1 //===--- SemaDecl.cpp - Semantic Analysis for Declarations ----------------===// 2 // 3 // Part of the LLVM Project, under the Apache License v2.0 with LLVM Exceptions. 4 // See https://llvm.org/LICENSE.txt for license information. 5 // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0 WITH LLVM-exception 6 // 7 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 8 // 9 // This file implements semantic analysis for declarations. 10 // 11 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 12 13 #include "TypeLocBuilder.h" 14 #include "clang/AST/ASTConsumer.h" 15 #include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h" 16 #include "clang/AST/ASTLambda.h" 17 #include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h" 18 #include "clang/AST/CharUnits.h" 19 #include "clang/AST/CommentDiagnostic.h" 20 #include "clang/AST/DeclCXX.h" 21 #include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h" 22 #include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h" 23 #include "clang/AST/EvaluatedExprVisitor.h" 24 #include "clang/AST/Expr.h" 25 #include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h" 26 #include "clang/AST/NonTrivialTypeVisitor.h" 27 #include "clang/AST/Randstruct.h" 28 #include "clang/AST/StmtCXX.h" 29 #include "clang/Basic/Builtins.h" 30 #include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h" 31 #include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h" 32 #include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h" 33 #include "clang/Lex/HeaderSearch.h" // TODO: Sema shouldn't depend on Lex 34 #include "clang/Lex/Lexer.h" // TODO: Extract static functions to fix layering. 35 #include "clang/Lex/ModuleLoader.h" // TODO: Sema shouldn't depend on Lex 36 #include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h" // Included for isCodeCompletionEnabled() 37 #include "clang/Sema/CXXFieldCollector.h" 38 #include "clang/Sema/DeclSpec.h" 39 #include "clang/Sema/DelayedDiagnostic.h" 40 #include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h" 41 #include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h" 42 #include "clang/Sema/ParsedTemplate.h" 43 #include "clang/Sema/Scope.h" 44 #include "clang/Sema/ScopeInfo.h" 45 #include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h" 46 #include "clang/Sema/Template.h" 47 #include "llvm/ADT/SmallString.h" 48 #include "llvm/ADT/Triple.h" 49 #include <algorithm> 50 #include <cstring> 51 #include <functional> 52 #include <unordered_map> 53 54 using namespace clang; 55 using namespace sema; 56 57 Sema::DeclGroupPtrTy Sema::ConvertDeclToDeclGroup(Decl *Ptr, Decl *OwnedType) { 58 if (OwnedType) { 59 Decl *Group[2] = { OwnedType, Ptr }; 60 return DeclGroupPtrTy::make(DeclGroupRef::Create(Context, Group, 2)); 61 } 62 63 return DeclGroupPtrTy::make(DeclGroupRef(Ptr)); 64 } 65 66 namespace { 67 68 class TypeNameValidatorCCC final : public CorrectionCandidateCallback { 69 public: 70 TypeNameValidatorCCC(bool AllowInvalid, bool WantClass = false, 71 bool AllowTemplates = false, 72 bool AllowNonTemplates = true) 73 : AllowInvalidDecl(AllowInvalid), WantClassName(WantClass), 74 AllowTemplates(AllowTemplates), AllowNonTemplates(AllowNonTemplates) { 75 WantExpressionKeywords = false; 76 WantCXXNamedCasts = false; 77 WantRemainingKeywords = false; 78 } 79 80 bool ValidateCandidate(const TypoCorrection &candidate) override { 81 if (NamedDecl *ND = candidate.getCorrectionDecl()) { 82 if (!AllowInvalidDecl && ND->isInvalidDecl()) 83 return false; 84 85 if (getAsTypeTemplateDecl(ND)) 86 return AllowTemplates; 87 88 bool IsType = isa<TypeDecl>(ND) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(ND); 89 if (!IsType) 90 return false; 91 92 if (AllowNonTemplates) 93 return true; 94 95 // An injected-class-name of a class template (specialization) is valid 96 // as a template or as a non-template. 97 if (AllowTemplates) { 98 auto *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ND); 99 if (!RD || !RD->isInjectedClassName()) 100 return false; 101 RD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD->getDeclContext()); 102 return RD->getDescribedClassTemplate() || 103 isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(RD); 104 } 105 106 return false; 107 } 108 109 return !WantClassName && candidate.isKeyword(); 110 } 111 112 std::unique_ptr<CorrectionCandidateCallback> clone() override { 113 return std::make_unique<TypeNameValidatorCCC>(*this); 114 } 115 116 private: 117 bool AllowInvalidDecl; 118 bool WantClassName; 119 bool AllowTemplates; 120 bool AllowNonTemplates; 121 }; 122 123 } // end anonymous namespace 124 125 /// Determine whether the token kind starts a simple-type-specifier. 126 bool Sema::isSimpleTypeSpecifier(tok::TokenKind Kind) const { 127 switch (Kind) { 128 // FIXME: Take into account the current language when deciding whether a 129 // token kind is a valid type specifier 130 case tok::kw_short: 131 case tok::kw_long: 132 case tok::kw___int64: 133 case tok::kw___int128: 134 case tok::kw_signed: 135 case tok::kw_unsigned: 136 case tok::kw_void: 137 case tok::kw_char: 138 case tok::kw_int: 139 case tok::kw_half: 140 case tok::kw_float: 141 case tok::kw_double: 142 case tok::kw___bf16: 143 case tok::kw__Float16: 144 case tok::kw___float128: 145 case tok::kw___ibm128: 146 case tok::kw_wchar_t: 147 case tok::kw_bool: 148 case tok::kw___underlying_type: 149 case tok::kw___auto_type: 150 return true; 151 152 case tok::annot_typename: 153 case tok::kw_char16_t: 154 case tok::kw_char32_t: 155 case tok::kw_typeof: 156 case tok::annot_decltype: 157 case tok::kw_decltype: 158 return getLangOpts().CPlusPlus; 159 160 case tok::kw_char8_t: 161 return getLangOpts().Char8; 162 163 default: 164 break; 165 } 166 167 return false; 168 } 169 170 namespace { 171 enum class UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult { 172 NotFound, 173 FoundNonType, 174 FoundType 175 }; 176 } // end anonymous namespace 177 178 /// Tries to perform unqualified lookup of the type decls in bases for 179 /// dependent class. 180 /// \return \a NotFound if no any decls is found, \a FoundNotType if found not a 181 /// type decl, \a FoundType if only type decls are found. 182 static UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult 183 lookupUnqualifiedTypeNameInBase(Sema &S, const IdentifierInfo &II, 184 SourceLocation NameLoc, 185 const CXXRecordDecl *RD) { 186 if (!RD->hasDefinition()) 187 return UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::NotFound; 188 // Look for type decls in base classes. 189 UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult FoundTypeDecl = 190 UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::NotFound; 191 for (const auto &Base : RD->bases()) { 192 const CXXRecordDecl *BaseRD = nullptr; 193 if (auto *BaseTT = Base.getType()->getAs<TagType>()) 194 BaseRD = BaseTT->getAsCXXRecordDecl(); 195 else if (auto *TST = Base.getType()->getAs<TemplateSpecializationType>()) { 196 // Look for type decls in dependent base classes that have known primary 197 // templates. 198 if (!TST || !TST->isDependentType()) 199 continue; 200 auto *TD = TST->getTemplateName().getAsTemplateDecl(); 201 if (!TD) 202 continue; 203 if (auto *BasePrimaryTemplate = 204 dyn_cast_or_null<CXXRecordDecl>(TD->getTemplatedDecl())) { 205 if (BasePrimaryTemplate->getCanonicalDecl() != RD->getCanonicalDecl()) 206 BaseRD = BasePrimaryTemplate; 207 else if (auto *CTD = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateDecl>(TD)) { 208 if (const ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *PS = 209 CTD->findPartialSpecialization(Base.getType())) 210 if (PS->getCanonicalDecl() != RD->getCanonicalDecl()) 211 BaseRD = PS; 212 } 213 } 214 } 215 if (BaseRD) { 216 for (NamedDecl *ND : BaseRD->lookup(&II)) { 217 if (!isa<TypeDecl>(ND)) 218 return UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::FoundNonType; 219 FoundTypeDecl = UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::FoundType; 220 } 221 if (FoundTypeDecl == UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::NotFound) { 222 switch (lookupUnqualifiedTypeNameInBase(S, II, NameLoc, BaseRD)) { 223 case UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::FoundNonType: 224 return UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::FoundNonType; 225 case UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::FoundType: 226 FoundTypeDecl = UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::FoundType; 227 break; 228 case UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::NotFound: 229 break; 230 } 231 } 232 } 233 } 234 235 return FoundTypeDecl; 236 } 237 238 static ParsedType recoverFromTypeInKnownDependentBase(Sema &S, 239 const IdentifierInfo &II, 240 SourceLocation NameLoc) { 241 // Lookup in the parent class template context, if any. 242 const CXXRecordDecl *RD = nullptr; 243 UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult FoundTypeDecl = 244 UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::NotFound; 245 for (DeclContext *DC = S.CurContext; 246 DC && FoundTypeDecl == UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::NotFound; 247 DC = DC->getParent()) { 248 // Look for type decls in dependent base classes that have known primary 249 // templates. 250 RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC); 251 if (RD && RD->getDescribedClassTemplate()) 252 FoundTypeDecl = lookupUnqualifiedTypeNameInBase(S, II, NameLoc, RD); 253 } 254 if (FoundTypeDecl != UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::FoundType) 255 return nullptr; 256 257 // We found some types in dependent base classes. Recover as if the user 258 // wrote 'typename MyClass::II' instead of 'II'. We'll fully resolve the 259 // lookup during template instantiation. 260 S.Diag(NameLoc, diag::ext_found_in_dependent_base) << &II; 261 262 ASTContext &Context = S.Context; 263 auto *NNS = NestedNameSpecifier::Create(Context, nullptr, false, 264 cast<Type>(Context.getRecordType(RD))); 265 QualType T = Context.getDependentNameType(ETK_Typename, NNS, &II); 266 267 CXXScopeSpec SS; 268 SS.MakeTrivial(Context, NNS, SourceRange(NameLoc)); 269 270 TypeLocBuilder Builder; 271 DependentNameTypeLoc DepTL = Builder.push<DependentNameTypeLoc>(T); 272 DepTL.setNameLoc(NameLoc); 273 DepTL.setElaboratedKeywordLoc(SourceLocation()); 274 DepTL.setQualifierLoc(SS.getWithLocInContext(Context)); 275 return S.CreateParsedType(T, Builder.getTypeSourceInfo(Context, T)); 276 } 277 278 /// If the identifier refers to a type name within this scope, 279 /// return the declaration of that type. 280 /// 281 /// This routine performs ordinary name lookup of the identifier II 282 /// within the given scope, with optional C++ scope specifier SS, to 283 /// determine whether the name refers to a type. If so, returns an 284 /// opaque pointer (actually a QualType) corresponding to that 285 /// type. Otherwise, returns NULL. 286 ParsedType Sema::getTypeName(const IdentifierInfo &II, SourceLocation NameLoc, 287 Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec *SS, 288 bool isClassName, bool HasTrailingDot, 289 ParsedType ObjectTypePtr, 290 bool IsCtorOrDtorName, 291 bool WantNontrivialTypeSourceInfo, 292 bool IsClassTemplateDeductionContext, 293 IdentifierInfo **CorrectedII) { 294 // FIXME: Consider allowing this outside C++1z mode as an extension. 295 bool AllowDeducedTemplate = IsClassTemplateDeductionContext && 296 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 && !IsCtorOrDtorName && 297 !isClassName && !HasTrailingDot; 298 299 // Determine where we will perform name lookup. 300 DeclContext *LookupCtx = nullptr; 301 if (ObjectTypePtr) { 302 QualType ObjectType = ObjectTypePtr.get(); 303 if (ObjectType->isRecordType()) 304 LookupCtx = computeDeclContext(ObjectType); 305 } else if (SS && SS->isNotEmpty()) { 306 LookupCtx = computeDeclContext(*SS, false); 307 308 if (!LookupCtx) { 309 if (isDependentScopeSpecifier(*SS)) { 310 // C++ [temp.res]p3: 311 // A qualified-id that refers to a type and in which the 312 // nested-name-specifier depends on a template-parameter (14.6.2) 313 // shall be prefixed by the keyword typename to indicate that the 314 // qualified-id denotes a type, forming an 315 // elaborated-type-specifier (7.1.5.3). 316 // 317 // We therefore do not perform any name lookup if the result would 318 // refer to a member of an unknown specialization. 319 if (!isClassName && !IsCtorOrDtorName) 320 return nullptr; 321 322 // We know from the grammar that this name refers to a type, 323 // so build a dependent node to describe the type. 324 if (WantNontrivialTypeSourceInfo) 325 return ActOnTypenameType(S, SourceLocation(), *SS, II, NameLoc).get(); 326 327 NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc = SS->getWithLocInContext(Context); 328 QualType T = CheckTypenameType(ETK_None, SourceLocation(), QualifierLoc, 329 II, NameLoc); 330 return ParsedType::make(T); 331 } 332 333 return nullptr; 334 } 335 336 if (!LookupCtx->isDependentContext() && 337 RequireCompleteDeclContext(*SS, LookupCtx)) 338 return nullptr; 339 } 340 341 // FIXME: LookupNestedNameSpecifierName isn't the right kind of 342 // lookup for class-names. 343 LookupNameKind Kind = isClassName ? LookupNestedNameSpecifierName : 344 LookupOrdinaryName; 345 LookupResult Result(*this, &II, NameLoc, Kind); 346 if (LookupCtx) { 347 // Perform "qualified" name lookup into the declaration context we 348 // computed, which is either the type of the base of a member access 349 // expression or the declaration context associated with a prior 350 // nested-name-specifier. 351 LookupQualifiedName(Result, LookupCtx); 352 353 if (ObjectTypePtr && Result.empty()) { 354 // C++ [basic.lookup.classref]p3: 355 // If the unqualified-id is ~type-name, the type-name is looked up 356 // in the context of the entire postfix-expression. If the type T of 357 // the object expression is of a class type C, the type-name is also 358 // looked up in the scope of class C. At least one of the lookups shall 359 // find a name that refers to (possibly cv-qualified) T. 360 LookupName(Result, S); 361 } 362 } else { 363 // Perform unqualified name lookup. 364 LookupName(Result, S); 365 366 // For unqualified lookup in a class template in MSVC mode, look into 367 // dependent base classes where the primary class template is known. 368 if (Result.empty() && getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && (!SS || SS->isEmpty())) { 369 if (ParsedType TypeInBase = 370 recoverFromTypeInKnownDependentBase(*this, II, NameLoc)) 371 return TypeInBase; 372 } 373 } 374 375 NamedDecl *IIDecl = nullptr; 376 UsingShadowDecl *FoundUsingShadow = nullptr; 377 switch (Result.getResultKind()) { 378 case LookupResult::NotFound: 379 case LookupResult::NotFoundInCurrentInstantiation: 380 if (CorrectedII) { 381 TypeNameValidatorCCC CCC(/*AllowInvalid=*/true, isClassName, 382 AllowDeducedTemplate); 383 TypoCorrection Correction = CorrectTypo(Result.getLookupNameInfo(), Kind, 384 S, SS, CCC, CTK_ErrorRecovery); 385 IdentifierInfo *NewII = Correction.getCorrectionAsIdentifierInfo(); 386 TemplateTy Template; 387 bool MemberOfUnknownSpecialization; 388 UnqualifiedId TemplateName; 389 TemplateName.setIdentifier(NewII, NameLoc); 390 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS = Correction.getCorrectionSpecifier(); 391 CXXScopeSpec NewSS, *NewSSPtr = SS; 392 if (SS && NNS) { 393 NewSS.MakeTrivial(Context, NNS, SourceRange(NameLoc)); 394 NewSSPtr = &NewSS; 395 } 396 if (Correction && (NNS || NewII != &II) && 397 // Ignore a correction to a template type as the to-be-corrected 398 // identifier is not a template (typo correction for template names 399 // is handled elsewhere). 400 !(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && NewSSPtr && 401 isTemplateName(S, *NewSSPtr, false, TemplateName, nullptr, false, 402 Template, MemberOfUnknownSpecialization))) { 403 ParsedType Ty = getTypeName(*NewII, NameLoc, S, NewSSPtr, 404 isClassName, HasTrailingDot, ObjectTypePtr, 405 IsCtorOrDtorName, 406 WantNontrivialTypeSourceInfo, 407 IsClassTemplateDeductionContext); 408 if (Ty) { 409 diagnoseTypo(Correction, 410 PDiag(diag::err_unknown_type_or_class_name_suggest) 411 << Result.getLookupName() << isClassName); 412 if (SS && NNS) 413 SS->MakeTrivial(Context, NNS, SourceRange(NameLoc)); 414 *CorrectedII = NewII; 415 return Ty; 416 } 417 } 418 } 419 // If typo correction failed or was not performed, fall through 420 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 421 case LookupResult::FoundOverloaded: 422 case LookupResult::FoundUnresolvedValue: 423 Result.suppressDiagnostics(); 424 return nullptr; 425 426 case LookupResult::Ambiguous: 427 // Recover from type-hiding ambiguities by hiding the type. We'll 428 // do the lookup again when looking for an object, and we can 429 // diagnose the error then. If we don't do this, then the error 430 // about hiding the type will be immediately followed by an error 431 // that only makes sense if the identifier was treated like a type. 432 if (Result.getAmbiguityKind() == LookupResult::AmbiguousTagHiding) { 433 Result.suppressDiagnostics(); 434 return nullptr; 435 } 436 437 // Look to see if we have a type anywhere in the list of results. 438 for (LookupResult::iterator Res = Result.begin(), ResEnd = Result.end(); 439 Res != ResEnd; ++Res) { 440 NamedDecl *RealRes = (*Res)->getUnderlyingDecl(); 441 if (isa<TypeDecl, ObjCInterfaceDecl, UnresolvedUsingIfExistsDecl>( 442 RealRes) || 443 (AllowDeducedTemplate && getAsTypeTemplateDecl(RealRes))) { 444 if (!IIDecl || 445 // Make the selection of the recovery decl deterministic. 446 RealRes->getLocation() < IIDecl->getLocation()) { 447 IIDecl = RealRes; 448 FoundUsingShadow = dyn_cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*Res); 449 } 450 } 451 } 452 453 if (!IIDecl) { 454 // None of the entities we found is a type, so there is no way 455 // to even assume that the result is a type. In this case, don't 456 // complain about the ambiguity. The parser will either try to 457 // perform this lookup again (e.g., as an object name), which 458 // will produce the ambiguity, or will complain that it expected 459 // a type name. 460 Result.suppressDiagnostics(); 461 return nullptr; 462 } 463 464 // We found a type within the ambiguous lookup; diagnose the 465 // ambiguity and then return that type. This might be the right 466 // answer, or it might not be, but it suppresses any attempt to 467 // perform the name lookup again. 468 break; 469 470 case LookupResult::Found: 471 IIDecl = Result.getFoundDecl(); 472 FoundUsingShadow = dyn_cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*Result.begin()); 473 break; 474 } 475 476 assert(IIDecl && "Didn't find decl"); 477 478 QualType T; 479 if (TypeDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TypeDecl>(IIDecl)) { 480 // C++ [class.qual]p2: A lookup that would find the injected-class-name 481 // instead names the constructors of the class, except when naming a class. 482 // This is ill-formed when we're not actually forming a ctor or dtor name. 483 auto *LookupRD = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXRecordDecl>(LookupCtx); 484 auto *FoundRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TD); 485 if (!isClassName && !IsCtorOrDtorName && LookupRD && FoundRD && 486 FoundRD->isInjectedClassName() && 487 declaresSameEntity(LookupRD, cast<Decl>(FoundRD->getParent()))) 488 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_out_of_line_qualified_id_type_names_constructor) 489 << &II << /*Type*/1; 490 491 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IIDecl, NameLoc); 492 493 T = Context.getTypeDeclType(TD); 494 MarkAnyDeclReferenced(TD->getLocation(), TD, /*OdrUse=*/false); 495 } else if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(IIDecl)) { 496 (void)DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IDecl, NameLoc); 497 if (!HasTrailingDot) 498 T = Context.getObjCInterfaceType(IDecl); 499 FoundUsingShadow = nullptr; // FIXME: Target must be a TypeDecl. 500 } else if (auto *UD = dyn_cast<UnresolvedUsingIfExistsDecl>(IIDecl)) { 501 (void)DiagnoseUseOfDecl(UD, NameLoc); 502 // Recover with 'int' 503 T = Context.IntTy; 504 FoundUsingShadow = nullptr; 505 } else if (AllowDeducedTemplate) { 506 if (auto *TD = getAsTypeTemplateDecl(IIDecl)) { 507 assert(!FoundUsingShadow || FoundUsingShadow->getTargetDecl() == TD); 508 TemplateName Template = 509 FoundUsingShadow ? TemplateName(FoundUsingShadow) : TemplateName(TD); 510 T = Context.getDeducedTemplateSpecializationType(Template, QualType(), 511 false); 512 // Don't wrap in a further UsingType. 513 FoundUsingShadow = nullptr; 514 } 515 } 516 517 if (T.isNull()) { 518 // If it's not plausibly a type, suppress diagnostics. 519 Result.suppressDiagnostics(); 520 return nullptr; 521 } 522 523 if (FoundUsingShadow) 524 T = Context.getUsingType(FoundUsingShadow, T); 525 526 // NOTE: avoid constructing an ElaboratedType(Loc) if this is a 527 // constructor or destructor name (in such a case, the scope specifier 528 // will be attached to the enclosing Expr or Decl node). 529 if (SS && SS->isNotEmpty() && !IsCtorOrDtorName && 530 !isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl, UnresolvedUsingIfExistsDecl>(IIDecl)) { 531 if (WantNontrivialTypeSourceInfo) { 532 // Construct a type with type-source information. 533 TypeLocBuilder Builder; 534 Builder.pushTypeSpec(T).setNameLoc(NameLoc); 535 536 T = getElaboratedType(ETK_None, *SS, T); 537 ElaboratedTypeLoc ElabTL = Builder.push<ElaboratedTypeLoc>(T); 538 ElabTL.setElaboratedKeywordLoc(SourceLocation()); 539 ElabTL.setQualifierLoc(SS->getWithLocInContext(Context)); 540 return CreateParsedType(T, Builder.getTypeSourceInfo(Context, T)); 541 } else { 542 T = getElaboratedType(ETK_None, *SS, T); 543 } 544 } 545 546 return ParsedType::make(T); 547 } 548 549 // Builds a fake NNS for the given decl context. 550 static NestedNameSpecifier * 551 synthesizeCurrentNestedNameSpecifier(ASTContext &Context, DeclContext *DC) { 552 for (;; DC = DC->getLookupParent()) { 553 DC = DC->getPrimaryContext(); 554 auto *ND = dyn_cast<NamespaceDecl>(DC); 555 if (ND && !ND->isInline() && !ND->isAnonymousNamespace()) 556 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(Context, nullptr, ND); 557 else if (auto *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) 558 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(Context, nullptr, RD->isTemplateDecl(), 559 RD->getTypeForDecl()); 560 else if (isa<TranslationUnitDecl>(DC)) 561 return NestedNameSpecifier::GlobalSpecifier(Context); 562 } 563 llvm_unreachable("something isn't in TU scope?"); 564 } 565 566 /// Find the parent class with dependent bases of the innermost enclosing method 567 /// context. Do not look for enclosing CXXRecordDecls directly, or we will end 568 /// up allowing unqualified dependent type names at class-level, which MSVC 569 /// correctly rejects. 570 static const CXXRecordDecl * 571 findRecordWithDependentBasesOfEnclosingMethod(const DeclContext *DC) { 572 for (; DC && DC->isDependentContext(); DC = DC->getLookupParent()) { 573 DC = DC->getPrimaryContext(); 574 if (const auto *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)) 575 if (MD->getParent()->hasAnyDependentBases()) 576 return MD->getParent(); 577 } 578 return nullptr; 579 } 580 581 ParsedType Sema::ActOnMSVCUnknownTypeName(const IdentifierInfo &II, 582 SourceLocation NameLoc, 583 bool IsTemplateTypeArg) { 584 assert(getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && "shouldn't be called in non-MSVC mode"); 585 586 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS = nullptr; 587 if (IsTemplateTypeArg && getCurScope()->isTemplateParamScope()) { 588 // If we weren't able to parse a default template argument, delay lookup 589 // until instantiation time by making a non-dependent DependentTypeName. We 590 // pretend we saw a NestedNameSpecifier referring to the current scope, and 591 // lookup is retried. 592 // FIXME: This hurts our diagnostic quality, since we get errors like "no 593 // type named 'Foo' in 'current_namespace'" when the user didn't write any 594 // name specifiers. 595 NNS = synthesizeCurrentNestedNameSpecifier(Context, CurContext); 596 Diag(NameLoc, diag::ext_ms_delayed_template_argument) << &II; 597 } else if (const CXXRecordDecl *RD = 598 findRecordWithDependentBasesOfEnclosingMethod(CurContext)) { 599 // Build a DependentNameType that will perform lookup into RD at 600 // instantiation time. 601 NNS = NestedNameSpecifier::Create(Context, nullptr, RD->isTemplateDecl(), 602 RD->getTypeForDecl()); 603 604 // Diagnose that this identifier was undeclared, and retry the lookup during 605 // template instantiation. 606 Diag(NameLoc, diag::ext_undeclared_unqual_id_with_dependent_base) << &II 607 << RD; 608 } else { 609 // This is not a situation that we should recover from. 610 return ParsedType(); 611 } 612 613 QualType T = Context.getDependentNameType(ETK_None, NNS, &II); 614 615 // Build type location information. We synthesized the qualifier, so we have 616 // to build a fake NestedNameSpecifierLoc. 617 NestedNameSpecifierLocBuilder NNSLocBuilder; 618 NNSLocBuilder.MakeTrivial(Context, NNS, SourceRange(NameLoc)); 619 NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc = NNSLocBuilder.getWithLocInContext(Context); 620 621 TypeLocBuilder Builder; 622 DependentNameTypeLoc DepTL = Builder.push<DependentNameTypeLoc>(T); 623 DepTL.setNameLoc(NameLoc); 624 DepTL.setElaboratedKeywordLoc(SourceLocation()); 625 DepTL.setQualifierLoc(QualifierLoc); 626 return CreateParsedType(T, Builder.getTypeSourceInfo(Context, T)); 627 } 628 629 /// isTagName() - This method is called *for error recovery purposes only* 630 /// to determine if the specified name is a valid tag name ("struct foo"). If 631 /// so, this returns the TST for the tag corresponding to it (TST_enum, 632 /// TST_union, TST_struct, TST_interface, TST_class). This is used to diagnose 633 /// cases in C where the user forgot to specify the tag. 634 DeclSpec::TST Sema::isTagName(IdentifierInfo &II, Scope *S) { 635 // Do a tag name lookup in this scope. 636 LookupResult R(*this, &II, SourceLocation(), LookupTagName); 637 LookupName(R, S, false); 638 R.suppressDiagnostics(); 639 if (R.getResultKind() == LookupResult::Found) 640 if (const TagDecl *TD = R.getAsSingle<TagDecl>()) { 641 switch (TD->getTagKind()) { 642 case TTK_Struct: return DeclSpec::TST_struct; 643 case TTK_Interface: return DeclSpec::TST_interface; 644 case TTK_Union: return DeclSpec::TST_union; 645 case TTK_Class: return DeclSpec::TST_class; 646 case TTK_Enum: return DeclSpec::TST_enum; 647 } 648 } 649 650 return DeclSpec::TST_unspecified; 651 } 652 653 /// isMicrosoftMissingTypename - In Microsoft mode, within class scope, 654 /// if a CXXScopeSpec's type is equal to the type of one of the base classes 655 /// then downgrade the missing typename error to a warning. 656 /// This is needed for MSVC compatibility; Example: 657 /// @code 658 /// template<class T> class A { 659 /// public: 660 /// typedef int TYPE; 661 /// }; 662 /// template<class T> class B : public A<T> { 663 /// public: 664 /// A<T>::TYPE a; // no typename required because A<T> is a base class. 665 /// }; 666 /// @endcode 667 bool Sema::isMicrosoftMissingTypename(const CXXScopeSpec *SS, Scope *S) { 668 if (CurContext->isRecord()) { 669 if (SS->getScopeRep()->getKind() == NestedNameSpecifier::Super) 670 return true; 671 672 const Type *Ty = SS->getScopeRep()->getAsType(); 673 674 CXXRecordDecl *RD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(CurContext); 675 for (const auto &Base : RD->bases()) 676 if (Ty && Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(QualType(Ty, 1), Base.getType())) 677 return true; 678 return S->isFunctionPrototypeScope(); 679 } 680 return CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod() || S->isFunctionPrototypeScope(); 681 } 682 683 void Sema::DiagnoseUnknownTypeName(IdentifierInfo *&II, 684 SourceLocation IILoc, 685 Scope *S, 686 CXXScopeSpec *SS, 687 ParsedType &SuggestedType, 688 bool IsTemplateName) { 689 // Don't report typename errors for editor placeholders. 690 if (II->isEditorPlaceholder()) 691 return; 692 // We don't have anything to suggest (yet). 693 SuggestedType = nullptr; 694 695 // There may have been a typo in the name of the type. Look up typo 696 // results, in case we have something that we can suggest. 697 TypeNameValidatorCCC CCC(/*AllowInvalid=*/false, /*WantClass=*/false, 698 /*AllowTemplates=*/IsTemplateName, 699 /*AllowNonTemplates=*/!IsTemplateName); 700 if (TypoCorrection Corrected = 701 CorrectTypo(DeclarationNameInfo(II, IILoc), LookupOrdinaryName, S, SS, 702 CCC, CTK_ErrorRecovery)) { 703 // FIXME: Support error recovery for the template-name case. 704 bool CanRecover = !IsTemplateName; 705 if (Corrected.isKeyword()) { 706 // We corrected to a keyword. 707 diagnoseTypo(Corrected, 708 PDiag(IsTemplateName ? diag::err_no_template_suggest 709 : diag::err_unknown_typename_suggest) 710 << II); 711 II = Corrected.getCorrectionAsIdentifierInfo(); 712 } else { 713 // We found a similarly-named type or interface; suggest that. 714 if (!SS || !SS->isSet()) { 715 diagnoseTypo(Corrected, 716 PDiag(IsTemplateName ? diag::err_no_template_suggest 717 : diag::err_unknown_typename_suggest) 718 << II, CanRecover); 719 } else if (DeclContext *DC = computeDeclContext(*SS, false)) { 720 std::string CorrectedStr(Corrected.getAsString(getLangOpts())); 721 bool DroppedSpecifier = Corrected.WillReplaceSpecifier() && 722 II->getName().equals(CorrectedStr); 723 diagnoseTypo(Corrected, 724 PDiag(IsTemplateName 725 ? diag::err_no_member_template_suggest 726 : diag::err_unknown_nested_typename_suggest) 727 << II << DC << DroppedSpecifier << SS->getRange(), 728 CanRecover); 729 } else { 730 llvm_unreachable("could not have corrected a typo here"); 731 } 732 733 if (!CanRecover) 734 return; 735 736 CXXScopeSpec tmpSS; 737 if (Corrected.getCorrectionSpecifier()) 738 tmpSS.MakeTrivial(Context, Corrected.getCorrectionSpecifier(), 739 SourceRange(IILoc)); 740 // FIXME: Support class template argument deduction here. 741 SuggestedType = 742 getTypeName(*Corrected.getCorrectionAsIdentifierInfo(), IILoc, S, 743 tmpSS.isSet() ? &tmpSS : SS, false, false, nullptr, 744 /*IsCtorOrDtorName=*/false, 745 /*WantNontrivialTypeSourceInfo=*/true); 746 } 747 return; 748 } 749 750 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !IsTemplateName) { 751 // See if II is a class template that the user forgot to pass arguments to. 752 UnqualifiedId Name; 753 Name.setIdentifier(II, IILoc); 754 CXXScopeSpec EmptySS; 755 TemplateTy TemplateResult; 756 bool MemberOfUnknownSpecialization; 757 if (isTemplateName(S, SS ? *SS : EmptySS, /*hasTemplateKeyword=*/false, 758 Name, nullptr, true, TemplateResult, 759 MemberOfUnknownSpecialization) == TNK_Type_template) { 760 diagnoseMissingTemplateArguments(TemplateResult.get(), IILoc); 761 return; 762 } 763 } 764 765 // FIXME: Should we move the logic that tries to recover from a missing tag 766 // (struct, union, enum) from Parser::ParseImplicitInt here, instead? 767 768 if (!SS || (!SS->isSet() && !SS->isInvalid())) 769 Diag(IILoc, IsTemplateName ? diag::err_no_template 770 : diag::err_unknown_typename) 771 << II; 772 else if (DeclContext *DC = computeDeclContext(*SS, false)) 773 Diag(IILoc, IsTemplateName ? diag::err_no_member_template 774 : diag::err_typename_nested_not_found) 775 << II << DC << SS->getRange(); 776 else if (SS->isValid() && SS->getScopeRep()->containsErrors()) { 777 SuggestedType = 778 ActOnTypenameType(S, SourceLocation(), *SS, *II, IILoc).get(); 779 } else if (isDependentScopeSpecifier(*SS)) { 780 unsigned DiagID = diag::err_typename_missing; 781 if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && isMicrosoftMissingTypename(SS, S)) 782 DiagID = diag::ext_typename_missing; 783 784 Diag(SS->getRange().getBegin(), DiagID) 785 << SS->getScopeRep() << II->getName() 786 << SourceRange(SS->getRange().getBegin(), IILoc) 787 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SS->getRange().getBegin(), "typename "); 788 SuggestedType = ActOnTypenameType(S, SourceLocation(), 789 *SS, *II, IILoc).get(); 790 } else { 791 assert(SS && SS->isInvalid() && 792 "Invalid scope specifier has already been diagnosed"); 793 } 794 } 795 796 /// Determine whether the given result set contains either a type name 797 /// or 798 static bool isResultTypeOrTemplate(LookupResult &R, const Token &NextToken) { 799 bool CheckTemplate = R.getSema().getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 800 NextToken.is(tok::less); 801 802 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), IEnd = R.end(); I != IEnd; ++I) { 803 if (isa<TypeDecl>(*I) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(*I)) 804 return true; 805 806 if (CheckTemplate && isa<TemplateDecl>(*I)) 807 return true; 808 } 809 810 return false; 811 } 812 813 static bool isTagTypeWithMissingTag(Sema &SemaRef, LookupResult &Result, 814 Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, 815 IdentifierInfo *&Name, 816 SourceLocation NameLoc) { 817 LookupResult R(SemaRef, Name, NameLoc, Sema::LookupTagName); 818 SemaRef.LookupParsedName(R, S, &SS); 819 if (TagDecl *Tag = R.getAsSingle<TagDecl>()) { 820 StringRef FixItTagName; 821 switch (Tag->getTagKind()) { 822 case TTK_Class: 823 FixItTagName = "class "; 824 break; 825 826 case TTK_Enum: 827 FixItTagName = "enum "; 828 break; 829 830 case TTK_Struct: 831 FixItTagName = "struct "; 832 break; 833 834 case TTK_Interface: 835 FixItTagName = "__interface "; 836 break; 837 838 case TTK_Union: 839 FixItTagName = "union "; 840 break; 841 } 842 843 StringRef TagName = FixItTagName.drop_back(); 844 SemaRef.Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_use_of_tag_name_without_tag) 845 << Name << TagName << SemaRef.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus 846 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(NameLoc, FixItTagName); 847 848 for (LookupResult::iterator I = Result.begin(), IEnd = Result.end(); 849 I != IEnd; ++I) 850 SemaRef.Diag((*I)->getLocation(), diag::note_decl_hiding_tag_type) 851 << Name << TagName; 852 853 // Replace lookup results with just the tag decl. 854 Result.clear(Sema::LookupTagName); 855 SemaRef.LookupParsedName(Result, S, &SS); 856 return true; 857 } 858 859 return false; 860 } 861 862 Sema::NameClassification Sema::ClassifyName(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, 863 IdentifierInfo *&Name, 864 SourceLocation NameLoc, 865 const Token &NextToken, 866 CorrectionCandidateCallback *CCC) { 867 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo(Name, NameLoc); 868 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMethod = getCurMethodDecl(); 869 870 assert(NextToken.isNot(tok::coloncolon) && 871 "parse nested name specifiers before calling ClassifyName"); 872 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && SS.isSet() && 873 isCurrentClassName(*Name, S, &SS)) { 874 // Per [class.qual]p2, this names the constructors of SS, not the 875 // injected-class-name. We don't have a classification for that. 876 // There's not much point caching this result, since the parser 877 // will reject it later. 878 return NameClassification::Unknown(); 879 } 880 881 LookupResult Result(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 882 LookupParsedName(Result, S, &SS, !CurMethod); 883 884 if (SS.isInvalid()) 885 return NameClassification::Error(); 886 887 // For unqualified lookup in a class template in MSVC mode, look into 888 // dependent base classes where the primary class template is known. 889 if (Result.empty() && SS.isEmpty() && getLangOpts().MSVCCompat) { 890 if (ParsedType TypeInBase = 891 recoverFromTypeInKnownDependentBase(*this, *Name, NameLoc)) 892 return TypeInBase; 893 } 894 895 // Perform lookup for Objective-C instance variables (including automatically 896 // synthesized instance variables), if we're in an Objective-C method. 897 // FIXME: This lookup really, really needs to be folded in to the normal 898 // unqualified lookup mechanism. 899 if (SS.isEmpty() && CurMethod && !isResultTypeOrTemplate(Result, NextToken)) { 900 DeclResult Ivar = LookupIvarInObjCMethod(Result, S, Name); 901 if (Ivar.isInvalid()) 902 return NameClassification::Error(); 903 if (Ivar.isUsable()) 904 return NameClassification::NonType(cast<NamedDecl>(Ivar.get())); 905 906 // We defer builtin creation until after ivar lookup inside ObjC methods. 907 if (Result.empty()) 908 LookupBuiltin(Result); 909 } 910 911 bool SecondTry = false; 912 bool IsFilteredTemplateName = false; 913 914 Corrected: 915 switch (Result.getResultKind()) { 916 case LookupResult::NotFound: 917 // If an unqualified-id is followed by a '(', then we have a function 918 // call. 919 if (SS.isEmpty() && NextToken.is(tok::l_paren)) { 920 // In C++, this is an ADL-only call. 921 // FIXME: Reference? 922 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 923 return NameClassification::UndeclaredNonType(); 924 925 // C90 6.3.2.2: 926 // If the expression that precedes the parenthesized argument list in a 927 // function call consists solely of an identifier, and if no 928 // declaration is visible for this identifier, the identifier is 929 // implicitly declared exactly as if, in the innermost block containing 930 // the function call, the declaration 931 // 932 // extern int identifier (); 933 // 934 // appeared. 935 // 936 // We also allow this in C99 as an extension. However, this is not 937 // allowed in all language modes as functions without prototypes may not 938 // be supported. 939 if (getLangOpts().implicitFunctionsAllowed()) { 940 if (NamedDecl *D = ImplicitlyDefineFunction(NameLoc, *Name, S)) 941 return NameClassification::NonType(D); 942 } 943 } 944 945 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20 && SS.isEmpty() && NextToken.is(tok::less)) { 946 // In C++20 onwards, this could be an ADL-only call to a function 947 // template, and we're required to assume that this is a template name. 948 // 949 // FIXME: Find a way to still do typo correction in this case. 950 TemplateName Template = 951 Context.getAssumedTemplateName(NameInfo.getName()); 952 return NameClassification::UndeclaredTemplate(Template); 953 } 954 955 // In C, we first see whether there is a tag type by the same name, in 956 // which case it's likely that the user just forgot to write "enum", 957 // "struct", or "union". 958 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !SecondTry && 959 isTagTypeWithMissingTag(*this, Result, S, SS, Name, NameLoc)) { 960 break; 961 } 962 963 // Perform typo correction to determine if there is another name that is 964 // close to this name. 965 if (!SecondTry && CCC) { 966 SecondTry = true; 967 if (TypoCorrection Corrected = 968 CorrectTypo(Result.getLookupNameInfo(), Result.getLookupKind(), S, 969 &SS, *CCC, CTK_ErrorRecovery)) { 970 unsigned UnqualifiedDiag = diag::err_undeclared_var_use_suggest; 971 unsigned QualifiedDiag = diag::err_no_member_suggest; 972 973 NamedDecl *FirstDecl = Corrected.getFoundDecl(); 974 NamedDecl *UnderlyingFirstDecl = Corrected.getCorrectionDecl(); 975 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && NextToken.is(tok::less) && 976 UnderlyingFirstDecl && isa<TemplateDecl>(UnderlyingFirstDecl)) { 977 UnqualifiedDiag = diag::err_no_template_suggest; 978 QualifiedDiag = diag::err_no_member_template_suggest; 979 } else if (UnderlyingFirstDecl && 980 (isa<TypeDecl>(UnderlyingFirstDecl) || 981 isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(UnderlyingFirstDecl) || 982 isa<ObjCCompatibleAliasDecl>(UnderlyingFirstDecl))) { 983 UnqualifiedDiag = diag::err_unknown_typename_suggest; 984 QualifiedDiag = diag::err_unknown_nested_typename_suggest; 985 } 986 987 if (SS.isEmpty()) { 988 diagnoseTypo(Corrected, PDiag(UnqualifiedDiag) << Name); 989 } else {// FIXME: is this even reachable? Test it. 990 std::string CorrectedStr(Corrected.getAsString(getLangOpts())); 991 bool DroppedSpecifier = Corrected.WillReplaceSpecifier() && 992 Name->getName().equals(CorrectedStr); 993 diagnoseTypo(Corrected, PDiag(QualifiedDiag) 994 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) 995 << DroppedSpecifier << SS.getRange()); 996 } 997 998 // Update the name, so that the caller has the new name. 999 Name = Corrected.getCorrectionAsIdentifierInfo(); 1000 1001 // Typo correction corrected to a keyword. 1002 if (Corrected.isKeyword()) 1003 return Name; 1004 1005 // Also update the LookupResult... 1006 // FIXME: This should probably go away at some point 1007 Result.clear(); 1008 Result.setLookupName(Corrected.getCorrection()); 1009 if (FirstDecl) 1010 Result.addDecl(FirstDecl); 1011 1012 // If we found an Objective-C instance variable, let 1013 // LookupInObjCMethod build the appropriate expression to 1014 // reference the ivar. 1015 // FIXME: This is a gross hack. 1016 if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = Result.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>()) { 1017 DeclResult R = 1018 LookupIvarInObjCMethod(Result, S, Ivar->getIdentifier()); 1019 if (R.isInvalid()) 1020 return NameClassification::Error(); 1021 if (R.isUsable()) 1022 return NameClassification::NonType(Ivar); 1023 } 1024 1025 goto Corrected; 1026 } 1027 } 1028 1029 // We failed to correct; just fall through and let the parser deal with it. 1030 Result.suppressDiagnostics(); 1031 return NameClassification::Unknown(); 1032 1033 case LookupResult::NotFoundInCurrentInstantiation: { 1034 // We performed name lookup into the current instantiation, and there were 1035 // dependent bases, so we treat this result the same way as any other 1036 // dependent nested-name-specifier. 1037 1038 // C++ [temp.res]p2: 1039 // A name used in a template declaration or definition and that is 1040 // dependent on a template-parameter is assumed not to name a type 1041 // unless the applicable name lookup finds a type name or the name is 1042 // qualified by the keyword typename. 1043 // 1044 // FIXME: If the next token is '<', we might want to ask the parser to 1045 // perform some heroics to see if we actually have a 1046 // template-argument-list, which would indicate a missing 'template' 1047 // keyword here. 1048 return NameClassification::DependentNonType(); 1049 } 1050 1051 case LookupResult::Found: 1052 case LookupResult::FoundOverloaded: 1053 case LookupResult::FoundUnresolvedValue: 1054 break; 1055 1056 case LookupResult::Ambiguous: 1057 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && NextToken.is(tok::less) && 1058 hasAnyAcceptableTemplateNames(Result, /*AllowFunctionTemplates=*/true, 1059 /*AllowDependent=*/false)) { 1060 // C++ [temp.local]p3: 1061 // A lookup that finds an injected-class-name (10.2) can result in an 1062 // ambiguity in certain cases (for example, if it is found in more than 1063 // one base class). If all of the injected-class-names that are found 1064 // refer to specializations of the same class template, and if the name 1065 // is followed by a template-argument-list, the reference refers to the 1066 // class template itself and not a specialization thereof, and is not 1067 // ambiguous. 1068 // 1069 // This filtering can make an ambiguous result into an unambiguous one, 1070 // so try again after filtering out template names. 1071 FilterAcceptableTemplateNames(Result); 1072 if (!Result.isAmbiguous()) { 1073 IsFilteredTemplateName = true; 1074 break; 1075 } 1076 } 1077 1078 // Diagnose the ambiguity and return an error. 1079 return NameClassification::Error(); 1080 } 1081 1082 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && NextToken.is(tok::less) && 1083 (IsFilteredTemplateName || 1084 hasAnyAcceptableTemplateNames( 1085 Result, /*AllowFunctionTemplates=*/true, 1086 /*AllowDependent=*/false, 1087 /*AllowNonTemplateFunctions*/ SS.isEmpty() && 1088 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20))) { 1089 // C++ [temp.names]p3: 1090 // After name lookup (3.4) finds that a name is a template-name or that 1091 // an operator-function-id or a literal- operator-id refers to a set of 1092 // overloaded functions any member of which is a function template if 1093 // this is followed by a <, the < is always taken as the delimiter of a 1094 // template-argument-list and never as the less-than operator. 1095 // C++2a [temp.names]p2: 1096 // A name is also considered to refer to a template if it is an 1097 // unqualified-id followed by a < and name lookup finds either one 1098 // or more functions or finds nothing. 1099 if (!IsFilteredTemplateName) 1100 FilterAcceptableTemplateNames(Result); 1101 1102 bool IsFunctionTemplate; 1103 bool IsVarTemplate; 1104 TemplateName Template; 1105 if (Result.end() - Result.begin() > 1) { 1106 IsFunctionTemplate = true; 1107 Template = Context.getOverloadedTemplateName(Result.begin(), 1108 Result.end()); 1109 } else if (!Result.empty()) { 1110 auto *TD = cast<TemplateDecl>(getAsTemplateNameDecl( 1111 *Result.begin(), /*AllowFunctionTemplates=*/true, 1112 /*AllowDependent=*/false)); 1113 IsFunctionTemplate = isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(TD); 1114 IsVarTemplate = isa<VarTemplateDecl>(TD); 1115 1116 UsingShadowDecl *FoundUsingShadow = 1117 dyn_cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*Result.begin()); 1118 assert(!FoundUsingShadow || 1119 TD == cast<TemplateDecl>(FoundUsingShadow->getTargetDecl())); 1120 Template = 1121 FoundUsingShadow ? TemplateName(FoundUsingShadow) : TemplateName(TD); 1122 if (SS.isNotEmpty()) 1123 Template = Context.getQualifiedTemplateName(SS.getScopeRep(), 1124 /*TemplateKeyword=*/false, 1125 Template); 1126 } else { 1127 // All results were non-template functions. This is a function template 1128 // name. 1129 IsFunctionTemplate = true; 1130 Template = Context.getAssumedTemplateName(NameInfo.getName()); 1131 } 1132 1133 if (IsFunctionTemplate) { 1134 // Function templates always go through overload resolution, at which 1135 // point we'll perform the various checks (e.g., accessibility) we need 1136 // to based on which function we selected. 1137 Result.suppressDiagnostics(); 1138 1139 return NameClassification::FunctionTemplate(Template); 1140 } 1141 1142 return IsVarTemplate ? NameClassification::VarTemplate(Template) 1143 : NameClassification::TypeTemplate(Template); 1144 } 1145 1146 auto BuildTypeFor = [&](TypeDecl *Type, NamedDecl *Found) { 1147 QualType T = Context.getTypeDeclType(Type); 1148 if (const auto *USD = dyn_cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Found)) 1149 T = Context.getUsingType(USD, T); 1150 1151 if (SS.isEmpty()) // No elaborated type, trivial location info 1152 return ParsedType::make(T); 1153 1154 TypeLocBuilder Builder; 1155 Builder.pushTypeSpec(T).setNameLoc(NameLoc); 1156 T = getElaboratedType(ETK_None, SS, T); 1157 ElaboratedTypeLoc ElabTL = Builder.push<ElaboratedTypeLoc>(T); 1158 ElabTL.setElaboratedKeywordLoc(SourceLocation()); 1159 ElabTL.setQualifierLoc(SS.getWithLocInContext(Context)); 1160 return CreateParsedType(T, Builder.getTypeSourceInfo(Context, T)); 1161 }; 1162 1163 NamedDecl *FirstDecl = (*Result.begin())->getUnderlyingDecl(); 1164 if (TypeDecl *Type = dyn_cast<TypeDecl>(FirstDecl)) { 1165 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Type, NameLoc); 1166 MarkAnyDeclReferenced(Type->getLocation(), Type, /*OdrUse=*/false); 1167 return BuildTypeFor(Type, *Result.begin()); 1168 } 1169 1170 ObjCInterfaceDecl *Class = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(FirstDecl); 1171 if (!Class) { 1172 // FIXME: It's unfortunate that we don't have a Type node for handling this. 1173 if (ObjCCompatibleAliasDecl *Alias = 1174 dyn_cast<ObjCCompatibleAliasDecl>(FirstDecl)) 1175 Class = Alias->getClassInterface(); 1176 } 1177 1178 if (Class) { 1179 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Class, NameLoc); 1180 1181 if (NextToken.is(tok::period)) { 1182 // Interface. <something> is parsed as a property reference expression. 1183 // Just return "unknown" as a fall-through for now. 1184 Result.suppressDiagnostics(); 1185 return NameClassification::Unknown(); 1186 } 1187 1188 QualType T = Context.getObjCInterfaceType(Class); 1189 return ParsedType::make(T); 1190 } 1191 1192 if (isa<ConceptDecl>(FirstDecl)) 1193 return NameClassification::Concept( 1194 TemplateName(cast<TemplateDecl>(FirstDecl))); 1195 1196 if (auto *EmptyD = dyn_cast<UnresolvedUsingIfExistsDecl>(FirstDecl)) { 1197 (void)DiagnoseUseOfDecl(EmptyD, NameLoc); 1198 return NameClassification::Error(); 1199 } 1200 1201 // We can have a type template here if we're classifying a template argument. 1202 if (isa<TemplateDecl>(FirstDecl) && !isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(FirstDecl) && 1203 !isa<VarTemplateDecl>(FirstDecl)) 1204 return NameClassification::TypeTemplate( 1205 TemplateName(cast<TemplateDecl>(FirstDecl))); 1206 1207 // Check for a tag type hidden by a non-type decl in a few cases where it 1208 // seems likely a type is wanted instead of the non-type that was found. 1209 bool NextIsOp = NextToken.isOneOf(tok::amp, tok::star); 1210 if ((NextToken.is(tok::identifier) || 1211 (NextIsOp && 1212 FirstDecl->getUnderlyingDecl()->isFunctionOrFunctionTemplate())) && 1213 isTagTypeWithMissingTag(*this, Result, S, SS, Name, NameLoc)) { 1214 TypeDecl *Type = Result.getAsSingle<TypeDecl>(); 1215 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Type, NameLoc); 1216 return BuildTypeFor(Type, *Result.begin()); 1217 } 1218 1219 // If we already know which single declaration is referenced, just annotate 1220 // that declaration directly. Defer resolving even non-overloaded class 1221 // member accesses, as we need to defer certain access checks until we know 1222 // the context. 1223 bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, Result, NextToken.is(tok::l_paren)); 1224 if (Result.isSingleResult() && !ADL && !FirstDecl->isCXXClassMember()) 1225 return NameClassification::NonType(Result.getRepresentativeDecl()); 1226 1227 // Otherwise, this is an overload set that we will need to resolve later. 1228 Result.suppressDiagnostics(); 1229 return NameClassification::OverloadSet(UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create( 1230 Context, Result.getNamingClass(), SS.getWithLocInContext(Context), 1231 Result.getLookupNameInfo(), ADL, Result.isOverloadedResult(), 1232 Result.begin(), Result.end())); 1233 } 1234 1235 ExprResult 1236 Sema::ActOnNameClassifiedAsUndeclaredNonType(IdentifierInfo *Name, 1237 SourceLocation NameLoc) { 1238 assert(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "ADL-only call in C?"); 1239 CXXScopeSpec SS; 1240 LookupResult Result(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 1241 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, Result, /*ADL=*/true); 1242 } 1243 1244 ExprResult 1245 Sema::ActOnNameClassifiedAsDependentNonType(const CXXScopeSpec &SS, 1246 IdentifierInfo *Name, 1247 SourceLocation NameLoc, 1248 bool IsAddressOfOperand) { 1249 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo(Name, NameLoc); 1250 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, /*TemplateKWLoc=*/SourceLocation(), 1251 NameInfo, IsAddressOfOperand, 1252 /*TemplateArgs=*/nullptr); 1253 } 1254 1255 ExprResult Sema::ActOnNameClassifiedAsNonType(Scope *S, const CXXScopeSpec &SS, 1256 NamedDecl *Found, 1257 SourceLocation NameLoc, 1258 const Token &NextToken) { 1259 if (getCurMethodDecl() && SS.isEmpty()) 1260 if (auto *Ivar = dyn_cast<ObjCIvarDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl())) 1261 return BuildIvarRefExpr(S, NameLoc, Ivar); 1262 1263 // Reconstruct the lookup result. 1264 LookupResult Result(*this, Found->getDeclName(), NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 1265 Result.addDecl(Found); 1266 Result.resolveKind(); 1267 1268 bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, Result, NextToken.is(tok::l_paren)); 1269 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, Result, ADL); 1270 } 1271 1272 ExprResult Sema::ActOnNameClassifiedAsOverloadSet(Scope *S, Expr *E) { 1273 // For an implicit class member access, transform the result into a member 1274 // access expression if necessary. 1275 auto *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(E); 1276 if ((*ULE->decls_begin())->isCXXClassMember()) { 1277 CXXScopeSpec SS; 1278 SS.Adopt(ULE->getQualifierLoc()); 1279 1280 // Reconstruct the lookup result. 1281 LookupResult Result(*this, ULE->getName(), ULE->getNameLoc(), 1282 LookupOrdinaryName); 1283 Result.setNamingClass(ULE->getNamingClass()); 1284 for (auto I = ULE->decls_begin(), E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) 1285 Result.addDecl(*I, I.getAccess()); 1286 Result.resolveKind(); 1287 return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, SourceLocation(), Result, 1288 nullptr, S); 1289 } 1290 1291 // Otherwise, this is already in the form we needed, and no further checks 1292 // are necessary. 1293 return ULE; 1294 } 1295 1296 Sema::TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics 1297 Sema::getTemplateNameKindForDiagnostics(TemplateName Name) { 1298 auto *TD = Name.getAsTemplateDecl(); 1299 if (!TD) 1300 return TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics::DependentTemplate; 1301 if (isa<ClassTemplateDecl>(TD)) 1302 return TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics::ClassTemplate; 1303 if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(TD)) 1304 return TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics::FunctionTemplate; 1305 if (isa<VarTemplateDecl>(TD)) 1306 return TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics::VarTemplate; 1307 if (isa<TypeAliasTemplateDecl>(TD)) 1308 return TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics::AliasTemplate; 1309 if (isa<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(TD)) 1310 return TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics::TemplateTemplateParam; 1311 if (isa<ConceptDecl>(TD)) 1312 return TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics::Concept; 1313 return TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics::DependentTemplate; 1314 } 1315 1316 void Sema::PushDeclContext(Scope *S, DeclContext *DC) { 1317 assert(DC->getLexicalParent() == CurContext && 1318 "The next DeclContext should be lexically contained in the current one."); 1319 CurContext = DC; 1320 S->setEntity(DC); 1321 } 1322 1323 void Sema::PopDeclContext() { 1324 assert(CurContext && "DeclContext imbalance!"); 1325 1326 CurContext = CurContext->getLexicalParent(); 1327 assert(CurContext && "Popped translation unit!"); 1328 } 1329 1330 Sema::SkippedDefinitionContext Sema::ActOnTagStartSkippedDefinition(Scope *S, 1331 Decl *D) { 1332 // Unlike PushDeclContext, the context to which we return is not necessarily 1333 // the containing DC of TD, because the new context will be some pre-existing 1334 // TagDecl definition instead of a fresh one. 1335 auto Result = static_cast<SkippedDefinitionContext>(CurContext); 1336 CurContext = cast<TagDecl>(D)->getDefinition(); 1337 assert(CurContext && "skipping definition of undefined tag"); 1338 // Start lookups from the parent of the current context; we don't want to look 1339 // into the pre-existing complete definition. 1340 S->setEntity(CurContext->getLookupParent()); 1341 return Result; 1342 } 1343 1344 void Sema::ActOnTagFinishSkippedDefinition(SkippedDefinitionContext Context) { 1345 CurContext = static_cast<decltype(CurContext)>(Context); 1346 } 1347 1348 /// EnterDeclaratorContext - Used when we must lookup names in the context 1349 /// of a declarator's nested name specifier. 1350 /// 1351 void Sema::EnterDeclaratorContext(Scope *S, DeclContext *DC) { 1352 // C++0x [basic.lookup.unqual]p13: 1353 // A name used in the definition of a static data member of class 1354 // X (after the qualified-id of the static member) is looked up as 1355 // if the name was used in a member function of X. 1356 // C++0x [basic.lookup.unqual]p14: 1357 // If a variable member of a namespace is defined outside of the 1358 // scope of its namespace then any name used in the definition of 1359 // the variable member (after the declarator-id) is looked up as 1360 // if the definition of the variable member occurred in its 1361 // namespace. 1362 // Both of these imply that we should push a scope whose context 1363 // is the semantic context of the declaration. We can't use 1364 // PushDeclContext here because that context is not necessarily 1365 // lexically contained in the current context. Fortunately, 1366 // the containing scope should have the appropriate information. 1367 1368 assert(!S->getEntity() && "scope already has entity"); 1369 1370 #ifndef NDEBUG 1371 Scope *Ancestor = S->getParent(); 1372 while (!Ancestor->getEntity()) Ancestor = Ancestor->getParent(); 1373 assert(Ancestor->getEntity() == CurContext && "ancestor context mismatch"); 1374 #endif 1375 1376 CurContext = DC; 1377 S->setEntity(DC); 1378 1379 if (S->getParent()->isTemplateParamScope()) { 1380 // Also set the corresponding entities for all immediately-enclosing 1381 // template parameter scopes. 1382 EnterTemplatedContext(S->getParent(), DC); 1383 } 1384 } 1385 1386 void Sema::ExitDeclaratorContext(Scope *S) { 1387 assert(S->getEntity() == CurContext && "Context imbalance!"); 1388 1389 // Switch back to the lexical context. The safety of this is 1390 // enforced by an assert in EnterDeclaratorContext. 1391 Scope *Ancestor = S->getParent(); 1392 while (!Ancestor->getEntity()) Ancestor = Ancestor->getParent(); 1393 CurContext = Ancestor->getEntity(); 1394 1395 // We don't need to do anything with the scope, which is going to 1396 // disappear. 1397 } 1398 1399 void Sema::EnterTemplatedContext(Scope *S, DeclContext *DC) { 1400 assert(S->isTemplateParamScope() && 1401 "expected to be initializing a template parameter scope"); 1402 1403 // C++20 [temp.local]p7: 1404 // In the definition of a member of a class template that appears outside 1405 // of the class template definition, the name of a member of the class 1406 // template hides the name of a template-parameter of any enclosing class 1407 // templates (but not a template-parameter of the member if the member is a 1408 // class or function template). 1409 // C++20 [temp.local]p9: 1410 // In the definition of a class template or in the definition of a member 1411 // of such a template that appears outside of the template definition, for 1412 // each non-dependent base class (13.8.2.1), if the name of the base class 1413 // or the name of a member of the base class is the same as the name of a 1414 // template-parameter, the base class name or member name hides the 1415 // template-parameter name (6.4.10). 1416 // 1417 // This means that a template parameter scope should be searched immediately 1418 // after searching the DeclContext for which it is a template parameter 1419 // scope. For example, for 1420 // template<typename T> template<typename U> template<typename V> 1421 // void N::A<T>::B<U>::f(...) 1422 // we search V then B<U> (and base classes) then U then A<T> (and base 1423 // classes) then T then N then ::. 1424 unsigned ScopeDepth = getTemplateDepth(S); 1425 for (; S && S->isTemplateParamScope(); S = S->getParent(), --ScopeDepth) { 1426 DeclContext *SearchDCAfterScope = DC; 1427 for (; DC; DC = DC->getLookupParent()) { 1428 if (const TemplateParameterList *TPL = 1429 cast<Decl>(DC)->getDescribedTemplateParams()) { 1430 unsigned DCDepth = TPL->getDepth() + 1; 1431 if (DCDepth > ScopeDepth) 1432 continue; 1433 if (ScopeDepth == DCDepth) 1434 SearchDCAfterScope = DC = DC->getLookupParent(); 1435 break; 1436 } 1437 } 1438 S->setLookupEntity(SearchDCAfterScope); 1439 } 1440 } 1441 1442 void Sema::ActOnReenterFunctionContext(Scope* S, Decl *D) { 1443 // We assume that the caller has already called 1444 // ActOnReenterTemplateScope so getTemplatedDecl() works. 1445 FunctionDecl *FD = D->getAsFunction(); 1446 if (!FD) 1447 return; 1448 1449 // Same implementation as PushDeclContext, but enters the context 1450 // from the lexical parent, rather than the top-level class. 1451 assert(CurContext == FD->getLexicalParent() && 1452 "The next DeclContext should be lexically contained in the current one."); 1453 CurContext = FD; 1454 S->setEntity(CurContext); 1455 1456 for (unsigned P = 0, NumParams = FD->getNumParams(); P < NumParams; ++P) { 1457 ParmVarDecl *Param = FD->getParamDecl(P); 1458 // If the parameter has an identifier, then add it to the scope 1459 if (Param->getIdentifier()) { 1460 S->AddDecl(Param); 1461 IdResolver.AddDecl(Param); 1462 } 1463 } 1464 } 1465 1466 void Sema::ActOnExitFunctionContext() { 1467 // Same implementation as PopDeclContext, but returns to the lexical parent, 1468 // rather than the top-level class. 1469 assert(CurContext && "DeclContext imbalance!"); 1470 CurContext = CurContext->getLexicalParent(); 1471 assert(CurContext && "Popped translation unit!"); 1472 } 1473 1474 /// Determine whether overloading is allowed for a new function 1475 /// declaration considering prior declarations of the same name. 1476 /// 1477 /// This routine determines whether overloading is possible, not 1478 /// whether a new declaration actually overloads a previous one. 1479 /// It will return true in C++ (where overloads are alway permitted) 1480 /// or, as a C extension, when either the new declaration or a 1481 /// previous one is declared with the 'overloadable' attribute. 1482 static bool AllowOverloadingOfFunction(const LookupResult &Previous, 1483 ASTContext &Context, 1484 const FunctionDecl *New) { 1485 if (Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || New->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>()) 1486 return true; 1487 1488 // Multiversion function declarations are not overloads in the 1489 // usual sense of that term, but lookup will report that an 1490 // overload set was found if more than one multiversion function 1491 // declaration is present for the same name. It is therefore 1492 // inadequate to assume that some prior declaration(s) had 1493 // the overloadable attribute; checking is required. Since one 1494 // declaration is permitted to omit the attribute, it is necessary 1495 // to check at least two; hence the 'any_of' check below. Note that 1496 // the overloadable attribute is implicitly added to declarations 1497 // that were required to have it but did not. 1498 if (Previous.getResultKind() == LookupResult::FoundOverloaded) { 1499 return llvm::any_of(Previous, [](const NamedDecl *ND) { 1500 return ND->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>(); 1501 }); 1502 } else if (Previous.getResultKind() == LookupResult::Found) 1503 return Previous.getFoundDecl()->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>(); 1504 1505 return false; 1506 } 1507 1508 /// Add this decl to the scope shadowed decl chains. 1509 void Sema::PushOnScopeChains(NamedDecl *D, Scope *S, bool AddToContext) { 1510 // Move up the scope chain until we find the nearest enclosing 1511 // non-transparent context. The declaration will be introduced into this 1512 // scope. 1513 while (S->getEntity() && S->getEntity()->isTransparentContext()) 1514 S = S->getParent(); 1515 1516 // Add scoped declarations into their context, so that they can be 1517 // found later. Declarations without a context won't be inserted 1518 // into any context. 1519 if (AddToContext) 1520 CurContext->addDecl(D); 1521 1522 // Out-of-line definitions shouldn't be pushed into scope in C++, unless they 1523 // are function-local declarations. 1524 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && D->isOutOfLine() && !S->getFnParent()) 1525 return; 1526 1527 // Template instantiations should also not be pushed into scope. 1528 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D) && 1529 cast<FunctionDecl>(D)->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization()) 1530 return; 1531 1532 // If this replaces anything in the current scope, 1533 IdentifierResolver::iterator I = IdResolver.begin(D->getDeclName()), 1534 IEnd = IdResolver.end(); 1535 for (; I != IEnd; ++I) { 1536 if (S->isDeclScope(*I) && D->declarationReplaces(*I)) { 1537 S->RemoveDecl(*I); 1538 IdResolver.RemoveDecl(*I); 1539 1540 // Should only need to replace one decl. 1541 break; 1542 } 1543 } 1544 1545 S->AddDecl(D); 1546 1547 if (isa<LabelDecl>(D) && !cast<LabelDecl>(D)->isGnuLocal()) { 1548 // Implicitly-generated labels may end up getting generated in an order that 1549 // isn't strictly lexical, which breaks name lookup. Be careful to insert 1550 // the label at the appropriate place in the identifier chain. 1551 for (I = IdResolver.begin(D->getDeclName()); I != IEnd; ++I) { 1552 DeclContext *IDC = (*I)->getLexicalDeclContext()->getRedeclContext(); 1553 if (IDC == CurContext) { 1554 if (!S->isDeclScope(*I)) 1555 continue; 1556 } else if (IDC->Encloses(CurContext)) 1557 break; 1558 } 1559 1560 IdResolver.InsertDeclAfter(I, D); 1561 } else { 1562 IdResolver.AddDecl(D); 1563 } 1564 warnOnReservedIdentifier(D); 1565 } 1566 1567 bool Sema::isDeclInScope(NamedDecl *D, DeclContext *Ctx, Scope *S, 1568 bool AllowInlineNamespace) { 1569 return IdResolver.isDeclInScope(D, Ctx, S, AllowInlineNamespace); 1570 } 1571 1572 Scope *Sema::getScopeForDeclContext(Scope *S, DeclContext *DC) { 1573 DeclContext *TargetDC = DC->getPrimaryContext(); 1574 do { 1575 if (DeclContext *ScopeDC = S->getEntity()) 1576 if (ScopeDC->getPrimaryContext() == TargetDC) 1577 return S; 1578 } while ((S = S->getParent())); 1579 1580 return nullptr; 1581 } 1582 1583 static bool isOutOfScopePreviousDeclaration(NamedDecl *, 1584 DeclContext*, 1585 ASTContext&); 1586 1587 /// Filters out lookup results that don't fall within the given scope 1588 /// as determined by isDeclInScope. 1589 void Sema::FilterLookupForScope(LookupResult &R, DeclContext *Ctx, Scope *S, 1590 bool ConsiderLinkage, 1591 bool AllowInlineNamespace) { 1592 LookupResult::Filter F = R.makeFilter(); 1593 while (F.hasNext()) { 1594 NamedDecl *D = F.next(); 1595 1596 if (isDeclInScope(D, Ctx, S, AllowInlineNamespace)) 1597 continue; 1598 1599 if (ConsiderLinkage && isOutOfScopePreviousDeclaration(D, Ctx, Context)) 1600 continue; 1601 1602 F.erase(); 1603 } 1604 1605 F.done(); 1606 } 1607 1608 /// We've determined that \p New is a redeclaration of \p Old. Check that they 1609 /// have compatible owning modules. 1610 bool Sema::CheckRedeclarationModuleOwnership(NamedDecl *New, NamedDecl *Old) { 1611 // [module.interface]p7: 1612 // A declaration is attached to a module as follows: 1613 // - If the declaration is a non-dependent friend declaration that nominates a 1614 // function with a declarator-id that is a qualified-id or template-id or that 1615 // nominates a class other than with an elaborated-type-specifier with neither 1616 // a nested-name-specifier nor a simple-template-id, it is attached to the 1617 // module to which the friend is attached ([basic.link]). 1618 if (New->getFriendObjectKind() && 1619 Old->getOwningModuleForLinkage() != New->getOwningModuleForLinkage()) { 1620 New->setLocalOwningModule(Old->getOwningModule()); 1621 makeMergedDefinitionVisible(New); 1622 return false; 1623 } 1624 1625 Module *NewM = New->getOwningModule(); 1626 Module *OldM = Old->getOwningModule(); 1627 1628 if (NewM && NewM->Kind == Module::PrivateModuleFragment) 1629 NewM = NewM->Parent; 1630 if (OldM && OldM->Kind == Module::PrivateModuleFragment) 1631 OldM = OldM->Parent; 1632 1633 // If we have a decl in a module partition, it is part of the containing 1634 // module (which is the only thing that can be importing it). 1635 if (NewM && OldM && 1636 (OldM->Kind == Module::ModulePartitionInterface || 1637 OldM->Kind == Module::ModulePartitionImplementation)) { 1638 return false; 1639 } 1640 1641 if (NewM == OldM) 1642 return false; 1643 1644 bool NewIsModuleInterface = NewM && NewM->isModulePurview(); 1645 bool OldIsModuleInterface = OldM && OldM->isModulePurview(); 1646 if (NewIsModuleInterface || OldIsModuleInterface) { 1647 // C++ Modules TS [basic.def.odr] 6.2/6.7 [sic]: 1648 // if a declaration of D [...] appears in the purview of a module, all 1649 // other such declarations shall appear in the purview of the same module 1650 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_mismatched_owning_module) 1651 << New 1652 << NewIsModuleInterface 1653 << (NewIsModuleInterface ? NewM->getFullModuleName() : "") 1654 << OldIsModuleInterface 1655 << (OldIsModuleInterface ? OldM->getFullModuleName() : ""); 1656 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 1657 New->setInvalidDecl(); 1658 return true; 1659 } 1660 1661 return false; 1662 } 1663 1664 // [module.interface]p6: 1665 // A redeclaration of an entity X is implicitly exported if X was introduced by 1666 // an exported declaration; otherwise it shall not be exported. 1667 bool Sema::CheckRedeclarationExported(NamedDecl *New, NamedDecl *Old) { 1668 // [module.interface]p1: 1669 // An export-declaration shall inhabit a namespace scope. 1670 // 1671 // So it is meaningless to talk about redeclaration which is not at namespace 1672 // scope. 1673 if (!New->getLexicalDeclContext() 1674 ->getNonTransparentContext() 1675 ->isFileContext() || 1676 !Old->getLexicalDeclContext() 1677 ->getNonTransparentContext() 1678 ->isFileContext()) 1679 return false; 1680 1681 bool IsNewExported = New->isInExportDeclContext(); 1682 bool IsOldExported = Old->isInExportDeclContext(); 1683 1684 // It should be irrevelant if both of them are not exported. 1685 if (!IsNewExported && !IsOldExported) 1686 return false; 1687 1688 if (IsOldExported) 1689 return false; 1690 1691 assert(IsNewExported); 1692 1693 auto Lk = Old->getFormalLinkage(); 1694 int S = 0; 1695 if (Lk == Linkage::InternalLinkage) 1696 S = 1; 1697 else if (Lk == Linkage::ModuleLinkage) 1698 S = 2; 1699 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redeclaration_non_exported) << New << S; 1700 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 1701 return true; 1702 } 1703 1704 // A wrapper function for checking the semantic restrictions of 1705 // a redeclaration within a module. 1706 bool Sema::CheckRedeclarationInModule(NamedDecl *New, NamedDecl *Old) { 1707 if (CheckRedeclarationModuleOwnership(New, Old)) 1708 return true; 1709 1710 if (CheckRedeclarationExported(New, Old)) 1711 return true; 1712 1713 return false; 1714 } 1715 1716 static bool isUsingDecl(NamedDecl *D) { 1717 return isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D) || 1718 isa<UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl>(D) || 1719 isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(D); 1720 } 1721 1722 /// Removes using shadow declarations from the lookup results. 1723 static void RemoveUsingDecls(LookupResult &R) { 1724 LookupResult::Filter F = R.makeFilter(); 1725 while (F.hasNext()) 1726 if (isUsingDecl(F.next())) 1727 F.erase(); 1728 1729 F.done(); 1730 } 1731 1732 /// Check for this common pattern: 1733 /// @code 1734 /// class S { 1735 /// S(const S&); // DO NOT IMPLEMENT 1736 /// void operator=(const S&); // DO NOT IMPLEMENT 1737 /// }; 1738 /// @endcode 1739 static bool IsDisallowedCopyOrAssign(const CXXMethodDecl *D) { 1740 // FIXME: Should check for private access too but access is set after we get 1741 // the decl here. 1742 if (D->doesThisDeclarationHaveABody()) 1743 return false; 1744 1745 if (const CXXConstructorDecl *CD = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D)) 1746 return CD->isCopyConstructor(); 1747 return D->isCopyAssignmentOperator(); 1748 } 1749 1750 // We need this to handle 1751 // 1752 // typedef struct { 1753 // void *foo() { return 0; } 1754 // } A; 1755 // 1756 // When we see foo we don't know if after the typedef we will get 'A' or '*A' 1757 // for example. If 'A', foo will have external linkage. If we have '*A', 1758 // foo will have no linkage. Since we can't know until we get to the end 1759 // of the typedef, this function finds out if D might have non-external linkage. 1760 // Callers should verify at the end of the TU if it D has external linkage or 1761 // not. 1762 bool Sema::mightHaveNonExternalLinkage(const DeclaratorDecl *D) { 1763 const DeclContext *DC = D->getDeclContext(); 1764 while (!DC->isTranslationUnit()) { 1765 if (const RecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(DC)){ 1766 if (!RD->hasNameForLinkage()) 1767 return true; 1768 } 1769 DC = DC->getParent(); 1770 } 1771 1772 return !D->isExternallyVisible(); 1773 } 1774 1775 // FIXME: This needs to be refactored; some other isInMainFile users want 1776 // these semantics. 1777 static bool isMainFileLoc(const Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) { 1778 if (S.TUKind != TU_Complete) 1779 return false; 1780 return S.SourceMgr.isInMainFile(Loc); 1781 } 1782 1783 bool Sema::ShouldWarnIfUnusedFileScopedDecl(const DeclaratorDecl *D) const { 1784 assert(D); 1785 1786 if (D->isInvalidDecl() || D->isUsed() || D->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>()) 1787 return false; 1788 1789 // Ignore all entities declared within templates, and out-of-line definitions 1790 // of members of class templates. 1791 if (D->getDeclContext()->isDependentContext() || 1792 D->getLexicalDeclContext()->isDependentContext()) 1793 return false; 1794 1795 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 1796 if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) 1797 return false; 1798 // A non-out-of-line declaration of a member specialization was implicitly 1799 // instantiated; it's the out-of-line declaration that we're interested in. 1800 if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ExplicitSpecialization && 1801 FD->getMemberSpecializationInfo() && !FD->isOutOfLine()) 1802 return false; 1803 1804 if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)) { 1805 if (MD->isVirtual() || IsDisallowedCopyOrAssign(MD)) 1806 return false; 1807 } else { 1808 // 'static inline' functions are defined in headers; don't warn. 1809 if (FD->isInlined() && !isMainFileLoc(*this, FD->getLocation())) 1810 return false; 1811 } 1812 1813 if (FD->doesThisDeclarationHaveABody() && 1814 Context.DeclMustBeEmitted(FD)) 1815 return false; 1816 } else if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) { 1817 // Constants and utility variables are defined in headers with internal 1818 // linkage; don't warn. (Unlike functions, there isn't a convenient marker 1819 // like "inline".) 1820 if (!isMainFileLoc(*this, VD->getLocation())) 1821 return false; 1822 1823 if (Context.DeclMustBeEmitted(VD)) 1824 return false; 1825 1826 if (VD->isStaticDataMember() && 1827 VD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) 1828 return false; 1829 if (VD->isStaticDataMember() && 1830 VD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ExplicitSpecialization && 1831 VD->getMemberSpecializationInfo() && !VD->isOutOfLine()) 1832 return false; 1833 1834 if (VD->isInline() && !isMainFileLoc(*this, VD->getLocation())) 1835 return false; 1836 } else { 1837 return false; 1838 } 1839 1840 // Only warn for unused decls internal to the translation unit. 1841 // FIXME: This seems like a bogus check; it suppresses -Wunused-function 1842 // for inline functions defined in the main source file, for instance. 1843 return mightHaveNonExternalLinkage(D); 1844 } 1845 1846 void Sema::MarkUnusedFileScopedDecl(const DeclaratorDecl *D) { 1847 if (!D) 1848 return; 1849 1850 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 1851 const FunctionDecl *First = FD->getFirstDecl(); 1852 if (FD != First && ShouldWarnIfUnusedFileScopedDecl(First)) 1853 return; // First should already be in the vector. 1854 } 1855 1856 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) { 1857 const VarDecl *First = VD->getFirstDecl(); 1858 if (VD != First && ShouldWarnIfUnusedFileScopedDecl(First)) 1859 return; // First should already be in the vector. 1860 } 1861 1862 if (ShouldWarnIfUnusedFileScopedDecl(D)) 1863 UnusedFileScopedDecls.push_back(D); 1864 } 1865 1866 static bool ShouldDiagnoseUnusedDecl(const NamedDecl *D) { 1867 if (D->isInvalidDecl()) 1868 return false; 1869 1870 if (auto *DD = dyn_cast<DecompositionDecl>(D)) { 1871 // For a decomposition declaration, warn if none of the bindings are 1872 // referenced, instead of if the variable itself is referenced (which 1873 // it is, by the bindings' expressions). 1874 for (auto *BD : DD->bindings()) 1875 if (BD->isReferenced()) 1876 return false; 1877 } else if (!D->getDeclName()) { 1878 return false; 1879 } else if (D->isReferenced() || D->isUsed()) { 1880 return false; 1881 } 1882 1883 if (D->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>() || D->hasAttr<ObjCPreciseLifetimeAttr>()) 1884 return false; 1885 1886 if (isa<LabelDecl>(D)) 1887 return true; 1888 1889 // Except for labels, we only care about unused decls that are local to 1890 // functions. 1891 bool WithinFunction = D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod(); 1892 if (const auto *R = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext())) 1893 // For dependent types, the diagnostic is deferred. 1894 WithinFunction = 1895 WithinFunction || (R->isLocalClass() && !R->isDependentType()); 1896 if (!WithinFunction) 1897 return false; 1898 1899 if (isa<TypedefNameDecl>(D)) 1900 return true; 1901 1902 // White-list anything that isn't a local variable. 1903 if (!isa<VarDecl>(D) || isa<ParmVarDecl>(D) || isa<ImplicitParamDecl>(D)) 1904 return false; 1905 1906 // Types of valid local variables should be complete, so this should succeed. 1907 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) { 1908 1909 const Expr *Init = VD->getInit(); 1910 if (const auto *Cleanups = dyn_cast_or_null<ExprWithCleanups>(Init)) 1911 Init = Cleanups->getSubExpr(); 1912 1913 const auto *Ty = VD->getType().getTypePtr(); 1914 1915 // Only look at the outermost level of typedef. 1916 if (const TypedefType *TT = Ty->getAs<TypedefType>()) { 1917 // Allow anything marked with __attribute__((unused)). 1918 if (TT->getDecl()->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>()) 1919 return false; 1920 } 1921 1922 // Warn for reference variables whose initializtion performs lifetime 1923 // extension. 1924 if (const auto *MTE = dyn_cast_or_null<MaterializeTemporaryExpr>(Init)) { 1925 if (MTE->getExtendingDecl()) { 1926 Ty = VD->getType().getNonReferenceType().getTypePtr(); 1927 Init = MTE->getSubExpr()->IgnoreImplicitAsWritten(); 1928 } 1929 } 1930 1931 // If we failed to complete the type for some reason, or if the type is 1932 // dependent, don't diagnose the variable. 1933 if (Ty->isIncompleteType() || Ty->isDependentType()) 1934 return false; 1935 1936 // Look at the element type to ensure that the warning behaviour is 1937 // consistent for both scalars and arrays. 1938 Ty = Ty->getBaseElementTypeUnsafe(); 1939 1940 if (const TagType *TT = Ty->getAs<TagType>()) { 1941 const TagDecl *Tag = TT->getDecl(); 1942 if (Tag->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>()) 1943 return false; 1944 1945 if (const CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Tag)) { 1946 if (!RD->hasTrivialDestructor() && !RD->hasAttr<WarnUnusedAttr>()) 1947 return false; 1948 1949 if (Init) { 1950 const CXXConstructExpr *Construct = 1951 dyn_cast<CXXConstructExpr>(Init); 1952 if (Construct && !Construct->isElidable()) { 1953 CXXConstructorDecl *CD = Construct->getConstructor(); 1954 if (!CD->isTrivial() && !RD->hasAttr<WarnUnusedAttr>() && 1955 (VD->getInit()->isValueDependent() || !VD->evaluateValue())) 1956 return false; 1957 } 1958 1959 // Suppress the warning if we don't know how this is constructed, and 1960 // it could possibly be non-trivial constructor. 1961 if (Init->isTypeDependent()) { 1962 for (const CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor : RD->ctors()) 1963 if (!Ctor->isTrivial()) 1964 return false; 1965 } 1966 1967 // Suppress the warning if the constructor is unresolved because 1968 // its arguments are dependent. 1969 if (isa<CXXUnresolvedConstructExpr>(Init)) 1970 return false; 1971 } 1972 } 1973 } 1974 1975 // TODO: __attribute__((unused)) templates? 1976 } 1977 1978 return true; 1979 } 1980 1981 static void GenerateFixForUnusedDecl(const NamedDecl *D, ASTContext &Ctx, 1982 FixItHint &Hint) { 1983 if (isa<LabelDecl>(D)) { 1984 SourceLocation AfterColon = Lexer::findLocationAfterToken( 1985 D->getEndLoc(), tok::colon, Ctx.getSourceManager(), Ctx.getLangOpts(), 1986 true); 1987 if (AfterColon.isInvalid()) 1988 return; 1989 Hint = FixItHint::CreateRemoval( 1990 CharSourceRange::getCharRange(D->getBeginLoc(), AfterColon)); 1991 } 1992 } 1993 1994 void Sema::DiagnoseUnusedNestedTypedefs(const RecordDecl *D) { 1995 if (D->getTypeForDecl()->isDependentType()) 1996 return; 1997 1998 for (auto *TmpD : D->decls()) { 1999 if (const auto *T = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(TmpD)) 2000 DiagnoseUnusedDecl(T); 2001 else if(const auto *R = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(TmpD)) 2002 DiagnoseUnusedNestedTypedefs(R); 2003 } 2004 } 2005 2006 /// DiagnoseUnusedDecl - Emit warnings about declarations that are not used 2007 /// unless they are marked attr(unused). 2008 void Sema::DiagnoseUnusedDecl(const NamedDecl *D) { 2009 if (!ShouldDiagnoseUnusedDecl(D)) 2010 return; 2011 2012 if (auto *TD = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(D)) { 2013 // typedefs can be referenced later on, so the diagnostics are emitted 2014 // at end-of-translation-unit. 2015 UnusedLocalTypedefNameCandidates.insert(TD); 2016 return; 2017 } 2018 2019 FixItHint Hint; 2020 GenerateFixForUnusedDecl(D, Context, Hint); 2021 2022 unsigned DiagID; 2023 if (isa<VarDecl>(D) && cast<VarDecl>(D)->isExceptionVariable()) 2024 DiagID = diag::warn_unused_exception_param; 2025 else if (isa<LabelDecl>(D)) 2026 DiagID = diag::warn_unused_label; 2027 else 2028 DiagID = diag::warn_unused_variable; 2029 2030 Diag(D->getLocation(), DiagID) << D << Hint; 2031 } 2032 2033 void Sema::DiagnoseUnusedButSetDecl(const VarDecl *VD) { 2034 // If it's not referenced, it can't be set. If it has the Cleanup attribute, 2035 // it's not really unused. 2036 if (!VD->isReferenced() || !VD->getDeclName() || VD->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>() || 2037 VD->hasAttr<CleanupAttr>()) 2038 return; 2039 2040 const auto *Ty = VD->getType().getTypePtr()->getBaseElementTypeUnsafe(); 2041 2042 if (Ty->isReferenceType() || Ty->isDependentType()) 2043 return; 2044 2045 if (const TagType *TT = Ty->getAs<TagType>()) { 2046 const TagDecl *Tag = TT->getDecl(); 2047 if (Tag->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>()) 2048 return; 2049 // In C++, don't warn for record types that don't have WarnUnusedAttr, to 2050 // mimic gcc's behavior. 2051 if (const CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Tag)) { 2052 if (!RD->hasAttr<WarnUnusedAttr>()) 2053 return; 2054 } 2055 } 2056 2057 // Don't warn about __block Objective-C pointer variables, as they might 2058 // be assigned in the block but not used elsewhere for the purpose of lifetime 2059 // extension. 2060 if (VD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>() && Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType()) 2061 return; 2062 2063 // Don't warn about Objective-C pointer variables with precise lifetime 2064 // semantics; they can be used to ensure ARC releases the object at a known 2065 // time, which may mean assignment but no other references. 2066 if (VD->hasAttr<ObjCPreciseLifetimeAttr>() && Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType()) 2067 return; 2068 2069 auto iter = RefsMinusAssignments.find(VD); 2070 if (iter == RefsMinusAssignments.end()) 2071 return; 2072 2073 assert(iter->getSecond() >= 0 && 2074 "Found a negative number of references to a VarDecl"); 2075 if (iter->getSecond() != 0) 2076 return; 2077 unsigned DiagID = isa<ParmVarDecl>(VD) ? diag::warn_unused_but_set_parameter 2078 : diag::warn_unused_but_set_variable; 2079 Diag(VD->getLocation(), DiagID) << VD; 2080 } 2081 2082 static void CheckPoppedLabel(LabelDecl *L, Sema &S) { 2083 // Verify that we have no forward references left. If so, there was a goto 2084 // or address of a label taken, but no definition of it. Label fwd 2085 // definitions are indicated with a null substmt which is also not a resolved 2086 // MS inline assembly label name. 2087 bool Diagnose = false; 2088 if (L->isMSAsmLabel()) 2089 Diagnose = !L->isResolvedMSAsmLabel(); 2090 else 2091 Diagnose = L->getStmt() == nullptr; 2092 if (Diagnose) 2093 S.Diag(L->getLocation(), diag::err_undeclared_label_use) << L; 2094 } 2095 2096 void Sema::ActOnPopScope(SourceLocation Loc, Scope *S) { 2097 S->mergeNRVOIntoParent(); 2098 2099 if (S->decl_empty()) return; 2100 assert((S->getFlags() & (Scope::DeclScope | Scope::TemplateParamScope)) && 2101 "Scope shouldn't contain decls!"); 2102 2103 for (auto *TmpD : S->decls()) { 2104 assert(TmpD && "This decl didn't get pushed??"); 2105 2106 assert(isa<NamedDecl>(TmpD) && "Decl isn't NamedDecl?"); 2107 NamedDecl *D = cast<NamedDecl>(TmpD); 2108 2109 // Diagnose unused variables in this scope. 2110 if (!S->hasUnrecoverableErrorOccurred()) { 2111 DiagnoseUnusedDecl(D); 2112 if (const auto *RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(D)) 2113 DiagnoseUnusedNestedTypedefs(RD); 2114 if (VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) { 2115 DiagnoseUnusedButSetDecl(VD); 2116 RefsMinusAssignments.erase(VD); 2117 } 2118 } 2119 2120 if (!D->getDeclName()) continue; 2121 2122 // If this was a forward reference to a label, verify it was defined. 2123 if (LabelDecl *LD = dyn_cast<LabelDecl>(D)) 2124 CheckPoppedLabel(LD, *this); 2125 2126 // Remove this name from our lexical scope, and warn on it if we haven't 2127 // already. 2128 IdResolver.RemoveDecl(D); 2129 auto ShadowI = ShadowingDecls.find(D); 2130 if (ShadowI != ShadowingDecls.end()) { 2131 if (const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(ShadowI->second)) { 2132 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::warn_ctor_parm_shadows_field) 2133 << D << FD << FD->getParent(); 2134 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 2135 } 2136 ShadowingDecls.erase(ShadowI); 2137 } 2138 } 2139 } 2140 2141 /// Look for an Objective-C class in the translation unit. 2142 /// 2143 /// \param Id The name of the Objective-C class we're looking for. If 2144 /// typo-correction fixes this name, the Id will be updated 2145 /// to the fixed name. 2146 /// 2147 /// \param IdLoc The location of the name in the translation unit. 2148 /// 2149 /// \param DoTypoCorrection If true, this routine will attempt typo correction 2150 /// if there is no class with the given name. 2151 /// 2152 /// \returns The declaration of the named Objective-C class, or NULL if the 2153 /// class could not be found. 2154 ObjCInterfaceDecl *Sema::getObjCInterfaceDecl(IdentifierInfo *&Id, 2155 SourceLocation IdLoc, 2156 bool DoTypoCorrection) { 2157 // The third "scope" argument is 0 since we aren't enabling lazy built-in 2158 // creation from this context. 2159 NamedDecl *IDecl = LookupSingleName(TUScope, Id, IdLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 2160 2161 if (!IDecl && DoTypoCorrection) { 2162 // Perform typo correction at the given location, but only if we 2163 // find an Objective-C class name. 2164 DeclFilterCCC<ObjCInterfaceDecl> CCC{}; 2165 if (TypoCorrection C = 2166 CorrectTypo(DeclarationNameInfo(Id, IdLoc), LookupOrdinaryName, 2167 TUScope, nullptr, CCC, CTK_ErrorRecovery)) { 2168 diagnoseTypo(C, PDiag(diag::err_undef_interface_suggest) << Id); 2169 IDecl = C.getCorrectionDeclAs<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(); 2170 Id = IDecl->getIdentifier(); 2171 } 2172 } 2173 ObjCInterfaceDecl *Def = dyn_cast_or_null<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(IDecl); 2174 // This routine must always return a class definition, if any. 2175 if (Def && Def->getDefinition()) 2176 Def = Def->getDefinition(); 2177 return Def; 2178 } 2179 2180 /// getNonFieldDeclScope - Retrieves the innermost scope, starting 2181 /// from S, where a non-field would be declared. This routine copes 2182 /// with the difference between C and C++ scoping rules in structs and 2183 /// unions. For example, the following code is well-formed in C but 2184 /// ill-formed in C++: 2185 /// @code 2186 /// struct S6 { 2187 /// enum { BAR } e; 2188 /// }; 2189 /// 2190 /// void test_S6() { 2191 /// struct S6 a; 2192 /// a.e = BAR; 2193 /// } 2194 /// @endcode 2195 /// For the declaration of BAR, this routine will return a different 2196 /// scope. The scope S will be the scope of the unnamed enumeration 2197 /// within S6. In C++, this routine will return the scope associated 2198 /// with S6, because the enumeration's scope is a transparent 2199 /// context but structures can contain non-field names. In C, this 2200 /// routine will return the translation unit scope, since the 2201 /// enumeration's scope is a transparent context and structures cannot 2202 /// contain non-field names. 2203 Scope *Sema::getNonFieldDeclScope(Scope *S) { 2204 while (((S->getFlags() & Scope::DeclScope) == 0) || 2205 (S->getEntity() && S->getEntity()->isTransparentContext()) || 2206 (S->isClassScope() && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)) 2207 S = S->getParent(); 2208 return S; 2209 } 2210 2211 static StringRef getHeaderName(Builtin::Context &BuiltinInfo, unsigned ID, 2212 ASTContext::GetBuiltinTypeError Error) { 2213 switch (Error) { 2214 case ASTContext::GE_None: 2215 return ""; 2216 case ASTContext::GE_Missing_type: 2217 return BuiltinInfo.getHeaderName(ID); 2218 case ASTContext::GE_Missing_stdio: 2219 return "stdio.h"; 2220 case ASTContext::GE_Missing_setjmp: 2221 return "setjmp.h"; 2222 case ASTContext::GE_Missing_ucontext: 2223 return "ucontext.h"; 2224 } 2225 llvm_unreachable("unhandled error kind"); 2226 } 2227 2228 FunctionDecl *Sema::CreateBuiltin(IdentifierInfo *II, QualType Type, 2229 unsigned ID, SourceLocation Loc) { 2230 DeclContext *Parent = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl(); 2231 2232 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 2233 LinkageSpecDecl *CLinkageDecl = LinkageSpecDecl::Create( 2234 Context, Parent, Loc, Loc, LinkageSpecDecl::lang_c, false); 2235 CLinkageDecl->setImplicit(); 2236 Parent->addDecl(CLinkageDecl); 2237 Parent = CLinkageDecl; 2238 } 2239 2240 FunctionDecl *New = FunctionDecl::Create(Context, Parent, Loc, Loc, II, Type, 2241 /*TInfo=*/nullptr, SC_Extern, 2242 getCurFPFeatures().isFPConstrained(), 2243 false, Type->isFunctionProtoType()); 2244 New->setImplicit(); 2245 New->addAttr(BuiltinAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, ID)); 2246 2247 // Create Decl objects for each parameter, adding them to the 2248 // FunctionDecl. 2249 if (const FunctionProtoType *FT = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Type)) { 2250 SmallVector<ParmVarDecl *, 16> Params; 2251 for (unsigned i = 0, e = FT->getNumParams(); i != e; ++i) { 2252 ParmVarDecl *parm = ParmVarDecl::Create( 2253 Context, New, SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(), nullptr, 2254 FT->getParamType(i), /*TInfo=*/nullptr, SC_None, nullptr); 2255 parm->setScopeInfo(0, i); 2256 Params.push_back(parm); 2257 } 2258 New->setParams(Params); 2259 } 2260 2261 AddKnownFunctionAttributes(New); 2262 return New; 2263 } 2264 2265 /// LazilyCreateBuiltin - The specified Builtin-ID was first used at 2266 /// file scope. lazily create a decl for it. ForRedeclaration is true 2267 /// if we're creating this built-in in anticipation of redeclaring the 2268 /// built-in. 2269 NamedDecl *Sema::LazilyCreateBuiltin(IdentifierInfo *II, unsigned ID, 2270 Scope *S, bool ForRedeclaration, 2271 SourceLocation Loc) { 2272 LookupNecessaryTypesForBuiltin(S, ID); 2273 2274 ASTContext::GetBuiltinTypeError Error; 2275 QualType R = Context.GetBuiltinType(ID, Error); 2276 if (Error) { 2277 if (!ForRedeclaration) 2278 return nullptr; 2279 2280 // If we have a builtin without an associated type we should not emit a 2281 // warning when we were not able to find a type for it. 2282 if (Error == ASTContext::GE_Missing_type || 2283 Context.BuiltinInfo.allowTypeMismatch(ID)) 2284 return nullptr; 2285 2286 // If we could not find a type for setjmp it is because the jmp_buf type was 2287 // not defined prior to the setjmp declaration. 2288 if (Error == ASTContext::GE_Missing_setjmp) { 2289 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_implicit_decl_no_jmp_buf) 2290 << Context.BuiltinInfo.getName(ID); 2291 return nullptr; 2292 } 2293 2294 // Generally, we emit a warning that the declaration requires the 2295 // appropriate header. 2296 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_implicit_decl_requires_sysheader) 2297 << getHeaderName(Context.BuiltinInfo, ID, Error) 2298 << Context.BuiltinInfo.getName(ID); 2299 return nullptr; 2300 } 2301 2302 if (!ForRedeclaration && 2303 (Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(ID) || 2304 Context.BuiltinInfo.isHeaderDependentFunction(ID))) { 2305 Diag(Loc, LangOpts.C99 ? diag::ext_implicit_lib_function_decl_c99 2306 : diag::ext_implicit_lib_function_decl) 2307 << Context.BuiltinInfo.getName(ID) << R; 2308 if (const char *Header = Context.BuiltinInfo.getHeaderName(ID)) 2309 Diag(Loc, diag::note_include_header_or_declare) 2310 << Header << Context.BuiltinInfo.getName(ID); 2311 } 2312 2313 if (R.isNull()) 2314 return nullptr; 2315 2316 FunctionDecl *New = CreateBuiltin(II, R, ID, Loc); 2317 RegisterLocallyScopedExternCDecl(New, S); 2318 2319 // TUScope is the translation-unit scope to insert this function into. 2320 // FIXME: This is hideous. We need to teach PushOnScopeChains to 2321 // relate Scopes to DeclContexts, and probably eliminate CurContext 2322 // entirely, but we're not there yet. 2323 DeclContext *SavedContext = CurContext; 2324 CurContext = New->getDeclContext(); 2325 PushOnScopeChains(New, TUScope); 2326 CurContext = SavedContext; 2327 return New; 2328 } 2329 2330 /// Typedef declarations don't have linkage, but they still denote the same 2331 /// entity if their types are the same. 2332 /// FIXME: This is notionally doing the same thing as ASTReaderDecl's 2333 /// isSameEntity. 2334 static void filterNonConflictingPreviousTypedefDecls(Sema &S, 2335 TypedefNameDecl *Decl, 2336 LookupResult &Previous) { 2337 // This is only interesting when modules are enabled. 2338 if (!S.getLangOpts().Modules && !S.getLangOpts().ModulesLocalVisibility) 2339 return; 2340 2341 // Empty sets are uninteresting. 2342 if (Previous.empty()) 2343 return; 2344 2345 LookupResult::Filter Filter = Previous.makeFilter(); 2346 while (Filter.hasNext()) { 2347 NamedDecl *Old = Filter.next(); 2348 2349 // Non-hidden declarations are never ignored. 2350 if (S.isVisible(Old)) 2351 continue; 2352 2353 // Declarations of the same entity are not ignored, even if they have 2354 // different linkages. 2355 if (auto *OldTD = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(Old)) { 2356 if (S.Context.hasSameType(OldTD->getUnderlyingType(), 2357 Decl->getUnderlyingType())) 2358 continue; 2359 2360 // If both declarations give a tag declaration a typedef name for linkage 2361 // purposes, then they declare the same entity. 2362 if (OldTD->getAnonDeclWithTypedefName(/*AnyRedecl*/true) && 2363 Decl->getAnonDeclWithTypedefName()) 2364 continue; 2365 } 2366 2367 Filter.erase(); 2368 } 2369 2370 Filter.done(); 2371 } 2372 2373 bool Sema::isIncompatibleTypedef(TypeDecl *Old, TypedefNameDecl *New) { 2374 QualType OldType; 2375 if (TypedefNameDecl *OldTypedef = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(Old)) 2376 OldType = OldTypedef->getUnderlyingType(); 2377 else 2378 OldType = Context.getTypeDeclType(Old); 2379 QualType NewType = New->getUnderlyingType(); 2380 2381 if (NewType->isVariablyModifiedType()) { 2382 // Must not redefine a typedef with a variably-modified type. 2383 int Kind = isa<TypeAliasDecl>(Old) ? 1 : 0; 2384 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition_variably_modified_typedef) 2385 << Kind << NewType; 2386 if (Old->getLocation().isValid()) 2387 notePreviousDefinition(Old, New->getLocation()); 2388 New->setInvalidDecl(); 2389 return true; 2390 } 2391 2392 if (OldType != NewType && 2393 !OldType->isDependentType() && 2394 !NewType->isDependentType() && 2395 !Context.hasSameType(OldType, NewType)) { 2396 int Kind = isa<TypeAliasDecl>(Old) ? 1 : 0; 2397 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition_different_typedef) 2398 << Kind << NewType << OldType; 2399 if (Old->getLocation().isValid()) 2400 notePreviousDefinition(Old, New->getLocation()); 2401 New->setInvalidDecl(); 2402 return true; 2403 } 2404 return false; 2405 } 2406 2407 /// MergeTypedefNameDecl - We just parsed a typedef 'New' which has the 2408 /// same name and scope as a previous declaration 'Old'. Figure out 2409 /// how to resolve this situation, merging decls or emitting 2410 /// diagnostics as appropriate. If there was an error, set New to be invalid. 2411 /// 2412 void Sema::MergeTypedefNameDecl(Scope *S, TypedefNameDecl *New, 2413 LookupResult &OldDecls) { 2414 // If the new decl is known invalid already, don't bother doing any 2415 // merging checks. 2416 if (New->isInvalidDecl()) return; 2417 2418 // Allow multiple definitions for ObjC built-in typedefs. 2419 // FIXME: Verify the underlying types are equivalent! 2420 if (getLangOpts().ObjC) { 2421 const IdentifierInfo *TypeID = New->getIdentifier(); 2422 switch (TypeID->getLength()) { 2423 default: break; 2424 case 2: 2425 { 2426 if (!TypeID->isStr("id")) 2427 break; 2428 QualType T = New->getUnderlyingType(); 2429 if (!T->isPointerType()) 2430 break; 2431 if (!T->isVoidPointerType()) { 2432 QualType PT = T->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 2433 if (!PT->isStructureType()) 2434 break; 2435 } 2436 Context.setObjCIdRedefinitionType(T); 2437 // Install the built-in type for 'id', ignoring the current definition. 2438 New->setTypeForDecl(Context.getObjCIdType().getTypePtr()); 2439 return; 2440 } 2441 case 5: 2442 if (!TypeID->isStr("Class")) 2443 break; 2444 Context.setObjCClassRedefinitionType(New->getUnderlyingType()); 2445 // Install the built-in type for 'Class', ignoring the current definition. 2446 New->setTypeForDecl(Context.getObjCClassType().getTypePtr()); 2447 return; 2448 case 3: 2449 if (!TypeID->isStr("SEL")) 2450 break; 2451 Context.setObjCSelRedefinitionType(New->getUnderlyingType()); 2452 // Install the built-in type for 'SEL', ignoring the current definition. 2453 New->setTypeForDecl(Context.getObjCSelType().getTypePtr()); 2454 return; 2455 } 2456 // Fall through - the typedef name was not a builtin type. 2457 } 2458 2459 // Verify the old decl was also a type. 2460 TypeDecl *Old = OldDecls.getAsSingle<TypeDecl>(); 2461 if (!Old) { 2462 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition_different_kind) 2463 << New->getDeclName(); 2464 2465 NamedDecl *OldD = OldDecls.getRepresentativeDecl(); 2466 if (OldD->getLocation().isValid()) 2467 notePreviousDefinition(OldD, New->getLocation()); 2468 2469 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 2470 } 2471 2472 // If the old declaration is invalid, just give up here. 2473 if (Old->isInvalidDecl()) 2474 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 2475 2476 if (auto *OldTD = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(Old)) { 2477 auto *OldTag = OldTD->getAnonDeclWithTypedefName(/*AnyRedecl*/true); 2478 auto *NewTag = New->getAnonDeclWithTypedefName(); 2479 NamedDecl *Hidden = nullptr; 2480 if (OldTag && NewTag && 2481 OldTag->getCanonicalDecl() != NewTag->getCanonicalDecl() && 2482 !hasVisibleDefinition(OldTag, &Hidden)) { 2483 // There is a definition of this tag, but it is not visible. Use it 2484 // instead of our tag. 2485 New->setTypeForDecl(OldTD->getTypeForDecl()); 2486 if (OldTD->isModed()) 2487 New->setModedTypeSourceInfo(OldTD->getTypeSourceInfo(), 2488 OldTD->getUnderlyingType()); 2489 else 2490 New->setTypeSourceInfo(OldTD->getTypeSourceInfo()); 2491 2492 // Make the old tag definition visible. 2493 makeMergedDefinitionVisible(Hidden); 2494 2495 // If this was an unscoped enumeration, yank all of its enumerators 2496 // out of the scope. 2497 if (isa<EnumDecl>(NewTag)) { 2498 Scope *EnumScope = getNonFieldDeclScope(S); 2499 for (auto *D : NewTag->decls()) { 2500 auto *ED = cast<EnumConstantDecl>(D); 2501 assert(EnumScope->isDeclScope(ED)); 2502 EnumScope->RemoveDecl(ED); 2503 IdResolver.RemoveDecl(ED); 2504 ED->getLexicalDeclContext()->removeDecl(ED); 2505 } 2506 } 2507 } 2508 } 2509 2510 // If the typedef types are not identical, reject them in all languages and 2511 // with any extensions enabled. 2512 if (isIncompatibleTypedef(Old, New)) 2513 return; 2514 2515 // The types match. Link up the redeclaration chain and merge attributes if 2516 // the old declaration was a typedef. 2517 if (TypedefNameDecl *Typedef = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(Old)) { 2518 New->setPreviousDecl(Typedef); 2519 mergeDeclAttributes(New, Old); 2520 } 2521 2522 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt) 2523 return; 2524 2525 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 2526 // C++ [dcl.typedef]p2: 2527 // In a given non-class scope, a typedef specifier can be used to 2528 // redefine the name of any type declared in that scope to refer 2529 // to the type to which it already refers. 2530 if (!isa<CXXRecordDecl>(CurContext)) 2531 return; 2532 2533 // C++0x [dcl.typedef]p4: 2534 // In a given class scope, a typedef specifier can be used to redefine 2535 // any class-name declared in that scope that is not also a typedef-name 2536 // to refer to the type to which it already refers. 2537 // 2538 // This wording came in via DR424, which was a correction to the 2539 // wording in DR56, which accidentally banned code like: 2540 // 2541 // struct S { 2542 // typedef struct A { } A; 2543 // }; 2544 // 2545 // in the C++03 standard. We implement the C++0x semantics, which 2546 // allow the above but disallow 2547 // 2548 // struct S { 2549 // typedef int I; 2550 // typedef int I; 2551 // }; 2552 // 2553 // since that was the intent of DR56. 2554 if (!isa<TypedefNameDecl>(Old)) 2555 return; 2556 2557 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition) 2558 << New->getDeclName(); 2559 notePreviousDefinition(Old, New->getLocation()); 2560 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 2561 } 2562 2563 // Modules always permit redefinition of typedefs, as does C11. 2564 if (getLangOpts().Modules || getLangOpts().C11) 2565 return; 2566 2567 // If we have a redefinition of a typedef in C, emit a warning. This warning 2568 // is normally mapped to an error, but can be controlled with 2569 // -Wtypedef-redefinition. If either the original or the redefinition is 2570 // in a system header, don't emit this for compatibility with GCC. 2571 if (getDiagnostics().getSuppressSystemWarnings() && 2572 // Some standard types are defined implicitly in Clang (e.g. OpenCL). 2573 (Old->isImplicit() || 2574 Context.getSourceManager().isInSystemHeader(Old->getLocation()) || 2575 Context.getSourceManager().isInSystemHeader(New->getLocation()))) 2576 return; 2577 2578 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::ext_redefinition_of_typedef) 2579 << New->getDeclName(); 2580 notePreviousDefinition(Old, New->getLocation()); 2581 } 2582 2583 /// DeclhasAttr - returns true if decl Declaration already has the target 2584 /// attribute. 2585 static bool DeclHasAttr(const Decl *D, const Attr *A) { 2586 const OwnershipAttr *OA = dyn_cast<OwnershipAttr>(A); 2587 const AnnotateAttr *Ann = dyn_cast<AnnotateAttr>(A); 2588 for (const auto *i : D->attrs()) 2589 if (i->getKind() == A->getKind()) { 2590 if (Ann) { 2591 if (Ann->getAnnotation() == cast<AnnotateAttr>(i)->getAnnotation()) 2592 return true; 2593 continue; 2594 } 2595 // FIXME: Don't hardcode this check 2596 if (OA && isa<OwnershipAttr>(i)) 2597 return OA->getOwnKind() == cast<OwnershipAttr>(i)->getOwnKind(); 2598 return true; 2599 } 2600 2601 return false; 2602 } 2603 2604 static bool isAttributeTargetADefinition(Decl *D) { 2605 if (VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) 2606 return VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition(); 2607 if (TagDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(D)) 2608 return TD->isCompleteDefinition() || TD->isBeingDefined(); 2609 return true; 2610 } 2611 2612 /// Merge alignment attributes from \p Old to \p New, taking into account the 2613 /// special semantics of C11's _Alignas specifier and C++11's alignas attribute. 2614 /// 2615 /// \return \c true if any attributes were added to \p New. 2616 static bool mergeAlignedAttrs(Sema &S, NamedDecl *New, Decl *Old) { 2617 // Look for alignas attributes on Old, and pick out whichever attribute 2618 // specifies the strictest alignment requirement. 2619 AlignedAttr *OldAlignasAttr = nullptr; 2620 AlignedAttr *OldStrictestAlignAttr = nullptr; 2621 unsigned OldAlign = 0; 2622 for (auto *I : Old->specific_attrs<AlignedAttr>()) { 2623 // FIXME: We have no way of representing inherited dependent alignments 2624 // in a case like: 2625 // template<int A, int B> struct alignas(A) X; 2626 // template<int A, int B> struct alignas(B) X {}; 2627 // For now, we just ignore any alignas attributes which are not on the 2628 // definition in such a case. 2629 if (I->isAlignmentDependent()) 2630 return false; 2631 2632 if (I->isAlignas()) 2633 OldAlignasAttr = I; 2634 2635 unsigned Align = I->getAlignment(S.Context); 2636 if (Align > OldAlign) { 2637 OldAlign = Align; 2638 OldStrictestAlignAttr = I; 2639 } 2640 } 2641 2642 // Look for alignas attributes on New. 2643 AlignedAttr *NewAlignasAttr = nullptr; 2644 unsigned NewAlign = 0; 2645 for (auto *I : New->specific_attrs<AlignedAttr>()) { 2646 if (I->isAlignmentDependent()) 2647 return false; 2648 2649 if (I->isAlignas()) 2650 NewAlignasAttr = I; 2651 2652 unsigned Align = I->getAlignment(S.Context); 2653 if (Align > NewAlign) 2654 NewAlign = Align; 2655 } 2656 2657 if (OldAlignasAttr && NewAlignasAttr && OldAlign != NewAlign) { 2658 // Both declarations have 'alignas' attributes. We require them to match. 2659 // C++11 [dcl.align]p6 and C11 6.7.5/7 both come close to saying this, but 2660 // fall short. (If two declarations both have alignas, they must both match 2661 // every definition, and so must match each other if there is a definition.) 2662 2663 // If either declaration only contains 'alignas(0)' specifiers, then it 2664 // specifies the natural alignment for the type. 2665 if (OldAlign == 0 || NewAlign == 0) { 2666 QualType Ty; 2667 if (ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(New)) 2668 Ty = VD->getType(); 2669 else 2670 Ty = S.Context.getTagDeclType(cast<TagDecl>(New)); 2671 2672 if (OldAlign == 0) 2673 OldAlign = S.Context.getTypeAlign(Ty); 2674 if (NewAlign == 0) 2675 NewAlign = S.Context.getTypeAlign(Ty); 2676 } 2677 2678 if (OldAlign != NewAlign) { 2679 S.Diag(NewAlignasAttr->getLocation(), diag::err_alignas_mismatch) 2680 << (unsigned)S.Context.toCharUnitsFromBits(OldAlign).getQuantity() 2681 << (unsigned)S.Context.toCharUnitsFromBits(NewAlign).getQuantity(); 2682 S.Diag(OldAlignasAttr->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 2683 } 2684 } 2685 2686 if (OldAlignasAttr && !NewAlignasAttr && isAttributeTargetADefinition(New)) { 2687 // C++11 [dcl.align]p6: 2688 // if any declaration of an entity has an alignment-specifier, 2689 // every defining declaration of that entity shall specify an 2690 // equivalent alignment. 2691 // C11 6.7.5/7: 2692 // If the definition of an object does not have an alignment 2693 // specifier, any other declaration of that object shall also 2694 // have no alignment specifier. 2695 S.Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_alignas_missing_on_definition) 2696 << OldAlignasAttr; 2697 S.Diag(OldAlignasAttr->getLocation(), diag::note_alignas_on_declaration) 2698 << OldAlignasAttr; 2699 } 2700 2701 bool AnyAdded = false; 2702 2703 // Ensure we have an attribute representing the strictest alignment. 2704 if (OldAlign > NewAlign) { 2705 AlignedAttr *Clone = OldStrictestAlignAttr->clone(S.Context); 2706 Clone->setInherited(true); 2707 New->addAttr(Clone); 2708 AnyAdded = true; 2709 } 2710 2711 // Ensure we have an alignas attribute if the old declaration had one. 2712 if (OldAlignasAttr && !NewAlignasAttr && 2713 !(AnyAdded && OldStrictestAlignAttr->isAlignas())) { 2714 AlignedAttr *Clone = OldAlignasAttr->clone(S.Context); 2715 Clone->setInherited(true); 2716 New->addAttr(Clone); 2717 AnyAdded = true; 2718 } 2719 2720 return AnyAdded; 2721 } 2722 2723 #define WANT_DECL_MERGE_LOGIC 2724 #include "clang/Sema/AttrParsedAttrImpl.inc" 2725 #undef WANT_DECL_MERGE_LOGIC 2726 2727 static bool mergeDeclAttribute(Sema &S, NamedDecl *D, 2728 const InheritableAttr *Attr, 2729 Sema::AvailabilityMergeKind AMK) { 2730 // Diagnose any mutual exclusions between the attribute that we want to add 2731 // and attributes that already exist on the declaration. 2732 if (!DiagnoseMutualExclusions(S, D, Attr)) 2733 return false; 2734 2735 // This function copies an attribute Attr from a previous declaration to the 2736 // new declaration D if the new declaration doesn't itself have that attribute 2737 // yet or if that attribute allows duplicates. 2738 // If you're adding a new attribute that requires logic different from 2739 // "use explicit attribute on decl if present, else use attribute from 2740 // previous decl", for example if the attribute needs to be consistent 2741 // between redeclarations, you need to call a custom merge function here. 2742 InheritableAttr *NewAttr = nullptr; 2743 if (const auto *AA = dyn_cast<AvailabilityAttr>(Attr)) 2744 NewAttr = S.mergeAvailabilityAttr( 2745 D, *AA, AA->getPlatform(), AA->isImplicit(), AA->getIntroduced(), 2746 AA->getDeprecated(), AA->getObsoleted(), AA->getUnavailable(), 2747 AA->getMessage(), AA->getStrict(), AA->getReplacement(), AMK, 2748 AA->getPriority()); 2749 else if (const auto *VA = dyn_cast<VisibilityAttr>(Attr)) 2750 NewAttr = S.mergeVisibilityAttr(D, *VA, VA->getVisibility()); 2751 else if (const auto *VA = dyn_cast<TypeVisibilityAttr>(Attr)) 2752 NewAttr = S.mergeTypeVisibilityAttr(D, *VA, VA->getVisibility()); 2753 else if (const auto *ImportA = dyn_cast<DLLImportAttr>(Attr)) 2754 NewAttr = S.mergeDLLImportAttr(D, *ImportA); 2755 else if (const auto *ExportA = dyn_cast<DLLExportAttr>(Attr)) 2756 NewAttr = S.mergeDLLExportAttr(D, *ExportA); 2757 else if (const auto *EA = dyn_cast<ErrorAttr>(Attr)) 2758 NewAttr = S.mergeErrorAttr(D, *EA, EA->getUserDiagnostic()); 2759 else if (const auto *FA = dyn_cast<FormatAttr>(Attr)) 2760 NewAttr = S.mergeFormatAttr(D, *FA, FA->getType(), FA->getFormatIdx(), 2761 FA->getFirstArg()); 2762 else if (const auto *SA = dyn_cast<SectionAttr>(Attr)) 2763 NewAttr = S.mergeSectionAttr(D, *SA, SA->getName()); 2764 else if (const auto *CSA = dyn_cast<CodeSegAttr>(Attr)) 2765 NewAttr = S.mergeCodeSegAttr(D, *CSA, CSA->getName()); 2766 else if (const auto *IA = dyn_cast<MSInheritanceAttr>(Attr)) 2767 NewAttr = S.mergeMSInheritanceAttr(D, *IA, IA->getBestCase(), 2768 IA->getInheritanceModel()); 2769 else if (const auto *AA = dyn_cast<AlwaysInlineAttr>(Attr)) 2770 NewAttr = S.mergeAlwaysInlineAttr(D, *AA, 2771 &S.Context.Idents.get(AA->getSpelling())); 2772 else if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA && isa<FunctionDecl>(D) && 2773 (isa<CUDAHostAttr>(Attr) || isa<CUDADeviceAttr>(Attr) || 2774 isa<CUDAGlobalAttr>(Attr))) { 2775 // CUDA target attributes are part of function signature for 2776 // overloading purposes and must not be merged. 2777 return false; 2778 } else if (const auto *MA = dyn_cast<MinSizeAttr>(Attr)) 2779 NewAttr = S.mergeMinSizeAttr(D, *MA); 2780 else if (const auto *SNA = dyn_cast<SwiftNameAttr>(Attr)) 2781 NewAttr = S.mergeSwiftNameAttr(D, *SNA, SNA->getName()); 2782 else if (const auto *OA = dyn_cast<OptimizeNoneAttr>(Attr)) 2783 NewAttr = S.mergeOptimizeNoneAttr(D, *OA); 2784 else if (const auto *InternalLinkageA = dyn_cast<InternalLinkageAttr>(Attr)) 2785 NewAttr = S.mergeInternalLinkageAttr(D, *InternalLinkageA); 2786 else if (isa<AlignedAttr>(Attr)) 2787 // AlignedAttrs are handled separately, because we need to handle all 2788 // such attributes on a declaration at the same time. 2789 NewAttr = nullptr; 2790 else if ((isa<DeprecatedAttr>(Attr) || isa<UnavailableAttr>(Attr)) && 2791 (AMK == Sema::AMK_Override || 2792 AMK == Sema::AMK_ProtocolImplementation || 2793 AMK == Sema::AMK_OptionalProtocolImplementation)) 2794 NewAttr = nullptr; 2795 else if (const auto *UA = dyn_cast<UuidAttr>(Attr)) 2796 NewAttr = S.mergeUuidAttr(D, *UA, UA->getGuid(), UA->getGuidDecl()); 2797 else if (const auto *IMA = dyn_cast<WebAssemblyImportModuleAttr>(Attr)) 2798 NewAttr = S.mergeImportModuleAttr(D, *IMA); 2799 else if (const auto *INA = dyn_cast<WebAssemblyImportNameAttr>(Attr)) 2800 NewAttr = S.mergeImportNameAttr(D, *INA); 2801 else if (const auto *TCBA = dyn_cast<EnforceTCBAttr>(Attr)) 2802 NewAttr = S.mergeEnforceTCBAttr(D, *TCBA); 2803 else if (const auto *TCBLA = dyn_cast<EnforceTCBLeafAttr>(Attr)) 2804 NewAttr = S.mergeEnforceTCBLeafAttr(D, *TCBLA); 2805 else if (const auto *BTFA = dyn_cast<BTFDeclTagAttr>(Attr)) 2806 NewAttr = S.mergeBTFDeclTagAttr(D, *BTFA); 2807 else if (const auto *NT = dyn_cast<HLSLNumThreadsAttr>(Attr)) 2808 NewAttr = 2809 S.mergeHLSLNumThreadsAttr(D, *NT, NT->getX(), NT->getY(), NT->getZ()); 2810 else if (const auto *SA = dyn_cast<HLSLShaderAttr>(Attr)) 2811 NewAttr = S.mergeHLSLShaderAttr(D, *SA, SA->getType()); 2812 else if (Attr->shouldInheritEvenIfAlreadyPresent() || !DeclHasAttr(D, Attr)) 2813 NewAttr = cast<InheritableAttr>(Attr->clone(S.Context)); 2814 2815 if (NewAttr) { 2816 NewAttr->setInherited(true); 2817 D->addAttr(NewAttr); 2818 if (isa<MSInheritanceAttr>(NewAttr)) 2819 S.Consumer.AssignInheritanceModel(cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)); 2820 return true; 2821 } 2822 2823 return false; 2824 } 2825 2826 static const NamedDecl *getDefinition(const Decl *D) { 2827 if (const TagDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(D)) 2828 return TD->getDefinition(); 2829 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) { 2830 const VarDecl *Def = VD->getDefinition(); 2831 if (Def) 2832 return Def; 2833 return VD->getActingDefinition(); 2834 } 2835 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 2836 const FunctionDecl *Def = nullptr; 2837 if (FD->isDefined(Def, true)) 2838 return Def; 2839 } 2840 return nullptr; 2841 } 2842 2843 static bool hasAttribute(const Decl *D, attr::Kind Kind) { 2844 for (const auto *Attribute : D->attrs()) 2845 if (Attribute->getKind() == Kind) 2846 return true; 2847 return false; 2848 } 2849 2850 /// checkNewAttributesAfterDef - If we already have a definition, check that 2851 /// there are no new attributes in this declaration. 2852 static void checkNewAttributesAfterDef(Sema &S, Decl *New, const Decl *Old) { 2853 if (!New->hasAttrs()) 2854 return; 2855 2856 const NamedDecl *Def = getDefinition(Old); 2857 if (!Def || Def == New) 2858 return; 2859 2860 AttrVec &NewAttributes = New->getAttrs(); 2861 for (unsigned I = 0, E = NewAttributes.size(); I != E;) { 2862 const Attr *NewAttribute = NewAttributes[I]; 2863 2864 if (isa<AliasAttr>(NewAttribute) || isa<IFuncAttr>(NewAttribute)) { 2865 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(New)) { 2866 Sema::SkipBodyInfo SkipBody; 2867 S.CheckForFunctionRedefinition(FD, cast<FunctionDecl>(Def), &SkipBody); 2868 2869 // If we're skipping this definition, drop the "alias" attribute. 2870 if (SkipBody.ShouldSkip) { 2871 NewAttributes.erase(NewAttributes.begin() + I); 2872 --E; 2873 continue; 2874 } 2875 } else { 2876 VarDecl *VD = cast<VarDecl>(New); 2877 unsigned Diag = cast<VarDecl>(Def)->isThisDeclarationADefinition() == 2878 VarDecl::TentativeDefinition 2879 ? diag::err_alias_after_tentative 2880 : diag::err_redefinition; 2881 S.Diag(VD->getLocation(), Diag) << VD->getDeclName(); 2882 if (Diag == diag::err_redefinition) 2883 S.notePreviousDefinition(Def, VD->getLocation()); 2884 else 2885 S.Diag(Def->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition); 2886 VD->setInvalidDecl(); 2887 } 2888 ++I; 2889 continue; 2890 } 2891 2892 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(Def)) { 2893 // Tentative definitions are only interesting for the alias check above. 2894 if (VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() != VarDecl::Definition) { 2895 ++I; 2896 continue; 2897 } 2898 } 2899 2900 if (hasAttribute(Def, NewAttribute->getKind())) { 2901 ++I; 2902 continue; // regular attr merging will take care of validating this. 2903 } 2904 2905 if (isa<C11NoReturnAttr>(NewAttribute)) { 2906 // C's _Noreturn is allowed to be added to a function after it is defined. 2907 ++I; 2908 continue; 2909 } else if (isa<UuidAttr>(NewAttribute)) { 2910 // msvc will allow a subsequent definition to add an uuid to a class 2911 ++I; 2912 continue; 2913 } else if (const AlignedAttr *AA = dyn_cast<AlignedAttr>(NewAttribute)) { 2914 if (AA->isAlignas()) { 2915 // C++11 [dcl.align]p6: 2916 // if any declaration of an entity has an alignment-specifier, 2917 // every defining declaration of that entity shall specify an 2918 // equivalent alignment. 2919 // C11 6.7.5/7: 2920 // If the definition of an object does not have an alignment 2921 // specifier, any other declaration of that object shall also 2922 // have no alignment specifier. 2923 S.Diag(Def->getLocation(), diag::err_alignas_missing_on_definition) 2924 << AA; 2925 S.Diag(NewAttribute->getLocation(), diag::note_alignas_on_declaration) 2926 << AA; 2927 NewAttributes.erase(NewAttributes.begin() + I); 2928 --E; 2929 continue; 2930 } 2931 } else if (isa<LoaderUninitializedAttr>(NewAttribute)) { 2932 // If there is a C definition followed by a redeclaration with this 2933 // attribute then there are two different definitions. In C++, prefer the 2934 // standard diagnostics. 2935 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 2936 S.Diag(NewAttribute->getLocation(), 2937 diag::err_loader_uninitialized_redeclaration); 2938 S.Diag(Def->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition); 2939 NewAttributes.erase(NewAttributes.begin() + I); 2940 --E; 2941 continue; 2942 } 2943 } else if (isa<SelectAnyAttr>(NewAttribute) && 2944 cast<VarDecl>(New)->isInline() && 2945 !cast<VarDecl>(New)->isInlineSpecified()) { 2946 // Don't warn about applying selectany to implicitly inline variables. 2947 // Older compilers and language modes would require the use of selectany 2948 // to make such variables inline, and it would have no effect if we 2949 // honored it. 2950 ++I; 2951 continue; 2952 } else if (isa<OMPDeclareVariantAttr>(NewAttribute)) { 2953 // We allow to add OMP[Begin]DeclareVariantAttr to be added to 2954 // declarations after defintions. 2955 ++I; 2956 continue; 2957 } 2958 2959 S.Diag(NewAttribute->getLocation(), 2960 diag::warn_attribute_precede_definition); 2961 S.Diag(Def->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition); 2962 NewAttributes.erase(NewAttributes.begin() + I); 2963 --E; 2964 } 2965 } 2966 2967 static void diagnoseMissingConstinit(Sema &S, const VarDecl *InitDecl, 2968 const ConstInitAttr *CIAttr, 2969 bool AttrBeforeInit) { 2970 SourceLocation InsertLoc = InitDecl->getInnerLocStart(); 2971 2972 // Figure out a good way to write this specifier on the old declaration. 2973 // FIXME: We should just use the spelling of CIAttr, but we don't preserve 2974 // enough of the attribute list spelling information to extract that without 2975 // heroics. 2976 std::string SuitableSpelling; 2977 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20) 2978 SuitableSpelling = std::string( 2979 S.PP.getLastMacroWithSpelling(InsertLoc, {tok::kw_constinit})); 2980 if (SuitableSpelling.empty() && S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) 2981 SuitableSpelling = std::string(S.PP.getLastMacroWithSpelling( 2982 InsertLoc, {tok::l_square, tok::l_square, 2983 S.PP.getIdentifierInfo("clang"), tok::coloncolon, 2984 S.PP.getIdentifierInfo("require_constant_initialization"), 2985 tok::r_square, tok::r_square})); 2986 if (SuitableSpelling.empty()) 2987 SuitableSpelling = std::string(S.PP.getLastMacroWithSpelling( 2988 InsertLoc, {tok::kw___attribute, tok::l_paren, tok::r_paren, 2989 S.PP.getIdentifierInfo("require_constant_initialization"), 2990 tok::r_paren, tok::r_paren})); 2991 if (SuitableSpelling.empty() && S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20) 2992 SuitableSpelling = "constinit"; 2993 if (SuitableSpelling.empty() && S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) 2994 SuitableSpelling = "[[clang::require_constant_initialization]]"; 2995 if (SuitableSpelling.empty()) 2996 SuitableSpelling = "__attribute__((require_constant_initialization))"; 2997 SuitableSpelling += " "; 2998 2999 if (AttrBeforeInit) { 3000 // extern constinit int a; 3001 // int a = 0; // error (missing 'constinit'), accepted as extension 3002 assert(CIAttr->isConstinit() && "should not diagnose this for attribute"); 3003 S.Diag(InitDecl->getLocation(), diag::ext_constinit_missing) 3004 << InitDecl << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(InsertLoc, SuitableSpelling); 3005 S.Diag(CIAttr->getLocation(), diag::note_constinit_specified_here); 3006 } else { 3007 // int a = 0; 3008 // constinit extern int a; // error (missing 'constinit') 3009 S.Diag(CIAttr->getLocation(), 3010 CIAttr->isConstinit() ? diag::err_constinit_added_too_late 3011 : diag::warn_require_const_init_added_too_late) 3012 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(SourceRange(CIAttr->getLocation())); 3013 S.Diag(InitDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_constinit_missing_here) 3014 << CIAttr->isConstinit() 3015 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(InsertLoc, SuitableSpelling); 3016 } 3017 } 3018 3019 /// mergeDeclAttributes - Copy attributes from the Old decl to the New one. 3020 void Sema::mergeDeclAttributes(NamedDecl *New, Decl *Old, 3021 AvailabilityMergeKind AMK) { 3022 if (UsedAttr *OldAttr = Old->getMostRecentDecl()->getAttr<UsedAttr>()) { 3023 UsedAttr *NewAttr = OldAttr->clone(Context); 3024 NewAttr->setInherited(true); 3025 New->addAttr(NewAttr); 3026 } 3027 if (RetainAttr *OldAttr = Old->getMostRecentDecl()->getAttr<RetainAttr>()) { 3028 RetainAttr *NewAttr = OldAttr->clone(Context); 3029 NewAttr->setInherited(true); 3030 New->addAttr(NewAttr); 3031 } 3032 3033 if (!Old->hasAttrs() && !New->hasAttrs()) 3034 return; 3035 3036 // [dcl.constinit]p1: 3037 // If the [constinit] specifier is applied to any declaration of a 3038 // variable, it shall be applied to the initializing declaration. 3039 const auto *OldConstInit = Old->getAttr<ConstInitAttr>(); 3040 const auto *NewConstInit = New->getAttr<ConstInitAttr>(); 3041 if (bool(OldConstInit) != bool(NewConstInit)) { 3042 const auto *OldVD = cast<VarDecl>(Old); 3043 auto *NewVD = cast<VarDecl>(New); 3044 3045 // Find the initializing declaration. Note that we might not have linked 3046 // the new declaration into the redeclaration chain yet. 3047 const VarDecl *InitDecl = OldVD->getInitializingDeclaration(); 3048 if (!InitDecl && 3049 (NewVD->hasInit() || NewVD->isThisDeclarationADefinition())) 3050 InitDecl = NewVD; 3051 3052 if (InitDecl == NewVD) { 3053 // This is the initializing declaration. If it would inherit 'constinit', 3054 // that's ill-formed. (Note that we do not apply this to the attribute 3055 // form). 3056 if (OldConstInit && OldConstInit->isConstinit()) 3057 diagnoseMissingConstinit(*this, NewVD, OldConstInit, 3058 /*AttrBeforeInit=*/true); 3059 } else if (NewConstInit) { 3060 // This is the first time we've been told that this declaration should 3061 // have a constant initializer. If we already saw the initializing 3062 // declaration, this is too late. 3063 if (InitDecl && InitDecl != NewVD) { 3064 diagnoseMissingConstinit(*this, InitDecl, NewConstInit, 3065 /*AttrBeforeInit=*/false); 3066 NewVD->dropAttr<ConstInitAttr>(); 3067 } 3068 } 3069 } 3070 3071 // Attributes declared post-definition are currently ignored. 3072 checkNewAttributesAfterDef(*this, New, Old); 3073 3074 if (AsmLabelAttr *NewA = New->getAttr<AsmLabelAttr>()) { 3075 if (AsmLabelAttr *OldA = Old->getAttr<AsmLabelAttr>()) { 3076 if (!OldA->isEquivalent(NewA)) { 3077 // This redeclaration changes __asm__ label. 3078 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_different_asm_label); 3079 Diag(OldA->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 3080 } 3081 } else if (Old->isUsed()) { 3082 // This redeclaration adds an __asm__ label to a declaration that has 3083 // already been ODR-used. 3084 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_late_asm_label_name) 3085 << isa<FunctionDecl>(Old) << New->getAttr<AsmLabelAttr>()->getRange(); 3086 } 3087 } 3088 3089 // Re-declaration cannot add abi_tag's. 3090 if (const auto *NewAbiTagAttr = New->getAttr<AbiTagAttr>()) { 3091 if (const auto *OldAbiTagAttr = Old->getAttr<AbiTagAttr>()) { 3092 for (const auto &NewTag : NewAbiTagAttr->tags()) { 3093 if (!llvm::is_contained(OldAbiTagAttr->tags(), NewTag)) { 3094 Diag(NewAbiTagAttr->getLocation(), 3095 diag::err_new_abi_tag_on_redeclaration) 3096 << NewTag; 3097 Diag(OldAbiTagAttr->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 3098 } 3099 } 3100 } else { 3101 Diag(NewAbiTagAttr->getLocation(), diag::err_abi_tag_on_redeclaration); 3102 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 3103 } 3104 } 3105 3106 // This redeclaration adds a section attribute. 3107 if (New->hasAttr<SectionAttr>() && !Old->hasAttr<SectionAttr>()) { 3108 if (auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(New)) { 3109 if (VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() == VarDecl::DeclarationOnly) { 3110 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::warn_attribute_section_on_redeclaration); 3111 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 3112 } 3113 } 3114 } 3115 3116 // Redeclaration adds code-seg attribute. 3117 const auto *NewCSA = New->getAttr<CodeSegAttr>(); 3118 if (NewCSA && !Old->hasAttr<CodeSegAttr>() && 3119 !NewCSA->isImplicit() && isa<CXXMethodDecl>(New)) { 3120 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::warn_mismatched_section) 3121 << 0 /*codeseg*/; 3122 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 3123 } 3124 3125 if (!Old->hasAttrs()) 3126 return; 3127 3128 bool foundAny = New->hasAttrs(); 3129 3130 // Ensure that any moving of objects within the allocated map is done before 3131 // we process them. 3132 if (!foundAny) New->setAttrs(AttrVec()); 3133 3134 for (auto *I : Old->specific_attrs<InheritableAttr>()) { 3135 // Ignore deprecated/unavailable/availability attributes if requested. 3136 AvailabilityMergeKind LocalAMK = AMK_None; 3137 if (isa<DeprecatedAttr>(I) || 3138 isa<UnavailableAttr>(I) || 3139 isa<AvailabilityAttr>(I)) { 3140 switch (AMK) { 3141 case AMK_None: 3142 continue; 3143 3144 case AMK_Redeclaration: 3145 case AMK_Override: 3146 case AMK_ProtocolImplementation: 3147 case AMK_OptionalProtocolImplementation: 3148 LocalAMK = AMK; 3149 break; 3150 } 3151 } 3152 3153 // Already handled. 3154 if (isa<UsedAttr>(I) || isa<RetainAttr>(I)) 3155 continue; 3156 3157 if (mergeDeclAttribute(*this, New, I, LocalAMK)) 3158 foundAny = true; 3159 } 3160 3161 if (mergeAlignedAttrs(*this, New, Old)) 3162 foundAny = true; 3163 3164 if (!foundAny) New->dropAttrs(); 3165 } 3166 3167 /// mergeParamDeclAttributes - Copy attributes from the old parameter 3168 /// to the new one. 3169 static void mergeParamDeclAttributes(ParmVarDecl *newDecl, 3170 const ParmVarDecl *oldDecl, 3171 Sema &S) { 3172 // C++11 [dcl.attr.depend]p2: 3173 // The first declaration of a function shall specify the 3174 // carries_dependency attribute for its declarator-id if any declaration 3175 // of the function specifies the carries_dependency attribute. 3176 const CarriesDependencyAttr *CDA = newDecl->getAttr<CarriesDependencyAttr>(); 3177 if (CDA && !oldDecl->hasAttr<CarriesDependencyAttr>()) { 3178 S.Diag(CDA->getLocation(), 3179 diag::err_carries_dependency_missing_on_first_decl) << 1/*Param*/; 3180 // Find the first declaration of the parameter. 3181 // FIXME: Should we build redeclaration chains for function parameters? 3182 const FunctionDecl *FirstFD = 3183 cast<FunctionDecl>(oldDecl->getDeclContext())->getFirstDecl(); 3184 const ParmVarDecl *FirstVD = 3185 FirstFD->getParamDecl(oldDecl->getFunctionScopeIndex()); 3186 S.Diag(FirstVD->getLocation(), 3187 diag::note_carries_dependency_missing_first_decl) << 1/*Param*/; 3188 } 3189 3190 if (!oldDecl->hasAttrs()) 3191 return; 3192 3193 bool foundAny = newDecl->hasAttrs(); 3194 3195 // Ensure that any moving of objects within the allocated map is 3196 // done before we process them. 3197 if (!foundAny) newDecl->setAttrs(AttrVec()); 3198 3199 for (const auto *I : oldDecl->specific_attrs<InheritableParamAttr>()) { 3200 if (!DeclHasAttr(newDecl, I)) { 3201 InheritableAttr *newAttr = 3202 cast<InheritableParamAttr>(I->clone(S.Context)); 3203 newAttr->setInherited(true); 3204 newDecl->addAttr(newAttr); 3205 foundAny = true; 3206 } 3207 } 3208 3209 if (!foundAny) newDecl->dropAttrs(); 3210 } 3211 3212 static void mergeParamDeclTypes(ParmVarDecl *NewParam, 3213 const ParmVarDecl *OldParam, 3214 Sema &S) { 3215 if (auto Oldnullability = OldParam->getType()->getNullability(S.Context)) { 3216 if (auto Newnullability = NewParam->getType()->getNullability(S.Context)) { 3217 if (*Oldnullability != *Newnullability) { 3218 S.Diag(NewParam->getLocation(), diag::warn_mismatched_nullability_attr) 3219 << DiagNullabilityKind( 3220 *Newnullability, 3221 ((NewParam->getObjCDeclQualifier() & Decl::OBJC_TQ_CSNullability) 3222 != 0)) 3223 << DiagNullabilityKind( 3224 *Oldnullability, 3225 ((OldParam->getObjCDeclQualifier() & Decl::OBJC_TQ_CSNullability) 3226 != 0)); 3227 S.Diag(OldParam->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 3228 } 3229 } else { 3230 QualType NewT = NewParam->getType(); 3231 NewT = S.Context.getAttributedType( 3232 AttributedType::getNullabilityAttrKind(*Oldnullability), 3233 NewT, NewT); 3234 NewParam->setType(NewT); 3235 } 3236 } 3237 } 3238 3239 namespace { 3240 3241 /// Used in MergeFunctionDecl to keep track of function parameters in 3242 /// C. 3243 struct GNUCompatibleParamWarning { 3244 ParmVarDecl *OldParm; 3245 ParmVarDecl *NewParm; 3246 QualType PromotedType; 3247 }; 3248 3249 } // end anonymous namespace 3250 3251 // Determine whether the previous declaration was a definition, implicit 3252 // declaration, or a declaration. 3253 template <typename T> 3254 static std::pair<diag::kind, SourceLocation> 3255 getNoteDiagForInvalidRedeclaration(const T *Old, const T *New) { 3256 diag::kind PrevDiag; 3257 SourceLocation OldLocation = Old->getLocation(); 3258 if (Old->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) 3259 PrevDiag = diag::note_previous_definition; 3260 else if (Old->isImplicit()) { 3261 PrevDiag = diag::note_previous_implicit_declaration; 3262 if (const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Old)) { 3263 if (FD->getBuiltinID()) 3264 PrevDiag = diag::note_previous_builtin_declaration; 3265 } 3266 if (OldLocation.isInvalid()) 3267 OldLocation = New->getLocation(); 3268 } else 3269 PrevDiag = diag::note_previous_declaration; 3270 return std::make_pair(PrevDiag, OldLocation); 3271 } 3272 3273 /// canRedefineFunction - checks if a function can be redefined. Currently, 3274 /// only extern inline functions can be redefined, and even then only in 3275 /// GNU89 mode. 3276 static bool canRedefineFunction(const FunctionDecl *FD, 3277 const LangOptions& LangOpts) { 3278 return ((FD->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>() || LangOpts.GNUInline) && 3279 !LangOpts.CPlusPlus && 3280 FD->isInlineSpecified() && 3281 FD->getStorageClass() == SC_Extern); 3282 } 3283 3284 const AttributedType *Sema::getCallingConvAttributedType(QualType T) const { 3285 const AttributedType *AT = T->getAs<AttributedType>(); 3286 while (AT && !AT->isCallingConv()) 3287 AT = AT->getModifiedType()->getAs<AttributedType>(); 3288 return AT; 3289 } 3290 3291 template <typename T> 3292 static bool haveIncompatibleLanguageLinkages(const T *Old, const T *New) { 3293 const DeclContext *DC = Old->getDeclContext(); 3294 if (DC->isRecord()) 3295 return false; 3296 3297 LanguageLinkage OldLinkage = Old->getLanguageLinkage(); 3298 if (OldLinkage == CXXLanguageLinkage && New->isInExternCContext()) 3299 return true; 3300 if (OldLinkage == CLanguageLinkage && New->isInExternCXXContext()) 3301 return true; 3302 return false; 3303 } 3304 3305 template<typename T> static bool isExternC(T *D) { return D->isExternC(); } 3306 static bool isExternC(VarTemplateDecl *) { return false; } 3307 static bool isExternC(FunctionTemplateDecl *) { return false; } 3308 3309 /// Check whether a redeclaration of an entity introduced by a 3310 /// using-declaration is valid, given that we know it's not an overload 3311 /// (nor a hidden tag declaration). 3312 template<typename ExpectedDecl> 3313 static bool checkUsingShadowRedecl(Sema &S, UsingShadowDecl *OldS, 3314 ExpectedDecl *New) { 3315 // C++11 [basic.scope.declarative]p4: 3316 // Given a set of declarations in a single declarative region, each of 3317 // which specifies the same unqualified name, 3318 // -- they shall all refer to the same entity, or all refer to functions 3319 // and function templates; or 3320 // -- exactly one declaration shall declare a class name or enumeration 3321 // name that is not a typedef name and the other declarations shall all 3322 // refer to the same variable or enumerator, or all refer to functions 3323 // and function templates; in this case the class name or enumeration 3324 // name is hidden (3.3.10). 3325 3326 // C++11 [namespace.udecl]p14: 3327 // If a function declaration in namespace scope or block scope has the 3328 // same name and the same parameter-type-list as a function introduced 3329 // by a using-declaration, and the declarations do not declare the same 3330 // function, the program is ill-formed. 3331 3332 auto *Old = dyn_cast<ExpectedDecl>(OldS->getTargetDecl()); 3333 if (Old && 3334 !Old->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->Equals( 3335 New->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()) && 3336 !(isExternC(Old) && isExternC(New))) 3337 Old = nullptr; 3338 3339 if (!Old) { 3340 S.Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_using_decl_conflict_reverse); 3341 S.Diag(OldS->getTargetDecl()->getLocation(), diag::note_using_decl_target); 3342 S.Diag(OldS->getIntroducer()->getLocation(), diag::note_using_decl) << 0; 3343 return true; 3344 } 3345 return false; 3346 } 3347 3348 static bool hasIdenticalPassObjectSizeAttrs(const FunctionDecl *A, 3349 const FunctionDecl *B) { 3350 assert(A->getNumParams() == B->getNumParams()); 3351 3352 auto AttrEq = [](const ParmVarDecl *A, const ParmVarDecl *B) { 3353 const auto *AttrA = A->getAttr<PassObjectSizeAttr>(); 3354 const auto *AttrB = B->getAttr<PassObjectSizeAttr>(); 3355 if (AttrA == AttrB) 3356 return true; 3357 return AttrA && AttrB && AttrA->getType() == AttrB->getType() && 3358 AttrA->isDynamic() == AttrB->isDynamic(); 3359 }; 3360 3361 return std::equal(A->param_begin(), A->param_end(), B->param_begin(), AttrEq); 3362 } 3363 3364 /// If necessary, adjust the semantic declaration context for a qualified 3365 /// declaration to name the correct inline namespace within the qualifier. 3366 static void adjustDeclContextForDeclaratorDecl(DeclaratorDecl *NewD, 3367 DeclaratorDecl *OldD) { 3368 // The only case where we need to update the DeclContext is when 3369 // redeclaration lookup for a qualified name finds a declaration 3370 // in an inline namespace within the context named by the qualifier: 3371 // 3372 // inline namespace N { int f(); } 3373 // int ::f(); // Sema DC needs adjusting from :: to N::. 3374 // 3375 // For unqualified declarations, the semantic context *can* change 3376 // along the redeclaration chain (for local extern declarations, 3377 // extern "C" declarations, and friend declarations in particular). 3378 if (!NewD->getQualifier()) 3379 return; 3380 3381 // NewD is probably already in the right context. 3382 auto *NamedDC = NewD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext(); 3383 auto *SemaDC = OldD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext(); 3384 if (NamedDC->Equals(SemaDC)) 3385 return; 3386 3387 assert((NamedDC->InEnclosingNamespaceSetOf(SemaDC) || 3388 NewD->isInvalidDecl() || OldD->isInvalidDecl()) && 3389 "unexpected context for redeclaration"); 3390 3391 auto *LexDC = NewD->getLexicalDeclContext(); 3392 auto FixSemaDC = [=](NamedDecl *D) { 3393 if (!D) 3394 return; 3395 D->setDeclContext(SemaDC); 3396 D->setLexicalDeclContext(LexDC); 3397 }; 3398 3399 FixSemaDC(NewD); 3400 if (auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(NewD)) 3401 FixSemaDC(FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()); 3402 else if (auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(NewD)) 3403 FixSemaDC(VD->getDescribedVarTemplate()); 3404 } 3405 3406 /// MergeFunctionDecl - We just parsed a function 'New' from 3407 /// declarator D which has the same name and scope as a previous 3408 /// declaration 'Old'. Figure out how to resolve this situation, 3409 /// merging decls or emitting diagnostics as appropriate. 3410 /// 3411 /// In C++, New and Old must be declarations that are not 3412 /// overloaded. Use IsOverload to determine whether New and Old are 3413 /// overloaded, and to select the Old declaration that New should be 3414 /// merged with. 3415 /// 3416 /// Returns true if there was an error, false otherwise. 3417 bool Sema::MergeFunctionDecl(FunctionDecl *New, NamedDecl *&OldD, Scope *S, 3418 bool MergeTypeWithOld, bool NewDeclIsDefn) { 3419 // Verify the old decl was also a function. 3420 FunctionDecl *Old = OldD->getAsFunction(); 3421 if (!Old) { 3422 if (UsingShadowDecl *Shadow = dyn_cast<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)) { 3423 if (New->getFriendObjectKind()) { 3424 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_using_decl_friend); 3425 Diag(Shadow->getTargetDecl()->getLocation(), 3426 diag::note_using_decl_target); 3427 Diag(Shadow->getIntroducer()->getLocation(), diag::note_using_decl) 3428 << 0; 3429 return true; 3430 } 3431 3432 // Check whether the two declarations might declare the same function or 3433 // function template. 3434 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *NewTemplate = 3435 New->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()) { 3436 if (checkUsingShadowRedecl<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*this, Shadow, 3437 NewTemplate)) 3438 return true; 3439 OldD = Old = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Shadow->getTargetDecl()) 3440 ->getAsFunction(); 3441 } else { 3442 if (checkUsingShadowRedecl<FunctionDecl>(*this, Shadow, New)) 3443 return true; 3444 OldD = Old = cast<FunctionDecl>(Shadow->getTargetDecl()); 3445 } 3446 } else { 3447 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition_different_kind) 3448 << New->getDeclName(); 3449 notePreviousDefinition(OldD, New->getLocation()); 3450 return true; 3451 } 3452 } 3453 3454 // If the old declaration was found in an inline namespace and the new 3455 // declaration was qualified, update the DeclContext to match. 3456 adjustDeclContextForDeclaratorDecl(New, Old); 3457 3458 // If the old declaration is invalid, just give up here. 3459 if (Old->isInvalidDecl()) 3460 return true; 3461 3462 // Disallow redeclaration of some builtins. 3463 if (!getASTContext().canBuiltinBeRedeclared(Old)) { 3464 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_builtin_redeclare) << Old->getDeclName(); 3465 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_builtin_declaration) 3466 << Old << Old->getType(); 3467 return true; 3468 } 3469 3470 diag::kind PrevDiag; 3471 SourceLocation OldLocation; 3472 std::tie(PrevDiag, OldLocation) = 3473 getNoteDiagForInvalidRedeclaration(Old, New); 3474 3475 // Don't complain about this if we're in GNU89 mode and the old function 3476 // is an extern inline function. 3477 // Don't complain about specializations. They are not supposed to have 3478 // storage classes. 3479 if (!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(New) && !isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Old) && 3480 New->getStorageClass() == SC_Static && 3481 Old->hasExternalFormalLinkage() && 3482 !New->getTemplateSpecializationInfo() && 3483 !canRedefineFunction(Old, getLangOpts())) { 3484 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt) { 3485 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::ext_static_non_static) << New; 3486 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 3487 } else { 3488 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_static_non_static) << New; 3489 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 3490 return true; 3491 } 3492 } 3493 3494 if (const auto *ILA = New->getAttr<InternalLinkageAttr>()) 3495 if (!Old->hasAttr<InternalLinkageAttr>()) { 3496 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_missing_on_first_decl) 3497 << ILA; 3498 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 3499 New->dropAttr<InternalLinkageAttr>(); 3500 } 3501 3502 if (auto *EA = New->getAttr<ErrorAttr>()) { 3503 if (!Old->hasAttr<ErrorAttr>()) { 3504 Diag(EA->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_missing_on_first_decl) << EA; 3505 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 3506 New->dropAttr<ErrorAttr>(); 3507 } 3508 } 3509 3510 if (CheckRedeclarationInModule(New, Old)) 3511 return true; 3512 3513 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 3514 bool OldOvl = Old->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>(); 3515 if (OldOvl != New->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>() && !Old->isImplicit()) { 3516 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_overloadable_mismatch) 3517 << New << OldOvl; 3518 3519 // Try our best to find a decl that actually has the overloadable 3520 // attribute for the note. In most cases (e.g. programs with only one 3521 // broken declaration/definition), this won't matter. 3522 // 3523 // FIXME: We could do this if we juggled some extra state in 3524 // OverloadableAttr, rather than just removing it. 3525 const Decl *DiagOld = Old; 3526 if (OldOvl) { 3527 auto OldIter = llvm::find_if(Old->redecls(), [](const Decl *D) { 3528 const auto *A = D->getAttr<OverloadableAttr>(); 3529 return A && !A->isImplicit(); 3530 }); 3531 // If we've implicitly added *all* of the overloadable attrs to this 3532 // chain, emitting a "previous redecl" note is pointless. 3533 DiagOld = OldIter == Old->redecls_end() ? nullptr : *OldIter; 3534 } 3535 3536 if (DiagOld) 3537 Diag(DiagOld->getLocation(), 3538 diag::note_attribute_overloadable_prev_overload) 3539 << OldOvl; 3540 3541 if (OldOvl) 3542 New->addAttr(OverloadableAttr::CreateImplicit(Context)); 3543 else 3544 New->dropAttr<OverloadableAttr>(); 3545 } 3546 } 3547 3548 // If a function is first declared with a calling convention, but is later 3549 // declared or defined without one, all following decls assume the calling 3550 // convention of the first. 3551 // 3552 // It's OK if a function is first declared without a calling convention, 3553 // but is later declared or defined with the default calling convention. 3554 // 3555 // To test if either decl has an explicit calling convention, we look for 3556 // AttributedType sugar nodes on the type as written. If they are missing or 3557 // were canonicalized away, we assume the calling convention was implicit. 3558 // 3559 // Note also that we DO NOT return at this point, because we still have 3560 // other tests to run. 3561 QualType OldQType = Context.getCanonicalType(Old->getType()); 3562 QualType NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(New->getType()); 3563 const FunctionType *OldType = cast<FunctionType>(OldQType); 3564 const FunctionType *NewType = cast<FunctionType>(NewQType); 3565 FunctionType::ExtInfo OldTypeInfo = OldType->getExtInfo(); 3566 FunctionType::ExtInfo NewTypeInfo = NewType->getExtInfo(); 3567 bool RequiresAdjustment = false; 3568 3569 if (OldTypeInfo.getCC() != NewTypeInfo.getCC()) { 3570 FunctionDecl *First = Old->getFirstDecl(); 3571 const FunctionType *FT = 3572 First->getType().getCanonicalType()->castAs<FunctionType>(); 3573 FunctionType::ExtInfo FI = FT->getExtInfo(); 3574 bool NewCCExplicit = getCallingConvAttributedType(New->getType()); 3575 if (!NewCCExplicit) { 3576 // Inherit the CC from the previous declaration if it was specified 3577 // there but not here. 3578 NewTypeInfo = NewTypeInfo.withCallingConv(OldTypeInfo.getCC()); 3579 RequiresAdjustment = true; 3580 } else if (Old->getBuiltinID()) { 3581 // Builtin attribute isn't propagated to the new one yet at this point, 3582 // so we check if the old one is a builtin. 3583 3584 // Calling Conventions on a Builtin aren't really useful and setting a 3585 // default calling convention and cdecl'ing some builtin redeclarations is 3586 // common, so warn and ignore the calling convention on the redeclaration. 3587 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::warn_cconv_unsupported) 3588 << FunctionType::getNameForCallConv(NewTypeInfo.getCC()) 3589 << (int)CallingConventionIgnoredReason::BuiltinFunction; 3590 NewTypeInfo = NewTypeInfo.withCallingConv(OldTypeInfo.getCC()); 3591 RequiresAdjustment = true; 3592 } else { 3593 // Calling conventions aren't compatible, so complain. 3594 bool FirstCCExplicit = getCallingConvAttributedType(First->getType()); 3595 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_cconv_change) 3596 << FunctionType::getNameForCallConv(NewTypeInfo.getCC()) 3597 << !FirstCCExplicit 3598 << (!FirstCCExplicit ? "" : 3599 FunctionType::getNameForCallConv(FI.getCC())); 3600 3601 // Put the note on the first decl, since it is the one that matters. 3602 Diag(First->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 3603 return true; 3604 } 3605 } 3606 3607 // FIXME: diagnose the other way around? 3608 if (OldTypeInfo.getNoReturn() && !NewTypeInfo.getNoReturn()) { 3609 NewTypeInfo = NewTypeInfo.withNoReturn(true); 3610 RequiresAdjustment = true; 3611 } 3612 3613 // Merge regparm attribute. 3614 if (OldTypeInfo.getHasRegParm() != NewTypeInfo.getHasRegParm() || 3615 OldTypeInfo.getRegParm() != NewTypeInfo.getRegParm()) { 3616 if (NewTypeInfo.getHasRegParm()) { 3617 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_regparm_mismatch) 3618 << NewType->getRegParmType() 3619 << OldType->getRegParmType(); 3620 Diag(OldLocation, diag::note_previous_declaration); 3621 return true; 3622 } 3623 3624 NewTypeInfo = NewTypeInfo.withRegParm(OldTypeInfo.getRegParm()); 3625 RequiresAdjustment = true; 3626 } 3627 3628 // Merge ns_returns_retained attribute. 3629 if (OldTypeInfo.getProducesResult() != NewTypeInfo.getProducesResult()) { 3630 if (NewTypeInfo.getProducesResult()) { 3631 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_function_attribute_mismatch) 3632 << "'ns_returns_retained'"; 3633 Diag(OldLocation, diag::note_previous_declaration); 3634 return true; 3635 } 3636 3637 NewTypeInfo = NewTypeInfo.withProducesResult(true); 3638 RequiresAdjustment = true; 3639 } 3640 3641 if (OldTypeInfo.getNoCallerSavedRegs() != 3642 NewTypeInfo.getNoCallerSavedRegs()) { 3643 if (NewTypeInfo.getNoCallerSavedRegs()) { 3644 AnyX86NoCallerSavedRegistersAttr *Attr = 3645 New->getAttr<AnyX86NoCallerSavedRegistersAttr>(); 3646 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_function_attribute_mismatch) << Attr; 3647 Diag(OldLocation, diag::note_previous_declaration); 3648 return true; 3649 } 3650 3651 NewTypeInfo = NewTypeInfo.withNoCallerSavedRegs(true); 3652 RequiresAdjustment = true; 3653 } 3654 3655 if (RequiresAdjustment) { 3656 const FunctionType *AdjustedType = New->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>(); 3657 AdjustedType = Context.adjustFunctionType(AdjustedType, NewTypeInfo); 3658 New->setType(QualType(AdjustedType, 0)); 3659 NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(New->getType()); 3660 } 3661 3662 // If this redeclaration makes the function inline, we may need to add it to 3663 // UndefinedButUsed. 3664 if (!Old->isInlined() && New->isInlined() && 3665 !New->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>() && 3666 !getLangOpts().GNUInline && 3667 Old->isUsed(false) && 3668 !Old->isDefined() && !New->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) 3669 UndefinedButUsed.insert(std::make_pair(Old->getCanonicalDecl(), 3670 SourceLocation())); 3671 3672 // If this redeclaration makes it newly gnu_inline, we don't want to warn 3673 // about it. 3674 if (New->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>() && 3675 Old->isInlined() && !Old->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>()) { 3676 UndefinedButUsed.erase(Old->getCanonicalDecl()); 3677 } 3678 3679 // If pass_object_size params don't match up perfectly, this isn't a valid 3680 // redeclaration. 3681 if (Old->getNumParams() > 0 && Old->getNumParams() == New->getNumParams() && 3682 !hasIdenticalPassObjectSizeAttrs(Old, New)) { 3683 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_different_pass_object_size_params) 3684 << New->getDeclName(); 3685 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag) << Old << Old->getType(); 3686 return true; 3687 } 3688 3689 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 3690 // C++1z [over.load]p2 3691 // Certain function declarations cannot be overloaded: 3692 // -- Function declarations that differ only in the return type, 3693 // the exception specification, or both cannot be overloaded. 3694 3695 // Check the exception specifications match. This may recompute the type of 3696 // both Old and New if it resolved exception specifications, so grab the 3697 // types again after this. Because this updates the type, we do this before 3698 // any of the other checks below, which may update the "de facto" NewQType 3699 // but do not necessarily update the type of New. 3700 if (CheckEquivalentExceptionSpec(Old, New)) 3701 return true; 3702 OldQType = Context.getCanonicalType(Old->getType()); 3703 NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(New->getType()); 3704 3705 // Go back to the type source info to compare the declared return types, 3706 // per C++1y [dcl.type.auto]p13: 3707 // Redeclarations or specializations of a function or function template 3708 // with a declared return type that uses a placeholder type shall also 3709 // use that placeholder, not a deduced type. 3710 QualType OldDeclaredReturnType = Old->getDeclaredReturnType(); 3711 QualType NewDeclaredReturnType = New->getDeclaredReturnType(); 3712 if (!Context.hasSameType(OldDeclaredReturnType, NewDeclaredReturnType) && 3713 canFullyTypeCheckRedeclaration(New, Old, NewDeclaredReturnType, 3714 OldDeclaredReturnType)) { 3715 QualType ResQT; 3716 if (NewDeclaredReturnType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && 3717 OldDeclaredReturnType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) 3718 // FIXME: This does the wrong thing for a deduced return type. 3719 ResQT = Context.mergeObjCGCQualifiers(NewQType, OldQType); 3720 if (ResQT.isNull()) { 3721 if (New->isCXXClassMember() && New->isOutOfLine()) 3722 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_member_def_does_not_match_ret_type) 3723 << New << New->getReturnTypeSourceRange(); 3724 else 3725 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_ovl_diff_return_type) 3726 << New->getReturnTypeSourceRange(); 3727 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag) << Old << Old->getType() 3728 << Old->getReturnTypeSourceRange(); 3729 return true; 3730 } 3731 else 3732 NewQType = ResQT; 3733 } 3734 3735 QualType OldReturnType = OldType->getReturnType(); 3736 QualType NewReturnType = cast<FunctionType>(NewQType)->getReturnType(); 3737 if (OldReturnType != NewReturnType) { 3738 // If this function has a deduced return type and has already been 3739 // defined, copy the deduced value from the old declaration. 3740 AutoType *OldAT = Old->getReturnType()->getContainedAutoType(); 3741 if (OldAT && OldAT->isDeduced()) { 3742 QualType DT = OldAT->getDeducedType(); 3743 if (DT.isNull()) { 3744 New->setType(SubstAutoTypeDependent(New->getType())); 3745 NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(SubstAutoTypeDependent(NewQType)); 3746 } else { 3747 New->setType(SubstAutoType(New->getType(), DT)); 3748 NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(SubstAutoType(NewQType, DT)); 3749 } 3750 } 3751 } 3752 3753 const CXXMethodDecl *OldMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Old); 3754 CXXMethodDecl *NewMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(New); 3755 if (OldMethod && NewMethod) { 3756 // Preserve triviality. 3757 NewMethod->setTrivial(OldMethod->isTrivial()); 3758 3759 // MSVC allows explicit template specialization at class scope: 3760 // 2 CXXMethodDecls referring to the same function will be injected. 3761 // We don't want a redeclaration error. 3762 bool IsClassScopeExplicitSpecialization = 3763 OldMethod->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization() && 3764 NewMethod->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization(); 3765 bool isFriend = NewMethod->getFriendObjectKind(); 3766 3767 if (!isFriend && NewMethod->getLexicalDeclContext()->isRecord() && 3768 !IsClassScopeExplicitSpecialization) { 3769 // -- Member function declarations with the same name and the 3770 // same parameter types cannot be overloaded if any of them 3771 // is a static member function declaration. 3772 if (OldMethod->isStatic() != NewMethod->isStatic()) { 3773 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_ovl_static_nonstatic_member); 3774 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag) << Old << Old->getType(); 3775 return true; 3776 } 3777 3778 // C++ [class.mem]p1: 3779 // [...] A member shall not be declared twice in the 3780 // member-specification, except that a nested class or member 3781 // class template can be declared and then later defined. 3782 if (!inTemplateInstantiation()) { 3783 unsigned NewDiag; 3784 if (isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(OldMethod)) 3785 NewDiag = diag::err_constructor_redeclared; 3786 else if (isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(NewMethod)) 3787 NewDiag = diag::err_destructor_redeclared; 3788 else if (isa<CXXConversionDecl>(NewMethod)) 3789 NewDiag = diag::err_conv_function_redeclared; 3790 else 3791 NewDiag = diag::err_member_redeclared; 3792 3793 Diag(New->getLocation(), NewDiag); 3794 } else { 3795 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_member_redeclared_in_instantiation) 3796 << New << New->getType(); 3797 } 3798 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag) << Old << Old->getType(); 3799 return true; 3800 3801 // Complain if this is an explicit declaration of a special 3802 // member that was initially declared implicitly. 3803 // 3804 // As an exception, it's okay to befriend such methods in order 3805 // to permit the implicit constructor/destructor/operator calls. 3806 } else if (OldMethod->isImplicit()) { 3807 if (isFriend) { 3808 NewMethod->setImplicit(); 3809 } else { 3810 Diag(NewMethod->getLocation(), 3811 diag::err_definition_of_implicitly_declared_member) 3812 << New << getSpecialMember(OldMethod); 3813 return true; 3814 } 3815 } else if (OldMethod->getFirstDecl()->isExplicitlyDefaulted() && !isFriend) { 3816 Diag(NewMethod->getLocation(), 3817 diag::err_definition_of_explicitly_defaulted_member) 3818 << getSpecialMember(OldMethod); 3819 return true; 3820 } 3821 } 3822 3823 // C++11 [dcl.attr.noreturn]p1: 3824 // The first declaration of a function shall specify the noreturn 3825 // attribute if any declaration of that function specifies the noreturn 3826 // attribute. 3827 if (const auto *NRA = New->getAttr<CXX11NoReturnAttr>()) 3828 if (!Old->hasAttr<CXX11NoReturnAttr>()) { 3829 Diag(NRA->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_missing_on_first_decl) 3830 << NRA; 3831 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 3832 } 3833 3834 // C++11 [dcl.attr.depend]p2: 3835 // The first declaration of a function shall specify the 3836 // carries_dependency attribute for its declarator-id if any declaration 3837 // of the function specifies the carries_dependency attribute. 3838 const CarriesDependencyAttr *CDA = New->getAttr<CarriesDependencyAttr>(); 3839 if (CDA && !Old->hasAttr<CarriesDependencyAttr>()) { 3840 Diag(CDA->getLocation(), 3841 diag::err_carries_dependency_missing_on_first_decl) << 0/*Function*/; 3842 Diag(Old->getFirstDecl()->getLocation(), 3843 diag::note_carries_dependency_missing_first_decl) << 0/*Function*/; 3844 } 3845 3846 // (C++98 8.3.5p3): 3847 // All declarations for a function shall agree exactly in both the 3848 // return type and the parameter-type-list. 3849 // We also want to respect all the extended bits except noreturn. 3850 3851 // noreturn should now match unless the old type info didn't have it. 3852 QualType OldQTypeForComparison = OldQType; 3853 if (!OldTypeInfo.getNoReturn() && NewTypeInfo.getNoReturn()) { 3854 auto *OldType = OldQType->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 3855 const FunctionType *OldTypeForComparison 3856 = Context.adjustFunctionType(OldType, OldTypeInfo.withNoReturn(true)); 3857 OldQTypeForComparison = QualType(OldTypeForComparison, 0); 3858 assert(OldQTypeForComparison.isCanonical()); 3859 } 3860 3861 if (haveIncompatibleLanguageLinkages(Old, New)) { 3862 // As a special case, retain the language linkage from previous 3863 // declarations of a friend function as an extension. 3864 // 3865 // This liberal interpretation of C++ [class.friend]p3 matches GCC/MSVC 3866 // and is useful because there's otherwise no way to specify language 3867 // linkage within class scope. 3868 // 3869 // Check cautiously as the friend object kind isn't yet complete. 3870 if (New->getFriendObjectKind() != Decl::FOK_None) { 3871 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::ext_retained_language_linkage) << New; 3872 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 3873 } else { 3874 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_different_language_linkage) << New; 3875 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 3876 return true; 3877 } 3878 } 3879 3880 // If the function types are compatible, merge the declarations. Ignore the 3881 // exception specifier because it was already checked above in 3882 // CheckEquivalentExceptionSpec, and we don't want follow-on diagnostics 3883 // about incompatible types under -fms-compatibility. 3884 if (Context.hasSameFunctionTypeIgnoringExceptionSpec(OldQTypeForComparison, 3885 NewQType)) 3886 return MergeCompatibleFunctionDecls(New, Old, S, MergeTypeWithOld); 3887 3888 // If the types are imprecise (due to dependent constructs in friends or 3889 // local extern declarations), it's OK if they differ. We'll check again 3890 // during instantiation. 3891 if (!canFullyTypeCheckRedeclaration(New, Old, NewQType, OldQType)) 3892 return false; 3893 3894 // Fall through for conflicting redeclarations and redefinitions. 3895 } 3896 3897 // C: Function types need to be compatible, not identical. This handles 3898 // duplicate function decls like "void f(int); void f(enum X);" properly. 3899 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 3900 // C99 6.7.5.3p15: ...If one type has a parameter type list and the other 3901 // type is specified by a function definition that contains a (possibly 3902 // empty) identifier list, both shall agree in the number of parameters 3903 // and the type of each parameter shall be compatible with the type that 3904 // results from the application of default argument promotions to the 3905 // type of the corresponding identifier. ... 3906 // This cannot be handled by ASTContext::typesAreCompatible() because that 3907 // doesn't know whether the function type is for a definition or not when 3908 // eventually calling ASTContext::mergeFunctionTypes(). The only situation 3909 // we need to cover here is that the number of arguments agree as the 3910 // default argument promotion rules were already checked by 3911 // ASTContext::typesAreCompatible(). 3912 if (Old->hasPrototype() && !New->hasWrittenPrototype() && NewDeclIsDefn && 3913 Old->getNumParams() != New->getNumParams()) { 3914 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_conflicting_types) << New; 3915 Diag(Old->getLocation(), PrevDiag) << Old << Old->getType(); 3916 return true; 3917 } 3918 3919 // If we are merging two functions where only one of them has a prototype, 3920 // we may have enough information to decide to issue a diagnostic that the 3921 // function without a protoype will change behavior in C2x. This handles 3922 // cases like: 3923 // void i(); void i(int j); 3924 // void i(int j); void i(); 3925 // void i(); void i(int j) {} 3926 // See ActOnFinishFunctionBody() for other cases of the behavior change 3927 // diagnostic. See GetFullTypeForDeclarator() for handling of a function 3928 // type without a prototype. 3929 if (New->hasWrittenPrototype() != Old->hasWrittenPrototype() && 3930 !New->isImplicit() && !Old->isImplicit()) { 3931 const FunctionDecl *WithProto, *WithoutProto; 3932 if (New->hasWrittenPrototype()) { 3933 WithProto = New; 3934 WithoutProto = Old; 3935 } else { 3936 WithProto = Old; 3937 WithoutProto = New; 3938 } 3939 3940 if (WithProto->getNumParams() != 0) { 3941 // The function definition has parameters, so this will change 3942 // behavior in C2x. 3943 // 3944 // If we already warned about about the function without a prototype 3945 // being deprecated, add a note that it also changes behavior. If we 3946 // didn't warn about it being deprecated (because the diagnostic is 3947 // not enabled), warn now that it is deprecated and changes behavior. 3948 bool AddNote = false; 3949 if (Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_strict_prototypes, 3950 WithoutProto->getLocation())) { 3951 if (WithoutProto->getBuiltinID() == 0 && 3952 !WithoutProto->isImplicit() && 3953 SourceMgr.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(WithoutProto->getLocation(), 3954 WithProto->getLocation())) { 3955 PartialDiagnostic PD = 3956 PDiag(diag::warn_non_prototype_changes_behavior); 3957 if (TypeSourceInfo *TSI = WithoutProto->getTypeSourceInfo()) { 3958 if (auto FTL = TSI->getTypeLoc().getAs<FunctionNoProtoTypeLoc>()) 3959 PD << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FTL.getRParenLoc(), "void"); 3960 } 3961 Diag(WithoutProto->getLocation(), PD); 3962 } 3963 } else { 3964 AddNote = true; 3965 } 3966 3967 // Because the function with a prototype has parameters but a previous 3968 // declaration had none, the function with the prototype will also 3969 // change behavior in C2x. 3970 if (WithProto->getBuiltinID() == 0 && !WithProto->isImplicit()) { 3971 if (SourceMgr.isBeforeInTranslationUnit( 3972 WithProto->getLocation(), WithoutProto->getLocation())) { 3973 // If the function with the prototype comes before the function 3974 // without the prototype, we only want to diagnose the one without 3975 // the prototype. 3976 Diag(WithoutProto->getLocation(), 3977 diag::warn_non_prototype_changes_behavior); 3978 } else { 3979 // Otherwise, diagnose the one with the prototype, and potentially 3980 // attach a note to the one without a prototype if needed. 3981 Diag(WithProto->getLocation(), 3982 diag::warn_non_prototype_changes_behavior); 3983 if (AddNote && WithoutProto->getBuiltinID() == 0) 3984 Diag(WithoutProto->getLocation(), 3985 diag::note_func_decl_changes_behavior); 3986 } 3987 } else if (AddNote && WithoutProto->getBuiltinID() == 0 && 3988 !WithoutProto->isImplicit()) { 3989 // If we were supposed to add a note but the function with a 3990 // prototype is a builtin or was implicitly declared, which means we 3991 // have nothing to attach the note to, so we issue a warning instead. 3992 Diag(WithoutProto->getLocation(), 3993 diag::warn_non_prototype_changes_behavior); 3994 } 3995 } 3996 } 3997 3998 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(OldQType, NewQType)) { 3999 const FunctionType *OldFuncType = OldQType->getAs<FunctionType>(); 4000 const FunctionType *NewFuncType = NewQType->getAs<FunctionType>(); 4001 const FunctionProtoType *OldProto = nullptr; 4002 if (MergeTypeWithOld && isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(NewFuncType) && 4003 (OldProto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(OldFuncType))) { 4004 // The old declaration provided a function prototype, but the 4005 // new declaration does not. Merge in the prototype. 4006 assert(!OldProto->hasExceptionSpec() && "Exception spec in C"); 4007 SmallVector<QualType, 16> ParamTypes(OldProto->param_types()); 4008 NewQType = 4009 Context.getFunctionType(NewFuncType->getReturnType(), ParamTypes, 4010 OldProto->getExtProtoInfo()); 4011 New->setType(NewQType); 4012 New->setHasInheritedPrototype(); 4013 4014 // Synthesize parameters with the same types. 4015 SmallVector<ParmVarDecl *, 16> Params; 4016 for (const auto &ParamType : OldProto->param_types()) { 4017 ParmVarDecl *Param = ParmVarDecl::Create( 4018 Context, New, SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(), nullptr, 4019 ParamType, /*TInfo=*/nullptr, SC_None, nullptr); 4020 Param->setScopeInfo(0, Params.size()); 4021 Param->setImplicit(); 4022 Params.push_back(Param); 4023 } 4024 4025 New->setParams(Params); 4026 } 4027 4028 return MergeCompatibleFunctionDecls(New, Old, S, MergeTypeWithOld); 4029 } 4030 } 4031 4032 // Check if the function types are compatible when pointer size address 4033 // spaces are ignored. 4034 if (Context.hasSameFunctionTypeIgnoringPtrSizes(OldQType, NewQType)) 4035 return false; 4036 4037 // GNU C permits a K&R definition to follow a prototype declaration 4038 // if the declared types of the parameters in the K&R definition 4039 // match the types in the prototype declaration, even when the 4040 // promoted types of the parameters from the K&R definition differ 4041 // from the types in the prototype. GCC then keeps the types from 4042 // the prototype. 4043 // 4044 // If a variadic prototype is followed by a non-variadic K&R definition, 4045 // the K&R definition becomes variadic. This is sort of an edge case, but 4046 // it's legal per the standard depending on how you read C99 6.7.5.3p15 and 4047 // C99 6.9.1p8. 4048 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 4049 Old->hasPrototype() && !New->hasPrototype() && 4050 New->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>() && 4051 Old->getNumParams() == New->getNumParams()) { 4052 SmallVector<QualType, 16> ArgTypes; 4053 SmallVector<GNUCompatibleParamWarning, 16> Warnings; 4054 const FunctionProtoType *OldProto 4055 = Old->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 4056 const FunctionProtoType *NewProto 4057 = New->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 4058 4059 // Determine whether this is the GNU C extension. 4060 QualType MergedReturn = Context.mergeTypes(OldProto->getReturnType(), 4061 NewProto->getReturnType()); 4062 bool LooseCompatible = !MergedReturn.isNull(); 4063 for (unsigned Idx = 0, End = Old->getNumParams(); 4064 LooseCompatible && Idx != End; ++Idx) { 4065 ParmVarDecl *OldParm = Old->getParamDecl(Idx); 4066 ParmVarDecl *NewParm = New->getParamDecl(Idx); 4067 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(OldParm->getType(), 4068 NewProto->getParamType(Idx))) { 4069 ArgTypes.push_back(NewParm->getType()); 4070 } else if (Context.typesAreCompatible(OldParm->getType(), 4071 NewParm->getType(), 4072 /*CompareUnqualified=*/true)) { 4073 GNUCompatibleParamWarning Warn = { OldParm, NewParm, 4074 NewProto->getParamType(Idx) }; 4075 Warnings.push_back(Warn); 4076 ArgTypes.push_back(NewParm->getType()); 4077 } else 4078 LooseCompatible = false; 4079 } 4080 4081 if (LooseCompatible) { 4082 for (unsigned Warn = 0; Warn < Warnings.size(); ++Warn) { 4083 Diag(Warnings[Warn].NewParm->getLocation(), 4084 diag::ext_param_promoted_not_compatible_with_prototype) 4085 << Warnings[Warn].PromotedType 4086 << Warnings[Warn].OldParm->getType(); 4087 if (Warnings[Warn].OldParm->getLocation().isValid()) 4088 Diag(Warnings[Warn].OldParm->getLocation(), 4089 diag::note_previous_declaration); 4090 } 4091 4092 if (MergeTypeWithOld) 4093 New->setType(Context.getFunctionType(MergedReturn, ArgTypes, 4094 OldProto->getExtProtoInfo())); 4095 return MergeCompatibleFunctionDecls(New, Old, S, MergeTypeWithOld); 4096 } 4097 4098 // Fall through to diagnose conflicting types. 4099 } 4100 4101 // A function that has already been declared has been redeclared or 4102 // defined with a different type; show an appropriate diagnostic. 4103 4104 // If the previous declaration was an implicitly-generated builtin 4105 // declaration, then at the very least we should use a specialized note. 4106 unsigned BuiltinID; 4107 if (Old->isImplicit() && (BuiltinID = Old->getBuiltinID())) { 4108 // If it's actually a library-defined builtin function like 'malloc' 4109 // or 'printf', just warn about the incompatible redeclaration. 4110 if (Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID)) { 4111 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::warn_redecl_library_builtin) << New; 4112 Diag(OldLocation, diag::note_previous_builtin_declaration) 4113 << Old << Old->getType(); 4114 return false; 4115 } 4116 4117 PrevDiag = diag::note_previous_builtin_declaration; 4118 } 4119 4120 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_conflicting_types) << New->getDeclName(); 4121 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag) << Old << Old->getType(); 4122 return true; 4123 } 4124 4125 /// Completes the merge of two function declarations that are 4126 /// known to be compatible. 4127 /// 4128 /// This routine handles the merging of attributes and other 4129 /// properties of function declarations from the old declaration to 4130 /// the new declaration, once we know that New is in fact a 4131 /// redeclaration of Old. 4132 /// 4133 /// \returns false 4134 bool Sema::MergeCompatibleFunctionDecls(FunctionDecl *New, FunctionDecl *Old, 4135 Scope *S, bool MergeTypeWithOld) { 4136 // Merge the attributes 4137 mergeDeclAttributes(New, Old); 4138 4139 // Merge "pure" flag. 4140 if (Old->isPure()) 4141 New->setPure(); 4142 4143 // Merge "used" flag. 4144 if (Old->getMostRecentDecl()->isUsed(false)) 4145 New->setIsUsed(); 4146 4147 // Merge attributes from the parameters. These can mismatch with K&R 4148 // declarations. 4149 if (New->getNumParams() == Old->getNumParams()) 4150 for (unsigned i = 0, e = New->getNumParams(); i != e; ++i) { 4151 ParmVarDecl *NewParam = New->getParamDecl(i); 4152 ParmVarDecl *OldParam = Old->getParamDecl(i); 4153 mergeParamDeclAttributes(NewParam, OldParam, *this); 4154 mergeParamDeclTypes(NewParam, OldParam, *this); 4155 } 4156 4157 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 4158 return MergeCXXFunctionDecl(New, Old, S); 4159 4160 // Merge the function types so the we get the composite types for the return 4161 // and argument types. Per C11 6.2.7/4, only update the type if the old decl 4162 // was visible. 4163 QualType Merged = Context.mergeTypes(Old->getType(), New->getType()); 4164 if (!Merged.isNull() && MergeTypeWithOld) 4165 New->setType(Merged); 4166 4167 return false; 4168 } 4169 4170 void Sema::mergeObjCMethodDecls(ObjCMethodDecl *newMethod, 4171 ObjCMethodDecl *oldMethod) { 4172 // Merge the attributes, including deprecated/unavailable 4173 AvailabilityMergeKind MergeKind = 4174 isa<ObjCProtocolDecl>(oldMethod->getDeclContext()) 4175 ? (oldMethod->isOptional() ? AMK_OptionalProtocolImplementation 4176 : AMK_ProtocolImplementation) 4177 : isa<ObjCImplDecl>(newMethod->getDeclContext()) ? AMK_Redeclaration 4178 : AMK_Override; 4179 4180 mergeDeclAttributes(newMethod, oldMethod, MergeKind); 4181 4182 // Merge attributes from the parameters. 4183 ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator oi = oldMethod->param_begin(), 4184 oe = oldMethod->param_end(); 4185 for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator 4186 ni = newMethod->param_begin(), ne = newMethod->param_end(); 4187 ni != ne && oi != oe; ++ni, ++oi) 4188 mergeParamDeclAttributes(*ni, *oi, *this); 4189 4190 CheckObjCMethodOverride(newMethod, oldMethod); 4191 } 4192 4193 static void diagnoseVarDeclTypeMismatch(Sema &S, VarDecl *New, VarDecl* Old) { 4194 assert(!S.Context.hasSameType(New->getType(), Old->getType())); 4195 4196 S.Diag(New->getLocation(), New->isThisDeclarationADefinition() 4197 ? diag::err_redefinition_different_type 4198 : diag::err_redeclaration_different_type) 4199 << New->getDeclName() << New->getType() << Old->getType(); 4200 4201 diag::kind PrevDiag; 4202 SourceLocation OldLocation; 4203 std::tie(PrevDiag, OldLocation) 4204 = getNoteDiagForInvalidRedeclaration(Old, New); 4205 S.Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 4206 New->setInvalidDecl(); 4207 } 4208 4209 /// MergeVarDeclTypes - We parsed a variable 'New' which has the same name and 4210 /// scope as a previous declaration 'Old'. Figure out how to merge their types, 4211 /// emitting diagnostics as appropriate. 4212 /// 4213 /// Declarations using the auto type specifier (C++ [decl.spec.auto]) call back 4214 /// to here in AddInitializerToDecl. We can't check them before the initializer 4215 /// is attached. 4216 void Sema::MergeVarDeclTypes(VarDecl *New, VarDecl *Old, 4217 bool MergeTypeWithOld) { 4218 if (New->isInvalidDecl() || Old->isInvalidDecl()) 4219 return; 4220 4221 QualType MergedT; 4222 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 4223 if (New->getType()->isUndeducedType()) { 4224 // We don't know what the new type is until the initializer is attached. 4225 return; 4226 } else if (Context.hasSameType(New->getType(), Old->getType())) { 4227 // These could still be something that needs exception specs checked. 4228 return MergeVarDeclExceptionSpecs(New, Old); 4229 } 4230 // C++ [basic.link]p10: 4231 // [...] the types specified by all declarations referring to a given 4232 // object or function shall be identical, except that declarations for an 4233 // array object can specify array types that differ by the presence or 4234 // absence of a major array bound (8.3.4). 4235 else if (Old->getType()->isArrayType() && New->getType()->isArrayType()) { 4236 const ArrayType *OldArray = Context.getAsArrayType(Old->getType()); 4237 const ArrayType *NewArray = Context.getAsArrayType(New->getType()); 4238 4239 // We are merging a variable declaration New into Old. If it has an array 4240 // bound, and that bound differs from Old's bound, we should diagnose the 4241 // mismatch. 4242 if (!NewArray->isIncompleteArrayType() && !NewArray->isDependentType()) { 4243 for (VarDecl *PrevVD = Old->getMostRecentDecl(); PrevVD; 4244 PrevVD = PrevVD->getPreviousDecl()) { 4245 QualType PrevVDTy = PrevVD->getType(); 4246 if (PrevVDTy->isIncompleteArrayType() || PrevVDTy->isDependentType()) 4247 continue; 4248 4249 if (!Context.hasSameType(New->getType(), PrevVDTy)) 4250 return diagnoseVarDeclTypeMismatch(*this, New, PrevVD); 4251 } 4252 } 4253 4254 if (OldArray->isIncompleteArrayType() && NewArray->isArrayType()) { 4255 if (Context.hasSameType(OldArray->getElementType(), 4256 NewArray->getElementType())) 4257 MergedT = New->getType(); 4258 } 4259 // FIXME: Check visibility. New is hidden but has a complete type. If New 4260 // has no array bound, it should not inherit one from Old, if Old is not 4261 // visible. 4262 else if (OldArray->isArrayType() && NewArray->isIncompleteArrayType()) { 4263 if (Context.hasSameType(OldArray->getElementType(), 4264 NewArray->getElementType())) 4265 MergedT = Old->getType(); 4266 } 4267 } 4268 else if (New->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() && 4269 Old->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 4270 MergedT = Context.mergeObjCGCQualifiers(New->getType(), 4271 Old->getType()); 4272 } 4273 } else { 4274 // C 6.2.7p2: 4275 // All declarations that refer to the same object or function shall have 4276 // compatible type. 4277 MergedT = Context.mergeTypes(New->getType(), Old->getType()); 4278 } 4279 if (MergedT.isNull()) { 4280 // It's OK if we couldn't merge types if either type is dependent, for a 4281 // block-scope variable. In other cases (static data members of class 4282 // templates, variable templates, ...), we require the types to be 4283 // equivalent. 4284 // FIXME: The C++ standard doesn't say anything about this. 4285 if ((New->getType()->isDependentType() || 4286 Old->getType()->isDependentType()) && New->isLocalVarDecl()) { 4287 // If the old type was dependent, we can't merge with it, so the new type 4288 // becomes dependent for now. We'll reproduce the original type when we 4289 // instantiate the TypeSourceInfo for the variable. 4290 if (!New->getType()->isDependentType() && MergeTypeWithOld) 4291 New->setType(Context.DependentTy); 4292 return; 4293 } 4294 return diagnoseVarDeclTypeMismatch(*this, New, Old); 4295 } 4296 4297 // Don't actually update the type on the new declaration if the old 4298 // declaration was an extern declaration in a different scope. 4299 if (MergeTypeWithOld) 4300 New->setType(MergedT); 4301 } 4302 4303 static bool mergeTypeWithPrevious(Sema &S, VarDecl *NewVD, VarDecl *OldVD, 4304 LookupResult &Previous) { 4305 // C11 6.2.7p4: 4306 // For an identifier with internal or external linkage declared 4307 // in a scope in which a prior declaration of that identifier is 4308 // visible, if the prior declaration specifies internal or 4309 // external linkage, the type of the identifier at the later 4310 // declaration becomes the composite type. 4311 // 4312 // If the variable isn't visible, we do not merge with its type. 4313 if (Previous.isShadowed()) 4314 return false; 4315 4316 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 4317 // C++11 [dcl.array]p3: 4318 // If there is a preceding declaration of the entity in the same 4319 // scope in which the bound was specified, an omitted array bound 4320 // is taken to be the same as in that earlier declaration. 4321 return NewVD->isPreviousDeclInSameBlockScope() || 4322 (!OldVD->getLexicalDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod() && 4323 !NewVD->getLexicalDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod()); 4324 } else { 4325 // If the old declaration was function-local, don't merge with its 4326 // type unless we're in the same function. 4327 return !OldVD->getLexicalDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod() || 4328 OldVD->getLexicalDeclContext() == NewVD->getLexicalDeclContext(); 4329 } 4330 } 4331 4332 /// MergeVarDecl - We just parsed a variable 'New' which has the same name 4333 /// and scope as a previous declaration 'Old'. Figure out how to resolve this 4334 /// situation, merging decls or emitting diagnostics as appropriate. 4335 /// 4336 /// Tentative definition rules (C99 6.9.2p2) are checked by 4337 /// FinalizeDeclaratorGroup. Unfortunately, we can't analyze tentative 4338 /// definitions here, since the initializer hasn't been attached. 4339 /// 4340 void Sema::MergeVarDecl(VarDecl *New, LookupResult &Previous) { 4341 // If the new decl is already invalid, don't do any other checking. 4342 if (New->isInvalidDecl()) 4343 return; 4344 4345 if (!shouldLinkPossiblyHiddenDecl(Previous, New)) 4346 return; 4347 4348 VarTemplateDecl *NewTemplate = New->getDescribedVarTemplate(); 4349 4350 // Verify the old decl was also a variable or variable template. 4351 VarDecl *Old = nullptr; 4352 VarTemplateDecl *OldTemplate = nullptr; 4353 if (Previous.isSingleResult()) { 4354 if (NewTemplate) { 4355 OldTemplate = dyn_cast<VarTemplateDecl>(Previous.getFoundDecl()); 4356 Old = OldTemplate ? OldTemplate->getTemplatedDecl() : nullptr; 4357 4358 if (auto *Shadow = 4359 dyn_cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Previous.getRepresentativeDecl())) 4360 if (checkUsingShadowRedecl<VarTemplateDecl>(*this, Shadow, NewTemplate)) 4361 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 4362 } else { 4363 Old = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(Previous.getFoundDecl()); 4364 4365 if (auto *Shadow = 4366 dyn_cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Previous.getRepresentativeDecl())) 4367 if (checkUsingShadowRedecl<VarDecl>(*this, Shadow, New)) 4368 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 4369 } 4370 } 4371 if (!Old) { 4372 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition_different_kind) 4373 << New->getDeclName(); 4374 notePreviousDefinition(Previous.getRepresentativeDecl(), 4375 New->getLocation()); 4376 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 4377 } 4378 4379 // If the old declaration was found in an inline namespace and the new 4380 // declaration was qualified, update the DeclContext to match. 4381 adjustDeclContextForDeclaratorDecl(New, Old); 4382 4383 // Ensure the template parameters are compatible. 4384 if (NewTemplate && 4385 !TemplateParameterListsAreEqual(NewTemplate->getTemplateParameters(), 4386 OldTemplate->getTemplateParameters(), 4387 /*Complain=*/true, TPL_TemplateMatch)) 4388 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 4389 4390 // C++ [class.mem]p1: 4391 // A member shall not be declared twice in the member-specification [...] 4392 // 4393 // Here, we need only consider static data members. 4394 if (Old->isStaticDataMember() && !New->isOutOfLine()) { 4395 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_duplicate_member) 4396 << New->getIdentifier(); 4397 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 4398 New->setInvalidDecl(); 4399 } 4400 4401 mergeDeclAttributes(New, Old); 4402 // Warn if an already-declared variable is made a weak_import in a subsequent 4403 // declaration 4404 if (New->hasAttr<WeakImportAttr>() && 4405 Old->getStorageClass() == SC_None && 4406 !Old->hasAttr<WeakImportAttr>()) { 4407 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::warn_weak_import) << New->getDeclName(); 4408 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 4409 // Remove weak_import attribute on new declaration. 4410 New->dropAttr<WeakImportAttr>(); 4411 } 4412 4413 if (const auto *ILA = New->getAttr<InternalLinkageAttr>()) 4414 if (!Old->hasAttr<InternalLinkageAttr>()) { 4415 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_missing_on_first_decl) 4416 << ILA; 4417 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 4418 New->dropAttr<InternalLinkageAttr>(); 4419 } 4420 4421 // Merge the types. 4422 VarDecl *MostRecent = Old->getMostRecentDecl(); 4423 if (MostRecent != Old) { 4424 MergeVarDeclTypes(New, MostRecent, 4425 mergeTypeWithPrevious(*this, New, MostRecent, Previous)); 4426 if (New->isInvalidDecl()) 4427 return; 4428 } 4429 4430 MergeVarDeclTypes(New, Old, mergeTypeWithPrevious(*this, New, Old, Previous)); 4431 if (New->isInvalidDecl()) 4432 return; 4433 4434 diag::kind PrevDiag; 4435 SourceLocation OldLocation; 4436 std::tie(PrevDiag, OldLocation) = 4437 getNoteDiagForInvalidRedeclaration(Old, New); 4438 4439 // [dcl.stc]p8: Check if we have a non-static decl followed by a static. 4440 if (New->getStorageClass() == SC_Static && 4441 !New->isStaticDataMember() && 4442 Old->hasExternalFormalLinkage()) { 4443 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt) { 4444 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::ext_static_non_static) 4445 << New->getDeclName(); 4446 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 4447 } else { 4448 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_static_non_static) 4449 << New->getDeclName(); 4450 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 4451 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 4452 } 4453 } 4454 // C99 6.2.2p4: 4455 // For an identifier declared with the storage-class specifier 4456 // extern in a scope in which a prior declaration of that 4457 // identifier is visible,23) if the prior declaration specifies 4458 // internal or external linkage, the linkage of the identifier at 4459 // the later declaration is the same as the linkage specified at 4460 // the prior declaration. If no prior declaration is visible, or 4461 // if the prior declaration specifies no linkage, then the 4462 // identifier has external linkage. 4463 if (New->hasExternalStorage() && Old->hasLinkage()) 4464 /* Okay */; 4465 else if (New->getCanonicalDecl()->getStorageClass() != SC_Static && 4466 !New->isStaticDataMember() && 4467 Old->getCanonicalDecl()->getStorageClass() == SC_Static) { 4468 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_non_static_static) << New->getDeclName(); 4469 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 4470 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 4471 } 4472 4473 // Check if extern is followed by non-extern and vice-versa. 4474 if (New->hasExternalStorage() && 4475 !Old->hasLinkage() && Old->isLocalVarDeclOrParm()) { 4476 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_extern_non_extern) << New->getDeclName(); 4477 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 4478 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 4479 } 4480 if (Old->hasLinkage() && New->isLocalVarDeclOrParm() && 4481 !New->hasExternalStorage()) { 4482 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_non_extern_extern) << New->getDeclName(); 4483 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 4484 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 4485 } 4486 4487 if (CheckRedeclarationInModule(New, Old)) 4488 return; 4489 4490 // Variables with external linkage are analyzed in FinalizeDeclaratorGroup. 4491 4492 // FIXME: The test for external storage here seems wrong? We still 4493 // need to check for mismatches. 4494 if (!New->hasExternalStorage() && !New->isFileVarDecl() && 4495 // Don't complain about out-of-line definitions of static members. 4496 !(Old->getLexicalDeclContext()->isRecord() && 4497 !New->getLexicalDeclContext()->isRecord())) { 4498 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition) << New->getDeclName(); 4499 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 4500 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 4501 } 4502 4503 if (New->isInline() && !Old->getMostRecentDecl()->isInline()) { 4504 if (VarDecl *Def = Old->getDefinition()) { 4505 // C++1z [dcl.fcn.spec]p4: 4506 // If the definition of a variable appears in a translation unit before 4507 // its first declaration as inline, the program is ill-formed. 4508 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_inline_decl_follows_def) << New; 4509 Diag(Def->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition); 4510 } 4511 } 4512 4513 // If this redeclaration makes the variable inline, we may need to add it to 4514 // UndefinedButUsed. 4515 if (!Old->isInline() && New->isInline() && Old->isUsed(false) && 4516 !Old->getDefinition() && !New->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) 4517 UndefinedButUsed.insert(std::make_pair(Old->getCanonicalDecl(), 4518 SourceLocation())); 4519 4520 if (New->getTLSKind() != Old->getTLSKind()) { 4521 if (!Old->getTLSKind()) { 4522 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_thread_non_thread) << New->getDeclName(); 4523 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 4524 } else if (!New->getTLSKind()) { 4525 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_non_thread_thread) << New->getDeclName(); 4526 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 4527 } else { 4528 // Do not allow redeclaration to change the variable between requiring 4529 // static and dynamic initialization. 4530 // FIXME: GCC allows this, but uses the TLS keyword on the first 4531 // declaration to determine the kind. Do we need to be compatible here? 4532 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_thread_thread_different_kind) 4533 << New->getDeclName() << (New->getTLSKind() == VarDecl::TLS_Dynamic); 4534 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 4535 } 4536 } 4537 4538 // C++ doesn't have tentative definitions, so go right ahead and check here. 4539 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 4540 New->isThisDeclarationADefinition() == VarDecl::Definition) { 4541 if (Old->isStaticDataMember() && Old->getCanonicalDecl()->isInline() && 4542 Old->getCanonicalDecl()->isConstexpr()) { 4543 // This definition won't be a definition any more once it's been merged. 4544 Diag(New->getLocation(), 4545 diag::warn_deprecated_redundant_constexpr_static_def); 4546 } else if (VarDecl *Def = Old->getDefinition()) { 4547 if (checkVarDeclRedefinition(Def, New)) 4548 return; 4549 } 4550 } 4551 4552 if (haveIncompatibleLanguageLinkages(Old, New)) { 4553 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_different_language_linkage) << New; 4554 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 4555 New->setInvalidDecl(); 4556 return; 4557 } 4558 4559 // Merge "used" flag. 4560 if (Old->getMostRecentDecl()->isUsed(false)) 4561 New->setIsUsed(); 4562 4563 // Keep a chain of previous declarations. 4564 New->setPreviousDecl(Old); 4565 if (NewTemplate) 4566 NewTemplate->setPreviousDecl(OldTemplate); 4567 4568 // Inherit access appropriately. 4569 New->setAccess(Old->getAccess()); 4570 if (NewTemplate) 4571 NewTemplate->setAccess(New->getAccess()); 4572 4573 if (Old->isInline()) 4574 New->setImplicitlyInline(); 4575 } 4576 4577 void Sema::notePreviousDefinition(const NamedDecl *Old, SourceLocation New) { 4578 SourceManager &SrcMgr = getSourceManager(); 4579 auto FNewDecLoc = SrcMgr.getDecomposedLoc(New); 4580 auto FOldDecLoc = SrcMgr.getDecomposedLoc(Old->getLocation()); 4581 auto *FNew = SrcMgr.getFileEntryForID(FNewDecLoc.first); 4582 auto *FOld = SrcMgr.getFileEntryForID(FOldDecLoc.first); 4583 auto &HSI = PP.getHeaderSearchInfo(); 4584 StringRef HdrFilename = 4585 SrcMgr.getFilename(SrcMgr.getSpellingLoc(Old->getLocation())); 4586 4587 auto noteFromModuleOrInclude = [&](Module *Mod, 4588 SourceLocation IncLoc) -> bool { 4589 // Redefinition errors with modules are common with non modular mapped 4590 // headers, example: a non-modular header H in module A that also gets 4591 // included directly in a TU. Pointing twice to the same header/definition 4592 // is confusing, try to get better diagnostics when modules is on. 4593 if (IncLoc.isValid()) { 4594 if (Mod) { 4595 Diag(IncLoc, diag::note_redefinition_modules_same_file) 4596 << HdrFilename.str() << Mod->getFullModuleName(); 4597 if (!Mod->DefinitionLoc.isInvalid()) 4598 Diag(Mod->DefinitionLoc, diag::note_defined_here) 4599 << Mod->getFullModuleName(); 4600 } else { 4601 Diag(IncLoc, diag::note_redefinition_include_same_file) 4602 << HdrFilename.str(); 4603 } 4604 return true; 4605 } 4606 4607 return false; 4608 }; 4609 4610 // Is it the same file and same offset? Provide more information on why 4611 // this leads to a redefinition error. 4612 if (FNew == FOld && FNewDecLoc.second == FOldDecLoc.second) { 4613 SourceLocation OldIncLoc = SrcMgr.getIncludeLoc(FOldDecLoc.first); 4614 SourceLocation NewIncLoc = SrcMgr.getIncludeLoc(FNewDecLoc.first); 4615 bool EmittedDiag = 4616 noteFromModuleOrInclude(Old->getOwningModule(), OldIncLoc); 4617 EmittedDiag |= noteFromModuleOrInclude(getCurrentModule(), NewIncLoc); 4618 4619 // If the header has no guards, emit a note suggesting one. 4620 if (FOld && !HSI.isFileMultipleIncludeGuarded(FOld)) 4621 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_use_ifdef_guards); 4622 4623 if (EmittedDiag) 4624 return; 4625 } 4626 4627 // Redefinition coming from different files or couldn't do better above. 4628 if (Old->getLocation().isValid()) 4629 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition); 4630 } 4631 4632 /// We've just determined that \p Old and \p New both appear to be definitions 4633 /// of the same variable. Either diagnose or fix the problem. 4634 bool Sema::checkVarDeclRedefinition(VarDecl *Old, VarDecl *New) { 4635 if (!hasVisibleDefinition(Old) && 4636 (New->getFormalLinkage() == InternalLinkage || 4637 New->isInline() || 4638 New->getDescribedVarTemplate() || 4639 New->getNumTemplateParameterLists() || 4640 New->getDeclContext()->isDependentContext())) { 4641 // The previous definition is hidden, and multiple definitions are 4642 // permitted (in separate TUs). Demote this to a declaration. 4643 New->demoteThisDefinitionToDeclaration(); 4644 4645 // Make the canonical definition visible. 4646 if (auto *OldTD = Old->getDescribedVarTemplate()) 4647 makeMergedDefinitionVisible(OldTD); 4648 makeMergedDefinitionVisible(Old); 4649 return false; 4650 } else { 4651 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition) << New; 4652 notePreviousDefinition(Old, New->getLocation()); 4653 New->setInvalidDecl(); 4654 return true; 4655 } 4656 } 4657 4658 /// ParsedFreeStandingDeclSpec - This method is invoked when a declspec with 4659 /// no declarator (e.g. "struct foo;") is parsed. 4660 Decl * 4661 Sema::ParsedFreeStandingDeclSpec(Scope *S, AccessSpecifier AS, DeclSpec &DS, 4662 RecordDecl *&AnonRecord) { 4663 return ParsedFreeStandingDeclSpec(S, AS, DS, MultiTemplateParamsArg(), false, 4664 AnonRecord); 4665 } 4666 4667 // The MS ABI changed between VS2013 and VS2015 with regard to numbers used to 4668 // disambiguate entities defined in different scopes. 4669 // While the VS2015 ABI fixes potential miscompiles, it is also breaks 4670 // compatibility. 4671 // We will pick our mangling number depending on which version of MSVC is being 4672 // targeted. 4673 static unsigned getMSManglingNumber(const LangOptions &LO, Scope *S) { 4674 return LO.isCompatibleWithMSVC(LangOptions::MSVC2015) 4675 ? S->getMSCurManglingNumber() 4676 : S->getMSLastManglingNumber(); 4677 } 4678 4679 void Sema::handleTagNumbering(const TagDecl *Tag, Scope *TagScope) { 4680 if (!Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 4681 return; 4682 4683 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Tag->getParent())) { 4684 // If this tag is the direct child of a class, number it if 4685 // it is anonymous. 4686 if (!Tag->getName().empty() || Tag->getTypedefNameForAnonDecl()) 4687 return; 4688 MangleNumberingContext &MCtx = 4689 Context.getManglingNumberContext(Tag->getParent()); 4690 Context.setManglingNumber( 4691 Tag, MCtx.getManglingNumber( 4692 Tag, getMSManglingNumber(getLangOpts(), TagScope))); 4693 return; 4694 } 4695 4696 // If this tag isn't a direct child of a class, number it if it is local. 4697 MangleNumberingContext *MCtx; 4698 Decl *ManglingContextDecl; 4699 std::tie(MCtx, ManglingContextDecl) = 4700 getCurrentMangleNumberContext(Tag->getDeclContext()); 4701 if (MCtx) { 4702 Context.setManglingNumber( 4703 Tag, MCtx->getManglingNumber( 4704 Tag, getMSManglingNumber(getLangOpts(), TagScope))); 4705 } 4706 } 4707 4708 namespace { 4709 struct NonCLikeKind { 4710 enum { 4711 None, 4712 BaseClass, 4713 DefaultMemberInit, 4714 Lambda, 4715 Friend, 4716 OtherMember, 4717 Invalid, 4718 } Kind = None; 4719 SourceRange Range; 4720 4721 explicit operator bool() { return Kind != None; } 4722 }; 4723 } 4724 4725 /// Determine whether a class is C-like, according to the rules of C++ 4726 /// [dcl.typedef] for anonymous classes with typedef names for linkage. 4727 static NonCLikeKind getNonCLikeKindForAnonymousStruct(const CXXRecordDecl *RD) { 4728 if (RD->isInvalidDecl()) 4729 return {NonCLikeKind::Invalid, {}}; 4730 4731 // C++ [dcl.typedef]p9: [P1766R1] 4732 // An unnamed class with a typedef name for linkage purposes shall not 4733 // 4734 // -- have any base classes 4735 if (RD->getNumBases()) 4736 return {NonCLikeKind::BaseClass, 4737 SourceRange(RD->bases_begin()->getBeginLoc(), 4738 RD->bases_end()[-1].getEndLoc())}; 4739 bool Invalid = false; 4740 for (Decl *D : RD->decls()) { 4741 // Don't complain about things we already diagnosed. 4742 if (D->isInvalidDecl()) { 4743 Invalid = true; 4744 continue; 4745 } 4746 4747 // -- have any [...] default member initializers 4748 if (auto *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(D)) { 4749 if (FD->hasInClassInitializer()) { 4750 auto *Init = FD->getInClassInitializer(); 4751 return {NonCLikeKind::DefaultMemberInit, 4752 Init ? Init->getSourceRange() : D->getSourceRange()}; 4753 } 4754 continue; 4755 } 4756 4757 // FIXME: We don't allow friend declarations. This violates the wording of 4758 // P1766, but not the intent. 4759 if (isa<FriendDecl>(D)) 4760 return {NonCLikeKind::Friend, D->getSourceRange()}; 4761 4762 // -- declare any members other than non-static data members, member 4763 // enumerations, or member classes, 4764 if (isa<StaticAssertDecl>(D) || isa<IndirectFieldDecl>(D) || 4765 isa<EnumDecl>(D)) 4766 continue; 4767 auto *MemberRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D); 4768 if (!MemberRD) { 4769 if (D->isImplicit()) 4770 continue; 4771 return {NonCLikeKind::OtherMember, D->getSourceRange()}; 4772 } 4773 4774 // -- contain a lambda-expression, 4775 if (MemberRD->isLambda()) 4776 return {NonCLikeKind::Lambda, MemberRD->getSourceRange()}; 4777 4778 // and all member classes shall also satisfy these requirements 4779 // (recursively). 4780 if (MemberRD->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) { 4781 if (auto Kind = getNonCLikeKindForAnonymousStruct(MemberRD)) 4782 return Kind; 4783 } 4784 } 4785 4786 return {Invalid ? NonCLikeKind::Invalid : NonCLikeKind::None, {}}; 4787 } 4788 4789 void Sema::setTagNameForLinkagePurposes(TagDecl *TagFromDeclSpec, 4790 TypedefNameDecl *NewTD) { 4791 if (TagFromDeclSpec->isInvalidDecl()) 4792 return; 4793 4794 // Do nothing if the tag already has a name for linkage purposes. 4795 if (TagFromDeclSpec->hasNameForLinkage()) 4796 return; 4797 4798 // A well-formed anonymous tag must always be a TUK_Definition. 4799 assert(TagFromDeclSpec->isThisDeclarationADefinition()); 4800 4801 // The type must match the tag exactly; no qualifiers allowed. 4802 if (!Context.hasSameType(NewTD->getUnderlyingType(), 4803 Context.getTagDeclType(TagFromDeclSpec))) { 4804 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 4805 Context.addTypedefNameForUnnamedTagDecl(TagFromDeclSpec, NewTD); 4806 return; 4807 } 4808 4809 // C++ [dcl.typedef]p9: [P1766R1, applied as DR] 4810 // An unnamed class with a typedef name for linkage purposes shall [be 4811 // C-like]. 4812 // 4813 // FIXME: Also diagnose if we've already computed the linkage. That ideally 4814 // shouldn't happen, but there are constructs that the language rule doesn't 4815 // disallow for which we can't reasonably avoid computing linkage early. 4816 const CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TagFromDeclSpec); 4817 NonCLikeKind NonCLike = RD ? getNonCLikeKindForAnonymousStruct(RD) 4818 : NonCLikeKind(); 4819 bool ChangesLinkage = TagFromDeclSpec->hasLinkageBeenComputed(); 4820 if (NonCLike || ChangesLinkage) { 4821 if (NonCLike.Kind == NonCLikeKind::Invalid) 4822 return; 4823 4824 unsigned DiagID = diag::ext_non_c_like_anon_struct_in_typedef; 4825 if (ChangesLinkage) { 4826 // If the linkage changes, we can't accept this as an extension. 4827 if (NonCLike.Kind == NonCLikeKind::None) 4828 DiagID = diag::err_typedef_changes_linkage; 4829 else 4830 DiagID = diag::err_non_c_like_anon_struct_in_typedef; 4831 } 4832 4833 SourceLocation FixitLoc = 4834 getLocForEndOfToken(TagFromDeclSpec->getInnerLocStart()); 4835 llvm::SmallString<40> TextToInsert; 4836 TextToInsert += ' '; 4837 TextToInsert += NewTD->getIdentifier()->getName(); 4838 4839 Diag(FixitLoc, DiagID) 4840 << isa<TypeAliasDecl>(NewTD) 4841 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FixitLoc, TextToInsert); 4842 if (NonCLike.Kind != NonCLikeKind::None) { 4843 Diag(NonCLike.Range.getBegin(), diag::note_non_c_like_anon_struct) 4844 << NonCLike.Kind - 1 << NonCLike.Range; 4845 } 4846 Diag(NewTD->getLocation(), diag::note_typedef_for_linkage_here) 4847 << NewTD << isa<TypeAliasDecl>(NewTD); 4848 4849 if (ChangesLinkage) 4850 return; 4851 } 4852 4853 // Otherwise, set this as the anon-decl typedef for the tag. 4854 TagFromDeclSpec->setTypedefNameForAnonDecl(NewTD); 4855 } 4856 4857 static unsigned GetDiagnosticTypeSpecifierID(DeclSpec::TST T) { 4858 switch (T) { 4859 case DeclSpec::TST_class: 4860 return 0; 4861 case DeclSpec::TST_struct: 4862 return 1; 4863 case DeclSpec::TST_interface: 4864 return 2; 4865 case DeclSpec::TST_union: 4866 return 3; 4867 case DeclSpec::TST_enum: 4868 return 4; 4869 default: 4870 llvm_unreachable("unexpected type specifier"); 4871 } 4872 } 4873 4874 /// ParsedFreeStandingDeclSpec - This method is invoked when a declspec with 4875 /// no declarator (e.g. "struct foo;") is parsed. It also accepts template 4876 /// parameters to cope with template friend declarations. 4877 Decl * 4878 Sema::ParsedFreeStandingDeclSpec(Scope *S, AccessSpecifier AS, DeclSpec &DS, 4879 MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParams, 4880 bool IsExplicitInstantiation, 4881 RecordDecl *&AnonRecord) { 4882 Decl *TagD = nullptr; 4883 TagDecl *Tag = nullptr; 4884 if (DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_class || 4885 DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_struct || 4886 DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_interface || 4887 DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_union || 4888 DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_enum) { 4889 TagD = DS.getRepAsDecl(); 4890 4891 if (!TagD) // We probably had an error 4892 return nullptr; 4893 4894 // Note that the above type specs guarantee that the 4895 // type rep is a Decl, whereas in many of the others 4896 // it's a Type. 4897 if (isa<TagDecl>(TagD)) 4898 Tag = cast<TagDecl>(TagD); 4899 else if (ClassTemplateDecl *CTD = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateDecl>(TagD)) 4900 Tag = CTD->getTemplatedDecl(); 4901 } 4902 4903 if (Tag) { 4904 handleTagNumbering(Tag, S); 4905 Tag->setFreeStanding(); 4906 if (Tag->isInvalidDecl()) 4907 return Tag; 4908 } 4909 4910 if (unsigned TypeQuals = DS.getTypeQualifiers()) { 4911 // Enforce C99 6.7.3p2: "Types other than pointer types derived from object 4912 // or incomplete types shall not be restrict-qualified." 4913 if (TypeQuals & DeclSpec::TQ_restrict) 4914 Diag(DS.getRestrictSpecLoc(), 4915 diag::err_typecheck_invalid_restrict_not_pointer_noarg) 4916 << DS.getSourceRange(); 4917 } 4918 4919 if (DS.isInlineSpecified()) 4920 Diag(DS.getInlineSpecLoc(), diag::err_inline_non_function) 4921 << getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17; 4922 4923 if (DS.hasConstexprSpecifier()) { 4924 // C++0x [dcl.constexpr]p1: constexpr can only be applied to declarations 4925 // and definitions of functions and variables. 4926 // C++2a [dcl.constexpr]p1: The consteval specifier shall be applied only to 4927 // the declaration of a function or function template 4928 if (Tag) 4929 Diag(DS.getConstexprSpecLoc(), diag::err_constexpr_tag) 4930 << GetDiagnosticTypeSpecifierID(DS.getTypeSpecType()) 4931 << static_cast<int>(DS.getConstexprSpecifier()); 4932 else 4933 Diag(DS.getConstexprSpecLoc(), diag::err_constexpr_wrong_decl_kind) 4934 << static_cast<int>(DS.getConstexprSpecifier()); 4935 // Don't emit warnings after this error. 4936 return TagD; 4937 } 4938 4939 DiagnoseFunctionSpecifiers(DS); 4940 4941 if (DS.isFriendSpecified()) { 4942 // If we're dealing with a decl but not a TagDecl, assume that 4943 // whatever routines created it handled the friendship aspect. 4944 if (TagD && !Tag) 4945 return nullptr; 4946 return ActOnFriendTypeDecl(S, DS, TemplateParams); 4947 } 4948 4949 const CXXScopeSpec &SS = DS.getTypeSpecScope(); 4950 bool IsExplicitSpecialization = 4951 !TemplateParams.empty() && TemplateParams.back()->size() == 0; 4952 if (Tag && SS.isNotEmpty() && !Tag->isCompleteDefinition() && 4953 !IsExplicitInstantiation && !IsExplicitSpecialization && 4954 !isa<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(Tag)) { 4955 // Per C++ [dcl.type.elab]p1, a class declaration cannot have a 4956 // nested-name-specifier unless it is an explicit instantiation 4957 // or an explicit specialization. 4958 // 4959 // FIXME: We allow class template partial specializations here too, per the 4960 // obvious intent of DR1819. 4961 // 4962 // Per C++ [dcl.enum]p1, an opaque-enum-declaration can't either. 4963 Diag(SS.getBeginLoc(), diag::err_standalone_class_nested_name_specifier) 4964 << GetDiagnosticTypeSpecifierID(DS.getTypeSpecType()) << SS.getRange(); 4965 return nullptr; 4966 } 4967 4968 // Track whether this decl-specifier declares anything. 4969 bool DeclaresAnything = true; 4970 4971 // Handle anonymous struct definitions. 4972 if (RecordDecl *Record = dyn_cast_or_null<RecordDecl>(Tag)) { 4973 if (!Record->getDeclName() && Record->isCompleteDefinition() && 4974 DS.getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_typedef) { 4975 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || 4976 Record->getDeclContext()->isRecord()) { 4977 // If CurContext is a DeclContext that can contain statements, 4978 // RecursiveASTVisitor won't visit the decls that 4979 // BuildAnonymousStructOrUnion() will put into CurContext. 4980 // Also store them here so that they can be part of the 4981 // DeclStmt that gets created in this case. 4982 // FIXME: Also return the IndirectFieldDecls created by 4983 // BuildAnonymousStructOr union, for the same reason? 4984 if (CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod()) 4985 AnonRecord = Record; 4986 return BuildAnonymousStructOrUnion(S, DS, AS, Record, 4987 Context.getPrintingPolicy()); 4988 } 4989 4990 DeclaresAnything = false; 4991 } 4992 } 4993 4994 // C11 6.7.2.1p2: 4995 // A struct-declaration that does not declare an anonymous structure or 4996 // anonymous union shall contain a struct-declarator-list. 4997 // 4998 // This rule also existed in C89 and C99; the grammar for struct-declaration 4999 // did not permit a struct-declaration without a struct-declarator-list. 5000 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && CurContext->isRecord() && 5001 DS.getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_unspecified) { 5002 // Check for Microsoft C extension: anonymous struct/union member. 5003 // Handle 2 kinds of anonymous struct/union: 5004 // struct STRUCT; 5005 // union UNION; 5006 // and 5007 // STRUCT_TYPE; <- where STRUCT_TYPE is a typedef struct. 5008 // UNION_TYPE; <- where UNION_TYPE is a typedef union. 5009 if ((Tag && Tag->getDeclName()) || 5010 DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_typename) { 5011 RecordDecl *Record = nullptr; 5012 if (Tag) 5013 Record = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Tag); 5014 else if (const RecordType *RT = 5015 DS.getRepAsType().get()->getAsStructureType()) 5016 Record = RT->getDecl(); 5017 else if (const RecordType *UT = DS.getRepAsType().get()->getAsUnionType()) 5018 Record = UT->getDecl(); 5019 5020 if (Record && getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt) { 5021 Diag(DS.getBeginLoc(), diag::ext_ms_anonymous_record) 5022 << Record->isUnion() << DS.getSourceRange(); 5023 return BuildMicrosoftCAnonymousStruct(S, DS, Record); 5024 } 5025 5026 DeclaresAnything = false; 5027 } 5028 } 5029 5030 // Skip all the checks below if we have a type error. 5031 if (DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_error || 5032 (TagD && TagD->isInvalidDecl())) 5033 return TagD; 5034 5035 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 5036 DS.getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_typedef) 5037 if (EnumDecl *Enum = dyn_cast_or_null<EnumDecl>(Tag)) 5038 if (Enum->enumerator_begin() == Enum->enumerator_end() && 5039 !Enum->getIdentifier() && !Enum->isInvalidDecl()) 5040 DeclaresAnything = false; 5041 5042 if (!DS.isMissingDeclaratorOk()) { 5043 // Customize diagnostic for a typedef missing a name. 5044 if (DS.getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_typedef) 5045 Diag(DS.getBeginLoc(), diag::ext_typedef_without_a_name) 5046 << DS.getSourceRange(); 5047 else 5048 DeclaresAnything = false; 5049 } 5050 5051 if (DS.isModulePrivateSpecified() && 5052 Tag && Tag->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod()) 5053 Diag(DS.getModulePrivateSpecLoc(), diag::err_module_private_local_class) 5054 << Tag->getTagKind() 5055 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getModulePrivateSpecLoc()); 5056 5057 ActOnDocumentableDecl(TagD); 5058 5059 // C 6.7/2: 5060 // A declaration [...] shall declare at least a declarator [...], a tag, 5061 // or the members of an enumeration. 5062 // C++ [dcl.dcl]p3: 5063 // [If there are no declarators], and except for the declaration of an 5064 // unnamed bit-field, the decl-specifier-seq shall introduce one or more 5065 // names into the program, or shall redeclare a name introduced by a 5066 // previous declaration. 5067 if (!DeclaresAnything) { 5068 // In C, we allow this as a (popular) extension / bug. Don't bother 5069 // producing further diagnostics for redundant qualifiers after this. 5070 Diag(DS.getBeginLoc(), (IsExplicitInstantiation || !TemplateParams.empty()) 5071 ? diag::err_no_declarators 5072 : diag::ext_no_declarators) 5073 << DS.getSourceRange(); 5074 return TagD; 5075 } 5076 5077 // C++ [dcl.stc]p1: 5078 // If a storage-class-specifier appears in a decl-specifier-seq, [...] the 5079 // init-declarator-list of the declaration shall not be empty. 5080 // C++ [dcl.fct.spec]p1: 5081 // If a cv-qualifier appears in a decl-specifier-seq, the 5082 // init-declarator-list of the declaration shall not be empty. 5083 // 5084 // Spurious qualifiers here appear to be valid in C. 5085 unsigned DiagID = diag::warn_standalone_specifier; 5086 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 5087 DiagID = diag::ext_standalone_specifier; 5088 5089 // Note that a linkage-specification sets a storage class, but 5090 // 'extern "C" struct foo;' is actually valid and not theoretically 5091 // useless. 5092 if (DeclSpec::SCS SCS = DS.getStorageClassSpec()) { 5093 if (SCS == DeclSpec::SCS_mutable) 5094 // Since mutable is not a viable storage class specifier in C, there is 5095 // no reason to treat it as an extension. Instead, diagnose as an error. 5096 Diag(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc(), diag::err_mutable_nonmember); 5097 else if (!DS.isExternInLinkageSpec() && SCS != DeclSpec::SCS_typedef) 5098 Diag(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc(), DiagID) 5099 << DeclSpec::getSpecifierName(SCS); 5100 } 5101 5102 if (DeclSpec::TSCS TSCS = DS.getThreadStorageClassSpec()) 5103 Diag(DS.getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(), DiagID) 5104 << DeclSpec::getSpecifierName(TSCS); 5105 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers()) { 5106 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_const) 5107 Diag(DS.getConstSpecLoc(), DiagID) << "const"; 5108 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_volatile) 5109 Diag(DS.getConstSpecLoc(), DiagID) << "volatile"; 5110 // Restrict is covered above. 5111 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_atomic) 5112 Diag(DS.getAtomicSpecLoc(), DiagID) << "_Atomic"; 5113 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_unaligned) 5114 Diag(DS.getUnalignedSpecLoc(), DiagID) << "__unaligned"; 5115 } 5116 5117 // Warn about ignored type attributes, for example: 5118 // __attribute__((aligned)) struct A; 5119 // Attributes should be placed after tag to apply to type declaration. 5120 if (!DS.getAttributes().empty()) { 5121 DeclSpec::TST TypeSpecType = DS.getTypeSpecType(); 5122 if (TypeSpecType == DeclSpec::TST_class || 5123 TypeSpecType == DeclSpec::TST_struct || 5124 TypeSpecType == DeclSpec::TST_interface || 5125 TypeSpecType == DeclSpec::TST_union || 5126 TypeSpecType == DeclSpec::TST_enum) { 5127 for (const ParsedAttr &AL : DS.getAttributes()) 5128 Diag(AL.getLoc(), diag::warn_declspec_attribute_ignored) 5129 << AL << GetDiagnosticTypeSpecifierID(TypeSpecType); 5130 } 5131 } 5132 5133 return TagD; 5134 } 5135 5136 /// We are trying to inject an anonymous member into the given scope; 5137 /// check if there's an existing declaration that can't be overloaded. 5138 /// 5139 /// \return true if this is a forbidden redeclaration 5140 static bool CheckAnonMemberRedeclaration(Sema &SemaRef, 5141 Scope *S, 5142 DeclContext *Owner, 5143 DeclarationName Name, 5144 SourceLocation NameLoc, 5145 bool IsUnion) { 5146 LookupResult R(SemaRef, Name, NameLoc, Sema::LookupMemberName, 5147 Sema::ForVisibleRedeclaration); 5148 if (!SemaRef.LookupName(R, S)) return false; 5149 5150 // Pick a representative declaration. 5151 NamedDecl *PrevDecl = R.getRepresentativeDecl()->getUnderlyingDecl(); 5152 assert(PrevDecl && "Expected a non-null Decl"); 5153 5154 if (!SemaRef.isDeclInScope(PrevDecl, Owner, S)) 5155 return false; 5156 5157 SemaRef.Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_anonymous_record_member_redecl) 5158 << IsUnion << Name; 5159 SemaRef.Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 5160 5161 return true; 5162 } 5163 5164 /// InjectAnonymousStructOrUnionMembers - Inject the members of the 5165 /// anonymous struct or union AnonRecord into the owning context Owner 5166 /// and scope S. This routine will be invoked just after we realize 5167 /// that an unnamed union or struct is actually an anonymous union or 5168 /// struct, e.g., 5169 /// 5170 /// @code 5171 /// union { 5172 /// int i; 5173 /// float f; 5174 /// }; // InjectAnonymousStructOrUnionMembers called here to inject i and 5175 /// // f into the surrounding scope.x 5176 /// @endcode 5177 /// 5178 /// This routine is recursive, injecting the names of nested anonymous 5179 /// structs/unions into the owning context and scope as well. 5180 static bool 5181 InjectAnonymousStructOrUnionMembers(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, DeclContext *Owner, 5182 RecordDecl *AnonRecord, AccessSpecifier AS, 5183 SmallVectorImpl<NamedDecl *> &Chaining) { 5184 bool Invalid = false; 5185 5186 // Look every FieldDecl and IndirectFieldDecl with a name. 5187 for (auto *D : AnonRecord->decls()) { 5188 if ((isa<FieldDecl>(D) || isa<IndirectFieldDecl>(D)) && 5189 cast<NamedDecl>(D)->getDeclName()) { 5190 ValueDecl *VD = cast<ValueDecl>(D); 5191 if (CheckAnonMemberRedeclaration(SemaRef, S, Owner, VD->getDeclName(), 5192 VD->getLocation(), 5193 AnonRecord->isUnion())) { 5194 // C++ [class.union]p2: 5195 // The names of the members of an anonymous union shall be 5196 // distinct from the names of any other entity in the 5197 // scope in which the anonymous union is declared. 5198 Invalid = true; 5199 } else { 5200 // C++ [class.union]p2: 5201 // For the purpose of name lookup, after the anonymous union 5202 // definition, the members of the anonymous union are 5203 // considered to have been defined in the scope in which the 5204 // anonymous union is declared. 5205 unsigned OldChainingSize = Chaining.size(); 5206 if (IndirectFieldDecl *IF = dyn_cast<IndirectFieldDecl>(VD)) 5207 Chaining.append(IF->chain_begin(), IF->chain_end()); 5208 else 5209 Chaining.push_back(VD); 5210 5211 assert(Chaining.size() >= 2); 5212 NamedDecl **NamedChain = 5213 new (SemaRef.Context)NamedDecl*[Chaining.size()]; 5214 for (unsigned i = 0; i < Chaining.size(); i++) 5215 NamedChain[i] = Chaining[i]; 5216 5217 IndirectFieldDecl *IndirectField = IndirectFieldDecl::Create( 5218 SemaRef.Context, Owner, VD->getLocation(), VD->getIdentifier(), 5219 VD->getType(), {NamedChain, Chaining.size()}); 5220 5221 for (const auto *Attr : VD->attrs()) 5222 IndirectField->addAttr(Attr->clone(SemaRef.Context)); 5223 5224 IndirectField->setAccess(AS); 5225 IndirectField->setImplicit(); 5226 SemaRef.PushOnScopeChains(IndirectField, S); 5227 5228 // That includes picking up the appropriate access specifier. 5229 if (AS != AS_none) IndirectField->setAccess(AS); 5230 5231 Chaining.resize(OldChainingSize); 5232 } 5233 } 5234 } 5235 5236 return Invalid; 5237 } 5238 5239 /// StorageClassSpecToVarDeclStorageClass - Maps a DeclSpec::SCS to 5240 /// a VarDecl::StorageClass. Any error reporting is up to the caller: 5241 /// illegal input values are mapped to SC_None. 5242 static StorageClass 5243 StorageClassSpecToVarDeclStorageClass(const DeclSpec &DS) { 5244 DeclSpec::SCS StorageClassSpec = DS.getStorageClassSpec(); 5245 assert(StorageClassSpec != DeclSpec::SCS_typedef && 5246 "Parser allowed 'typedef' as storage class VarDecl."); 5247 switch (StorageClassSpec) { 5248 case DeclSpec::SCS_unspecified: return SC_None; 5249 case DeclSpec::SCS_extern: 5250 if (DS.isExternInLinkageSpec()) 5251 return SC_None; 5252 return SC_Extern; 5253 case DeclSpec::SCS_static: return SC_Static; 5254 case DeclSpec::SCS_auto: return SC_Auto; 5255 case DeclSpec::SCS_register: return SC_Register; 5256 case DeclSpec::SCS_private_extern: return SC_PrivateExtern; 5257 // Illegal SCSs map to None: error reporting is up to the caller. 5258 case DeclSpec::SCS_mutable: // Fall through. 5259 case DeclSpec::SCS_typedef: return SC_None; 5260 } 5261 llvm_unreachable("unknown storage class specifier"); 5262 } 5263 5264 static SourceLocation findDefaultInitializer(const CXXRecordDecl *Record) { 5265 assert(Record->hasInClassInitializer()); 5266 5267 for (const auto *I : Record->decls()) { 5268 const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(I); 5269 if (const auto *IFD = dyn_cast<IndirectFieldDecl>(I)) 5270 FD = IFD->getAnonField(); 5271 if (FD && FD->hasInClassInitializer()) 5272 return FD->getLocation(); 5273 } 5274 5275 llvm_unreachable("couldn't find in-class initializer"); 5276 } 5277 5278 static void checkDuplicateDefaultInit(Sema &S, CXXRecordDecl *Parent, 5279 SourceLocation DefaultInitLoc) { 5280 if (!Parent->isUnion() || !Parent->hasInClassInitializer()) 5281 return; 5282 5283 S.Diag(DefaultInitLoc, diag::err_multiple_mem_union_initialization); 5284 S.Diag(findDefaultInitializer(Parent), diag::note_previous_initializer) << 0; 5285 } 5286 5287 static void checkDuplicateDefaultInit(Sema &S, CXXRecordDecl *Parent, 5288 CXXRecordDecl *AnonUnion) { 5289 if (!Parent->isUnion() || !Parent->hasInClassInitializer()) 5290 return; 5291 5292 checkDuplicateDefaultInit(S, Parent, findDefaultInitializer(AnonUnion)); 5293 } 5294 5295 /// BuildAnonymousStructOrUnion - Handle the declaration of an 5296 /// anonymous structure or union. Anonymous unions are a C++ feature 5297 /// (C++ [class.union]) and a C11 feature; anonymous structures 5298 /// are a C11 feature and GNU C++ extension. 5299 Decl *Sema::BuildAnonymousStructOrUnion(Scope *S, DeclSpec &DS, 5300 AccessSpecifier AS, 5301 RecordDecl *Record, 5302 const PrintingPolicy &Policy) { 5303 DeclContext *Owner = Record->getDeclContext(); 5304 5305 // Diagnose whether this anonymous struct/union is an extension. 5306 if (Record->isUnion() && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !getLangOpts().C11) 5307 Diag(Record->getLocation(), diag::ext_anonymous_union); 5308 else if (!Record->isUnion() && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 5309 Diag(Record->getLocation(), diag::ext_gnu_anonymous_struct); 5310 else if (!Record->isUnion() && !getLangOpts().C11) 5311 Diag(Record->getLocation(), diag::ext_c11_anonymous_struct); 5312 5313 // C and C++ require different kinds of checks for anonymous 5314 // structs/unions. 5315 bool Invalid = false; 5316 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 5317 const char *PrevSpec = nullptr; 5318 if (Record->isUnion()) { 5319 // C++ [class.union]p6: 5320 // C++17 [class.union.anon]p2: 5321 // Anonymous unions declared in a named namespace or in the 5322 // global namespace shall be declared static. 5323 unsigned DiagID; 5324 DeclContext *OwnerScope = Owner->getRedeclContext(); 5325 if (DS.getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_static && 5326 (OwnerScope->isTranslationUnit() || 5327 (OwnerScope->isNamespace() && 5328 !cast<NamespaceDecl>(OwnerScope)->isAnonymousNamespace()))) { 5329 Diag(Record->getLocation(), diag::err_anonymous_union_not_static) 5330 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Record->getLocation(), "static "); 5331 5332 // Recover by adding 'static'. 5333 DS.SetStorageClassSpec(*this, DeclSpec::SCS_static, SourceLocation(), 5334 PrevSpec, DiagID, Policy); 5335 } 5336 // C++ [class.union]p6: 5337 // A storage class is not allowed in a declaration of an 5338 // anonymous union in a class scope. 5339 else if (DS.getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_unspecified && 5340 isa<RecordDecl>(Owner)) { 5341 Diag(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc(), 5342 diag::err_anonymous_union_with_storage_spec) 5343 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc()); 5344 5345 // Recover by removing the storage specifier. 5346 DS.SetStorageClassSpec(*this, DeclSpec::SCS_unspecified, 5347 SourceLocation(), 5348 PrevSpec, DiagID, Context.getPrintingPolicy()); 5349 } 5350 } 5351 5352 // Ignore const/volatile/restrict qualifiers. 5353 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers()) { 5354 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_const) 5355 Diag(DS.getConstSpecLoc(), diag::ext_anonymous_struct_union_qualified) 5356 << Record->isUnion() << "const" 5357 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getConstSpecLoc()); 5358 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_volatile) 5359 Diag(DS.getVolatileSpecLoc(), 5360 diag::ext_anonymous_struct_union_qualified) 5361 << Record->isUnion() << "volatile" 5362 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getVolatileSpecLoc()); 5363 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_restrict) 5364 Diag(DS.getRestrictSpecLoc(), 5365 diag::ext_anonymous_struct_union_qualified) 5366 << Record->isUnion() << "restrict" 5367 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getRestrictSpecLoc()); 5368 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_atomic) 5369 Diag(DS.getAtomicSpecLoc(), 5370 diag::ext_anonymous_struct_union_qualified) 5371 << Record->isUnion() << "_Atomic" 5372 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getAtomicSpecLoc()); 5373 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_unaligned) 5374 Diag(DS.getUnalignedSpecLoc(), 5375 diag::ext_anonymous_struct_union_qualified) 5376 << Record->isUnion() << "__unaligned" 5377 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getUnalignedSpecLoc()); 5378 5379 DS.ClearTypeQualifiers(); 5380 } 5381 5382 // C++ [class.union]p2: 5383 // The member-specification of an anonymous union shall only 5384 // define non-static data members. [Note: nested types and 5385 // functions cannot be declared within an anonymous union. ] 5386 for (auto *Mem : Record->decls()) { 5387 // Ignore invalid declarations; we already diagnosed them. 5388 if (Mem->isInvalidDecl()) 5389 continue; 5390 5391 if (auto *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(Mem)) { 5392 // C++ [class.union]p3: 5393 // An anonymous union shall not have private or protected 5394 // members (clause 11). 5395 assert(FD->getAccess() != AS_none); 5396 if (FD->getAccess() != AS_public) { 5397 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_anonymous_record_nonpublic_member) 5398 << Record->isUnion() << (FD->getAccess() == AS_protected); 5399 Invalid = true; 5400 } 5401 5402 // C++ [class.union]p1 5403 // An object of a class with a non-trivial constructor, a non-trivial 5404 // copy constructor, a non-trivial destructor, or a non-trivial copy 5405 // assignment operator cannot be a member of a union, nor can an 5406 // array of such objects. 5407 if (CheckNontrivialField(FD)) 5408 Invalid = true; 5409 } else if (Mem->isImplicit()) { 5410 // Any implicit members are fine. 5411 } else if (isa<TagDecl>(Mem) && Mem->getDeclContext() != Record) { 5412 // This is a type that showed up in an 5413 // elaborated-type-specifier inside the anonymous struct or 5414 // union, but which actually declares a type outside of the 5415 // anonymous struct or union. It's okay. 5416 } else if (auto *MemRecord = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Mem)) { 5417 if (!MemRecord->isAnonymousStructOrUnion() && 5418 MemRecord->getDeclName()) { 5419 // Visual C++ allows type definition in anonymous struct or union. 5420 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt) 5421 Diag(MemRecord->getLocation(), diag::ext_anonymous_record_with_type) 5422 << Record->isUnion(); 5423 else { 5424 // This is a nested type declaration. 5425 Diag(MemRecord->getLocation(), diag::err_anonymous_record_with_type) 5426 << Record->isUnion(); 5427 Invalid = true; 5428 } 5429 } else { 5430 // This is an anonymous type definition within another anonymous type. 5431 // This is a popular extension, provided by Plan9, MSVC and GCC, but 5432 // not part of standard C++. 5433 Diag(MemRecord->getLocation(), 5434 diag::ext_anonymous_record_with_anonymous_type) 5435 << Record->isUnion(); 5436 } 5437 } else if (isa<AccessSpecDecl>(Mem)) { 5438 // Any access specifier is fine. 5439 } else if (isa<StaticAssertDecl>(Mem)) { 5440 // In C++1z, static_assert declarations are also fine. 5441 } else { 5442 // We have something that isn't a non-static data 5443 // member. Complain about it. 5444 unsigned DK = diag::err_anonymous_record_bad_member; 5445 if (isa<TypeDecl>(Mem)) 5446 DK = diag::err_anonymous_record_with_type; 5447 else if (isa<FunctionDecl>(Mem)) 5448 DK = diag::err_anonymous_record_with_function; 5449 else if (isa<VarDecl>(Mem)) 5450 DK = diag::err_anonymous_record_with_static; 5451 5452 // Visual C++ allows type definition in anonymous struct or union. 5453 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt && 5454 DK == diag::err_anonymous_record_with_type) 5455 Diag(Mem->getLocation(), diag::ext_anonymous_record_with_type) 5456 << Record->isUnion(); 5457 else { 5458 Diag(Mem->getLocation(), DK) << Record->isUnion(); 5459 Invalid = true; 5460 } 5461 } 5462 } 5463 5464 // C++11 [class.union]p8 (DR1460): 5465 // At most one variant member of a union may have a 5466 // brace-or-equal-initializer. 5467 if (cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record)->hasInClassInitializer() && 5468 Owner->isRecord()) 5469 checkDuplicateDefaultInit(*this, cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Owner), 5470 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record)); 5471 } 5472 5473 if (!Record->isUnion() && !Owner->isRecord()) { 5474 Diag(Record->getLocation(), diag::err_anonymous_struct_not_member) 5475 << getLangOpts().CPlusPlus; 5476 Invalid = true; 5477 } 5478 5479 // C++ [dcl.dcl]p3: 5480 // [If there are no declarators], and except for the declaration of an 5481 // unnamed bit-field, the decl-specifier-seq shall introduce one or more 5482 // names into the program 5483 // C++ [class.mem]p2: 5484 // each such member-declaration shall either declare at least one member 5485 // name of the class or declare at least one unnamed bit-field 5486 // 5487 // For C this is an error even for a named struct, and is diagnosed elsewhere. 5488 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && Record->field_empty()) 5489 Diag(DS.getBeginLoc(), diag::ext_no_declarators) << DS.getSourceRange(); 5490 5491 // Mock up a declarator. 5492 Declarator Dc(DS, DeclaratorContext::Member); 5493 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = GetTypeForDeclarator(Dc, S); 5494 assert(TInfo && "couldn't build declarator info for anonymous struct/union"); 5495 5496 // Create a declaration for this anonymous struct/union. 5497 NamedDecl *Anon = nullptr; 5498 if (RecordDecl *OwningClass = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Owner)) { 5499 Anon = FieldDecl::Create( 5500 Context, OwningClass, DS.getBeginLoc(), Record->getLocation(), 5501 /*IdentifierInfo=*/nullptr, Context.getTypeDeclType(Record), TInfo, 5502 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr, /*Mutable=*/false, 5503 /*InitStyle=*/ICIS_NoInit); 5504 Anon->setAccess(AS); 5505 ProcessDeclAttributes(S, Anon, Dc); 5506 5507 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 5508 FieldCollector->Add(cast<FieldDecl>(Anon)); 5509 } else { 5510 DeclSpec::SCS SCSpec = DS.getStorageClassSpec(); 5511 StorageClass SC = StorageClassSpecToVarDeclStorageClass(DS); 5512 if (SCSpec == DeclSpec::SCS_mutable) { 5513 // mutable can only appear on non-static class members, so it's always 5514 // an error here 5515 Diag(Record->getLocation(), diag::err_mutable_nonmember); 5516 Invalid = true; 5517 SC = SC_None; 5518 } 5519 5520 assert(DS.getAttributes().empty() && "No attribute expected"); 5521 Anon = VarDecl::Create(Context, Owner, DS.getBeginLoc(), 5522 Record->getLocation(), /*IdentifierInfo=*/nullptr, 5523 Context.getTypeDeclType(Record), TInfo, SC); 5524 5525 // Default-initialize the implicit variable. This initialization will be 5526 // trivial in almost all cases, except if a union member has an in-class 5527 // initializer: 5528 // union { int n = 0; }; 5529 ActOnUninitializedDecl(Anon); 5530 } 5531 Anon->setImplicit(); 5532 5533 // Mark this as an anonymous struct/union type. 5534 Record->setAnonymousStructOrUnion(true); 5535 5536 // Add the anonymous struct/union object to the current 5537 // context. We'll be referencing this object when we refer to one of 5538 // its members. 5539 Owner->addDecl(Anon); 5540 5541 // Inject the members of the anonymous struct/union into the owning 5542 // context and into the identifier resolver chain for name lookup 5543 // purposes. 5544 SmallVector<NamedDecl*, 2> Chain; 5545 Chain.push_back(Anon); 5546 5547 if (InjectAnonymousStructOrUnionMembers(*this, S, Owner, Record, AS, Chain)) 5548 Invalid = true; 5549 5550 if (VarDecl *NewVD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(Anon)) { 5551 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && NewVD->isStaticLocal()) { 5552 MangleNumberingContext *MCtx; 5553 Decl *ManglingContextDecl; 5554 std::tie(MCtx, ManglingContextDecl) = 5555 getCurrentMangleNumberContext(NewVD->getDeclContext()); 5556 if (MCtx) { 5557 Context.setManglingNumber( 5558 NewVD, MCtx->getManglingNumber( 5559 NewVD, getMSManglingNumber(getLangOpts(), S))); 5560 Context.setStaticLocalNumber(NewVD, MCtx->getStaticLocalNumber(NewVD)); 5561 } 5562 } 5563 } 5564 5565 if (Invalid) 5566 Anon->setInvalidDecl(); 5567 5568 return Anon; 5569 } 5570 5571 /// BuildMicrosoftCAnonymousStruct - Handle the declaration of an 5572 /// Microsoft C anonymous structure. 5573 /// Ref: http://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/z2cx9y4f.aspx 5574 /// Example: 5575 /// 5576 /// struct A { int a; }; 5577 /// struct B { struct A; int b; }; 5578 /// 5579 /// void foo() { 5580 /// B var; 5581 /// var.a = 3; 5582 /// } 5583 /// 5584 Decl *Sema::BuildMicrosoftCAnonymousStruct(Scope *S, DeclSpec &DS, 5585 RecordDecl *Record) { 5586 assert(Record && "expected a record!"); 5587 5588 // Mock up a declarator. 5589 Declarator Dc(DS, DeclaratorContext::TypeName); 5590 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = GetTypeForDeclarator(Dc, S); 5591 assert(TInfo && "couldn't build declarator info for anonymous struct"); 5592 5593 auto *ParentDecl = cast<RecordDecl>(CurContext); 5594 QualType RecTy = Context.getTypeDeclType(Record); 5595 5596 // Create a declaration for this anonymous struct. 5597 NamedDecl *Anon = 5598 FieldDecl::Create(Context, ParentDecl, DS.getBeginLoc(), DS.getBeginLoc(), 5599 /*IdentifierInfo=*/nullptr, RecTy, TInfo, 5600 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr, /*Mutable=*/false, 5601 /*InitStyle=*/ICIS_NoInit); 5602 Anon->setImplicit(); 5603 5604 // Add the anonymous struct object to the current context. 5605 CurContext->addDecl(Anon); 5606 5607 // Inject the members of the anonymous struct into the current 5608 // context and into the identifier resolver chain for name lookup 5609 // purposes. 5610 SmallVector<NamedDecl*, 2> Chain; 5611 Chain.push_back(Anon); 5612 5613 RecordDecl *RecordDef = Record->getDefinition(); 5614 if (RequireCompleteSizedType(Anon->getLocation(), RecTy, 5615 diag::err_field_incomplete_or_sizeless) || 5616 InjectAnonymousStructOrUnionMembers(*this, S, CurContext, RecordDef, 5617 AS_none, Chain)) { 5618 Anon->setInvalidDecl(); 5619 ParentDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 5620 } 5621 5622 return Anon; 5623 } 5624 5625 /// GetNameForDeclarator - Determine the full declaration name for the 5626 /// given Declarator. 5627 DeclarationNameInfo Sema::GetNameForDeclarator(Declarator &D) { 5628 return GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(D.getName()); 5629 } 5630 5631 /// Retrieves the declaration name from a parsed unqualified-id. 5632 DeclarationNameInfo 5633 Sema::GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(const UnqualifiedId &Name) { 5634 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo; 5635 NameInfo.setLoc(Name.StartLocation); 5636 5637 switch (Name.getKind()) { 5638 5639 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ImplicitSelfParam: 5640 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_Identifier: 5641 NameInfo.setName(Name.Identifier); 5642 return NameInfo; 5643 5644 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_DeductionGuideName: { 5645 // C++ [temp.deduct.guide]p3: 5646 // The simple-template-id shall name a class template specialization. 5647 // The template-name shall be the same identifier as the template-name 5648 // of the simple-template-id. 5649 // These together intend to imply that the template-name shall name a 5650 // class template. 5651 // FIXME: template<typename T> struct X {}; 5652 // template<typename T> using Y = X<T>; 5653 // Y(int) -> Y<int>; 5654 // satisfies these rules but does not name a class template. 5655 TemplateName TN = Name.TemplateName.get().get(); 5656 auto *Template = TN.getAsTemplateDecl(); 5657 if (!Template || !isa<ClassTemplateDecl>(Template)) { 5658 Diag(Name.StartLocation, 5659 diag::err_deduction_guide_name_not_class_template) 5660 << (int)getTemplateNameKindForDiagnostics(TN) << TN; 5661 if (Template) 5662 Diag(Template->getLocation(), diag::note_template_decl_here); 5663 return DeclarationNameInfo(); 5664 } 5665 5666 NameInfo.setName( 5667 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXDeductionGuideName(Template)); 5668 return NameInfo; 5669 } 5670 5671 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_OperatorFunctionId: 5672 NameInfo.setName(Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName( 5673 Name.OperatorFunctionId.Operator)); 5674 NameInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange( 5675 Name.OperatorFunctionId.SymbolLocations[0], Name.EndLocation)); 5676 return NameInfo; 5677 5678 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_LiteralOperatorId: 5679 NameInfo.setName(Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXLiteralOperatorName( 5680 Name.Identifier)); 5681 NameInfo.setCXXLiteralOperatorNameLoc(Name.EndLocation); 5682 return NameInfo; 5683 5684 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ConversionFunctionId: { 5685 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo; 5686 QualType Ty = GetTypeFromParser(Name.ConversionFunctionId, &TInfo); 5687 if (Ty.isNull()) 5688 return DeclarationNameInfo(); 5689 NameInfo.setName(Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXConversionFunctionName( 5690 Context.getCanonicalType(Ty))); 5691 NameInfo.setNamedTypeInfo(TInfo); 5692 return NameInfo; 5693 } 5694 5695 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ConstructorName: { 5696 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo; 5697 QualType Ty = GetTypeFromParser(Name.ConstructorName, &TInfo); 5698 if (Ty.isNull()) 5699 return DeclarationNameInfo(); 5700 NameInfo.setName(Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXConstructorName( 5701 Context.getCanonicalType(Ty))); 5702 NameInfo.setNamedTypeInfo(TInfo); 5703 return NameInfo; 5704 } 5705 5706 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ConstructorTemplateId: { 5707 // In well-formed code, we can only have a constructor 5708 // template-id that refers to the current context, so go there 5709 // to find the actual type being constructed. 5710 CXXRecordDecl *CurClass = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(CurContext); 5711 if (!CurClass || CurClass->getIdentifier() != Name.TemplateId->Name) 5712 return DeclarationNameInfo(); 5713 5714 // Determine the type of the class being constructed. 5715 QualType CurClassType = Context.getTypeDeclType(CurClass); 5716 5717 // FIXME: Check two things: that the template-id names the same type as 5718 // CurClassType, and that the template-id does not occur when the name 5719 // was qualified. 5720 5721 NameInfo.setName(Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXConstructorName( 5722 Context.getCanonicalType(CurClassType))); 5723 // FIXME: should we retrieve TypeSourceInfo? 5724 NameInfo.setNamedTypeInfo(nullptr); 5725 return NameInfo; 5726 } 5727 5728 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_DestructorName: { 5729 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo; 5730 QualType Ty = GetTypeFromParser(Name.DestructorName, &TInfo); 5731 if (Ty.isNull()) 5732 return DeclarationNameInfo(); 5733 NameInfo.setName(Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXDestructorName( 5734 Context.getCanonicalType(Ty))); 5735 NameInfo.setNamedTypeInfo(TInfo); 5736 return NameInfo; 5737 } 5738 5739 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId: { 5740 TemplateName TName = Name.TemplateId->Template.get(); 5741 SourceLocation TNameLoc = Name.TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc; 5742 return Context.getNameForTemplate(TName, TNameLoc); 5743 } 5744 5745 } // switch (Name.getKind()) 5746 5747 llvm_unreachable("Unknown name kind"); 5748 } 5749 5750 static QualType getCoreType(QualType Ty) { 5751 do { 5752 if (Ty->isPointerType() || Ty->isReferenceType()) 5753 Ty = Ty->getPointeeType(); 5754 else if (Ty->isArrayType()) 5755 Ty = Ty->castAsArrayTypeUnsafe()->getElementType(); 5756 else 5757 return Ty.withoutLocalFastQualifiers(); 5758 } while (true); 5759 } 5760 5761 /// hasSimilarParameters - Determine whether the C++ functions Declaration 5762 /// and Definition have "nearly" matching parameters. This heuristic is 5763 /// used to improve diagnostics in the case where an out-of-line function 5764 /// definition doesn't match any declaration within the class or namespace. 5765 /// Also sets Params to the list of indices to the parameters that differ 5766 /// between the declaration and the definition. If hasSimilarParameters 5767 /// returns true and Params is empty, then all of the parameters match. 5768 static bool hasSimilarParameters(ASTContext &Context, 5769 FunctionDecl *Declaration, 5770 FunctionDecl *Definition, 5771 SmallVectorImpl<unsigned> &Params) { 5772 Params.clear(); 5773 if (Declaration->param_size() != Definition->param_size()) 5774 return false; 5775 for (unsigned Idx = 0; Idx < Declaration->param_size(); ++Idx) { 5776 QualType DeclParamTy = Declaration->getParamDecl(Idx)->getType(); 5777 QualType DefParamTy = Definition->getParamDecl(Idx)->getType(); 5778 5779 // The parameter types are identical 5780 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(DefParamTy, DeclParamTy)) 5781 continue; 5782 5783 QualType DeclParamBaseTy = getCoreType(DeclParamTy); 5784 QualType DefParamBaseTy = getCoreType(DefParamTy); 5785 const IdentifierInfo *DeclTyName = DeclParamBaseTy.getBaseTypeIdentifier(); 5786 const IdentifierInfo *DefTyName = DefParamBaseTy.getBaseTypeIdentifier(); 5787 5788 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(DeclParamBaseTy, DefParamBaseTy) || 5789 (DeclTyName && DeclTyName == DefTyName)) 5790 Params.push_back(Idx); 5791 else // The two parameters aren't even close 5792 return false; 5793 } 5794 5795 return true; 5796 } 5797 5798 /// RebuildDeclaratorInCurrentInstantiation - Checks whether the given 5799 /// declarator needs to be rebuilt in the current instantiation. 5800 /// Any bits of declarator which appear before the name are valid for 5801 /// consideration here. That's specifically the type in the decl spec 5802 /// and the base type in any member-pointer chunks. 5803 static bool RebuildDeclaratorInCurrentInstantiation(Sema &S, Declarator &D, 5804 DeclarationName Name) { 5805 // The types we specifically need to rebuild are: 5806 // - typenames, typeofs, and decltypes 5807 // - types which will become injected class names 5808 // Of course, we also need to rebuild any type referencing such a 5809 // type. It's safest to just say "dependent", but we call out a 5810 // few cases here. 5811 5812 DeclSpec &DS = D.getMutableDeclSpec(); 5813 switch (DS.getTypeSpecType()) { 5814 case DeclSpec::TST_typename: 5815 case DeclSpec::TST_typeofType: 5816 case DeclSpec::TST_underlyingType: 5817 case DeclSpec::TST_atomic: { 5818 // Grab the type from the parser. 5819 TypeSourceInfo *TSI = nullptr; 5820 QualType T = S.GetTypeFromParser(DS.getRepAsType(), &TSI); 5821 if (T.isNull() || !T->isInstantiationDependentType()) break; 5822 5823 // Make sure there's a type source info. This isn't really much 5824 // of a waste; most dependent types should have type source info 5825 // attached already. 5826 if (!TSI) 5827 TSI = S.Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T, DS.getTypeSpecTypeLoc()); 5828 5829 // Rebuild the type in the current instantiation. 5830 TSI = S.RebuildTypeInCurrentInstantiation(TSI, D.getIdentifierLoc(), Name); 5831 if (!TSI) return true; 5832 5833 // Store the new type back in the decl spec. 5834 ParsedType LocType = S.CreateParsedType(TSI->getType(), TSI); 5835 DS.UpdateTypeRep(LocType); 5836 break; 5837 } 5838 5839 case DeclSpec::TST_decltype: 5840 case DeclSpec::TST_typeofExpr: { 5841 Expr *E = DS.getRepAsExpr(); 5842 ExprResult Result = S.RebuildExprInCurrentInstantiation(E); 5843 if (Result.isInvalid()) return true; 5844 DS.UpdateExprRep(Result.get()); 5845 break; 5846 } 5847 5848 default: 5849 // Nothing to do for these decl specs. 5850 break; 5851 } 5852 5853 // It doesn't matter what order we do this in. 5854 for (unsigned I = 0, E = D.getNumTypeObjects(); I != E; ++I) { 5855 DeclaratorChunk &Chunk = D.getTypeObject(I); 5856 5857 // The only type information in the declarator which can come 5858 // before the declaration name is the base type of a member 5859 // pointer. 5860 if (Chunk.Kind != DeclaratorChunk::MemberPointer) 5861 continue; 5862 5863 // Rebuild the scope specifier in-place. 5864 CXXScopeSpec &SS = Chunk.Mem.Scope(); 5865 if (S.RebuildNestedNameSpecifierInCurrentInstantiation(SS)) 5866 return true; 5867 } 5868 5869 return false; 5870 } 5871 5872 /// Returns true if the declaration is declared in a system header or from a 5873 /// system macro. 5874 static bool isFromSystemHeader(SourceManager &SM, const Decl *D) { 5875 return SM.isInSystemHeader(D->getLocation()) || 5876 SM.isInSystemMacro(D->getLocation()); 5877 } 5878 5879 void Sema::warnOnReservedIdentifier(const NamedDecl *D) { 5880 // Avoid warning twice on the same identifier, and don't warn on redeclaration 5881 // of system decl. 5882 if (D->getPreviousDecl() || D->isImplicit()) 5883 return; 5884 ReservedIdentifierStatus Status = D->isReserved(getLangOpts()); 5885 if (Status != ReservedIdentifierStatus::NotReserved && 5886 !isFromSystemHeader(Context.getSourceManager(), D)) { 5887 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::warn_reserved_extern_symbol) 5888 << D << static_cast<int>(Status); 5889 } 5890 } 5891 5892 Decl *Sema::ActOnDeclarator(Scope *S, Declarator &D) { 5893 D.setFunctionDefinitionKind(FunctionDefinitionKind::Declaration); 5894 Decl *Dcl = HandleDeclarator(S, D, MultiTemplateParamsArg()); 5895 5896 if (OriginalLexicalContext && OriginalLexicalContext->isObjCContainer() && 5897 Dcl && Dcl->getDeclContext()->isFileContext()) 5898 Dcl->setTopLevelDeclInObjCContainer(); 5899 5900 return Dcl; 5901 } 5902 5903 /// DiagnoseClassNameShadow - Implement C++ [class.mem]p13: 5904 /// If T is the name of a class, then each of the following shall have a 5905 /// name different from T: 5906 /// - every static data member of class T; 5907 /// - every member function of class T 5908 /// - every member of class T that is itself a type; 5909 /// \returns true if the declaration name violates these rules. 5910 bool Sema::DiagnoseClassNameShadow(DeclContext *DC, 5911 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo) { 5912 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName(); 5913 5914 CXXRecordDecl *Record = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC); 5915 while (Record && Record->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) 5916 Record = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record->getParent()); 5917 if (Record && Record->getIdentifier() && Record->getDeclName() == Name) { 5918 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_member_name_of_class) << Name; 5919 return true; 5920 } 5921 5922 return false; 5923 } 5924 5925 /// Diagnose a declaration whose declarator-id has the given 5926 /// nested-name-specifier. 5927 /// 5928 /// \param SS The nested-name-specifier of the declarator-id. 5929 /// 5930 /// \param DC The declaration context to which the nested-name-specifier 5931 /// resolves. 5932 /// 5933 /// \param Name The name of the entity being declared. 5934 /// 5935 /// \param Loc The location of the name of the entity being declared. 5936 /// 5937 /// \param IsTemplateId Whether the name is a (simple-)template-id, and thus 5938 /// we're declaring an explicit / partial specialization / instantiation. 5939 /// 5940 /// \returns true if we cannot safely recover from this error, false otherwise. 5941 bool Sema::diagnoseQualifiedDeclaration(CXXScopeSpec &SS, DeclContext *DC, 5942 DeclarationName Name, 5943 SourceLocation Loc, bool IsTemplateId) { 5944 DeclContext *Cur = CurContext; 5945 while (isa<LinkageSpecDecl>(Cur) || isa<CapturedDecl>(Cur)) 5946 Cur = Cur->getParent(); 5947 5948 // If the user provided a superfluous scope specifier that refers back to the 5949 // class in which the entity is already declared, diagnose and ignore it. 5950 // 5951 // class X { 5952 // void X::f(); 5953 // }; 5954 // 5955 // Note, it was once ill-formed to give redundant qualification in all 5956 // contexts, but that rule was removed by DR482. 5957 if (Cur->Equals(DC)) { 5958 if (Cur->isRecord()) { 5959 Diag(Loc, LangOpts.MicrosoftExt ? diag::warn_member_extra_qualification 5960 : diag::err_member_extra_qualification) 5961 << Name << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(SS.getRange()); 5962 SS.clear(); 5963 } else { 5964 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_namespace_member_extra_qualification) << Name; 5965 } 5966 return false; 5967 } 5968 5969 // Check whether the qualifying scope encloses the scope of the original 5970 // declaration. For a template-id, we perform the checks in 5971 // CheckTemplateSpecializationScope. 5972 if (!Cur->Encloses(DC) && !IsTemplateId) { 5973 if (Cur->isRecord()) 5974 Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_qualification) 5975 << Name << SS.getRange(); 5976 else if (isa<TranslationUnitDecl>(DC)) 5977 Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_declarator_global_scope) 5978 << Name << SS.getRange(); 5979 else if (isa<FunctionDecl>(Cur)) 5980 Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_declarator_in_function) 5981 << Name << SS.getRange(); 5982 else if (isa<BlockDecl>(Cur)) 5983 Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_declarator_in_block) 5984 << Name << SS.getRange(); 5985 else if (isa<ExportDecl>(Cur)) { 5986 if (!isa<NamespaceDecl>(DC)) 5987 Diag(Loc, diag::err_export_non_namespace_scope_name) 5988 << Name << SS.getRange(); 5989 else 5990 // The cases that DC is not NamespaceDecl should be handled in 5991 // CheckRedeclarationExported. 5992 return false; 5993 } else 5994 Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_declarator_scope) 5995 << Name << cast<NamedDecl>(Cur) << cast<NamedDecl>(DC) << SS.getRange(); 5996 5997 return true; 5998 } 5999 6000 if (Cur->isRecord()) { 6001 // Cannot qualify members within a class. 6002 Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_qualification) 6003 << Name << SS.getRange(); 6004 SS.clear(); 6005 6006 // C++ constructors and destructors with incorrect scopes can break 6007 // our AST invariants by having the wrong underlying types. If 6008 // that's the case, then drop this declaration entirely. 6009 if ((Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConstructorName || 6010 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) && 6011 !Context.hasSameType(Name.getCXXNameType(), 6012 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Cur)))) 6013 return true; 6014 6015 return false; 6016 } 6017 6018 // C++11 [dcl.meaning]p1: 6019 // [...] "The nested-name-specifier of the qualified declarator-id shall 6020 // not begin with a decltype-specifer" 6021 NestedNameSpecifierLoc SpecLoc(SS.getScopeRep(), SS.location_data()); 6022 while (SpecLoc.getPrefix()) 6023 SpecLoc = SpecLoc.getPrefix(); 6024 if (isa_and_nonnull<DecltypeType>( 6025 SpecLoc.getNestedNameSpecifier()->getAsType())) 6026 Diag(Loc, diag::err_decltype_in_declarator) 6027 << SpecLoc.getTypeLoc().getSourceRange(); 6028 6029 return false; 6030 } 6031 6032 NamedDecl *Sema::HandleDeclarator(Scope *S, Declarator &D, 6033 MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParamLists) { 6034 // TODO: consider using NameInfo for diagnostic. 6035 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo = GetNameForDeclarator(D); 6036 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName(); 6037 6038 // All of these full declarators require an identifier. If it doesn't have 6039 // one, the ParsedFreeStandingDeclSpec action should be used. 6040 if (D.isDecompositionDeclarator()) { 6041 return ActOnDecompositionDeclarator(S, D, TemplateParamLists); 6042 } else if (!Name) { 6043 if (!D.isInvalidType()) // Reject this if we think it is valid. 6044 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getBeginLoc(), diag::err_declarator_need_ident) 6045 << D.getDeclSpec().getSourceRange() << D.getSourceRange(); 6046 return nullptr; 6047 } else if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(NameInfo, UPPC_DeclarationType)) 6048 return nullptr; 6049 6050 // The scope passed in may not be a decl scope. Zip up the scope tree until 6051 // we find one that is. 6052 while ((S->getFlags() & Scope::DeclScope) == 0 || 6053 (S->getFlags() & Scope::TemplateParamScope) != 0) 6054 S = S->getParent(); 6055 6056 DeclContext *DC = CurContext; 6057 if (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isInvalid()) 6058 D.setInvalidType(); 6059 else if (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet()) { 6060 if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(D.getCXXScopeSpec(), 6061 UPPC_DeclarationQualifier)) 6062 return nullptr; 6063 6064 bool EnteringContext = !D.getDeclSpec().isFriendSpecified(); 6065 DC = computeDeclContext(D.getCXXScopeSpec(), EnteringContext); 6066 if (!DC || isa<EnumDecl>(DC)) { 6067 // If we could not compute the declaration context, it's because the 6068 // declaration context is dependent but does not refer to a class, 6069 // class template, or class template partial specialization. Complain 6070 // and return early, to avoid the coming semantic disaster. 6071 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), 6072 diag::err_template_qualified_declarator_no_match) 6073 << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getScopeRep() 6074 << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getRange(); 6075 return nullptr; 6076 } 6077 bool IsDependentContext = DC->isDependentContext(); 6078 6079 if (!IsDependentContext && 6080 RequireCompleteDeclContext(D.getCXXScopeSpec(), DC)) 6081 return nullptr; 6082 6083 // If a class is incomplete, do not parse entities inside it. 6084 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC) && !cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)->hasDefinition()) { 6085 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), 6086 diag::err_member_def_undefined_record) 6087 << Name << DC << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getRange(); 6088 return nullptr; 6089 } 6090 if (!D.getDeclSpec().isFriendSpecified()) { 6091 if (diagnoseQualifiedDeclaration( 6092 D.getCXXScopeSpec(), DC, Name, D.getIdentifierLoc(), 6093 D.getName().getKind() == UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId)) { 6094 if (DC->isRecord()) 6095 return nullptr; 6096 6097 D.setInvalidType(); 6098 } 6099 } 6100 6101 // Check whether we need to rebuild the type of the given 6102 // declaration in the current instantiation. 6103 if (EnteringContext && IsDependentContext && 6104 TemplateParamLists.size() != 0) { 6105 ContextRAII SavedContext(*this, DC); 6106 if (RebuildDeclaratorInCurrentInstantiation(*this, D, Name)) 6107 D.setInvalidType(); 6108 } 6109 } 6110 6111 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = GetTypeForDeclarator(D, S); 6112 QualType R = TInfo->getType(); 6113 6114 if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(D.getIdentifierLoc(), TInfo, 6115 UPPC_DeclarationType)) 6116 D.setInvalidType(); 6117 6118 LookupResult Previous(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName, 6119 forRedeclarationInCurContext()); 6120 6121 // See if this is a redefinition of a variable in the same scope. 6122 if (!D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet()) { 6123 bool IsLinkageLookup = false; 6124 bool CreateBuiltins = false; 6125 6126 // If the declaration we're planning to build will be a function 6127 // or object with linkage, then look for another declaration with 6128 // linkage (C99 6.2.2p4-5 and C++ [basic.link]p6). 6129 // 6130 // If the declaration we're planning to build will be declared with 6131 // external linkage in the translation unit, create any builtin with 6132 // the same name. 6133 if (D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_typedef) 6134 /* Do nothing*/; 6135 else if (CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod() && 6136 (D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_extern || 6137 R->isFunctionType())) { 6138 IsLinkageLookup = true; 6139 CreateBuiltins = 6140 CurContext->getEnclosingNamespaceContext()->isTranslationUnit(); 6141 } else if (CurContext->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit() && 6142 D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_static) 6143 CreateBuiltins = true; 6144 6145 if (IsLinkageLookup) { 6146 Previous.clear(LookupRedeclarationWithLinkage); 6147 Previous.setRedeclarationKind(ForExternalRedeclaration); 6148 } 6149 6150 LookupName(Previous, S, CreateBuiltins); 6151 } else { // Something like "int foo::x;" 6152 LookupQualifiedName(Previous, DC); 6153 6154 // C++ [dcl.meaning]p1: 6155 // When the declarator-id is qualified, the declaration shall refer to a 6156 // previously declared member of the class or namespace to which the 6157 // qualifier refers (or, in the case of a namespace, of an element of the 6158 // inline namespace set of that namespace (7.3.1)) or to a specialization 6159 // thereof; [...] 6160 // 6161 // Note that we already checked the context above, and that we do not have 6162 // enough information to make sure that Previous contains the declaration 6163 // we want to match. For example, given: 6164 // 6165 // class X { 6166 // void f(); 6167 // void f(float); 6168 // }; 6169 // 6170 // void X::f(int) { } // ill-formed 6171 // 6172 // In this case, Previous will point to the overload set 6173 // containing the two f's declared in X, but neither of them 6174 // matches. 6175 6176 // C++ [dcl.meaning]p1: 6177 // [...] the member shall not merely have been introduced by a 6178 // using-declaration in the scope of the class or namespace nominated by 6179 // the nested-name-specifier of the declarator-id. 6180 RemoveUsingDecls(Previous); 6181 } 6182 6183 if (Previous.isSingleResult() && 6184 Previous.getFoundDecl()->isTemplateParameter()) { 6185 // Maybe we will complain about the shadowed template parameter. 6186 if (!D.isInvalidType()) 6187 DiagnoseTemplateParameterShadow(D.getIdentifierLoc(), 6188 Previous.getFoundDecl()); 6189 6190 // Just pretend that we didn't see the previous declaration. 6191 Previous.clear(); 6192 } 6193 6194 if (!R->isFunctionType() && DiagnoseClassNameShadow(DC, NameInfo)) 6195 // Forget that the previous declaration is the injected-class-name. 6196 Previous.clear(); 6197 6198 // In C++, the previous declaration we find might be a tag type 6199 // (class or enum). In this case, the new declaration will hide the 6200 // tag type. Note that this applies to functions, function templates, and 6201 // variables, but not to typedefs (C++ [dcl.typedef]p4) or variable templates. 6202 if (Previous.isSingleTagDecl() && 6203 D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_typedef && 6204 (TemplateParamLists.size() == 0 || R->isFunctionType())) 6205 Previous.clear(); 6206 6207 // Check that there are no default arguments other than in the parameters 6208 // of a function declaration (C++ only). 6209 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 6210 CheckExtraCXXDefaultArguments(D); 6211 6212 NamedDecl *New; 6213 6214 bool AddToScope = true; 6215 if (D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_typedef) { 6216 if (TemplateParamLists.size()) { 6217 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_template_typedef); 6218 return nullptr; 6219 } 6220 6221 New = ActOnTypedefDeclarator(S, D, DC, TInfo, Previous); 6222 } else if (R->isFunctionType()) { 6223 New = ActOnFunctionDeclarator(S, D, DC, TInfo, Previous, 6224 TemplateParamLists, 6225 AddToScope); 6226 } else { 6227 New = ActOnVariableDeclarator(S, D, DC, TInfo, Previous, TemplateParamLists, 6228 AddToScope); 6229 } 6230 6231 if (!New) 6232 return nullptr; 6233 6234 // If this has an identifier and is not a function template specialization, 6235 // add it to the scope stack. 6236 if (New->getDeclName() && AddToScope) 6237 PushOnScopeChains(New, S); 6238 6239 if (isInOpenMPDeclareTargetContext()) 6240 checkDeclIsAllowedInOpenMPTarget(nullptr, New); 6241 6242 return New; 6243 } 6244 6245 /// Helper method to turn variable array types into constant array 6246 /// types in certain situations which would otherwise be errors (for 6247 /// GCC compatibility). 6248 static QualType TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedType(QualType T, 6249 ASTContext &Context, 6250 bool &SizeIsNegative, 6251 llvm::APSInt &Oversized) { 6252 // This method tries to turn a variable array into a constant 6253 // array even when the size isn't an ICE. This is necessary 6254 // for compatibility with code that depends on gcc's buggy 6255 // constant expression folding, like struct {char x[(int)(char*)2];} 6256 SizeIsNegative = false; 6257 Oversized = 0; 6258 6259 if (T->isDependentType()) 6260 return QualType(); 6261 6262 QualifierCollector Qs; 6263 const Type *Ty = Qs.strip(T); 6264 6265 if (const PointerType* PTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(Ty)) { 6266 QualType Pointee = PTy->getPointeeType(); 6267 QualType FixedType = 6268 TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedType(Pointee, Context, SizeIsNegative, 6269 Oversized); 6270 if (FixedType.isNull()) return FixedType; 6271 FixedType = Context.getPointerType(FixedType); 6272 return Qs.apply(Context, FixedType); 6273 } 6274 if (const ParenType* PTy = dyn_cast<ParenType>(Ty)) { 6275 QualType Inner = PTy->getInnerType(); 6276 QualType FixedType = 6277 TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedType(Inner, Context, SizeIsNegative, 6278 Oversized); 6279 if (FixedType.isNull()) return FixedType; 6280 FixedType = Context.getParenType(FixedType); 6281 return Qs.apply(Context, FixedType); 6282 } 6283 6284 const VariableArrayType* VLATy = dyn_cast<VariableArrayType>(T); 6285 if (!VLATy) 6286 return QualType(); 6287 6288 QualType ElemTy = VLATy->getElementType(); 6289 if (ElemTy->isVariablyModifiedType()) { 6290 ElemTy = TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedType(ElemTy, Context, 6291 SizeIsNegative, Oversized); 6292 if (ElemTy.isNull()) 6293 return QualType(); 6294 } 6295 6296 Expr::EvalResult Result; 6297 if (!VLATy->getSizeExpr() || 6298 !VLATy->getSizeExpr()->EvaluateAsInt(Result, Context)) 6299 return QualType(); 6300 6301 llvm::APSInt Res = Result.Val.getInt(); 6302 6303 // Check whether the array size is negative. 6304 if (Res.isSigned() && Res.isNegative()) { 6305 SizeIsNegative = true; 6306 return QualType(); 6307 } 6308 6309 // Check whether the array is too large to be addressed. 6310 unsigned ActiveSizeBits = 6311 (!ElemTy->isDependentType() && !ElemTy->isVariablyModifiedType() && 6312 !ElemTy->isIncompleteType() && !ElemTy->isUndeducedType()) 6313 ? ConstantArrayType::getNumAddressingBits(Context, ElemTy, Res) 6314 : Res.getActiveBits(); 6315 if (ActiveSizeBits > ConstantArrayType::getMaxSizeBits(Context)) { 6316 Oversized = Res; 6317 return QualType(); 6318 } 6319 6320 QualType FoldedArrayType = Context.getConstantArrayType( 6321 ElemTy, Res, VLATy->getSizeExpr(), ArrayType::Normal, 0); 6322 return Qs.apply(Context, FoldedArrayType); 6323 } 6324 6325 static void 6326 FixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeLoc(TypeLoc SrcTL, TypeLoc DstTL) { 6327 SrcTL = SrcTL.getUnqualifiedLoc(); 6328 DstTL = DstTL.getUnqualifiedLoc(); 6329 if (PointerTypeLoc SrcPTL = SrcTL.getAs<PointerTypeLoc>()) { 6330 PointerTypeLoc DstPTL = DstTL.castAs<PointerTypeLoc>(); 6331 FixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeLoc(SrcPTL.getPointeeLoc(), 6332 DstPTL.getPointeeLoc()); 6333 DstPTL.setStarLoc(SrcPTL.getStarLoc()); 6334 return; 6335 } 6336 if (ParenTypeLoc SrcPTL = SrcTL.getAs<ParenTypeLoc>()) { 6337 ParenTypeLoc DstPTL = DstTL.castAs<ParenTypeLoc>(); 6338 FixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeLoc(SrcPTL.getInnerLoc(), 6339 DstPTL.getInnerLoc()); 6340 DstPTL.setLParenLoc(SrcPTL.getLParenLoc()); 6341 DstPTL.setRParenLoc(SrcPTL.getRParenLoc()); 6342 return; 6343 } 6344 ArrayTypeLoc SrcATL = SrcTL.castAs<ArrayTypeLoc>(); 6345 ArrayTypeLoc DstATL = DstTL.castAs<ArrayTypeLoc>(); 6346 TypeLoc SrcElemTL = SrcATL.getElementLoc(); 6347 TypeLoc DstElemTL = DstATL.getElementLoc(); 6348 if (VariableArrayTypeLoc SrcElemATL = 6349 SrcElemTL.getAs<VariableArrayTypeLoc>()) { 6350 ConstantArrayTypeLoc DstElemATL = DstElemTL.castAs<ConstantArrayTypeLoc>(); 6351 FixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeLoc(SrcElemATL, DstElemATL); 6352 } else { 6353 DstElemTL.initializeFullCopy(SrcElemTL); 6354 } 6355 DstATL.setLBracketLoc(SrcATL.getLBracketLoc()); 6356 DstATL.setSizeExpr(SrcATL.getSizeExpr()); 6357 DstATL.setRBracketLoc(SrcATL.getRBracketLoc()); 6358 } 6359 6360 /// Helper method to turn variable array types into constant array 6361 /// types in certain situations which would otherwise be errors (for 6362 /// GCC compatibility). 6363 static TypeSourceInfo* 6364 TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeSourceInfo(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, 6365 ASTContext &Context, 6366 bool &SizeIsNegative, 6367 llvm::APSInt &Oversized) { 6368 QualType FixedTy 6369 = TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedType(TInfo->getType(), Context, 6370 SizeIsNegative, Oversized); 6371 if (FixedTy.isNull()) 6372 return nullptr; 6373 TypeSourceInfo *FixedTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(FixedTy); 6374 FixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeLoc(TInfo->getTypeLoc(), 6375 FixedTInfo->getTypeLoc()); 6376 return FixedTInfo; 6377 } 6378 6379 /// Attempt to fold a variable-sized type to a constant-sized type, returning 6380 /// true if we were successful. 6381 bool Sema::tryToFixVariablyModifiedVarType(TypeSourceInfo *&TInfo, 6382 QualType &T, SourceLocation Loc, 6383 unsigned FailedFoldDiagID) { 6384 bool SizeIsNegative; 6385 llvm::APSInt Oversized; 6386 TypeSourceInfo *FixedTInfo = TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeSourceInfo( 6387 TInfo, Context, SizeIsNegative, Oversized); 6388 if (FixedTInfo) { 6389 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_vla_folded_to_constant); 6390 TInfo = FixedTInfo; 6391 T = FixedTInfo->getType(); 6392 return true; 6393 } 6394 6395 if (SizeIsNegative) 6396 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_negative_array_size); 6397 else if (Oversized.getBoolValue()) 6398 Diag(Loc, diag::err_array_too_large) << toString(Oversized, 10); 6399 else if (FailedFoldDiagID) 6400 Diag(Loc, FailedFoldDiagID); 6401 return false; 6402 } 6403 6404 /// Register the given locally-scoped extern "C" declaration so 6405 /// that it can be found later for redeclarations. We include any extern "C" 6406 /// declaration that is not visible in the translation unit here, not just 6407 /// function-scope declarations. 6408 void 6409 Sema::RegisterLocallyScopedExternCDecl(NamedDecl *ND, Scope *S) { 6410 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 6411 ND->getLexicalDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit()) 6412 // Don't need to track declarations in the TU in C. 6413 return; 6414 6415 // Note that we have a locally-scoped external with this name. 6416 Context.getExternCContextDecl()->makeDeclVisibleInContext(ND); 6417 } 6418 6419 NamedDecl *Sema::findLocallyScopedExternCDecl(DeclarationName Name) { 6420 // FIXME: We can have multiple results via __attribute__((overloadable)). 6421 auto Result = Context.getExternCContextDecl()->lookup(Name); 6422 return Result.empty() ? nullptr : *Result.begin(); 6423 } 6424 6425 /// Diagnose function specifiers on a declaration of an identifier that 6426 /// does not identify a function. 6427 void Sema::DiagnoseFunctionSpecifiers(const DeclSpec &DS) { 6428 // FIXME: We should probably indicate the identifier in question to avoid 6429 // confusion for constructs like "virtual int a(), b;" 6430 if (DS.isVirtualSpecified()) 6431 Diag(DS.getVirtualSpecLoc(), 6432 diag::err_virtual_non_function); 6433 6434 if (DS.hasExplicitSpecifier()) 6435 Diag(DS.getExplicitSpecLoc(), 6436 diag::err_explicit_non_function); 6437 6438 if (DS.isNoreturnSpecified()) 6439 Diag(DS.getNoreturnSpecLoc(), 6440 diag::err_noreturn_non_function); 6441 } 6442 6443 NamedDecl* 6444 Sema::ActOnTypedefDeclarator(Scope* S, Declarator& D, DeclContext* DC, 6445 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, LookupResult &Previous) { 6446 // Typedef declarators cannot be qualified (C++ [dcl.meaning]p1). 6447 if (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet()) { 6448 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_qualified_typedef_declarator) 6449 << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getRange(); 6450 D.setInvalidType(); 6451 // Pretend we didn't see the scope specifier. 6452 DC = CurContext; 6453 Previous.clear(); 6454 } 6455 6456 DiagnoseFunctionSpecifiers(D.getDeclSpec()); 6457 6458 if (D.getDeclSpec().isInlineSpecified()) 6459 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc(), diag::err_inline_non_function) 6460 << getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17; 6461 if (D.getDeclSpec().hasConstexprSpecifier()) 6462 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecLoc(), diag::err_invalid_constexpr) 6463 << 1 << static_cast<int>(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecifier()); 6464 6465 if (D.getName().Kind != UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_Identifier) { 6466 if (D.getName().Kind == UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_DeductionGuideName) 6467 Diag(D.getName().StartLocation, 6468 diag::err_deduction_guide_invalid_specifier) 6469 << "typedef"; 6470 else 6471 Diag(D.getName().StartLocation, diag::err_typedef_not_identifier) 6472 << D.getName().getSourceRange(); 6473 return nullptr; 6474 } 6475 6476 TypedefDecl *NewTD = ParseTypedefDecl(S, D, TInfo->getType(), TInfo); 6477 if (!NewTD) return nullptr; 6478 6479 // Handle attributes prior to checking for duplicates in MergeVarDecl 6480 ProcessDeclAttributes(S, NewTD, D); 6481 6482 CheckTypedefForVariablyModifiedType(S, NewTD); 6483 6484 bool Redeclaration = D.isRedeclaration(); 6485 NamedDecl *ND = ActOnTypedefNameDecl(S, DC, NewTD, Previous, Redeclaration); 6486 D.setRedeclaration(Redeclaration); 6487 return ND; 6488 } 6489 6490 void 6491 Sema::CheckTypedefForVariablyModifiedType(Scope *S, TypedefNameDecl *NewTD) { 6492 // C99 6.7.7p2: If a typedef name specifies a variably modified type 6493 // then it shall have block scope. 6494 // Note that variably modified types must be fixed before merging the decl so 6495 // that redeclarations will match. 6496 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = NewTD->getTypeSourceInfo(); 6497 QualType T = TInfo->getType(); 6498 if (T->isVariablyModifiedType()) { 6499 setFunctionHasBranchProtectedScope(); 6500 6501 if (S->getFnParent() == nullptr) { 6502 bool SizeIsNegative; 6503 llvm::APSInt Oversized; 6504 TypeSourceInfo *FixedTInfo = 6505 TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeSourceInfo(TInfo, Context, 6506 SizeIsNegative, 6507 Oversized); 6508 if (FixedTInfo) { 6509 Diag(NewTD->getLocation(), diag::ext_vla_folded_to_constant); 6510 NewTD->setTypeSourceInfo(FixedTInfo); 6511 } else { 6512 if (SizeIsNegative) 6513 Diag(NewTD->getLocation(), diag::err_typecheck_negative_array_size); 6514 else if (T->isVariableArrayType()) 6515 Diag(NewTD->getLocation(), diag::err_vla_decl_in_file_scope); 6516 else if (Oversized.getBoolValue()) 6517 Diag(NewTD->getLocation(), diag::err_array_too_large) 6518 << toString(Oversized, 10); 6519 else 6520 Diag(NewTD->getLocation(), diag::err_vm_decl_in_file_scope); 6521 NewTD->setInvalidDecl(); 6522 } 6523 } 6524 } 6525 } 6526 6527 /// ActOnTypedefNameDecl - Perform semantic checking for a declaration which 6528 /// declares a typedef-name, either using the 'typedef' type specifier or via 6529 /// a C++0x [dcl.typedef]p2 alias-declaration: 'using T = A;'. 6530 NamedDecl* 6531 Sema::ActOnTypedefNameDecl(Scope *S, DeclContext *DC, TypedefNameDecl *NewTD, 6532 LookupResult &Previous, bool &Redeclaration) { 6533 6534 // Find the shadowed declaration before filtering for scope. 6535 NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl = getShadowedDeclaration(NewTD, Previous); 6536 6537 // Merge the decl with the existing one if appropriate. If the decl is 6538 // in an outer scope, it isn't the same thing. 6539 FilterLookupForScope(Previous, DC, S, /*ConsiderLinkage*/false, 6540 /*AllowInlineNamespace*/false); 6541 filterNonConflictingPreviousTypedefDecls(*this, NewTD, Previous); 6542 if (!Previous.empty()) { 6543 Redeclaration = true; 6544 MergeTypedefNameDecl(S, NewTD, Previous); 6545 } else { 6546 inferGslPointerAttribute(NewTD); 6547 } 6548 6549 if (ShadowedDecl && !Redeclaration) 6550 CheckShadow(NewTD, ShadowedDecl, Previous); 6551 6552 // If this is the C FILE type, notify the AST context. 6553 if (IdentifierInfo *II = NewTD->getIdentifier()) 6554 if (!NewTD->isInvalidDecl() && 6555 NewTD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit()) { 6556 if (II->isStr("FILE")) 6557 Context.setFILEDecl(NewTD); 6558 else if (II->isStr("jmp_buf")) 6559 Context.setjmp_bufDecl(NewTD); 6560 else if (II->isStr("sigjmp_buf")) 6561 Context.setsigjmp_bufDecl(NewTD); 6562 else if (II->isStr("ucontext_t")) 6563 Context.setucontext_tDecl(NewTD); 6564 } 6565 6566 return NewTD; 6567 } 6568 6569 /// Determines whether the given declaration is an out-of-scope 6570 /// previous declaration. 6571 /// 6572 /// This routine should be invoked when name lookup has found a 6573 /// previous declaration (PrevDecl) that is not in the scope where a 6574 /// new declaration by the same name is being introduced. If the new 6575 /// declaration occurs in a local scope, previous declarations with 6576 /// linkage may still be considered previous declarations (C99 6577 /// 6.2.2p4-5, C++ [basic.link]p6). 6578 /// 6579 /// \param PrevDecl the previous declaration found by name 6580 /// lookup 6581 /// 6582 /// \param DC the context in which the new declaration is being 6583 /// declared. 6584 /// 6585 /// \returns true if PrevDecl is an out-of-scope previous declaration 6586 /// for a new delcaration with the same name. 6587 static bool 6588 isOutOfScopePreviousDeclaration(NamedDecl *PrevDecl, DeclContext *DC, 6589 ASTContext &Context) { 6590 if (!PrevDecl) 6591 return false; 6592 6593 if (!PrevDecl->hasLinkage()) 6594 return false; 6595 6596 if (Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 6597 // C++ [basic.link]p6: 6598 // If there is a visible declaration of an entity with linkage 6599 // having the same name and type, ignoring entities declared 6600 // outside the innermost enclosing namespace scope, the block 6601 // scope declaration declares that same entity and receives the 6602 // linkage of the previous declaration. 6603 DeclContext *OuterContext = DC->getRedeclContext(); 6604 if (!OuterContext->isFunctionOrMethod()) 6605 // This rule only applies to block-scope declarations. 6606 return false; 6607 6608 DeclContext *PrevOuterContext = PrevDecl->getDeclContext(); 6609 if (PrevOuterContext->isRecord()) 6610 // We found a member function: ignore it. 6611 return false; 6612 6613 // Find the innermost enclosing namespace for the new and 6614 // previous declarations. 6615 OuterContext = OuterContext->getEnclosingNamespaceContext(); 6616 PrevOuterContext = PrevOuterContext->getEnclosingNamespaceContext(); 6617 6618 // The previous declaration is in a different namespace, so it 6619 // isn't the same function. 6620 if (!OuterContext->Equals(PrevOuterContext)) 6621 return false; 6622 } 6623 6624 return true; 6625 } 6626 6627 static void SetNestedNameSpecifier(Sema &S, DeclaratorDecl *DD, Declarator &D) { 6628 CXXScopeSpec &SS = D.getCXXScopeSpec(); 6629 if (!SS.isSet()) return; 6630 DD->setQualifierInfo(SS.getWithLocInContext(S.Context)); 6631 } 6632 6633 bool Sema::inferObjCARCLifetime(ValueDecl *decl) { 6634 QualType type = decl->getType(); 6635 Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime lifetime = type.getObjCLifetime(); 6636 if (lifetime == Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing) { 6637 // Various kinds of declaration aren't allowed to be __autoreleasing. 6638 unsigned kind = -1U; 6639 if (VarDecl *var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(decl)) { 6640 if (var->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) 6641 kind = 0; // __block 6642 else if (!var->hasLocalStorage()) 6643 kind = 1; // global 6644 } else if (isa<ObjCIvarDecl>(decl)) { 6645 kind = 3; // ivar 6646 } else if (isa<FieldDecl>(decl)) { 6647 kind = 2; // field 6648 } 6649 6650 if (kind != -1U) { 6651 Diag(decl->getLocation(), diag::err_arc_autoreleasing_var) 6652 << kind; 6653 } 6654 } else if (lifetime == Qualifiers::OCL_None) { 6655 // Try to infer lifetime. 6656 if (!type->isObjCLifetimeType()) 6657 return false; 6658 6659 lifetime = type->getObjCARCImplicitLifetime(); 6660 type = Context.getLifetimeQualifiedType(type, lifetime); 6661 decl->setType(type); 6662 } 6663 6664 if (VarDecl *var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(decl)) { 6665 // Thread-local variables cannot have lifetime. 6666 if (lifetime && lifetime != Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone && 6667 var->getTLSKind()) { 6668 Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::err_arc_thread_ownership) 6669 << var->getType(); 6670 return true; 6671 } 6672 } 6673 6674 return false; 6675 } 6676 6677 void Sema::deduceOpenCLAddressSpace(ValueDecl *Decl) { 6678 if (Decl->getType().hasAddressSpace()) 6679 return; 6680 if (Decl->getType()->isDependentType()) 6681 return; 6682 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(Decl)) { 6683 QualType Type = Var->getType(); 6684 if (Type->isSamplerT() || Type->isVoidType()) 6685 return; 6686 LangAS ImplAS = LangAS::opencl_private; 6687 // OpenCL C v3.0 s6.7.8 - For OpenCL C 2.0 or with the 6688 // __opencl_c_program_scope_global_variables feature, the address space 6689 // for a variable at program scope or a static or extern variable inside 6690 // a function are inferred to be __global. 6691 if (getOpenCLOptions().areProgramScopeVariablesSupported(getLangOpts()) && 6692 Var->hasGlobalStorage()) 6693 ImplAS = LangAS::opencl_global; 6694 // If the original type from a decayed type is an array type and that array 6695 // type has no address space yet, deduce it now. 6696 if (auto DT = dyn_cast<DecayedType>(Type)) { 6697 auto OrigTy = DT->getOriginalType(); 6698 if (!OrigTy.hasAddressSpace() && OrigTy->isArrayType()) { 6699 // Add the address space to the original array type and then propagate 6700 // that to the element type through `getAsArrayType`. 6701 OrigTy = Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(OrigTy, ImplAS); 6702 OrigTy = QualType(Context.getAsArrayType(OrigTy), 0); 6703 // Re-generate the decayed type. 6704 Type = Context.getDecayedType(OrigTy); 6705 } 6706 } 6707 Type = Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(Type, ImplAS); 6708 // Apply any qualifiers (including address space) from the array type to 6709 // the element type. This implements C99 6.7.3p8: "If the specification of 6710 // an array type includes any type qualifiers, the element type is so 6711 // qualified, not the array type." 6712 if (Type->isArrayType()) 6713 Type = QualType(Context.getAsArrayType(Type), 0); 6714 Decl->setType(Type); 6715 } 6716 } 6717 6718 static void checkAttributesAfterMerging(Sema &S, NamedDecl &ND) { 6719 // Ensure that an auto decl is deduced otherwise the checks below might cache 6720 // the wrong linkage. 6721 assert(S.ParsingInitForAutoVars.count(&ND) == 0); 6722 6723 // 'weak' only applies to declarations with external linkage. 6724 if (WeakAttr *Attr = ND.getAttr<WeakAttr>()) { 6725 if (!ND.isExternallyVisible()) { 6726 S.Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_weak_static); 6727 ND.dropAttr<WeakAttr>(); 6728 } 6729 } 6730 if (WeakRefAttr *Attr = ND.getAttr<WeakRefAttr>()) { 6731 if (ND.isExternallyVisible()) { 6732 S.Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_weakref_not_static); 6733 ND.dropAttr<WeakRefAttr>(); 6734 ND.dropAttr<AliasAttr>(); 6735 } 6736 } 6737 6738 if (auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(&ND)) { 6739 if (VD->hasInit()) { 6740 if (const auto *Attr = VD->getAttr<AliasAttr>()) { 6741 assert(VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() && 6742 !VD->isExternallyVisible() && "Broken AliasAttr handled late!"); 6743 S.Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::err_alias_is_definition) << VD << 0; 6744 VD->dropAttr<AliasAttr>(); 6745 } 6746 } 6747 } 6748 6749 // 'selectany' only applies to externally visible variable declarations. 6750 // It does not apply to functions. 6751 if (SelectAnyAttr *Attr = ND.getAttr<SelectAnyAttr>()) { 6752 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(ND) || !ND.isExternallyVisible()) { 6753 S.Diag(Attr->getLocation(), 6754 diag::err_attribute_selectany_non_extern_data); 6755 ND.dropAttr<SelectAnyAttr>(); 6756 } 6757 } 6758 6759 if (const InheritableAttr *Attr = getDLLAttr(&ND)) { 6760 auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(&ND); 6761 bool IsAnonymousNS = false; 6762 bool IsMicrosoft = S.Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft(); 6763 if (VD) { 6764 const NamespaceDecl *NS = dyn_cast<NamespaceDecl>(VD->getDeclContext()); 6765 while (NS && !IsAnonymousNS) { 6766 IsAnonymousNS = NS->isAnonymousNamespace(); 6767 NS = dyn_cast<NamespaceDecl>(NS->getParent()); 6768 } 6769 } 6770 // dll attributes require external linkage. Static locals may have external 6771 // linkage but still cannot be explicitly imported or exported. 6772 // In Microsoft mode, a variable defined in anonymous namespace must have 6773 // external linkage in order to be exported. 6774 bool AnonNSInMicrosoftMode = IsAnonymousNS && IsMicrosoft; 6775 if ((ND.isExternallyVisible() && AnonNSInMicrosoftMode) || 6776 (!AnonNSInMicrosoftMode && 6777 (!ND.isExternallyVisible() || (VD && VD->isStaticLocal())))) { 6778 S.Diag(ND.getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_dll_not_extern) 6779 << &ND << Attr; 6780 ND.setInvalidDecl(); 6781 } 6782 } 6783 6784 // Check the attributes on the function type, if any. 6785 if (const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(&ND)) { 6786 // Don't declare this variable in the second operand of the for-statement; 6787 // GCC miscompiles that by ending its lifetime before evaluating the 6788 // third operand. See gcc.gnu.org/PR86769. 6789 AttributedTypeLoc ATL; 6790 for (TypeLoc TL = FD->getTypeSourceInfo()->getTypeLoc(); 6791 (ATL = TL.getAsAdjusted<AttributedTypeLoc>()); 6792 TL = ATL.getModifiedLoc()) { 6793 // The [[lifetimebound]] attribute can be applied to the implicit object 6794 // parameter of a non-static member function (other than a ctor or dtor) 6795 // by applying it to the function type. 6796 if (const auto *A = ATL.getAttrAs<LifetimeBoundAttr>()) { 6797 const auto *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD); 6798 if (!MD || MD->isStatic()) { 6799 S.Diag(A->getLocation(), diag::err_lifetimebound_no_object_param) 6800 << !MD << A->getRange(); 6801 } else if (isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(MD) || isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(MD)) { 6802 S.Diag(A->getLocation(), diag::err_lifetimebound_ctor_dtor) 6803 << isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(MD) << A->getRange(); 6804 } 6805 } 6806 } 6807 } 6808 } 6809 6810 static void checkDLLAttributeRedeclaration(Sema &S, NamedDecl *OldDecl, 6811 NamedDecl *NewDecl, 6812 bool IsSpecialization, 6813 bool IsDefinition) { 6814 if (OldDecl->isInvalidDecl() || NewDecl->isInvalidDecl()) 6815 return; 6816 6817 bool IsTemplate = false; 6818 if (TemplateDecl *OldTD = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(OldDecl)) { 6819 OldDecl = OldTD->getTemplatedDecl(); 6820 IsTemplate = true; 6821 if (!IsSpecialization) 6822 IsDefinition = false; 6823 } 6824 if (TemplateDecl *NewTD = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(NewDecl)) { 6825 NewDecl = NewTD->getTemplatedDecl(); 6826 IsTemplate = true; 6827 } 6828 6829 if (!OldDecl || !NewDecl) 6830 return; 6831 6832 const DLLImportAttr *OldImportAttr = OldDecl->getAttr<DLLImportAttr>(); 6833 const DLLExportAttr *OldExportAttr = OldDecl->getAttr<DLLExportAttr>(); 6834 const DLLImportAttr *NewImportAttr = NewDecl->getAttr<DLLImportAttr>(); 6835 const DLLExportAttr *NewExportAttr = NewDecl->getAttr<DLLExportAttr>(); 6836 6837 // dllimport and dllexport are inheritable attributes so we have to exclude 6838 // inherited attribute instances. 6839 bool HasNewAttr = (NewImportAttr && !NewImportAttr->isInherited()) || 6840 (NewExportAttr && !NewExportAttr->isInherited()); 6841 6842 // A redeclaration is not allowed to add a dllimport or dllexport attribute, 6843 // the only exception being explicit specializations. 6844 // Implicitly generated declarations are also excluded for now because there 6845 // is no other way to switch these to use dllimport or dllexport. 6846 bool AddsAttr = !(OldImportAttr || OldExportAttr) && HasNewAttr; 6847 6848 if (AddsAttr && !IsSpecialization && !OldDecl->isImplicit()) { 6849 // Allow with a warning for free functions and global variables. 6850 bool JustWarn = false; 6851 if (!OldDecl->isCXXClassMember()) { 6852 auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(OldDecl); 6853 if (VD && !VD->getDescribedVarTemplate()) 6854 JustWarn = true; 6855 auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(OldDecl); 6856 if (FD && FD->getTemplatedKind() == FunctionDecl::TK_NonTemplate) 6857 JustWarn = true; 6858 } 6859 6860 // We cannot change a declaration that's been used because IR has already 6861 // been emitted. Dllimported functions will still work though (modulo 6862 // address equality) as they can use the thunk. 6863 if (OldDecl->isUsed()) 6864 if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(OldDecl) || !NewImportAttr) 6865 JustWarn = false; 6866 6867 unsigned DiagID = JustWarn ? diag::warn_attribute_dll_redeclaration 6868 : diag::err_attribute_dll_redeclaration; 6869 S.Diag(NewDecl->getLocation(), DiagID) 6870 << NewDecl 6871 << (NewImportAttr ? (const Attr *)NewImportAttr : NewExportAttr); 6872 S.Diag(OldDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 6873 if (!JustWarn) { 6874 NewDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 6875 return; 6876 } 6877 } 6878 6879 // A redeclaration is not allowed to drop a dllimport attribute, the only 6880 // exceptions being inline function definitions (except for function 6881 // templates), local extern declarations, qualified friend declarations or 6882 // special MSVC extension: in the last case, the declaration is treated as if 6883 // it were marked dllexport. 6884 bool IsInline = false, IsStaticDataMember = false, IsQualifiedFriend = false; 6885 bool IsMicrosoftABI = S.Context.getTargetInfo().shouldDLLImportComdatSymbols(); 6886 if (const auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(NewDecl)) { 6887 // Ignore static data because out-of-line definitions are diagnosed 6888 // separately. 6889 IsStaticDataMember = VD->isStaticDataMember(); 6890 IsDefinition = VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition(S.Context) != 6891 VarDecl::DeclarationOnly; 6892 } else if (const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(NewDecl)) { 6893 IsInline = FD->isInlined(); 6894 IsQualifiedFriend = FD->getQualifier() && 6895 FD->getFriendObjectKind() == Decl::FOK_Declared; 6896 } 6897 6898 if (OldImportAttr && !HasNewAttr && 6899 (!IsInline || (IsMicrosoftABI && IsTemplate)) && !IsStaticDataMember && 6900 !NewDecl->isLocalExternDecl() && !IsQualifiedFriend) { 6901 if (IsMicrosoftABI && IsDefinition) { 6902 S.Diag(NewDecl->getLocation(), 6903 diag::warn_redeclaration_without_import_attribute) 6904 << NewDecl; 6905 S.Diag(OldDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 6906 NewDecl->dropAttr<DLLImportAttr>(); 6907 NewDecl->addAttr( 6908 DLLExportAttr::CreateImplicit(S.Context, NewImportAttr->getRange())); 6909 } else { 6910 S.Diag(NewDecl->getLocation(), 6911 diag::warn_redeclaration_without_attribute_prev_attribute_ignored) 6912 << NewDecl << OldImportAttr; 6913 S.Diag(OldDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 6914 S.Diag(OldImportAttr->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_attribute); 6915 OldDecl->dropAttr<DLLImportAttr>(); 6916 NewDecl->dropAttr<DLLImportAttr>(); 6917 } 6918 } else if (IsInline && OldImportAttr && !IsMicrosoftABI) { 6919 // In MinGW, seeing a function declared inline drops the dllimport 6920 // attribute. 6921 OldDecl->dropAttr<DLLImportAttr>(); 6922 NewDecl->dropAttr<DLLImportAttr>(); 6923 S.Diag(NewDecl->getLocation(), 6924 diag::warn_dllimport_dropped_from_inline_function) 6925 << NewDecl << OldImportAttr; 6926 } 6927 6928 // A specialization of a class template member function is processed here 6929 // since it's a redeclaration. If the parent class is dllexport, the 6930 // specialization inherits that attribute. This doesn't happen automatically 6931 // since the parent class isn't instantiated until later. 6932 if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewDecl)) { 6933 if (MD->getTemplatedKind() == FunctionDecl::TK_MemberSpecialization && 6934 !NewImportAttr && !NewExportAttr) { 6935 if (const DLLExportAttr *ParentExportAttr = 6936 MD->getParent()->getAttr<DLLExportAttr>()) { 6937 DLLExportAttr *NewAttr = ParentExportAttr->clone(S.Context); 6938 NewAttr->setInherited(true); 6939 NewDecl->addAttr(NewAttr); 6940 } 6941 } 6942 } 6943 } 6944 6945 /// Given that we are within the definition of the given function, 6946 /// will that definition behave like C99's 'inline', where the 6947 /// definition is discarded except for optimization purposes? 6948 static bool isFunctionDefinitionDiscarded(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *FD) { 6949 // Try to avoid calling GetGVALinkageForFunction. 6950 6951 // All cases of this require the 'inline' keyword. 6952 if (!FD->isInlined()) return false; 6953 6954 // This is only possible in C++ with the gnu_inline attribute. 6955 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !FD->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>()) 6956 return false; 6957 6958 // Okay, go ahead and call the relatively-more-expensive function. 6959 return S.Context.GetGVALinkageForFunction(FD) == GVA_AvailableExternally; 6960 } 6961 6962 /// Determine whether a variable is extern "C" prior to attaching 6963 /// an initializer. We can't just call isExternC() here, because that 6964 /// will also compute and cache whether the declaration is externally 6965 /// visible, which might change when we attach the initializer. 6966 /// 6967 /// This can only be used if the declaration is known to not be a 6968 /// redeclaration of an internal linkage declaration. 6969 /// 6970 /// For instance: 6971 /// 6972 /// auto x = []{}; 6973 /// 6974 /// Attaching the initializer here makes this declaration not externally 6975 /// visible, because its type has internal linkage. 6976 /// 6977 /// FIXME: This is a hack. 6978 template<typename T> 6979 static bool isIncompleteDeclExternC(Sema &S, const T *D) { 6980 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 6981 // In C++, the overloadable attribute negates the effects of extern "C". 6982 if (!D->isInExternCContext() || D->template hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>()) 6983 return false; 6984 6985 // So do CUDA's host/device attributes. 6986 if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA && (D->template hasAttr<CUDADeviceAttr>() || 6987 D->template hasAttr<CUDAHostAttr>())) 6988 return false; 6989 } 6990 return D->isExternC(); 6991 } 6992 6993 static bool shouldConsiderLinkage(const VarDecl *VD) { 6994 const DeclContext *DC = VD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext(); 6995 if (DC->isFunctionOrMethod() || isa<OMPDeclareReductionDecl>(DC) || 6996 isa<OMPDeclareMapperDecl>(DC)) 6997 return VD->hasExternalStorage(); 6998 if (DC->isFileContext()) 6999 return true; 7000 if (DC->isRecord()) 7001 return false; 7002 if (isa<RequiresExprBodyDecl>(DC)) 7003 return false; 7004 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected context"); 7005 } 7006 7007 static bool shouldConsiderLinkage(const FunctionDecl *FD) { 7008 const DeclContext *DC = FD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext(); 7009 if (DC->isFileContext() || DC->isFunctionOrMethod() || 7010 isa<OMPDeclareReductionDecl>(DC) || isa<OMPDeclareMapperDecl>(DC)) 7011 return true; 7012 if (DC->isRecord()) 7013 return false; 7014 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected context"); 7015 } 7016 7017 static bool hasParsedAttr(Scope *S, const Declarator &PD, 7018 ParsedAttr::Kind Kind) { 7019 // Check decl attributes on the DeclSpec. 7020 if (PD.getDeclSpec().getAttributes().hasAttribute(Kind)) 7021 return true; 7022 7023 // Walk the declarator structure, checking decl attributes that were in a type 7024 // position to the decl itself. 7025 for (unsigned I = 0, E = PD.getNumTypeObjects(); I != E; ++I) { 7026 if (PD.getTypeObject(I).getAttrs().hasAttribute(Kind)) 7027 return true; 7028 } 7029 7030 // Finally, check attributes on the decl itself. 7031 return PD.getAttributes().hasAttribute(Kind); 7032 } 7033 7034 /// Adjust the \c DeclContext for a function or variable that might be a 7035 /// function-local external declaration. 7036 bool Sema::adjustContextForLocalExternDecl(DeclContext *&DC) { 7037 if (!DC->isFunctionOrMethod()) 7038 return false; 7039 7040 // If this is a local extern function or variable declared within a function 7041 // template, don't add it into the enclosing namespace scope until it is 7042 // instantiated; it might have a dependent type right now. 7043 if (DC->isDependentContext()) 7044 return true; 7045 7046 // C++11 [basic.link]p7: 7047 // When a block scope declaration of an entity with linkage is not found to 7048 // refer to some other declaration, then that entity is a member of the 7049 // innermost enclosing namespace. 7050 // 7051 // Per C++11 [namespace.def]p6, the innermost enclosing namespace is a 7052 // semantically-enclosing namespace, not a lexically-enclosing one. 7053 while (!DC->isFileContext() && !isa<LinkageSpecDecl>(DC)) 7054 DC = DC->getParent(); 7055 return true; 7056 } 7057 7058 /// Returns true if given declaration has external C language linkage. 7059 static bool isDeclExternC(const Decl *D) { 7060 if (const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) 7061 return FD->isExternC(); 7062 if (const auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) 7063 return VD->isExternC(); 7064 7065 llvm_unreachable("Unknown type of decl!"); 7066 } 7067 7068 /// Returns true if there hasn't been any invalid type diagnosed. 7069 static bool diagnoseOpenCLTypes(Sema &Se, VarDecl *NewVD) { 7070 DeclContext *DC = NewVD->getDeclContext(); 7071 QualType R = NewVD->getType(); 7072 7073 // OpenCL v2.0 s6.9.b - Image type can only be used as a function argument. 7074 // OpenCL v2.0 s6.13.16.1 - Pipe type can only be used as a function 7075 // argument. 7076 if (R->isImageType() || R->isPipeType()) { 7077 Se.Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), 7078 diag::err_opencl_type_can_only_be_used_as_function_parameter) 7079 << R; 7080 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7081 return false; 7082 } 7083 7084 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9.r: 7085 // The event type cannot be used to declare a program scope variable. 7086 // OpenCL v2.0 s6.9.q: 7087 // The clk_event_t and reserve_id_t types cannot be declared in program 7088 // scope. 7089 if (NewVD->hasGlobalStorage() && !NewVD->isStaticLocal()) { 7090 if (R->isReserveIDT() || R->isClkEventT() || R->isEventT()) { 7091 Se.Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), 7092 diag::err_invalid_type_for_program_scope_var) 7093 << R; 7094 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7095 return false; 7096 } 7097 } 7098 7099 // OpenCL v1.0 s6.8.a.3: Pointers to functions are not allowed. 7100 if (!Se.getOpenCLOptions().isAvailableOption("__cl_clang_function_pointers", 7101 Se.getLangOpts())) { 7102 QualType NR = R.getCanonicalType(); 7103 while (NR->isPointerType() || NR->isMemberFunctionPointerType() || 7104 NR->isReferenceType()) { 7105 if (NR->isFunctionPointerType() || NR->isMemberFunctionPointerType() || 7106 NR->isFunctionReferenceType()) { 7107 Se.Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_function_pointer) 7108 << NR->isReferenceType(); 7109 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7110 return false; 7111 } 7112 NR = NR->getPointeeType(); 7113 } 7114 } 7115 7116 if (!Se.getOpenCLOptions().isAvailableOption("cl_khr_fp16", 7117 Se.getLangOpts())) { 7118 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.1.1.1: reject declaring variables of the half and 7119 // half array type (unless the cl_khr_fp16 extension is enabled). 7120 if (Se.Context.getBaseElementType(R)->isHalfType()) { 7121 Se.Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_half_declaration) << R; 7122 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7123 return false; 7124 } 7125 } 7126 7127 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9.r: 7128 // The event type cannot be used with the __local, __constant and __global 7129 // address space qualifiers. 7130 if (R->isEventT()) { 7131 if (R.getAddressSpace() != LangAS::opencl_private) { 7132 Se.Diag(NewVD->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_event_t_addr_space_qual); 7133 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7134 return false; 7135 } 7136 } 7137 7138 if (R->isSamplerT()) { 7139 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9.b p4: 7140 // The sampler type cannot be used with the __local and __global address 7141 // space qualifiers. 7142 if (R.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_local || 7143 R.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_global) { 7144 Se.Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_wrong_sampler_addressspace); 7145 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7146 } 7147 7148 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.12.14.1: 7149 // A global sampler must be declared with either the constant address 7150 // space qualifier or with the const qualifier. 7151 if (DC->isTranslationUnit() && 7152 !(R.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_constant || 7153 R.isConstQualified())) { 7154 Se.Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_nonconst_global_sampler); 7155 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7156 } 7157 if (NewVD->isInvalidDecl()) 7158 return false; 7159 } 7160 7161 return true; 7162 } 7163 7164 template <typename AttrTy> 7165 static void copyAttrFromTypedefToDecl(Sema &S, Decl *D, const TypedefType *TT) { 7166 const TypedefNameDecl *TND = TT->getDecl(); 7167 if (const auto *Attribute = TND->getAttr<AttrTy>()) { 7168 AttrTy *Clone = Attribute->clone(S.Context); 7169 Clone->setInherited(true); 7170 D->addAttr(Clone); 7171 } 7172 } 7173 7174 NamedDecl *Sema::ActOnVariableDeclarator( 7175 Scope *S, Declarator &D, DeclContext *DC, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, 7176 LookupResult &Previous, MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParamLists, 7177 bool &AddToScope, ArrayRef<BindingDecl *> Bindings) { 7178 QualType R = TInfo->getType(); 7179 DeclarationName Name = GetNameForDeclarator(D).getName(); 7180 7181 IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo(); 7182 7183 if (D.isDecompositionDeclarator()) { 7184 // Take the name of the first declarator as our name for diagnostic 7185 // purposes. 7186 auto &Decomp = D.getDecompositionDeclarator(); 7187 if (!Decomp.bindings().empty()) { 7188 II = Decomp.bindings()[0].Name; 7189 Name = II; 7190 } 7191 } else if (!II) { 7192 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_bad_variable_name) << Name; 7193 return nullptr; 7194 } 7195 7196 7197 DeclSpec::SCS SCSpec = D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec(); 7198 StorageClass SC = StorageClassSpecToVarDeclStorageClass(D.getDeclSpec()); 7199 7200 // dllimport globals without explicit storage class are treated as extern. We 7201 // have to change the storage class this early to get the right DeclContext. 7202 if (SC == SC_None && !DC->isRecord() && 7203 hasParsedAttr(S, D, ParsedAttr::AT_DLLImport) && 7204 !hasParsedAttr(S, D, ParsedAttr::AT_DLLExport)) 7205 SC = SC_Extern; 7206 7207 DeclContext *OriginalDC = DC; 7208 bool IsLocalExternDecl = SC == SC_Extern && 7209 adjustContextForLocalExternDecl(DC); 7210 7211 if (SCSpec == DeclSpec::SCS_mutable) { 7212 // mutable can only appear on non-static class members, so it's always 7213 // an error here 7214 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_mutable_nonmember); 7215 D.setInvalidType(); 7216 SC = SC_None; 7217 } 7218 7219 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && SCSpec == DeclSpec::SCS_register && 7220 !D.getAsmLabel() && !getSourceManager().isInSystemMacro( 7221 D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc())) { 7222 // In C++11, the 'register' storage class specifier is deprecated. 7223 // Suppress the warning in system macros, it's used in macros in some 7224 // popular C system headers, such as in glibc's htonl() macro. 7225 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(), 7226 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 ? diag::ext_register_storage_class 7227 : diag::warn_deprecated_register) 7228 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc()); 7229 } 7230 7231 DiagnoseFunctionSpecifiers(D.getDeclSpec()); 7232 7233 if (!DC->isRecord() && S->getFnParent() == nullptr) { 7234 // C99 6.9p2: The storage-class specifiers auto and register shall not 7235 // appear in the declaration specifiers in an external declaration. 7236 // Global Register+Asm is a GNU extension we support. 7237 if (SC == SC_Auto || (SC == SC_Register && !D.getAsmLabel())) { 7238 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_typecheck_sclass_fscope); 7239 D.setInvalidType(); 7240 } 7241 } 7242 7243 // If this variable has a VLA type and an initializer, try to 7244 // fold to a constant-sized type. This is otherwise invalid. 7245 if (D.hasInitializer() && R->isVariableArrayType()) 7246 tryToFixVariablyModifiedVarType(TInfo, R, D.getIdentifierLoc(), 7247 /*DiagID=*/0); 7248 7249 bool IsMemberSpecialization = false; 7250 bool IsVariableTemplateSpecialization = false; 7251 bool IsPartialSpecialization = false; 7252 bool IsVariableTemplate = false; 7253 VarDecl *NewVD = nullptr; 7254 VarTemplateDecl *NewTemplate = nullptr; 7255 TemplateParameterList *TemplateParams = nullptr; 7256 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 7257 NewVD = VarDecl::Create(Context, DC, D.getBeginLoc(), D.getIdentifierLoc(), 7258 II, R, TInfo, SC); 7259 7260 if (R->getContainedDeducedType()) 7261 ParsingInitForAutoVars.insert(NewVD); 7262 7263 if (D.isInvalidType()) 7264 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7265 7266 if (NewVD->getType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion() && 7267 NewVD->hasLocalStorage()) 7268 checkNonTrivialCUnion(NewVD->getType(), NewVD->getLocation(), 7269 NTCUC_AutoVar, NTCUK_Destruct); 7270 } else { 7271 bool Invalid = false; 7272 7273 if (DC->isRecord() && !CurContext->isRecord()) { 7274 // This is an out-of-line definition of a static data member. 7275 switch (SC) { 7276 case SC_None: 7277 break; 7278 case SC_Static: 7279 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(), 7280 diag::err_static_out_of_line) 7281 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc()); 7282 break; 7283 case SC_Auto: 7284 case SC_Register: 7285 case SC_Extern: 7286 // [dcl.stc] p2: The auto or register specifiers shall be applied only 7287 // to names of variables declared in a block or to function parameters. 7288 // [dcl.stc] p6: The extern specifier cannot be used in the declaration 7289 // of class members 7290 7291 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(), 7292 diag::err_storage_class_for_static_member) 7293 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc()); 7294 break; 7295 case SC_PrivateExtern: 7296 llvm_unreachable("C storage class in c++!"); 7297 } 7298 } 7299 7300 if (SC == SC_Static && CurContext->isRecord()) { 7301 if (const CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) { 7302 // Walk up the enclosing DeclContexts to check for any that are 7303 // incompatible with static data members. 7304 const DeclContext *FunctionOrMethod = nullptr; 7305 const CXXRecordDecl *AnonStruct = nullptr; 7306 for (DeclContext *Ctxt = DC; Ctxt; Ctxt = Ctxt->getParent()) { 7307 if (Ctxt->isFunctionOrMethod()) { 7308 FunctionOrMethod = Ctxt; 7309 break; 7310 } 7311 const CXXRecordDecl *ParentDecl = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Ctxt); 7312 if (ParentDecl && !ParentDecl->getDeclName()) { 7313 AnonStruct = ParentDecl; 7314 break; 7315 } 7316 } 7317 if (FunctionOrMethod) { 7318 // C++ [class.static.data]p5: A local class shall not have static data 7319 // members. 7320 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), 7321 diag::err_static_data_member_not_allowed_in_local_class) 7322 << Name << RD->getDeclName() << RD->getTagKind(); 7323 } else if (AnonStruct) { 7324 // C++ [class.static.data]p4: Unnamed classes and classes contained 7325 // directly or indirectly within unnamed classes shall not contain 7326 // static data members. 7327 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), 7328 diag::err_static_data_member_not_allowed_in_anon_struct) 7329 << Name << AnonStruct->getTagKind(); 7330 Invalid = true; 7331 } else if (RD->isUnion()) { 7332 // C++98 [class.union]p1: If a union contains a static data member, 7333 // the program is ill-formed. C++11 drops this restriction. 7334 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), 7335 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 7336 ? diag::warn_cxx98_compat_static_data_member_in_union 7337 : diag::ext_static_data_member_in_union) << Name; 7338 } 7339 } 7340 } 7341 7342 // Match up the template parameter lists with the scope specifier, then 7343 // determine whether we have a template or a template specialization. 7344 bool InvalidScope = false; 7345 TemplateParams = MatchTemplateParametersToScopeSpecifier( 7346 D.getDeclSpec().getBeginLoc(), D.getIdentifierLoc(), 7347 D.getCXXScopeSpec(), 7348 D.getName().getKind() == UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId 7349 ? D.getName().TemplateId 7350 : nullptr, 7351 TemplateParamLists, 7352 /*never a friend*/ false, IsMemberSpecialization, InvalidScope); 7353 Invalid |= InvalidScope; 7354 7355 if (TemplateParams) { 7356 if (!TemplateParams->size() && 7357 D.getName().getKind() != UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId) { 7358 // There is an extraneous 'template<>' for this variable. Complain 7359 // about it, but allow the declaration of the variable. 7360 Diag(TemplateParams->getTemplateLoc(), 7361 diag::err_template_variable_noparams) 7362 << II 7363 << SourceRange(TemplateParams->getTemplateLoc(), 7364 TemplateParams->getRAngleLoc()); 7365 TemplateParams = nullptr; 7366 } else { 7367 // Check that we can declare a template here. 7368 if (CheckTemplateDeclScope(S, TemplateParams)) 7369 return nullptr; 7370 7371 if (D.getName().getKind() == UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId) { 7372 // This is an explicit specialization or a partial specialization. 7373 IsVariableTemplateSpecialization = true; 7374 IsPartialSpecialization = TemplateParams->size() > 0; 7375 } else { // if (TemplateParams->size() > 0) 7376 // This is a template declaration. 7377 IsVariableTemplate = true; 7378 7379 // Only C++1y supports variable templates (N3651). 7380 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), 7381 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 7382 ? diag::warn_cxx11_compat_variable_template 7383 : diag::ext_variable_template); 7384 } 7385 } 7386 } else { 7387 // Check that we can declare a member specialization here. 7388 if (!TemplateParamLists.empty() && IsMemberSpecialization && 7389 CheckTemplateDeclScope(S, TemplateParamLists.back())) 7390 return nullptr; 7391 assert((Invalid || 7392 D.getName().getKind() != UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId) && 7393 "should have a 'template<>' for this decl"); 7394 } 7395 7396 if (IsVariableTemplateSpecialization) { 7397 SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc = 7398 TemplateParamLists.size() > 0 7399 ? TemplateParamLists[0]->getTemplateLoc() 7400 : SourceLocation(); 7401 DeclResult Res = ActOnVarTemplateSpecialization( 7402 S, D, TInfo, TemplateKWLoc, TemplateParams, SC, 7403 IsPartialSpecialization); 7404 if (Res.isInvalid()) 7405 return nullptr; 7406 NewVD = cast<VarDecl>(Res.get()); 7407 AddToScope = false; 7408 } else if (D.isDecompositionDeclarator()) { 7409 NewVD = DecompositionDecl::Create(Context, DC, D.getBeginLoc(), 7410 D.getIdentifierLoc(), R, TInfo, SC, 7411 Bindings); 7412 } else 7413 NewVD = VarDecl::Create(Context, DC, D.getBeginLoc(), 7414 D.getIdentifierLoc(), II, R, TInfo, SC); 7415 7416 // If this is supposed to be a variable template, create it as such. 7417 if (IsVariableTemplate) { 7418 NewTemplate = 7419 VarTemplateDecl::Create(Context, DC, D.getIdentifierLoc(), Name, 7420 TemplateParams, NewVD); 7421 NewVD->setDescribedVarTemplate(NewTemplate); 7422 } 7423 7424 // If this decl has an auto type in need of deduction, make a note of the 7425 // Decl so we can diagnose uses of it in its own initializer. 7426 if (R->getContainedDeducedType()) 7427 ParsingInitForAutoVars.insert(NewVD); 7428 7429 if (D.isInvalidType() || Invalid) { 7430 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7431 if (NewTemplate) 7432 NewTemplate->setInvalidDecl(); 7433 } 7434 7435 SetNestedNameSpecifier(*this, NewVD, D); 7436 7437 // If we have any template parameter lists that don't directly belong to 7438 // the variable (matching the scope specifier), store them. 7439 unsigned VDTemplateParamLists = TemplateParams ? 1 : 0; 7440 if (TemplateParamLists.size() > VDTemplateParamLists) 7441 NewVD->setTemplateParameterListsInfo( 7442 Context, TemplateParamLists.drop_back(VDTemplateParamLists)); 7443 } 7444 7445 if (D.getDeclSpec().isInlineSpecified()) { 7446 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 7447 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc(), diag::err_inline_non_function) 7448 << 0; 7449 } else if (CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod()) { 7450 // 'inline' is not allowed on block scope variable declaration. 7451 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc(), 7452 diag::err_inline_declaration_block_scope) << Name 7453 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc()); 7454 } else { 7455 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc(), 7456 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 ? diag::warn_cxx14_compat_inline_variable 7457 : diag::ext_inline_variable); 7458 NewVD->setInlineSpecified(); 7459 } 7460 } 7461 7462 // Set the lexical context. If the declarator has a C++ scope specifier, the 7463 // lexical context will be different from the semantic context. 7464 NewVD->setLexicalDeclContext(CurContext); 7465 if (NewTemplate) 7466 NewTemplate->setLexicalDeclContext(CurContext); 7467 7468 if (IsLocalExternDecl) { 7469 if (D.isDecompositionDeclarator()) 7470 for (auto *B : Bindings) 7471 B->setLocalExternDecl(); 7472 else 7473 NewVD->setLocalExternDecl(); 7474 } 7475 7476 bool EmitTLSUnsupportedError = false; 7477 if (DeclSpec::TSCS TSCS = D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpec()) { 7478 // C++11 [dcl.stc]p4: 7479 // When thread_local is applied to a variable of block scope the 7480 // storage-class-specifier static is implied if it does not appear 7481 // explicitly. 7482 // Core issue: 'static' is not implied if the variable is declared 7483 // 'extern'. 7484 if (NewVD->hasLocalStorage() && 7485 (SCSpec != DeclSpec::SCS_unspecified || 7486 TSCS != DeclSpec::TSCS_thread_local || 7487 !DC->isFunctionOrMethod())) 7488 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(), 7489 diag::err_thread_non_global) 7490 << DeclSpec::getSpecifierName(TSCS); 7491 else if (!Context.getTargetInfo().isTLSSupported()) { 7492 if (getLangOpts().CUDA || getLangOpts().OpenMPIsDevice || 7493 getLangOpts().SYCLIsDevice) { 7494 // Postpone error emission until we've collected attributes required to 7495 // figure out whether it's a host or device variable and whether the 7496 // error should be ignored. 7497 EmitTLSUnsupportedError = true; 7498 // We still need to mark the variable as TLS so it shows up in AST with 7499 // proper storage class for other tools to use even if we're not going 7500 // to emit any code for it. 7501 NewVD->setTSCSpec(TSCS); 7502 } else 7503 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(), 7504 diag::err_thread_unsupported); 7505 } else 7506 NewVD->setTSCSpec(TSCS); 7507 } 7508 7509 switch (D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecifier()) { 7510 case ConstexprSpecKind::Unspecified: 7511 break; 7512 7513 case ConstexprSpecKind::Consteval: 7514 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecLoc(), 7515 diag::err_constexpr_wrong_decl_kind) 7516 << static_cast<int>(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecifier()); 7517 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 7518 7519 case ConstexprSpecKind::Constexpr: 7520 NewVD->setConstexpr(true); 7521 // C++1z [dcl.spec.constexpr]p1: 7522 // A static data member declared with the constexpr specifier is 7523 // implicitly an inline variable. 7524 if (NewVD->isStaticDataMember() && 7525 (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 || 7526 Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft())) 7527 NewVD->setImplicitlyInline(); 7528 break; 7529 7530 case ConstexprSpecKind::Constinit: 7531 if (!NewVD->hasGlobalStorage()) 7532 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecLoc(), 7533 diag::err_constinit_local_variable); 7534 else 7535 NewVD->addAttr(ConstInitAttr::Create( 7536 Context, D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecLoc(), 7537 AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Keyword, ConstInitAttr::Keyword_constinit)); 7538 break; 7539 } 7540 7541 // C99 6.7.4p3 7542 // An inline definition of a function with external linkage shall 7543 // not contain a definition of a modifiable object with static or 7544 // thread storage duration... 7545 // We only apply this when the function is required to be defined 7546 // elsewhere, i.e. when the function is not 'extern inline'. Note 7547 // that a local variable with thread storage duration still has to 7548 // be marked 'static'. Also note that it's possible to get these 7549 // semantics in C++ using __attribute__((gnu_inline)). 7550 if (SC == SC_Static && S->getFnParent() != nullptr && 7551 !NewVD->getType().isConstQualified()) { 7552 FunctionDecl *CurFD = getCurFunctionDecl(); 7553 if (CurFD && isFunctionDefinitionDiscarded(*this, CurFD)) { 7554 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(), 7555 diag::warn_static_local_in_extern_inline); 7556 MaybeSuggestAddingStaticToDecl(CurFD); 7557 } 7558 } 7559 7560 if (D.getDeclSpec().isModulePrivateSpecified()) { 7561 if (IsVariableTemplateSpecialization) 7562 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_module_private_specialization) 7563 << (IsPartialSpecialization ? 1 : 0) 7564 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval( 7565 D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc()); 7566 else if (IsMemberSpecialization) 7567 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_module_private_specialization) 7568 << 2 7569 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc()); 7570 else if (NewVD->hasLocalStorage()) 7571 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_module_private_local) 7572 << 0 << NewVD 7573 << SourceRange(D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc()) 7574 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval( 7575 D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc()); 7576 else { 7577 NewVD->setModulePrivate(); 7578 if (NewTemplate) 7579 NewTemplate->setModulePrivate(); 7580 for (auto *B : Bindings) 7581 B->setModulePrivate(); 7582 } 7583 } 7584 7585 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) { 7586 deduceOpenCLAddressSpace(NewVD); 7587 7588 DeclSpec::TSCS TSC = D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpec(); 7589 if (TSC != TSCS_unspecified) { 7590 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(), 7591 diag::err_opencl_unknown_type_specifier) 7592 << getLangOpts().getOpenCLVersionString() 7593 << DeclSpec::getSpecifierName(TSC) << 1; 7594 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7595 } 7596 } 7597 7598 // Handle attributes prior to checking for duplicates in MergeVarDecl 7599 ProcessDeclAttributes(S, NewVD, D); 7600 7601 // FIXME: This is probably the wrong location to be doing this and we should 7602 // probably be doing this for more attributes (especially for function 7603 // pointer attributes such as format, warn_unused_result, etc.). Ideally 7604 // the code to copy attributes would be generated by TableGen. 7605 if (R->isFunctionPointerType()) 7606 if (const auto *TT = R->getAs<TypedefType>()) 7607 copyAttrFromTypedefToDecl<AllocSizeAttr>(*this, NewVD, TT); 7608 7609 if (getLangOpts().CUDA || getLangOpts().OpenMPIsDevice || 7610 getLangOpts().SYCLIsDevice) { 7611 if (EmitTLSUnsupportedError && 7612 ((getLangOpts().CUDA && DeclAttrsMatchCUDAMode(getLangOpts(), NewVD)) || 7613 (getLangOpts().OpenMPIsDevice && 7614 OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr::isDeclareTargetDeclaration(NewVD)))) 7615 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(), 7616 diag::err_thread_unsupported); 7617 7618 if (EmitTLSUnsupportedError && 7619 (LangOpts.SYCLIsDevice || (LangOpts.OpenMP && LangOpts.OpenMPIsDevice))) 7620 targetDiag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_thread_unsupported); 7621 // CUDA B.2.5: "__shared__ and __constant__ variables have implied static 7622 // storage [duration]." 7623 if (SC == SC_None && S->getFnParent() != nullptr && 7624 (NewVD->hasAttr<CUDASharedAttr>() || 7625 NewVD->hasAttr<CUDAConstantAttr>())) { 7626 NewVD->setStorageClass(SC_Static); 7627 } 7628 } 7629 7630 // Ensure that dllimport globals without explicit storage class are treated as 7631 // extern. The storage class is set above using parsed attributes. Now we can 7632 // check the VarDecl itself. 7633 assert(!NewVD->hasAttr<DLLImportAttr>() || 7634 NewVD->getAttr<DLLImportAttr>()->isInherited() || 7635 NewVD->isStaticDataMember() || NewVD->getStorageClass() != SC_None); 7636 7637 // In auto-retain/release, infer strong retension for variables of 7638 // retainable type. 7639 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && inferObjCARCLifetime(NewVD)) 7640 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7641 7642 // Handle GNU asm-label extension (encoded as an attribute). 7643 if (Expr *E = (Expr*)D.getAsmLabel()) { 7644 // The parser guarantees this is a string. 7645 StringLiteral *SE = cast<StringLiteral>(E); 7646 StringRef Label = SE->getString(); 7647 if (S->getFnParent() != nullptr) { 7648 switch (SC) { 7649 case SC_None: 7650 case SC_Auto: 7651 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_asm_label_on_auto_decl) << Label; 7652 break; 7653 case SC_Register: 7654 // Local Named register 7655 if (!Context.getTargetInfo().isValidGCCRegisterName(Label) && 7656 DeclAttrsMatchCUDAMode(getLangOpts(), getCurFunctionDecl())) 7657 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_asm_unknown_register_name) << Label; 7658 break; 7659 case SC_Static: 7660 case SC_Extern: 7661 case SC_PrivateExtern: 7662 break; 7663 } 7664 } else if (SC == SC_Register) { 7665 // Global Named register 7666 if (DeclAttrsMatchCUDAMode(getLangOpts(), NewVD)) { 7667 const auto &TI = Context.getTargetInfo(); 7668 bool HasSizeMismatch; 7669 7670 if (!TI.isValidGCCRegisterName(Label)) 7671 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_asm_unknown_register_name) << Label; 7672 else if (!TI.validateGlobalRegisterVariable(Label, 7673 Context.getTypeSize(R), 7674 HasSizeMismatch)) 7675 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_asm_invalid_global_var_reg) << Label; 7676 else if (HasSizeMismatch) 7677 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_asm_register_size_mismatch) << Label; 7678 } 7679 7680 if (!R->isIntegralType(Context) && !R->isPointerType()) { 7681 Diag(D.getBeginLoc(), diag::err_asm_bad_register_type); 7682 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(true); 7683 } 7684 } 7685 7686 NewVD->addAttr(AsmLabelAttr::Create(Context, Label, 7687 /*IsLiteralLabel=*/true, 7688 SE->getStrTokenLoc(0))); 7689 } else if (!ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.empty()) { 7690 llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo*,AsmLabelAttr*>::iterator I = 7691 ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.find(NewVD->getIdentifier()); 7692 if (I != ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.end()) { 7693 if (isDeclExternC(NewVD)) { 7694 NewVD->addAttr(I->second); 7695 ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.erase(I); 7696 } else 7697 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::warn_redefine_extname_not_applied) 7698 << /*Variable*/1 << NewVD; 7699 } 7700 } 7701 7702 // Find the shadowed declaration before filtering for scope. 7703 NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl = D.getCXXScopeSpec().isEmpty() 7704 ? getShadowedDeclaration(NewVD, Previous) 7705 : nullptr; 7706 7707 // Don't consider existing declarations that are in a different 7708 // scope and are out-of-semantic-context declarations (if the new 7709 // declaration has linkage). 7710 FilterLookupForScope(Previous, OriginalDC, S, shouldConsiderLinkage(NewVD), 7711 D.getCXXScopeSpec().isNotEmpty() || 7712 IsMemberSpecialization || 7713 IsVariableTemplateSpecialization); 7714 7715 // Check whether the previous declaration is in the same block scope. This 7716 // affects whether we merge types with it, per C++11 [dcl.array]p3. 7717 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 7718 NewVD->isLocalVarDecl() && NewVD->hasExternalStorage()) 7719 NewVD->setPreviousDeclInSameBlockScope( 7720 Previous.isSingleResult() && !Previous.isShadowed() && 7721 isDeclInScope(Previous.getFoundDecl(), OriginalDC, S, false)); 7722 7723 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 7724 D.setRedeclaration(CheckVariableDeclaration(NewVD, Previous)); 7725 } else { 7726 // If this is an explicit specialization of a static data member, check it. 7727 if (IsMemberSpecialization && !NewVD->isInvalidDecl() && 7728 CheckMemberSpecialization(NewVD, Previous)) 7729 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7730 7731 // Merge the decl with the existing one if appropriate. 7732 if (!Previous.empty()) { 7733 if (Previous.isSingleResult() && 7734 isa<FieldDecl>(Previous.getFoundDecl()) && 7735 D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet()) { 7736 // The user tried to define a non-static data member 7737 // out-of-line (C++ [dcl.meaning]p1). 7738 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_nonstatic_member_out_of_line) 7739 << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getRange(); 7740 Previous.clear(); 7741 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7742 } 7743 } else if (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet()) { 7744 // No previous declaration in the qualifying scope. 7745 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_no_member) 7746 << Name << computeDeclContext(D.getCXXScopeSpec(), true) 7747 << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getRange(); 7748 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7749 } 7750 7751 if (!IsVariableTemplateSpecialization) 7752 D.setRedeclaration(CheckVariableDeclaration(NewVD, Previous)); 7753 7754 if (NewTemplate) { 7755 VarTemplateDecl *PrevVarTemplate = 7756 NewVD->getPreviousDecl() 7757 ? NewVD->getPreviousDecl()->getDescribedVarTemplate() 7758 : nullptr; 7759 7760 // Check the template parameter list of this declaration, possibly 7761 // merging in the template parameter list from the previous variable 7762 // template declaration. 7763 if (CheckTemplateParameterList( 7764 TemplateParams, 7765 PrevVarTemplate ? PrevVarTemplate->getTemplateParameters() 7766 : nullptr, 7767 (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet() && DC && DC->isRecord() && 7768 DC->isDependentContext()) 7769 ? TPC_ClassTemplateMember 7770 : TPC_VarTemplate)) 7771 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7772 7773 // If we are providing an explicit specialization of a static variable 7774 // template, make a note of that. 7775 if (PrevVarTemplate && 7776 PrevVarTemplate->getInstantiatedFromMemberTemplate()) 7777 PrevVarTemplate->setMemberSpecialization(); 7778 } 7779 } 7780 7781 // Diagnose shadowed variables iff this isn't a redeclaration. 7782 if (ShadowedDecl && !D.isRedeclaration()) 7783 CheckShadow(NewVD, ShadowedDecl, Previous); 7784 7785 ProcessPragmaWeak(S, NewVD); 7786 7787 // If this is the first declaration of an extern C variable, update 7788 // the map of such variables. 7789 if (NewVD->isFirstDecl() && !NewVD->isInvalidDecl() && 7790 isIncompleteDeclExternC(*this, NewVD)) 7791 RegisterLocallyScopedExternCDecl(NewVD, S); 7792 7793 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && NewVD->isStaticLocal()) { 7794 MangleNumberingContext *MCtx; 7795 Decl *ManglingContextDecl; 7796 std::tie(MCtx, ManglingContextDecl) = 7797 getCurrentMangleNumberContext(NewVD->getDeclContext()); 7798 if (MCtx) { 7799 Context.setManglingNumber( 7800 NewVD, MCtx->getManglingNumber( 7801 NewVD, getMSManglingNumber(getLangOpts(), S))); 7802 Context.setStaticLocalNumber(NewVD, MCtx->getStaticLocalNumber(NewVD)); 7803 } 7804 } 7805 7806 // Special handling of variable named 'main'. 7807 if (Name.getAsIdentifierInfo() && Name.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("main") && 7808 NewVD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit() && 7809 !getLangOpts().Freestanding && !NewVD->getDescribedVarTemplate()) { 7810 7811 // C++ [basic.start.main]p3 7812 // A program that declares a variable main at global scope is ill-formed. 7813 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 7814 Diag(D.getBeginLoc(), diag::err_main_global_variable); 7815 7816 // In C, and external-linkage variable named main results in undefined 7817 // behavior. 7818 else if (NewVD->hasExternalFormalLinkage()) 7819 Diag(D.getBeginLoc(), diag::warn_main_redefined); 7820 } 7821 7822 if (D.isRedeclaration() && !Previous.empty()) { 7823 NamedDecl *Prev = Previous.getRepresentativeDecl(); 7824 checkDLLAttributeRedeclaration(*this, Prev, NewVD, IsMemberSpecialization, 7825 D.isFunctionDefinition()); 7826 } 7827 7828 if (NewTemplate) { 7829 if (NewVD->isInvalidDecl()) 7830 NewTemplate->setInvalidDecl(); 7831 ActOnDocumentableDecl(NewTemplate); 7832 return NewTemplate; 7833 } 7834 7835 if (IsMemberSpecialization && !NewVD->isInvalidDecl()) 7836 CompleteMemberSpecialization(NewVD, Previous); 7837 7838 return NewVD; 7839 } 7840 7841 /// Enum describing the %select options in diag::warn_decl_shadow. 7842 enum ShadowedDeclKind { 7843 SDK_Local, 7844 SDK_Global, 7845 SDK_StaticMember, 7846 SDK_Field, 7847 SDK_Typedef, 7848 SDK_Using, 7849 SDK_StructuredBinding 7850 }; 7851 7852 /// Determine what kind of declaration we're shadowing. 7853 static ShadowedDeclKind computeShadowedDeclKind(const NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl, 7854 const DeclContext *OldDC) { 7855 if (isa<TypeAliasDecl>(ShadowedDecl)) 7856 return SDK_Using; 7857 else if (isa<TypedefDecl>(ShadowedDecl)) 7858 return SDK_Typedef; 7859 else if (isa<BindingDecl>(ShadowedDecl)) 7860 return SDK_StructuredBinding; 7861 else if (isa<RecordDecl>(OldDC)) 7862 return isa<FieldDecl>(ShadowedDecl) ? SDK_Field : SDK_StaticMember; 7863 7864 return OldDC->isFileContext() ? SDK_Global : SDK_Local; 7865 } 7866 7867 /// Return the location of the capture if the given lambda captures the given 7868 /// variable \p VD, or an invalid source location otherwise. 7869 static SourceLocation getCaptureLocation(const LambdaScopeInfo *LSI, 7870 const VarDecl *VD) { 7871 for (const Capture &Capture : LSI->Captures) { 7872 if (Capture.isVariableCapture() && Capture.getVariable() == VD) 7873 return Capture.getLocation(); 7874 } 7875 return SourceLocation(); 7876 } 7877 7878 static bool shouldWarnIfShadowedDecl(const DiagnosticsEngine &Diags, 7879 const LookupResult &R) { 7880 // Only diagnose if we're shadowing an unambiguous field or variable. 7881 if (R.getResultKind() != LookupResult::Found) 7882 return false; 7883 7884 // Return false if warning is ignored. 7885 return !Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_decl_shadow, R.getNameLoc()); 7886 } 7887 7888 /// Return the declaration shadowed by the given variable \p D, or null 7889 /// if it doesn't shadow any declaration or shadowing warnings are disabled. 7890 NamedDecl *Sema::getShadowedDeclaration(const VarDecl *D, 7891 const LookupResult &R) { 7892 if (!shouldWarnIfShadowedDecl(Diags, R)) 7893 return nullptr; 7894 7895 // Don't diagnose declarations at file scope. 7896 if (D->hasGlobalStorage()) 7897 return nullptr; 7898 7899 NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl = R.getFoundDecl(); 7900 return isa<VarDecl, FieldDecl, BindingDecl>(ShadowedDecl) ? ShadowedDecl 7901 : nullptr; 7902 } 7903 7904 /// Return the declaration shadowed by the given typedef \p D, or null 7905 /// if it doesn't shadow any declaration or shadowing warnings are disabled. 7906 NamedDecl *Sema::getShadowedDeclaration(const TypedefNameDecl *D, 7907 const LookupResult &R) { 7908 // Don't warn if typedef declaration is part of a class 7909 if (D->getDeclContext()->isRecord()) 7910 return nullptr; 7911 7912 if (!shouldWarnIfShadowedDecl(Diags, R)) 7913 return nullptr; 7914 7915 NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl = R.getFoundDecl(); 7916 return isa<TypedefNameDecl>(ShadowedDecl) ? ShadowedDecl : nullptr; 7917 } 7918 7919 /// Return the declaration shadowed by the given variable \p D, or null 7920 /// if it doesn't shadow any declaration or shadowing warnings are disabled. 7921 NamedDecl *Sema::getShadowedDeclaration(const BindingDecl *D, 7922 const LookupResult &R) { 7923 if (!shouldWarnIfShadowedDecl(Diags, R)) 7924 return nullptr; 7925 7926 NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl = R.getFoundDecl(); 7927 return isa<VarDecl, FieldDecl, BindingDecl>(ShadowedDecl) ? ShadowedDecl 7928 : nullptr; 7929 } 7930 7931 /// Diagnose variable or built-in function shadowing. Implements 7932 /// -Wshadow. 7933 /// 7934 /// This method is called whenever a VarDecl is added to a "useful" 7935 /// scope. 7936 /// 7937 /// \param ShadowedDecl the declaration that is shadowed by the given variable 7938 /// \param R the lookup of the name 7939 /// 7940 void Sema::CheckShadow(NamedDecl *D, NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl, 7941 const LookupResult &R) { 7942 DeclContext *NewDC = D->getDeclContext(); 7943 7944 if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(ShadowedDecl)) { 7945 // Fields are not shadowed by variables in C++ static methods. 7946 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewDC)) 7947 if (MD->isStatic()) 7948 return; 7949 7950 // Fields shadowed by constructor parameters are a special case. Usually 7951 // the constructor initializes the field with the parameter. 7952 if (isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(NewDC)) 7953 if (const auto PVD = dyn_cast<ParmVarDecl>(D)) { 7954 // Remember that this was shadowed so we can either warn about its 7955 // modification or its existence depending on warning settings. 7956 ShadowingDecls.insert({PVD->getCanonicalDecl(), FD}); 7957 return; 7958 } 7959 } 7960 7961 if (VarDecl *shadowedVar = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(ShadowedDecl)) 7962 if (shadowedVar->isExternC()) { 7963 // For shadowing external vars, make sure that we point to the global 7964 // declaration, not a locally scoped extern declaration. 7965 for (auto I : shadowedVar->redecls()) 7966 if (I->isFileVarDecl()) { 7967 ShadowedDecl = I; 7968 break; 7969 } 7970 } 7971 7972 DeclContext *OldDC = ShadowedDecl->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext(); 7973 7974 unsigned WarningDiag = diag::warn_decl_shadow; 7975 SourceLocation CaptureLoc; 7976 if (isa<VarDecl>(D) && isa<VarDecl>(ShadowedDecl) && NewDC && 7977 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(NewDC)) { 7978 if (const auto *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(NewDC->getParent())) { 7979 if (RD->isLambda() && OldDC->Encloses(NewDC->getLexicalParent())) { 7980 if (RD->getLambdaCaptureDefault() == LCD_None) { 7981 // Try to avoid warnings for lambdas with an explicit capture list. 7982 const auto *LSI = cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(getCurFunction()); 7983 // Warn only when the lambda captures the shadowed decl explicitly. 7984 CaptureLoc = getCaptureLocation(LSI, cast<VarDecl>(ShadowedDecl)); 7985 if (CaptureLoc.isInvalid()) 7986 WarningDiag = diag::warn_decl_shadow_uncaptured_local; 7987 } else { 7988 // Remember that this was shadowed so we can avoid the warning if the 7989 // shadowed decl isn't captured and the warning settings allow it. 7990 cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(getCurFunction()) 7991 ->ShadowingDecls.push_back( 7992 {cast<VarDecl>(D), cast<VarDecl>(ShadowedDecl)}); 7993 return; 7994 } 7995 } 7996 7997 if (cast<VarDecl>(ShadowedDecl)->hasLocalStorage()) { 7998 // A variable can't shadow a local variable in an enclosing scope, if 7999 // they are separated by a non-capturing declaration context. 8000 for (DeclContext *ParentDC = NewDC; 8001 ParentDC && !ParentDC->Equals(OldDC); 8002 ParentDC = getLambdaAwareParentOfDeclContext(ParentDC)) { 8003 // Only block literals, captured statements, and lambda expressions 8004 // can capture; other scopes don't. 8005 if (!isa<BlockDecl>(ParentDC) && !isa<CapturedDecl>(ParentDC) && 8006 !isLambdaCallOperator(ParentDC)) { 8007 return; 8008 } 8009 } 8010 } 8011 } 8012 } 8013 8014 // Only warn about certain kinds of shadowing for class members. 8015 if (NewDC && NewDC->isRecord()) { 8016 // In particular, don't warn about shadowing non-class members. 8017 if (!OldDC->isRecord()) 8018 return; 8019 8020 // TODO: should we warn about static data members shadowing 8021 // static data members from base classes? 8022 8023 // TODO: don't diagnose for inaccessible shadowed members. 8024 // This is hard to do perfectly because we might friend the 8025 // shadowing context, but that's just a false negative. 8026 } 8027 8028 8029 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName(); 8030 8031 // Emit warning and note. 8032 ShadowedDeclKind Kind = computeShadowedDeclKind(ShadowedDecl, OldDC); 8033 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), WarningDiag) << Name << Kind << OldDC; 8034 if (!CaptureLoc.isInvalid()) 8035 Diag(CaptureLoc, diag::note_var_explicitly_captured_here) 8036 << Name << /*explicitly*/ 1; 8037 Diag(ShadowedDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 8038 } 8039 8040 /// Diagnose shadowing for variables shadowed in the lambda record \p LambdaRD 8041 /// when these variables are captured by the lambda. 8042 void Sema::DiagnoseShadowingLambdaDecls(const LambdaScopeInfo *LSI) { 8043 for (const auto &Shadow : LSI->ShadowingDecls) { 8044 const VarDecl *ShadowedDecl = Shadow.ShadowedDecl; 8045 // Try to avoid the warning when the shadowed decl isn't captured. 8046 SourceLocation CaptureLoc = getCaptureLocation(LSI, ShadowedDecl); 8047 const DeclContext *OldDC = ShadowedDecl->getDeclContext(); 8048 Diag(Shadow.VD->getLocation(), CaptureLoc.isInvalid() 8049 ? diag::warn_decl_shadow_uncaptured_local 8050 : diag::warn_decl_shadow) 8051 << Shadow.VD->getDeclName() 8052 << computeShadowedDeclKind(ShadowedDecl, OldDC) << OldDC; 8053 if (!CaptureLoc.isInvalid()) 8054 Diag(CaptureLoc, diag::note_var_explicitly_captured_here) 8055 << Shadow.VD->getDeclName() << /*explicitly*/ 0; 8056 Diag(ShadowedDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 8057 } 8058 } 8059 8060 /// Check -Wshadow without the advantage of a previous lookup. 8061 void Sema::CheckShadow(Scope *S, VarDecl *D) { 8062 if (Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_decl_shadow, D->getLocation())) 8063 return; 8064 8065 LookupResult R(*this, D->getDeclName(), D->getLocation(), 8066 Sema::LookupOrdinaryName, Sema::ForVisibleRedeclaration); 8067 LookupName(R, S); 8068 if (NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl = getShadowedDeclaration(D, R)) 8069 CheckShadow(D, ShadowedDecl, R); 8070 } 8071 8072 /// Check if 'E', which is an expression that is about to be modified, refers 8073 /// to a constructor parameter that shadows a field. 8074 void Sema::CheckShadowingDeclModification(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc) { 8075 // Quickly ignore expressions that can't be shadowing ctor parameters. 8076 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || ShadowingDecls.empty()) 8077 return; 8078 E = E->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 8079 auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E); 8080 if (!DRE) 8081 return; 8082 const NamedDecl *D = cast<NamedDecl>(DRE->getDecl()->getCanonicalDecl()); 8083 auto I = ShadowingDecls.find(D); 8084 if (I == ShadowingDecls.end()) 8085 return; 8086 const NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl = I->second; 8087 const DeclContext *OldDC = ShadowedDecl->getDeclContext(); 8088 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_modifying_shadowing_decl) << D << OldDC; 8089 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_var_declared_here) << D; 8090 Diag(ShadowedDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 8091 8092 // Avoid issuing multiple warnings about the same decl. 8093 ShadowingDecls.erase(I); 8094 } 8095 8096 /// Check for conflict between this global or extern "C" declaration and 8097 /// previous global or extern "C" declarations. This is only used in C++. 8098 template<typename T> 8099 static bool checkGlobalOrExternCConflict( 8100 Sema &S, const T *ND, bool IsGlobal, LookupResult &Previous) { 8101 assert(S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "only C++ has extern \"C\""); 8102 NamedDecl *Prev = S.findLocallyScopedExternCDecl(ND->getDeclName()); 8103 8104 if (!Prev && IsGlobal && !isIncompleteDeclExternC(S, ND)) { 8105 // The common case: this global doesn't conflict with any extern "C" 8106 // declaration. 8107 return false; 8108 } 8109 8110 if (Prev) { 8111 if (!IsGlobal || isIncompleteDeclExternC(S, ND)) { 8112 // Both the old and new declarations have C language linkage. This is a 8113 // redeclaration. 8114 Previous.clear(); 8115 Previous.addDecl(Prev); 8116 return true; 8117 } 8118 8119 // This is a global, non-extern "C" declaration, and there is a previous 8120 // non-global extern "C" declaration. Diagnose if this is a variable 8121 // declaration. 8122 if (!isa<VarDecl>(ND)) 8123 return false; 8124 } else { 8125 // The declaration is extern "C". Check for any declaration in the 8126 // translation unit which might conflict. 8127 if (IsGlobal) { 8128 // We have already performed the lookup into the translation unit. 8129 IsGlobal = false; 8130 for (LookupResult::iterator I = Previous.begin(), E = Previous.end(); 8131 I != E; ++I) { 8132 if (isa<VarDecl>(*I)) { 8133 Prev = *I; 8134 break; 8135 } 8136 } 8137 } else { 8138 DeclContext::lookup_result R = 8139 S.Context.getTranslationUnitDecl()->lookup(ND->getDeclName()); 8140 for (DeclContext::lookup_result::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); 8141 I != E; ++I) { 8142 if (isa<VarDecl>(*I)) { 8143 Prev = *I; 8144 break; 8145 } 8146 // FIXME: If we have any other entity with this name in global scope, 8147 // the declaration is ill-formed, but that is a defect: it breaks the 8148 // 'stat' hack, for instance. Only variables can have mangled name 8149 // clashes with extern "C" declarations, so only they deserve a 8150 // diagnostic. 8151 } 8152 } 8153 8154 if (!Prev) 8155 return false; 8156 } 8157 8158 // Use the first declaration's location to ensure we point at something which 8159 // is lexically inside an extern "C" linkage-spec. 8160 assert(Prev && "should have found a previous declaration to diagnose"); 8161 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Prev)) 8162 Prev = FD->getFirstDecl(); 8163 else 8164 Prev = cast<VarDecl>(Prev)->getFirstDecl(); 8165 8166 S.Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::err_extern_c_global_conflict) 8167 << IsGlobal << ND; 8168 S.Diag(Prev->getLocation(), diag::note_extern_c_global_conflict) 8169 << IsGlobal; 8170 return false; 8171 } 8172 8173 /// Apply special rules for handling extern "C" declarations. Returns \c true 8174 /// if we have found that this is a redeclaration of some prior entity. 8175 /// 8176 /// Per C++ [dcl.link]p6: 8177 /// Two declarations [for a function or variable] with C language linkage 8178 /// with the same name that appear in different scopes refer to the same 8179 /// [entity]. An entity with C language linkage shall not be declared with 8180 /// the same name as an entity in global scope. 8181 template<typename T> 8182 static bool checkForConflictWithNonVisibleExternC(Sema &S, const T *ND, 8183 LookupResult &Previous) { 8184 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 8185 // In C, when declaring a global variable, look for a corresponding 'extern' 8186 // variable declared in function scope. We don't need this in C++, because 8187 // we find local extern decls in the surrounding file-scope DeclContext. 8188 if (ND->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit()) { 8189 if (NamedDecl *Prev = S.findLocallyScopedExternCDecl(ND->getDeclName())) { 8190 Previous.clear(); 8191 Previous.addDecl(Prev); 8192 return true; 8193 } 8194 } 8195 return false; 8196 } 8197 8198 // A declaration in the translation unit can conflict with an extern "C" 8199 // declaration. 8200 if (ND->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit()) 8201 return checkGlobalOrExternCConflict(S, ND, /*IsGlobal*/true, Previous); 8202 8203 // An extern "C" declaration can conflict with a declaration in the 8204 // translation unit or can be a redeclaration of an extern "C" declaration 8205 // in another scope. 8206 if (isIncompleteDeclExternC(S,ND)) 8207 return checkGlobalOrExternCConflict(S, ND, /*IsGlobal*/false, Previous); 8208 8209 // Neither global nor extern "C": nothing to do. 8210 return false; 8211 } 8212 8213 void Sema::CheckVariableDeclarationType(VarDecl *NewVD) { 8214 // If the decl is already known invalid, don't check it. 8215 if (NewVD->isInvalidDecl()) 8216 return; 8217 8218 QualType T = NewVD->getType(); 8219 8220 // Defer checking an 'auto' type until its initializer is attached. 8221 if (T->isUndeducedType()) 8222 return; 8223 8224 if (NewVD->hasAttrs()) 8225 CheckAlignasUnderalignment(NewVD); 8226 8227 if (T->isObjCObjectType()) { 8228 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_statically_allocated_object) 8229 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(NewVD->getLocation(), "*"); 8230 T = Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(T); 8231 NewVD->setType(T); 8232 } 8233 8234 // Emit an error if an address space was applied to decl with local storage. 8235 // This includes arrays of objects with address space qualifiers, but not 8236 // automatic variables that point to other address spaces. 8237 // ISO/IEC TR 18037 S5.1.2 8238 if (!getLangOpts().OpenCL && NewVD->hasLocalStorage() && 8239 T.getAddressSpace() != LangAS::Default) { 8240 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_as_qualified_auto_decl) << 0; 8241 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8242 return; 8243 } 8244 8245 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.8 - The static qualifier is valid only in program 8246 // scope. 8247 if (getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion == 120 && 8248 !getOpenCLOptions().isAvailableOption("cl_clang_storage_class_specifiers", 8249 getLangOpts()) && 8250 NewVD->isStaticLocal()) { 8251 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_static_function_scope); 8252 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8253 return; 8254 } 8255 8256 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) { 8257 if (!diagnoseOpenCLTypes(*this, NewVD)) 8258 return; 8259 8260 // OpenCL v2.0 s6.12.5 - The __block storage type is not supported. 8261 if (NewVD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) { 8262 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_block_storage_type); 8263 return; 8264 } 8265 8266 if (T->isBlockPointerType()) { 8267 // OpenCL v2.0 s6.12.5 - Any block declaration must be const qualified and 8268 // can't use 'extern' storage class. 8269 if (!T.isConstQualified()) { 8270 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_invalid_block_declaration) 8271 << 0 /*const*/; 8272 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8273 return; 8274 } 8275 if (NewVD->hasExternalStorage()) { 8276 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_extern_block_declaration); 8277 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8278 return; 8279 } 8280 } 8281 8282 // FIXME: Adding local AS in C++ for OpenCL might make sense. 8283 if (NewVD->isFileVarDecl() || NewVD->isStaticLocal() || 8284 NewVD->hasExternalStorage()) { 8285 if (!T->isSamplerT() && !T->isDependentType() && 8286 !(T.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_constant || 8287 (T.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_global && 8288 getOpenCLOptions().areProgramScopeVariablesSupported( 8289 getLangOpts())))) { 8290 int Scope = NewVD->isStaticLocal() | NewVD->hasExternalStorage() << 1; 8291 if (getOpenCLOptions().areProgramScopeVariablesSupported(getLangOpts())) 8292 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_global_invalid_addr_space) 8293 << Scope << "global or constant"; 8294 else 8295 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_global_invalid_addr_space) 8296 << Scope << "constant"; 8297 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8298 return; 8299 } 8300 } else { 8301 if (T.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_global) { 8302 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_function_variable) 8303 << 1 /*is any function*/ << "global"; 8304 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8305 return; 8306 } 8307 if (T.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_constant || 8308 T.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_local) { 8309 FunctionDecl *FD = getCurFunctionDecl(); 8310 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.5.2 and s6.5.3: no local or constant variables 8311 // in functions. 8312 if (FD && !FD->hasAttr<OpenCLKernelAttr>()) { 8313 if (T.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_constant) 8314 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_function_variable) 8315 << 0 /*non-kernel only*/ << "constant"; 8316 else 8317 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_function_variable) 8318 << 0 /*non-kernel only*/ << "local"; 8319 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8320 return; 8321 } 8322 // OpenCL v2.0 s6.5.2 and s6.5.3: local and constant variables must be 8323 // in the outermost scope of a kernel function. 8324 if (FD && FD->hasAttr<OpenCLKernelAttr>()) { 8325 if (!getCurScope()->isFunctionScope()) { 8326 if (T.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_constant) 8327 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_addrspace_scope) 8328 << "constant"; 8329 else 8330 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_addrspace_scope) 8331 << "local"; 8332 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8333 return; 8334 } 8335 } 8336 } else if (T.getAddressSpace() != LangAS::opencl_private && 8337 // If we are parsing a template we didn't deduce an addr 8338 // space yet. 8339 T.getAddressSpace() != LangAS::Default) { 8340 // Do not allow other address spaces on automatic variable. 8341 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_as_qualified_auto_decl) << 1; 8342 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8343 return; 8344 } 8345 } 8346 } 8347 8348 if (NewVD->hasLocalStorage() && T.isObjCGCWeak() 8349 && !NewVD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) { 8350 if (getLangOpts().getGC() != LangOptions::NonGC) 8351 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::warn_gc_attribute_weak_on_local); 8352 else { 8353 assert(!getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount); 8354 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::warn_attribute_weak_on_local); 8355 } 8356 } 8357 8358 bool isVM = T->isVariablyModifiedType(); 8359 if (isVM || NewVD->hasAttr<CleanupAttr>() || 8360 NewVD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) 8361 setFunctionHasBranchProtectedScope(); 8362 8363 if ((isVM && NewVD->hasLinkage()) || 8364 (T->isVariableArrayType() && NewVD->hasGlobalStorage())) { 8365 bool SizeIsNegative; 8366 llvm::APSInt Oversized; 8367 TypeSourceInfo *FixedTInfo = TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeSourceInfo( 8368 NewVD->getTypeSourceInfo(), Context, SizeIsNegative, Oversized); 8369 QualType FixedT; 8370 if (FixedTInfo && T == NewVD->getTypeSourceInfo()->getType()) 8371 FixedT = FixedTInfo->getType(); 8372 else if (FixedTInfo) { 8373 // Type and type-as-written are canonically different. We need to fix up 8374 // both types separately. 8375 FixedT = TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedType(T, Context, SizeIsNegative, 8376 Oversized); 8377 } 8378 if ((!FixedTInfo || FixedT.isNull()) && T->isVariableArrayType()) { 8379 const VariableArrayType *VAT = Context.getAsVariableArrayType(T); 8380 // FIXME: This won't give the correct result for 8381 // int a[10][n]; 8382 SourceRange SizeRange = VAT->getSizeExpr()->getSourceRange(); 8383 8384 if (NewVD->isFileVarDecl()) 8385 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_vla_decl_in_file_scope) 8386 << SizeRange; 8387 else if (NewVD->isStaticLocal()) 8388 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_vla_decl_has_static_storage) 8389 << SizeRange; 8390 else 8391 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_vla_decl_has_extern_linkage) 8392 << SizeRange; 8393 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8394 return; 8395 } 8396 8397 if (!FixedTInfo) { 8398 if (NewVD->isFileVarDecl()) 8399 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_vm_decl_in_file_scope); 8400 else 8401 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_vm_decl_has_extern_linkage); 8402 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8403 return; 8404 } 8405 8406 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::ext_vla_folded_to_constant); 8407 NewVD->setType(FixedT); 8408 NewVD->setTypeSourceInfo(FixedTInfo); 8409 } 8410 8411 if (T->isVoidType()) { 8412 // C++98 [dcl.stc]p5: The extern specifier can be applied only to the names 8413 // of objects and functions. 8414 if (NewVD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() || getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 8415 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type) 8416 << T; 8417 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8418 return; 8419 } 8420 } 8421 8422 if (!NewVD->hasLocalStorage() && NewVD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) { 8423 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_block_on_nonlocal); 8424 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8425 return; 8426 } 8427 8428 if (!NewVD->hasLocalStorage() && T->isSizelessType()) { 8429 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_sizeless_nonlocal) << T; 8430 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8431 return; 8432 } 8433 8434 if (isVM && NewVD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) { 8435 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_block_on_vm); 8436 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8437 return; 8438 } 8439 8440 if (NewVD->isConstexpr() && !T->isDependentType() && 8441 RequireLiteralType(NewVD->getLocation(), T, 8442 diag::err_constexpr_var_non_literal)) { 8443 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8444 return; 8445 } 8446 8447 // PPC MMA non-pointer types are not allowed as non-local variable types. 8448 if (Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isPPC64() && 8449 !NewVD->isLocalVarDecl() && 8450 CheckPPCMMAType(T, NewVD->getLocation())) { 8451 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8452 return; 8453 } 8454 } 8455 8456 /// Perform semantic checking on a newly-created variable 8457 /// declaration. 8458 /// 8459 /// This routine performs all of the type-checking required for a 8460 /// variable declaration once it has been built. It is used both to 8461 /// check variables after they have been parsed and their declarators 8462 /// have been translated into a declaration, and to check variables 8463 /// that have been instantiated from a template. 8464 /// 8465 /// Sets NewVD->isInvalidDecl() if an error was encountered. 8466 /// 8467 /// Returns true if the variable declaration is a redeclaration. 8468 bool Sema::CheckVariableDeclaration(VarDecl *NewVD, LookupResult &Previous) { 8469 CheckVariableDeclarationType(NewVD); 8470 8471 // If the decl is already known invalid, don't check it. 8472 if (NewVD->isInvalidDecl()) 8473 return false; 8474 8475 // If we did not find anything by this name, look for a non-visible 8476 // extern "C" declaration with the same name. 8477 if (Previous.empty() && 8478 checkForConflictWithNonVisibleExternC(*this, NewVD, Previous)) 8479 Previous.setShadowed(); 8480 8481 if (!Previous.empty()) { 8482 MergeVarDecl(NewVD, Previous); 8483 return true; 8484 } 8485 return false; 8486 } 8487 8488 /// AddOverriddenMethods - See if a method overrides any in the base classes, 8489 /// and if so, check that it's a valid override and remember it. 8490 bool Sema::AddOverriddenMethods(CXXRecordDecl *DC, CXXMethodDecl *MD) { 8491 llvm::SmallPtrSet<const CXXMethodDecl*, 4> Overridden; 8492 8493 // Look for methods in base classes that this method might override. 8494 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/false, 8495 /*DetectVirtual=*/false); 8496 auto VisitBase = [&] (const CXXBaseSpecifier *Specifier, CXXBasePath &Path) { 8497 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = Specifier->getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl(); 8498 DeclarationName Name = MD->getDeclName(); 8499 8500 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) { 8501 // We really want to find the base class destructor here. 8502 QualType T = Context.getTypeDeclType(BaseRecord); 8503 CanQualType CT = Context.getCanonicalType(T); 8504 Name = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXDestructorName(CT); 8505 } 8506 8507 for (NamedDecl *BaseND : BaseRecord->lookup(Name)) { 8508 CXXMethodDecl *BaseMD = 8509 dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(BaseND->getCanonicalDecl()); 8510 if (!BaseMD || !BaseMD->isVirtual() || 8511 IsOverload(MD, BaseMD, /*UseMemberUsingDeclRules=*/false, 8512 /*ConsiderCudaAttrs=*/true, 8513 // C++2a [class.virtual]p2 does not consider requires 8514 // clauses when overriding. 8515 /*ConsiderRequiresClauses=*/false)) 8516 continue; 8517 8518 if (Overridden.insert(BaseMD).second) { 8519 MD->addOverriddenMethod(BaseMD); 8520 CheckOverridingFunctionReturnType(MD, BaseMD); 8521 CheckOverridingFunctionAttributes(MD, BaseMD); 8522 CheckOverridingFunctionExceptionSpec(MD, BaseMD); 8523 CheckIfOverriddenFunctionIsMarkedFinal(MD, BaseMD); 8524 } 8525 8526 // A method can only override one function from each base class. We 8527 // don't track indirectly overridden methods from bases of bases. 8528 return true; 8529 } 8530 8531 return false; 8532 }; 8533 8534 DC->lookupInBases(VisitBase, Paths); 8535 return !Overridden.empty(); 8536 } 8537 8538 namespace { 8539 // Struct for holding all of the extra arguments needed by 8540 // DiagnoseInvalidRedeclaration to call Sema::ActOnFunctionDeclarator. 8541 struct ActOnFDArgs { 8542 Scope *S; 8543 Declarator &D; 8544 MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParamLists; 8545 bool AddToScope; 8546 }; 8547 } // end anonymous namespace 8548 8549 namespace { 8550 8551 // Callback to only accept typo corrections that have a non-zero edit distance. 8552 // Also only accept corrections that have the same parent decl. 8553 class DifferentNameValidatorCCC final : public CorrectionCandidateCallback { 8554 public: 8555 DifferentNameValidatorCCC(ASTContext &Context, FunctionDecl *TypoFD, 8556 CXXRecordDecl *Parent) 8557 : Context(Context), OriginalFD(TypoFD), 8558 ExpectedParent(Parent ? Parent->getCanonicalDecl() : nullptr) {} 8559 8560 bool ValidateCandidate(const TypoCorrection &candidate) override { 8561 if (candidate.getEditDistance() == 0) 8562 return false; 8563 8564 SmallVector<unsigned, 1> MismatchedParams; 8565 for (TypoCorrection::const_decl_iterator CDecl = candidate.begin(), 8566 CDeclEnd = candidate.end(); 8567 CDecl != CDeclEnd; ++CDecl) { 8568 FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*CDecl); 8569 8570 if (FD && !FD->hasBody() && 8571 hasSimilarParameters(Context, FD, OriginalFD, MismatchedParams)) { 8572 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)) { 8573 CXXRecordDecl *Parent = MD->getParent(); 8574 if (Parent && Parent->getCanonicalDecl() == ExpectedParent) 8575 return true; 8576 } else if (!ExpectedParent) { 8577 return true; 8578 } 8579 } 8580 } 8581 8582 return false; 8583 } 8584 8585 std::unique_ptr<CorrectionCandidateCallback> clone() override { 8586 return std::make_unique<DifferentNameValidatorCCC>(*this); 8587 } 8588 8589 private: 8590 ASTContext &Context; 8591 FunctionDecl *OriginalFD; 8592 CXXRecordDecl *ExpectedParent; 8593 }; 8594 8595 } // end anonymous namespace 8596 8597 void Sema::MarkTypoCorrectedFunctionDefinition(const NamedDecl *F) { 8598 TypoCorrectedFunctionDefinitions.insert(F); 8599 } 8600 8601 /// Generate diagnostics for an invalid function redeclaration. 8602 /// 8603 /// This routine handles generating the diagnostic messages for an invalid 8604 /// function redeclaration, including finding possible similar declarations 8605 /// or performing typo correction if there are no previous declarations with 8606 /// the same name. 8607 /// 8608 /// Returns a NamedDecl iff typo correction was performed and substituting in 8609 /// the new declaration name does not cause new errors. 8610 static NamedDecl *DiagnoseInvalidRedeclaration( 8611 Sema &SemaRef, LookupResult &Previous, FunctionDecl *NewFD, 8612 ActOnFDArgs &ExtraArgs, bool IsLocalFriend, Scope *S) { 8613 DeclarationName Name = NewFD->getDeclName(); 8614 DeclContext *NewDC = NewFD->getDeclContext(); 8615 SmallVector<unsigned, 1> MismatchedParams; 8616 SmallVector<std::pair<FunctionDecl *, unsigned>, 1> NearMatches; 8617 TypoCorrection Correction; 8618 bool IsDefinition = ExtraArgs.D.isFunctionDefinition(); 8619 unsigned DiagMsg = 8620 IsLocalFriend ? diag::err_no_matching_local_friend : 8621 NewFD->getFriendObjectKind() ? diag::err_qualified_friend_no_match : 8622 diag::err_member_decl_does_not_match; 8623 LookupResult Prev(SemaRef, Name, NewFD->getLocation(), 8624 IsLocalFriend ? Sema::LookupLocalFriendName 8625 : Sema::LookupOrdinaryName, 8626 Sema::ForVisibleRedeclaration); 8627 8628 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 8629 if (IsLocalFriend) 8630 SemaRef.LookupName(Prev, S); 8631 else 8632 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(Prev, NewDC); 8633 assert(!Prev.isAmbiguous() && 8634 "Cannot have an ambiguity in previous-declaration lookup"); 8635 CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD); 8636 DifferentNameValidatorCCC CCC(SemaRef.Context, NewFD, 8637 MD ? MD->getParent() : nullptr); 8638 if (!Prev.empty()) { 8639 for (LookupResult::iterator Func = Prev.begin(), FuncEnd = Prev.end(); 8640 Func != FuncEnd; ++Func) { 8641 FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*Func); 8642 if (FD && 8643 hasSimilarParameters(SemaRef.Context, FD, NewFD, MismatchedParams)) { 8644 // Add 1 to the index so that 0 can mean the mismatch didn't 8645 // involve a parameter 8646 unsigned ParamNum = 8647 MismatchedParams.empty() ? 0 : MismatchedParams.front() + 1; 8648 NearMatches.push_back(std::make_pair(FD, ParamNum)); 8649 } 8650 } 8651 // If the qualified name lookup yielded nothing, try typo correction 8652 } else if ((Correction = SemaRef.CorrectTypo( 8653 Prev.getLookupNameInfo(), Prev.getLookupKind(), S, 8654 &ExtraArgs.D.getCXXScopeSpec(), CCC, Sema::CTK_ErrorRecovery, 8655 IsLocalFriend ? nullptr : NewDC))) { 8656 // Set up everything for the call to ActOnFunctionDeclarator 8657 ExtraArgs.D.SetIdentifier(Correction.getCorrectionAsIdentifierInfo(), 8658 ExtraArgs.D.getIdentifierLoc()); 8659 Previous.clear(); 8660 Previous.setLookupName(Correction.getCorrection()); 8661 for (TypoCorrection::decl_iterator CDecl = Correction.begin(), 8662 CDeclEnd = Correction.end(); 8663 CDecl != CDeclEnd; ++CDecl) { 8664 FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*CDecl); 8665 if (FD && !FD->hasBody() && 8666 hasSimilarParameters(SemaRef.Context, FD, NewFD, MismatchedParams)) { 8667 Previous.addDecl(FD); 8668 } 8669 } 8670 bool wasRedeclaration = ExtraArgs.D.isRedeclaration(); 8671 8672 NamedDecl *Result; 8673 // Retry building the function declaration with the new previous 8674 // declarations, and with errors suppressed. 8675 { 8676 // Trap errors. 8677 Sema::SFINAETrap Trap(SemaRef); 8678 8679 // TODO: Refactor ActOnFunctionDeclarator so that we can call only the 8680 // pieces need to verify the typo-corrected C++ declaration and hopefully 8681 // eliminate the need for the parameter pack ExtraArgs. 8682 Result = SemaRef.ActOnFunctionDeclarator( 8683 ExtraArgs.S, ExtraArgs.D, 8684 Correction.getCorrectionDecl()->getDeclContext(), 8685 NewFD->getTypeSourceInfo(), Previous, ExtraArgs.TemplateParamLists, 8686 ExtraArgs.AddToScope); 8687 8688 if (Trap.hasErrorOccurred()) 8689 Result = nullptr; 8690 } 8691 8692 if (Result) { 8693 // Determine which correction we picked. 8694 Decl *Canonical = Result->getCanonicalDecl(); 8695 for (LookupResult::iterator I = Previous.begin(), E = Previous.end(); 8696 I != E; ++I) 8697 if ((*I)->getCanonicalDecl() == Canonical) 8698 Correction.setCorrectionDecl(*I); 8699 8700 // Let Sema know about the correction. 8701 SemaRef.MarkTypoCorrectedFunctionDefinition(Result); 8702 SemaRef.diagnoseTypo( 8703 Correction, 8704 SemaRef.PDiag(IsLocalFriend 8705 ? diag::err_no_matching_local_friend_suggest 8706 : diag::err_member_decl_does_not_match_suggest) 8707 << Name << NewDC << IsDefinition); 8708 return Result; 8709 } 8710 8711 // Pretend the typo correction never occurred 8712 ExtraArgs.D.SetIdentifier(Name.getAsIdentifierInfo(), 8713 ExtraArgs.D.getIdentifierLoc()); 8714 ExtraArgs.D.setRedeclaration(wasRedeclaration); 8715 Previous.clear(); 8716 Previous.setLookupName(Name); 8717 } 8718 8719 SemaRef.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), DiagMsg) 8720 << Name << NewDC << IsDefinition << NewFD->getLocation(); 8721 8722 bool NewFDisConst = false; 8723 if (CXXMethodDecl *NewMD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD)) 8724 NewFDisConst = NewMD->isConst(); 8725 8726 for (SmallVectorImpl<std::pair<FunctionDecl *, unsigned> >::iterator 8727 NearMatch = NearMatches.begin(), NearMatchEnd = NearMatches.end(); 8728 NearMatch != NearMatchEnd; ++NearMatch) { 8729 FunctionDecl *FD = NearMatch->first; 8730 CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD); 8731 bool FDisConst = MD && MD->isConst(); 8732 bool IsMember = MD || !IsLocalFriend; 8733 8734 // FIXME: These notes are poorly worded for the local friend case. 8735 if (unsigned Idx = NearMatch->second) { 8736 ParmVarDecl *FDParam = FD->getParamDecl(Idx-1); 8737 SourceLocation Loc = FDParam->getTypeSpecStartLoc(); 8738 if (Loc.isInvalid()) Loc = FD->getLocation(); 8739 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, IsMember ? diag::note_member_def_close_param_match 8740 : diag::note_local_decl_close_param_match) 8741 << Idx << FDParam->getType() 8742 << NewFD->getParamDecl(Idx - 1)->getType(); 8743 } else if (FDisConst != NewFDisConst) { 8744 SemaRef.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_member_def_close_const_match) 8745 << NewFDisConst << FD->getSourceRange().getEnd() 8746 << (NewFDisConst 8747 ? FixItHint::CreateRemoval(ExtraArgs.D.getFunctionTypeInfo() 8748 .getConstQualifierLoc()) 8749 : FixItHint::CreateInsertion(ExtraArgs.D.getFunctionTypeInfo() 8750 .getRParenLoc() 8751 .getLocWithOffset(1), 8752 " const")); 8753 } else 8754 SemaRef.Diag(FD->getLocation(), 8755 IsMember ? diag::note_member_def_close_match 8756 : diag::note_local_decl_close_match); 8757 } 8758 return nullptr; 8759 } 8760 8761 static StorageClass getFunctionStorageClass(Sema &SemaRef, Declarator &D) { 8762 switch (D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec()) { 8763 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown storage class!"); 8764 case DeclSpec::SCS_auto: 8765 case DeclSpec::SCS_register: 8766 case DeclSpec::SCS_mutable: 8767 SemaRef.Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(), 8768 diag::err_typecheck_sclass_func); 8769 D.getMutableDeclSpec().ClearStorageClassSpecs(); 8770 D.setInvalidType(); 8771 break; 8772 case DeclSpec::SCS_unspecified: break; 8773 case DeclSpec::SCS_extern: 8774 if (D.getDeclSpec().isExternInLinkageSpec()) 8775 return SC_None; 8776 return SC_Extern; 8777 case DeclSpec::SCS_static: { 8778 if (SemaRef.CurContext->getRedeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod()) { 8779 // C99 6.7.1p5: 8780 // The declaration of an identifier for a function that has 8781 // block scope shall have no explicit storage-class specifier 8782 // other than extern 8783 // See also (C++ [dcl.stc]p4). 8784 SemaRef.Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(), 8785 diag::err_static_block_func); 8786 break; 8787 } else 8788 return SC_Static; 8789 } 8790 case DeclSpec::SCS_private_extern: return SC_PrivateExtern; 8791 } 8792 8793 // No explicit storage class has already been returned 8794 return SC_None; 8795 } 8796 8797 static FunctionDecl *CreateNewFunctionDecl(Sema &SemaRef, Declarator &D, 8798 DeclContext *DC, QualType &R, 8799 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, 8800 StorageClass SC, 8801 bool &IsVirtualOkay) { 8802 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo = SemaRef.GetNameForDeclarator(D); 8803 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName(); 8804 8805 FunctionDecl *NewFD = nullptr; 8806 bool isInline = D.getDeclSpec().isInlineSpecified(); 8807 8808 if (!SemaRef.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 8809 // Determine whether the function was written with a prototype. This is 8810 // true when: 8811 // - there is a prototype in the declarator, or 8812 // - the type R of the function is some kind of typedef or other non- 8813 // attributed reference to a type name (which eventually refers to a 8814 // function type). Note, we can't always look at the adjusted type to 8815 // check this case because attributes may cause a non-function 8816 // declarator to still have a function type. e.g., 8817 // typedef void func(int a); 8818 // __attribute__((noreturn)) func other_func; // This has a prototype 8819 bool HasPrototype = 8820 (D.isFunctionDeclarator() && D.getFunctionTypeInfo().hasPrototype) || 8821 (D.getDeclSpec().isTypeRep() && 8822 D.getDeclSpec().getRepAsType().get()->isFunctionProtoType()) || 8823 (!R->getAsAdjusted<FunctionType>() && R->isFunctionProtoType()); 8824 assert( 8825 (HasPrototype || !SemaRef.getLangOpts().requiresStrictPrototypes()) && 8826 "Strict prototypes are required"); 8827 8828 NewFD = FunctionDecl::Create( 8829 SemaRef.Context, DC, D.getBeginLoc(), NameInfo, R, TInfo, SC, 8830 SemaRef.getCurFPFeatures().isFPConstrained(), isInline, HasPrototype, 8831 ConstexprSpecKind::Unspecified, 8832 /*TrailingRequiresClause=*/nullptr); 8833 if (D.isInvalidType()) 8834 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 8835 8836 return NewFD; 8837 } 8838 8839 ExplicitSpecifier ExplicitSpecifier = D.getDeclSpec().getExplicitSpecifier(); 8840 8841 ConstexprSpecKind ConstexprKind = D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecifier(); 8842 if (ConstexprKind == ConstexprSpecKind::Constinit) { 8843 SemaRef.Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecLoc(), 8844 diag::err_constexpr_wrong_decl_kind) 8845 << static_cast<int>(ConstexprKind); 8846 ConstexprKind = ConstexprSpecKind::Unspecified; 8847 D.getMutableDeclSpec().ClearConstexprSpec(); 8848 } 8849 Expr *TrailingRequiresClause = D.getTrailingRequiresClause(); 8850 8851 // Check that the return type is not an abstract class type. 8852 // For record types, this is done by the AbstractClassUsageDiagnoser once 8853 // the class has been completely parsed. 8854 if (!DC->isRecord() && 8855 SemaRef.RequireNonAbstractType( 8856 D.getIdentifierLoc(), R->castAs<FunctionType>()->getReturnType(), 8857 diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl, SemaRef.AbstractReturnType)) 8858 D.setInvalidType(); 8859 8860 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConstructorName) { 8861 // This is a C++ constructor declaration. 8862 assert(DC->isRecord() && 8863 "Constructors can only be declared in a member context"); 8864 8865 R = SemaRef.CheckConstructorDeclarator(D, R, SC); 8866 return CXXConstructorDecl::Create( 8867 SemaRef.Context, cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC), D.getBeginLoc(), NameInfo, R, 8868 TInfo, ExplicitSpecifier, SemaRef.getCurFPFeatures().isFPConstrained(), 8869 isInline, /*isImplicitlyDeclared=*/false, ConstexprKind, 8870 InheritedConstructor(), TrailingRequiresClause); 8871 8872 } else if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) { 8873 // This is a C++ destructor declaration. 8874 if (DC->isRecord()) { 8875 R = SemaRef.CheckDestructorDeclarator(D, R, SC); 8876 CXXRecordDecl *Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC); 8877 CXXDestructorDecl *NewDD = CXXDestructorDecl::Create( 8878 SemaRef.Context, Record, D.getBeginLoc(), NameInfo, R, TInfo, 8879 SemaRef.getCurFPFeatures().isFPConstrained(), isInline, 8880 /*isImplicitlyDeclared=*/false, ConstexprKind, 8881 TrailingRequiresClause); 8882 8883 // If the destructor needs an implicit exception specification, set it 8884 // now. FIXME: It'd be nice to be able to create the right type to start 8885 // with, but the type needs to reference the destructor declaration. 8886 if (SemaRef.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) 8887 SemaRef.AdjustDestructorExceptionSpec(NewDD); 8888 8889 IsVirtualOkay = true; 8890 return NewDD; 8891 8892 } else { 8893 SemaRef.Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_destructor_not_member); 8894 D.setInvalidType(); 8895 8896 // Create a FunctionDecl to satisfy the function definition parsing 8897 // code path. 8898 return FunctionDecl::Create( 8899 SemaRef.Context, DC, D.getBeginLoc(), D.getIdentifierLoc(), Name, R, 8900 TInfo, SC, SemaRef.getCurFPFeatures().isFPConstrained(), isInline, 8901 /*hasPrototype=*/true, ConstexprKind, TrailingRequiresClause); 8902 } 8903 8904 } else if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName) { 8905 if (!DC->isRecord()) { 8906 SemaRef.Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), 8907 diag::err_conv_function_not_member); 8908 return nullptr; 8909 } 8910 8911 SemaRef.CheckConversionDeclarator(D, R, SC); 8912 if (D.isInvalidType()) 8913 return nullptr; 8914 8915 IsVirtualOkay = true; 8916 return CXXConversionDecl::Create( 8917 SemaRef.Context, cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC), D.getBeginLoc(), NameInfo, R, 8918 TInfo, SemaRef.getCurFPFeatures().isFPConstrained(), isInline, 8919 ExplicitSpecifier, ConstexprKind, SourceLocation(), 8920 TrailingRequiresClause); 8921 8922 } else if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXDeductionGuideName) { 8923 if (TrailingRequiresClause) 8924 SemaRef.Diag(TrailingRequiresClause->getBeginLoc(), 8925 diag::err_trailing_requires_clause_on_deduction_guide) 8926 << TrailingRequiresClause->getSourceRange(); 8927 SemaRef.CheckDeductionGuideDeclarator(D, R, SC); 8928 8929 return CXXDeductionGuideDecl::Create(SemaRef.Context, DC, D.getBeginLoc(), 8930 ExplicitSpecifier, NameInfo, R, TInfo, 8931 D.getEndLoc()); 8932 } else if (DC->isRecord()) { 8933 // If the name of the function is the same as the name of the record, 8934 // then this must be an invalid constructor that has a return type. 8935 // (The parser checks for a return type and makes the declarator a 8936 // constructor if it has no return type). 8937 if (Name.getAsIdentifierInfo() && 8938 Name.getAsIdentifierInfo() == cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)->getIdentifier()){ 8939 SemaRef.Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_constructor_return_type) 8940 << SourceRange(D.getDeclSpec().getTypeSpecTypeLoc()) 8941 << SourceRange(D.getIdentifierLoc()); 8942 return nullptr; 8943 } 8944 8945 // This is a C++ method declaration. 8946 CXXMethodDecl *Ret = CXXMethodDecl::Create( 8947 SemaRef.Context, cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC), D.getBeginLoc(), NameInfo, R, 8948 TInfo, SC, SemaRef.getCurFPFeatures().isFPConstrained(), isInline, 8949 ConstexprKind, SourceLocation(), TrailingRequiresClause); 8950 IsVirtualOkay = !Ret->isStatic(); 8951 return Ret; 8952 } else { 8953 bool isFriend = 8954 SemaRef.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && D.getDeclSpec().isFriendSpecified(); 8955 if (!isFriend && SemaRef.CurContext->isRecord()) 8956 return nullptr; 8957 8958 // Determine whether the function was written with a 8959 // prototype. This true when: 8960 // - we're in C++ (where every function has a prototype), 8961 return FunctionDecl::Create( 8962 SemaRef.Context, DC, D.getBeginLoc(), NameInfo, R, TInfo, SC, 8963 SemaRef.getCurFPFeatures().isFPConstrained(), isInline, 8964 true /*HasPrototype*/, ConstexprKind, TrailingRequiresClause); 8965 } 8966 } 8967 8968 enum OpenCLParamType { 8969 ValidKernelParam, 8970 PtrPtrKernelParam, 8971 PtrKernelParam, 8972 InvalidAddrSpacePtrKernelParam, 8973 InvalidKernelParam, 8974 RecordKernelParam 8975 }; 8976 8977 static bool isOpenCLSizeDependentType(ASTContext &C, QualType Ty) { 8978 // Size dependent types are just typedefs to normal integer types 8979 // (e.g. unsigned long), so we cannot distinguish them from other typedefs to 8980 // integers other than by their names. 8981 StringRef SizeTypeNames[] = {"size_t", "intptr_t", "uintptr_t", "ptrdiff_t"}; 8982 8983 // Remove typedefs one by one until we reach a typedef 8984 // for a size dependent type. 8985 QualType DesugaredTy = Ty; 8986 do { 8987 ArrayRef<StringRef> Names(SizeTypeNames); 8988 auto Match = llvm::find(Names, DesugaredTy.getUnqualifiedType().getAsString()); 8989 if (Names.end() != Match) 8990 return true; 8991 8992 Ty = DesugaredTy; 8993 DesugaredTy = Ty.getSingleStepDesugaredType(C); 8994 } while (DesugaredTy != Ty); 8995 8996 return false; 8997 } 8998 8999 static OpenCLParamType getOpenCLKernelParameterType(Sema &S, QualType PT) { 9000 if (PT->isDependentType()) 9001 return InvalidKernelParam; 9002 9003 if (PT->isPointerType() || PT->isReferenceType()) { 9004 QualType PointeeType = PT->getPointeeType(); 9005 if (PointeeType.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_generic || 9006 PointeeType.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_private || 9007 PointeeType.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::Default) 9008 return InvalidAddrSpacePtrKernelParam; 9009 9010 if (PointeeType->isPointerType()) { 9011 // This is a pointer to pointer parameter. 9012 // Recursively check inner type. 9013 OpenCLParamType ParamKind = getOpenCLKernelParameterType(S, PointeeType); 9014 if (ParamKind == InvalidAddrSpacePtrKernelParam || 9015 ParamKind == InvalidKernelParam) 9016 return ParamKind; 9017 9018 return PtrPtrKernelParam; 9019 } 9020 9021 // C++ for OpenCL v1.0 s2.4: 9022 // Moreover the types used in parameters of the kernel functions must be: 9023 // Standard layout types for pointer parameters. The same applies to 9024 // reference if an implementation supports them in kernel parameters. 9025 if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCLCPlusPlus && 9026 !S.getOpenCLOptions().isAvailableOption( 9027 "__cl_clang_non_portable_kernel_param_types", S.getLangOpts()) && 9028 !PointeeType->isAtomicType() && !PointeeType->isVoidType() && 9029 !PointeeType->isStandardLayoutType()) 9030 return InvalidKernelParam; 9031 9032 return PtrKernelParam; 9033 } 9034 9035 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9.k: 9036 // Arguments to kernel functions in a program cannot be declared with the 9037 // built-in scalar types bool, half, size_t, ptrdiff_t, intptr_t, and 9038 // uintptr_t or a struct and/or union that contain fields declared to be one 9039 // of these built-in scalar types. 9040 if (isOpenCLSizeDependentType(S.getASTContext(), PT)) 9041 return InvalidKernelParam; 9042 9043 if (PT->isImageType()) 9044 return PtrKernelParam; 9045 9046 if (PT->isBooleanType() || PT->isEventT() || PT->isReserveIDT()) 9047 return InvalidKernelParam; 9048 9049 // OpenCL extension spec v1.2 s9.5: 9050 // This extension adds support for half scalar and vector types as built-in 9051 // types that can be used for arithmetic operations, conversions etc. 9052 if (!S.getOpenCLOptions().isAvailableOption("cl_khr_fp16", S.getLangOpts()) && 9053 PT->isHalfType()) 9054 return InvalidKernelParam; 9055 9056 // Look into an array argument to check if it has a forbidden type. 9057 if (PT->isArrayType()) { 9058 const Type *UnderlyingTy = PT->getPointeeOrArrayElementType(); 9059 // Call ourself to check an underlying type of an array. Since the 9060 // getPointeeOrArrayElementType returns an innermost type which is not an 9061 // array, this recursive call only happens once. 9062 return getOpenCLKernelParameterType(S, QualType(UnderlyingTy, 0)); 9063 } 9064 9065 // C++ for OpenCL v1.0 s2.4: 9066 // Moreover the types used in parameters of the kernel functions must be: 9067 // Trivial and standard-layout types C++17 [basic.types] (plain old data 9068 // types) for parameters passed by value; 9069 if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCLCPlusPlus && 9070 !S.getOpenCLOptions().isAvailableOption( 9071 "__cl_clang_non_portable_kernel_param_types", S.getLangOpts()) && 9072 !PT->isOpenCLSpecificType() && !PT.isPODType(S.Context)) 9073 return InvalidKernelParam; 9074 9075 if (PT->isRecordType()) 9076 return RecordKernelParam; 9077 9078 return ValidKernelParam; 9079 } 9080 9081 static void checkIsValidOpenCLKernelParameter( 9082 Sema &S, 9083 Declarator &D, 9084 ParmVarDecl *Param, 9085 llvm::SmallPtrSetImpl<const Type *> &ValidTypes) { 9086 QualType PT = Param->getType(); 9087 9088 // Cache the valid types we encounter to avoid rechecking structs that are 9089 // used again 9090 if (ValidTypes.count(PT.getTypePtr())) 9091 return; 9092 9093 switch (getOpenCLKernelParameterType(S, PT)) { 9094 case PtrPtrKernelParam: 9095 // OpenCL v3.0 s6.11.a: 9096 // A kernel function argument cannot be declared as a pointer to a pointer 9097 // type. [...] This restriction only applies to OpenCL C 1.2 or below. 9098 if (S.getLangOpts().getOpenCLCompatibleVersion() <= 120) { 9099 S.Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_ptrptr_kernel_param); 9100 D.setInvalidType(); 9101 return; 9102 } 9103 9104 ValidTypes.insert(PT.getTypePtr()); 9105 return; 9106 9107 case InvalidAddrSpacePtrKernelParam: 9108 // OpenCL v1.0 s6.5: 9109 // __kernel function arguments declared to be a pointer of a type can point 9110 // to one of the following address spaces only : __global, __local or 9111 // __constant. 9112 S.Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_kernel_arg_address_space); 9113 D.setInvalidType(); 9114 return; 9115 9116 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9.k: 9117 // Arguments to kernel functions in a program cannot be declared with the 9118 // built-in scalar types bool, half, size_t, ptrdiff_t, intptr_t, and 9119 // uintptr_t or a struct and/or union that contain fields declared to be 9120 // one of these built-in scalar types. 9121 9122 case InvalidKernelParam: 9123 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.8 n: 9124 // A kernel function argument cannot be declared 9125 // of event_t type. 9126 // Do not diagnose half type since it is diagnosed as invalid argument 9127 // type for any function elsewhere. 9128 if (!PT->isHalfType()) { 9129 S.Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_bad_kernel_param_type) << PT; 9130 9131 // Explain what typedefs are involved. 9132 const TypedefType *Typedef = nullptr; 9133 while ((Typedef = PT->getAs<TypedefType>())) { 9134 SourceLocation Loc = Typedef->getDecl()->getLocation(); 9135 // SourceLocation may be invalid for a built-in type. 9136 if (Loc.isValid()) 9137 S.Diag(Loc, diag::note_entity_declared_at) << PT; 9138 PT = Typedef->desugar(); 9139 } 9140 } 9141 9142 D.setInvalidType(); 9143 return; 9144 9145 case PtrKernelParam: 9146 case ValidKernelParam: 9147 ValidTypes.insert(PT.getTypePtr()); 9148 return; 9149 9150 case RecordKernelParam: 9151 break; 9152 } 9153 9154 // Track nested structs we will inspect 9155 SmallVector<const Decl *, 4> VisitStack; 9156 9157 // Track where we are in the nested structs. Items will migrate from 9158 // VisitStack to HistoryStack as we do the DFS for bad field. 9159 SmallVector<const FieldDecl *, 4> HistoryStack; 9160 HistoryStack.push_back(nullptr); 9161 9162 // At this point we already handled everything except of a RecordType or 9163 // an ArrayType of a RecordType. 9164 assert((PT->isArrayType() || PT->isRecordType()) && "Unexpected type."); 9165 const RecordType *RecTy = 9166 PT->getPointeeOrArrayElementType()->getAs<RecordType>(); 9167 const RecordDecl *OrigRecDecl = RecTy->getDecl(); 9168 9169 VisitStack.push_back(RecTy->getDecl()); 9170 assert(VisitStack.back() && "First decl null?"); 9171 9172 do { 9173 const Decl *Next = VisitStack.pop_back_val(); 9174 if (!Next) { 9175 assert(!HistoryStack.empty()); 9176 // Found a marker, we have gone up a level 9177 if (const FieldDecl *Hist = HistoryStack.pop_back_val()) 9178 ValidTypes.insert(Hist->getType().getTypePtr()); 9179 9180 continue; 9181 } 9182 9183 // Adds everything except the original parameter declaration (which is not a 9184 // field itself) to the history stack. 9185 const RecordDecl *RD; 9186 if (const FieldDecl *Field = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(Next)) { 9187 HistoryStack.push_back(Field); 9188 9189 QualType FieldTy = Field->getType(); 9190 // Other field types (known to be valid or invalid) are handled while we 9191 // walk around RecordDecl::fields(). 9192 assert((FieldTy->isArrayType() || FieldTy->isRecordType()) && 9193 "Unexpected type."); 9194 const Type *FieldRecTy = FieldTy->getPointeeOrArrayElementType(); 9195 9196 RD = FieldRecTy->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl(); 9197 } else { 9198 RD = cast<RecordDecl>(Next); 9199 } 9200 9201 // Add a null marker so we know when we've gone back up a level 9202 VisitStack.push_back(nullptr); 9203 9204 for (const auto *FD : RD->fields()) { 9205 QualType QT = FD->getType(); 9206 9207 if (ValidTypes.count(QT.getTypePtr())) 9208 continue; 9209 9210 OpenCLParamType ParamType = getOpenCLKernelParameterType(S, QT); 9211 if (ParamType == ValidKernelParam) 9212 continue; 9213 9214 if (ParamType == RecordKernelParam) { 9215 VisitStack.push_back(FD); 9216 continue; 9217 } 9218 9219 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9.p: 9220 // Arguments to kernel functions that are declared to be a struct or union 9221 // do not allow OpenCL objects to be passed as elements of the struct or 9222 // union. 9223 if (ParamType == PtrKernelParam || ParamType == PtrPtrKernelParam || 9224 ParamType == InvalidAddrSpacePtrKernelParam) { 9225 S.Diag(Param->getLocation(), 9226 diag::err_record_with_pointers_kernel_param) 9227 << PT->isUnionType() 9228 << PT; 9229 } else { 9230 S.Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_bad_kernel_param_type) << PT; 9231 } 9232 9233 S.Diag(OrigRecDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_within_field_of_type) 9234 << OrigRecDecl->getDeclName(); 9235 9236 // We have an error, now let's go back up through history and show where 9237 // the offending field came from 9238 for (ArrayRef<const FieldDecl *>::const_iterator 9239 I = HistoryStack.begin() + 1, 9240 E = HistoryStack.end(); 9241 I != E; ++I) { 9242 const FieldDecl *OuterField = *I; 9243 S.Diag(OuterField->getLocation(), diag::note_within_field_of_type) 9244 << OuterField->getType(); 9245 } 9246 9247 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_illegal_field_declared_here) 9248 << QT->isPointerType() 9249 << QT; 9250 D.setInvalidType(); 9251 return; 9252 } 9253 } while (!VisitStack.empty()); 9254 } 9255 9256 /// Find the DeclContext in which a tag is implicitly declared if we see an 9257 /// elaborated type specifier in the specified context, and lookup finds 9258 /// nothing. 9259 static DeclContext *getTagInjectionContext(DeclContext *DC) { 9260 while (!DC->isFileContext() && !DC->isFunctionOrMethod()) 9261 DC = DC->getParent(); 9262 return DC; 9263 } 9264 9265 /// Find the Scope in which a tag is implicitly declared if we see an 9266 /// elaborated type specifier in the specified context, and lookup finds 9267 /// nothing. 9268 static Scope *getTagInjectionScope(Scope *S, const LangOptions &LangOpts) { 9269 while (S->isClassScope() || 9270 (LangOpts.CPlusPlus && 9271 S->isFunctionPrototypeScope()) || 9272 ((S->getFlags() & Scope::DeclScope) == 0) || 9273 (S->getEntity() && S->getEntity()->isTransparentContext())) 9274 S = S->getParent(); 9275 return S; 9276 } 9277 9278 /// Determine whether a declaration matches a known function in namespace std. 9279 static bool isStdBuiltin(ASTContext &Ctx, FunctionDecl *FD, 9280 unsigned BuiltinID) { 9281 switch (BuiltinID) { 9282 case Builtin::BI__GetExceptionInfo: 9283 // No type checking whatsoever. 9284 return Ctx.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft(); 9285 9286 case Builtin::BIaddressof: 9287 case Builtin::BI__addressof: 9288 case Builtin::BIforward: 9289 case Builtin::BImove: 9290 case Builtin::BImove_if_noexcept: 9291 case Builtin::BIas_const: { 9292 // Ensure that we don't treat the algorithm 9293 // OutputIt std::move(InputIt, InputIt, OutputIt) 9294 // as the builtin std::move. 9295 const auto *FPT = FD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 9296 return FPT->getNumParams() == 1 && !FPT->isVariadic(); 9297 } 9298 9299 default: 9300 return false; 9301 } 9302 } 9303 9304 NamedDecl* 9305 Sema::ActOnFunctionDeclarator(Scope *S, Declarator &D, DeclContext *DC, 9306 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, LookupResult &Previous, 9307 MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParamListsRef, 9308 bool &AddToScope) { 9309 QualType R = TInfo->getType(); 9310 9311 assert(R->isFunctionType()); 9312 if (R.getCanonicalType()->castAs<FunctionType>()->getCmseNSCallAttr()) 9313 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_function_decl_cmse_ns_call); 9314 9315 SmallVector<TemplateParameterList *, 4> TemplateParamLists; 9316 llvm::append_range(TemplateParamLists, TemplateParamListsRef); 9317 if (TemplateParameterList *Invented = D.getInventedTemplateParameterList()) { 9318 if (!TemplateParamLists.empty() && 9319 Invented->getDepth() == TemplateParamLists.back()->getDepth()) 9320 TemplateParamLists.back() = Invented; 9321 else 9322 TemplateParamLists.push_back(Invented); 9323 } 9324 9325 // TODO: consider using NameInfo for diagnostic. 9326 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo = GetNameForDeclarator(D); 9327 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName(); 9328 StorageClass SC = getFunctionStorageClass(*this, D); 9329 9330 if (DeclSpec::TSCS TSCS = D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpec()) 9331 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(), 9332 diag::err_invalid_thread) 9333 << DeclSpec::getSpecifierName(TSCS); 9334 9335 if (D.isFirstDeclarationOfMember()) 9336 adjustMemberFunctionCC(R, D.isStaticMember(), D.isCtorOrDtor(), 9337 D.getIdentifierLoc()); 9338 9339 bool isFriend = false; 9340 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate = nullptr; 9341 bool isMemberSpecialization = false; 9342 bool isFunctionTemplateSpecialization = false; 9343 9344 bool isDependentClassScopeExplicitSpecialization = false; 9345 bool HasExplicitTemplateArgs = false; 9346 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgs; 9347 9348 bool isVirtualOkay = false; 9349 9350 DeclContext *OriginalDC = DC; 9351 bool IsLocalExternDecl = adjustContextForLocalExternDecl(DC); 9352 9353 FunctionDecl *NewFD = CreateNewFunctionDecl(*this, D, DC, R, TInfo, SC, 9354 isVirtualOkay); 9355 if (!NewFD) return nullptr; 9356 9357 if (OriginalLexicalContext && OriginalLexicalContext->isObjCContainer()) 9358 NewFD->setTopLevelDeclInObjCContainer(); 9359 9360 // Set the lexical context. If this is a function-scope declaration, or has a 9361 // C++ scope specifier, or is the object of a friend declaration, the lexical 9362 // context will be different from the semantic context. 9363 NewFD->setLexicalDeclContext(CurContext); 9364 9365 if (IsLocalExternDecl) 9366 NewFD->setLocalExternDecl(); 9367 9368 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 9369 bool isInline = D.getDeclSpec().isInlineSpecified(); 9370 bool isVirtual = D.getDeclSpec().isVirtualSpecified(); 9371 bool hasExplicit = D.getDeclSpec().hasExplicitSpecifier(); 9372 isFriend = D.getDeclSpec().isFriendSpecified(); 9373 if (isFriend && !isInline && D.isFunctionDefinition()) { 9374 // C++ [class.friend]p5 9375 // A function can be defined in a friend declaration of a 9376 // class . . . . Such a function is implicitly inline. 9377 NewFD->setImplicitlyInline(); 9378 } 9379 9380 // If this is a method defined in an __interface, and is not a constructor 9381 // or an overloaded operator, then set the pure flag (isVirtual will already 9382 // return true). 9383 if (const CXXRecordDecl *Parent = 9384 dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(NewFD->getDeclContext())) { 9385 if (Parent->isInterface() && cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD)->isUserProvided()) 9386 NewFD->setPure(true); 9387 9388 // C++ [class.union]p2 9389 // A union can have member functions, but not virtual functions. 9390 if (isVirtual && Parent->isUnion()) { 9391 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getVirtualSpecLoc(), diag::err_virtual_in_union); 9392 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 9393 } 9394 if ((Parent->isClass() || Parent->isStruct()) && 9395 Parent->hasAttr<SYCLSpecialClassAttr>() && 9396 NewFD->getKind() == Decl::Kind::CXXMethod && NewFD->getIdentifier() && 9397 NewFD->getName() == "__init" && D.isFunctionDefinition()) { 9398 if (auto *Def = Parent->getDefinition()) 9399 Def->setInitMethod(true); 9400 } 9401 } 9402 9403 SetNestedNameSpecifier(*this, NewFD, D); 9404 isMemberSpecialization = false; 9405 isFunctionTemplateSpecialization = false; 9406 if (D.isInvalidType()) 9407 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 9408 9409 // Match up the template parameter lists with the scope specifier, then 9410 // determine whether we have a template or a template specialization. 9411 bool Invalid = false; 9412 TemplateParameterList *TemplateParams = 9413 MatchTemplateParametersToScopeSpecifier( 9414 D.getDeclSpec().getBeginLoc(), D.getIdentifierLoc(), 9415 D.getCXXScopeSpec(), 9416 D.getName().getKind() == UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId 9417 ? D.getName().TemplateId 9418 : nullptr, 9419 TemplateParamLists, isFriend, isMemberSpecialization, 9420 Invalid); 9421 if (TemplateParams) { 9422 // Check that we can declare a template here. 9423 if (CheckTemplateDeclScope(S, TemplateParams)) 9424 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 9425 9426 if (TemplateParams->size() > 0) { 9427 // This is a function template 9428 9429 // A destructor cannot be a template. 9430 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) { 9431 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_destructor_template); 9432 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 9433 } 9434 9435 // If we're adding a template to a dependent context, we may need to 9436 // rebuilding some of the types used within the template parameter list, 9437 // now that we know what the current instantiation is. 9438 if (DC->isDependentContext()) { 9439 ContextRAII SavedContext(*this, DC); 9440 if (RebuildTemplateParamsInCurrentInstantiation(TemplateParams)) 9441 Invalid = true; 9442 } 9443 9444 FunctionTemplate = FunctionTemplateDecl::Create(Context, DC, 9445 NewFD->getLocation(), 9446 Name, TemplateParams, 9447 NewFD); 9448 FunctionTemplate->setLexicalDeclContext(CurContext); 9449 NewFD->setDescribedFunctionTemplate(FunctionTemplate); 9450 9451 // For source fidelity, store the other template param lists. 9452 if (TemplateParamLists.size() > 1) { 9453 NewFD->setTemplateParameterListsInfo(Context, 9454 ArrayRef<TemplateParameterList *>(TemplateParamLists) 9455 .drop_back(1)); 9456 } 9457 } else { 9458 // This is a function template specialization. 9459 isFunctionTemplateSpecialization = true; 9460 // For source fidelity, store all the template param lists. 9461 if (TemplateParamLists.size() > 0) 9462 NewFD->setTemplateParameterListsInfo(Context, TemplateParamLists); 9463 9464 // C++0x [temp.expl.spec]p20 forbids "template<> friend void foo(int);". 9465 if (isFriend) { 9466 // We want to remove the "template<>", found here. 9467 SourceRange RemoveRange = TemplateParams->getSourceRange(); 9468 9469 // If we remove the template<> and the name is not a 9470 // template-id, we're actually silently creating a problem: 9471 // the friend declaration will refer to an untemplated decl, 9472 // and clearly the user wants a template specialization. So 9473 // we need to insert '<>' after the name. 9474 SourceLocation InsertLoc; 9475 if (D.getName().getKind() != UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId) { 9476 InsertLoc = D.getName().getSourceRange().getEnd(); 9477 InsertLoc = getLocForEndOfToken(InsertLoc); 9478 } 9479 9480 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_template_spec_decl_friend) 9481 << Name << RemoveRange 9482 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(RemoveRange) 9483 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(InsertLoc, "<>"); 9484 Invalid = true; 9485 } 9486 } 9487 } else { 9488 // Check that we can declare a template here. 9489 if (!TemplateParamLists.empty() && isMemberSpecialization && 9490 CheckTemplateDeclScope(S, TemplateParamLists.back())) 9491 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 9492 9493 // All template param lists were matched against the scope specifier: 9494 // this is NOT (an explicit specialization of) a template. 9495 if (TemplateParamLists.size() > 0) 9496 // For source fidelity, store all the template param lists. 9497 NewFD->setTemplateParameterListsInfo(Context, TemplateParamLists); 9498 } 9499 9500 if (Invalid) { 9501 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 9502 if (FunctionTemplate) 9503 FunctionTemplate->setInvalidDecl(); 9504 } 9505 9506 // C++ [dcl.fct.spec]p5: 9507 // The virtual specifier shall only be used in declarations of 9508 // nonstatic class member functions that appear within a 9509 // member-specification of a class declaration; see 10.3. 9510 // 9511 if (isVirtual && !NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) { 9512 if (!isVirtualOkay) { 9513 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getVirtualSpecLoc(), 9514 diag::err_virtual_non_function); 9515 } else if (!CurContext->isRecord()) { 9516 // 'virtual' was specified outside of the class. 9517 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getVirtualSpecLoc(), 9518 diag::err_virtual_out_of_class) 9519 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getVirtualSpecLoc()); 9520 } else if (NewFD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()) { 9521 // C++ [temp.mem]p3: 9522 // A member function template shall not be virtual. 9523 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getVirtualSpecLoc(), 9524 diag::err_virtual_member_function_template) 9525 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getVirtualSpecLoc()); 9526 } else { 9527 // Okay: Add virtual to the method. 9528 NewFD->setVirtualAsWritten(true); 9529 } 9530 9531 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && 9532 NewFD->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType()) 9533 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getVirtualSpecLoc(), diag::err_auto_fn_virtual); 9534 } 9535 9536 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && 9537 (NewFD->isDependentContext() || 9538 (isFriend && CurContext->isDependentContext())) && 9539 NewFD->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType()) { 9540 // If the function template is referenced directly (for instance, as a 9541 // member of the current instantiation), pretend it has a dependent type. 9542 // This is not really justified by the standard, but is the only sane 9543 // thing to do. 9544 // FIXME: For a friend function, we have not marked the function as being 9545 // a friend yet, so 'isDependentContext' on the FD doesn't work. 9546 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = 9547 NewFD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 9548 QualType Result = SubstAutoTypeDependent(FPT->getReturnType()); 9549 NewFD->setType(Context.getFunctionType(Result, FPT->getParamTypes(), 9550 FPT->getExtProtoInfo())); 9551 } 9552 9553 // C++ [dcl.fct.spec]p3: 9554 // The inline specifier shall not appear on a block scope function 9555 // declaration. 9556 if (isInline && !NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) { 9557 if (CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod()) { 9558 // 'inline' is not allowed on block scope function declaration. 9559 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc(), 9560 diag::err_inline_declaration_block_scope) << Name 9561 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc()); 9562 } 9563 } 9564 9565 // C++ [dcl.fct.spec]p6: 9566 // The explicit specifier shall be used only in the declaration of a 9567 // constructor or conversion function within its class definition; 9568 // see 12.3.1 and 12.3.2. 9569 if (hasExplicit && !NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && 9570 !isa<CXXDeductionGuideDecl>(NewFD)) { 9571 if (!CurContext->isRecord()) { 9572 // 'explicit' was specified outside of the class. 9573 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getExplicitSpecLoc(), 9574 diag::err_explicit_out_of_class) 9575 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getExplicitSpecRange()); 9576 } else if (!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(NewFD) && 9577 !isa<CXXConversionDecl>(NewFD)) { 9578 // 'explicit' was specified on a function that wasn't a constructor 9579 // or conversion function. 9580 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getExplicitSpecLoc(), 9581 diag::err_explicit_non_ctor_or_conv_function) 9582 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getExplicitSpecRange()); 9583 } 9584 } 9585 9586 ConstexprSpecKind ConstexprKind = D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecifier(); 9587 if (ConstexprKind != ConstexprSpecKind::Unspecified) { 9588 // C++11 [dcl.constexpr]p2: constexpr functions and constexpr constructors 9589 // are implicitly inline. 9590 NewFD->setImplicitlyInline(); 9591 9592 // C++11 [dcl.constexpr]p3: functions declared constexpr are required to 9593 // be either constructors or to return a literal type. Therefore, 9594 // destructors cannot be declared constexpr. 9595 if (isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(NewFD) && 9596 (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20 || 9597 ConstexprKind == ConstexprSpecKind::Consteval)) { 9598 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecLoc(), diag::err_constexpr_dtor) 9599 << static_cast<int>(ConstexprKind); 9600 NewFD->setConstexprKind(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20 9601 ? ConstexprSpecKind::Unspecified 9602 : ConstexprSpecKind::Constexpr); 9603 } 9604 // C++20 [dcl.constexpr]p2: An allocation function, or a 9605 // deallocation function shall not be declared with the consteval 9606 // specifier. 9607 if (ConstexprKind == ConstexprSpecKind::Consteval && 9608 (NewFD->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_New || 9609 NewFD->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Array_New || 9610 NewFD->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Delete || 9611 NewFD->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Array_Delete)) { 9612 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecLoc(), 9613 diag::err_invalid_consteval_decl_kind) 9614 << NewFD; 9615 NewFD->setConstexprKind(ConstexprSpecKind::Constexpr); 9616 } 9617 } 9618 9619 // If __module_private__ was specified, mark the function accordingly. 9620 if (D.getDeclSpec().isModulePrivateSpecified()) { 9621 if (isFunctionTemplateSpecialization) { 9622 SourceLocation ModulePrivateLoc 9623 = D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc(); 9624 Diag(ModulePrivateLoc, diag::err_module_private_specialization) 9625 << 0 9626 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(ModulePrivateLoc); 9627 } else { 9628 NewFD->setModulePrivate(); 9629 if (FunctionTemplate) 9630 FunctionTemplate->setModulePrivate(); 9631 } 9632 } 9633 9634 if (isFriend) { 9635 if (FunctionTemplate) { 9636 FunctionTemplate->setObjectOfFriendDecl(); 9637 FunctionTemplate->setAccess(AS_public); 9638 } 9639 NewFD->setObjectOfFriendDecl(); 9640 NewFD->setAccess(AS_public); 9641 } 9642 9643 // If a function is defined as defaulted or deleted, mark it as such now. 9644 // We'll do the relevant checks on defaulted / deleted functions later. 9645 switch (D.getFunctionDefinitionKind()) { 9646 case FunctionDefinitionKind::Declaration: 9647 case FunctionDefinitionKind::Definition: 9648 break; 9649 9650 case FunctionDefinitionKind::Defaulted: 9651 NewFD->setDefaulted(); 9652 break; 9653 9654 case FunctionDefinitionKind::Deleted: 9655 NewFD->setDeletedAsWritten(); 9656 break; 9657 } 9658 9659 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD) && DC == CurContext && 9660 D.isFunctionDefinition()) { 9661 // C++ [class.mfct]p2: 9662 // A member function may be defined (8.4) in its class definition, in 9663 // which case it is an inline member function (7.1.2) 9664 NewFD->setImplicitlyInline(); 9665 } 9666 9667 if (SC == SC_Static && isa<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD) && 9668 !CurContext->isRecord()) { 9669 // C++ [class.static]p1: 9670 // A data or function member of a class may be declared static 9671 // in a class definition, in which case it is a static member of 9672 // the class. 9673 9674 // Complain about the 'static' specifier if it's on an out-of-line 9675 // member function definition. 9676 9677 // MSVC permits the use of a 'static' storage specifier on an out-of-line 9678 // member function template declaration and class member template 9679 // declaration (MSVC versions before 2015), warn about this. 9680 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(), 9681 ((!getLangOpts().isCompatibleWithMSVC(LangOptions::MSVC2015) && 9682 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)->getDescribedClassTemplate()) || 9683 (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && NewFD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate())) 9684 ? diag::ext_static_out_of_line : diag::err_static_out_of_line) 9685 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc()); 9686 } 9687 9688 // C++11 [except.spec]p15: 9689 // A deallocation function with no exception-specification is treated 9690 // as if it were specified with noexcept(true). 9691 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = R->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 9692 if ((Name.getCXXOverloadedOperator() == OO_Delete || 9693 Name.getCXXOverloadedOperator() == OO_Array_Delete) && 9694 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && FPT && !FPT->hasExceptionSpec()) 9695 NewFD->setType(Context.getFunctionType( 9696 FPT->getReturnType(), FPT->getParamTypes(), 9697 FPT->getExtProtoInfo().withExceptionSpec(EST_BasicNoexcept))); 9698 } 9699 9700 // Filter out previous declarations that don't match the scope. 9701 FilterLookupForScope(Previous, OriginalDC, S, shouldConsiderLinkage(NewFD), 9702 D.getCXXScopeSpec().isNotEmpty() || 9703 isMemberSpecialization || 9704 isFunctionTemplateSpecialization); 9705 9706 // Handle GNU asm-label extension (encoded as an attribute). 9707 if (Expr *E = (Expr*) D.getAsmLabel()) { 9708 // The parser guarantees this is a string. 9709 StringLiteral *SE = cast<StringLiteral>(E); 9710 NewFD->addAttr(AsmLabelAttr::Create(Context, SE->getString(), 9711 /*IsLiteralLabel=*/true, 9712 SE->getStrTokenLoc(0))); 9713 } else if (!ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.empty()) { 9714 llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo*,AsmLabelAttr*>::iterator I = 9715 ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.find(NewFD->getIdentifier()); 9716 if (I != ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.end()) { 9717 if (isDeclExternC(NewFD)) { 9718 NewFD->addAttr(I->second); 9719 ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.erase(I); 9720 } else 9721 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::warn_redefine_extname_not_applied) 9722 << /*Variable*/0 << NewFD; 9723 } 9724 } 9725 9726 // Copy the parameter declarations from the declarator D to the function 9727 // declaration NewFD, if they are available. First scavenge them into Params. 9728 SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 16> Params; 9729 unsigned FTIIdx; 9730 if (D.isFunctionDeclarator(FTIIdx)) { 9731 DeclaratorChunk::FunctionTypeInfo &FTI = D.getTypeObject(FTIIdx).Fun; 9732 9733 // Check for C99 6.7.5.3p10 - foo(void) is a non-varargs 9734 // function that takes no arguments, not a function that takes a 9735 // single void argument. 9736 // We let through "const void" here because Sema::GetTypeForDeclarator 9737 // already checks for that case. 9738 if (FTIHasNonVoidParameters(FTI) && FTI.Params[0].Param) { 9739 for (unsigned i = 0, e = FTI.NumParams; i != e; ++i) { 9740 ParmVarDecl *Param = cast<ParmVarDecl>(FTI.Params[i].Param); 9741 assert(Param->getDeclContext() != NewFD && "Was set before ?"); 9742 Param->setDeclContext(NewFD); 9743 Params.push_back(Param); 9744 9745 if (Param->isInvalidDecl()) 9746 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 9747 } 9748 } 9749 9750 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 9751 // In C, find all the tag declarations from the prototype and move them 9752 // into the function DeclContext. Remove them from the surrounding tag 9753 // injection context of the function, which is typically but not always 9754 // the TU. 9755 DeclContext *PrototypeTagContext = 9756 getTagInjectionContext(NewFD->getLexicalDeclContext()); 9757 for (NamedDecl *NonParmDecl : FTI.getDeclsInPrototype()) { 9758 auto *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(NonParmDecl); 9759 9760 // We don't want to reparent enumerators. Look at their parent enum 9761 // instead. 9762 if (!TD) { 9763 if (auto *ECD = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(NonParmDecl)) 9764 TD = cast<EnumDecl>(ECD->getDeclContext()); 9765 } 9766 if (!TD) 9767 continue; 9768 DeclContext *TagDC = TD->getLexicalDeclContext(); 9769 if (!TagDC->containsDecl(TD)) 9770 continue; 9771 TagDC->removeDecl(TD); 9772 TD->setDeclContext(NewFD); 9773 NewFD->addDecl(TD); 9774 9775 // Preserve the lexical DeclContext if it is not the surrounding tag 9776 // injection context of the FD. In this example, the semantic context of 9777 // E will be f and the lexical context will be S, while both the 9778 // semantic and lexical contexts of S will be f: 9779 // void f(struct S { enum E { a } f; } s); 9780 if (TagDC != PrototypeTagContext) 9781 TD->setLexicalDeclContext(TagDC); 9782 } 9783 } 9784 } else if (const FunctionProtoType *FT = R->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) { 9785 // When we're declaring a function with a typedef, typeof, etc as in the 9786 // following example, we'll need to synthesize (unnamed) 9787 // parameters for use in the declaration. 9788 // 9789 // @code 9790 // typedef void fn(int); 9791 // fn f; 9792 // @endcode 9793 9794 // Synthesize a parameter for each argument type. 9795 for (const auto &AI : FT->param_types()) { 9796 ParmVarDecl *Param = 9797 BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(NewFD, D.getIdentifierLoc(), AI); 9798 Param->setScopeInfo(0, Params.size()); 9799 Params.push_back(Param); 9800 } 9801 } else { 9802 assert(R->isFunctionNoProtoType() && NewFD->getNumParams() == 0 && 9803 "Should not need args for typedef of non-prototype fn"); 9804 } 9805 9806 // Finally, we know we have the right number of parameters, install them. 9807 NewFD->setParams(Params); 9808 9809 if (D.getDeclSpec().isNoreturnSpecified()) 9810 NewFD->addAttr(C11NoReturnAttr::Create(Context, 9811 D.getDeclSpec().getNoreturnSpecLoc(), 9812 AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Keyword)); 9813 9814 // Functions returning a variably modified type violate C99 6.7.5.2p2 9815 // because all functions have linkage. 9816 if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && 9817 NewFD->getReturnType()->isVariablyModifiedType()) { 9818 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_vm_func_decl); 9819 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 9820 } 9821 9822 // Apply an implicit SectionAttr if '#pragma clang section text' is active 9823 if (PragmaClangTextSection.Valid && D.isFunctionDefinition() && 9824 !NewFD->hasAttr<SectionAttr>()) 9825 NewFD->addAttr(PragmaClangTextSectionAttr::CreateImplicit( 9826 Context, PragmaClangTextSection.SectionName, 9827 PragmaClangTextSection.PragmaLocation, AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma)); 9828 9829 // Apply an implicit SectionAttr if #pragma code_seg is active. 9830 if (CodeSegStack.CurrentValue && D.isFunctionDefinition() && 9831 !NewFD->hasAttr<SectionAttr>()) { 9832 NewFD->addAttr(SectionAttr::CreateImplicit( 9833 Context, CodeSegStack.CurrentValue->getString(), 9834 CodeSegStack.CurrentPragmaLocation, AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma, 9835 SectionAttr::Declspec_allocate)); 9836 if (UnifySection(CodeSegStack.CurrentValue->getString(), 9837 ASTContext::PSF_Implicit | ASTContext::PSF_Execute | 9838 ASTContext::PSF_Read, 9839 NewFD)) 9840 NewFD->dropAttr<SectionAttr>(); 9841 } 9842 9843 // Apply an implicit CodeSegAttr from class declspec or 9844 // apply an implicit SectionAttr from #pragma code_seg if active. 9845 if (!NewFD->hasAttr<CodeSegAttr>()) { 9846 if (Attr *SAttr = getImplicitCodeSegOrSectionAttrForFunction(NewFD, 9847 D.isFunctionDefinition())) { 9848 NewFD->addAttr(SAttr); 9849 } 9850 } 9851 9852 // Handle attributes. 9853 ProcessDeclAttributes(S, NewFD, D); 9854 9855 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) { 9856 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.5: Using an address space qualifier in a function return 9857 // type declaration will generate a compilation error. 9858 LangAS AddressSpace = NewFD->getReturnType().getAddressSpace(); 9859 if (AddressSpace != LangAS::Default) { 9860 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), 9861 diag::err_opencl_return_value_with_address_space); 9862 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 9863 } 9864 } 9865 9866 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 9867 // Perform semantic checking on the function declaration. 9868 if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && NewFD->isMain()) 9869 CheckMain(NewFD, D.getDeclSpec()); 9870 9871 if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && NewFD->isMSVCRTEntryPoint()) 9872 CheckMSVCRTEntryPoint(NewFD); 9873 9874 if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) 9875 D.setRedeclaration(CheckFunctionDeclaration(S, NewFD, Previous, 9876 isMemberSpecialization, 9877 D.isFunctionDefinition())); 9878 else if (!Previous.empty()) 9879 // Recover gracefully from an invalid redeclaration. 9880 D.setRedeclaration(true); 9881 assert((NewFD->isInvalidDecl() || !D.isRedeclaration() || 9882 Previous.getResultKind() != LookupResult::FoundOverloaded) && 9883 "previous declaration set still overloaded"); 9884 9885 // Diagnose no-prototype function declarations with calling conventions that 9886 // don't support variadic calls. Only do this in C and do it after merging 9887 // possibly prototyped redeclarations. 9888 const FunctionType *FT = NewFD->getType()->castAs<FunctionType>(); 9889 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FT) && !D.isFunctionDefinition()) { 9890 CallingConv CC = FT->getExtInfo().getCC(); 9891 if (!supportsVariadicCall(CC)) { 9892 // Windows system headers sometimes accidentally use stdcall without 9893 // (void) parameters, so we relax this to a warning. 9894 int DiagID = 9895 CC == CC_X86StdCall ? diag::warn_cconv_knr : diag::err_cconv_knr; 9896 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), DiagID) 9897 << FunctionType::getNameForCallConv(CC); 9898 } 9899 } 9900 9901 if (NewFD->getReturnType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion() || 9902 NewFD->getReturnType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion()) 9903 checkNonTrivialCUnion(NewFD->getReturnType(), 9904 NewFD->getReturnTypeSourceRange().getBegin(), 9905 NTCUC_FunctionReturn, NTCUK_Destruct|NTCUK_Copy); 9906 } else { 9907 // C++11 [replacement.functions]p3: 9908 // The program's definitions shall not be specified as inline. 9909 // 9910 // N.B. We diagnose declarations instead of definitions per LWG issue 2340. 9911 // 9912 // Suppress the diagnostic if the function is __attribute__((used)), since 9913 // that forces an external definition to be emitted. 9914 if (D.getDeclSpec().isInlineSpecified() && 9915 NewFD->isReplaceableGlobalAllocationFunction() && 9916 !NewFD->hasAttr<UsedAttr>()) 9917 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc(), 9918 diag::ext_operator_new_delete_declared_inline) 9919 << NewFD->getDeclName(); 9920 9921 // If the declarator is a template-id, translate the parser's template 9922 // argument list into our AST format. 9923 if (D.getName().getKind() == UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId) { 9924 TemplateIdAnnotation *TemplateId = D.getName().TemplateId; 9925 TemplateArgs.setLAngleLoc(TemplateId->LAngleLoc); 9926 TemplateArgs.setRAngleLoc(TemplateId->RAngleLoc); 9927 ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(), 9928 TemplateId->NumArgs); 9929 translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr, 9930 TemplateArgs); 9931 9932 HasExplicitTemplateArgs = true; 9933 9934 if (NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) { 9935 HasExplicitTemplateArgs = false; 9936 } else if (FunctionTemplate) { 9937 // Function template with explicit template arguments. 9938 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_function_template_partial_spec) 9939 << SourceRange(TemplateId->LAngleLoc, TemplateId->RAngleLoc); 9940 9941 HasExplicitTemplateArgs = false; 9942 } else { 9943 assert((isFunctionTemplateSpecialization || 9944 D.getDeclSpec().isFriendSpecified()) && 9945 "should have a 'template<>' for this decl"); 9946 // "friend void foo<>(int);" is an implicit specialization decl. 9947 isFunctionTemplateSpecialization = true; 9948 } 9949 } else if (isFriend && isFunctionTemplateSpecialization) { 9950 // This combination is only possible in a recovery case; the user 9951 // wrote something like: 9952 // template <> friend void foo(int); 9953 // which we're recovering from as if the user had written: 9954 // friend void foo<>(int); 9955 // Go ahead and fake up a template id. 9956 HasExplicitTemplateArgs = true; 9957 TemplateArgs.setLAngleLoc(D.getIdentifierLoc()); 9958 TemplateArgs.setRAngleLoc(D.getIdentifierLoc()); 9959 } 9960 9961 // We do not add HD attributes to specializations here because 9962 // they may have different constexpr-ness compared to their 9963 // templates and, after maybeAddCUDAHostDeviceAttrs() is applied, 9964 // may end up with different effective targets. Instead, a 9965 // specialization inherits its target attributes from its template 9966 // in the CheckFunctionTemplateSpecialization() call below. 9967 if (getLangOpts().CUDA && !isFunctionTemplateSpecialization) 9968 maybeAddCUDAHostDeviceAttrs(NewFD, Previous); 9969 9970 // If it's a friend (and only if it's a friend), it's possible 9971 // that either the specialized function type or the specialized 9972 // template is dependent, and therefore matching will fail. In 9973 // this case, don't check the specialization yet. 9974 if (isFunctionTemplateSpecialization && isFriend && 9975 (NewFD->getType()->isDependentType() || DC->isDependentContext() || 9976 TemplateSpecializationType::anyInstantiationDependentTemplateArguments( 9977 TemplateArgs.arguments()))) { 9978 assert(HasExplicitTemplateArgs && 9979 "friend function specialization without template args"); 9980 if (CheckDependentFunctionTemplateSpecialization(NewFD, TemplateArgs, 9981 Previous)) 9982 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 9983 } else if (isFunctionTemplateSpecialization) { 9984 if (CurContext->isDependentContext() && CurContext->isRecord() 9985 && !isFriend) { 9986 isDependentClassScopeExplicitSpecialization = true; 9987 } else if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && 9988 CheckFunctionTemplateSpecialization( 9989 NewFD, (HasExplicitTemplateArgs ? &TemplateArgs : nullptr), 9990 Previous)) 9991 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 9992 9993 // C++ [dcl.stc]p1: 9994 // A storage-class-specifier shall not be specified in an explicit 9995 // specialization (14.7.3) 9996 FunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo *Info = 9997 NewFD->getTemplateSpecializationInfo(); 9998 if (Info && SC != SC_None) { 9999 if (SC != Info->getTemplate()->getTemplatedDecl()->getStorageClass()) 10000 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), 10001 diag::err_explicit_specialization_inconsistent_storage_class) 10002 << SC 10003 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval( 10004 D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc()); 10005 10006 else 10007 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), 10008 diag::ext_explicit_specialization_storage_class) 10009 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval( 10010 D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc()); 10011 } 10012 } else if (isMemberSpecialization && isa<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD)) { 10013 if (CheckMemberSpecialization(NewFD, Previous)) 10014 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10015 } 10016 10017 // Perform semantic checking on the function declaration. 10018 if (!isDependentClassScopeExplicitSpecialization) { 10019 if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && NewFD->isMain()) 10020 CheckMain(NewFD, D.getDeclSpec()); 10021 10022 if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && NewFD->isMSVCRTEntryPoint()) 10023 CheckMSVCRTEntryPoint(NewFD); 10024 10025 if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) 10026 D.setRedeclaration(CheckFunctionDeclaration(S, NewFD, Previous, 10027 isMemberSpecialization, 10028 D.isFunctionDefinition())); 10029 else if (!Previous.empty()) 10030 // Recover gracefully from an invalid redeclaration. 10031 D.setRedeclaration(true); 10032 } 10033 10034 assert((NewFD->isInvalidDecl() || !D.isRedeclaration() || 10035 Previous.getResultKind() != LookupResult::FoundOverloaded) && 10036 "previous declaration set still overloaded"); 10037 10038 NamedDecl *PrincipalDecl = (FunctionTemplate 10039 ? cast<NamedDecl>(FunctionTemplate) 10040 : NewFD); 10041 10042 if (isFriend && NewFD->getPreviousDecl()) { 10043 AccessSpecifier Access = AS_public; 10044 if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) 10045 Access = NewFD->getPreviousDecl()->getAccess(); 10046 10047 NewFD->setAccess(Access); 10048 if (FunctionTemplate) FunctionTemplate->setAccess(Access); 10049 } 10050 10051 if (NewFD->isOverloadedOperator() && !DC->isRecord() && 10052 PrincipalDecl->isInIdentifierNamespace(Decl::IDNS_Ordinary)) 10053 PrincipalDecl->setNonMemberOperator(); 10054 10055 // If we have a function template, check the template parameter 10056 // list. This will check and merge default template arguments. 10057 if (FunctionTemplate) { 10058 FunctionTemplateDecl *PrevTemplate = 10059 FunctionTemplate->getPreviousDecl(); 10060 CheckTemplateParameterList(FunctionTemplate->getTemplateParameters(), 10061 PrevTemplate ? PrevTemplate->getTemplateParameters() 10062 : nullptr, 10063 D.getDeclSpec().isFriendSpecified() 10064 ? (D.isFunctionDefinition() 10065 ? TPC_FriendFunctionTemplateDefinition 10066 : TPC_FriendFunctionTemplate) 10067 : (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet() && 10068 DC && DC->isRecord() && 10069 DC->isDependentContext()) 10070 ? TPC_ClassTemplateMember 10071 : TPC_FunctionTemplate); 10072 } 10073 10074 if (NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) { 10075 // Ignore all the rest of this. 10076 } else if (!D.isRedeclaration()) { 10077 struct ActOnFDArgs ExtraArgs = { S, D, TemplateParamLists, 10078 AddToScope }; 10079 // Fake up an access specifier if it's supposed to be a class member. 10080 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(NewFD->getDeclContext())) 10081 NewFD->setAccess(AS_public); 10082 10083 // Qualified decls generally require a previous declaration. 10084 if (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet()) { 10085 // ...with the major exception of templated-scope or 10086 // dependent-scope friend declarations. 10087 10088 // TODO: we currently also suppress this check in dependent 10089 // contexts because (1) the parameter depth will be off when 10090 // matching friend templates and (2) we might actually be 10091 // selecting a friend based on a dependent factor. But there 10092 // are situations where these conditions don't apply and we 10093 // can actually do this check immediately. 10094 // 10095 // Unless the scope is dependent, it's always an error if qualified 10096 // redeclaration lookup found nothing at all. Diagnose that now; 10097 // nothing will diagnose that error later. 10098 if (isFriend && 10099 (D.getCXXScopeSpec().getScopeRep()->isDependent() || 10100 (!Previous.empty() && CurContext->isDependentContext()))) { 10101 // ignore these 10102 } else if (NewFD->isCPUDispatchMultiVersion() || 10103 NewFD->isCPUSpecificMultiVersion()) { 10104 // ignore this, we allow the redeclaration behavior here to create new 10105 // versions of the function. 10106 } else { 10107 // The user tried to provide an out-of-line definition for a 10108 // function that is a member of a class or namespace, but there 10109 // was no such member function declared (C++ [class.mfct]p2, 10110 // C++ [namespace.memdef]p2). For example: 10111 // 10112 // class X { 10113 // void f() const; 10114 // }; 10115 // 10116 // void X::f() { } // ill-formed 10117 // 10118 // Complain about this problem, and attempt to suggest close 10119 // matches (e.g., those that differ only in cv-qualifiers and 10120 // whether the parameter types are references). 10121 10122 if (NamedDecl *Result = DiagnoseInvalidRedeclaration( 10123 *this, Previous, NewFD, ExtraArgs, false, nullptr)) { 10124 AddToScope = ExtraArgs.AddToScope; 10125 return Result; 10126 } 10127 } 10128 10129 // Unqualified local friend declarations are required to resolve 10130 // to something. 10131 } else if (isFriend && cast<CXXRecordDecl>(CurContext)->isLocalClass()) { 10132 if (NamedDecl *Result = DiagnoseInvalidRedeclaration( 10133 *this, Previous, NewFD, ExtraArgs, true, S)) { 10134 AddToScope = ExtraArgs.AddToScope; 10135 return Result; 10136 } 10137 } 10138 } else if (!D.isFunctionDefinition() && 10139 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD) && NewFD->isOutOfLine() && 10140 !isFriend && !isFunctionTemplateSpecialization && 10141 !isMemberSpecialization) { 10142 // An out-of-line member function declaration must also be a 10143 // definition (C++ [class.mfct]p2). 10144 // Note that this is not the case for explicit specializations of 10145 // function templates or member functions of class templates, per 10146 // C++ [temp.expl.spec]p2. We also allow these declarations as an 10147 // extension for compatibility with old SWIG code which likes to 10148 // generate them. 10149 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::ext_out_of_line_declaration) 10150 << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getRange(); 10151 } 10152 } 10153 10154 // If this is the first declaration of a library builtin function, add 10155 // attributes as appropriate. 10156 if (!D.isRedeclaration()) { 10157 if (IdentifierInfo *II = Previous.getLookupName().getAsIdentifierInfo()) { 10158 if (unsigned BuiltinID = II->getBuiltinID()) { 10159 bool InStdNamespace = Context.BuiltinInfo.isInStdNamespace(BuiltinID); 10160 if (!InStdNamespace && 10161 NewFD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isFileContext()) { 10162 if (NewFD->getLanguageLinkage() == CLanguageLinkage) { 10163 // Validate the type matches unless this builtin is specified as 10164 // matching regardless of its declared type. 10165 if (Context.BuiltinInfo.allowTypeMismatch(BuiltinID)) { 10166 NewFD->addAttr(BuiltinAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, BuiltinID)); 10167 } else { 10168 ASTContext::GetBuiltinTypeError Error; 10169 LookupNecessaryTypesForBuiltin(S, BuiltinID); 10170 QualType BuiltinType = Context.GetBuiltinType(BuiltinID, Error); 10171 10172 if (!Error && !BuiltinType.isNull() && 10173 Context.hasSameFunctionTypeIgnoringExceptionSpec( 10174 NewFD->getType(), BuiltinType)) 10175 NewFD->addAttr(BuiltinAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, BuiltinID)); 10176 } 10177 } 10178 } else if (InStdNamespace && NewFD->isInStdNamespace() && 10179 isStdBuiltin(Context, NewFD, BuiltinID)) { 10180 NewFD->addAttr(BuiltinAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, BuiltinID)); 10181 } 10182 } 10183 } 10184 } 10185 10186 ProcessPragmaWeak(S, NewFD); 10187 checkAttributesAfterMerging(*this, *NewFD); 10188 10189 AddKnownFunctionAttributes(NewFD); 10190 10191 if (NewFD->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>() && 10192 !NewFD->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) { 10193 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), 10194 diag::err_attribute_overloadable_no_prototype) 10195 << NewFD; 10196 10197 // Turn this into a variadic function with no parameters. 10198 const auto *FT = NewFD->getType()->castAs<FunctionType>(); 10199 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI( 10200 Context.getDefaultCallingConvention(true, false)); 10201 EPI.Variadic = true; 10202 EPI.ExtInfo = FT->getExtInfo(); 10203 10204 QualType R = Context.getFunctionType(FT->getReturnType(), None, EPI); 10205 NewFD->setType(R); 10206 } 10207 10208 // If there's a #pragma GCC visibility in scope, and this isn't a class 10209 // member, set the visibility of this function. 10210 if (!DC->isRecord() && NewFD->isExternallyVisible()) 10211 AddPushedVisibilityAttribute(NewFD); 10212 10213 // If there's a #pragma clang arc_cf_code_audited in scope, consider 10214 // marking the function. 10215 AddCFAuditedAttribute(NewFD); 10216 10217 // If this is a function definition, check if we have to apply any 10218 // attributes (i.e. optnone and no_builtin) due to a pragma. 10219 if (D.isFunctionDefinition()) { 10220 AddRangeBasedOptnone(NewFD); 10221 AddImplicitMSFunctionNoBuiltinAttr(NewFD); 10222 } 10223 10224 // If this is the first declaration of an extern C variable, update 10225 // the map of such variables. 10226 if (NewFD->isFirstDecl() && !NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && 10227 isIncompleteDeclExternC(*this, NewFD)) 10228 RegisterLocallyScopedExternCDecl(NewFD, S); 10229 10230 // Set this FunctionDecl's range up to the right paren. 10231 NewFD->setRangeEnd(D.getSourceRange().getEnd()); 10232 10233 if (D.isRedeclaration() && !Previous.empty()) { 10234 NamedDecl *Prev = Previous.getRepresentativeDecl(); 10235 checkDLLAttributeRedeclaration(*this, Prev, NewFD, 10236 isMemberSpecialization || 10237 isFunctionTemplateSpecialization, 10238 D.isFunctionDefinition()); 10239 } 10240 10241 if (getLangOpts().CUDA) { 10242 IdentifierInfo *II = NewFD->getIdentifier(); 10243 if (II && II->isStr(getCudaConfigureFuncName()) && 10244 !NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && 10245 NewFD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit()) { 10246 if (!R->castAs<FunctionType>()->getReturnType()->isScalarType()) 10247 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_config_scalar_return) 10248 << getCudaConfigureFuncName(); 10249 Context.setcudaConfigureCallDecl(NewFD); 10250 } 10251 10252 // Variadic functions, other than a *declaration* of printf, are not allowed 10253 // in device-side CUDA code, unless someone passed 10254 // -fcuda-allow-variadic-functions. 10255 if (!getLangOpts().CUDAAllowVariadicFunctions && NewFD->isVariadic() && 10256 (NewFD->hasAttr<CUDADeviceAttr>() || 10257 NewFD->hasAttr<CUDAGlobalAttr>()) && 10258 !(II && II->isStr("printf") && NewFD->isExternC() && 10259 !D.isFunctionDefinition())) { 10260 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_variadic_device_fn); 10261 } 10262 } 10263 10264 MarkUnusedFileScopedDecl(NewFD); 10265 10266 10267 10268 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && NewFD->hasAttr<OpenCLKernelAttr>()) { 10269 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.8 static is invalid for kernel functions. 10270 if (SC == SC_Static) { 10271 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_static_kernel); 10272 D.setInvalidType(); 10273 } 10274 10275 // OpenCL v1.2, s6.9 -- Kernels can only have return type void. 10276 if (!NewFD->getReturnType()->isVoidType()) { 10277 SourceRange RTRange = NewFD->getReturnTypeSourceRange(); 10278 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_expected_kernel_void_return_type) 10279 << (RTRange.isValid() ? FixItHint::CreateReplacement(RTRange, "void") 10280 : FixItHint()); 10281 D.setInvalidType(); 10282 } 10283 10284 llvm::SmallPtrSet<const Type *, 16> ValidTypes; 10285 for (auto Param : NewFD->parameters()) 10286 checkIsValidOpenCLKernelParameter(*this, D, Param, ValidTypes); 10287 10288 if (getLangOpts().OpenCLCPlusPlus) { 10289 if (DC->isRecord()) { 10290 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_method_kernel); 10291 D.setInvalidType(); 10292 } 10293 if (FunctionTemplate) { 10294 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_template_kernel); 10295 D.setInvalidType(); 10296 } 10297 } 10298 } 10299 10300 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 10301 if (FunctionTemplate) { 10302 if (NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) 10303 FunctionTemplate->setInvalidDecl(); 10304 return FunctionTemplate; 10305 } 10306 10307 if (isMemberSpecialization && !NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) 10308 CompleteMemberSpecialization(NewFD, Previous); 10309 } 10310 10311 for (const ParmVarDecl *Param : NewFD->parameters()) { 10312 QualType PT = Param->getType(); 10313 10314 // OpenCL 2.0 pipe restrictions forbids pipe packet types to be non-value 10315 // types. 10316 if (getLangOpts().getOpenCLCompatibleVersion() >= 200) { 10317 if(const PipeType *PipeTy = PT->getAs<PipeType>()) { 10318 QualType ElemTy = PipeTy->getElementType(); 10319 if (ElemTy->isReferenceType() || ElemTy->isPointerType()) { 10320 Diag(Param->getTypeSpecStartLoc(), diag::err_reference_pipe_type ); 10321 D.setInvalidType(); 10322 } 10323 } 10324 } 10325 } 10326 10327 // Here we have an function template explicit specialization at class scope. 10328 // The actual specialization will be postponed to template instatiation 10329 // time via the ClassScopeFunctionSpecializationDecl node. 10330 if (isDependentClassScopeExplicitSpecialization) { 10331 ClassScopeFunctionSpecializationDecl *NewSpec = 10332 ClassScopeFunctionSpecializationDecl::Create( 10333 Context, CurContext, NewFD->getLocation(), 10334 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD), 10335 HasExplicitTemplateArgs, TemplateArgs); 10336 CurContext->addDecl(NewSpec); 10337 AddToScope = false; 10338 } 10339 10340 // Diagnose availability attributes. Availability cannot be used on functions 10341 // that are run during load/unload. 10342 if (const auto *attr = NewFD->getAttr<AvailabilityAttr>()) { 10343 if (NewFD->hasAttr<ConstructorAttr>()) { 10344 Diag(attr->getLocation(), diag::warn_availability_on_static_initializer) 10345 << 1; 10346 NewFD->dropAttr<AvailabilityAttr>(); 10347 } 10348 if (NewFD->hasAttr<DestructorAttr>()) { 10349 Diag(attr->getLocation(), diag::warn_availability_on_static_initializer) 10350 << 2; 10351 NewFD->dropAttr<AvailabilityAttr>(); 10352 } 10353 } 10354 10355 // Diagnose no_builtin attribute on function declaration that are not a 10356 // definition. 10357 // FIXME: We should really be doing this in 10358 // SemaDeclAttr.cpp::handleNoBuiltinAttr, unfortunately we only have access to 10359 // the FunctionDecl and at this point of the code 10360 // FunctionDecl::isThisDeclarationADefinition() which always returns `false` 10361 // because Sema::ActOnStartOfFunctionDef has not been called yet. 10362 if (const auto *NBA = NewFD->getAttr<NoBuiltinAttr>()) 10363 switch (D.getFunctionDefinitionKind()) { 10364 case FunctionDefinitionKind::Defaulted: 10365 case FunctionDefinitionKind::Deleted: 10366 Diag(NBA->getLocation(), 10367 diag::err_attribute_no_builtin_on_defaulted_deleted_function) 10368 << NBA->getSpelling(); 10369 break; 10370 case FunctionDefinitionKind::Declaration: 10371 Diag(NBA->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_no_builtin_on_non_definition) 10372 << NBA->getSpelling(); 10373 break; 10374 case FunctionDefinitionKind::Definition: 10375 break; 10376 } 10377 10378 return NewFD; 10379 } 10380 10381 /// Return a CodeSegAttr from a containing class. The Microsoft docs say 10382 /// when __declspec(code_seg) "is applied to a class, all member functions of 10383 /// the class and nested classes -- this includes compiler-generated special 10384 /// member functions -- are put in the specified segment." 10385 /// The actual behavior is a little more complicated. The Microsoft compiler 10386 /// won't check outer classes if there is an active value from #pragma code_seg. 10387 /// The CodeSeg is always applied from the direct parent but only from outer 10388 /// classes when the #pragma code_seg stack is empty. See: 10389 /// https://reviews.llvm.org/D22931, the Microsoft feedback page is no longer 10390 /// available since MS has removed the page. 10391 static Attr *getImplicitCodeSegAttrFromClass(Sema &S, const FunctionDecl *FD) { 10392 const auto *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD); 10393 if (!Method) 10394 return nullptr; 10395 const CXXRecordDecl *Parent = Method->getParent(); 10396 if (const auto *SAttr = Parent->getAttr<CodeSegAttr>()) { 10397 Attr *NewAttr = SAttr->clone(S.getASTContext()); 10398 NewAttr->setImplicit(true); 10399 return NewAttr; 10400 } 10401 10402 // The Microsoft compiler won't check outer classes for the CodeSeg 10403 // when the #pragma code_seg stack is active. 10404 if (S.CodeSegStack.CurrentValue) 10405 return nullptr; 10406 10407 while ((Parent = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Parent->getParent()))) { 10408 if (const auto *SAttr = Parent->getAttr<CodeSegAttr>()) { 10409 Attr *NewAttr = SAttr->clone(S.getASTContext()); 10410 NewAttr->setImplicit(true); 10411 return NewAttr; 10412 } 10413 } 10414 return nullptr; 10415 } 10416 10417 /// Returns an implicit CodeSegAttr if a __declspec(code_seg) is found on a 10418 /// containing class. Otherwise it will return implicit SectionAttr if the 10419 /// function is a definition and there is an active value on CodeSegStack 10420 /// (from the current #pragma code-seg value). 10421 /// 10422 /// \param FD Function being declared. 10423 /// \param IsDefinition Whether it is a definition or just a declarartion. 10424 /// \returns A CodeSegAttr or SectionAttr to apply to the function or 10425 /// nullptr if no attribute should be added. 10426 Attr *Sema::getImplicitCodeSegOrSectionAttrForFunction(const FunctionDecl *FD, 10427 bool IsDefinition) { 10428 if (Attr *A = getImplicitCodeSegAttrFromClass(*this, FD)) 10429 return A; 10430 if (!FD->hasAttr<SectionAttr>() && IsDefinition && 10431 CodeSegStack.CurrentValue) 10432 return SectionAttr::CreateImplicit( 10433 getASTContext(), CodeSegStack.CurrentValue->getString(), 10434 CodeSegStack.CurrentPragmaLocation, AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma, 10435 SectionAttr::Declspec_allocate); 10436 return nullptr; 10437 } 10438 10439 /// Determines if we can perform a correct type check for \p D as a 10440 /// redeclaration of \p PrevDecl. If not, we can generally still perform a 10441 /// best-effort check. 10442 /// 10443 /// \param NewD The new declaration. 10444 /// \param OldD The old declaration. 10445 /// \param NewT The portion of the type of the new declaration to check. 10446 /// \param OldT The portion of the type of the old declaration to check. 10447 bool Sema::canFullyTypeCheckRedeclaration(ValueDecl *NewD, ValueDecl *OldD, 10448 QualType NewT, QualType OldT) { 10449 if (!NewD->getLexicalDeclContext()->isDependentContext()) 10450 return true; 10451 10452 // For dependently-typed local extern declarations and friends, we can't 10453 // perform a correct type check in general until instantiation: 10454 // 10455 // int f(); 10456 // template<typename T> void g() { T f(); } 10457 // 10458 // (valid if g() is only instantiated with T = int). 10459 if (NewT->isDependentType() && 10460 (NewD->isLocalExternDecl() || NewD->getFriendObjectKind())) 10461 return false; 10462 10463 // Similarly, if the previous declaration was a dependent local extern 10464 // declaration, we don't really know its type yet. 10465 if (OldT->isDependentType() && OldD->isLocalExternDecl()) 10466 return false; 10467 10468 return true; 10469 } 10470 10471 /// Checks if the new declaration declared in dependent context must be 10472 /// put in the same redeclaration chain as the specified declaration. 10473 /// 10474 /// \param D Declaration that is checked. 10475 /// \param PrevDecl Previous declaration found with proper lookup method for the 10476 /// same declaration name. 10477 /// \returns True if D must be added to the redeclaration chain which PrevDecl 10478 /// belongs to. 10479 /// 10480 bool Sema::shouldLinkDependentDeclWithPrevious(Decl *D, Decl *PrevDecl) { 10481 if (!D->getLexicalDeclContext()->isDependentContext()) 10482 return true; 10483 10484 // Don't chain dependent friend function definitions until instantiation, to 10485 // permit cases like 10486 // 10487 // void func(); 10488 // template<typename T> class C1 { friend void func() {} }; 10489 // template<typename T> class C2 { friend void func() {} }; 10490 // 10491 // ... which is valid if only one of C1 and C2 is ever instantiated. 10492 // 10493 // FIXME: This need only apply to function definitions. For now, we proxy 10494 // this by checking for a file-scope function. We do not want this to apply 10495 // to friend declarations nominating member functions, because that gets in 10496 // the way of access checks. 10497 if (D->getFriendObjectKind() && D->getDeclContext()->isFileContext()) 10498 return false; 10499 10500 auto *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D); 10501 auto *PrevVD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(PrevDecl); 10502 return !VD || !PrevVD || 10503 canFullyTypeCheckRedeclaration(VD, PrevVD, VD->getType(), 10504 PrevVD->getType()); 10505 } 10506 10507 /// Check the target attribute of the function for MultiVersion 10508 /// validity. 10509 /// 10510 /// Returns true if there was an error, false otherwise. 10511 static bool CheckMultiVersionValue(Sema &S, const FunctionDecl *FD) { 10512 const auto *TA = FD->getAttr<TargetAttr>(); 10513 assert(TA && "MultiVersion Candidate requires a target attribute"); 10514 ParsedTargetAttr ParseInfo = TA->parse(); 10515 const TargetInfo &TargetInfo = S.Context.getTargetInfo(); 10516 enum ErrType { Feature = 0, Architecture = 1 }; 10517 10518 if (!ParseInfo.Architecture.empty() && 10519 !TargetInfo.validateCpuIs(ParseInfo.Architecture)) { 10520 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_bad_multiversion_option) 10521 << Architecture << ParseInfo.Architecture; 10522 return true; 10523 } 10524 10525 for (const auto &Feat : ParseInfo.Features) { 10526 auto BareFeat = StringRef{Feat}.substr(1); 10527 if (Feat[0] == '-') { 10528 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_bad_multiversion_option) 10529 << Feature << ("no-" + BareFeat).str(); 10530 return true; 10531 } 10532 10533 if (!TargetInfo.validateCpuSupports(BareFeat) || 10534 !TargetInfo.isValidFeatureName(BareFeat)) { 10535 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_bad_multiversion_option) 10536 << Feature << BareFeat; 10537 return true; 10538 } 10539 } 10540 return false; 10541 } 10542 10543 // Provide a white-list of attributes that are allowed to be combined with 10544 // multiversion functions. 10545 static bool AttrCompatibleWithMultiVersion(attr::Kind Kind, 10546 MultiVersionKind MVKind) { 10547 // Note: this list/diagnosis must match the list in 10548 // checkMultiversionAttributesAllSame. 10549 switch (Kind) { 10550 default: 10551 return false; 10552 case attr::Used: 10553 return MVKind == MultiVersionKind::Target; 10554 case attr::NonNull: 10555 case attr::NoThrow: 10556 return true; 10557 } 10558 } 10559 10560 static bool checkNonMultiVersionCompatAttributes(Sema &S, 10561 const FunctionDecl *FD, 10562 const FunctionDecl *CausedFD, 10563 MultiVersionKind MVKind) { 10564 const auto Diagnose = [FD, CausedFD, MVKind](Sema &S, const Attr *A) { 10565 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_disallowed_other_attr) 10566 << static_cast<unsigned>(MVKind) << A; 10567 if (CausedFD) 10568 S.Diag(CausedFD->getLocation(), diag::note_multiversioning_caused_here); 10569 return true; 10570 }; 10571 10572 for (const Attr *A : FD->attrs()) { 10573 switch (A->getKind()) { 10574 case attr::CPUDispatch: 10575 case attr::CPUSpecific: 10576 if (MVKind != MultiVersionKind::CPUDispatch && 10577 MVKind != MultiVersionKind::CPUSpecific) 10578 return Diagnose(S, A); 10579 break; 10580 case attr::Target: 10581 if (MVKind != MultiVersionKind::Target) 10582 return Diagnose(S, A); 10583 break; 10584 case attr::TargetClones: 10585 if (MVKind != MultiVersionKind::TargetClones) 10586 return Diagnose(S, A); 10587 break; 10588 default: 10589 if (!AttrCompatibleWithMultiVersion(A->getKind(), MVKind)) 10590 return Diagnose(S, A); 10591 break; 10592 } 10593 } 10594 return false; 10595 } 10596 10597 bool Sema::areMultiversionVariantFunctionsCompatible( 10598 const FunctionDecl *OldFD, const FunctionDecl *NewFD, 10599 const PartialDiagnostic &NoProtoDiagID, 10600 const PartialDiagnosticAt &NoteCausedDiagIDAt, 10601 const PartialDiagnosticAt &NoSupportDiagIDAt, 10602 const PartialDiagnosticAt &DiffDiagIDAt, bool TemplatesSupported, 10603 bool ConstexprSupported, bool CLinkageMayDiffer) { 10604 enum DoesntSupport { 10605 FuncTemplates = 0, 10606 VirtFuncs = 1, 10607 DeducedReturn = 2, 10608 Constructors = 3, 10609 Destructors = 4, 10610 DeletedFuncs = 5, 10611 DefaultedFuncs = 6, 10612 ConstexprFuncs = 7, 10613 ConstevalFuncs = 8, 10614 Lambda = 9, 10615 }; 10616 enum Different { 10617 CallingConv = 0, 10618 ReturnType = 1, 10619 ConstexprSpec = 2, 10620 InlineSpec = 3, 10621 Linkage = 4, 10622 LanguageLinkage = 5, 10623 }; 10624 10625 if (NoProtoDiagID.getDiagID() != 0 && OldFD && 10626 !OldFD->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) { 10627 Diag(OldFD->getLocation(), NoProtoDiagID); 10628 Diag(NoteCausedDiagIDAt.first, NoteCausedDiagIDAt.second); 10629 return true; 10630 } 10631 10632 if (NoProtoDiagID.getDiagID() != 0 && 10633 !NewFD->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) 10634 return Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), NoProtoDiagID); 10635 10636 if (!TemplatesSupported && 10637 NewFD->getTemplatedKind() == FunctionDecl::TK_FunctionTemplate) 10638 return Diag(NoSupportDiagIDAt.first, NoSupportDiagIDAt.second) 10639 << FuncTemplates; 10640 10641 if (const auto *NewCXXFD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD)) { 10642 if (NewCXXFD->isVirtual()) 10643 return Diag(NoSupportDiagIDAt.first, NoSupportDiagIDAt.second) 10644 << VirtFuncs; 10645 10646 if (isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(NewCXXFD)) 10647 return Diag(NoSupportDiagIDAt.first, NoSupportDiagIDAt.second) 10648 << Constructors; 10649 10650 if (isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(NewCXXFD)) 10651 return Diag(NoSupportDiagIDAt.first, NoSupportDiagIDAt.second) 10652 << Destructors; 10653 } 10654 10655 if (NewFD->isDeleted()) 10656 return Diag(NoSupportDiagIDAt.first, NoSupportDiagIDAt.second) 10657 << DeletedFuncs; 10658 10659 if (NewFD->isDefaulted()) 10660 return Diag(NoSupportDiagIDAt.first, NoSupportDiagIDAt.second) 10661 << DefaultedFuncs; 10662 10663 if (!ConstexprSupported && NewFD->isConstexpr()) 10664 return Diag(NoSupportDiagIDAt.first, NoSupportDiagIDAt.second) 10665 << (NewFD->isConsteval() ? ConstevalFuncs : ConstexprFuncs); 10666 10667 QualType NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(NewFD->getType()); 10668 const auto *NewType = cast<FunctionType>(NewQType); 10669 QualType NewReturnType = NewType->getReturnType(); 10670 10671 if (NewReturnType->isUndeducedType()) 10672 return Diag(NoSupportDiagIDAt.first, NoSupportDiagIDAt.second) 10673 << DeducedReturn; 10674 10675 // Ensure the return type is identical. 10676 if (OldFD) { 10677 QualType OldQType = Context.getCanonicalType(OldFD->getType()); 10678 const auto *OldType = cast<FunctionType>(OldQType); 10679 FunctionType::ExtInfo OldTypeInfo = OldType->getExtInfo(); 10680 FunctionType::ExtInfo NewTypeInfo = NewType->getExtInfo(); 10681 10682 if (OldTypeInfo.getCC() != NewTypeInfo.getCC()) 10683 return Diag(DiffDiagIDAt.first, DiffDiagIDAt.second) << CallingConv; 10684 10685 QualType OldReturnType = OldType->getReturnType(); 10686 10687 if (OldReturnType != NewReturnType) 10688 return Diag(DiffDiagIDAt.first, DiffDiagIDAt.second) << ReturnType; 10689 10690 if (OldFD->getConstexprKind() != NewFD->getConstexprKind()) 10691 return Diag(DiffDiagIDAt.first, DiffDiagIDAt.second) << ConstexprSpec; 10692 10693 if (OldFD->isInlineSpecified() != NewFD->isInlineSpecified()) 10694 return Diag(DiffDiagIDAt.first, DiffDiagIDAt.second) << InlineSpec; 10695 10696 if (OldFD->getFormalLinkage() != NewFD->getFormalLinkage()) 10697 return Diag(DiffDiagIDAt.first, DiffDiagIDAt.second) << Linkage; 10698 10699 if (!CLinkageMayDiffer && OldFD->isExternC() != NewFD->isExternC()) 10700 return Diag(DiffDiagIDAt.first, DiffDiagIDAt.second) << LanguageLinkage; 10701 10702 if (CheckEquivalentExceptionSpec( 10703 OldFD->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(), OldFD->getLocation(), 10704 NewFD->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(), NewFD->getLocation())) 10705 return true; 10706 } 10707 return false; 10708 } 10709 10710 static bool CheckMultiVersionAdditionalRules(Sema &S, const FunctionDecl *OldFD, 10711 const FunctionDecl *NewFD, 10712 bool CausesMV, 10713 MultiVersionKind MVKind) { 10714 if (!S.getASTContext().getTargetInfo().supportsMultiVersioning()) { 10715 S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_not_supported); 10716 if (OldFD) 10717 S.Diag(OldFD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 10718 return true; 10719 } 10720 10721 bool IsCPUSpecificCPUDispatchMVKind = 10722 MVKind == MultiVersionKind::CPUDispatch || 10723 MVKind == MultiVersionKind::CPUSpecific; 10724 10725 if (CausesMV && OldFD && 10726 checkNonMultiVersionCompatAttributes(S, OldFD, NewFD, MVKind)) 10727 return true; 10728 10729 if (checkNonMultiVersionCompatAttributes(S, NewFD, nullptr, MVKind)) 10730 return true; 10731 10732 // Only allow transition to MultiVersion if it hasn't been used. 10733 if (OldFD && CausesMV && OldFD->isUsed(false)) 10734 return S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_after_used); 10735 10736 return S.areMultiversionVariantFunctionsCompatible( 10737 OldFD, NewFD, S.PDiag(diag::err_multiversion_noproto), 10738 PartialDiagnosticAt(NewFD->getLocation(), 10739 S.PDiag(diag::note_multiversioning_caused_here)), 10740 PartialDiagnosticAt(NewFD->getLocation(), 10741 S.PDiag(diag::err_multiversion_doesnt_support) 10742 << static_cast<unsigned>(MVKind)), 10743 PartialDiagnosticAt(NewFD->getLocation(), 10744 S.PDiag(diag::err_multiversion_diff)), 10745 /*TemplatesSupported=*/false, 10746 /*ConstexprSupported=*/!IsCPUSpecificCPUDispatchMVKind, 10747 /*CLinkageMayDiffer=*/false); 10748 } 10749 10750 /// Check the validity of a multiversion function declaration that is the 10751 /// first of its kind. Also sets the multiversion'ness' of the function itself. 10752 /// 10753 /// This sets NewFD->isInvalidDecl() to true if there was an error. 10754 /// 10755 /// Returns true if there was an error, false otherwise. 10756 static bool CheckMultiVersionFirstFunction(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *FD, 10757 MultiVersionKind MVKind, 10758 const TargetAttr *TA) { 10759 assert(MVKind != MultiVersionKind::None && 10760 "Function lacks multiversion attribute"); 10761 10762 // Target only causes MV if it is default, otherwise this is a normal 10763 // function. 10764 if (MVKind == MultiVersionKind::Target && !TA->isDefaultVersion()) 10765 return false; 10766 10767 if (MVKind == MultiVersionKind::Target && CheckMultiVersionValue(S, FD)) { 10768 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 10769 return true; 10770 } 10771 10772 if (CheckMultiVersionAdditionalRules(S, nullptr, FD, true, MVKind)) { 10773 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 10774 return true; 10775 } 10776 10777 FD->setIsMultiVersion(); 10778 return false; 10779 } 10780 10781 static bool PreviousDeclsHaveMultiVersionAttribute(const FunctionDecl *FD) { 10782 for (const Decl *D = FD->getPreviousDecl(); D; D = D->getPreviousDecl()) { 10783 if (D->getAsFunction()->getMultiVersionKind() != MultiVersionKind::None) 10784 return true; 10785 } 10786 10787 return false; 10788 } 10789 10790 static bool CheckTargetCausesMultiVersioning( 10791 Sema &S, FunctionDecl *OldFD, FunctionDecl *NewFD, const TargetAttr *NewTA, 10792 bool &Redeclaration, NamedDecl *&OldDecl, LookupResult &Previous) { 10793 const auto *OldTA = OldFD->getAttr<TargetAttr>(); 10794 ParsedTargetAttr NewParsed = NewTA->parse(); 10795 // Sort order doesn't matter, it just needs to be consistent. 10796 llvm::sort(NewParsed.Features); 10797 10798 // If the old decl is NOT MultiVersioned yet, and we don't cause that 10799 // to change, this is a simple redeclaration. 10800 if (!NewTA->isDefaultVersion() && 10801 (!OldTA || OldTA->getFeaturesStr() == NewTA->getFeaturesStr())) 10802 return false; 10803 10804 // Otherwise, this decl causes MultiVersioning. 10805 if (CheckMultiVersionAdditionalRules(S, OldFD, NewFD, true, 10806 MultiVersionKind::Target)) { 10807 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10808 return true; 10809 } 10810 10811 if (CheckMultiVersionValue(S, NewFD)) { 10812 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10813 return true; 10814 } 10815 10816 // If this is 'default', permit the forward declaration. 10817 if (!OldFD->isMultiVersion() && !OldTA && NewTA->isDefaultVersion()) { 10818 Redeclaration = true; 10819 OldDecl = OldFD; 10820 OldFD->setIsMultiVersion(); 10821 NewFD->setIsMultiVersion(); 10822 return false; 10823 } 10824 10825 if (CheckMultiVersionValue(S, OldFD)) { 10826 S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::note_multiversioning_caused_here); 10827 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10828 return true; 10829 } 10830 10831 ParsedTargetAttr OldParsed = OldTA->parse(std::less<std::string>()); 10832 10833 if (OldParsed == NewParsed) { 10834 S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_duplicate); 10835 S.Diag(OldFD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 10836 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10837 return true; 10838 } 10839 10840 for (const auto *FD : OldFD->redecls()) { 10841 const auto *CurTA = FD->getAttr<TargetAttr>(); 10842 // We allow forward declarations before ANY multiversioning attributes, but 10843 // nothing after the fact. 10844 if (PreviousDeclsHaveMultiVersionAttribute(FD) && 10845 (!CurTA || CurTA->isInherited())) { 10846 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_required_in_redecl) 10847 << 0; 10848 S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::note_multiversioning_caused_here); 10849 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10850 return true; 10851 } 10852 } 10853 10854 OldFD->setIsMultiVersion(); 10855 NewFD->setIsMultiVersion(); 10856 Redeclaration = false; 10857 OldDecl = nullptr; 10858 Previous.clear(); 10859 return false; 10860 } 10861 10862 static bool MultiVersionTypesCompatible(MultiVersionKind Old, 10863 MultiVersionKind New) { 10864 if (Old == New || Old == MultiVersionKind::None || 10865 New == MultiVersionKind::None) 10866 return true; 10867 10868 return (Old == MultiVersionKind::CPUDispatch && 10869 New == MultiVersionKind::CPUSpecific) || 10870 (Old == MultiVersionKind::CPUSpecific && 10871 New == MultiVersionKind::CPUDispatch); 10872 } 10873 10874 /// Check the validity of a new function declaration being added to an existing 10875 /// multiversioned declaration collection. 10876 static bool CheckMultiVersionAdditionalDecl( 10877 Sema &S, FunctionDecl *OldFD, FunctionDecl *NewFD, 10878 MultiVersionKind NewMVKind, const TargetAttr *NewTA, 10879 const CPUDispatchAttr *NewCPUDisp, const CPUSpecificAttr *NewCPUSpec, 10880 const TargetClonesAttr *NewClones, bool &Redeclaration, NamedDecl *&OldDecl, 10881 LookupResult &Previous) { 10882 10883 MultiVersionKind OldMVKind = OldFD->getMultiVersionKind(); 10884 // Disallow mixing of multiversioning types. 10885 if (!MultiVersionTypesCompatible(OldMVKind, NewMVKind)) { 10886 S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_types_mixed); 10887 S.Diag(OldFD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 10888 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10889 return true; 10890 } 10891 10892 ParsedTargetAttr NewParsed; 10893 if (NewTA) { 10894 NewParsed = NewTA->parse(); 10895 llvm::sort(NewParsed.Features); 10896 } 10897 10898 bool UseMemberUsingDeclRules = 10899 S.CurContext->isRecord() && !NewFD->getFriendObjectKind(); 10900 10901 bool MayNeedOverloadableChecks = 10902 AllowOverloadingOfFunction(Previous, S.Context, NewFD); 10903 10904 // Next, check ALL non-overloads to see if this is a redeclaration of a 10905 // previous member of the MultiVersion set. 10906 for (NamedDecl *ND : Previous) { 10907 FunctionDecl *CurFD = ND->getAsFunction(); 10908 if (!CurFD) 10909 continue; 10910 if (MayNeedOverloadableChecks && 10911 S.IsOverload(NewFD, CurFD, UseMemberUsingDeclRules)) 10912 continue; 10913 10914 switch (NewMVKind) { 10915 case MultiVersionKind::None: 10916 assert(OldMVKind == MultiVersionKind::TargetClones && 10917 "Only target_clones can be omitted in subsequent declarations"); 10918 break; 10919 case MultiVersionKind::Target: { 10920 const auto *CurTA = CurFD->getAttr<TargetAttr>(); 10921 if (CurTA->getFeaturesStr() == NewTA->getFeaturesStr()) { 10922 NewFD->setIsMultiVersion(); 10923 Redeclaration = true; 10924 OldDecl = ND; 10925 return false; 10926 } 10927 10928 ParsedTargetAttr CurParsed = CurTA->parse(std::less<std::string>()); 10929 if (CurParsed == NewParsed) { 10930 S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_duplicate); 10931 S.Diag(CurFD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 10932 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10933 return true; 10934 } 10935 break; 10936 } 10937 case MultiVersionKind::TargetClones: { 10938 const auto *CurClones = CurFD->getAttr<TargetClonesAttr>(); 10939 Redeclaration = true; 10940 OldDecl = CurFD; 10941 NewFD->setIsMultiVersion(); 10942 10943 if (CurClones && NewClones && 10944 (CurClones->featuresStrs_size() != NewClones->featuresStrs_size() || 10945 !std::equal(CurClones->featuresStrs_begin(), 10946 CurClones->featuresStrs_end(), 10947 NewClones->featuresStrs_begin()))) { 10948 S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_target_clone_doesnt_match); 10949 S.Diag(CurFD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 10950 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10951 return true; 10952 } 10953 10954 return false; 10955 } 10956 case MultiVersionKind::CPUSpecific: 10957 case MultiVersionKind::CPUDispatch: { 10958 const auto *CurCPUSpec = CurFD->getAttr<CPUSpecificAttr>(); 10959 const auto *CurCPUDisp = CurFD->getAttr<CPUDispatchAttr>(); 10960 // Handle CPUDispatch/CPUSpecific versions. 10961 // Only 1 CPUDispatch function is allowed, this will make it go through 10962 // the redeclaration errors. 10963 if (NewMVKind == MultiVersionKind::CPUDispatch && 10964 CurFD->hasAttr<CPUDispatchAttr>()) { 10965 if (CurCPUDisp->cpus_size() == NewCPUDisp->cpus_size() && 10966 std::equal( 10967 CurCPUDisp->cpus_begin(), CurCPUDisp->cpus_end(), 10968 NewCPUDisp->cpus_begin(), 10969 [](const IdentifierInfo *Cur, const IdentifierInfo *New) { 10970 return Cur->getName() == New->getName(); 10971 })) { 10972 NewFD->setIsMultiVersion(); 10973 Redeclaration = true; 10974 OldDecl = ND; 10975 return false; 10976 } 10977 10978 // If the declarations don't match, this is an error condition. 10979 S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_cpu_dispatch_mismatch); 10980 S.Diag(CurFD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 10981 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10982 return true; 10983 } 10984 if (NewMVKind == MultiVersionKind::CPUSpecific && CurCPUSpec) { 10985 if (CurCPUSpec->cpus_size() == NewCPUSpec->cpus_size() && 10986 std::equal( 10987 CurCPUSpec->cpus_begin(), CurCPUSpec->cpus_end(), 10988 NewCPUSpec->cpus_begin(), 10989 [](const IdentifierInfo *Cur, const IdentifierInfo *New) { 10990 return Cur->getName() == New->getName(); 10991 })) { 10992 NewFD->setIsMultiVersion(); 10993 Redeclaration = true; 10994 OldDecl = ND; 10995 return false; 10996 } 10997 10998 // Only 1 version of CPUSpecific is allowed for each CPU. 10999 for (const IdentifierInfo *CurII : CurCPUSpec->cpus()) { 11000 for (const IdentifierInfo *NewII : NewCPUSpec->cpus()) { 11001 if (CurII == NewII) { 11002 S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_cpu_specific_multiple_defs) 11003 << NewII; 11004 S.Diag(CurFD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 11005 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 11006 return true; 11007 } 11008 } 11009 } 11010 } 11011 break; 11012 } 11013 } 11014 } 11015 11016 // Else, this is simply a non-redecl case. Checking the 'value' is only 11017 // necessary in the Target case, since The CPUSpecific/Dispatch cases are 11018 // handled in the attribute adding step. 11019 if (NewMVKind == MultiVersionKind::Target && 11020 CheckMultiVersionValue(S, NewFD)) { 11021 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 11022 return true; 11023 } 11024 11025 if (CheckMultiVersionAdditionalRules(S, OldFD, NewFD, 11026 !OldFD->isMultiVersion(), NewMVKind)) { 11027 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 11028 return true; 11029 } 11030 11031 // Permit forward declarations in the case where these two are compatible. 11032 if (!OldFD->isMultiVersion()) { 11033 OldFD->setIsMultiVersion(); 11034 NewFD->setIsMultiVersion(); 11035 Redeclaration = true; 11036 OldDecl = OldFD; 11037 return false; 11038 } 11039 11040 NewFD->setIsMultiVersion(); 11041 Redeclaration = false; 11042 OldDecl = nullptr; 11043 Previous.clear(); 11044 return false; 11045 } 11046 11047 /// Check the validity of a mulitversion function declaration. 11048 /// Also sets the multiversion'ness' of the function itself. 11049 /// 11050 /// This sets NewFD->isInvalidDecl() to true if there was an error. 11051 /// 11052 /// Returns true if there was an error, false otherwise. 11053 static bool CheckMultiVersionFunction(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *NewFD, 11054 bool &Redeclaration, NamedDecl *&OldDecl, 11055 LookupResult &Previous) { 11056 const auto *NewTA = NewFD->getAttr<TargetAttr>(); 11057 const auto *NewCPUDisp = NewFD->getAttr<CPUDispatchAttr>(); 11058 const auto *NewCPUSpec = NewFD->getAttr<CPUSpecificAttr>(); 11059 const auto *NewClones = NewFD->getAttr<TargetClonesAttr>(); 11060 MultiVersionKind MVKind = NewFD->getMultiVersionKind(); 11061 11062 // Main isn't allowed to become a multiversion function, however it IS 11063 // permitted to have 'main' be marked with the 'target' optimization hint. 11064 if (NewFD->isMain()) { 11065 if (MVKind != MultiVersionKind::None && 11066 !(MVKind == MultiVersionKind::Target && !NewTA->isDefaultVersion())) { 11067 S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_not_allowed_on_main); 11068 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 11069 return true; 11070 } 11071 return false; 11072 } 11073 11074 if (!OldDecl || !OldDecl->getAsFunction() || 11075 OldDecl->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext() != 11076 NewFD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()) { 11077 // If there's no previous declaration, AND this isn't attempting to cause 11078 // multiversioning, this isn't an error condition. 11079 if (MVKind == MultiVersionKind::None) 11080 return false; 11081 return CheckMultiVersionFirstFunction(S, NewFD, MVKind, NewTA); 11082 } 11083 11084 FunctionDecl *OldFD = OldDecl->getAsFunction(); 11085 11086 if (!OldFD->isMultiVersion() && MVKind == MultiVersionKind::None) 11087 return false; 11088 11089 // Multiversioned redeclarations aren't allowed to omit the attribute, except 11090 // for target_clones. 11091 if (OldFD->isMultiVersion() && MVKind == MultiVersionKind::None && 11092 OldFD->getMultiVersionKind() != MultiVersionKind::TargetClones) { 11093 S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_required_in_redecl) 11094 << (OldFD->getMultiVersionKind() != MultiVersionKind::Target); 11095 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 11096 return true; 11097 } 11098 11099 if (!OldFD->isMultiVersion()) { 11100 switch (MVKind) { 11101 case MultiVersionKind::Target: 11102 return CheckTargetCausesMultiVersioning(S, OldFD, NewFD, NewTA, 11103 Redeclaration, OldDecl, Previous); 11104 case MultiVersionKind::TargetClones: 11105 if (OldFD->isUsed(false)) { 11106 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 11107 return S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_after_used); 11108 } 11109 OldFD->setIsMultiVersion(); 11110 break; 11111 case MultiVersionKind::CPUDispatch: 11112 case MultiVersionKind::CPUSpecific: 11113 case MultiVersionKind::None: 11114 break; 11115 } 11116 } 11117 11118 // At this point, we have a multiversion function decl (in OldFD) AND an 11119 // appropriate attribute in the current function decl. Resolve that these are 11120 // still compatible with previous declarations. 11121 return CheckMultiVersionAdditionalDecl(S, OldFD, NewFD, MVKind, NewTA, 11122 NewCPUDisp, NewCPUSpec, NewClones, 11123 Redeclaration, OldDecl, Previous); 11124 } 11125 11126 /// Perform semantic checking of a new function declaration. 11127 /// 11128 /// Performs semantic analysis of the new function declaration 11129 /// NewFD. This routine performs all semantic checking that does not 11130 /// require the actual declarator involved in the declaration, and is 11131 /// used both for the declaration of functions as they are parsed 11132 /// (called via ActOnDeclarator) and for the declaration of functions 11133 /// that have been instantiated via C++ template instantiation (called 11134 /// via InstantiateDecl). 11135 /// 11136 /// \param IsMemberSpecialization whether this new function declaration is 11137 /// a member specialization (that replaces any definition provided by the 11138 /// previous declaration). 11139 /// 11140 /// This sets NewFD->isInvalidDecl() to true if there was an error. 11141 /// 11142 /// \returns true if the function declaration is a redeclaration. 11143 bool Sema::CheckFunctionDeclaration(Scope *S, FunctionDecl *NewFD, 11144 LookupResult &Previous, 11145 bool IsMemberSpecialization, 11146 bool DeclIsDefn) { 11147 assert(!NewFD->getReturnType()->isVariablyModifiedType() && 11148 "Variably modified return types are not handled here"); 11149 11150 // Determine whether the type of this function should be merged with 11151 // a previous visible declaration. This never happens for functions in C++, 11152 // and always happens in C if the previous declaration was visible. 11153 bool MergeTypeWithPrevious = !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 11154 !Previous.isShadowed(); 11155 11156 bool Redeclaration = false; 11157 NamedDecl *OldDecl = nullptr; 11158 bool MayNeedOverloadableChecks = false; 11159 11160 // Merge or overload the declaration with an existing declaration of 11161 // the same name, if appropriate. 11162 if (!Previous.empty()) { 11163 // Determine whether NewFD is an overload of PrevDecl or 11164 // a declaration that requires merging. If it's an overload, 11165 // there's no more work to do here; we'll just add the new 11166 // function to the scope. 11167 if (!AllowOverloadingOfFunction(Previous, Context, NewFD)) { 11168 NamedDecl *Candidate = Previous.getRepresentativeDecl(); 11169 if (shouldLinkPossiblyHiddenDecl(Candidate, NewFD)) { 11170 Redeclaration = true; 11171 OldDecl = Candidate; 11172 } 11173 } else { 11174 MayNeedOverloadableChecks = true; 11175 switch (CheckOverload(S, NewFD, Previous, OldDecl, 11176 /*NewIsUsingDecl*/ false)) { 11177 case Ovl_Match: 11178 Redeclaration = true; 11179 break; 11180 11181 case Ovl_NonFunction: 11182 Redeclaration = true; 11183 break; 11184 11185 case Ovl_Overload: 11186 Redeclaration = false; 11187 break; 11188 } 11189 } 11190 } 11191 11192 // Check for a previous extern "C" declaration with this name. 11193 if (!Redeclaration && 11194 checkForConflictWithNonVisibleExternC(*this, NewFD, Previous)) { 11195 if (!Previous.empty()) { 11196 // This is an extern "C" declaration with the same name as a previous 11197 // declaration, and thus redeclares that entity... 11198 Redeclaration = true; 11199 OldDecl = Previous.getFoundDecl(); 11200 MergeTypeWithPrevious = false; 11201 11202 // ... except in the presence of __attribute__((overloadable)). 11203 if (OldDecl->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>() || 11204 NewFD->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>()) { 11205 if (IsOverload(NewFD, cast<FunctionDecl>(OldDecl), false)) { 11206 MayNeedOverloadableChecks = true; 11207 Redeclaration = false; 11208 OldDecl = nullptr; 11209 } 11210 } 11211 } 11212 } 11213 11214 if (CheckMultiVersionFunction(*this, NewFD, Redeclaration, OldDecl, Previous)) 11215 return Redeclaration; 11216 11217 // PPC MMA non-pointer types are not allowed as function return types. 11218 if (Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isPPC64() && 11219 CheckPPCMMAType(NewFD->getReturnType(), NewFD->getLocation())) { 11220 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 11221 } 11222 11223 // C++11 [dcl.constexpr]p8: 11224 // A constexpr specifier for a non-static member function that is not 11225 // a constructor declares that member function to be const. 11226 // 11227 // This needs to be delayed until we know whether this is an out-of-line 11228 // definition of a static member function. 11229 // 11230 // This rule is not present in C++1y, so we produce a backwards 11231 // compatibility warning whenever it happens in C++11. 11232 CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD); 11233 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && MD && MD->isConstexpr() && 11234 !MD->isStatic() && !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(MD) && 11235 !isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(MD) && !MD->getMethodQualifiers().hasConst()) { 11236 CXXMethodDecl *OldMD = nullptr; 11237 if (OldDecl) 11238 OldMD = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(OldDecl->getAsFunction()); 11239 if (!OldMD || !OldMD->isStatic()) { 11240 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = 11241 MD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 11242 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo(); 11243 EPI.TypeQuals.addConst(); 11244 MD->setType(Context.getFunctionType(FPT->getReturnType(), 11245 FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI)); 11246 11247 // Warn that we did this, if we're not performing template instantiation. 11248 // In that case, we'll have warned already when the template was defined. 11249 if (!inTemplateInstantiation()) { 11250 SourceLocation AddConstLoc; 11251 if (FunctionTypeLoc FTL = MD->getTypeSourceInfo()->getTypeLoc() 11252 .IgnoreParens().getAs<FunctionTypeLoc>()) 11253 AddConstLoc = getLocForEndOfToken(FTL.getRParenLoc()); 11254 11255 Diag(MD->getLocation(), diag::warn_cxx14_compat_constexpr_not_const) 11256 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(AddConstLoc, " const"); 11257 } 11258 } 11259 } 11260 11261 if (Redeclaration) { 11262 // NewFD and OldDecl represent declarations that need to be 11263 // merged. 11264 if (MergeFunctionDecl(NewFD, OldDecl, S, MergeTypeWithPrevious, 11265 DeclIsDefn)) { 11266 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 11267 return Redeclaration; 11268 } 11269 11270 Previous.clear(); 11271 Previous.addDecl(OldDecl); 11272 11273 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *OldTemplateDecl = 11274 dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(OldDecl)) { 11275 auto *OldFD = OldTemplateDecl->getTemplatedDecl(); 11276 FunctionTemplateDecl *NewTemplateDecl 11277 = NewFD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate(); 11278 assert(NewTemplateDecl && "Template/non-template mismatch"); 11279 11280 // The call to MergeFunctionDecl above may have created some state in 11281 // NewTemplateDecl that needs to be merged with OldTemplateDecl before we 11282 // can add it as a redeclaration. 11283 NewTemplateDecl->mergePrevDecl(OldTemplateDecl); 11284 11285 NewFD->setPreviousDeclaration(OldFD); 11286 if (NewFD->isCXXClassMember()) { 11287 NewFD->setAccess(OldTemplateDecl->getAccess()); 11288 NewTemplateDecl->setAccess(OldTemplateDecl->getAccess()); 11289 } 11290 11291 // If this is an explicit specialization of a member that is a function 11292 // template, mark it as a member specialization. 11293 if (IsMemberSpecialization && 11294 NewTemplateDecl->getInstantiatedFromMemberTemplate()) { 11295 NewTemplateDecl->setMemberSpecialization(); 11296 assert(OldTemplateDecl->isMemberSpecialization()); 11297 // Explicit specializations of a member template do not inherit deleted 11298 // status from the parent member template that they are specializing. 11299 if (OldFD->isDeleted()) { 11300 // FIXME: This assert will not hold in the presence of modules. 11301 assert(OldFD->getCanonicalDecl() == OldFD); 11302 // FIXME: We need an update record for this AST mutation. 11303 OldFD->setDeletedAsWritten(false); 11304 } 11305 } 11306 11307 } else { 11308 if (shouldLinkDependentDeclWithPrevious(NewFD, OldDecl)) { 11309 auto *OldFD = cast<FunctionDecl>(OldDecl); 11310 // This needs to happen first so that 'inline' propagates. 11311 NewFD->setPreviousDeclaration(OldFD); 11312 if (NewFD->isCXXClassMember()) 11313 NewFD->setAccess(OldFD->getAccess()); 11314 } 11315 } 11316 } else if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && MayNeedOverloadableChecks && 11317 !NewFD->getAttr<OverloadableAttr>()) { 11318 assert((Previous.empty() || 11319 llvm::any_of(Previous, 11320 [](const NamedDecl *ND) { 11321 return ND->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>(); 11322 })) && 11323 "Non-redecls shouldn't happen without overloadable present"); 11324 11325 auto OtherUnmarkedIter = llvm::find_if(Previous, [](const NamedDecl *ND) { 11326 const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(ND); 11327 return FD && !FD->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>(); 11328 }); 11329 11330 if (OtherUnmarkedIter != Previous.end()) { 11331 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), 11332 diag::err_attribute_overloadable_multiple_unmarked_overloads); 11333 Diag((*OtherUnmarkedIter)->getLocation(), 11334 diag::note_attribute_overloadable_prev_overload) 11335 << false; 11336 11337 NewFD->addAttr(OverloadableAttr::CreateImplicit(Context)); 11338 } 11339 } 11340 11341 if (LangOpts.OpenMP) 11342 ActOnFinishedFunctionDefinitionInOpenMPAssumeScope(NewFD); 11343 11344 // Semantic checking for this function declaration (in isolation). 11345 11346 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 11347 // C++-specific checks. 11348 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(NewFD)) { 11349 CheckConstructor(Constructor); 11350 } else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = 11351 dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(NewFD)) { 11352 CXXRecordDecl *Record = Destructor->getParent(); 11353 QualType ClassType = Context.getTypeDeclType(Record); 11354 11355 // FIXME: Shouldn't we be able to perform this check even when the class 11356 // type is dependent? Both gcc and edg can handle that. 11357 if (!ClassType->isDependentType()) { 11358 DeclarationName Name 11359 = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXDestructorName( 11360 Context.getCanonicalType(ClassType)); 11361 if (NewFD->getDeclName() != Name) { 11362 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_destructor_name); 11363 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 11364 return Redeclaration; 11365 } 11366 } 11367 } else if (auto *Guide = dyn_cast<CXXDeductionGuideDecl>(NewFD)) { 11368 if (auto *TD = Guide->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()) 11369 CheckDeductionGuideTemplate(TD); 11370 11371 // A deduction guide is not on the list of entities that can be 11372 // explicitly specialized. 11373 if (Guide->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ExplicitSpecialization) 11374 Diag(Guide->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_deduction_guide_specialized) 11375 << /*explicit specialization*/ 1; 11376 } 11377 11378 // Find any virtual functions that this function overrides. 11379 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD)) { 11380 if (!Method->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization() && 11381 !Method->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() && 11382 Method->isCanonicalDecl()) { 11383 AddOverriddenMethods(Method->getParent(), Method); 11384 } 11385 if (Method->isVirtual() && NewFD->getTrailingRequiresClause()) 11386 // C++2a [class.virtual]p6 11387 // A virtual method shall not have a requires-clause. 11388 Diag(NewFD->getTrailingRequiresClause()->getBeginLoc(), 11389 diag::err_constrained_virtual_method); 11390 11391 if (Method->isStatic()) 11392 checkThisInStaticMemberFunctionType(Method); 11393 } 11394 11395 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conversion = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(NewFD)) 11396 ActOnConversionDeclarator(Conversion); 11397 11398 // Extra checking for C++ overloaded operators (C++ [over.oper]). 11399 if (NewFD->isOverloadedOperator() && 11400 CheckOverloadedOperatorDeclaration(NewFD)) { 11401 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 11402 return Redeclaration; 11403 } 11404 11405 // Extra checking for C++0x literal operators (C++0x [over.literal]). 11406 if (NewFD->getLiteralIdentifier() && 11407 CheckLiteralOperatorDeclaration(NewFD)) { 11408 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 11409 return Redeclaration; 11410 } 11411 11412 // In C++, check default arguments now that we have merged decls. Unless 11413 // the lexical context is the class, because in this case this is done 11414 // during delayed parsing anyway. 11415 if (!CurContext->isRecord()) 11416 CheckCXXDefaultArguments(NewFD); 11417 11418 // If this function is declared as being extern "C", then check to see if 11419 // the function returns a UDT (class, struct, or union type) that is not C 11420 // compatible, and if it does, warn the user. 11421 // But, issue any diagnostic on the first declaration only. 11422 if (Previous.empty() && NewFD->isExternC()) { 11423 QualType R = NewFD->getReturnType(); 11424 if (R->isIncompleteType() && !R->isVoidType()) 11425 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::warn_return_value_udt_incomplete) 11426 << NewFD << R; 11427 else if (!R.isPODType(Context) && !R->isVoidType() && 11428 !R->isObjCObjectPointerType()) 11429 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::warn_return_value_udt) << NewFD << R; 11430 } 11431 11432 // C++1z [dcl.fct]p6: 11433 // [...] whether the function has a non-throwing exception-specification 11434 // [is] part of the function type 11435 // 11436 // This results in an ABI break between C++14 and C++17 for functions whose 11437 // declared type includes an exception-specification in a parameter or 11438 // return type. (Exception specifications on the function itself are OK in 11439 // most cases, and exception specifications are not permitted in most other 11440 // contexts where they could make it into a mangling.) 11441 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 && !NewFD->getPrimaryTemplate()) { 11442 auto HasNoexcept = [&](QualType T) -> bool { 11443 // Strip off declarator chunks that could be between us and a function 11444 // type. We don't need to look far, exception specifications are very 11445 // restricted prior to C++17. 11446 if (auto *RT = T->getAs<ReferenceType>()) 11447 T = RT->getPointeeType(); 11448 else if (T->isAnyPointerType()) 11449 T = T->getPointeeType(); 11450 else if (auto *MPT = T->getAs<MemberPointerType>()) 11451 T = MPT->getPointeeType(); 11452 if (auto *FPT = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) 11453 if (FPT->isNothrow()) 11454 return true; 11455 return false; 11456 }; 11457 11458 auto *FPT = NewFD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 11459 bool AnyNoexcept = HasNoexcept(FPT->getReturnType()); 11460 for (QualType T : FPT->param_types()) 11461 AnyNoexcept |= HasNoexcept(T); 11462 if (AnyNoexcept) 11463 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), 11464 diag::warn_cxx17_compat_exception_spec_in_signature) 11465 << NewFD; 11466 } 11467 11468 if (!Redeclaration && LangOpts.CUDA) 11469 checkCUDATargetOverload(NewFD, Previous); 11470 } 11471 return Redeclaration; 11472 } 11473 11474 void Sema::CheckMain(FunctionDecl* FD, const DeclSpec& DS) { 11475 // C++11 [basic.start.main]p3: 11476 // A program that [...] declares main to be inline, static or 11477 // constexpr is ill-formed. 11478 // C11 6.7.4p4: In a hosted environment, no function specifier(s) shall 11479 // appear in a declaration of main. 11480 // static main is not an error under C99, but we should warn about it. 11481 // We accept _Noreturn main as an extension. 11482 if (FD->getStorageClass() == SC_Static) 11483 Diag(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc(), getLangOpts().CPlusPlus 11484 ? diag::err_static_main : diag::warn_static_main) 11485 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc()); 11486 if (FD->isInlineSpecified()) 11487 Diag(DS.getInlineSpecLoc(), diag::err_inline_main) 11488 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getInlineSpecLoc()); 11489 if (DS.isNoreturnSpecified()) { 11490 SourceLocation NoreturnLoc = DS.getNoreturnSpecLoc(); 11491 SourceRange NoreturnRange(NoreturnLoc, getLocForEndOfToken(NoreturnLoc)); 11492 Diag(NoreturnLoc, diag::ext_noreturn_main); 11493 Diag(NoreturnLoc, diag::note_main_remove_noreturn) 11494 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(NoreturnRange); 11495 } 11496 if (FD->isConstexpr()) { 11497 Diag(DS.getConstexprSpecLoc(), diag::err_constexpr_main) 11498 << FD->isConsteval() 11499 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getConstexprSpecLoc()); 11500 FD->setConstexprKind(ConstexprSpecKind::Unspecified); 11501 } 11502 11503 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) { 11504 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_no_main) 11505 << FD->hasAttr<OpenCLKernelAttr>(); 11506 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 11507 return; 11508 } 11509 11510 // Functions named main in hlsl are default entries, but don't have specific 11511 // signatures they are required to conform to. 11512 if (getLangOpts().HLSL) 11513 return; 11514 11515 QualType T = FD->getType(); 11516 assert(T->isFunctionType() && "function decl is not of function type"); 11517 const FunctionType* FT = T->castAs<FunctionType>(); 11518 11519 // Set default calling convention for main() 11520 if (FT->getCallConv() != CC_C) { 11521 FT = Context.adjustFunctionType(FT, FT->getExtInfo().withCallingConv(CC_C)); 11522 FD->setType(QualType(FT, 0)); 11523 T = Context.getCanonicalType(FD->getType()); 11524 } 11525 11526 if (getLangOpts().GNUMode && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 11527 // In C with GNU extensions we allow main() to have non-integer return 11528 // type, but we should warn about the extension, and we disable the 11529 // implicit-return-zero rule. 11530 11531 // GCC in C mode accepts qualified 'int'. 11532 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FT->getReturnType(), Context.IntTy)) 11533 FD->setHasImplicitReturnZero(true); 11534 else { 11535 Diag(FD->getTypeSpecStartLoc(), diag::ext_main_returns_nonint); 11536 SourceRange RTRange = FD->getReturnTypeSourceRange(); 11537 if (RTRange.isValid()) 11538 Diag(RTRange.getBegin(), diag::note_main_change_return_type) 11539 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(RTRange, "int"); 11540 } 11541 } else { 11542 // In C and C++, main magically returns 0 if you fall off the end; 11543 // set the flag which tells us that. 11544 // This is C++ [basic.start.main]p5 and C99 5.1.2.2.3. 11545 11546 // All the standards say that main() should return 'int'. 11547 if (Context.hasSameType(FT->getReturnType(), Context.IntTy)) 11548 FD->setHasImplicitReturnZero(true); 11549 else { 11550 // Otherwise, this is just a flat-out error. 11551 SourceRange RTRange = FD->getReturnTypeSourceRange(); 11552 Diag(FD->getTypeSpecStartLoc(), diag::err_main_returns_nonint) 11553 << (RTRange.isValid() ? FixItHint::CreateReplacement(RTRange, "int") 11554 : FixItHint()); 11555 FD->setInvalidDecl(true); 11556 } 11557 } 11558 11559 // Treat protoless main() as nullary. 11560 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FT)) return; 11561 11562 const FunctionProtoType* FTP = cast<const FunctionProtoType>(FT); 11563 unsigned nparams = FTP->getNumParams(); 11564 assert(FD->getNumParams() == nparams); 11565 11566 bool HasExtraParameters = (nparams > 3); 11567 11568 if (FTP->isVariadic()) { 11569 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::ext_variadic_main); 11570 // FIXME: if we had information about the location of the ellipsis, we 11571 // could add a FixIt hint to remove it as a parameter. 11572 } 11573 11574 // Darwin passes an undocumented fourth argument of type char**. If 11575 // other platforms start sprouting these, the logic below will start 11576 // getting shifty. 11577 if (nparams == 4 && Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isOSDarwin()) 11578 HasExtraParameters = false; 11579 11580 if (HasExtraParameters) { 11581 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_main_surplus_args) << nparams; 11582 FD->setInvalidDecl(true); 11583 nparams = 3; 11584 } 11585 11586 // FIXME: a lot of the following diagnostics would be improved 11587 // if we had some location information about types. 11588 11589 QualType CharPP = 11590 Context.getPointerType(Context.getPointerType(Context.CharTy)); 11591 QualType Expected[] = { Context.IntTy, CharPP, CharPP, CharPP }; 11592 11593 for (unsigned i = 0; i < nparams; ++i) { 11594 QualType AT = FTP->getParamType(i); 11595 11596 bool mismatch = true; 11597 11598 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(AT, Expected[i])) 11599 mismatch = false; 11600 else if (Expected[i] == CharPP) { 11601 // As an extension, the following forms are okay: 11602 // char const ** 11603 // char const * const * 11604 // char * const * 11605 11606 QualifierCollector qs; 11607 const PointerType* PT; 11608 if ((PT = qs.strip(AT)->getAs<PointerType>()) && 11609 (PT = qs.strip(PT->getPointeeType())->getAs<PointerType>()) && 11610 Context.hasSameType(QualType(qs.strip(PT->getPointeeType()), 0), 11611 Context.CharTy)) { 11612 qs.removeConst(); 11613 mismatch = !qs.empty(); 11614 } 11615 } 11616 11617 if (mismatch) { 11618 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_main_arg_wrong) << i << Expected[i]; 11619 // TODO: suggest replacing given type with expected type 11620 FD->setInvalidDecl(true); 11621 } 11622 } 11623 11624 if (nparams == 1 && !FD->isInvalidDecl()) { 11625 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::warn_main_one_arg); 11626 } 11627 11628 if (!FD->isInvalidDecl() && FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()) { 11629 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_mainlike_template_decl) << FD; 11630 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 11631 } 11632 } 11633 11634 static bool isDefaultStdCall(FunctionDecl *FD, Sema &S) { 11635 11636 // Default calling convention for main and wmain is __cdecl 11637 if (FD->getName() == "main" || FD->getName() == "wmain") 11638 return false; 11639 11640 // Default calling convention for MinGW is __cdecl 11641 const llvm::Triple &T = S.Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple(); 11642 if (T.isWindowsGNUEnvironment()) 11643 return false; 11644 11645 // Default calling convention for WinMain, wWinMain and DllMain 11646 // is __stdcall on 32 bit Windows 11647 if (T.isOSWindows() && T.getArch() == llvm::Triple::x86) 11648 return true; 11649 11650 return false; 11651 } 11652 11653 void Sema::CheckMSVCRTEntryPoint(FunctionDecl *FD) { 11654 QualType T = FD->getType(); 11655 assert(T->isFunctionType() && "function decl is not of function type"); 11656 const FunctionType *FT = T->castAs<FunctionType>(); 11657 11658 // Set an implicit return of 'zero' if the function can return some integral, 11659 // enumeration, pointer or nullptr type. 11660 if (FT->getReturnType()->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() || 11661 FT->getReturnType()->isAnyPointerType() || 11662 FT->getReturnType()->isNullPtrType()) 11663 // DllMain is exempt because a return value of zero means it failed. 11664 if (FD->getName() != "DllMain") 11665 FD->setHasImplicitReturnZero(true); 11666 11667 // Explicity specified calling conventions are applied to MSVC entry points 11668 if (!hasExplicitCallingConv(T)) { 11669 if (isDefaultStdCall(FD, *this)) { 11670 if (FT->getCallConv() != CC_X86StdCall) { 11671 FT = Context.adjustFunctionType( 11672 FT, FT->getExtInfo().withCallingConv(CC_X86StdCall)); 11673 FD->setType(QualType(FT, 0)); 11674 } 11675 } else if (FT->getCallConv() != CC_C) { 11676 FT = Context.adjustFunctionType(FT, 11677 FT->getExtInfo().withCallingConv(CC_C)); 11678 FD->setType(QualType(FT, 0)); 11679 } 11680 } 11681 11682 if (!FD->isInvalidDecl() && FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()) { 11683 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_mainlike_template_decl) << FD; 11684 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 11685 } 11686 } 11687 11688 bool Sema::CheckForConstantInitializer(Expr *Init, QualType DclT) { 11689 // FIXME: Need strict checking. In C89, we need to check for 11690 // any assignment, increment, decrement, function-calls, or 11691 // commas outside of a sizeof. In C99, it's the same list, 11692 // except that the aforementioned are allowed in unevaluated 11693 // expressions. Everything else falls under the 11694 // "may accept other forms of constant expressions" exception. 11695 // 11696 // Regular C++ code will not end up here (exceptions: language extensions, 11697 // OpenCL C++ etc), so the constant expression rules there don't matter. 11698 if (Init->isValueDependent()) { 11699 assert(Init->containsErrors() && 11700 "Dependent code should only occur in error-recovery path."); 11701 return true; 11702 } 11703 const Expr *Culprit; 11704 if (Init->isConstantInitializer(Context, false, &Culprit)) 11705 return false; 11706 Diag(Culprit->getExprLoc(), diag::err_init_element_not_constant) 11707 << Culprit->getSourceRange(); 11708 return true; 11709 } 11710 11711 namespace { 11712 // Visits an initialization expression to see if OrigDecl is evaluated in 11713 // its own initialization and throws a warning if it does. 11714 class SelfReferenceChecker 11715 : public EvaluatedExprVisitor<SelfReferenceChecker> { 11716 Sema &S; 11717 Decl *OrigDecl; 11718 bool isRecordType; 11719 bool isPODType; 11720 bool isReferenceType; 11721 11722 bool isInitList; 11723 llvm::SmallVector<unsigned, 4> InitFieldIndex; 11724 11725 public: 11726 typedef EvaluatedExprVisitor<SelfReferenceChecker> Inherited; 11727 11728 SelfReferenceChecker(Sema &S, Decl *OrigDecl) : Inherited(S.Context), 11729 S(S), OrigDecl(OrigDecl) { 11730 isPODType = false; 11731 isRecordType = false; 11732 isReferenceType = false; 11733 isInitList = false; 11734 if (ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(OrigDecl)) { 11735 isPODType = VD->getType().isPODType(S.Context); 11736 isRecordType = VD->getType()->isRecordType(); 11737 isReferenceType = VD->getType()->isReferenceType(); 11738 } 11739 } 11740 11741 // For most expressions, just call the visitor. For initializer lists, 11742 // track the index of the field being initialized since fields are 11743 // initialized in order allowing use of previously initialized fields. 11744 void CheckExpr(Expr *E) { 11745 InitListExpr *InitList = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(E); 11746 if (!InitList) { 11747 Visit(E); 11748 return; 11749 } 11750 11751 // Track and increment the index here. 11752 isInitList = true; 11753 InitFieldIndex.push_back(0); 11754 for (auto Child : InitList->children()) { 11755 CheckExpr(cast<Expr>(Child)); 11756 ++InitFieldIndex.back(); 11757 } 11758 InitFieldIndex.pop_back(); 11759 } 11760 11761 // Returns true if MemberExpr is checked and no further checking is needed. 11762 // Returns false if additional checking is required. 11763 bool CheckInitListMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E, bool CheckReference) { 11764 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl*, 4> Fields; 11765 Expr *Base = E; 11766 bool ReferenceField = false; 11767 11768 // Get the field members used. 11769 while (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(Base)) { 11770 FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()); 11771 if (!FD) 11772 return false; 11773 Fields.push_back(FD); 11774 if (FD->getType()->isReferenceType()) 11775 ReferenceField = true; 11776 Base = ME->getBase()->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 11777 } 11778 11779 // Keep checking only if the base Decl is the same. 11780 DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(Base); 11781 if (!DRE || DRE->getDecl() != OrigDecl) 11782 return false; 11783 11784 // A reference field can be bound to an unininitialized field. 11785 if (CheckReference && !ReferenceField) 11786 return true; 11787 11788 // Convert FieldDecls to their index number. 11789 llvm::SmallVector<unsigned, 4> UsedFieldIndex; 11790 for (const FieldDecl *I : llvm::reverse(Fields)) 11791 UsedFieldIndex.push_back(I->getFieldIndex()); 11792 11793 // See if a warning is needed by checking the first difference in index 11794 // numbers. If field being used has index less than the field being 11795 // initialized, then the use is safe. 11796 for (auto UsedIter = UsedFieldIndex.begin(), 11797 UsedEnd = UsedFieldIndex.end(), 11798 OrigIter = InitFieldIndex.begin(), 11799 OrigEnd = InitFieldIndex.end(); 11800 UsedIter != UsedEnd && OrigIter != OrigEnd; ++UsedIter, ++OrigIter) { 11801 if (*UsedIter < *OrigIter) 11802 return true; 11803 if (*UsedIter > *OrigIter) 11804 break; 11805 } 11806 11807 // TODO: Add a different warning which will print the field names. 11808 HandleDeclRefExpr(DRE); 11809 return true; 11810 } 11811 11812 // For most expressions, the cast is directly above the DeclRefExpr. 11813 // For conditional operators, the cast can be outside the conditional 11814 // operator if both expressions are DeclRefExpr's. 11815 void HandleValue(Expr *E) { 11816 E = E->IgnoreParens(); 11817 if (DeclRefExpr* DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) { 11818 HandleDeclRefExpr(DRE); 11819 return; 11820 } 11821 11822 if (ConditionalOperator *CO = dyn_cast<ConditionalOperator>(E)) { 11823 Visit(CO->getCond()); 11824 HandleValue(CO->getTrueExpr()); 11825 HandleValue(CO->getFalseExpr()); 11826 return; 11827 } 11828 11829 if (BinaryConditionalOperator *BCO = 11830 dyn_cast<BinaryConditionalOperator>(E)) { 11831 Visit(BCO->getCond()); 11832 HandleValue(BCO->getFalseExpr()); 11833 return; 11834 } 11835 11836 if (OpaqueValueExpr *OVE = dyn_cast<OpaqueValueExpr>(E)) { 11837 HandleValue(OVE->getSourceExpr()); 11838 return; 11839 } 11840 11841 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(E)) { 11842 if (BO->getOpcode() == BO_Comma) { 11843 Visit(BO->getLHS()); 11844 HandleValue(BO->getRHS()); 11845 return; 11846 } 11847 } 11848 11849 if (isa<MemberExpr>(E)) { 11850 if (isInitList) { 11851 if (CheckInitListMemberExpr(cast<MemberExpr>(E), 11852 false /*CheckReference*/)) 11853 return; 11854 } 11855 11856 Expr *Base = E->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 11857 while (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(Base)) { 11858 // Check for static member variables and don't warn on them. 11859 if (!isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl())) 11860 return; 11861 Base = ME->getBase()->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 11862 } 11863 if (DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(Base)) 11864 HandleDeclRefExpr(DRE); 11865 return; 11866 } 11867 11868 Visit(E); 11869 } 11870 11871 // Reference types not handled in HandleValue are handled here since all 11872 // uses of references are bad, not just r-value uses. 11873 void VisitDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) { 11874 if (isReferenceType) 11875 HandleDeclRefExpr(E); 11876 } 11877 11878 void VisitImplicitCastExpr(ImplicitCastExpr *E) { 11879 if (E->getCastKind() == CK_LValueToRValue) { 11880 HandleValue(E->getSubExpr()); 11881 return; 11882 } 11883 11884 Inherited::VisitImplicitCastExpr(E); 11885 } 11886 11887 void VisitMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E) { 11888 if (isInitList) { 11889 if (CheckInitListMemberExpr(E, true /*CheckReference*/)) 11890 return; 11891 } 11892 11893 // Don't warn on arrays since they can be treated as pointers. 11894 if (E->getType()->canDecayToPointerType()) return; 11895 11896 // Warn when a non-static method call is followed by non-static member 11897 // field accesses, which is followed by a DeclRefExpr. 11898 CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(E->getMemberDecl()); 11899 bool Warn = (MD && !MD->isStatic()); 11900 Expr *Base = E->getBase()->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 11901 while (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(Base)) { 11902 if (!isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl())) 11903 Warn = false; 11904 Base = ME->getBase()->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 11905 } 11906 11907 if (DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(Base)) { 11908 if (Warn) 11909 HandleDeclRefExpr(DRE); 11910 return; 11911 } 11912 11913 // The base of a MemberExpr is not a MemberExpr or a DeclRefExpr. 11914 // Visit that expression. 11915 Visit(Base); 11916 } 11917 11918 void VisitCXXOperatorCallExpr(CXXOperatorCallExpr *E) { 11919 Expr *Callee = E->getCallee(); 11920 11921 if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(Callee)) 11922 return Inherited::VisitCXXOperatorCallExpr(E); 11923 11924 Visit(Callee); 11925 for (auto Arg: E->arguments()) 11926 HandleValue(Arg->IgnoreParenImpCasts()); 11927 } 11928 11929 void VisitUnaryOperator(UnaryOperator *E) { 11930 // For POD record types, addresses of its own members are well-defined. 11931 if (E->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf && isRecordType && 11932 isa<MemberExpr>(E->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens())) { 11933 if (!isPODType) 11934 HandleValue(E->getSubExpr()); 11935 return; 11936 } 11937 11938 if (E->isIncrementDecrementOp()) { 11939 HandleValue(E->getSubExpr()); 11940 return; 11941 } 11942 11943 Inherited::VisitUnaryOperator(E); 11944 } 11945 11946 void VisitObjCMessageExpr(ObjCMessageExpr *E) {} 11947 11948 void VisitCXXConstructExpr(CXXConstructExpr *E) { 11949 if (E->getConstructor()->isCopyConstructor()) { 11950 Expr *ArgExpr = E->getArg(0); 11951 if (InitListExpr *ILE = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(ArgExpr)) 11952 if (ILE->getNumInits() == 1) 11953 ArgExpr = ILE->getInit(0); 11954 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(ArgExpr)) 11955 if (ICE->getCastKind() == CK_NoOp) 11956 ArgExpr = ICE->getSubExpr(); 11957 HandleValue(ArgExpr); 11958 return; 11959 } 11960 Inherited::VisitCXXConstructExpr(E); 11961 } 11962 11963 void VisitCallExpr(CallExpr *E) { 11964 // Treat std::move as a use. 11965 if (E->isCallToStdMove()) { 11966 HandleValue(E->getArg(0)); 11967 return; 11968 } 11969 11970 Inherited::VisitCallExpr(E); 11971 } 11972 11973 void VisitBinaryOperator(BinaryOperator *E) { 11974 if (E->isCompoundAssignmentOp()) { 11975 HandleValue(E->getLHS()); 11976 Visit(E->getRHS()); 11977 return; 11978 } 11979 11980 Inherited::VisitBinaryOperator(E); 11981 } 11982 11983 // A custom visitor for BinaryConditionalOperator is needed because the 11984 // regular visitor would check the condition and true expression separately 11985 // but both point to the same place giving duplicate diagnostics. 11986 void VisitBinaryConditionalOperator(BinaryConditionalOperator *E) { 11987 Visit(E->getCond()); 11988 Visit(E->getFalseExpr()); 11989 } 11990 11991 void HandleDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *DRE) { 11992 Decl* ReferenceDecl = DRE->getDecl(); 11993 if (OrigDecl != ReferenceDecl) return; 11994 unsigned diag; 11995 if (isReferenceType) { 11996 diag = diag::warn_uninit_self_reference_in_reference_init; 11997 } else if (cast<VarDecl>(OrigDecl)->isStaticLocal()) { 11998 diag = diag::warn_static_self_reference_in_init; 11999 } else if (isa<TranslationUnitDecl>(OrigDecl->getDeclContext()) || 12000 isa<NamespaceDecl>(OrigDecl->getDeclContext()) || 12001 DRE->getDecl()->getType()->isRecordType()) { 12002 diag = diag::warn_uninit_self_reference_in_init; 12003 } else { 12004 // Local variables will be handled by the CFG analysis. 12005 return; 12006 } 12007 12008 S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(DRE->getBeginLoc(), DRE, 12009 S.PDiag(diag) 12010 << DRE->getDecl() << OrigDecl->getLocation() 12011 << DRE->getSourceRange()); 12012 } 12013 }; 12014 12015 /// CheckSelfReference - Warns if OrigDecl is used in expression E. 12016 static void CheckSelfReference(Sema &S, Decl* OrigDecl, Expr *E, 12017 bool DirectInit) { 12018 // Parameters arguments are occassionially constructed with itself, 12019 // for instance, in recursive functions. Skip them. 12020 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(OrigDecl)) 12021 return; 12022 12023 E = E->IgnoreParens(); 12024 12025 // Skip checking T a = a where T is not a record or reference type. 12026 // Doing so is a way to silence uninitialized warnings. 12027 if (!DirectInit && !cast<VarDecl>(OrigDecl)->getType()->isRecordType()) 12028 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)) 12029 if (ICE->getCastKind() == CK_LValueToRValue) 12030 if (DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(ICE->getSubExpr())) 12031 if (DRE->getDecl() == OrigDecl) 12032 return; 12033 12034 SelfReferenceChecker(S, OrigDecl).CheckExpr(E); 12035 } 12036 } // end anonymous namespace 12037 12038 namespace { 12039 // Simple wrapper to add the name of a variable or (if no variable is 12040 // available) a DeclarationName into a diagnostic. 12041 struct VarDeclOrName { 12042 VarDecl *VDecl; 12043 DeclarationName Name; 12044 12045 friend const Sema::SemaDiagnosticBuilder & 12046 operator<<(const Sema::SemaDiagnosticBuilder &Diag, VarDeclOrName VN) { 12047 return VN.VDecl ? Diag << VN.VDecl : Diag << VN.Name; 12048 } 12049 }; 12050 } // end anonymous namespace 12051 12052 QualType Sema::deduceVarTypeFromInitializer(VarDecl *VDecl, 12053 DeclarationName Name, QualType Type, 12054 TypeSourceInfo *TSI, 12055 SourceRange Range, bool DirectInit, 12056 Expr *Init) { 12057 bool IsInitCapture = !VDecl; 12058 assert((!VDecl || !VDecl->isInitCapture()) && 12059 "init captures are expected to be deduced prior to initialization"); 12060 12061 VarDeclOrName VN{VDecl, Name}; 12062 12063 DeducedType *Deduced = Type->getContainedDeducedType(); 12064 assert(Deduced && "deduceVarTypeFromInitializer for non-deduced type"); 12065 12066 // C++11 [dcl.spec.auto]p3 12067 if (!Init) { 12068 assert(VDecl && "no init for init capture deduction?"); 12069 12070 // Except for class argument deduction, and then for an initializing 12071 // declaration only, i.e. no static at class scope or extern. 12072 if (!isa<DeducedTemplateSpecializationType>(Deduced) || 12073 VDecl->hasExternalStorage() || 12074 VDecl->isStaticDataMember()) { 12075 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_auto_var_requires_init) 12076 << VDecl->getDeclName() << Type; 12077 return QualType(); 12078 } 12079 } 12080 12081 ArrayRef<Expr*> DeduceInits; 12082 if (Init) 12083 DeduceInits = Init; 12084 12085 if (DirectInit) { 12086 if (auto *PL = dyn_cast_or_null<ParenListExpr>(Init)) 12087 DeduceInits = PL->exprs(); 12088 } 12089 12090 if (isa<DeducedTemplateSpecializationType>(Deduced)) { 12091 assert(VDecl && "non-auto type for init capture deduction?"); 12092 InitializedEntity Entity = InitializedEntity::InitializeVariable(VDecl); 12093 InitializationKind Kind = InitializationKind::CreateForInit( 12094 VDecl->getLocation(), DirectInit, Init); 12095 // FIXME: Initialization should not be taking a mutable list of inits. 12096 SmallVector<Expr*, 8> InitsCopy(DeduceInits.begin(), DeduceInits.end()); 12097 return DeduceTemplateSpecializationFromInitializer(TSI, Entity, Kind, 12098 InitsCopy); 12099 } 12100 12101 if (DirectInit) { 12102 if (auto *IL = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(Init)) 12103 DeduceInits = IL->inits(); 12104 } 12105 12106 // Deduction only works if we have exactly one source expression. 12107 if (DeduceInits.empty()) { 12108 // It isn't possible to write this directly, but it is possible to 12109 // end up in this situation with "auto x(some_pack...);" 12110 Diag(Init->getBeginLoc(), IsInitCapture 12111 ? diag::err_init_capture_no_expression 12112 : diag::err_auto_var_init_no_expression) 12113 << VN << Type << Range; 12114 return QualType(); 12115 } 12116 12117 if (DeduceInits.size() > 1) { 12118 Diag(DeduceInits[1]->getBeginLoc(), 12119 IsInitCapture ? diag::err_init_capture_multiple_expressions 12120 : diag::err_auto_var_init_multiple_expressions) 12121 << VN << Type << Range; 12122 return QualType(); 12123 } 12124 12125 Expr *DeduceInit = DeduceInits[0]; 12126 if (DirectInit && isa<InitListExpr>(DeduceInit)) { 12127 Diag(Init->getBeginLoc(), IsInitCapture 12128 ? diag::err_init_capture_paren_braces 12129 : diag::err_auto_var_init_paren_braces) 12130 << isa<InitListExpr>(Init) << VN << Type << Range; 12131 return QualType(); 12132 } 12133 12134 // Expressions default to 'id' when we're in a debugger. 12135 bool DefaultedAnyToId = false; 12136 if (getLangOpts().DebuggerCastResultToId && 12137 Init->getType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy && !IsInitCapture) { 12138 ExprResult Result = forceUnknownAnyToType(Init, Context.getObjCIdType()); 12139 if (Result.isInvalid()) { 12140 return QualType(); 12141 } 12142 Init = Result.get(); 12143 DefaultedAnyToId = true; 12144 } 12145 12146 // C++ [dcl.decomp]p1: 12147 // If the assignment-expression [...] has array type A and no ref-qualifier 12148 // is present, e has type cv A 12149 if (VDecl && isa<DecompositionDecl>(VDecl) && 12150 Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Type, Context.getAutoDeductType()) && 12151 DeduceInit->getType()->isConstantArrayType()) 12152 return Context.getQualifiedType(DeduceInit->getType(), 12153 Type.getQualifiers()); 12154 12155 QualType DeducedType; 12156 if (DeduceAutoType(TSI, DeduceInit, DeducedType) == DAR_Failed) { 12157 if (!IsInitCapture) 12158 DiagnoseAutoDeductionFailure(VDecl, DeduceInit); 12159 else if (isa<InitListExpr>(Init)) 12160 Diag(Range.getBegin(), 12161 diag::err_init_capture_deduction_failure_from_init_list) 12162 << VN 12163 << (DeduceInit->getType().isNull() ? TSI->getType() 12164 : DeduceInit->getType()) 12165 << DeduceInit->getSourceRange(); 12166 else 12167 Diag(Range.getBegin(), diag::err_init_capture_deduction_failure) 12168 << VN << TSI->getType() 12169 << (DeduceInit->getType().isNull() ? TSI->getType() 12170 : DeduceInit->getType()) 12171 << DeduceInit->getSourceRange(); 12172 } 12173 12174 // Warn if we deduced 'id'. 'auto' usually implies type-safety, but using 12175 // 'id' instead of a specific object type prevents most of our usual 12176 // checks. 12177 // We only want to warn outside of template instantiations, though: 12178 // inside a template, the 'id' could have come from a parameter. 12179 if (!inTemplateInstantiation() && !DefaultedAnyToId && !IsInitCapture && 12180 !DeducedType.isNull() && DeducedType->isObjCIdType()) { 12181 SourceLocation Loc = TSI->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(); 12182 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_auto_var_is_id) << VN << Range; 12183 } 12184 12185 return DeducedType; 12186 } 12187 12188 bool Sema::DeduceVariableDeclarationType(VarDecl *VDecl, bool DirectInit, 12189 Expr *Init) { 12190 assert(!Init || !Init->containsErrors()); 12191 QualType DeducedType = deduceVarTypeFromInitializer( 12192 VDecl, VDecl->getDeclName(), VDecl->getType(), VDecl->getTypeSourceInfo(), 12193 VDecl->getSourceRange(), DirectInit, Init); 12194 if (DeducedType.isNull()) { 12195 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12196 return true; 12197 } 12198 12199 VDecl->setType(DeducedType); 12200 assert(VDecl->isLinkageValid()); 12201 12202 // In ARC, infer lifetime. 12203 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && inferObjCARCLifetime(VDecl)) 12204 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12205 12206 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) 12207 deduceOpenCLAddressSpace(VDecl); 12208 12209 // If this is a redeclaration, check that the type we just deduced matches 12210 // the previously declared type. 12211 if (VarDecl *Old = VDecl->getPreviousDecl()) { 12212 // We never need to merge the type, because we cannot form an incomplete 12213 // array of auto, nor deduce such a type. 12214 MergeVarDeclTypes(VDecl, Old, /*MergeTypeWithPrevious*/ false); 12215 } 12216 12217 // Check the deduced type is valid for a variable declaration. 12218 CheckVariableDeclarationType(VDecl); 12219 return VDecl->isInvalidDecl(); 12220 } 12221 12222 void Sema::checkNonTrivialCUnionInInitializer(const Expr *Init, 12223 SourceLocation Loc) { 12224 if (auto *EWC = dyn_cast<ExprWithCleanups>(Init)) 12225 Init = EWC->getSubExpr(); 12226 12227 if (auto *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Init)) 12228 Init = CE->getSubExpr(); 12229 12230 QualType InitType = Init->getType(); 12231 assert((InitType.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion() || 12232 InitType.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion()) && 12233 "shouldn't be called if type doesn't have a non-trivial C struct"); 12234 if (auto *ILE = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(Init)) { 12235 for (auto I : ILE->inits()) { 12236 if (!I->getType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion() && 12237 !I->getType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion()) 12238 continue; 12239 SourceLocation SL = I->getExprLoc(); 12240 checkNonTrivialCUnionInInitializer(I, SL.isValid() ? SL : Loc); 12241 } 12242 return; 12243 } 12244 12245 if (isa<ImplicitValueInitExpr>(Init)) { 12246 if (InitType.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion()) 12247 checkNonTrivialCUnion(InitType, Loc, NTCUC_DefaultInitializedObject, 12248 NTCUK_Init); 12249 } else { 12250 // Assume all other explicit initializers involving copying some existing 12251 // object. 12252 // TODO: ignore any explicit initializers where we can guarantee 12253 // copy-elision. 12254 if (InitType.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion()) 12255 checkNonTrivialCUnion(InitType, Loc, NTCUC_CopyInit, NTCUK_Copy); 12256 } 12257 } 12258 12259 namespace { 12260 12261 bool shouldIgnoreForRecordTriviality(const FieldDecl *FD) { 12262 // Ignore unavailable fields. A field can be marked as unavailable explicitly 12263 // in the source code or implicitly by the compiler if it is in a union 12264 // defined in a system header and has non-trivial ObjC ownership 12265 // qualifications. We don't want those fields to participate in determining 12266 // whether the containing union is non-trivial. 12267 return FD->hasAttr<UnavailableAttr>(); 12268 } 12269 12270 struct DiagNonTrivalCUnionDefaultInitializeVisitor 12271 : DefaultInitializedTypeVisitor<DiagNonTrivalCUnionDefaultInitializeVisitor, 12272 void> { 12273 using Super = 12274 DefaultInitializedTypeVisitor<DiagNonTrivalCUnionDefaultInitializeVisitor, 12275 void>; 12276 12277 DiagNonTrivalCUnionDefaultInitializeVisitor( 12278 QualType OrigTy, SourceLocation OrigLoc, 12279 Sema::NonTrivialCUnionContext UseContext, Sema &S) 12280 : OrigTy(OrigTy), OrigLoc(OrigLoc), UseContext(UseContext), S(S) {} 12281 12282 void visitWithKind(QualType::PrimitiveDefaultInitializeKind PDIK, QualType QT, 12283 const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) { 12284 if (const auto *AT = S.Context.getAsArrayType(QT)) 12285 return this->asDerived().visit(S.Context.getBaseElementType(AT), FD, 12286 InNonTrivialUnion); 12287 return Super::visitWithKind(PDIK, QT, FD, InNonTrivialUnion); 12288 } 12289 12290 void visitARCStrong(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, 12291 bool InNonTrivialUnion) { 12292 if (InNonTrivialUnion) 12293 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union) 12294 << 1 << 0 << QT << FD->getName(); 12295 } 12296 12297 void visitARCWeak(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) { 12298 if (InNonTrivialUnion) 12299 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union) 12300 << 1 << 0 << QT << FD->getName(); 12301 } 12302 12303 void visitStruct(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) { 12304 const RecordDecl *RD = QT->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl(); 12305 if (RD->isUnion()) { 12306 if (OrigLoc.isValid()) { 12307 bool IsUnion = false; 12308 if (auto *OrigRD = OrigTy->getAsRecordDecl()) 12309 IsUnion = OrigRD->isUnion(); 12310 S.Diag(OrigLoc, diag::err_non_trivial_c_union_in_invalid_context) 12311 << 0 << OrigTy << IsUnion << UseContext; 12312 // Reset OrigLoc so that this diagnostic is emitted only once. 12313 OrigLoc = SourceLocation(); 12314 } 12315 InNonTrivialUnion = true; 12316 } 12317 12318 if (InNonTrivialUnion) 12319 S.Diag(RD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union) 12320 << 0 << 0 << QT.getUnqualifiedType() << ""; 12321 12322 for (const FieldDecl *FD : RD->fields()) 12323 if (!shouldIgnoreForRecordTriviality(FD)) 12324 asDerived().visit(FD->getType(), FD, InNonTrivialUnion); 12325 } 12326 12327 void visitTrivial(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) {} 12328 12329 // The non-trivial C union type or the struct/union type that contains a 12330 // non-trivial C union. 12331 QualType OrigTy; 12332 SourceLocation OrigLoc; 12333 Sema::NonTrivialCUnionContext UseContext; 12334 Sema &S; 12335 }; 12336 12337 struct DiagNonTrivalCUnionDestructedTypeVisitor 12338 : DestructedTypeVisitor<DiagNonTrivalCUnionDestructedTypeVisitor, void> { 12339 using Super = 12340 DestructedTypeVisitor<DiagNonTrivalCUnionDestructedTypeVisitor, void>; 12341 12342 DiagNonTrivalCUnionDestructedTypeVisitor( 12343 QualType OrigTy, SourceLocation OrigLoc, 12344 Sema::NonTrivialCUnionContext UseContext, Sema &S) 12345 : OrigTy(OrigTy), OrigLoc(OrigLoc), UseContext(UseContext), S(S) {} 12346 12347 void visitWithKind(QualType::DestructionKind DK, QualType QT, 12348 const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) { 12349 if (const auto *AT = S.Context.getAsArrayType(QT)) 12350 return this->asDerived().visit(S.Context.getBaseElementType(AT), FD, 12351 InNonTrivialUnion); 12352 return Super::visitWithKind(DK, QT, FD, InNonTrivialUnion); 12353 } 12354 12355 void visitARCStrong(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, 12356 bool InNonTrivialUnion) { 12357 if (InNonTrivialUnion) 12358 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union) 12359 << 1 << 1 << QT << FD->getName(); 12360 } 12361 12362 void visitARCWeak(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) { 12363 if (InNonTrivialUnion) 12364 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union) 12365 << 1 << 1 << QT << FD->getName(); 12366 } 12367 12368 void visitStruct(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) { 12369 const RecordDecl *RD = QT->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl(); 12370 if (RD->isUnion()) { 12371 if (OrigLoc.isValid()) { 12372 bool IsUnion = false; 12373 if (auto *OrigRD = OrigTy->getAsRecordDecl()) 12374 IsUnion = OrigRD->isUnion(); 12375 S.Diag(OrigLoc, diag::err_non_trivial_c_union_in_invalid_context) 12376 << 1 << OrigTy << IsUnion << UseContext; 12377 // Reset OrigLoc so that this diagnostic is emitted only once. 12378 OrigLoc = SourceLocation(); 12379 } 12380 InNonTrivialUnion = true; 12381 } 12382 12383 if (InNonTrivialUnion) 12384 S.Diag(RD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union) 12385 << 0 << 1 << QT.getUnqualifiedType() << ""; 12386 12387 for (const FieldDecl *FD : RD->fields()) 12388 if (!shouldIgnoreForRecordTriviality(FD)) 12389 asDerived().visit(FD->getType(), FD, InNonTrivialUnion); 12390 } 12391 12392 void visitTrivial(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) {} 12393 void visitCXXDestructor(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, 12394 bool InNonTrivialUnion) {} 12395 12396 // The non-trivial C union type or the struct/union type that contains a 12397 // non-trivial C union. 12398 QualType OrigTy; 12399 SourceLocation OrigLoc; 12400 Sema::NonTrivialCUnionContext UseContext; 12401 Sema &S; 12402 }; 12403 12404 struct DiagNonTrivalCUnionCopyVisitor 12405 : CopiedTypeVisitor<DiagNonTrivalCUnionCopyVisitor, false, void> { 12406 using Super = CopiedTypeVisitor<DiagNonTrivalCUnionCopyVisitor, false, void>; 12407 12408 DiagNonTrivalCUnionCopyVisitor(QualType OrigTy, SourceLocation OrigLoc, 12409 Sema::NonTrivialCUnionContext UseContext, 12410 Sema &S) 12411 : OrigTy(OrigTy), OrigLoc(OrigLoc), UseContext(UseContext), S(S) {} 12412 12413 void visitWithKind(QualType::PrimitiveCopyKind PCK, QualType QT, 12414 const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) { 12415 if (const auto *AT = S.Context.getAsArrayType(QT)) 12416 return this->asDerived().visit(S.Context.getBaseElementType(AT), FD, 12417 InNonTrivialUnion); 12418 return Super::visitWithKind(PCK, QT, FD, InNonTrivialUnion); 12419 } 12420 12421 void visitARCStrong(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, 12422 bool InNonTrivialUnion) { 12423 if (InNonTrivialUnion) 12424 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union) 12425 << 1 << 2 << QT << FD->getName(); 12426 } 12427 12428 void visitARCWeak(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) { 12429 if (InNonTrivialUnion) 12430 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union) 12431 << 1 << 2 << QT << FD->getName(); 12432 } 12433 12434 void visitStruct(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) { 12435 const RecordDecl *RD = QT->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl(); 12436 if (RD->isUnion()) { 12437 if (OrigLoc.isValid()) { 12438 bool IsUnion = false; 12439 if (auto *OrigRD = OrigTy->getAsRecordDecl()) 12440 IsUnion = OrigRD->isUnion(); 12441 S.Diag(OrigLoc, diag::err_non_trivial_c_union_in_invalid_context) 12442 << 2 << OrigTy << IsUnion << UseContext; 12443 // Reset OrigLoc so that this diagnostic is emitted only once. 12444 OrigLoc = SourceLocation(); 12445 } 12446 InNonTrivialUnion = true; 12447 } 12448 12449 if (InNonTrivialUnion) 12450 S.Diag(RD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union) 12451 << 0 << 2 << QT.getUnqualifiedType() << ""; 12452 12453 for (const FieldDecl *FD : RD->fields()) 12454 if (!shouldIgnoreForRecordTriviality(FD)) 12455 asDerived().visit(FD->getType(), FD, InNonTrivialUnion); 12456 } 12457 12458 void preVisit(QualType::PrimitiveCopyKind PCK, QualType QT, 12459 const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) {} 12460 void visitTrivial(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) {} 12461 void visitVolatileTrivial(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, 12462 bool InNonTrivialUnion) {} 12463 12464 // The non-trivial C union type or the struct/union type that contains a 12465 // non-trivial C union. 12466 QualType OrigTy; 12467 SourceLocation OrigLoc; 12468 Sema::NonTrivialCUnionContext UseContext; 12469 Sema &S; 12470 }; 12471 12472 } // namespace 12473 12474 void Sema::checkNonTrivialCUnion(QualType QT, SourceLocation Loc, 12475 NonTrivialCUnionContext UseContext, 12476 unsigned NonTrivialKind) { 12477 assert((QT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion() || 12478 QT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion() || 12479 QT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion()) && 12480 "shouldn't be called if type doesn't have a non-trivial C union"); 12481 12482 if ((NonTrivialKind & NTCUK_Init) && 12483 QT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion()) 12484 DiagNonTrivalCUnionDefaultInitializeVisitor(QT, Loc, UseContext, *this) 12485 .visit(QT, nullptr, false); 12486 if ((NonTrivialKind & NTCUK_Destruct) && 12487 QT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion()) 12488 DiagNonTrivalCUnionDestructedTypeVisitor(QT, Loc, UseContext, *this) 12489 .visit(QT, nullptr, false); 12490 if ((NonTrivialKind & NTCUK_Copy) && QT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion()) 12491 DiagNonTrivalCUnionCopyVisitor(QT, Loc, UseContext, *this) 12492 .visit(QT, nullptr, false); 12493 } 12494 12495 /// AddInitializerToDecl - Adds the initializer Init to the 12496 /// declaration dcl. If DirectInit is true, this is C++ direct 12497 /// initialization rather than copy initialization. 12498 void Sema::AddInitializerToDecl(Decl *RealDecl, Expr *Init, bool DirectInit) { 12499 // If there is no declaration, there was an error parsing it. Just ignore 12500 // the initializer. 12501 if (!RealDecl || RealDecl->isInvalidDecl()) { 12502 CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(Init, dyn_cast_or_null<VarDecl>(RealDecl)); 12503 return; 12504 } 12505 12506 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(RealDecl)) { 12507 // Pure-specifiers are handled in ActOnPureSpecifier. 12508 Diag(Method->getLocation(), diag::err_member_function_initialization) 12509 << Method->getDeclName() << Init->getSourceRange(); 12510 Method->setInvalidDecl(); 12511 return; 12512 } 12513 12514 VarDecl *VDecl = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(RealDecl); 12515 if (!VDecl) { 12516 assert(!isa<FieldDecl>(RealDecl) && "field init shouldn't get here"); 12517 Diag(RealDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_illegal_initializer); 12518 RealDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12519 return; 12520 } 12521 12522 // C++11 [decl.spec.auto]p6. Deduce the type which 'auto' stands in for. 12523 if (VDecl->getType()->isUndeducedType()) { 12524 // Attempt typo correction early so that the type of the init expression can 12525 // be deduced based on the chosen correction if the original init contains a 12526 // TypoExpr. 12527 ExprResult Res = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(Init, VDecl); 12528 if (!Res.isUsable()) { 12529 // There are unresolved typos in Init, just drop them. 12530 // FIXME: improve the recovery strategy to preserve the Init. 12531 RealDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12532 return; 12533 } 12534 if (Res.get()->containsErrors()) { 12535 // Invalidate the decl as we don't know the type for recovery-expr yet. 12536 RealDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12537 VDecl->setInit(Res.get()); 12538 return; 12539 } 12540 Init = Res.get(); 12541 12542 if (DeduceVariableDeclarationType(VDecl, DirectInit, Init)) 12543 return; 12544 } 12545 12546 // dllimport cannot be used on variable definitions. 12547 if (VDecl->hasAttr<DLLImportAttr>() && !VDecl->isStaticDataMember()) { 12548 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_dllimport_data_definition); 12549 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12550 return; 12551 } 12552 12553 if (VDecl->isLocalVarDecl() && VDecl->hasExternalStorage()) { 12554 // C99 6.7.8p5. C++ has no such restriction, but that is a defect. 12555 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_block_extern_cant_init); 12556 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12557 return; 12558 } 12559 12560 if (!VDecl->getType()->isDependentType()) { 12561 // A definition must end up with a complete type, which means it must be 12562 // complete with the restriction that an array type might be completed by 12563 // the initializer; note that later code assumes this restriction. 12564 QualType BaseDeclType = VDecl->getType(); 12565 if (const ArrayType *Array = Context.getAsIncompleteArrayType(BaseDeclType)) 12566 BaseDeclType = Array->getElementType(); 12567 if (RequireCompleteType(VDecl->getLocation(), BaseDeclType, 12568 diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)) { 12569 RealDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12570 return; 12571 } 12572 12573 // The variable can not have an abstract class type. 12574 if (RequireNonAbstractType(VDecl->getLocation(), VDecl->getType(), 12575 diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl, 12576 AbstractVariableType)) 12577 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12578 } 12579 12580 // If adding the initializer will turn this declaration into a definition, 12581 // and we already have a definition for this variable, diagnose or otherwise 12582 // handle the situation. 12583 if (VarDecl *Def = VDecl->getDefinition()) 12584 if (Def != VDecl && 12585 (!VDecl->isStaticDataMember() || VDecl->isOutOfLine()) && 12586 !VDecl->isThisDeclarationADemotedDefinition() && 12587 checkVarDeclRedefinition(Def, VDecl)) 12588 return; 12589 12590 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 12591 // C++ [class.static.data]p4 12592 // If a static data member is of const integral or const 12593 // enumeration type, its declaration in the class definition can 12594 // specify a constant-initializer which shall be an integral 12595 // constant expression (5.19). In that case, the member can appear 12596 // in integral constant expressions. The member shall still be 12597 // defined in a namespace scope if it is used in the program and the 12598 // namespace scope definition shall not contain an initializer. 12599 // 12600 // We already performed a redefinition check above, but for static 12601 // data members we also need to check whether there was an in-class 12602 // declaration with an initializer. 12603 if (VDecl->isStaticDataMember() && VDecl->getCanonicalDecl()->hasInit()) { 12604 Diag(Init->getExprLoc(), diag::err_static_data_member_reinitialization) 12605 << VDecl->getDeclName(); 12606 Diag(VDecl->getCanonicalDecl()->getInit()->getExprLoc(), 12607 diag::note_previous_initializer) 12608 << 0; 12609 return; 12610 } 12611 12612 if (VDecl->hasLocalStorage()) 12613 setFunctionHasBranchProtectedScope(); 12614 12615 if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(Init, UPPC_Initializer)) { 12616 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12617 return; 12618 } 12619 } 12620 12621 // OpenCL 1.1 6.5.2: "Variables allocated in the __local address space inside 12622 // a kernel function cannot be initialized." 12623 if (VDecl->getType().getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_local) { 12624 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_local_cant_init); 12625 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12626 return; 12627 } 12628 12629 // The LoaderUninitialized attribute acts as a definition (of undef). 12630 if (VDecl->hasAttr<LoaderUninitializedAttr>()) { 12631 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_loader_uninitialized_cant_init); 12632 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12633 return; 12634 } 12635 12636 // Get the decls type and save a reference for later, since 12637 // CheckInitializerTypes may change it. 12638 QualType DclT = VDecl->getType(), SavT = DclT; 12639 12640 // Expressions default to 'id' when we're in a debugger 12641 // and we are assigning it to a variable of Objective-C pointer type. 12642 if (getLangOpts().DebuggerCastResultToId && DclT->isObjCObjectPointerType() && 12643 Init->getType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) { 12644 ExprResult Result = forceUnknownAnyToType(Init, Context.getObjCIdType()); 12645 if (Result.isInvalid()) { 12646 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12647 return; 12648 } 12649 Init = Result.get(); 12650 } 12651 12652 // Perform the initialization. 12653 ParenListExpr *CXXDirectInit = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(Init); 12654 if (!VDecl->isInvalidDecl()) { 12655 InitializedEntity Entity = InitializedEntity::InitializeVariable(VDecl); 12656 InitializationKind Kind = InitializationKind::CreateForInit( 12657 VDecl->getLocation(), DirectInit, Init); 12658 12659 MultiExprArg Args = Init; 12660 if (CXXDirectInit) 12661 Args = MultiExprArg(CXXDirectInit->getExprs(), 12662 CXXDirectInit->getNumExprs()); 12663 12664 // Try to correct any TypoExprs in the initialization arguments. 12665 for (size_t Idx = 0; Idx < Args.size(); ++Idx) { 12666 ExprResult Res = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr( 12667 Args[Idx], VDecl, /*RecoverUncorrectedTypos=*/true, 12668 [this, Entity, Kind](Expr *E) { 12669 InitializationSequence Init(*this, Entity, Kind, MultiExprArg(E)); 12670 return Init.Failed() ? ExprError() : E; 12671 }); 12672 if (Res.isInvalid()) { 12673 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12674 } else if (Res.get() != Args[Idx]) { 12675 Args[Idx] = Res.get(); 12676 } 12677 } 12678 if (VDecl->isInvalidDecl()) 12679 return; 12680 12681 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, Args, 12682 /*TopLevelOfInitList=*/false, 12683 /*TreatUnavailableAsInvalid=*/false); 12684 ExprResult Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind, Args, &DclT); 12685 if (Result.isInvalid()) { 12686 // If the provided initializer fails to initialize the var decl, 12687 // we attach a recovery expr for better recovery. 12688 auto RecoveryExpr = 12689 CreateRecoveryExpr(Init->getBeginLoc(), Init->getEndLoc(), Args); 12690 if (RecoveryExpr.get()) 12691 VDecl->setInit(RecoveryExpr.get()); 12692 return; 12693 } 12694 12695 Init = Result.getAs<Expr>(); 12696 } 12697 12698 // Check for self-references within variable initializers. 12699 // Variables declared within a function/method body (except for references) 12700 // are handled by a dataflow analysis. 12701 // This is undefined behavior in C++, but valid in C. 12702 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 12703 if (!VDecl->hasLocalStorage() || VDecl->getType()->isRecordType() || 12704 VDecl->getType()->isReferenceType()) 12705 CheckSelfReference(*this, RealDecl, Init, DirectInit); 12706 12707 // If the type changed, it means we had an incomplete type that was 12708 // completed by the initializer. For example: 12709 // int ary[] = { 1, 3, 5 }; 12710 // "ary" transitions from an IncompleteArrayType to a ConstantArrayType. 12711 if (!VDecl->isInvalidDecl() && (DclT != SavT)) 12712 VDecl->setType(DclT); 12713 12714 if (!VDecl->isInvalidDecl()) { 12715 checkUnsafeAssigns(VDecl->getLocation(), VDecl->getType(), Init); 12716 12717 if (VDecl->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) 12718 checkRetainCycles(VDecl, Init); 12719 12720 // It is safe to assign a weak reference into a strong variable. 12721 // Although this code can still have problems: 12722 // id x = self.weakProp; 12723 // id y = self.weakProp; 12724 // we do not warn to warn spuriously when 'x' and 'y' are on separate 12725 // paths through the function. This should be revisited if 12726 // -Wrepeated-use-of-weak is made flow-sensitive. 12727 if (FunctionScopeInfo *FSI = getCurFunction()) 12728 if ((VDecl->getType().getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Strong || 12729 VDecl->getType().isNonWeakInMRRWithObjCWeak(Context)) && 12730 !Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_arc_repeated_use_of_weak, 12731 Init->getBeginLoc())) 12732 FSI->markSafeWeakUse(Init); 12733 } 12734 12735 // The initialization is usually a full-expression. 12736 // 12737 // FIXME: If this is a braced initialization of an aggregate, it is not 12738 // an expression, and each individual field initializer is a separate 12739 // full-expression. For instance, in: 12740 // 12741 // struct Temp { ~Temp(); }; 12742 // struct S { S(Temp); }; 12743 // struct T { S a, b; } t = { Temp(), Temp() } 12744 // 12745 // we should destroy the first Temp before constructing the second. 12746 ExprResult Result = 12747 ActOnFinishFullExpr(Init, VDecl->getLocation(), 12748 /*DiscardedValue*/ false, VDecl->isConstexpr()); 12749 if (Result.isInvalid()) { 12750 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12751 return; 12752 } 12753 Init = Result.get(); 12754 12755 // Attach the initializer to the decl. 12756 VDecl->setInit(Init); 12757 12758 if (VDecl->isLocalVarDecl()) { 12759 // Don't check the initializer if the declaration is malformed. 12760 if (VDecl->isInvalidDecl()) { 12761 // do nothing 12762 12763 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.5.3: __constant locals must be constant-initialized. 12764 // This is true even in C++ for OpenCL. 12765 } else if (VDecl->getType().getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_constant) { 12766 CheckForConstantInitializer(Init, DclT); 12767 12768 // Otherwise, C++ does not restrict the initializer. 12769 } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 12770 // do nothing 12771 12772 // C99 6.7.8p4: All the expressions in an initializer for an object that has 12773 // static storage duration shall be constant expressions or string literals. 12774 } else if (VDecl->getStorageClass() == SC_Static) { 12775 CheckForConstantInitializer(Init, DclT); 12776 12777 // C89 is stricter than C99 for aggregate initializers. 12778 // C89 6.5.7p3: All the expressions [...] in an initializer list 12779 // for an object that has aggregate or union type shall be 12780 // constant expressions. 12781 } else if (!getLangOpts().C99 && VDecl->getType()->isAggregateType() && 12782 isa<InitListExpr>(Init)) { 12783 const Expr *Culprit; 12784 if (!Init->isConstantInitializer(Context, false, &Culprit)) { 12785 Diag(Culprit->getExprLoc(), 12786 diag::ext_aggregate_init_not_constant) 12787 << Culprit->getSourceRange(); 12788 } 12789 } 12790 12791 if (auto *E = dyn_cast<ExprWithCleanups>(Init)) 12792 if (auto *BE = dyn_cast<BlockExpr>(E->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens())) 12793 if (VDecl->hasLocalStorage()) 12794 BE->getBlockDecl()->setCanAvoidCopyToHeap(); 12795 } else if (VDecl->isStaticDataMember() && !VDecl->isInline() && 12796 VDecl->getLexicalDeclContext()->isRecord()) { 12797 // This is an in-class initialization for a static data member, e.g., 12798 // 12799 // struct S { 12800 // static const int value = 17; 12801 // }; 12802 12803 // C++ [class.mem]p4: 12804 // A member-declarator can contain a constant-initializer only 12805 // if it declares a static member (9.4) of const integral or 12806 // const enumeration type, see 9.4.2. 12807 // 12808 // C++11 [class.static.data]p3: 12809 // If a non-volatile non-inline const static data member is of integral 12810 // or enumeration type, its declaration in the class definition can 12811 // specify a brace-or-equal-initializer in which every initializer-clause 12812 // that is an assignment-expression is a constant expression. A static 12813 // data member of literal type can be declared in the class definition 12814 // with the constexpr specifier; if so, its declaration shall specify a 12815 // brace-or-equal-initializer in which every initializer-clause that is 12816 // an assignment-expression is a constant expression. 12817 12818 // Do nothing on dependent types. 12819 if (DclT->isDependentType()) { 12820 12821 // Allow any 'static constexpr' members, whether or not they are of literal 12822 // type. We separately check that every constexpr variable is of literal 12823 // type. 12824 } else if (VDecl->isConstexpr()) { 12825 12826 // Require constness. 12827 } else if (!DclT.isConstQualified()) { 12828 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_in_class_initializer_non_const) 12829 << Init->getSourceRange(); 12830 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12831 12832 // We allow integer constant expressions in all cases. 12833 } else if (DclT->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) { 12834 // Check whether the expression is a constant expression. 12835 SourceLocation Loc; 12836 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && DclT.isVolatileQualified()) 12837 // In C++11, a non-constexpr const static data member with an 12838 // in-class initializer cannot be volatile. 12839 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_in_class_initializer_volatile); 12840 else if (Init->isValueDependent()) 12841 ; // Nothing to check. 12842 else if (Init->isIntegerConstantExpr(Context, &Loc)) 12843 ; // Ok, it's an ICE! 12844 else if (Init->getType()->isScopedEnumeralType() && 12845 Init->isCXX11ConstantExpr(Context)) 12846 ; // Ok, it is a scoped-enum constant expression. 12847 else if (Init->isEvaluatable(Context)) { 12848 // If we can constant fold the initializer through heroics, accept it, 12849 // but report this as a use of an extension for -pedantic. 12850 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_in_class_initializer_non_constant) 12851 << Init->getSourceRange(); 12852 } else { 12853 // Otherwise, this is some crazy unknown case. Report the issue at the 12854 // location provided by the isIntegerConstantExpr failed check. 12855 Diag(Loc, diag::err_in_class_initializer_non_constant) 12856 << Init->getSourceRange(); 12857 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12858 } 12859 12860 // We allow foldable floating-point constants as an extension. 12861 } else if (DclT->isFloatingType()) { // also permits complex, which is ok 12862 // In C++98, this is a GNU extension. In C++11, it is not, but we support 12863 // it anyway and provide a fixit to add the 'constexpr'. 12864 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) { 12865 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), 12866 diag::ext_in_class_initializer_float_type_cxx11) 12867 << DclT << Init->getSourceRange(); 12868 Diag(VDecl->getBeginLoc(), 12869 diag::note_in_class_initializer_float_type_cxx11) 12870 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(VDecl->getBeginLoc(), "constexpr "); 12871 } else { 12872 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::ext_in_class_initializer_float_type) 12873 << DclT << Init->getSourceRange(); 12874 12875 if (!Init->isValueDependent() && !Init->isEvaluatable(Context)) { 12876 Diag(Init->getExprLoc(), diag::err_in_class_initializer_non_constant) 12877 << Init->getSourceRange(); 12878 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12879 } 12880 } 12881 12882 // Suggest adding 'constexpr' in C++11 for literal types. 12883 } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && DclT->isLiteralType(Context)) { 12884 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_in_class_initializer_literal_type) 12885 << DclT << Init->getSourceRange() 12886 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(VDecl->getBeginLoc(), "constexpr "); 12887 VDecl->setConstexpr(true); 12888 12889 } else { 12890 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_in_class_initializer_bad_type) 12891 << DclT << Init->getSourceRange(); 12892 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12893 } 12894 } else if (VDecl->isFileVarDecl()) { 12895 // In C, extern is typically used to avoid tentative definitions when 12896 // declaring variables in headers, but adding an intializer makes it a 12897 // definition. This is somewhat confusing, so GCC and Clang both warn on it. 12898 // In C++, extern is often used to give implictly static const variables 12899 // external linkage, so don't warn in that case. If selectany is present, 12900 // this might be header code intended for C and C++ inclusion, so apply the 12901 // C++ rules. 12902 if (VDecl->getStorageClass() == SC_Extern && 12903 ((!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !VDecl->hasAttr<SelectAnyAttr>()) || 12904 !Context.getBaseElementType(VDecl->getType()).isConstQualified()) && 12905 !(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && VDecl->isExternC()) && 12906 !isTemplateInstantiation(VDecl->getTemplateSpecializationKind())) 12907 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::warn_extern_init); 12908 12909 // In Microsoft C++ mode, a const variable defined in namespace scope has 12910 // external linkage by default if the variable is declared with 12911 // __declspec(dllexport). 12912 if (Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() && 12913 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && VDecl->getType().isConstQualified() && 12914 VDecl->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>() && VDecl->getDefinition()) 12915 VDecl->setStorageClass(SC_Extern); 12916 12917 // C99 6.7.8p4. All file scoped initializers need to be constant. 12918 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !VDecl->isInvalidDecl()) 12919 CheckForConstantInitializer(Init, DclT); 12920 } 12921 12922 QualType InitType = Init->getType(); 12923 if (!InitType.isNull() && 12924 (InitType.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion() || 12925 InitType.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion())) 12926 checkNonTrivialCUnionInInitializer(Init, Init->getExprLoc()); 12927 12928 // We will represent direct-initialization similarly to copy-initialization: 12929 // int x(1); -as-> int x = 1; 12930 // ClassType x(a,b,c); -as-> ClassType x = ClassType(a,b,c); 12931 // 12932 // Clients that want to distinguish between the two forms, can check for 12933 // direct initializer using VarDecl::getInitStyle(). 12934 // A major benefit is that clients that don't particularly care about which 12935 // exactly form was it (like the CodeGen) can handle both cases without 12936 // special case code. 12937 12938 // C++ 8.5p11: 12939 // The form of initialization (using parentheses or '=') is generally 12940 // insignificant, but does matter when the entity being initialized has a 12941 // class type. 12942 if (CXXDirectInit) { 12943 assert(DirectInit && "Call-style initializer must be direct init."); 12944 VDecl->setInitStyle(VarDecl::CallInit); 12945 } else if (DirectInit) { 12946 // This must be list-initialization. No other way is direct-initialization. 12947 VDecl->setInitStyle(VarDecl::ListInit); 12948 } 12949 12950 if (LangOpts.OpenMP && 12951 (LangOpts.OpenMPIsDevice || !LangOpts.OMPTargetTriples.empty()) && 12952 VDecl->isFileVarDecl()) 12953 DeclsToCheckForDeferredDiags.insert(VDecl); 12954 CheckCompleteVariableDeclaration(VDecl); 12955 } 12956 12957 /// ActOnInitializerError - Given that there was an error parsing an 12958 /// initializer for the given declaration, try to at least re-establish 12959 /// invariants such as whether a variable's type is either dependent or 12960 /// complete. 12961 void Sema::ActOnInitializerError(Decl *D) { 12962 // Our main concern here is re-establishing invariants like "a 12963 // variable's type is either dependent or complete". 12964 if (!D || D->isInvalidDecl()) return; 12965 12966 VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D); 12967 if (!VD) return; 12968 12969 // Bindings are not usable if we can't make sense of the initializer. 12970 if (auto *DD = dyn_cast<DecompositionDecl>(D)) 12971 for (auto *BD : DD->bindings()) 12972 BD->setInvalidDecl(); 12973 12974 // Auto types are meaningless if we can't make sense of the initializer. 12975 if (VD->getType()->isUndeducedType()) { 12976 D->setInvalidDecl(); 12977 return; 12978 } 12979 12980 QualType Ty = VD->getType(); 12981 if (Ty->isDependentType()) return; 12982 12983 // Require a complete type. 12984 if (RequireCompleteType(VD->getLocation(), 12985 Context.getBaseElementType(Ty), 12986 diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)) { 12987 VD->setInvalidDecl(); 12988 return; 12989 } 12990 12991 // Require a non-abstract type. 12992 if (RequireNonAbstractType(VD->getLocation(), Ty, 12993 diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl, 12994 AbstractVariableType)) { 12995 VD->setInvalidDecl(); 12996 return; 12997 } 12998 12999 // Don't bother complaining about constructors or destructors, 13000 // though. 13001 } 13002 13003 void Sema::ActOnUninitializedDecl(Decl *RealDecl) { 13004 // If there is no declaration, there was an error parsing it. Just ignore it. 13005 if (!RealDecl) 13006 return; 13007 13008 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(RealDecl)) { 13009 QualType Type = Var->getType(); 13010 13011 // C++1z [dcl.dcl]p1 grammar implies that an initializer is mandatory. 13012 if (isa<DecompositionDecl>(RealDecl)) { 13013 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::err_decomp_decl_requires_init) << Var; 13014 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 13015 return; 13016 } 13017 13018 if (Type->isUndeducedType() && 13019 DeduceVariableDeclarationType(Var, false, nullptr)) 13020 return; 13021 13022 // C++11 [class.static.data]p3: A static data member can be declared with 13023 // the constexpr specifier; if so, its declaration shall specify 13024 // a brace-or-equal-initializer. 13025 // C++11 [dcl.constexpr]p1: The constexpr specifier shall be applied only to 13026 // the definition of a variable [...] or the declaration of a static data 13027 // member. 13028 if (Var->isConstexpr() && !Var->isThisDeclarationADefinition() && 13029 !Var->isThisDeclarationADemotedDefinition()) { 13030 if (Var->isStaticDataMember()) { 13031 // C++1z removes the relevant rule; the in-class declaration is always 13032 // a definition there. 13033 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 && 13034 !Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft()) { 13035 Diag(Var->getLocation(), 13036 diag::err_constexpr_static_mem_var_requires_init) 13037 << Var; 13038 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 13039 return; 13040 } 13041 } else { 13042 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::err_invalid_constexpr_var_decl); 13043 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 13044 return; 13045 } 13046 } 13047 13048 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.5.3: variables declared in the constant address space must 13049 // be initialized. 13050 if (!Var->isInvalidDecl() && 13051 Var->getType().getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_constant && 13052 Var->getStorageClass() != SC_Extern && !Var->getInit()) { 13053 bool HasConstExprDefaultConstructor = false; 13054 if (CXXRecordDecl *RD = Var->getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) { 13055 for (auto *Ctor : RD->ctors()) { 13056 if (Ctor->isConstexpr() && Ctor->getNumParams() == 0 && 13057 Ctor->getMethodQualifiers().getAddressSpace() == 13058 LangAS::opencl_constant) { 13059 HasConstExprDefaultConstructor = true; 13060 } 13061 } 13062 } 13063 if (!HasConstExprDefaultConstructor) { 13064 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_constant_no_init); 13065 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 13066 return; 13067 } 13068 } 13069 13070 if (!Var->isInvalidDecl() && RealDecl->hasAttr<LoaderUninitializedAttr>()) { 13071 if (Var->getStorageClass() == SC_Extern) { 13072 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::err_loader_uninitialized_extern_decl) 13073 << Var; 13074 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 13075 return; 13076 } 13077 if (RequireCompleteType(Var->getLocation(), Var->getType(), 13078 diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)) { 13079 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 13080 return; 13081 } 13082 if (CXXRecordDecl *RD = Var->getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) { 13083 if (!RD->hasTrivialDefaultConstructor()) { 13084 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::err_loader_uninitialized_trivial_ctor); 13085 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 13086 return; 13087 } 13088 } 13089 // The declaration is unitialized, no need for further checks. 13090 return; 13091 } 13092 13093 VarDecl::DefinitionKind DefKind = Var->isThisDeclarationADefinition(); 13094 if (!Var->isInvalidDecl() && DefKind != VarDecl::DeclarationOnly && 13095 Var->getType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion()) 13096 checkNonTrivialCUnion(Var->getType(), Var->getLocation(), 13097 NTCUC_DefaultInitializedObject, NTCUK_Init); 13098 13099 13100 switch (DefKind) { 13101 case VarDecl::Definition: 13102 if (!Var->isStaticDataMember() || !Var->getAnyInitializer()) 13103 break; 13104 13105 // We have an out-of-line definition of a static data member 13106 // that has an in-class initializer, so we type-check this like 13107 // a declaration. 13108 // 13109 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 13110 13111 case VarDecl::DeclarationOnly: 13112 // It's only a declaration. 13113 13114 // Block scope. C99 6.7p7: If an identifier for an object is 13115 // declared with no linkage (C99 6.2.2p6), the type for the 13116 // object shall be complete. 13117 if (!Type->isDependentType() && Var->isLocalVarDecl() && 13118 !Var->hasLinkage() && !Var->isInvalidDecl() && 13119 RequireCompleteType(Var->getLocation(), Type, 13120 diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)) 13121 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 13122 13123 // Make sure that the type is not abstract. 13124 if (!Type->isDependentType() && !Var->isInvalidDecl() && 13125 RequireNonAbstractType(Var->getLocation(), Type, 13126 diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl, 13127 AbstractVariableType)) 13128 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 13129 if (!Type->isDependentType() && !Var->isInvalidDecl() && 13130 Var->getStorageClass() == SC_PrivateExtern) { 13131 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::warn_private_extern); 13132 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_private_extern); 13133 } 13134 13135 if (Context.getTargetInfo().allowDebugInfoForExternalRef() && 13136 !Var->isInvalidDecl() && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 13137 ExternalDeclarations.push_back(Var); 13138 13139 return; 13140 13141 case VarDecl::TentativeDefinition: 13142 // File scope. C99 6.9.2p2: A declaration of an identifier for an 13143 // object that has file scope without an initializer, and without a 13144 // storage-class specifier or with the storage-class specifier "static", 13145 // constitutes a tentative definition. Note: A tentative definition with 13146 // external linkage is valid (C99 6.2.2p5). 13147 if (!Var->isInvalidDecl()) { 13148 if (const IncompleteArrayType *ArrayT 13149 = Context.getAsIncompleteArrayType(Type)) { 13150 if (RequireCompleteSizedType( 13151 Var->getLocation(), ArrayT->getElementType(), 13152 diag::err_array_incomplete_or_sizeless_type)) 13153 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 13154 } else if (Var->getStorageClass() == SC_Static) { 13155 // C99 6.9.2p3: If the declaration of an identifier for an object is 13156 // a tentative definition and has internal linkage (C99 6.2.2p3), the 13157 // declared type shall not be an incomplete type. 13158 // NOTE: code such as the following 13159 // static struct s; 13160 // struct s { int a; }; 13161 // is accepted by gcc. Hence here we issue a warning instead of 13162 // an error and we do not invalidate the static declaration. 13163 // NOTE: to avoid multiple warnings, only check the first declaration. 13164 if (Var->isFirstDecl()) 13165 RequireCompleteType(Var->getLocation(), Type, 13166 diag::ext_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type); 13167 } 13168 } 13169 13170 // Record the tentative definition; we're done. 13171 if (!Var->isInvalidDecl()) 13172 TentativeDefinitions.push_back(Var); 13173 return; 13174 } 13175 13176 // Provide a specific diagnostic for uninitialized variable 13177 // definitions with incomplete array type. 13178 if (Type->isIncompleteArrayType()) { 13179 Diag(Var->getLocation(), 13180 diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_array_needs_initializer); 13181 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 13182 return; 13183 } 13184 13185 // Provide a specific diagnostic for uninitialized variable 13186 // definitions with reference type. 13187 if (Type->isReferenceType()) { 13188 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::err_reference_var_requires_init) 13189 << Var << SourceRange(Var->getLocation(), Var->getLocation()); 13190 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 13191 return; 13192 } 13193 13194 // Do not attempt to type-check the default initializer for a 13195 // variable with dependent type. 13196 if (Type->isDependentType()) 13197 return; 13198 13199 if (Var->isInvalidDecl()) 13200 return; 13201 13202 if (!Var->hasAttr<AliasAttr>()) { 13203 if (RequireCompleteType(Var->getLocation(), 13204 Context.getBaseElementType(Type), 13205 diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)) { 13206 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 13207 return; 13208 } 13209 } else { 13210 return; 13211 } 13212 13213 // The variable can not have an abstract class type. 13214 if (RequireNonAbstractType(Var->getLocation(), Type, 13215 diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl, 13216 AbstractVariableType)) { 13217 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 13218 return; 13219 } 13220 13221 // Check for jumps past the implicit initializer. C++0x 13222 // clarifies that this applies to a "variable with automatic 13223 // storage duration", not a "local variable". 13224 // C++11 [stmt.dcl]p3 13225 // A program that jumps from a point where a variable with automatic 13226 // storage duration is not in scope to a point where it is in scope is 13227 // ill-formed unless the variable has scalar type, class type with a 13228 // trivial default constructor and a trivial destructor, a cv-qualified 13229 // version of one of these types, or an array of one of the preceding 13230 // types and is declared without an initializer. 13231 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && Var->hasLocalStorage()) { 13232 if (const RecordType *Record 13233 = Context.getBaseElementType(Type)->getAs<RecordType>()) { 13234 CXXRecordDecl *CXXRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record->getDecl()); 13235 // Mark the function (if we're in one) for further checking even if the 13236 // looser rules of C++11 do not require such checks, so that we can 13237 // diagnose incompatibilities with C++98. 13238 if (!CXXRecord->isPOD()) 13239 setFunctionHasBranchProtectedScope(); 13240 } 13241 } 13242 // In OpenCL, we can't initialize objects in the __local address space, 13243 // even implicitly, so don't synthesize an implicit initializer. 13244 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && 13245 Var->getType().getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_local) 13246 return; 13247 // C++03 [dcl.init]p9: 13248 // If no initializer is specified for an object, and the 13249 // object is of (possibly cv-qualified) non-POD class type (or 13250 // array thereof), the object shall be default-initialized; if 13251 // the object is of const-qualified type, the underlying class 13252 // type shall have a user-declared default 13253 // constructor. Otherwise, if no initializer is specified for 13254 // a non- static object, the object and its subobjects, if 13255 // any, have an indeterminate initial value); if the object 13256 // or any of its subobjects are of const-qualified type, the 13257 // program is ill-formed. 13258 // C++0x [dcl.init]p11: 13259 // If no initializer is specified for an object, the object is 13260 // default-initialized; [...]. 13261 InitializedEntity Entity = InitializedEntity::InitializeVariable(Var); 13262 InitializationKind Kind 13263 = InitializationKind::CreateDefault(Var->getLocation()); 13264 13265 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, None); 13266 ExprResult Init = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind, None); 13267 13268 if (Init.get()) { 13269 Var->setInit(MaybeCreateExprWithCleanups(Init.get())); 13270 // This is important for template substitution. 13271 Var->setInitStyle(VarDecl::CallInit); 13272 } else if (Init.isInvalid()) { 13273 // If default-init fails, attach a recovery-expr initializer to track 13274 // that initialization was attempted and failed. 13275 auto RecoveryExpr = 13276 CreateRecoveryExpr(Var->getLocation(), Var->getLocation(), {}); 13277 if (RecoveryExpr.get()) 13278 Var->setInit(RecoveryExpr.get()); 13279 } 13280 13281 CheckCompleteVariableDeclaration(Var); 13282 } 13283 } 13284 13285 void Sema::ActOnCXXForRangeDecl(Decl *D) { 13286 // If there is no declaration, there was an error parsing it. Ignore it. 13287 if (!D) 13288 return; 13289 13290 VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D); 13291 if (!VD) { 13292 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::err_for_range_decl_must_be_var); 13293 D->setInvalidDecl(); 13294 return; 13295 } 13296 13297 VD->setCXXForRangeDecl(true); 13298 13299 // for-range-declaration cannot be given a storage class specifier. 13300 int Error = -1; 13301 switch (VD->getStorageClass()) { 13302 case SC_None: 13303 break; 13304 case SC_Extern: 13305 Error = 0; 13306 break; 13307 case SC_Static: 13308 Error = 1; 13309 break; 13310 case SC_PrivateExtern: 13311 Error = 2; 13312 break; 13313 case SC_Auto: 13314 Error = 3; 13315 break; 13316 case SC_Register: 13317 Error = 4; 13318 break; 13319 } 13320 13321 // for-range-declaration cannot be given a storage class specifier con't. 13322 switch (VD->getTSCSpec()) { 13323 case TSCS_thread_local: 13324 Error = 6; 13325 break; 13326 case TSCS___thread: 13327 case TSCS__Thread_local: 13328 case TSCS_unspecified: 13329 break; 13330 } 13331 13332 if (Error != -1) { 13333 Diag(VD->getOuterLocStart(), diag::err_for_range_storage_class) 13334 << VD << Error; 13335 D->setInvalidDecl(); 13336 } 13337 } 13338 13339 StmtResult Sema::ActOnCXXForRangeIdentifier(Scope *S, SourceLocation IdentLoc, 13340 IdentifierInfo *Ident, 13341 ParsedAttributes &Attrs) { 13342 // C++1y [stmt.iter]p1: 13343 // A range-based for statement of the form 13344 // for ( for-range-identifier : for-range-initializer ) statement 13345 // is equivalent to 13346 // for ( auto&& for-range-identifier : for-range-initializer ) statement 13347 DeclSpec DS(Attrs.getPool().getFactory()); 13348 13349 const char *PrevSpec; 13350 unsigned DiagID; 13351 DS.SetTypeSpecType(DeclSpec::TST_auto, IdentLoc, PrevSpec, DiagID, 13352 getPrintingPolicy()); 13353 13354 Declarator D(DS, DeclaratorContext::ForInit); 13355 D.SetIdentifier(Ident, IdentLoc); 13356 D.takeAttributes(Attrs); 13357 13358 D.AddTypeInfo(DeclaratorChunk::getReference(0, IdentLoc, /*lvalue*/ false), 13359 IdentLoc); 13360 Decl *Var = ActOnDeclarator(S, D); 13361 cast<VarDecl>(Var)->setCXXForRangeDecl(true); 13362 FinalizeDeclaration(Var); 13363 return ActOnDeclStmt(FinalizeDeclaratorGroup(S, DS, Var), IdentLoc, 13364 Attrs.Range.getEnd().isValid() ? Attrs.Range.getEnd() 13365 : IdentLoc); 13366 } 13367 13368 void Sema::CheckCompleteVariableDeclaration(VarDecl *var) { 13369 if (var->isInvalidDecl()) return; 13370 13371 MaybeAddCUDAConstantAttr(var); 13372 13373 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) { 13374 // OpenCL v2.0 s6.12.5 - Every block variable declaration must have an 13375 // initialiser 13376 if (var->getTypeSourceInfo()->getType()->isBlockPointerType() && 13377 !var->hasInit()) { 13378 Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_invalid_block_declaration) 13379 << 1 /*Init*/; 13380 var->setInvalidDecl(); 13381 return; 13382 } 13383 } 13384 13385 // In Objective-C, don't allow jumps past the implicit initialization of a 13386 // local retaining variable. 13387 if (getLangOpts().ObjC && 13388 var->hasLocalStorage()) { 13389 switch (var->getType().getObjCLifetime()) { 13390 case Qualifiers::OCL_None: 13391 case Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone: 13392 case Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing: 13393 break; 13394 13395 case Qualifiers::OCL_Weak: 13396 case Qualifiers::OCL_Strong: 13397 setFunctionHasBranchProtectedScope(); 13398 break; 13399 } 13400 } 13401 13402 if (var->hasLocalStorage() && 13403 var->getType().isDestructedType() == QualType::DK_nontrivial_c_struct) 13404 setFunctionHasBranchProtectedScope(); 13405 13406 // Warn about externally-visible variables being defined without a 13407 // prior declaration. We only want to do this for global 13408 // declarations, but we also specifically need to avoid doing it for 13409 // class members because the linkage of an anonymous class can 13410 // change if it's later given a typedef name. 13411 if (var->isThisDeclarationADefinition() && 13412 var->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isFileContext() && 13413 var->isExternallyVisible() && var->hasLinkage() && 13414 !var->isInline() && !var->getDescribedVarTemplate() && 13415 !isa<VarTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(var) && 13416 !isTemplateInstantiation(var->getTemplateSpecializationKind()) && 13417 !getDiagnostics().isIgnored(diag::warn_missing_variable_declarations, 13418 var->getLocation())) { 13419 // Find a previous declaration that's not a definition. 13420 VarDecl *prev = var->getPreviousDecl(); 13421 while (prev && prev->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) 13422 prev = prev->getPreviousDecl(); 13423 13424 if (!prev) { 13425 Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::warn_missing_variable_declarations) << var; 13426 Diag(var->getTypeSpecStartLoc(), diag::note_static_for_internal_linkage) 13427 << /* variable */ 0; 13428 } 13429 } 13430 13431 // Cache the result of checking for constant initialization. 13432 Optional<bool> CacheHasConstInit; 13433 const Expr *CacheCulprit = nullptr; 13434 auto checkConstInit = [&]() mutable { 13435 if (!CacheHasConstInit) 13436 CacheHasConstInit = var->getInit()->isConstantInitializer( 13437 Context, var->getType()->isReferenceType(), &CacheCulprit); 13438 return *CacheHasConstInit; 13439 }; 13440 13441 if (var->getTLSKind() == VarDecl::TLS_Static) { 13442 if (var->getType().isDestructedType()) { 13443 // GNU C++98 edits for __thread, [basic.start.term]p3: 13444 // The type of an object with thread storage duration shall not 13445 // have a non-trivial destructor. 13446 Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::err_thread_nontrivial_dtor); 13447 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) 13448 Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::note_use_thread_local); 13449 } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && var->hasInit()) { 13450 if (!checkConstInit()) { 13451 // GNU C++98 edits for __thread, [basic.start.init]p4: 13452 // An object of thread storage duration shall not require dynamic 13453 // initialization. 13454 // FIXME: Need strict checking here. 13455 Diag(CacheCulprit->getExprLoc(), diag::err_thread_dynamic_init) 13456 << CacheCulprit->getSourceRange(); 13457 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) 13458 Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::note_use_thread_local); 13459 } 13460 } 13461 } 13462 13463 13464 if (!var->getType()->isStructureType() && var->hasInit() && 13465 isa<InitListExpr>(var->getInit())) { 13466 const auto *ILE = cast<InitListExpr>(var->getInit()); 13467 unsigned NumInits = ILE->getNumInits(); 13468 if (NumInits > 2) 13469 for (unsigned I = 0; I < NumInits; ++I) { 13470 const auto *Init = ILE->getInit(I); 13471 if (!Init) 13472 break; 13473 const auto *SL = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(Init->IgnoreImpCasts()); 13474 if (!SL) 13475 break; 13476 13477 unsigned NumConcat = SL->getNumConcatenated(); 13478 // Diagnose missing comma in string array initialization. 13479 // Do not warn when all the elements in the initializer are concatenated 13480 // together. Do not warn for macros too. 13481 if (NumConcat == 2 && !SL->getBeginLoc().isMacroID()) { 13482 bool OnlyOneMissingComma = true; 13483 for (unsigned J = I + 1; J < NumInits; ++J) { 13484 const auto *Init = ILE->getInit(J); 13485 if (!Init) 13486 break; 13487 const auto *SLJ = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(Init->IgnoreImpCasts()); 13488 if (!SLJ || SLJ->getNumConcatenated() > 1) { 13489 OnlyOneMissingComma = false; 13490 break; 13491 } 13492 } 13493 13494 if (OnlyOneMissingComma) { 13495 SmallVector<FixItHint, 1> Hints; 13496 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumConcat - 1; ++i) 13497 Hints.push_back(FixItHint::CreateInsertion( 13498 PP.getLocForEndOfToken(SL->getStrTokenLoc(i)), ",")); 13499 13500 Diag(SL->getStrTokenLoc(1), 13501 diag::warn_concatenated_literal_array_init) 13502 << Hints; 13503 Diag(SL->getBeginLoc(), 13504 diag::note_concatenated_string_literal_silence); 13505 } 13506 // In any case, stop now. 13507 break; 13508 } 13509 } 13510 } 13511 13512 13513 QualType type = var->getType(); 13514 13515 if (var->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) 13516 getCurFunction()->addByrefBlockVar(var); 13517 13518 Expr *Init = var->getInit(); 13519 bool GlobalStorage = var->hasGlobalStorage(); 13520 bool IsGlobal = GlobalStorage && !var->isStaticLocal(); 13521 QualType baseType = Context.getBaseElementType(type); 13522 bool HasConstInit = true; 13523 13524 // Check whether the initializer is sufficiently constant. 13525 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !type->isDependentType() && Init && 13526 !Init->isValueDependent() && 13527 (GlobalStorage || var->isConstexpr() || 13528 var->mightBeUsableInConstantExpressions(Context))) { 13529 // If this variable might have a constant initializer or might be usable in 13530 // constant expressions, check whether or not it actually is now. We can't 13531 // do this lazily, because the result might depend on things that change 13532 // later, such as which constexpr functions happen to be defined. 13533 SmallVector<PartialDiagnosticAt, 8> Notes; 13534 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) { 13535 // Prior to C++11, in contexts where a constant initializer is required, 13536 // the set of valid constant initializers is described by syntactic rules 13537 // in [expr.const]p2-6. 13538 // FIXME: Stricter checking for these rules would be useful for constinit / 13539 // -Wglobal-constructors. 13540 HasConstInit = checkConstInit(); 13541 13542 // Compute and cache the constant value, and remember that we have a 13543 // constant initializer. 13544 if (HasConstInit) { 13545 (void)var->checkForConstantInitialization(Notes); 13546 Notes.clear(); 13547 } else if (CacheCulprit) { 13548 Notes.emplace_back(CacheCulprit->getExprLoc(), 13549 PDiag(diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_const_expr)); 13550 Notes.back().second << CacheCulprit->getSourceRange(); 13551 } 13552 } else { 13553 // Evaluate the initializer to see if it's a constant initializer. 13554 HasConstInit = var->checkForConstantInitialization(Notes); 13555 } 13556 13557 if (HasConstInit) { 13558 // FIXME: Consider replacing the initializer with a ConstantExpr. 13559 } else if (var->isConstexpr()) { 13560 SourceLocation DiagLoc = var->getLocation(); 13561 // If the note doesn't add any useful information other than a source 13562 // location, fold it into the primary diagnostic. 13563 if (Notes.size() == 1 && Notes[0].second.getDiagID() == 13564 diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_const_expr) { 13565 DiagLoc = Notes[0].first; 13566 Notes.clear(); 13567 } 13568 Diag(DiagLoc, diag::err_constexpr_var_requires_const_init) 13569 << var << Init->getSourceRange(); 13570 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Notes.size(); I != N; ++I) 13571 Diag(Notes[I].first, Notes[I].second); 13572 } else if (GlobalStorage && var->hasAttr<ConstInitAttr>()) { 13573 auto *Attr = var->getAttr<ConstInitAttr>(); 13574 Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::err_require_constant_init_failed) 13575 << Init->getSourceRange(); 13576 Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_required_constant_init_here) 13577 << Attr->getRange() << Attr->isConstinit(); 13578 for (auto &it : Notes) 13579 Diag(it.first, it.second); 13580 } else if (IsGlobal && 13581 !getDiagnostics().isIgnored(diag::warn_global_constructor, 13582 var->getLocation())) { 13583 // Warn about globals which don't have a constant initializer. Don't 13584 // warn about globals with a non-trivial destructor because we already 13585 // warned about them. 13586 CXXRecordDecl *RD = baseType->getAsCXXRecordDecl(); 13587 if (!(RD && !RD->hasTrivialDestructor())) { 13588 // checkConstInit() here permits trivial default initialization even in 13589 // C++11 onwards, where such an initializer is not a constant initializer 13590 // but nonetheless doesn't require a global constructor. 13591 if (!checkConstInit()) 13592 Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::warn_global_constructor) 13593 << Init->getSourceRange(); 13594 } 13595 } 13596 } 13597 13598 // Apply section attributes and pragmas to global variables. 13599 if (GlobalStorage && var->isThisDeclarationADefinition() && 13600 !inTemplateInstantiation()) { 13601 PragmaStack<StringLiteral *> *Stack = nullptr; 13602 int SectionFlags = ASTContext::PSF_Read; 13603 if (var->getType().isConstQualified()) { 13604 if (HasConstInit) 13605 Stack = &ConstSegStack; 13606 else { 13607 Stack = &BSSSegStack; 13608 SectionFlags |= ASTContext::PSF_Write; 13609 } 13610 } else if (var->hasInit() && HasConstInit) { 13611 Stack = &DataSegStack; 13612 SectionFlags |= ASTContext::PSF_Write; 13613 } else { 13614 Stack = &BSSSegStack; 13615 SectionFlags |= ASTContext::PSF_Write; 13616 } 13617 if (const SectionAttr *SA = var->getAttr<SectionAttr>()) { 13618 if (SA->getSyntax() == AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Declspec) 13619 SectionFlags |= ASTContext::PSF_Implicit; 13620 UnifySection(SA->getName(), SectionFlags, var); 13621 } else if (Stack->CurrentValue) { 13622 SectionFlags |= ASTContext::PSF_Implicit; 13623 auto SectionName = Stack->CurrentValue->getString(); 13624 var->addAttr(SectionAttr::CreateImplicit( 13625 Context, SectionName, Stack->CurrentPragmaLocation, 13626 AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma, SectionAttr::Declspec_allocate)); 13627 if (UnifySection(SectionName, SectionFlags, var)) 13628 var->dropAttr<SectionAttr>(); 13629 } 13630 13631 // Apply the init_seg attribute if this has an initializer. If the 13632 // initializer turns out to not be dynamic, we'll end up ignoring this 13633 // attribute. 13634 if (CurInitSeg && var->getInit()) 13635 var->addAttr(InitSegAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, CurInitSeg->getString(), 13636 CurInitSegLoc, 13637 AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma)); 13638 } 13639 13640 // All the following checks are C++ only. 13641 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 13642 // If this variable must be emitted, add it as an initializer for the 13643 // current module. 13644 if (Context.DeclMustBeEmitted(var) && !ModuleScopes.empty()) 13645 Context.addModuleInitializer(ModuleScopes.back().Module, var); 13646 return; 13647 } 13648 13649 // Require the destructor. 13650 if (!type->isDependentType()) 13651 if (const RecordType *recordType = baseType->getAs<RecordType>()) 13652 FinalizeVarWithDestructor(var, recordType); 13653 13654 // If this variable must be emitted, add it as an initializer for the current 13655 // module. 13656 if (Context.DeclMustBeEmitted(var) && !ModuleScopes.empty()) 13657 Context.addModuleInitializer(ModuleScopes.back().Module, var); 13658 13659 // Build the bindings if this is a structured binding declaration. 13660 if (auto *DD = dyn_cast<DecompositionDecl>(var)) 13661 CheckCompleteDecompositionDeclaration(DD); 13662 } 13663 13664 /// Check if VD needs to be dllexport/dllimport due to being in a 13665 /// dllexport/import function. 13666 void Sema::CheckStaticLocalForDllExport(VarDecl *VD) { 13667 assert(VD->isStaticLocal()); 13668 13669 auto *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(VD->getParentFunctionOrMethod()); 13670 13671 // Find outermost function when VD is in lambda function. 13672 while (FD && !getDLLAttr(FD) && 13673 !FD->hasAttr<DLLExportStaticLocalAttr>() && 13674 !FD->hasAttr<DLLImportStaticLocalAttr>()) { 13675 FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(FD->getParentFunctionOrMethod()); 13676 } 13677 13678 if (!FD) 13679 return; 13680 13681 // Static locals inherit dll attributes from their function. 13682 if (Attr *A = getDLLAttr(FD)) { 13683 auto *NewAttr = cast<InheritableAttr>(A->clone(getASTContext())); 13684 NewAttr->setInherited(true); 13685 VD->addAttr(NewAttr); 13686 } else if (Attr *A = FD->getAttr<DLLExportStaticLocalAttr>()) { 13687 auto *NewAttr = DLLExportAttr::CreateImplicit(getASTContext(), *A); 13688 NewAttr->setInherited(true); 13689 VD->addAttr(NewAttr); 13690 13691 // Export this function to enforce exporting this static variable even 13692 // if it is not used in this compilation unit. 13693 if (!FD->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>()) 13694 FD->addAttr(NewAttr); 13695 13696 } else if (Attr *A = FD->getAttr<DLLImportStaticLocalAttr>()) { 13697 auto *NewAttr = DLLImportAttr::CreateImplicit(getASTContext(), *A); 13698 NewAttr->setInherited(true); 13699 VD->addAttr(NewAttr); 13700 } 13701 } 13702 13703 /// FinalizeDeclaration - called by ParseDeclarationAfterDeclarator to perform 13704 /// any semantic actions necessary after any initializer has been attached. 13705 void Sema::FinalizeDeclaration(Decl *ThisDecl) { 13706 // Note that we are no longer parsing the initializer for this declaration. 13707 ParsingInitForAutoVars.erase(ThisDecl); 13708 13709 VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast_or_null<VarDecl>(ThisDecl); 13710 if (!VD) 13711 return; 13712 13713 // Apply an implicit SectionAttr if '#pragma clang section bss|data|rodata' is active 13714 if (VD->hasGlobalStorage() && VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() && 13715 !inTemplateInstantiation() && !VD->hasAttr<SectionAttr>()) { 13716 if (PragmaClangBSSSection.Valid) 13717 VD->addAttr(PragmaClangBSSSectionAttr::CreateImplicit( 13718 Context, PragmaClangBSSSection.SectionName, 13719 PragmaClangBSSSection.PragmaLocation, 13720 AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma)); 13721 if (PragmaClangDataSection.Valid) 13722 VD->addAttr(PragmaClangDataSectionAttr::CreateImplicit( 13723 Context, PragmaClangDataSection.SectionName, 13724 PragmaClangDataSection.PragmaLocation, 13725 AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma)); 13726 if (PragmaClangRodataSection.Valid) 13727 VD->addAttr(PragmaClangRodataSectionAttr::CreateImplicit( 13728 Context, PragmaClangRodataSection.SectionName, 13729 PragmaClangRodataSection.PragmaLocation, 13730 AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma)); 13731 if (PragmaClangRelroSection.Valid) 13732 VD->addAttr(PragmaClangRelroSectionAttr::CreateImplicit( 13733 Context, PragmaClangRelroSection.SectionName, 13734 PragmaClangRelroSection.PragmaLocation, 13735 AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma)); 13736 } 13737 13738 if (auto *DD = dyn_cast<DecompositionDecl>(ThisDecl)) { 13739 for (auto *BD : DD->bindings()) { 13740 FinalizeDeclaration(BD); 13741 } 13742 } 13743 13744 checkAttributesAfterMerging(*this, *VD); 13745 13746 // Perform TLS alignment check here after attributes attached to the variable 13747 // which may affect the alignment have been processed. Only perform the check 13748 // if the target has a maximum TLS alignment (zero means no constraints). 13749 if (unsigned MaxAlign = Context.getTargetInfo().getMaxTLSAlign()) { 13750 // Protect the check so that it's not performed on dependent types and 13751 // dependent alignments (we can't determine the alignment in that case). 13752 if (VD->getTLSKind() && !VD->hasDependentAlignment()) { 13753 CharUnits MaxAlignChars = Context.toCharUnitsFromBits(MaxAlign); 13754 if (Context.getDeclAlign(VD) > MaxAlignChars) { 13755 Diag(VD->getLocation(), diag::err_tls_var_aligned_over_maximum) 13756 << (unsigned)Context.getDeclAlign(VD).getQuantity() << VD 13757 << (unsigned)MaxAlignChars.getQuantity(); 13758 } 13759 } 13760 } 13761 13762 if (VD->isStaticLocal()) 13763 CheckStaticLocalForDllExport(VD); 13764 13765 // Perform check for initializers of device-side global variables. 13766 // CUDA allows empty constructors as initializers (see E.2.3.1, CUDA 13767 // 7.5). We must also apply the same checks to all __shared__ 13768 // variables whether they are local or not. CUDA also allows 13769 // constant initializers for __constant__ and __device__ variables. 13770 if (getLangOpts().CUDA) 13771 checkAllowedCUDAInitializer(VD); 13772 13773 // Grab the dllimport or dllexport attribute off of the VarDecl. 13774 const InheritableAttr *DLLAttr = getDLLAttr(VD); 13775 13776 // Imported static data members cannot be defined out-of-line. 13777 if (const auto *IA = dyn_cast_or_null<DLLImportAttr>(DLLAttr)) { 13778 if (VD->isStaticDataMember() && VD->isOutOfLine() && 13779 VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) { 13780 // We allow definitions of dllimport class template static data members 13781 // with a warning. 13782 CXXRecordDecl *Context = 13783 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(VD->getFirstDecl()->getDeclContext()); 13784 bool IsClassTemplateMember = 13785 isa<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(Context) || 13786 Context->getDescribedClassTemplate(); 13787 13788 Diag(VD->getLocation(), 13789 IsClassTemplateMember 13790 ? diag::warn_attribute_dllimport_static_field_definition 13791 : diag::err_attribute_dllimport_static_field_definition); 13792 Diag(IA->getLocation(), diag::note_attribute); 13793 if (!IsClassTemplateMember) 13794 VD->setInvalidDecl(); 13795 } 13796 } 13797 13798 // dllimport/dllexport variables cannot be thread local, their TLS index 13799 // isn't exported with the variable. 13800 if (DLLAttr && VD->getTLSKind()) { 13801 auto *F = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(VD->getParentFunctionOrMethod()); 13802 if (F && getDLLAttr(F)) { 13803 assert(VD->isStaticLocal()); 13804 // But if this is a static local in a dlimport/dllexport function, the 13805 // function will never be inlined, which means the var would never be 13806 // imported, so having it marked import/export is safe. 13807 } else { 13808 Diag(VD->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_dll_thread_local) << VD 13809 << DLLAttr; 13810 VD->setInvalidDecl(); 13811 } 13812 } 13813 13814 if (UsedAttr *Attr = VD->getAttr<UsedAttr>()) { 13815 if (!Attr->isInherited() && !VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) { 13816 Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::warn_attribute_ignored_on_non_definition) 13817 << Attr; 13818 VD->dropAttr<UsedAttr>(); 13819 } 13820 } 13821 if (RetainAttr *Attr = VD->getAttr<RetainAttr>()) { 13822 if (!Attr->isInherited() && !VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) { 13823 Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::warn_attribute_ignored_on_non_definition) 13824 << Attr; 13825 VD->dropAttr<RetainAttr>(); 13826 } 13827 } 13828 13829 const DeclContext *DC = VD->getDeclContext(); 13830 // If there's a #pragma GCC visibility in scope, and this isn't a class 13831 // member, set the visibility of this variable. 13832 if (DC->getRedeclContext()->isFileContext() && VD->isExternallyVisible()) 13833 AddPushedVisibilityAttribute(VD); 13834 13835 // FIXME: Warn on unused var template partial specializations. 13836 if (VD->isFileVarDecl() && !isa<VarTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(VD)) 13837 MarkUnusedFileScopedDecl(VD); 13838 13839 // Now we have parsed the initializer and can update the table of magic 13840 // tag values. 13841 if (!VD->hasAttr<TypeTagForDatatypeAttr>() || 13842 !VD->getType()->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) 13843 return; 13844 13845 for (const auto *I : ThisDecl->specific_attrs<TypeTagForDatatypeAttr>()) { 13846 const Expr *MagicValueExpr = VD->getInit(); 13847 if (!MagicValueExpr) { 13848 continue; 13849 } 13850 Optional<llvm::APSInt> MagicValueInt; 13851 if (!(MagicValueInt = MagicValueExpr->getIntegerConstantExpr(Context))) { 13852 Diag(I->getRange().getBegin(), 13853 diag::err_type_tag_for_datatype_not_ice) 13854 << LangOpts.CPlusPlus << MagicValueExpr->getSourceRange(); 13855 continue; 13856 } 13857 if (MagicValueInt->getActiveBits() > 64) { 13858 Diag(I->getRange().getBegin(), 13859 diag::err_type_tag_for_datatype_too_large) 13860 << LangOpts.CPlusPlus << MagicValueExpr->getSourceRange(); 13861 continue; 13862 } 13863 uint64_t MagicValue = MagicValueInt->getZExtValue(); 13864 RegisterTypeTagForDatatype(I->getArgumentKind(), 13865 MagicValue, 13866 I->getMatchingCType(), 13867 I->getLayoutCompatible(), 13868 I->getMustBeNull()); 13869 } 13870 } 13871 13872 static bool hasDeducedAuto(DeclaratorDecl *DD) { 13873 auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(DD); 13874 return VD && !VD->getType()->hasAutoForTrailingReturnType(); 13875 } 13876 13877 Sema::DeclGroupPtrTy Sema::FinalizeDeclaratorGroup(Scope *S, const DeclSpec &DS, 13878 ArrayRef<Decl *> Group) { 13879 SmallVector<Decl*, 8> Decls; 13880 13881 if (DS.isTypeSpecOwned()) 13882 Decls.push_back(DS.getRepAsDecl()); 13883 13884 DeclaratorDecl *FirstDeclaratorInGroup = nullptr; 13885 DecompositionDecl *FirstDecompDeclaratorInGroup = nullptr; 13886 bool DiagnosedMultipleDecomps = false; 13887 DeclaratorDecl *FirstNonDeducedAutoInGroup = nullptr; 13888 bool DiagnosedNonDeducedAuto = false; 13889 13890 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Group.size(); i != e; ++i) { 13891 if (Decl *D = Group[i]) { 13892 // For declarators, there are some additional syntactic-ish checks we need 13893 // to perform. 13894 if (auto *DD = dyn_cast<DeclaratorDecl>(D)) { 13895 if (!FirstDeclaratorInGroup) 13896 FirstDeclaratorInGroup = DD; 13897 if (!FirstDecompDeclaratorInGroup) 13898 FirstDecompDeclaratorInGroup = dyn_cast<DecompositionDecl>(D); 13899 if (!FirstNonDeducedAutoInGroup && DS.hasAutoTypeSpec() && 13900 !hasDeducedAuto(DD)) 13901 FirstNonDeducedAutoInGroup = DD; 13902 13903 if (FirstDeclaratorInGroup != DD) { 13904 // A decomposition declaration cannot be combined with any other 13905 // declaration in the same group. 13906 if (FirstDecompDeclaratorInGroup && !DiagnosedMultipleDecomps) { 13907 Diag(FirstDecompDeclaratorInGroup->getLocation(), 13908 diag::err_decomp_decl_not_alone) 13909 << FirstDeclaratorInGroup->getSourceRange() 13910 << DD->getSourceRange(); 13911 DiagnosedMultipleDecomps = true; 13912 } 13913 13914 // A declarator that uses 'auto' in any way other than to declare a 13915 // variable with a deduced type cannot be combined with any other 13916 // declarator in the same group. 13917 if (FirstNonDeducedAutoInGroup && !DiagnosedNonDeducedAuto) { 13918 Diag(FirstNonDeducedAutoInGroup->getLocation(), 13919 diag::err_auto_non_deduced_not_alone) 13920 << FirstNonDeducedAutoInGroup->getType() 13921 ->hasAutoForTrailingReturnType() 13922 << FirstDeclaratorInGroup->getSourceRange() 13923 << DD->getSourceRange(); 13924 DiagnosedNonDeducedAuto = true; 13925 } 13926 } 13927 } 13928 13929 Decls.push_back(D); 13930 } 13931 } 13932 13933 if (DeclSpec::isDeclRep(DS.getTypeSpecType())) { 13934 if (TagDecl *Tag = dyn_cast_or_null<TagDecl>(DS.getRepAsDecl())) { 13935 handleTagNumbering(Tag, S); 13936 if (FirstDeclaratorInGroup && !Tag->hasNameForLinkage() && 13937 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 13938 Context.addDeclaratorForUnnamedTagDecl(Tag, FirstDeclaratorInGroup); 13939 } 13940 } 13941 13942 return BuildDeclaratorGroup(Decls); 13943 } 13944 13945 /// BuildDeclaratorGroup - convert a list of declarations into a declaration 13946 /// group, performing any necessary semantic checking. 13947 Sema::DeclGroupPtrTy 13948 Sema::BuildDeclaratorGroup(MutableArrayRef<Decl *> Group) { 13949 // C++14 [dcl.spec.auto]p7: (DR1347) 13950 // If the type that replaces the placeholder type is not the same in each 13951 // deduction, the program is ill-formed. 13952 if (Group.size() > 1) { 13953 QualType Deduced; 13954 VarDecl *DeducedDecl = nullptr; 13955 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Group.size(); i != e; ++i) { 13956 VarDecl *D = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(Group[i]); 13957 if (!D || D->isInvalidDecl()) 13958 break; 13959 DeducedType *DT = D->getType()->getContainedDeducedType(); 13960 if (!DT || DT->getDeducedType().isNull()) 13961 continue; 13962 if (Deduced.isNull()) { 13963 Deduced = DT->getDeducedType(); 13964 DeducedDecl = D; 13965 } else if (!Context.hasSameType(DT->getDeducedType(), Deduced)) { 13966 auto *AT = dyn_cast<AutoType>(DT); 13967 auto Dia = Diag(D->getTypeSourceInfo()->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), 13968 diag::err_auto_different_deductions) 13969 << (AT ? (unsigned)AT->getKeyword() : 3) << Deduced 13970 << DeducedDecl->getDeclName() << DT->getDeducedType() 13971 << D->getDeclName(); 13972 if (DeducedDecl->hasInit()) 13973 Dia << DeducedDecl->getInit()->getSourceRange(); 13974 if (D->getInit()) 13975 Dia << D->getInit()->getSourceRange(); 13976 D->setInvalidDecl(); 13977 break; 13978 } 13979 } 13980 } 13981 13982 ActOnDocumentableDecls(Group); 13983 13984 return DeclGroupPtrTy::make( 13985 DeclGroupRef::Create(Context, Group.data(), Group.size())); 13986 } 13987 13988 void Sema::ActOnDocumentableDecl(Decl *D) { 13989 ActOnDocumentableDecls(D); 13990 } 13991 13992 void Sema::ActOnDocumentableDecls(ArrayRef<Decl *> Group) { 13993 // Don't parse the comment if Doxygen diagnostics are ignored. 13994 if (Group.empty() || !Group[0]) 13995 return; 13996 13997 if (Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_doc_param_not_found, 13998 Group[0]->getLocation()) && 13999 Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_unknown_comment_command_name, 14000 Group[0]->getLocation())) 14001 return; 14002 14003 if (Group.size() >= 2) { 14004 // This is a decl group. Normally it will contain only declarations 14005 // produced from declarator list. But in case we have any definitions or 14006 // additional declaration references: 14007 // 'typedef struct S {} S;' 14008 // 'typedef struct S *S;' 14009 // 'struct S *pS;' 14010 // FinalizeDeclaratorGroup adds these as separate declarations. 14011 Decl *MaybeTagDecl = Group[0]; 14012 if (MaybeTagDecl && isa<TagDecl>(MaybeTagDecl)) { 14013 Group = Group.slice(1); 14014 } 14015 } 14016 14017 // FIMXE: We assume every Decl in the group is in the same file. 14018 // This is false when preprocessor constructs the group from decls in 14019 // different files (e. g. macros or #include). 14020 Context.attachCommentsToJustParsedDecls(Group, &getPreprocessor()); 14021 } 14022 14023 /// Common checks for a parameter-declaration that should apply to both function 14024 /// parameters and non-type template parameters. 14025 void Sema::CheckFunctionOrTemplateParamDeclarator(Scope *S, Declarator &D) { 14026 // Check that there are no default arguments inside the type of this 14027 // parameter. 14028 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 14029 CheckExtraCXXDefaultArguments(D); 14030 14031 // Parameter declarators cannot be qualified (C++ [dcl.meaning]p1). 14032 if (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet()) { 14033 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_qualified_param_declarator) 14034 << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getRange(); 14035 } 14036 14037 // [dcl.meaning]p1: An unqualified-id occurring in a declarator-id shall be a 14038 // simple identifier except [...irrelevant cases...]. 14039 switch (D.getName().getKind()) { 14040 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_Identifier: 14041 break; 14042 14043 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_OperatorFunctionId: 14044 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ConversionFunctionId: 14045 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_LiteralOperatorId: 14046 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ConstructorName: 14047 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_DestructorName: 14048 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ImplicitSelfParam: 14049 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_DeductionGuideName: 14050 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_bad_parameter_name) 14051 << GetNameForDeclarator(D).getName(); 14052 break; 14053 14054 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId: 14055 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ConstructorTemplateId: 14056 // GetNameForDeclarator would not produce a useful name in this case. 14057 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_bad_parameter_name_template_id); 14058 break; 14059 } 14060 } 14061 14062 /// ActOnParamDeclarator - Called from Parser::ParseFunctionDeclarator() 14063 /// to introduce parameters into function prototype scope. 14064 Decl *Sema::ActOnParamDeclarator(Scope *S, Declarator &D) { 14065 const DeclSpec &DS = D.getDeclSpec(); 14066 14067 // Verify C99 6.7.5.3p2: The only SCS allowed is 'register'. 14068 14069 // C++03 [dcl.stc]p2 also permits 'auto'. 14070 StorageClass SC = SC_None; 14071 if (DS.getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_register) { 14072 SC = SC_Register; 14073 // In C++11, the 'register' storage class specifier is deprecated. 14074 // In C++17, it is not allowed, but we tolerate it as an extension. 14075 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) { 14076 Diag(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc(), 14077 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 ? diag::ext_register_storage_class 14078 : diag::warn_deprecated_register) 14079 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc()); 14080 } 14081 } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 14082 DS.getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_auto) { 14083 SC = SC_Auto; 14084 } else if (DS.getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_unspecified) { 14085 Diag(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc(), 14086 diag::err_invalid_storage_class_in_func_decl); 14087 D.getMutableDeclSpec().ClearStorageClassSpecs(); 14088 } 14089 14090 if (DeclSpec::TSCS TSCS = DS.getThreadStorageClassSpec()) 14091 Diag(DS.getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(), diag::err_invalid_thread) 14092 << DeclSpec::getSpecifierName(TSCS); 14093 if (DS.isInlineSpecified()) 14094 Diag(DS.getInlineSpecLoc(), diag::err_inline_non_function) 14095 << getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17; 14096 if (DS.hasConstexprSpecifier()) 14097 Diag(DS.getConstexprSpecLoc(), diag::err_invalid_constexpr) 14098 << 0 << static_cast<int>(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecifier()); 14099 14100 DiagnoseFunctionSpecifiers(DS); 14101 14102 CheckFunctionOrTemplateParamDeclarator(S, D); 14103 14104 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = GetTypeForDeclarator(D, S); 14105 QualType parmDeclType = TInfo->getType(); 14106 14107 // Check for redeclaration of parameters, e.g. int foo(int x, int x); 14108 IdentifierInfo *II = D.getIdentifier(); 14109 if (II) { 14110 LookupResult R(*this, II, D.getIdentifierLoc(), LookupOrdinaryName, 14111 ForVisibleRedeclaration); 14112 LookupName(R, S); 14113 if (R.isSingleResult()) { 14114 NamedDecl *PrevDecl = R.getFoundDecl(); 14115 if (PrevDecl->isTemplateParameter()) { 14116 // Maybe we will complain about the shadowed template parameter. 14117 DiagnoseTemplateParameterShadow(D.getIdentifierLoc(), PrevDecl); 14118 // Just pretend that we didn't see the previous declaration. 14119 PrevDecl = nullptr; 14120 } else if (S->isDeclScope(PrevDecl)) { 14121 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_param_redefinition) << II; 14122 Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 14123 14124 // Recover by removing the name 14125 II = nullptr; 14126 D.SetIdentifier(nullptr, D.getIdentifierLoc()); 14127 D.setInvalidType(true); 14128 } 14129 } 14130 } 14131 14132 // Temporarily put parameter variables in the translation unit, not 14133 // the enclosing context. This prevents them from accidentally 14134 // looking like class members in C++. 14135 ParmVarDecl *New = 14136 CheckParameter(Context.getTranslationUnitDecl(), D.getBeginLoc(), 14137 D.getIdentifierLoc(), II, parmDeclType, TInfo, SC); 14138 14139 if (D.isInvalidType()) 14140 New->setInvalidDecl(); 14141 14142 assert(S->isFunctionPrototypeScope()); 14143 assert(S->getFunctionPrototypeDepth() >= 1); 14144 New->setScopeInfo(S->getFunctionPrototypeDepth() - 1, 14145 S->getNextFunctionPrototypeIndex()); 14146 14147 // Add the parameter declaration into this scope. 14148 S->AddDecl(New); 14149 if (II) 14150 IdResolver.AddDecl(New); 14151 14152 ProcessDeclAttributes(S, New, D); 14153 14154 if (D.getDeclSpec().isModulePrivateSpecified()) 14155 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_module_private_local) 14156 << 1 << New << SourceRange(D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc()) 14157 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc()); 14158 14159 if (New->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) { 14160 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_block_on_nonlocal); 14161 } 14162 14163 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) 14164 deduceOpenCLAddressSpace(New); 14165 14166 return New; 14167 } 14168 14169 /// Synthesizes a variable for a parameter arising from a 14170 /// typedef. 14171 ParmVarDecl *Sema::BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(DeclContext *DC, 14172 SourceLocation Loc, 14173 QualType T) { 14174 /* FIXME: setting StartLoc == Loc. 14175 Would it be worth to modify callers so as to provide proper source 14176 location for the unnamed parameters, embedding the parameter's type? */ 14177 ParmVarDecl *Param = ParmVarDecl::Create(Context, DC, Loc, Loc, nullptr, 14178 T, Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T, Loc), 14179 SC_None, nullptr); 14180 Param->setImplicit(); 14181 return Param; 14182 } 14183 14184 void Sema::DiagnoseUnusedParameters(ArrayRef<ParmVarDecl *> Parameters) { 14185 // Don't diagnose unused-parameter errors in template instantiations; we 14186 // will already have done so in the template itself. 14187 if (inTemplateInstantiation()) 14188 return; 14189 14190 for (const ParmVarDecl *Parameter : Parameters) { 14191 if (!Parameter->isReferenced() && Parameter->getDeclName() && 14192 !Parameter->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>()) { 14193 Diag(Parameter->getLocation(), diag::warn_unused_parameter) 14194 << Parameter->getDeclName(); 14195 } 14196 } 14197 } 14198 14199 void Sema::DiagnoseSizeOfParametersAndReturnValue( 14200 ArrayRef<ParmVarDecl *> Parameters, QualType ReturnTy, NamedDecl *D) { 14201 if (LangOpts.NumLargeByValueCopy == 0) // No check. 14202 return; 14203 14204 // Warn if the return value is pass-by-value and larger than the specified 14205 // threshold. 14206 if (!ReturnTy->isDependentType() && ReturnTy.isPODType(Context)) { 14207 unsigned Size = Context.getTypeSizeInChars(ReturnTy).getQuantity(); 14208 if (Size > LangOpts.NumLargeByValueCopy) 14209 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::warn_return_value_size) << D << Size; 14210 } 14211 14212 // Warn if any parameter is pass-by-value and larger than the specified 14213 // threshold. 14214 for (const ParmVarDecl *Parameter : Parameters) { 14215 QualType T = Parameter->getType(); 14216 if (T->isDependentType() || !T.isPODType(Context)) 14217 continue; 14218 unsigned Size = Context.getTypeSizeInChars(T).getQuantity(); 14219 if (Size > LangOpts.NumLargeByValueCopy) 14220 Diag(Parameter->getLocation(), diag::warn_parameter_size) 14221 << Parameter << Size; 14222 } 14223 } 14224 14225 ParmVarDecl *Sema::CheckParameter(DeclContext *DC, SourceLocation StartLoc, 14226 SourceLocation NameLoc, IdentifierInfo *Name, 14227 QualType T, TypeSourceInfo *TSInfo, 14228 StorageClass SC) { 14229 // In ARC, infer a lifetime qualifier for appropriate parameter types. 14230 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && 14231 T.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_None && 14232 T->isObjCLifetimeType()) { 14233 14234 Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime lifetime; 14235 14236 // Special cases for arrays: 14237 // - if it's const, use __unsafe_unretained 14238 // - otherwise, it's an error 14239 if (T->isArrayType()) { 14240 if (!T.isConstQualified()) { 14241 if (DelayedDiagnostics.shouldDelayDiagnostics()) 14242 DelayedDiagnostics.add( 14243 sema::DelayedDiagnostic::makeForbiddenType( 14244 NameLoc, diag::err_arc_array_param_no_ownership, T, false)); 14245 else 14246 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_arc_array_param_no_ownership) 14247 << TSInfo->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange(); 14248 } 14249 lifetime = Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone; 14250 } else { 14251 lifetime = T->getObjCARCImplicitLifetime(); 14252 } 14253 T = Context.getLifetimeQualifiedType(T, lifetime); 14254 } 14255 14256 ParmVarDecl *New = ParmVarDecl::Create(Context, DC, StartLoc, NameLoc, Name, 14257 Context.getAdjustedParameterType(T), 14258 TSInfo, SC, nullptr); 14259 14260 // Make a note if we created a new pack in the scope of a lambda, so that 14261 // we know that references to that pack must also be expanded within the 14262 // lambda scope. 14263 if (New->isParameterPack()) 14264 if (auto *LSI = getEnclosingLambda()) 14265 LSI->LocalPacks.push_back(New); 14266 14267 if (New->getType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion() || 14268 New->getType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion()) 14269 checkNonTrivialCUnion(New->getType(), New->getLocation(), 14270 NTCUC_FunctionParam, NTCUK_Destruct|NTCUK_Copy); 14271 14272 // Parameters can not be abstract class types. 14273 // For record types, this is done by the AbstractClassUsageDiagnoser once 14274 // the class has been completely parsed. 14275 if (!CurContext->isRecord() && 14276 RequireNonAbstractType(NameLoc, T, diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl, 14277 AbstractParamType)) 14278 New->setInvalidDecl(); 14279 14280 // Parameter declarators cannot be interface types. All ObjC objects are 14281 // passed by reference. 14282 if (T->isObjCObjectType()) { 14283 SourceLocation TypeEndLoc = 14284 getLocForEndOfToken(TSInfo->getTypeLoc().getEndLoc()); 14285 Diag(NameLoc, 14286 diag::err_object_cannot_be_passed_returned_by_value) << 1 << T 14287 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(TypeEndLoc, "*"); 14288 T = Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(T); 14289 New->setType(T); 14290 } 14291 14292 // ISO/IEC TR 18037 S6.7.3: "The type of an object with automatic storage 14293 // duration shall not be qualified by an address-space qualifier." 14294 // Since all parameters have automatic store duration, they can not have 14295 // an address space. 14296 if (T.getAddressSpace() != LangAS::Default && 14297 // OpenCL allows function arguments declared to be an array of a type 14298 // to be qualified with an address space. 14299 !(getLangOpts().OpenCL && 14300 (T->isArrayType() || T.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_private))) { 14301 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_arg_with_address_space); 14302 New->setInvalidDecl(); 14303 } 14304 14305 // PPC MMA non-pointer types are not allowed as function argument types. 14306 if (Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isPPC64() && 14307 CheckPPCMMAType(New->getOriginalType(), New->getLocation())) { 14308 New->setInvalidDecl(); 14309 } 14310 14311 return New; 14312 } 14313 14314 void Sema::ActOnFinishKNRParamDeclarations(Scope *S, Declarator &D, 14315 SourceLocation LocAfterDecls) { 14316 DeclaratorChunk::FunctionTypeInfo &FTI = D.getFunctionTypeInfo(); 14317 14318 // C99 6.9.1p6 "If a declarator includes an identifier list, each declaration 14319 // in the declaration list shall have at least one declarator, those 14320 // declarators shall only declare identifiers from the identifier list, and 14321 // every identifier in the identifier list shall be declared. 14322 // 14323 // C89 3.7.1p5 "If a declarator includes an identifier list, only the 14324 // identifiers it names shall be declared in the declaration list." 14325 // 14326 // This is why we only diagnose in C99 and later. Note, the other conditions 14327 // listed are checked elsewhere. 14328 if (!FTI.hasPrototype) { 14329 for (int i = FTI.NumParams; i != 0; /* decrement in loop */) { 14330 --i; 14331 if (FTI.Params[i].Param == nullptr) { 14332 if (getLangOpts().C99) { 14333 SmallString<256> Code; 14334 llvm::raw_svector_ostream(Code) 14335 << " int " << FTI.Params[i].Ident->getName() << ";\n"; 14336 Diag(FTI.Params[i].IdentLoc, diag::ext_param_not_declared) 14337 << FTI.Params[i].Ident 14338 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(LocAfterDecls, Code); 14339 } 14340 14341 // Implicitly declare the argument as type 'int' for lack of a better 14342 // type. 14343 AttributeFactory attrs; 14344 DeclSpec DS(attrs); 14345 const char* PrevSpec; // unused 14346 unsigned DiagID; // unused 14347 DS.SetTypeSpecType(DeclSpec::TST_int, FTI.Params[i].IdentLoc, PrevSpec, 14348 DiagID, Context.getPrintingPolicy()); 14349 // Use the identifier location for the type source range. 14350 DS.SetRangeStart(FTI.Params[i].IdentLoc); 14351 DS.SetRangeEnd(FTI.Params[i].IdentLoc); 14352 Declarator ParamD(DS, DeclaratorContext::KNRTypeList); 14353 ParamD.SetIdentifier(FTI.Params[i].Ident, FTI.Params[i].IdentLoc); 14354 FTI.Params[i].Param = ActOnParamDeclarator(S, ParamD); 14355 } 14356 } 14357 } 14358 } 14359 14360 Decl * 14361 Sema::ActOnStartOfFunctionDef(Scope *FnBodyScope, Declarator &D, 14362 MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParameterLists, 14363 SkipBodyInfo *SkipBody, FnBodyKind BodyKind) { 14364 assert(getCurFunctionDecl() == nullptr && "Function parsing confused"); 14365 assert(D.isFunctionDeclarator() && "Not a function declarator!"); 14366 Scope *ParentScope = FnBodyScope->getParent(); 14367 14368 // Check if we are in an `omp begin/end declare variant` scope. If we are, and 14369 // we define a non-templated function definition, we will create a declaration 14370 // instead (=BaseFD), and emit the definition with a mangled name afterwards. 14371 // The base function declaration will have the equivalent of an `omp declare 14372 // variant` annotation which specifies the mangled definition as a 14373 // specialization function under the OpenMP context defined as part of the 14374 // `omp begin declare variant`. 14375 SmallVector<FunctionDecl *, 4> Bases; 14376 if (LangOpts.OpenMP && isInOpenMPDeclareVariantScope()) 14377 ActOnStartOfFunctionDefinitionInOpenMPDeclareVariantScope( 14378 ParentScope, D, TemplateParameterLists, Bases); 14379 14380 D.setFunctionDefinitionKind(FunctionDefinitionKind::Definition); 14381 Decl *DP = HandleDeclarator(ParentScope, D, TemplateParameterLists); 14382 Decl *Dcl = ActOnStartOfFunctionDef(FnBodyScope, DP, SkipBody, BodyKind); 14383 14384 if (!Bases.empty()) 14385 ActOnFinishedFunctionDefinitionInOpenMPDeclareVariantScope(Dcl, Bases); 14386 14387 return Dcl; 14388 } 14389 14390 void Sema::ActOnFinishInlineFunctionDef(FunctionDecl *D) { 14391 Consumer.HandleInlineFunctionDefinition(D); 14392 } 14393 14394 static bool 14395 ShouldWarnAboutMissingPrototype(const FunctionDecl *FD, 14396 const FunctionDecl *&PossiblePrototype) { 14397 // Don't warn about invalid declarations. 14398 if (FD->isInvalidDecl()) 14399 return false; 14400 14401 // Or declarations that aren't global. 14402 if (!FD->isGlobal()) 14403 return false; 14404 14405 // Don't warn about C++ member functions. 14406 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)) 14407 return false; 14408 14409 // Don't warn about 'main'. 14410 if (isa<TranslationUnitDecl>(FD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext())) 14411 if (IdentifierInfo *II = FD->getIdentifier()) 14412 if (II->isStr("main") || II->isStr("efi_main")) 14413 return false; 14414 14415 // Don't warn about inline functions. 14416 if (FD->isInlined()) 14417 return false; 14418 14419 // Don't warn about function templates. 14420 if (FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()) 14421 return false; 14422 14423 // Don't warn about function template specializations. 14424 if (FD->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization()) 14425 return false; 14426 14427 // Don't warn for OpenCL kernels. 14428 if (FD->hasAttr<OpenCLKernelAttr>()) 14429 return false; 14430 14431 // Don't warn on explicitly deleted functions. 14432 if (FD->isDeleted()) 14433 return false; 14434 14435 // Don't warn on implicitly local functions (such as having local-typed 14436 // parameters). 14437 if (!FD->isExternallyVisible()) 14438 return false; 14439 14440 for (const FunctionDecl *Prev = FD->getPreviousDecl(); 14441 Prev; Prev = Prev->getPreviousDecl()) { 14442 // Ignore any declarations that occur in function or method 14443 // scope, because they aren't visible from the header. 14444 if (Prev->getLexicalDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod()) 14445 continue; 14446 14447 PossiblePrototype = Prev; 14448 return Prev->getType()->isFunctionNoProtoType(); 14449 } 14450 14451 return true; 14452 } 14453 14454 void 14455 Sema::CheckForFunctionRedefinition(FunctionDecl *FD, 14456 const FunctionDecl *EffectiveDefinition, 14457 SkipBodyInfo *SkipBody) { 14458 const FunctionDecl *Definition = EffectiveDefinition; 14459 if (!Definition && 14460 !FD->isDefined(Definition, /*CheckForPendingFriendDefinition*/ true)) 14461 return; 14462 14463 if (Definition->getFriendObjectKind() != Decl::FOK_None) { 14464 if (FunctionDecl *OrigDef = Definition->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction()) { 14465 if (FunctionDecl *OrigFD = FD->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction()) { 14466 // A merged copy of the same function, instantiated as a member of 14467 // the same class, is OK. 14468 if (declaresSameEntity(OrigFD, OrigDef) && 14469 declaresSameEntity(cast<Decl>(Definition->getLexicalDeclContext()), 14470 cast<Decl>(FD->getLexicalDeclContext()))) 14471 return; 14472 } 14473 } 14474 } 14475 14476 if (canRedefineFunction(Definition, getLangOpts())) 14477 return; 14478 14479 // Don't emit an error when this is redefinition of a typo-corrected 14480 // definition. 14481 if (TypoCorrectedFunctionDefinitions.count(Definition)) 14482 return; 14483 14484 // If we don't have a visible definition of the function, and it's inline or 14485 // a template, skip the new definition. 14486 if (SkipBody && !hasVisibleDefinition(Definition) && 14487 (Definition->getFormalLinkage() == InternalLinkage || 14488 Definition->isInlined() || 14489 Definition->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() || 14490 Definition->getNumTemplateParameterLists())) { 14491 SkipBody->ShouldSkip = true; 14492 SkipBody->Previous = const_cast<FunctionDecl*>(Definition); 14493 if (auto *TD = Definition->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()) 14494 makeMergedDefinitionVisible(TD); 14495 makeMergedDefinitionVisible(const_cast<FunctionDecl*>(Definition)); 14496 return; 14497 } 14498 14499 if (getLangOpts().GNUMode && Definition->isInlineSpecified() && 14500 Definition->getStorageClass() == SC_Extern) 14501 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition_extern_inline) 14502 << FD << getLangOpts().CPlusPlus; 14503 else 14504 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition) << FD; 14505 14506 Diag(Definition->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition); 14507 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 14508 } 14509 14510 static void RebuildLambdaScopeInfo(CXXMethodDecl *CallOperator, 14511 Sema &S) { 14512 CXXRecordDecl *const LambdaClass = CallOperator->getParent(); 14513 14514 LambdaScopeInfo *LSI = S.PushLambdaScope(); 14515 LSI->CallOperator = CallOperator; 14516 LSI->Lambda = LambdaClass; 14517 LSI->ReturnType = CallOperator->getReturnType(); 14518 const LambdaCaptureDefault LCD = LambdaClass->getLambdaCaptureDefault(); 14519 14520 if (LCD == LCD_None) 14521 LSI->ImpCaptureStyle = CapturingScopeInfo::ImpCap_None; 14522 else if (LCD == LCD_ByCopy) 14523 LSI->ImpCaptureStyle = CapturingScopeInfo::ImpCap_LambdaByval; 14524 else if (LCD == LCD_ByRef) 14525 LSI->ImpCaptureStyle = CapturingScopeInfo::ImpCap_LambdaByref; 14526 DeclarationNameInfo DNI = CallOperator->getNameInfo(); 14527 14528 LSI->IntroducerRange = DNI.getCXXOperatorNameRange(); 14529 LSI->Mutable = !CallOperator->isConst(); 14530 14531 // Add the captures to the LSI so they can be noted as already 14532 // captured within tryCaptureVar. 14533 auto I = LambdaClass->field_begin(); 14534 for (const auto &C : LambdaClass->captures()) { 14535 if (C.capturesVariable()) { 14536 VarDecl *VD = C.getCapturedVar(); 14537 if (VD->isInitCapture()) 14538 S.CurrentInstantiationScope->InstantiatedLocal(VD, VD); 14539 const bool ByRef = C.getCaptureKind() == LCK_ByRef; 14540 LSI->addCapture(VD, /*IsBlock*/false, ByRef, 14541 /*RefersToEnclosingVariableOrCapture*/true, C.getLocation(), 14542 /*EllipsisLoc*/C.isPackExpansion() 14543 ? C.getEllipsisLoc() : SourceLocation(), 14544 I->getType(), /*Invalid*/false); 14545 14546 } else if (C.capturesThis()) { 14547 LSI->addThisCapture(/*Nested*/ false, C.getLocation(), I->getType(), 14548 C.getCaptureKind() == LCK_StarThis); 14549 } else { 14550 LSI->addVLATypeCapture(C.getLocation(), I->getCapturedVLAType(), 14551 I->getType()); 14552 } 14553 ++I; 14554 } 14555 } 14556 14557 Decl *Sema::ActOnStartOfFunctionDef(Scope *FnBodyScope, Decl *D, 14558 SkipBodyInfo *SkipBody, 14559 FnBodyKind BodyKind) { 14560 if (!D) { 14561 // Parsing the function declaration failed in some way. Push on a fake scope 14562 // anyway so we can try to parse the function body. 14563 PushFunctionScope(); 14564 PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExprEvalContexts.back().Context); 14565 return D; 14566 } 14567 14568 FunctionDecl *FD = nullptr; 14569 14570 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)) 14571 FD = FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl(); 14572 else 14573 FD = cast<FunctionDecl>(D); 14574 14575 // Do not push if it is a lambda because one is already pushed when building 14576 // the lambda in ActOnStartOfLambdaDefinition(). 14577 if (!isLambdaCallOperator(FD)) 14578 PushExpressionEvaluationContext( 14579 FD->isConsteval() ? ExpressionEvaluationContext::ConstantEvaluated 14580 : ExprEvalContexts.back().Context); 14581 14582 // Check for defining attributes before the check for redefinition. 14583 if (const auto *Attr = FD->getAttr<AliasAttr>()) { 14584 Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::err_alias_is_definition) << FD << 0; 14585 FD->dropAttr<AliasAttr>(); 14586 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 14587 } 14588 if (const auto *Attr = FD->getAttr<IFuncAttr>()) { 14589 Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::err_alias_is_definition) << FD << 1; 14590 FD->dropAttr<IFuncAttr>(); 14591 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 14592 } 14593 14594 if (auto *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(FD)) { 14595 if (Ctor->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ExplicitSpecialization && 14596 Ctor->isDefaultConstructor() && 14597 Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft()) { 14598 // If this is an MS ABI dllexport default constructor, instantiate any 14599 // default arguments. 14600 InstantiateDefaultCtorDefaultArgs(Ctor); 14601 } 14602 } 14603 14604 // See if this is a redefinition. If 'will have body' (or similar) is already 14605 // set, then these checks were already performed when it was set. 14606 if (!FD->willHaveBody() && !FD->isLateTemplateParsed() && 14607 !FD->isThisDeclarationInstantiatedFromAFriendDefinition()) { 14608 CheckForFunctionRedefinition(FD, nullptr, SkipBody); 14609 14610 // If we're skipping the body, we're done. Don't enter the scope. 14611 if (SkipBody && SkipBody->ShouldSkip) 14612 return D; 14613 } 14614 14615 // Mark this function as "will have a body eventually". This lets users to 14616 // call e.g. isInlineDefinitionExternallyVisible while we're still parsing 14617 // this function. 14618 FD->setWillHaveBody(); 14619 14620 // If we are instantiating a generic lambda call operator, push 14621 // a LambdaScopeInfo onto the function stack. But use the information 14622 // that's already been calculated (ActOnLambdaExpr) to prime the current 14623 // LambdaScopeInfo. 14624 // When the template operator is being specialized, the LambdaScopeInfo, 14625 // has to be properly restored so that tryCaptureVariable doesn't try 14626 // and capture any new variables. In addition when calculating potential 14627 // captures during transformation of nested lambdas, it is necessary to 14628 // have the LSI properly restored. 14629 if (isGenericLambdaCallOperatorSpecialization(FD)) { 14630 assert(inTemplateInstantiation() && 14631 "There should be an active template instantiation on the stack " 14632 "when instantiating a generic lambda!"); 14633 RebuildLambdaScopeInfo(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D), *this); 14634 } else { 14635 // Enter a new function scope 14636 PushFunctionScope(); 14637 } 14638 14639 // Builtin functions cannot be defined. 14640 if (unsigned BuiltinID = FD->getBuiltinID()) { 14641 if (!Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID) && 14642 !Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedRuntimeFunction(BuiltinID)) { 14643 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_builtin_definition) << FD; 14644 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 14645 } 14646 } 14647 14648 // The return type of a function definition must be complete (C99 6.9.1p3), 14649 // unless the function is deleted (C++ specifc, C++ [dcl.fct.def.general]p2) 14650 QualType ResultType = FD->getReturnType(); 14651 if (!ResultType->isDependentType() && !ResultType->isVoidType() && 14652 !FD->isInvalidDecl() && BodyKind != FnBodyKind::Delete && 14653 RequireCompleteType(FD->getLocation(), ResultType, 14654 diag::err_func_def_incomplete_result)) 14655 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 14656 14657 if (FnBodyScope) 14658 PushDeclContext(FnBodyScope, FD); 14659 14660 // Check the validity of our function parameters 14661 if (BodyKind != FnBodyKind::Delete) 14662 CheckParmsForFunctionDef(FD->parameters(), 14663 /*CheckParameterNames=*/true); 14664 14665 // Add non-parameter declarations already in the function to the current 14666 // scope. 14667 if (FnBodyScope) { 14668 for (Decl *NPD : FD->decls()) { 14669 auto *NonParmDecl = dyn_cast<NamedDecl>(NPD); 14670 if (!NonParmDecl) 14671 continue; 14672 assert(!isa<ParmVarDecl>(NonParmDecl) && 14673 "parameters should not be in newly created FD yet"); 14674 14675 // If the decl has a name, make it accessible in the current scope. 14676 if (NonParmDecl->getDeclName()) 14677 PushOnScopeChains(NonParmDecl, FnBodyScope, /*AddToContext=*/false); 14678 14679 // Similarly, dive into enums and fish their constants out, making them 14680 // accessible in this scope. 14681 if (auto *ED = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(NonParmDecl)) { 14682 for (auto *EI : ED->enumerators()) 14683 PushOnScopeChains(EI, FnBodyScope, /*AddToContext=*/false); 14684 } 14685 } 14686 } 14687 14688 // Introduce our parameters into the function scope 14689 for (auto Param : FD->parameters()) { 14690 Param->setOwningFunction(FD); 14691 14692 // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack. 14693 if (Param->getIdentifier() && FnBodyScope) { 14694 CheckShadow(FnBodyScope, Param); 14695 14696 PushOnScopeChains(Param, FnBodyScope); 14697 } 14698 } 14699 14700 // Ensure that the function's exception specification is instantiated. 14701 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT = FD->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) 14702 ResolveExceptionSpec(D->getLocation(), FPT); 14703 14704 // dllimport cannot be applied to non-inline function definitions. 14705 if (FD->hasAttr<DLLImportAttr>() && !FD->isInlined() && 14706 !FD->isTemplateInstantiation()) { 14707 assert(!FD->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>()); 14708 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_dllimport_function_definition); 14709 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 14710 return D; 14711 } 14712 // We want to attach documentation to original Decl (which might be 14713 // a function template). 14714 ActOnDocumentableDecl(D); 14715 if (getCurLexicalContext()->isObjCContainer() && 14716 getCurLexicalContext()->getDeclKind() != Decl::ObjCCategoryImpl && 14717 getCurLexicalContext()->getDeclKind() != Decl::ObjCImplementation) 14718 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::warn_function_def_in_objc_container); 14719 14720 return D; 14721 } 14722 14723 /// Given the set of return statements within a function body, 14724 /// compute the variables that are subject to the named return value 14725 /// optimization. 14726 /// 14727 /// Each of the variables that is subject to the named return value 14728 /// optimization will be marked as NRVO variables in the AST, and any 14729 /// return statement that has a marked NRVO variable as its NRVO candidate can 14730 /// use the named return value optimization. 14731 /// 14732 /// This function applies a very simplistic algorithm for NRVO: if every return 14733 /// statement in the scope of a variable has the same NRVO candidate, that 14734 /// candidate is an NRVO variable. 14735 void Sema::computeNRVO(Stmt *Body, FunctionScopeInfo *Scope) { 14736 ReturnStmt **Returns = Scope->Returns.data(); 14737 14738 for (unsigned I = 0, E = Scope->Returns.size(); I != E; ++I) { 14739 if (const VarDecl *NRVOCandidate = Returns[I]->getNRVOCandidate()) { 14740 if (!NRVOCandidate->isNRVOVariable()) 14741 Returns[I]->setNRVOCandidate(nullptr); 14742 } 14743 } 14744 } 14745 14746 bool Sema::canDelayFunctionBody(const Declarator &D) { 14747 // We can't delay parsing the body of a constexpr function template (yet). 14748 if (D.getDeclSpec().hasConstexprSpecifier()) 14749 return false; 14750 14751 // We can't delay parsing the body of a function template with a deduced 14752 // return type (yet). 14753 if (D.getDeclSpec().hasAutoTypeSpec()) { 14754 // If the placeholder introduces a non-deduced trailing return type, 14755 // we can still delay parsing it. 14756 if (D.getNumTypeObjects()) { 14757 const auto &Outer = D.getTypeObject(D.getNumTypeObjects() - 1); 14758 if (Outer.Kind == DeclaratorChunk::Function && 14759 Outer.Fun.hasTrailingReturnType()) { 14760 QualType Ty = GetTypeFromParser(Outer.Fun.getTrailingReturnType()); 14761 return Ty.isNull() || !Ty->isUndeducedType(); 14762 } 14763 } 14764 return false; 14765 } 14766 14767 return true; 14768 } 14769 14770 bool Sema::canSkipFunctionBody(Decl *D) { 14771 // We cannot skip the body of a function (or function template) which is 14772 // constexpr, since we may need to evaluate its body in order to parse the 14773 // rest of the file. 14774 // We cannot skip the body of a function with an undeduced return type, 14775 // because any callers of that function need to know the type. 14776 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = D->getAsFunction()) { 14777 if (FD->isConstexpr()) 14778 return false; 14779 // We can't simply call Type::isUndeducedType here, because inside template 14780 // auto can be deduced to a dependent type, which is not considered 14781 // "undeduced". 14782 if (FD->getReturnType()->getContainedDeducedType()) 14783 return false; 14784 } 14785 return Consumer.shouldSkipFunctionBody(D); 14786 } 14787 14788 Decl *Sema::ActOnSkippedFunctionBody(Decl *Decl) { 14789 if (!Decl) 14790 return nullptr; 14791 if (FunctionDecl *FD = Decl->getAsFunction()) 14792 FD->setHasSkippedBody(); 14793 else if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(Decl)) 14794 MD->setHasSkippedBody(); 14795 return Decl; 14796 } 14797 14798 Decl *Sema::ActOnFinishFunctionBody(Decl *D, Stmt *BodyArg) { 14799 return ActOnFinishFunctionBody(D, BodyArg, false); 14800 } 14801 14802 /// RAII object that pops an ExpressionEvaluationContext when exiting a function 14803 /// body. 14804 class ExitFunctionBodyRAII { 14805 public: 14806 ExitFunctionBodyRAII(Sema &S, bool IsLambda) : S(S), IsLambda(IsLambda) {} 14807 ~ExitFunctionBodyRAII() { 14808 if (!IsLambda) 14809 S.PopExpressionEvaluationContext(); 14810 } 14811 14812 private: 14813 Sema &S; 14814 bool IsLambda = false; 14815 }; 14816 14817 static void diagnoseImplicitlyRetainedSelf(Sema &S) { 14818 llvm::DenseMap<const BlockDecl *, bool> EscapeInfo; 14819 14820 auto IsOrNestedInEscapingBlock = [&](const BlockDecl *BD) { 14821 if (EscapeInfo.count(BD)) 14822 return EscapeInfo[BD]; 14823 14824 bool R = false; 14825 const BlockDecl *CurBD = BD; 14826 14827 do { 14828 R = !CurBD->doesNotEscape(); 14829 if (R) 14830 break; 14831 CurBD = CurBD->getParent()->getInnermostBlockDecl(); 14832 } while (CurBD); 14833 14834 return EscapeInfo[BD] = R; 14835 }; 14836 14837 // If the location where 'self' is implicitly retained is inside a escaping 14838 // block, emit a diagnostic. 14839 for (const std::pair<SourceLocation, const BlockDecl *> &P : 14840 S.ImplicitlyRetainedSelfLocs) 14841 if (IsOrNestedInEscapingBlock(P.second)) 14842 S.Diag(P.first, diag::warn_implicitly_retains_self) 14843 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(P.first, "self->"); 14844 } 14845 14846 Decl *Sema::ActOnFinishFunctionBody(Decl *dcl, Stmt *Body, 14847 bool IsInstantiation) { 14848 FunctionScopeInfo *FSI = getCurFunction(); 14849 FunctionDecl *FD = dcl ? dcl->getAsFunction() : nullptr; 14850 14851 if (FSI->UsesFPIntrin && FD && !FD->hasAttr<StrictFPAttr>()) 14852 FD->addAttr(StrictFPAttr::CreateImplicit(Context)); 14853 14854 sema::AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy WP = AnalysisWarnings.getDefaultPolicy(); 14855 sema::AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy *ActivePolicy = nullptr; 14856 14857 if (getLangOpts().Coroutines && FSI->isCoroutine()) 14858 CheckCompletedCoroutineBody(FD, Body); 14859 14860 { 14861 // Do not call PopExpressionEvaluationContext() if it is a lambda because 14862 // one is already popped when finishing the lambda in BuildLambdaExpr(). 14863 // This is meant to pop the context added in ActOnStartOfFunctionDef(). 14864 ExitFunctionBodyRAII ExitRAII(*this, isLambdaCallOperator(FD)); 14865 14866 if (FD) { 14867 FD->setBody(Body); 14868 FD->setWillHaveBody(false); 14869 14870 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14) { 14871 if (!FD->isInvalidDecl() && Body && !FD->isDependentContext() && 14872 FD->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType()) { 14873 // For a function with a deduced result type to return void, 14874 // the result type as written must be 'auto' or 'decltype(auto)', 14875 // possibly cv-qualified or constrained, but not ref-qualified. 14876 if (!FD->getReturnType()->getAs<AutoType>()) { 14877 Diag(dcl->getLocation(), diag::err_auto_fn_no_return_but_not_auto) 14878 << FD->getReturnType(); 14879 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 14880 } else { 14881 // Falling off the end of the function is the same as 'return;'. 14882 Expr *Dummy = nullptr; 14883 if (DeduceFunctionTypeFromReturnExpr( 14884 FD, dcl->getLocation(), Dummy, 14885 FD->getReturnType()->getAs<AutoType>())) 14886 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 14887 } 14888 } 14889 } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && isLambdaCallOperator(FD)) { 14890 // In C++11, we don't use 'auto' deduction rules for lambda call 14891 // operators because we don't support return type deduction. 14892 auto *LSI = getCurLambda(); 14893 if (LSI->HasImplicitReturnType) { 14894 deduceClosureReturnType(*LSI); 14895 14896 // C++11 [expr.prim.lambda]p4: 14897 // [...] if there are no return statements in the compound-statement 14898 // [the deduced type is] the type void 14899 QualType RetType = 14900 LSI->ReturnType.isNull() ? Context.VoidTy : LSI->ReturnType; 14901 14902 // Update the return type to the deduced type. 14903 const auto *Proto = FD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 14904 FD->setType(Context.getFunctionType(RetType, Proto->getParamTypes(), 14905 Proto->getExtProtoInfo())); 14906 } 14907 } 14908 14909 // If the function implicitly returns zero (like 'main') or is naked, 14910 // don't complain about missing return statements. 14911 if (FD->hasImplicitReturnZero() || FD->hasAttr<NakedAttr>()) 14912 WP.disableCheckFallThrough(); 14913 14914 // MSVC permits the use of pure specifier (=0) on function definition, 14915 // defined at class scope, warn about this non-standard construct. 14916 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt && FD->isPure() && !FD->isOutOfLine()) 14917 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::ext_pure_function_definition); 14918 14919 if (!FD->isInvalidDecl()) { 14920 // Don't diagnose unused parameters of defaulted, deleted or naked 14921 // functions. 14922 if (!FD->isDeleted() && !FD->isDefaulted() && !FD->hasSkippedBody() && 14923 !FD->hasAttr<NakedAttr>()) 14924 DiagnoseUnusedParameters(FD->parameters()); 14925 DiagnoseSizeOfParametersAndReturnValue(FD->parameters(), 14926 FD->getReturnType(), FD); 14927 14928 // If this is a structor, we need a vtable. 14929 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(FD)) 14930 MarkVTableUsed(FD->getLocation(), Constructor->getParent()); 14931 else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = 14932 dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(FD)) 14933 MarkVTableUsed(FD->getLocation(), Destructor->getParent()); 14934 14935 // Try to apply the named return value optimization. We have to check 14936 // if we can do this here because lambdas keep return statements around 14937 // to deduce an implicit return type. 14938 if (FD->getReturnType()->isRecordType() && 14939 (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || !FD->isDependentContext())) 14940 computeNRVO(Body, FSI); 14941 } 14942 14943 // GNU warning -Wmissing-prototypes: 14944 // Warn if a global function is defined without a previous 14945 // prototype declaration. This warning is issued even if the 14946 // definition itself provides a prototype. The aim is to detect 14947 // global functions that fail to be declared in header files. 14948 const FunctionDecl *PossiblePrototype = nullptr; 14949 if (ShouldWarnAboutMissingPrototype(FD, PossiblePrototype)) { 14950 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::warn_missing_prototype) << FD; 14951 14952 if (PossiblePrototype) { 14953 // We found a declaration that is not a prototype, 14954 // but that could be a zero-parameter prototype 14955 if (TypeSourceInfo *TI = PossiblePrototype->getTypeSourceInfo()) { 14956 TypeLoc TL = TI->getTypeLoc(); 14957 if (FunctionNoProtoTypeLoc FTL = TL.getAs<FunctionNoProtoTypeLoc>()) 14958 Diag(PossiblePrototype->getLocation(), 14959 diag::note_declaration_not_a_prototype) 14960 << (FD->getNumParams() != 0) 14961 << (FD->getNumParams() == 0 ? FixItHint::CreateInsertion( 14962 FTL.getRParenLoc(), "void") 14963 : FixItHint{}); 14964 } 14965 } else { 14966 // Returns true if the token beginning at this Loc is `const`. 14967 auto isLocAtConst = [&](SourceLocation Loc, const SourceManager &SM, 14968 const LangOptions &LangOpts) { 14969 std::pair<FileID, unsigned> LocInfo = SM.getDecomposedLoc(Loc); 14970 if (LocInfo.first.isInvalid()) 14971 return false; 14972 14973 bool Invalid = false; 14974 StringRef Buffer = SM.getBufferData(LocInfo.first, &Invalid); 14975 if (Invalid) 14976 return false; 14977 14978 if (LocInfo.second > Buffer.size()) 14979 return false; 14980 14981 const char *LexStart = Buffer.data() + LocInfo.second; 14982 StringRef StartTok(LexStart, Buffer.size() - LocInfo.second); 14983 14984 return StartTok.consume_front("const") && 14985 (StartTok.empty() || isWhitespace(StartTok[0]) || 14986 StartTok.startswith("/*") || StartTok.startswith("//")); 14987 }; 14988 14989 auto findBeginLoc = [&]() { 14990 // If the return type has `const` qualifier, we want to insert 14991 // `static` before `const` (and not before the typename). 14992 if ((FD->getReturnType()->isAnyPointerType() && 14993 FD->getReturnType()->getPointeeType().isConstQualified()) || 14994 FD->getReturnType().isConstQualified()) { 14995 // But only do this if we can determine where the `const` is. 14996 14997 if (isLocAtConst(FD->getBeginLoc(), getSourceManager(), 14998 getLangOpts())) 14999 15000 return FD->getBeginLoc(); 15001 } 15002 return FD->getTypeSpecStartLoc(); 15003 }; 15004 Diag(FD->getTypeSpecStartLoc(), 15005 diag::note_static_for_internal_linkage) 15006 << /* function */ 1 15007 << (FD->getStorageClass() == SC_None 15008 ? FixItHint::CreateInsertion(findBeginLoc(), "static ") 15009 : FixItHint{}); 15010 } 15011 } 15012 15013 // If the function being defined does not have a prototype, then we may 15014 // need to diagnose it as changing behavior in C2x because we now know 15015 // whether the function accepts arguments or not. This only handles the 15016 // case where the definition has no prototype but does have parameters 15017 // and either there is no previous potential prototype, or the previous 15018 // potential prototype also has no actual prototype. This handles cases 15019 // like: 15020 // void f(); void f(a) int a; {} 15021 // void g(a) int a; {} 15022 // See MergeFunctionDecl() for other cases of the behavior change 15023 // diagnostic. See GetFullTypeForDeclarator() for handling of a function 15024 // type without a prototype. 15025 if (!FD->hasWrittenPrototype() && FD->getNumParams() != 0 && 15026 (!PossiblePrototype || (!PossiblePrototype->hasWrittenPrototype() && 15027 !PossiblePrototype->isImplicit()))) { 15028 // The function definition has parameters, so this will change behavior 15029 // in C2x. If there is a possible prototype, it comes before the 15030 // function definition. 15031 // FIXME: The declaration may have already been diagnosed as being 15032 // deprecated in GetFullTypeForDeclarator() if it had no arguments, but 15033 // there's no way to test for the "changes behavior" condition in 15034 // SemaType.cpp when forming the declaration's function type. So, we do 15035 // this awkward dance instead. 15036 // 15037 // If we have a possible prototype and it declares a function with a 15038 // prototype, we don't want to diagnose it; if we have a possible 15039 // prototype and it has no prototype, it may have already been 15040 // diagnosed in SemaType.cpp as deprecated depending on whether 15041 // -Wstrict-prototypes is enabled. If we already warned about it being 15042 // deprecated, add a note that it also changes behavior. If we didn't 15043 // warn about it being deprecated (because the diagnostic is not 15044 // enabled), warn now that it is deprecated and changes behavior. 15045 bool AddNote = false; 15046 if (PossiblePrototype) { 15047 if (Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_strict_prototypes, 15048 PossiblePrototype->getLocation())) { 15049 15050 PartialDiagnostic PD = 15051 PDiag(diag::warn_non_prototype_changes_behavior); 15052 if (TypeSourceInfo *TSI = PossiblePrototype->getTypeSourceInfo()) { 15053 if (auto FTL = TSI->getTypeLoc().getAs<FunctionNoProtoTypeLoc>()) 15054 PD << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FTL.getRParenLoc(), "void"); 15055 } 15056 Diag(PossiblePrototype->getLocation(), PD); 15057 } else { 15058 AddNote = true; 15059 } 15060 } 15061 15062 // Because this function definition has no prototype and it has 15063 // parameters, it will definitely change behavior in C2x. 15064 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::warn_non_prototype_changes_behavior); 15065 if (AddNote) 15066 Diag(PossiblePrototype->getLocation(), 15067 diag::note_func_decl_changes_behavior); 15068 } 15069 15070 // Warn on CPUDispatch with an actual body. 15071 if (FD->isMultiVersion() && FD->hasAttr<CPUDispatchAttr>() && Body) 15072 if (const auto *CmpndBody = dyn_cast<CompoundStmt>(Body)) 15073 if (!CmpndBody->body_empty()) 15074 Diag(CmpndBody->body_front()->getBeginLoc(), 15075 diag::warn_dispatch_body_ignored); 15076 15077 if (auto *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)) { 15078 const CXXMethodDecl *KeyFunction; 15079 if (MD->isOutOfLine() && (MD = MD->getCanonicalDecl()) && 15080 MD->isVirtual() && 15081 (KeyFunction = Context.getCurrentKeyFunction(MD->getParent())) && 15082 MD == KeyFunction->getCanonicalDecl()) { 15083 // Update the key-function state if necessary for this ABI. 15084 if (FD->isInlined() && 15085 !Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().canKeyFunctionBeInline()) { 15086 Context.setNonKeyFunction(MD); 15087 15088 // If the newly-chosen key function is already defined, then we 15089 // need to mark the vtable as used retroactively. 15090 KeyFunction = Context.getCurrentKeyFunction(MD->getParent()); 15091 const FunctionDecl *Definition; 15092 if (KeyFunction && KeyFunction->isDefined(Definition)) 15093 MarkVTableUsed(Definition->getLocation(), MD->getParent(), true); 15094 } else { 15095 // We just defined they key function; mark the vtable as used. 15096 MarkVTableUsed(FD->getLocation(), MD->getParent(), true); 15097 } 15098 } 15099 } 15100 15101 assert( 15102 (FD == getCurFunctionDecl() || getCurLambda()->CallOperator == FD) && 15103 "Function parsing confused"); 15104 } else if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast_or_null<ObjCMethodDecl>(dcl)) { 15105 assert(MD == getCurMethodDecl() && "Method parsing confused"); 15106 MD->setBody(Body); 15107 if (!MD->isInvalidDecl()) { 15108 DiagnoseSizeOfParametersAndReturnValue(MD->parameters(), 15109 MD->getReturnType(), MD); 15110 15111 if (Body) 15112 computeNRVO(Body, FSI); 15113 } 15114 if (FSI->ObjCShouldCallSuper) { 15115 Diag(MD->getEndLoc(), diag::warn_objc_missing_super_call) 15116 << MD->getSelector().getAsString(); 15117 FSI->ObjCShouldCallSuper = false; 15118 } 15119 if (FSI->ObjCWarnForNoDesignatedInitChain) { 15120 const ObjCMethodDecl *InitMethod = nullptr; 15121 bool isDesignated = 15122 MD->isDesignatedInitializerForTheInterface(&InitMethod); 15123 assert(isDesignated && InitMethod); 15124 (void)isDesignated; 15125 15126 auto superIsNSObject = [&](const ObjCMethodDecl *MD) { 15127 auto IFace = MD->getClassInterface(); 15128 if (!IFace) 15129 return false; 15130 auto SuperD = IFace->getSuperClass(); 15131 if (!SuperD) 15132 return false; 15133 return SuperD->getIdentifier() == 15134 NSAPIObj->getNSClassId(NSAPI::ClassId_NSObject); 15135 }; 15136 // Don't issue this warning for unavailable inits or direct subclasses 15137 // of NSObject. 15138 if (!MD->isUnavailable() && !superIsNSObject(MD)) { 15139 Diag(MD->getLocation(), 15140 diag::warn_objc_designated_init_missing_super_call); 15141 Diag(InitMethod->getLocation(), 15142 diag::note_objc_designated_init_marked_here); 15143 } 15144 FSI->ObjCWarnForNoDesignatedInitChain = false; 15145 } 15146 if (FSI->ObjCWarnForNoInitDelegation) { 15147 // Don't issue this warning for unavaialable inits. 15148 if (!MD->isUnavailable()) 15149 Diag(MD->getLocation(), 15150 diag::warn_objc_secondary_init_missing_init_call); 15151 FSI->ObjCWarnForNoInitDelegation = false; 15152 } 15153 15154 diagnoseImplicitlyRetainedSelf(*this); 15155 } else { 15156 // Parsing the function declaration failed in some way. Pop the fake scope 15157 // we pushed on. 15158 PopFunctionScopeInfo(ActivePolicy, dcl); 15159 return nullptr; 15160 } 15161 15162 if (Body && FSI->HasPotentialAvailabilityViolations) 15163 DiagnoseUnguardedAvailabilityViolations(dcl); 15164 15165 assert(!FSI->ObjCShouldCallSuper && 15166 "This should only be set for ObjC methods, which should have been " 15167 "handled in the block above."); 15168 15169 // Verify and clean out per-function state. 15170 if (Body && (!FD || !FD->isDefaulted())) { 15171 // C++ constructors that have function-try-blocks can't have return 15172 // statements in the handlers of that block. (C++ [except.handle]p14) 15173 // Verify this. 15174 if (FD && isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(FD) && isa<CXXTryStmt>(Body)) 15175 DiagnoseReturnInConstructorExceptionHandler(cast<CXXTryStmt>(Body)); 15176 15177 // Verify that gotos and switch cases don't jump into scopes illegally. 15178 if (FSI->NeedsScopeChecking() && !PP.isCodeCompletionEnabled()) 15179 DiagnoseInvalidJumps(Body); 15180 15181 if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(dcl)) { 15182 if (!Destructor->getParent()->isDependentType()) 15183 CheckDestructor(Destructor); 15184 15185 MarkBaseAndMemberDestructorsReferenced(Destructor->getLocation(), 15186 Destructor->getParent()); 15187 } 15188 15189 // If any errors have occurred, clear out any temporaries that may have 15190 // been leftover. This ensures that these temporaries won't be picked up 15191 // for deletion in some later function. 15192 if (hasUncompilableErrorOccurred() || 15193 getDiagnostics().getSuppressAllDiagnostics()) { 15194 DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext(); 15195 } 15196 if (!hasUncompilableErrorOccurred() && !isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(dcl)) { 15197 // Since the body is valid, issue any analysis-based warnings that are 15198 // enabled. 15199 ActivePolicy = &WP; 15200 } 15201 15202 if (!IsInstantiation && FD && FD->isConstexpr() && !FD->isInvalidDecl() && 15203 !CheckConstexprFunctionDefinition(FD, CheckConstexprKind::Diagnose)) 15204 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 15205 15206 if (FD && FD->hasAttr<NakedAttr>()) { 15207 for (const Stmt *S : Body->children()) { 15208 // Allow local register variables without initializer as they don't 15209 // require prologue. 15210 bool RegisterVariables = false; 15211 if (auto *DS = dyn_cast<DeclStmt>(S)) { 15212 for (const auto *Decl : DS->decls()) { 15213 if (const auto *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(Decl)) { 15214 RegisterVariables = 15215 Var->hasAttr<AsmLabelAttr>() && !Var->hasInit(); 15216 if (!RegisterVariables) 15217 break; 15218 } 15219 } 15220 } 15221 if (RegisterVariables) 15222 continue; 15223 if (!isa<AsmStmt>(S) && !isa<NullStmt>(S)) { 15224 Diag(S->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_non_asm_stmt_in_naked_function); 15225 Diag(FD->getAttr<NakedAttr>()->getLocation(), diag::note_attribute); 15226 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 15227 break; 15228 } 15229 } 15230 } 15231 15232 assert(ExprCleanupObjects.size() == 15233 ExprEvalContexts.back().NumCleanupObjects && 15234 "Leftover temporaries in function"); 15235 assert(!Cleanup.exprNeedsCleanups() && 15236 "Unaccounted cleanups in function"); 15237 assert(MaybeODRUseExprs.empty() && 15238 "Leftover expressions for odr-use checking"); 15239 } 15240 } // Pops the ExitFunctionBodyRAII scope, which needs to happen before we pop 15241 // the declaration context below. Otherwise, we're unable to transform 15242 // 'this' expressions when transforming immediate context functions. 15243 15244 if (!IsInstantiation) 15245 PopDeclContext(); 15246 15247 PopFunctionScopeInfo(ActivePolicy, dcl); 15248 // If any errors have occurred, clear out any temporaries that may have 15249 // been leftover. This ensures that these temporaries won't be picked up for 15250 // deletion in some later function. 15251 if (hasUncompilableErrorOccurred()) { 15252 DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext(); 15253 } 15254 15255 if (FD && ((LangOpts.OpenMP && (LangOpts.OpenMPIsDevice || 15256 !LangOpts.OMPTargetTriples.empty())) || 15257 LangOpts.CUDA || LangOpts.SYCLIsDevice)) { 15258 auto ES = getEmissionStatus(FD); 15259 if (ES == Sema::FunctionEmissionStatus::Emitted || 15260 ES == Sema::FunctionEmissionStatus::Unknown) 15261 DeclsToCheckForDeferredDiags.insert(FD); 15262 } 15263 15264 if (FD && !FD->isDeleted()) 15265 checkTypeSupport(FD->getType(), FD->getLocation(), FD); 15266 15267 return dcl; 15268 } 15269 15270 /// When we finish delayed parsing of an attribute, we must attach it to the 15271 /// relevant Decl. 15272 void Sema::ActOnFinishDelayedAttribute(Scope *S, Decl *D, 15273 ParsedAttributes &Attrs) { 15274 // Always attach attributes to the underlying decl. 15275 if (TemplateDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(D)) 15276 D = TD->getTemplatedDecl(); 15277 ProcessDeclAttributeList(S, D, Attrs); 15278 15279 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) 15280 if (Method->isStatic()) 15281 checkThisInStaticMemberFunctionAttributes(Method); 15282 } 15283 15284 /// ImplicitlyDefineFunction - An undeclared identifier was used in a function 15285 /// call, forming a call to an implicitly defined function (per C99 6.5.1p2). 15286 NamedDecl *Sema::ImplicitlyDefineFunction(SourceLocation Loc, 15287 IdentifierInfo &II, Scope *S) { 15288 // It is not valid to implicitly define a function in C2x. 15289 assert(LangOpts.implicitFunctionsAllowed() && 15290 "Implicit function declarations aren't allowed in this language mode"); 15291 15292 // Find the scope in which the identifier is injected and the corresponding 15293 // DeclContext. 15294 // FIXME: C89 does not say what happens if there is no enclosing block scope. 15295 // In that case, we inject the declaration into the translation unit scope 15296 // instead. 15297 Scope *BlockScope = S; 15298 while (!BlockScope->isCompoundStmtScope() && BlockScope->getParent()) 15299 BlockScope = BlockScope->getParent(); 15300 15301 Scope *ContextScope = BlockScope; 15302 while (!ContextScope->getEntity()) 15303 ContextScope = ContextScope->getParent(); 15304 ContextRAII SavedContext(*this, ContextScope->getEntity()); 15305 15306 // Before we produce a declaration for an implicitly defined 15307 // function, see whether there was a locally-scoped declaration of 15308 // this name as a function or variable. If so, use that 15309 // (non-visible) declaration, and complain about it. 15310 NamedDecl *ExternCPrev = findLocallyScopedExternCDecl(&II); 15311 if (ExternCPrev) { 15312 // We still need to inject the function into the enclosing block scope so 15313 // that later (non-call) uses can see it. 15314 PushOnScopeChains(ExternCPrev, BlockScope, /*AddToContext*/false); 15315 15316 // C89 footnote 38: 15317 // If in fact it is not defined as having type "function returning int", 15318 // the behavior is undefined. 15319 if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(ExternCPrev) || 15320 !Context.typesAreCompatible( 15321 cast<FunctionDecl>(ExternCPrev)->getType(), 15322 Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(Context.IntTy))) { 15323 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_use_out_of_scope_declaration) 15324 << ExternCPrev << !getLangOpts().C99; 15325 Diag(ExternCPrev->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 15326 return ExternCPrev; 15327 } 15328 } 15329 15330 // Extension in C99 (defaults to error). Legal in C89, but warn about it. 15331 unsigned diag_id; 15332 if (II.getName().startswith("__builtin_")) 15333 diag_id = diag::warn_builtin_unknown; 15334 // OpenCL v2.0 s6.9.u - Implicit function declaration is not supported. 15335 else if (getLangOpts().C99) 15336 diag_id = diag::ext_implicit_function_decl_c99; 15337 else 15338 diag_id = diag::warn_implicit_function_decl; 15339 15340 TypoCorrection Corrected; 15341 // Because typo correction is expensive, only do it if the implicit 15342 // function declaration is going to be treated as an error. 15343 // 15344 // Perform the corection before issuing the main diagnostic, as some consumers 15345 // use typo-correction callbacks to enhance the main diagnostic. 15346 if (S && !ExternCPrev && 15347 (Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag_id, Loc) >= DiagnosticsEngine::Error)) { 15348 DeclFilterCCC<FunctionDecl> CCC{}; 15349 Corrected = CorrectTypo(DeclarationNameInfo(&II, Loc), LookupOrdinaryName, 15350 S, nullptr, CCC, CTK_NonError); 15351 } 15352 15353 Diag(Loc, diag_id) << &II; 15354 if (Corrected) { 15355 // If the correction is going to suggest an implicitly defined function, 15356 // skip the correction as not being a particularly good idea. 15357 bool Diagnose = true; 15358 if (const auto *D = Corrected.getCorrectionDecl()) 15359 Diagnose = !D->isImplicit(); 15360 if (Diagnose) 15361 diagnoseTypo(Corrected, PDiag(diag::note_function_suggestion), 15362 /*ErrorRecovery*/ false); 15363 } 15364 15365 // If we found a prior declaration of this function, don't bother building 15366 // another one. We've already pushed that one into scope, so there's nothing 15367 // more to do. 15368 if (ExternCPrev) 15369 return ExternCPrev; 15370 15371 // Set a Declarator for the implicit definition: int foo(); 15372 const char *Dummy; 15373 AttributeFactory attrFactory; 15374 DeclSpec DS(attrFactory); 15375 unsigned DiagID; 15376 bool Error = DS.SetTypeSpecType(DeclSpec::TST_int, Loc, Dummy, DiagID, 15377 Context.getPrintingPolicy()); 15378 (void)Error; // Silence warning. 15379 assert(!Error && "Error setting up implicit decl!"); 15380 SourceLocation NoLoc; 15381 Declarator D(DS, DeclaratorContext::Block); 15382 D.AddTypeInfo(DeclaratorChunk::getFunction(/*HasProto=*/false, 15383 /*IsAmbiguous=*/false, 15384 /*LParenLoc=*/NoLoc, 15385 /*Params=*/nullptr, 15386 /*NumParams=*/0, 15387 /*EllipsisLoc=*/NoLoc, 15388 /*RParenLoc=*/NoLoc, 15389 /*RefQualifierIsLvalueRef=*/true, 15390 /*RefQualifierLoc=*/NoLoc, 15391 /*MutableLoc=*/NoLoc, EST_None, 15392 /*ESpecRange=*/SourceRange(), 15393 /*Exceptions=*/nullptr, 15394 /*ExceptionRanges=*/nullptr, 15395 /*NumExceptions=*/0, 15396 /*NoexceptExpr=*/nullptr, 15397 /*ExceptionSpecTokens=*/nullptr, 15398 /*DeclsInPrototype=*/None, Loc, 15399 Loc, D), 15400 std::move(DS.getAttributes()), SourceLocation()); 15401 D.SetIdentifier(&II, Loc); 15402 15403 // Insert this function into the enclosing block scope. 15404 FunctionDecl *FD = cast<FunctionDecl>(ActOnDeclarator(BlockScope, D)); 15405 FD->setImplicit(); 15406 15407 AddKnownFunctionAttributes(FD); 15408 15409 return FD; 15410 } 15411 15412 /// If this function is a C++ replaceable global allocation function 15413 /// (C++2a [basic.stc.dynamic.allocation], C++2a [new.delete]), 15414 /// adds any function attributes that we know a priori based on the standard. 15415 /// 15416 /// We need to check for duplicate attributes both here and where user-written 15417 /// attributes are applied to declarations. 15418 void Sema::AddKnownFunctionAttributesForReplaceableGlobalAllocationFunction( 15419 FunctionDecl *FD) { 15420 if (FD->isInvalidDecl()) 15421 return; 15422 15423 if (FD->getDeclName().getCXXOverloadedOperator() != OO_New && 15424 FD->getDeclName().getCXXOverloadedOperator() != OO_Array_New) 15425 return; 15426 15427 Optional<unsigned> AlignmentParam; 15428 bool IsNothrow = false; 15429 if (!FD->isReplaceableGlobalAllocationFunction(&AlignmentParam, &IsNothrow)) 15430 return; 15431 15432 // C++2a [basic.stc.dynamic.allocation]p4: 15433 // An allocation function that has a non-throwing exception specification 15434 // indicates failure by returning a null pointer value. Any other allocation 15435 // function never returns a null pointer value and indicates failure only by 15436 // throwing an exception [...] 15437 if (!IsNothrow && !FD->hasAttr<ReturnsNonNullAttr>()) 15438 FD->addAttr(ReturnsNonNullAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation())); 15439 15440 // C++2a [basic.stc.dynamic.allocation]p2: 15441 // An allocation function attempts to allocate the requested amount of 15442 // storage. [...] If the request succeeds, the value returned by a 15443 // replaceable allocation function is a [...] pointer value p0 different 15444 // from any previously returned value p1 [...] 15445 // 15446 // However, this particular information is being added in codegen, 15447 // because there is an opt-out switch for it (-fno-assume-sane-operator-new) 15448 15449 // C++2a [basic.stc.dynamic.allocation]p2: 15450 // An allocation function attempts to allocate the requested amount of 15451 // storage. If it is successful, it returns the address of the start of a 15452 // block of storage whose length in bytes is at least as large as the 15453 // requested size. 15454 if (!FD->hasAttr<AllocSizeAttr>()) { 15455 FD->addAttr(AllocSizeAttr::CreateImplicit( 15456 Context, /*ElemSizeParam=*/ParamIdx(1, FD), 15457 /*NumElemsParam=*/ParamIdx(), FD->getLocation())); 15458 } 15459 15460 // C++2a [basic.stc.dynamic.allocation]p3: 15461 // For an allocation function [...], the pointer returned on a successful 15462 // call shall represent the address of storage that is aligned as follows: 15463 // (3.1) If the allocation function takes an argument of type 15464 // std::align_val_t, the storage will have the alignment 15465 // specified by the value of this argument. 15466 if (AlignmentParam.hasValue() && !FD->hasAttr<AllocAlignAttr>()) { 15467 FD->addAttr(AllocAlignAttr::CreateImplicit( 15468 Context, ParamIdx(AlignmentParam.getValue(), FD), FD->getLocation())); 15469 } 15470 15471 // FIXME: 15472 // C++2a [basic.stc.dynamic.allocation]p3: 15473 // For an allocation function [...], the pointer returned on a successful 15474 // call shall represent the address of storage that is aligned as follows: 15475 // (3.2) Otherwise, if the allocation function is named operator new[], 15476 // the storage is aligned for any object that does not have 15477 // new-extended alignment ([basic.align]) and is no larger than the 15478 // requested size. 15479 // (3.3) Otherwise, the storage is aligned for any object that does not 15480 // have new-extended alignment and is of the requested size. 15481 } 15482 15483 /// Adds any function attributes that we know a priori based on 15484 /// the declaration of this function. 15485 /// 15486 /// These attributes can apply both to implicitly-declared builtins 15487 /// (like __builtin___printf_chk) or to library-declared functions 15488 /// like NSLog or printf. 15489 /// 15490 /// We need to check for duplicate attributes both here and where user-written 15491 /// attributes are applied to declarations. 15492 void Sema::AddKnownFunctionAttributes(FunctionDecl *FD) { 15493 if (FD->isInvalidDecl()) 15494 return; 15495 15496 // If this is a built-in function, map its builtin attributes to 15497 // actual attributes. 15498 if (unsigned BuiltinID = FD->getBuiltinID()) { 15499 // Handle printf-formatting attributes. 15500 unsigned FormatIdx; 15501 bool HasVAListArg; 15502 if (Context.BuiltinInfo.isPrintfLike(BuiltinID, FormatIdx, HasVAListArg)) { 15503 if (!FD->hasAttr<FormatAttr>()) { 15504 const char *fmt = "printf"; 15505 unsigned int NumParams = FD->getNumParams(); 15506 if (FormatIdx < NumParams && // NumParams may be 0 (e.g. vfprintf) 15507 FD->getParamDecl(FormatIdx)->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) 15508 fmt = "NSString"; 15509 FD->addAttr(FormatAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, 15510 &Context.Idents.get(fmt), 15511 FormatIdx+1, 15512 HasVAListArg ? 0 : FormatIdx+2, 15513 FD->getLocation())); 15514 } 15515 } 15516 if (Context.BuiltinInfo.isScanfLike(BuiltinID, FormatIdx, 15517 HasVAListArg)) { 15518 if (!FD->hasAttr<FormatAttr>()) 15519 FD->addAttr(FormatAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, 15520 &Context.Idents.get("scanf"), 15521 FormatIdx+1, 15522 HasVAListArg ? 0 : FormatIdx+2, 15523 FD->getLocation())); 15524 } 15525 15526 // Handle automatically recognized callbacks. 15527 SmallVector<int, 4> Encoding; 15528 if (!FD->hasAttr<CallbackAttr>() && 15529 Context.BuiltinInfo.performsCallback(BuiltinID, Encoding)) 15530 FD->addAttr(CallbackAttr::CreateImplicit( 15531 Context, Encoding.data(), Encoding.size(), FD->getLocation())); 15532 15533 // Mark const if we don't care about errno and that is the only thing 15534 // preventing the function from being const. This allows IRgen to use LLVM 15535 // intrinsics for such functions. 15536 if (!getLangOpts().MathErrno && !FD->hasAttr<ConstAttr>() && 15537 Context.BuiltinInfo.isConstWithoutErrno(BuiltinID)) 15538 FD->addAttr(ConstAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation())); 15539 15540 // We make "fma" on GNU or Windows const because we know it does not set 15541 // errno in those environments even though it could set errno based on the 15542 // C standard. 15543 const llvm::Triple &Trip = Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple(); 15544 if ((Trip.isGNUEnvironment() || Trip.isOSMSVCRT()) && 15545 !FD->hasAttr<ConstAttr>()) { 15546 switch (BuiltinID) { 15547 case Builtin::BI__builtin_fma: 15548 case Builtin::BI__builtin_fmaf: 15549 case Builtin::BI__builtin_fmal: 15550 case Builtin::BIfma: 15551 case Builtin::BIfmaf: 15552 case Builtin::BIfmal: 15553 FD->addAttr(ConstAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation())); 15554 break; 15555 default: 15556 break; 15557 } 15558 } 15559 15560 if (Context.BuiltinInfo.isReturnsTwice(BuiltinID) && 15561 !FD->hasAttr<ReturnsTwiceAttr>()) 15562 FD->addAttr(ReturnsTwiceAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, 15563 FD->getLocation())); 15564 if (Context.BuiltinInfo.isNoThrow(BuiltinID) && !FD->hasAttr<NoThrowAttr>()) 15565 FD->addAttr(NoThrowAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation())); 15566 if (Context.BuiltinInfo.isPure(BuiltinID) && !FD->hasAttr<PureAttr>()) 15567 FD->addAttr(PureAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation())); 15568 if (Context.BuiltinInfo.isConst(BuiltinID) && !FD->hasAttr<ConstAttr>()) 15569 FD->addAttr(ConstAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation())); 15570 if (getLangOpts().CUDA && Context.BuiltinInfo.isTSBuiltin(BuiltinID) && 15571 !FD->hasAttr<CUDADeviceAttr>() && !FD->hasAttr<CUDAHostAttr>()) { 15572 // Add the appropriate attribute, depending on the CUDA compilation mode 15573 // and which target the builtin belongs to. For example, during host 15574 // compilation, aux builtins are __device__, while the rest are __host__. 15575 if (getLangOpts().CUDAIsDevice != 15576 Context.BuiltinInfo.isAuxBuiltinID(BuiltinID)) 15577 FD->addAttr(CUDADeviceAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation())); 15578 else 15579 FD->addAttr(CUDAHostAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation())); 15580 } 15581 15582 // Add known guaranteed alignment for allocation functions. 15583 switch (BuiltinID) { 15584 case Builtin::BImemalign: 15585 case Builtin::BIaligned_alloc: 15586 if (!FD->hasAttr<AllocAlignAttr>()) 15587 FD->addAttr(AllocAlignAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, ParamIdx(1, FD), 15588 FD->getLocation())); 15589 break; 15590 default: 15591 break; 15592 } 15593 15594 // Add allocsize attribute for allocation functions. 15595 switch (BuiltinID) { 15596 case Builtin::BIcalloc: 15597 FD->addAttr(AllocSizeAttr::CreateImplicit( 15598 Context, ParamIdx(1, FD), ParamIdx(2, FD), FD->getLocation())); 15599 break; 15600 case Builtin::BImemalign: 15601 case Builtin::BIaligned_alloc: 15602 case Builtin::BIrealloc: 15603 FD->addAttr(AllocSizeAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, ParamIdx(2, FD), 15604 ParamIdx(), FD->getLocation())); 15605 break; 15606 case Builtin::BImalloc: 15607 FD->addAttr(AllocSizeAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, ParamIdx(1, FD), 15608 ParamIdx(), FD->getLocation())); 15609 break; 15610 default: 15611 break; 15612 } 15613 } 15614 15615 AddKnownFunctionAttributesForReplaceableGlobalAllocationFunction(FD); 15616 15617 // If C++ exceptions are enabled but we are told extern "C" functions cannot 15618 // throw, add an implicit nothrow attribute to any extern "C" function we come 15619 // across. 15620 if (getLangOpts().CXXExceptions && getLangOpts().ExternCNoUnwind && 15621 FD->isExternC() && !FD->hasAttr<NoThrowAttr>()) { 15622 const auto *FPT = FD->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 15623 if (!FPT || FPT->getExceptionSpecType() == EST_None) 15624 FD->addAttr(NoThrowAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation())); 15625 } 15626 15627 IdentifierInfo *Name = FD->getIdentifier(); 15628 if (!Name) 15629 return; 15630 if ((!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 15631 FD->getDeclContext()->isTranslationUnit()) || 15632 (isa<LinkageSpecDecl>(FD->getDeclContext()) && 15633 cast<LinkageSpecDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->getLanguage() == 15634 LinkageSpecDecl::lang_c)) { 15635 // Okay: this could be a libc/libm/Objective-C function we know 15636 // about. 15637 } else 15638 return; 15639 15640 if (Name->isStr("asprintf") || Name->isStr("vasprintf")) { 15641 // FIXME: asprintf and vasprintf aren't C99 functions. Should they be 15642 // target-specific builtins, perhaps? 15643 if (!FD->hasAttr<FormatAttr>()) 15644 FD->addAttr(FormatAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, 15645 &Context.Idents.get("printf"), 2, 15646 Name->isStr("vasprintf") ? 0 : 3, 15647 FD->getLocation())); 15648 } 15649 15650 if (Name->isStr("__CFStringMakeConstantString")) { 15651 // We already have a __builtin___CFStringMakeConstantString, 15652 // but builds that use -fno-constant-cfstrings don't go through that. 15653 if (!FD->hasAttr<FormatArgAttr>()) 15654 FD->addAttr(FormatArgAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, ParamIdx(1, FD), 15655 FD->getLocation())); 15656 } 15657 } 15658 15659 TypedefDecl *Sema::ParseTypedefDecl(Scope *S, Declarator &D, QualType T, 15660 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) { 15661 assert(D.getIdentifier() && "Wrong callback for declspec without declarator"); 15662 assert(!T.isNull() && "GetTypeForDeclarator() returned null type"); 15663 15664 if (!TInfo) { 15665 assert(D.isInvalidType() && "no declarator info for valid type"); 15666 TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T); 15667 } 15668 15669 // Scope manipulation handled by caller. 15670 TypedefDecl *NewTD = 15671 TypedefDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, D.getBeginLoc(), 15672 D.getIdentifierLoc(), D.getIdentifier(), TInfo); 15673 15674 // Bail out immediately if we have an invalid declaration. 15675 if (D.isInvalidType()) { 15676 NewTD->setInvalidDecl(); 15677 return NewTD; 15678 } 15679 15680 if (D.getDeclSpec().isModulePrivateSpecified()) { 15681 if (CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod()) 15682 Diag(NewTD->getLocation(), diag::err_module_private_local) 15683 << 2 << NewTD 15684 << SourceRange(D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc()) 15685 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval( 15686 D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc()); 15687 else 15688 NewTD->setModulePrivate(); 15689 } 15690 15691 // C++ [dcl.typedef]p8: 15692 // If the typedef declaration defines an unnamed class (or 15693 // enum), the first typedef-name declared by the declaration 15694 // to be that class type (or enum type) is used to denote the 15695 // class type (or enum type) for linkage purposes only. 15696 // We need to check whether the type was declared in the declaration. 15697 switch (D.getDeclSpec().getTypeSpecType()) { 15698 case TST_enum: 15699 case TST_struct: 15700 case TST_interface: 15701 case TST_union: 15702 case TST_class: { 15703 TagDecl *tagFromDeclSpec = cast<TagDecl>(D.getDeclSpec().getRepAsDecl()); 15704 setTagNameForLinkagePurposes(tagFromDeclSpec, NewTD); 15705 break; 15706 } 15707 15708 default: 15709 break; 15710 } 15711 15712 return NewTD; 15713 } 15714 15715 /// Check that this is a valid underlying type for an enum declaration. 15716 bool Sema::CheckEnumUnderlyingType(TypeSourceInfo *TI) { 15717 SourceLocation UnderlyingLoc = TI->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(); 15718 QualType T = TI->getType(); 15719 15720 if (T->isDependentType()) 15721 return false; 15722 15723 // This doesn't use 'isIntegralType' despite the error message mentioning 15724 // integral type because isIntegralType would also allow enum types in C. 15725 if (const BuiltinType *BT = T->getAs<BuiltinType>()) 15726 if (BT->isInteger()) 15727 return false; 15728 15729 if (T->isBitIntType()) 15730 return false; 15731 15732 return Diag(UnderlyingLoc, diag::err_enum_invalid_underlying) << T; 15733 } 15734 15735 /// Check whether this is a valid redeclaration of a previous enumeration. 15736 /// \return true if the redeclaration was invalid. 15737 bool Sema::CheckEnumRedeclaration(SourceLocation EnumLoc, bool IsScoped, 15738 QualType EnumUnderlyingTy, bool IsFixed, 15739 const EnumDecl *Prev) { 15740 if (IsScoped != Prev->isScoped()) { 15741 Diag(EnumLoc, diag::err_enum_redeclare_scoped_mismatch) 15742 << Prev->isScoped(); 15743 Diag(Prev->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 15744 return true; 15745 } 15746 15747 if (IsFixed && Prev->isFixed()) { 15748 if (!EnumUnderlyingTy->isDependentType() && 15749 !Prev->getIntegerType()->isDependentType() && 15750 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(EnumUnderlyingTy, 15751 Prev->getIntegerType())) { 15752 // TODO: Highlight the underlying type of the redeclaration. 15753 Diag(EnumLoc, diag::err_enum_redeclare_type_mismatch) 15754 << EnumUnderlyingTy << Prev->getIntegerType(); 15755 Diag(Prev->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration) 15756 << Prev->getIntegerTypeRange(); 15757 return true; 15758 } 15759 } else if (IsFixed != Prev->isFixed()) { 15760 Diag(EnumLoc, diag::err_enum_redeclare_fixed_mismatch) 15761 << Prev->isFixed(); 15762 Diag(Prev->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 15763 return true; 15764 } 15765 15766 return false; 15767 } 15768 15769 /// Get diagnostic %select index for tag kind for 15770 /// redeclaration diagnostic message. 15771 /// WARNING: Indexes apply to particular diagnostics only! 15772 /// 15773 /// \returns diagnostic %select index. 15774 static unsigned getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(TagTypeKind Tag) { 15775 switch (Tag) { 15776 case TTK_Struct: return 0; 15777 case TTK_Interface: return 1; 15778 case TTK_Class: return 2; 15779 default: llvm_unreachable("Invalid tag kind for redecl diagnostic!"); 15780 } 15781 } 15782 15783 /// Determine if tag kind is a class-key compatible with 15784 /// class for redeclaration (class, struct, or __interface). 15785 /// 15786 /// \returns true iff the tag kind is compatible. 15787 static bool isClassCompatTagKind(TagTypeKind Tag) 15788 { 15789 return Tag == TTK_Struct || Tag == TTK_Class || Tag == TTK_Interface; 15790 } 15791 15792 Sema::NonTagKind Sema::getNonTagTypeDeclKind(const Decl *PrevDecl, 15793 TagTypeKind TTK) { 15794 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(PrevDecl)) 15795 return NTK_Typedef; 15796 else if (isa<TypeAliasDecl>(PrevDecl)) 15797 return NTK_TypeAlias; 15798 else if (isa<ClassTemplateDecl>(PrevDecl)) 15799 return NTK_Template; 15800 else if (isa<TypeAliasTemplateDecl>(PrevDecl)) 15801 return NTK_TypeAliasTemplate; 15802 else if (isa<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(PrevDecl)) 15803 return NTK_TemplateTemplateArgument; 15804 switch (TTK) { 15805 case TTK_Struct: 15806 case TTK_Interface: 15807 case TTK_Class: 15808 return getLangOpts().CPlusPlus ? NTK_NonClass : NTK_NonStruct; 15809 case TTK_Union: 15810 return NTK_NonUnion; 15811 case TTK_Enum: 15812 return NTK_NonEnum; 15813 } 15814 llvm_unreachable("invalid TTK"); 15815 } 15816 15817 /// Determine whether a tag with a given kind is acceptable 15818 /// as a redeclaration of the given tag declaration. 15819 /// 15820 /// \returns true if the new tag kind is acceptable, false otherwise. 15821 bool Sema::isAcceptableTagRedeclaration(const TagDecl *Previous, 15822 TagTypeKind NewTag, bool isDefinition, 15823 SourceLocation NewTagLoc, 15824 const IdentifierInfo *Name) { 15825 // C++ [dcl.type.elab]p3: 15826 // The class-key or enum keyword present in the 15827 // elaborated-type-specifier shall agree in kind with the 15828 // declaration to which the name in the elaborated-type-specifier 15829 // refers. This rule also applies to the form of 15830 // elaborated-type-specifier that declares a class-name or 15831 // friend class since it can be construed as referring to the 15832 // definition of the class. Thus, in any 15833 // elaborated-type-specifier, the enum keyword shall be used to 15834 // refer to an enumeration (7.2), the union class-key shall be 15835 // used to refer to a union (clause 9), and either the class or 15836 // struct class-key shall be used to refer to a class (clause 9) 15837 // declared using the class or struct class-key. 15838 TagTypeKind OldTag = Previous->getTagKind(); 15839 if (OldTag != NewTag && 15840 !(isClassCompatTagKind(OldTag) && isClassCompatTagKind(NewTag))) 15841 return false; 15842 15843 // Tags are compatible, but we might still want to warn on mismatched tags. 15844 // Non-class tags can't be mismatched at this point. 15845 if (!isClassCompatTagKind(NewTag)) 15846 return true; 15847 15848 // Declarations for which -Wmismatched-tags is disabled are entirely ignored 15849 // by our warning analysis. We don't want to warn about mismatches with (eg) 15850 // declarations in system headers that are designed to be specialized, but if 15851 // a user asks us to warn, we should warn if their code contains mismatched 15852 // declarations. 15853 auto IsIgnoredLoc = [&](SourceLocation Loc) { 15854 return getDiagnostics().isIgnored(diag::warn_struct_class_tag_mismatch, 15855 Loc); 15856 }; 15857 if (IsIgnoredLoc(NewTagLoc)) 15858 return true; 15859 15860 auto IsIgnored = [&](const TagDecl *Tag) { 15861 return IsIgnoredLoc(Tag->getLocation()); 15862 }; 15863 while (IsIgnored(Previous)) { 15864 Previous = Previous->getPreviousDecl(); 15865 if (!Previous) 15866 return true; 15867 OldTag = Previous->getTagKind(); 15868 } 15869 15870 bool isTemplate = false; 15871 if (const CXXRecordDecl *Record = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Previous)) 15872 isTemplate = Record->getDescribedClassTemplate(); 15873 15874 if (inTemplateInstantiation()) { 15875 if (OldTag != NewTag) { 15876 // In a template instantiation, do not offer fix-its for tag mismatches 15877 // since they usually mess up the template instead of fixing the problem. 15878 Diag(NewTagLoc, diag::warn_struct_class_tag_mismatch) 15879 << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(NewTag) << isTemplate << Name 15880 << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(OldTag); 15881 // FIXME: Note previous location? 15882 } 15883 return true; 15884 } 15885 15886 if (isDefinition) { 15887 // On definitions, check all previous tags and issue a fix-it for each 15888 // one that doesn't match the current tag. 15889 if (Previous->getDefinition()) { 15890 // Don't suggest fix-its for redefinitions. 15891 return true; 15892 } 15893 15894 bool previousMismatch = false; 15895 for (const TagDecl *I : Previous->redecls()) { 15896 if (I->getTagKind() != NewTag) { 15897 // Ignore previous declarations for which the warning was disabled. 15898 if (IsIgnored(I)) 15899 continue; 15900 15901 if (!previousMismatch) { 15902 previousMismatch = true; 15903 Diag(NewTagLoc, diag::warn_struct_class_previous_tag_mismatch) 15904 << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(NewTag) << isTemplate << Name 15905 << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(I->getTagKind()); 15906 } 15907 Diag(I->getInnerLocStart(), diag::note_struct_class_suggestion) 15908 << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(NewTag) 15909 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(I->getInnerLocStart(), 15910 TypeWithKeyword::getTagTypeKindName(NewTag)); 15911 } 15912 } 15913 return true; 15914 } 15915 15916 // Identify the prevailing tag kind: this is the kind of the definition (if 15917 // there is a non-ignored definition), or otherwise the kind of the prior 15918 // (non-ignored) declaration. 15919 const TagDecl *PrevDef = Previous->getDefinition(); 15920 if (PrevDef && IsIgnored(PrevDef)) 15921 PrevDef = nullptr; 15922 const TagDecl *Redecl = PrevDef ? PrevDef : Previous; 15923 if (Redecl->getTagKind() != NewTag) { 15924 Diag(NewTagLoc, diag::warn_struct_class_tag_mismatch) 15925 << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(NewTag) << isTemplate << Name 15926 << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(OldTag); 15927 Diag(Redecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_use); 15928 15929 // If there is a previous definition, suggest a fix-it. 15930 if (PrevDef) { 15931 Diag(NewTagLoc, diag::note_struct_class_suggestion) 15932 << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(Redecl->getTagKind()) 15933 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange(NewTagLoc), 15934 TypeWithKeyword::getTagTypeKindName(Redecl->getTagKind())); 15935 } 15936 } 15937 15938 return true; 15939 } 15940 15941 /// Add a minimal nested name specifier fixit hint to allow lookup of a tag name 15942 /// from an outer enclosing namespace or file scope inside a friend declaration. 15943 /// This should provide the commented out code in the following snippet: 15944 /// namespace N { 15945 /// struct X; 15946 /// namespace M { 15947 /// struct Y { friend struct /*N::*/ X; }; 15948 /// } 15949 /// } 15950 static FixItHint createFriendTagNNSFixIt(Sema &SemaRef, NamedDecl *ND, Scope *S, 15951 SourceLocation NameLoc) { 15952 // While the decl is in a namespace, do repeated lookup of that name and see 15953 // if we get the same namespace back. If we do not, continue until 15954 // translation unit scope, at which point we have a fully qualified NNS. 15955 SmallVector<IdentifierInfo *, 4> Namespaces; 15956 DeclContext *DC = ND->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext(); 15957 for (; !DC->isTranslationUnit(); DC = DC->getParent()) { 15958 // This tag should be declared in a namespace, which can only be enclosed by 15959 // other namespaces. Bail if there's an anonymous namespace in the chain. 15960 NamespaceDecl *Namespace = dyn_cast<NamespaceDecl>(DC); 15961 if (!Namespace || Namespace->isAnonymousNamespace()) 15962 return FixItHint(); 15963 IdentifierInfo *II = Namespace->getIdentifier(); 15964 Namespaces.push_back(II); 15965 NamedDecl *Lookup = SemaRef.LookupSingleName( 15966 S, II, NameLoc, Sema::LookupNestedNameSpecifierName); 15967 if (Lookup == Namespace) 15968 break; 15969 } 15970 15971 // Once we have all the namespaces, reverse them to go outermost first, and 15972 // build an NNS. 15973 SmallString<64> Insertion; 15974 llvm::raw_svector_ostream OS(Insertion); 15975 if (DC->isTranslationUnit()) 15976 OS << "::"; 15977 std::reverse(Namespaces.begin(), Namespaces.end()); 15978 for (auto *II : Namespaces) 15979 OS << II->getName() << "::"; 15980 return FixItHint::CreateInsertion(NameLoc, Insertion); 15981 } 15982 15983 /// Determine whether a tag originally declared in context \p OldDC can 15984 /// be redeclared with an unqualified name in \p NewDC (assuming name lookup 15985 /// found a declaration in \p OldDC as a previous decl, perhaps through a 15986 /// using-declaration). 15987 static bool isAcceptableTagRedeclContext(Sema &S, DeclContext *OldDC, 15988 DeclContext *NewDC) { 15989 OldDC = OldDC->getRedeclContext(); 15990 NewDC = NewDC->getRedeclContext(); 15991 15992 if (OldDC->Equals(NewDC)) 15993 return true; 15994 15995 // In MSVC mode, we allow a redeclaration if the contexts are related (either 15996 // encloses the other). 15997 if (S.getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && 15998 (OldDC->Encloses(NewDC) || NewDC->Encloses(OldDC))) 15999 return true; 16000 16001 return false; 16002 } 16003 16004 /// This is invoked when we see 'struct foo' or 'struct {'. In the 16005 /// former case, Name will be non-null. In the later case, Name will be null. 16006 /// TagSpec indicates what kind of tag this is. TUK indicates whether this is a 16007 /// reference/declaration/definition of a tag. 16008 /// 16009 /// \param IsTypeSpecifier \c true if this is a type-specifier (or 16010 /// trailing-type-specifier) other than one in an alias-declaration. 16011 /// 16012 /// \param SkipBody If non-null, will be set to indicate if the caller should 16013 /// skip the definition of this tag and treat it as if it were a declaration. 16014 Decl *Sema::ActOnTag(Scope *S, unsigned TagSpec, TagUseKind TUK, 16015 SourceLocation KWLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS, 16016 IdentifierInfo *Name, SourceLocation NameLoc, 16017 const ParsedAttributesView &Attrs, AccessSpecifier AS, 16018 SourceLocation ModulePrivateLoc, 16019 MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParameterLists, 16020 bool &OwnedDecl, bool &IsDependent, 16021 SourceLocation ScopedEnumKWLoc, 16022 bool ScopedEnumUsesClassTag, TypeResult UnderlyingType, 16023 bool IsTypeSpecifier, bool IsTemplateParamOrArg, 16024 SkipBodyInfo *SkipBody) { 16025 // If this is not a definition, it must have a name. 16026 IdentifierInfo *OrigName = Name; 16027 assert((Name != nullptr || TUK == TUK_Definition) && 16028 "Nameless record must be a definition!"); 16029 assert(TemplateParameterLists.size() == 0 || TUK != TUK_Reference); 16030 16031 OwnedDecl = false; 16032 TagTypeKind Kind = TypeWithKeyword::getTagTypeKindForTypeSpec(TagSpec); 16033 bool ScopedEnum = ScopedEnumKWLoc.isValid(); 16034 16035 // FIXME: Check member specializations more carefully. 16036 bool isMemberSpecialization = false; 16037 bool Invalid = false; 16038 16039 // We only need to do this matching if we have template parameters 16040 // or a scope specifier, which also conveniently avoids this work 16041 // for non-C++ cases. 16042 if (TemplateParameterLists.size() > 0 || 16043 (SS.isNotEmpty() && TUK != TUK_Reference)) { 16044 if (TemplateParameterList *TemplateParams = 16045 MatchTemplateParametersToScopeSpecifier( 16046 KWLoc, NameLoc, SS, nullptr, TemplateParameterLists, 16047 TUK == TUK_Friend, isMemberSpecialization, Invalid)) { 16048 if (Kind == TTK_Enum) { 16049 Diag(KWLoc, diag::err_enum_template); 16050 return nullptr; 16051 } 16052 16053 if (TemplateParams->size() > 0) { 16054 // This is a declaration or definition of a class template (which may 16055 // be a member of another template). 16056 16057 if (Invalid) 16058 return nullptr; 16059 16060 OwnedDecl = false; 16061 DeclResult Result = CheckClassTemplate( 16062 S, TagSpec, TUK, KWLoc, SS, Name, NameLoc, Attrs, TemplateParams, 16063 AS, ModulePrivateLoc, 16064 /*FriendLoc*/ SourceLocation(), TemplateParameterLists.size() - 1, 16065 TemplateParameterLists.data(), SkipBody); 16066 return Result.get(); 16067 } else { 16068 // The "template<>" header is extraneous. 16069 Diag(TemplateParams->getTemplateLoc(), diag::err_template_tag_noparams) 16070 << TypeWithKeyword::getTagTypeKindName(Kind) << Name; 16071 isMemberSpecialization = true; 16072 } 16073 } 16074 16075 if (!TemplateParameterLists.empty() && isMemberSpecialization && 16076 CheckTemplateDeclScope(S, TemplateParameterLists.back())) 16077 return nullptr; 16078 } 16079 16080 // Figure out the underlying type if this a enum declaration. We need to do 16081 // this early, because it's needed to detect if this is an incompatible 16082 // redeclaration. 16083 llvm::PointerUnion<const Type*, TypeSourceInfo*> EnumUnderlying; 16084 bool IsFixed = !UnderlyingType.isUnset() || ScopedEnum; 16085 16086 if (Kind == TTK_Enum) { 16087 if (UnderlyingType.isInvalid() || (!UnderlyingType.get() && ScopedEnum)) { 16088 // No underlying type explicitly specified, or we failed to parse the 16089 // type, default to int. 16090 EnumUnderlying = Context.IntTy.getTypePtr(); 16091 } else if (UnderlyingType.get()) { 16092 // C++0x 7.2p2: The type-specifier-seq of an enum-base shall name an 16093 // integral type; any cv-qualification is ignored. 16094 TypeSourceInfo *TI = nullptr; 16095 GetTypeFromParser(UnderlyingType.get(), &TI); 16096 EnumUnderlying = TI; 16097 16098 if (CheckEnumUnderlyingType(TI)) 16099 // Recover by falling back to int. 16100 EnumUnderlying = Context.IntTy.getTypePtr(); 16101 16102 if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(TI->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), TI, 16103 UPPC_FixedUnderlyingType)) 16104 EnumUnderlying = Context.IntTy.getTypePtr(); 16105 16106 } else if (Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isWindowsMSVCEnvironment()) { 16107 // For MSVC ABI compatibility, unfixed enums must use an underlying type 16108 // of 'int'. However, if this is an unfixed forward declaration, don't set 16109 // the underlying type unless the user enables -fms-compatibility. This 16110 // makes unfixed forward declared enums incomplete and is more conforming. 16111 if (TUK == TUK_Definition || getLangOpts().MSVCCompat) 16112 EnumUnderlying = Context.IntTy.getTypePtr(); 16113 } 16114 } 16115 16116 DeclContext *SearchDC = CurContext; 16117 DeclContext *DC = CurContext; 16118 bool isStdBadAlloc = false; 16119 bool isStdAlignValT = false; 16120 16121 RedeclarationKind Redecl = forRedeclarationInCurContext(); 16122 if (TUK == TUK_Friend || TUK == TUK_Reference) 16123 Redecl = NotForRedeclaration; 16124 16125 /// Create a new tag decl in C/ObjC. Since the ODR-like semantics for ObjC/C 16126 /// implemented asks for structural equivalence checking, the returned decl 16127 /// here is passed back to the parser, allowing the tag body to be parsed. 16128 auto createTagFromNewDecl = [&]() -> TagDecl * { 16129 assert(!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "not meant for C++ usage"); 16130 // If there is an identifier, use the location of the identifier as the 16131 // location of the decl, otherwise use the location of the struct/union 16132 // keyword. 16133 SourceLocation Loc = NameLoc.isValid() ? NameLoc : KWLoc; 16134 TagDecl *New = nullptr; 16135 16136 if (Kind == TTK_Enum) { 16137 New = EnumDecl::Create(Context, SearchDC, KWLoc, Loc, Name, nullptr, 16138 ScopedEnum, ScopedEnumUsesClassTag, IsFixed); 16139 // If this is an undefined enum, bail. 16140 if (TUK != TUK_Definition && !Invalid) 16141 return nullptr; 16142 if (EnumUnderlying) { 16143 EnumDecl *ED = cast<EnumDecl>(New); 16144 if (TypeSourceInfo *TI = EnumUnderlying.dyn_cast<TypeSourceInfo *>()) 16145 ED->setIntegerTypeSourceInfo(TI); 16146 else 16147 ED->setIntegerType(QualType(EnumUnderlying.get<const Type *>(), 0)); 16148 ED->setPromotionType(ED->getIntegerType()); 16149 } 16150 } else { // struct/union 16151 New = RecordDecl::Create(Context, Kind, SearchDC, KWLoc, Loc, Name, 16152 nullptr); 16153 } 16154 16155 if (RecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(New)) { 16156 // Add alignment attributes if necessary; these attributes are checked 16157 // when the ASTContext lays out the structure. 16158 // 16159 // It is important for implementing the correct semantics that this 16160 // happen here (in ActOnTag). The #pragma pack stack is 16161 // maintained as a result of parser callbacks which can occur at 16162 // many points during the parsing of a struct declaration (because 16163 // the #pragma tokens are effectively skipped over during the 16164 // parsing of the struct). 16165 if (TUK == TUK_Definition && (!SkipBody || !SkipBody->ShouldSkip)) { 16166 AddAlignmentAttributesForRecord(RD); 16167 AddMsStructLayoutForRecord(RD); 16168 } 16169 } 16170 New->setLexicalDeclContext(CurContext); 16171 return New; 16172 }; 16173 16174 LookupResult Previous(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupTagName, Redecl); 16175 if (Name && SS.isNotEmpty()) { 16176 // We have a nested-name tag ('struct foo::bar'). 16177 16178 // Check for invalid 'foo::'. 16179 if (SS.isInvalid()) { 16180 Name = nullptr; 16181 goto CreateNewDecl; 16182 } 16183 16184 // If this is a friend or a reference to a class in a dependent 16185 // context, don't try to make a decl for it. 16186 if (TUK == TUK_Friend || TUK == TUK_Reference) { 16187 DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false); 16188 if (!DC) { 16189 IsDependent = true; 16190 return nullptr; 16191 } 16192 } else { 16193 DC = computeDeclContext(SS, true); 16194 if (!DC) { 16195 Diag(SS.getRange().getBegin(), diag::err_dependent_nested_name_spec) 16196 << SS.getRange(); 16197 return nullptr; 16198 } 16199 } 16200 16201 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC)) 16202 return nullptr; 16203 16204 SearchDC = DC; 16205 // Look-up name inside 'foo::'. 16206 LookupQualifiedName(Previous, DC); 16207 16208 if (Previous.isAmbiguous()) 16209 return nullptr; 16210 16211 if (Previous.empty()) { 16212 // Name lookup did not find anything. However, if the 16213 // nested-name-specifier refers to the current instantiation, 16214 // and that current instantiation has any dependent base 16215 // classes, we might find something at instantiation time: treat 16216 // this as a dependent elaborated-type-specifier. 16217 // But this only makes any sense for reference-like lookups. 16218 if (Previous.wasNotFoundInCurrentInstantiation() && 16219 (TUK == TUK_Reference || TUK == TUK_Friend)) { 16220 IsDependent = true; 16221 return nullptr; 16222 } 16223 16224 // A tag 'foo::bar' must already exist. 16225 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_not_tag_in_scope) 16226 << Kind << Name << DC << SS.getRange(); 16227 Name = nullptr; 16228 Invalid = true; 16229 goto CreateNewDecl; 16230 } 16231 } else if (Name) { 16232 // C++14 [class.mem]p14: 16233 // If T is the name of a class, then each of the following shall have a 16234 // name different from T: 16235 // -- every member of class T that is itself a type 16236 if (TUK != TUK_Reference && TUK != TUK_Friend && 16237 DiagnoseClassNameShadow(SearchDC, DeclarationNameInfo(Name, NameLoc))) 16238 return nullptr; 16239 16240 // If this is a named struct, check to see if there was a previous forward 16241 // declaration or definition. 16242 // FIXME: We're looking into outer scopes here, even when we 16243 // shouldn't be. Doing so can result in ambiguities that we 16244 // shouldn't be diagnosing. 16245 LookupName(Previous, S); 16246 16247 // When declaring or defining a tag, ignore ambiguities introduced 16248 // by types using'ed into this scope. 16249 if (Previous.isAmbiguous() && 16250 (TUK == TUK_Definition || TUK == TUK_Declaration)) { 16251 LookupResult::Filter F = Previous.makeFilter(); 16252 while (F.hasNext()) { 16253 NamedDecl *ND = F.next(); 16254 if (!ND->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->Equals( 16255 SearchDC->getRedeclContext())) 16256 F.erase(); 16257 } 16258 F.done(); 16259 } 16260 16261 // C++11 [namespace.memdef]p3: 16262 // If the name in a friend declaration is neither qualified nor 16263 // a template-id and the declaration is a function or an 16264 // elaborated-type-specifier, the lookup to determine whether 16265 // the entity has been previously declared shall not consider 16266 // any scopes outside the innermost enclosing namespace. 16267 // 16268 // MSVC doesn't implement the above rule for types, so a friend tag 16269 // declaration may be a redeclaration of a type declared in an enclosing 16270 // scope. They do implement this rule for friend functions. 16271 // 16272 // Does it matter that this should be by scope instead of by 16273 // semantic context? 16274 if (!Previous.empty() && TUK == TUK_Friend) { 16275 DeclContext *EnclosingNS = SearchDC->getEnclosingNamespaceContext(); 16276 LookupResult::Filter F = Previous.makeFilter(); 16277 bool FriendSawTagOutsideEnclosingNamespace = false; 16278 while (F.hasNext()) { 16279 NamedDecl *ND = F.next(); 16280 DeclContext *DC = ND->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext(); 16281 if (DC->isFileContext() && 16282 !EnclosingNS->Encloses(ND->getDeclContext())) { 16283 if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat) 16284 FriendSawTagOutsideEnclosingNamespace = true; 16285 else 16286 F.erase(); 16287 } 16288 } 16289 F.done(); 16290 16291 // Diagnose this MSVC extension in the easy case where lookup would have 16292 // unambiguously found something outside the enclosing namespace. 16293 if (Previous.isSingleResult() && FriendSawTagOutsideEnclosingNamespace) { 16294 NamedDecl *ND = Previous.getFoundDecl(); 16295 Diag(NameLoc, diag::ext_friend_tag_redecl_outside_namespace) 16296 << createFriendTagNNSFixIt(*this, ND, S, NameLoc); 16297 } 16298 } 16299 16300 // Note: there used to be some attempt at recovery here. 16301 if (Previous.isAmbiguous()) 16302 return nullptr; 16303 16304 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && TUK != TUK_Reference) { 16305 // FIXME: This makes sure that we ignore the contexts associated 16306 // with C structs, unions, and enums when looking for a matching 16307 // tag declaration or definition. See the similar lookup tweak 16308 // in Sema::LookupName; is there a better way to deal with this? 16309 while (isa<RecordDecl, EnumDecl, ObjCContainerDecl>(SearchDC)) 16310 SearchDC = SearchDC->getParent(); 16311 } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 16312 // Inside ObjCContainer want to keep it as a lexical decl context but go 16313 // past it (most often to TranslationUnit) to find the semantic decl 16314 // context. 16315 while (isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(SearchDC)) 16316 SearchDC = SearchDC->getParent(); 16317 } 16318 } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 16319 // Don't use ObjCContainerDecl as the semantic decl context for anonymous 16320 // TagDecl the same way as we skip it for named TagDecl. 16321 while (isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(SearchDC)) 16322 SearchDC = SearchDC->getParent(); 16323 } 16324 16325 if (Previous.isSingleResult() && 16326 Previous.getFoundDecl()->isTemplateParameter()) { 16327 // Maybe we will complain about the shadowed template parameter. 16328 DiagnoseTemplateParameterShadow(NameLoc, Previous.getFoundDecl()); 16329 // Just pretend that we didn't see the previous declaration. 16330 Previous.clear(); 16331 } 16332 16333 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && Name && DC && StdNamespace && 16334 DC->Equals(getStdNamespace())) { 16335 if (Name->isStr("bad_alloc")) { 16336 // This is a declaration of or a reference to "std::bad_alloc". 16337 isStdBadAlloc = true; 16338 16339 // If std::bad_alloc has been implicitly declared (but made invisible to 16340 // name lookup), fill in this implicit declaration as the previous 16341 // declaration, so that the declarations get chained appropriately. 16342 if (Previous.empty() && StdBadAlloc) 16343 Previous.addDecl(getStdBadAlloc()); 16344 } else if (Name->isStr("align_val_t")) { 16345 isStdAlignValT = true; 16346 if (Previous.empty() && StdAlignValT) 16347 Previous.addDecl(getStdAlignValT()); 16348 } 16349 } 16350 16351 // If we didn't find a previous declaration, and this is a reference 16352 // (or friend reference), move to the correct scope. In C++, we 16353 // also need to do a redeclaration lookup there, just in case 16354 // there's a shadow friend decl. 16355 if (Name && Previous.empty() && 16356 (TUK == TUK_Reference || TUK == TUK_Friend || IsTemplateParamOrArg)) { 16357 if (Invalid) goto CreateNewDecl; 16358 assert(SS.isEmpty()); 16359 16360 if (TUK == TUK_Reference || IsTemplateParamOrArg) { 16361 // C++ [basic.scope.pdecl]p5: 16362 // -- for an elaborated-type-specifier of the form 16363 // 16364 // class-key identifier 16365 // 16366 // if the elaborated-type-specifier is used in the 16367 // decl-specifier-seq or parameter-declaration-clause of a 16368 // function defined in namespace scope, the identifier is 16369 // declared as a class-name in the namespace that contains 16370 // the declaration; otherwise, except as a friend 16371 // declaration, the identifier is declared in the smallest 16372 // non-class, non-function-prototype scope that contains the 16373 // declaration. 16374 // 16375 // C99 6.7.2.3p8 has a similar (but not identical!) provision for 16376 // C structs and unions. 16377 // 16378 // It is an error in C++ to declare (rather than define) an enum 16379 // type, including via an elaborated type specifier. We'll 16380 // diagnose that later; for now, declare the enum in the same 16381 // scope as we would have picked for any other tag type. 16382 // 16383 // GNU C also supports this behavior as part of its incomplete 16384 // enum types extension, while GNU C++ does not. 16385 // 16386 // Find the context where we'll be declaring the tag. 16387 // FIXME: We would like to maintain the current DeclContext as the 16388 // lexical context, 16389 SearchDC = getTagInjectionContext(SearchDC); 16390 16391 // Find the scope where we'll be declaring the tag. 16392 S = getTagInjectionScope(S, getLangOpts()); 16393 } else { 16394 assert(TUK == TUK_Friend); 16395 // C++ [namespace.memdef]p3: 16396 // If a friend declaration in a non-local class first declares a 16397 // class or function, the friend class or function is a member of 16398 // the innermost enclosing namespace. 16399 SearchDC = SearchDC->getEnclosingNamespaceContext(); 16400 } 16401 16402 // In C++, we need to do a redeclaration lookup to properly 16403 // diagnose some problems. 16404 // FIXME: redeclaration lookup is also used (with and without C++) to find a 16405 // hidden declaration so that we don't get ambiguity errors when using a 16406 // type declared by an elaborated-type-specifier. In C that is not correct 16407 // and we should instead merge compatible types found by lookup. 16408 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 16409 // FIXME: This can perform qualified lookups into function contexts, 16410 // which are meaningless. 16411 Previous.setRedeclarationKind(forRedeclarationInCurContext()); 16412 LookupQualifiedName(Previous, SearchDC); 16413 } else { 16414 Previous.setRedeclarationKind(forRedeclarationInCurContext()); 16415 LookupName(Previous, S); 16416 } 16417 } 16418 16419 // If we have a known previous declaration to use, then use it. 16420 if (Previous.empty() && SkipBody && SkipBody->Previous) 16421 Previous.addDecl(SkipBody->Previous); 16422 16423 if (!Previous.empty()) { 16424 NamedDecl *PrevDecl = Previous.getFoundDecl(); 16425 NamedDecl *DirectPrevDecl = Previous.getRepresentativeDecl(); 16426 16427 // It's okay to have a tag decl in the same scope as a typedef 16428 // which hides a tag decl in the same scope. Finding this 16429 // with a redeclaration lookup can only actually happen in C++. 16430 // 16431 // This is also okay for elaborated-type-specifiers, which is 16432 // technically forbidden by the current standard but which is 16433 // okay according to the likely resolution of an open issue; 16434 // see http://www.open-std.org/jtc1/sc22/wg21/docs/cwg_active.html#407 16435 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 16436 if (TypedefNameDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(PrevDecl)) { 16437 if (const TagType *TT = TD->getUnderlyingType()->getAs<TagType>()) { 16438 TagDecl *Tag = TT->getDecl(); 16439 if (Tag->getDeclName() == Name && 16440 Tag->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext() 16441 ->Equals(TD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext())) { 16442 PrevDecl = Tag; 16443 Previous.clear(); 16444 Previous.addDecl(Tag); 16445 Previous.resolveKind(); 16446 } 16447 } 16448 } 16449 } 16450 16451 // If this is a redeclaration of a using shadow declaration, it must 16452 // declare a tag in the same context. In MSVC mode, we allow a 16453 // redefinition if either context is within the other. 16454 if (auto *Shadow = dyn_cast<UsingShadowDecl>(DirectPrevDecl)) { 16455 auto *OldTag = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(PrevDecl); 16456 if (SS.isEmpty() && TUK != TUK_Reference && TUK != TUK_Friend && 16457 isDeclInScope(Shadow, SearchDC, S, isMemberSpecialization) && 16458 !(OldTag && isAcceptableTagRedeclContext( 16459 *this, OldTag->getDeclContext(), SearchDC))) { 16460 Diag(KWLoc, diag::err_using_decl_conflict_reverse); 16461 Diag(Shadow->getTargetDecl()->getLocation(), 16462 diag::note_using_decl_target); 16463 Diag(Shadow->getIntroducer()->getLocation(), diag::note_using_decl) 16464 << 0; 16465 // Recover by ignoring the old declaration. 16466 Previous.clear(); 16467 goto CreateNewDecl; 16468 } 16469 } 16470 16471 if (TagDecl *PrevTagDecl = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(PrevDecl)) { 16472 // If this is a use of a previous tag, or if the tag is already declared 16473 // in the same scope (so that the definition/declaration completes or 16474 // rementions the tag), reuse the decl. 16475 if (TUK == TUK_Reference || TUK == TUK_Friend || 16476 isDeclInScope(DirectPrevDecl, SearchDC, S, 16477 SS.isNotEmpty() || isMemberSpecialization)) { 16478 // Make sure that this wasn't declared as an enum and now used as a 16479 // struct or something similar. 16480 if (!isAcceptableTagRedeclaration(PrevTagDecl, Kind, 16481 TUK == TUK_Definition, KWLoc, 16482 Name)) { 16483 bool SafeToContinue 16484 = (PrevTagDecl->getTagKind() != TTK_Enum && 16485 Kind != TTK_Enum); 16486 if (SafeToContinue) 16487 Diag(KWLoc, diag::err_use_with_wrong_tag) 16488 << Name 16489 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange(KWLoc), 16490 PrevTagDecl->getKindName()); 16491 else 16492 Diag(KWLoc, diag::err_use_with_wrong_tag) << Name; 16493 Diag(PrevTagDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_use); 16494 16495 if (SafeToContinue) 16496 Kind = PrevTagDecl->getTagKind(); 16497 else { 16498 // Recover by making this an anonymous redefinition. 16499 Name = nullptr; 16500 Previous.clear(); 16501 Invalid = true; 16502 } 16503 } 16504 16505 if (Kind == TTK_Enum && PrevTagDecl->getTagKind() == TTK_Enum) { 16506 const EnumDecl *PrevEnum = cast<EnumDecl>(PrevTagDecl); 16507 if (TUK == TUK_Reference || TUK == TUK_Friend) 16508 return PrevTagDecl; 16509 16510 QualType EnumUnderlyingTy; 16511 if (TypeSourceInfo *TI = EnumUnderlying.dyn_cast<TypeSourceInfo*>()) 16512 EnumUnderlyingTy = TI->getType().getUnqualifiedType(); 16513 else if (const Type *T = EnumUnderlying.dyn_cast<const Type*>()) 16514 EnumUnderlyingTy = QualType(T, 0); 16515 16516 // All conflicts with previous declarations are recovered by 16517 // returning the previous declaration, unless this is a definition, 16518 // in which case we want the caller to bail out. 16519 if (CheckEnumRedeclaration(NameLoc.isValid() ? NameLoc : KWLoc, 16520 ScopedEnum, EnumUnderlyingTy, 16521 IsFixed, PrevEnum)) 16522 return TUK == TUK_Declaration ? PrevTagDecl : nullptr; 16523 } 16524 16525 // C++11 [class.mem]p1: 16526 // A member shall not be declared twice in the member-specification, 16527 // except that a nested class or member class template can be declared 16528 // and then later defined. 16529 if (TUK == TUK_Declaration && PrevDecl->isCXXClassMember() && 16530 S->isDeclScope(PrevDecl)) { 16531 Diag(NameLoc, diag::ext_member_redeclared); 16532 Diag(PrevTagDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 16533 } 16534 16535 if (!Invalid) { 16536 // If this is a use, just return the declaration we found, unless 16537 // we have attributes. 16538 if (TUK == TUK_Reference || TUK == TUK_Friend) { 16539 if (!Attrs.empty()) { 16540 // FIXME: Diagnose these attributes. For now, we create a new 16541 // declaration to hold them. 16542 } else if (TUK == TUK_Reference && 16543 (PrevTagDecl->getFriendObjectKind() == 16544 Decl::FOK_Undeclared || 16545 PrevDecl->getOwningModule() != getCurrentModule()) && 16546 SS.isEmpty()) { 16547 // This declaration is a reference to an existing entity, but 16548 // has different visibility from that entity: it either makes 16549 // a friend visible or it makes a type visible in a new module. 16550 // In either case, create a new declaration. We only do this if 16551 // the declaration would have meant the same thing if no prior 16552 // declaration were found, that is, if it was found in the same 16553 // scope where we would have injected a declaration. 16554 if (!getTagInjectionContext(CurContext)->getRedeclContext() 16555 ->Equals(PrevDecl->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext())) 16556 return PrevTagDecl; 16557 // This is in the injected scope, create a new declaration in 16558 // that scope. 16559 S = getTagInjectionScope(S, getLangOpts()); 16560 } else { 16561 return PrevTagDecl; 16562 } 16563 } 16564 16565 // Diagnose attempts to redefine a tag. 16566 if (TUK == TUK_Definition) { 16567 if (NamedDecl *Def = PrevTagDecl->getDefinition()) { 16568 // If we're defining a specialization and the previous definition 16569 // is from an implicit instantiation, don't emit an error 16570 // here; we'll catch this in the general case below. 16571 bool IsExplicitSpecializationAfterInstantiation = false; 16572 if (isMemberSpecialization) { 16573 if (CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Def)) 16574 IsExplicitSpecializationAfterInstantiation = 16575 RD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() != 16576 TSK_ExplicitSpecialization; 16577 else if (EnumDecl *ED = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(Def)) 16578 IsExplicitSpecializationAfterInstantiation = 16579 ED->getTemplateSpecializationKind() != 16580 TSK_ExplicitSpecialization; 16581 } 16582 16583 // Note that clang allows ODR-like semantics for ObjC/C, i.e., do 16584 // not keep more that one definition around (merge them). However, 16585 // ensure the decl passes the structural compatibility check in 16586 // C11 6.2.7/1 (or 6.1.2.6/1 in C89). 16587 NamedDecl *Hidden = nullptr; 16588 if (SkipBody && !hasVisibleDefinition(Def, &Hidden)) { 16589 // There is a definition of this tag, but it is not visible. We 16590 // explicitly make use of C++'s one definition rule here, and 16591 // assume that this definition is identical to the hidden one 16592 // we already have. Make the existing definition visible and 16593 // use it in place of this one. 16594 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 16595 // Postpone making the old definition visible until after we 16596 // complete parsing the new one and do the structural 16597 // comparison. 16598 SkipBody->CheckSameAsPrevious = true; 16599 SkipBody->New = createTagFromNewDecl(); 16600 SkipBody->Previous = Def; 16601 return Def; 16602 } else { 16603 SkipBody->ShouldSkip = true; 16604 SkipBody->Previous = Def; 16605 makeMergedDefinitionVisible(Hidden); 16606 // Carry on and handle it like a normal definition. We'll 16607 // skip starting the definitiion later. 16608 } 16609 } else if (!IsExplicitSpecializationAfterInstantiation) { 16610 // A redeclaration in function prototype scope in C isn't 16611 // visible elsewhere, so merely issue a warning. 16612 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && S->containedInPrototypeScope()) 16613 Diag(NameLoc, diag::warn_redefinition_in_param_list) << Name; 16614 else 16615 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_redefinition) << Name; 16616 notePreviousDefinition(Def, 16617 NameLoc.isValid() ? NameLoc : KWLoc); 16618 // If this is a redefinition, recover by making this 16619 // struct be anonymous, which will make any later 16620 // references get the previous definition. 16621 Name = nullptr; 16622 Previous.clear(); 16623 Invalid = true; 16624 } 16625 } else { 16626 // If the type is currently being defined, complain 16627 // about a nested redefinition. 16628 auto *TD = Context.getTagDeclType(PrevTagDecl)->getAsTagDecl(); 16629 if (TD->isBeingDefined()) { 16630 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_nested_redefinition) << Name; 16631 Diag(PrevTagDecl->getLocation(), 16632 diag::note_previous_definition); 16633 Name = nullptr; 16634 Previous.clear(); 16635 Invalid = true; 16636 } 16637 } 16638 16639 // Okay, this is definition of a previously declared or referenced 16640 // tag. We're going to create a new Decl for it. 16641 } 16642 16643 // Okay, we're going to make a redeclaration. If this is some kind 16644 // of reference, make sure we build the redeclaration in the same DC 16645 // as the original, and ignore the current access specifier. 16646 if (TUK == TUK_Friend || TUK == TUK_Reference) { 16647 SearchDC = PrevTagDecl->getDeclContext(); 16648 AS = AS_none; 16649 } 16650 } 16651 // If we get here we have (another) forward declaration or we 16652 // have a definition. Just create a new decl. 16653 16654 } else { 16655 // If we get here, this is a definition of a new tag type in a nested 16656 // scope, e.g. "struct foo; void bar() { struct foo; }", just create a 16657 // new decl/type. We set PrevDecl to NULL so that the entities 16658 // have distinct types. 16659 Previous.clear(); 16660 } 16661 // If we get here, we're going to create a new Decl. If PrevDecl 16662 // is non-NULL, it's a definition of the tag declared by 16663 // PrevDecl. If it's NULL, we have a new definition. 16664 16665 // Otherwise, PrevDecl is not a tag, but was found with tag 16666 // lookup. This is only actually possible in C++, where a few 16667 // things like templates still live in the tag namespace. 16668 } else { 16669 // Use a better diagnostic if an elaborated-type-specifier 16670 // found the wrong kind of type on the first 16671 // (non-redeclaration) lookup. 16672 if ((TUK == TUK_Reference || TUK == TUK_Friend) && 16673 !Previous.isForRedeclaration()) { 16674 NonTagKind NTK = getNonTagTypeDeclKind(PrevDecl, Kind); 16675 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_tag_reference_non_tag) << PrevDecl << NTK 16676 << Kind; 16677 Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at); 16678 Invalid = true; 16679 16680 // Otherwise, only diagnose if the declaration is in scope. 16681 } else if (!isDeclInScope(DirectPrevDecl, SearchDC, S, 16682 SS.isNotEmpty() || isMemberSpecialization)) { 16683 // do nothing 16684 16685 // Diagnose implicit declarations introduced by elaborated types. 16686 } else if (TUK == TUK_Reference || TUK == TUK_Friend) { 16687 NonTagKind NTK = getNonTagTypeDeclKind(PrevDecl, Kind); 16688 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_tag_reference_conflict) << NTK; 16689 Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) << PrevDecl; 16690 Invalid = true; 16691 16692 // Otherwise it's a declaration. Call out a particularly common 16693 // case here. 16694 } else if (TypedefNameDecl *TND = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(PrevDecl)) { 16695 unsigned Kind = 0; 16696 if (isa<TypeAliasDecl>(PrevDecl)) Kind = 1; 16697 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_tag_definition_of_typedef) 16698 << Name << Kind << TND->getUnderlyingType(); 16699 Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) << PrevDecl; 16700 Invalid = true; 16701 16702 // Otherwise, diagnose. 16703 } else { 16704 // The tag name clashes with something else in the target scope, 16705 // issue an error and recover by making this tag be anonymous. 16706 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_redefinition_different_kind) << Name; 16707 notePreviousDefinition(PrevDecl, NameLoc); 16708 Name = nullptr; 16709 Invalid = true; 16710 } 16711 16712 // The existing declaration isn't relevant to us; we're in a 16713 // new scope, so clear out the previous declaration. 16714 Previous.clear(); 16715 } 16716 } 16717 16718 CreateNewDecl: 16719 16720 TagDecl *PrevDecl = nullptr; 16721 if (Previous.isSingleResult()) 16722 PrevDecl = cast<TagDecl>(Previous.getFoundDecl()); 16723 16724 // If there is an identifier, use the location of the identifier as the 16725 // location of the decl, otherwise use the location of the struct/union 16726 // keyword. 16727 SourceLocation Loc = NameLoc.isValid() ? NameLoc : KWLoc; 16728 16729 // Otherwise, create a new declaration. If there is a previous 16730 // declaration of the same entity, the two will be linked via 16731 // PrevDecl. 16732 TagDecl *New; 16733 16734 if (Kind == TTK_Enum) { 16735 // FIXME: Tag decls should be chained to any simultaneous vardecls, e.g.: 16736 // enum X { A, B, C } D; D should chain to X. 16737 New = EnumDecl::Create(Context, SearchDC, KWLoc, Loc, Name, 16738 cast_or_null<EnumDecl>(PrevDecl), ScopedEnum, 16739 ScopedEnumUsesClassTag, IsFixed); 16740 16741 if (isStdAlignValT && (!StdAlignValT || getStdAlignValT()->isImplicit())) 16742 StdAlignValT = cast<EnumDecl>(New); 16743 16744 // If this is an undefined enum, warn. 16745 if (TUK != TUK_Definition && !Invalid) { 16746 TagDecl *Def; 16747 if (IsFixed && cast<EnumDecl>(New)->isFixed()) { 16748 // C++0x: 7.2p2: opaque-enum-declaration. 16749 // Conflicts are diagnosed above. Do nothing. 16750 } 16751 else if (PrevDecl && (Def = cast<EnumDecl>(PrevDecl)->getDefinition())) { 16752 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_forward_ref_enum_def) 16753 << New; 16754 Diag(Def->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition); 16755 } else { 16756 unsigned DiagID = diag::ext_forward_ref_enum; 16757 if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat) 16758 DiagID = diag::ext_ms_forward_ref_enum; 16759 else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 16760 DiagID = diag::err_forward_ref_enum; 16761 Diag(Loc, DiagID); 16762 } 16763 } 16764 16765 if (EnumUnderlying) { 16766 EnumDecl *ED = cast<EnumDecl>(New); 16767 if (TypeSourceInfo *TI = EnumUnderlying.dyn_cast<TypeSourceInfo*>()) 16768 ED->setIntegerTypeSourceInfo(TI); 16769 else 16770 ED->setIntegerType(QualType(EnumUnderlying.get<const Type*>(), 0)); 16771 ED->setPromotionType(ED->getIntegerType()); 16772 assert(ED->isComplete() && "enum with type should be complete"); 16773 } 16774 } else { 16775 // struct/union/class 16776 16777 // FIXME: Tag decls should be chained to any simultaneous vardecls, e.g.: 16778 // struct X { int A; } D; D should chain to X. 16779 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 16780 // FIXME: Look for a way to use RecordDecl for simple structs. 16781 New = CXXRecordDecl::Create(Context, Kind, SearchDC, KWLoc, Loc, Name, 16782 cast_or_null<CXXRecordDecl>(PrevDecl)); 16783 16784 if (isStdBadAlloc && (!StdBadAlloc || getStdBadAlloc()->isImplicit())) 16785 StdBadAlloc = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(New); 16786 } else 16787 New = RecordDecl::Create(Context, Kind, SearchDC, KWLoc, Loc, Name, 16788 cast_or_null<RecordDecl>(PrevDecl)); 16789 } 16790 16791 // C++11 [dcl.type]p3: 16792 // A type-specifier-seq shall not define a class or enumeration [...]. 16793 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && (IsTypeSpecifier || IsTemplateParamOrArg) && 16794 TUK == TUK_Definition) { 16795 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_type_defined_in_type_specifier) 16796 << Context.getTagDeclType(New); 16797 Invalid = true; 16798 } 16799 16800 if (!Invalid && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && TUK == TUK_Definition && 16801 DC->getDeclKind() == Decl::Enum) { 16802 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_type_defined_in_enum) 16803 << Context.getTagDeclType(New); 16804 Invalid = true; 16805 } 16806 16807 // Maybe add qualifier info. 16808 if (SS.isNotEmpty()) { 16809 if (SS.isSet()) { 16810 // If this is either a declaration or a definition, check the 16811 // nested-name-specifier against the current context. 16812 if ((TUK == TUK_Definition || TUK == TUK_Declaration) && 16813 diagnoseQualifiedDeclaration(SS, DC, OrigName, Loc, 16814 isMemberSpecialization)) 16815 Invalid = true; 16816 16817 New->setQualifierInfo(SS.getWithLocInContext(Context)); 16818 if (TemplateParameterLists.size() > 0) { 16819 New->setTemplateParameterListsInfo(Context, TemplateParameterLists); 16820 } 16821 } 16822 else 16823 Invalid = true; 16824 } 16825 16826 if (RecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(New)) { 16827 // Add alignment attributes if necessary; these attributes are checked when 16828 // the ASTContext lays out the structure. 16829 // 16830 // It is important for implementing the correct semantics that this 16831 // happen here (in ActOnTag). The #pragma pack stack is 16832 // maintained as a result of parser callbacks which can occur at 16833 // many points during the parsing of a struct declaration (because 16834 // the #pragma tokens are effectively skipped over during the 16835 // parsing of the struct). 16836 if (TUK == TUK_Definition && (!SkipBody || !SkipBody->ShouldSkip)) { 16837 AddAlignmentAttributesForRecord(RD); 16838 AddMsStructLayoutForRecord(RD); 16839 } 16840 } 16841 16842 if (ModulePrivateLoc.isValid()) { 16843 if (isMemberSpecialization) 16844 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_module_private_specialization) 16845 << 2 16846 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(ModulePrivateLoc); 16847 // __module_private__ does not apply to local classes. However, we only 16848 // diagnose this as an error when the declaration specifiers are 16849 // freestanding. Here, we just ignore the __module_private__. 16850 else if (!SearchDC->isFunctionOrMethod()) 16851 New->setModulePrivate(); 16852 } 16853 16854 // If this is a specialization of a member class (of a class template), 16855 // check the specialization. 16856 if (isMemberSpecialization && CheckMemberSpecialization(New, Previous)) 16857 Invalid = true; 16858 16859 // If we're declaring or defining a tag in function prototype scope in C, 16860 // note that this type can only be used within the function and add it to 16861 // the list of decls to inject into the function definition scope. 16862 if ((Name || Kind == TTK_Enum) && 16863 getNonFieldDeclScope(S)->isFunctionPrototypeScope()) { 16864 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 16865 // C++ [dcl.fct]p6: 16866 // Types shall not be defined in return or parameter types. 16867 if (TUK == TUK_Definition && !IsTypeSpecifier) { 16868 Diag(Loc, diag::err_type_defined_in_param_type) 16869 << Name; 16870 Invalid = true; 16871 } 16872 } else if (!PrevDecl) { 16873 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_decl_in_param_list) << Context.getTagDeclType(New); 16874 } 16875 } 16876 16877 if (Invalid) 16878 New->setInvalidDecl(); 16879 16880 // Set the lexical context. If the tag has a C++ scope specifier, the 16881 // lexical context will be different from the semantic context. 16882 New->setLexicalDeclContext(CurContext); 16883 16884 // Mark this as a friend decl if applicable. 16885 // In Microsoft mode, a friend declaration also acts as a forward 16886 // declaration so we always pass true to setObjectOfFriendDecl to make 16887 // the tag name visible. 16888 if (TUK == TUK_Friend) 16889 New->setObjectOfFriendDecl(getLangOpts().MSVCCompat); 16890 16891 // Set the access specifier. 16892 if (!Invalid && SearchDC->isRecord()) 16893 SetMemberAccessSpecifier(New, PrevDecl, AS); 16894 16895 if (PrevDecl) 16896 CheckRedeclarationInModule(New, PrevDecl); 16897 16898 if (TUK == TUK_Definition && (!SkipBody || !SkipBody->ShouldSkip)) 16899 New->startDefinition(); 16900 16901 ProcessDeclAttributeList(S, New, Attrs); 16902 AddPragmaAttributes(S, New); 16903 16904 // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack. 16905 if (TUK == TUK_Friend) { 16906 // We might be replacing an existing declaration in the lookup tables; 16907 // if so, borrow its access specifier. 16908 if (PrevDecl) 16909 New->setAccess(PrevDecl->getAccess()); 16910 16911 DeclContext *DC = New->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext(); 16912 DC->makeDeclVisibleInContext(New); 16913 if (Name) // can be null along some error paths 16914 if (Scope *EnclosingScope = getScopeForDeclContext(S, DC)) 16915 PushOnScopeChains(New, EnclosingScope, /* AddToContext = */ false); 16916 } else if (Name) { 16917 S = getNonFieldDeclScope(S); 16918 PushOnScopeChains(New, S, true); 16919 } else { 16920 CurContext->addDecl(New); 16921 } 16922 16923 // If this is the C FILE type, notify the AST context. 16924 if (IdentifierInfo *II = New->getIdentifier()) 16925 if (!New->isInvalidDecl() && 16926 New->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit() && 16927 II->isStr("FILE")) 16928 Context.setFILEDecl(New); 16929 16930 if (PrevDecl) 16931 mergeDeclAttributes(New, PrevDecl); 16932 16933 if (auto *CXXRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(New)) 16934 inferGslOwnerPointerAttribute(CXXRD); 16935 16936 // If there's a #pragma GCC visibility in scope, set the visibility of this 16937 // record. 16938 AddPushedVisibilityAttribute(New); 16939 16940 if (isMemberSpecialization && !New->isInvalidDecl()) 16941 CompleteMemberSpecialization(New, Previous); 16942 16943 OwnedDecl = true; 16944 // In C++, don't return an invalid declaration. We can't recover well from 16945 // the cases where we make the type anonymous. 16946 if (Invalid && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 16947 if (New->isBeingDefined()) 16948 if (auto RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(New)) 16949 RD->completeDefinition(); 16950 return nullptr; 16951 } else if (SkipBody && SkipBody->ShouldSkip) { 16952 return SkipBody->Previous; 16953 } else { 16954 return New; 16955 } 16956 } 16957 16958 void Sema::ActOnTagStartDefinition(Scope *S, Decl *TagD) { 16959 AdjustDeclIfTemplate(TagD); 16960 TagDecl *Tag = cast<TagDecl>(TagD); 16961 16962 // Enter the tag context. 16963 PushDeclContext(S, Tag); 16964 16965 ActOnDocumentableDecl(TagD); 16966 16967 // If there's a #pragma GCC visibility in scope, set the visibility of this 16968 // record. 16969 AddPushedVisibilityAttribute(Tag); 16970 } 16971 16972 bool Sema::ActOnDuplicateDefinition(Decl *Prev, SkipBodyInfo &SkipBody) { 16973 if (!hasStructuralCompatLayout(Prev, SkipBody.New)) 16974 return false; 16975 16976 // Make the previous decl visible. 16977 makeMergedDefinitionVisible(SkipBody.Previous); 16978 return true; 16979 } 16980 16981 void Sema::ActOnObjCContainerStartDefinition(ObjCContainerDecl *IDecl) { 16982 assert(IDecl->getLexicalParent() == CurContext && 16983 "The next DeclContext should be lexically contained in the current one."); 16984 CurContext = IDecl; 16985 } 16986 16987 void Sema::ActOnStartCXXMemberDeclarations(Scope *S, Decl *TagD, 16988 SourceLocation FinalLoc, 16989 bool IsFinalSpelledSealed, 16990 bool IsAbstract, 16991 SourceLocation LBraceLoc) { 16992 AdjustDeclIfTemplate(TagD); 16993 CXXRecordDecl *Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TagD); 16994 16995 FieldCollector->StartClass(); 16996 16997 if (!Record->getIdentifier()) 16998 return; 16999 17000 if (IsAbstract) 17001 Record->markAbstract(); 17002 17003 if (FinalLoc.isValid()) { 17004 Record->addAttr(FinalAttr::Create( 17005 Context, FinalLoc, AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Keyword, 17006 static_cast<FinalAttr::Spelling>(IsFinalSpelledSealed))); 17007 } 17008 // C++ [class]p2: 17009 // [...] The class-name is also inserted into the scope of the 17010 // class itself; this is known as the injected-class-name. For 17011 // purposes of access checking, the injected-class-name is treated 17012 // as if it were a public member name. 17013 CXXRecordDecl *InjectedClassName = CXXRecordDecl::Create( 17014 Context, Record->getTagKind(), CurContext, Record->getBeginLoc(), 17015 Record->getLocation(), Record->getIdentifier(), 17016 /*PrevDecl=*/nullptr, 17017 /*DelayTypeCreation=*/true); 17018 Context.getTypeDeclType(InjectedClassName, Record); 17019 InjectedClassName->setImplicit(); 17020 InjectedClassName->setAccess(AS_public); 17021 if (ClassTemplateDecl *Template = Record->getDescribedClassTemplate()) 17022 InjectedClassName->setDescribedClassTemplate(Template); 17023 PushOnScopeChains(InjectedClassName, S); 17024 assert(InjectedClassName->isInjectedClassName() && 17025 "Broken injected-class-name"); 17026 } 17027 17028 void Sema::ActOnTagFinishDefinition(Scope *S, Decl *TagD, 17029 SourceRange BraceRange) { 17030 AdjustDeclIfTemplate(TagD); 17031 TagDecl *Tag = cast<TagDecl>(TagD); 17032 Tag->setBraceRange(BraceRange); 17033 17034 // Make sure we "complete" the definition even it is invalid. 17035 if (Tag->isBeingDefined()) { 17036 assert(Tag->isInvalidDecl() && "We should already have completed it"); 17037 if (RecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Tag)) 17038 RD->completeDefinition(); 17039 } 17040 17041 if (auto *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Tag)) { 17042 FieldCollector->FinishClass(); 17043 if (RD->hasAttr<SYCLSpecialClassAttr>()) { 17044 auto *Def = RD->getDefinition(); 17045 assert(Def && "The record is expected to have a completed definition"); 17046 unsigned NumInitMethods = 0; 17047 for (auto *Method : Def->methods()) { 17048 if (!Method->getIdentifier()) 17049 continue; 17050 if (Method->getName() == "__init") 17051 NumInitMethods++; 17052 } 17053 if (NumInitMethods > 1 || !Def->hasInitMethod()) 17054 Diag(RD->getLocation(), diag::err_sycl_special_type_num_init_method); 17055 } 17056 } 17057 17058 // Exit this scope of this tag's definition. 17059 PopDeclContext(); 17060 17061 if (getCurLexicalContext()->isObjCContainer() && 17062 Tag->getDeclContext()->isFileContext()) 17063 Tag->setTopLevelDeclInObjCContainer(); 17064 17065 // Notify the consumer that we've defined a tag. 17066 if (!Tag->isInvalidDecl()) 17067 Consumer.HandleTagDeclDefinition(Tag); 17068 17069 // Clangs implementation of #pragma align(packed) differs in bitfield layout 17070 // from XLs and instead matches the XL #pragma pack(1) behavior. 17071 if (Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isOSAIX() && 17072 AlignPackStack.hasValue()) { 17073 AlignPackInfo APInfo = AlignPackStack.CurrentValue; 17074 // Only diagnose #pragma align(packed). 17075 if (!APInfo.IsAlignAttr() || APInfo.getAlignMode() != AlignPackInfo::Packed) 17076 return; 17077 const RecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Tag); 17078 if (!RD) 17079 return; 17080 // Only warn if there is at least 1 bitfield member. 17081 if (llvm::any_of(RD->fields(), 17082 [](const FieldDecl *FD) { return FD->isBitField(); })) 17083 Diag(BraceRange.getBegin(), diag::warn_pragma_align_not_xl_compatible); 17084 } 17085 } 17086 17087 void Sema::ActOnObjCContainerFinishDefinition() { 17088 // Exit this scope of this interface definition. 17089 PopDeclContext(); 17090 } 17091 17092 void Sema::ActOnObjCTemporaryExitContainerContext(ObjCContainerDecl *ObjCCtx) { 17093 assert(ObjCCtx == CurContext && "Mismatch of container contexts"); 17094 OriginalLexicalContext = ObjCCtx; 17095 ActOnObjCContainerFinishDefinition(); 17096 } 17097 17098 void Sema::ActOnObjCReenterContainerContext(ObjCContainerDecl *ObjCCtx) { 17099 ActOnObjCContainerStartDefinition(ObjCCtx); 17100 OriginalLexicalContext = nullptr; 17101 } 17102 17103 void Sema::ActOnTagDefinitionError(Scope *S, Decl *TagD) { 17104 AdjustDeclIfTemplate(TagD); 17105 TagDecl *Tag = cast<TagDecl>(TagD); 17106 Tag->setInvalidDecl(); 17107 17108 // Make sure we "complete" the definition even it is invalid. 17109 if (Tag->isBeingDefined()) { 17110 if (RecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Tag)) 17111 RD->completeDefinition(); 17112 } 17113 17114 // We're undoing ActOnTagStartDefinition here, not 17115 // ActOnStartCXXMemberDeclarations, so we don't have to mess with 17116 // the FieldCollector. 17117 17118 PopDeclContext(); 17119 } 17120 17121 // Note that FieldName may be null for anonymous bitfields. 17122 ExprResult Sema::VerifyBitField(SourceLocation FieldLoc, 17123 IdentifierInfo *FieldName, 17124 QualType FieldTy, bool IsMsStruct, 17125 Expr *BitWidth, bool *ZeroWidth) { 17126 assert(BitWidth); 17127 if (BitWidth->containsErrors()) 17128 return ExprError(); 17129 17130 // Default to true; that shouldn't confuse checks for emptiness 17131 if (ZeroWidth) 17132 *ZeroWidth = true; 17133 17134 // C99 6.7.2.1p4 - verify the field type. 17135 // C++ 9.6p3: A bit-field shall have integral or enumeration type. 17136 if (!FieldTy->isDependentType() && !FieldTy->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) { 17137 // Handle incomplete and sizeless types with a specific error. 17138 if (RequireCompleteSizedType(FieldLoc, FieldTy, 17139 diag::err_field_incomplete_or_sizeless)) 17140 return ExprError(); 17141 if (FieldName) 17142 return Diag(FieldLoc, diag::err_not_integral_type_bitfield) 17143 << FieldName << FieldTy << BitWidth->getSourceRange(); 17144 return Diag(FieldLoc, diag::err_not_integral_type_anon_bitfield) 17145 << FieldTy << BitWidth->getSourceRange(); 17146 } else if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(const_cast<Expr *>(BitWidth), 17147 UPPC_BitFieldWidth)) 17148 return ExprError(); 17149 17150 // If the bit-width is type- or value-dependent, don't try to check 17151 // it now. 17152 if (BitWidth->isValueDependent() || BitWidth->isTypeDependent()) 17153 return BitWidth; 17154 17155 llvm::APSInt Value; 17156 ExprResult ICE = VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(BitWidth, &Value, AllowFold); 17157 if (ICE.isInvalid()) 17158 return ICE; 17159 BitWidth = ICE.get(); 17160 17161 if (Value != 0 && ZeroWidth) 17162 *ZeroWidth = false; 17163 17164 // Zero-width bitfield is ok for anonymous field. 17165 if (Value == 0 && FieldName) 17166 return Diag(FieldLoc, diag::err_bitfield_has_zero_width) << FieldName; 17167 17168 if (Value.isSigned() && Value.isNegative()) { 17169 if (FieldName) 17170 return Diag(FieldLoc, diag::err_bitfield_has_negative_width) 17171 << FieldName << toString(Value, 10); 17172 return Diag(FieldLoc, diag::err_anon_bitfield_has_negative_width) 17173 << toString(Value, 10); 17174 } 17175 17176 // The size of the bit-field must not exceed our maximum permitted object 17177 // size. 17178 if (Value.getActiveBits() > ConstantArrayType::getMaxSizeBits(Context)) { 17179 return Diag(FieldLoc, diag::err_bitfield_too_wide) 17180 << !FieldName << FieldName << toString(Value, 10); 17181 } 17182 17183 if (!FieldTy->isDependentType()) { 17184 uint64_t TypeStorageSize = Context.getTypeSize(FieldTy); 17185 uint64_t TypeWidth = Context.getIntWidth(FieldTy); 17186 bool BitfieldIsOverwide = Value.ugt(TypeWidth); 17187 17188 // Over-wide bitfields are an error in C or when using the MSVC bitfield 17189 // ABI. 17190 bool CStdConstraintViolation = 17191 BitfieldIsOverwide && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus; 17192 bool MSBitfieldViolation = 17193 Value.ugt(TypeStorageSize) && 17194 (IsMsStruct || Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft()); 17195 if (CStdConstraintViolation || MSBitfieldViolation) { 17196 unsigned DiagWidth = 17197 CStdConstraintViolation ? TypeWidth : TypeStorageSize; 17198 return Diag(FieldLoc, diag::err_bitfield_width_exceeds_type_width) 17199 << (bool)FieldName << FieldName << toString(Value, 10) 17200 << !CStdConstraintViolation << DiagWidth; 17201 } 17202 17203 // Warn on types where the user might conceivably expect to get all 17204 // specified bits as value bits: that's all integral types other than 17205 // 'bool'. 17206 if (BitfieldIsOverwide && !FieldTy->isBooleanType() && FieldName) { 17207 Diag(FieldLoc, diag::warn_bitfield_width_exceeds_type_width) 17208 << FieldName << toString(Value, 10) 17209 << (unsigned)TypeWidth; 17210 } 17211 } 17212 17213 return BitWidth; 17214 } 17215 17216 /// ActOnField - Each field of a C struct/union is passed into this in order 17217 /// to create a FieldDecl object for it. 17218 Decl *Sema::ActOnField(Scope *S, Decl *TagD, SourceLocation DeclStart, 17219 Declarator &D, Expr *BitfieldWidth) { 17220 FieldDecl *Res = HandleField(S, cast_or_null<RecordDecl>(TagD), 17221 DeclStart, D, static_cast<Expr*>(BitfieldWidth), 17222 /*InitStyle=*/ICIS_NoInit, AS_public); 17223 return Res; 17224 } 17225 17226 /// HandleField - Analyze a field of a C struct or a C++ data member. 17227 /// 17228 FieldDecl *Sema::HandleField(Scope *S, RecordDecl *Record, 17229 SourceLocation DeclStart, 17230 Declarator &D, Expr *BitWidth, 17231 InClassInitStyle InitStyle, 17232 AccessSpecifier AS) { 17233 if (D.isDecompositionDeclarator()) { 17234 const DecompositionDeclarator &Decomp = D.getDecompositionDeclarator(); 17235 Diag(Decomp.getLSquareLoc(), diag::err_decomp_decl_context) 17236 << Decomp.getSourceRange(); 17237 return nullptr; 17238 } 17239 17240 IdentifierInfo *II = D.getIdentifier(); 17241 SourceLocation Loc = DeclStart; 17242 if (II) Loc = D.getIdentifierLoc(); 17243 17244 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = GetTypeForDeclarator(D, S); 17245 QualType T = TInfo->getType(); 17246 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 17247 CheckExtraCXXDefaultArguments(D); 17248 17249 if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(D.getIdentifierLoc(), TInfo, 17250 UPPC_DataMemberType)) { 17251 D.setInvalidType(); 17252 T = Context.IntTy; 17253 TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T, Loc); 17254 } 17255 } 17256 17257 DiagnoseFunctionSpecifiers(D.getDeclSpec()); 17258 17259 if (D.getDeclSpec().isInlineSpecified()) 17260 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc(), diag::err_inline_non_function) 17261 << getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17; 17262 if (DeclSpec::TSCS TSCS = D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpec()) 17263 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(), 17264 diag::err_invalid_thread) 17265 << DeclSpec::getSpecifierName(TSCS); 17266 17267 // Check to see if this name was declared as a member previously 17268 NamedDecl *PrevDecl = nullptr; 17269 LookupResult Previous(*this, II, Loc, LookupMemberName, 17270 ForVisibleRedeclaration); 17271 LookupName(Previous, S); 17272 switch (Previous.getResultKind()) { 17273 case LookupResult::Found: 17274 case LookupResult::FoundUnresolvedValue: 17275 PrevDecl = Previous.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>(); 17276 break; 17277 17278 case LookupResult::FoundOverloaded: 17279 PrevDecl = Previous.getRepresentativeDecl(); 17280 break; 17281 17282 case LookupResult::NotFound: 17283 case LookupResult::NotFoundInCurrentInstantiation: 17284 case LookupResult::Ambiguous: 17285 break; 17286 } 17287 Previous.suppressDiagnostics(); 17288 17289 if (PrevDecl && PrevDecl->isTemplateParameter()) { 17290 // Maybe we will complain about the shadowed template parameter. 17291 DiagnoseTemplateParameterShadow(D.getIdentifierLoc(), PrevDecl); 17292 // Just pretend that we didn't see the previous declaration. 17293 PrevDecl = nullptr; 17294 } 17295 17296 if (PrevDecl && !isDeclInScope(PrevDecl, Record, S)) 17297 PrevDecl = nullptr; 17298 17299 bool Mutable 17300 = (D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_mutable); 17301 SourceLocation TSSL = D.getBeginLoc(); 17302 FieldDecl *NewFD 17303 = CheckFieldDecl(II, T, TInfo, Record, Loc, Mutable, BitWidth, InitStyle, 17304 TSSL, AS, PrevDecl, &D); 17305 17306 if (NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) 17307 Record->setInvalidDecl(); 17308 17309 if (D.getDeclSpec().isModulePrivateSpecified()) 17310 NewFD->setModulePrivate(); 17311 17312 if (NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && PrevDecl) { 17313 // Don't introduce NewFD into scope; there's already something 17314 // with the same name in the same scope. 17315 } else if (II) { 17316 PushOnScopeChains(NewFD, S); 17317 } else 17318 Record->addDecl(NewFD); 17319 17320 return NewFD; 17321 } 17322 17323 /// Build a new FieldDecl and check its well-formedness. 17324 /// 17325 /// This routine builds a new FieldDecl given the fields name, type, 17326 /// record, etc. \p PrevDecl should refer to any previous declaration 17327 /// with the same name and in the same scope as the field to be 17328 /// created. 17329 /// 17330 /// \returns a new FieldDecl. 17331 /// 17332 /// \todo The Declarator argument is a hack. It will be removed once 17333 FieldDecl *Sema::CheckFieldDecl(DeclarationName Name, QualType T, 17334 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, 17335 RecordDecl *Record, SourceLocation Loc, 17336 bool Mutable, Expr *BitWidth, 17337 InClassInitStyle InitStyle, 17338 SourceLocation TSSL, 17339 AccessSpecifier AS, NamedDecl *PrevDecl, 17340 Declarator *D) { 17341 IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo(); 17342 bool InvalidDecl = false; 17343 if (D) InvalidDecl = D->isInvalidType(); 17344 17345 // If we receive a broken type, recover by assuming 'int' and 17346 // marking this declaration as invalid. 17347 if (T.isNull() || T->containsErrors()) { 17348 InvalidDecl = true; 17349 T = Context.IntTy; 17350 } 17351 17352 QualType EltTy = Context.getBaseElementType(T); 17353 if (!EltTy->isDependentType() && !EltTy->containsErrors()) { 17354 if (RequireCompleteSizedType(Loc, EltTy, 17355 diag::err_field_incomplete_or_sizeless)) { 17356 // Fields of incomplete type force their record to be invalid. 17357 Record->setInvalidDecl(); 17358 InvalidDecl = true; 17359 } else { 17360 NamedDecl *Def; 17361 EltTy->isIncompleteType(&Def); 17362 if (Def && Def->isInvalidDecl()) { 17363 Record->setInvalidDecl(); 17364 InvalidDecl = true; 17365 } 17366 } 17367 } 17368 17369 // TR 18037 does not allow fields to be declared with address space 17370 if (T.hasAddressSpace() || T->isDependentAddressSpaceType() || 17371 T->getBaseElementTypeUnsafe()->isDependentAddressSpaceType()) { 17372 Diag(Loc, diag::err_field_with_address_space); 17373 Record->setInvalidDecl(); 17374 InvalidDecl = true; 17375 } 17376 17377 if (LangOpts.OpenCL) { 17378 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9b,r & OpenCL v2.0 s6.12.5 - The following types cannot be 17379 // used as structure or union field: image, sampler, event or block types. 17380 if (T->isEventT() || T->isImageType() || T->isSamplerT() || 17381 T->isBlockPointerType()) { 17382 Diag(Loc, diag::err_opencl_type_struct_or_union_field) << T; 17383 Record->setInvalidDecl(); 17384 InvalidDecl = true; 17385 } 17386 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9.c: bitfields are not supported, unless Clang extension 17387 // is enabled. 17388 if (BitWidth && !getOpenCLOptions().isAvailableOption( 17389 "__cl_clang_bitfields", LangOpts)) { 17390 Diag(Loc, diag::err_opencl_bitfields); 17391 InvalidDecl = true; 17392 } 17393 } 17394 17395 // Anonymous bit-fields cannot be cv-qualified (CWG 2229). 17396 if (!InvalidDecl && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !II && BitWidth && 17397 T.hasQualifiers()) { 17398 InvalidDecl = true; 17399 Diag(Loc, diag::err_anon_bitfield_qualifiers); 17400 } 17401 17402 // C99 6.7.2.1p8: A member of a structure or union may have any type other 17403 // than a variably modified type. 17404 if (!InvalidDecl && T->isVariablyModifiedType()) { 17405 if (!tryToFixVariablyModifiedVarType( 17406 TInfo, T, Loc, diag::err_typecheck_field_variable_size)) 17407 InvalidDecl = true; 17408 } 17409 17410 // Fields can not have abstract class types 17411 if (!InvalidDecl && RequireNonAbstractType(Loc, T, 17412 diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl, 17413 AbstractFieldType)) 17414 InvalidDecl = true; 17415 17416 bool ZeroWidth = false; 17417 if (InvalidDecl) 17418 BitWidth = nullptr; 17419 // If this is declared as a bit-field, check the bit-field. 17420 if (BitWidth) { 17421 BitWidth = VerifyBitField(Loc, II, T, Record->isMsStruct(Context), BitWidth, 17422 &ZeroWidth).get(); 17423 if (!BitWidth) { 17424 InvalidDecl = true; 17425 BitWidth = nullptr; 17426 ZeroWidth = false; 17427 } 17428 } 17429 17430 // Check that 'mutable' is consistent with the type of the declaration. 17431 if (!InvalidDecl && Mutable) { 17432 unsigned DiagID = 0; 17433 if (T->isReferenceType()) 17434 DiagID = getLangOpts().MSVCCompat ? diag::ext_mutable_reference 17435 : diag::err_mutable_reference; 17436 else if (T.isConstQualified()) 17437 DiagID = diag::err_mutable_const; 17438 17439 if (DiagID) { 17440 SourceLocation ErrLoc = Loc; 17441 if (D && D->getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc().isValid()) 17442 ErrLoc = D->getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(); 17443 Diag(ErrLoc, DiagID); 17444 if (DiagID != diag::ext_mutable_reference) { 17445 Mutable = false; 17446 InvalidDecl = true; 17447 } 17448 } 17449 } 17450 17451 // C++11 [class.union]p8 (DR1460): 17452 // At most one variant member of a union may have a 17453 // brace-or-equal-initializer. 17454 if (InitStyle != ICIS_NoInit) 17455 checkDuplicateDefaultInit(*this, cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record), Loc); 17456 17457 FieldDecl *NewFD = FieldDecl::Create(Context, Record, TSSL, Loc, II, T, TInfo, 17458 BitWidth, Mutable, InitStyle); 17459 if (InvalidDecl) 17460 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 17461 17462 if (PrevDecl && !isa<TagDecl>(PrevDecl)) { 17463 Diag(Loc, diag::err_duplicate_member) << II; 17464 Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 17465 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 17466 } 17467 17468 if (!InvalidDecl && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 17469 if (Record->isUnion()) { 17470 if (const RecordType *RT = EltTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { 17471 CXXRecordDecl* RDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RT->getDecl()); 17472 if (RDecl->getDefinition()) { 17473 // C++ [class.union]p1: An object of a class with a non-trivial 17474 // constructor, a non-trivial copy constructor, a non-trivial 17475 // destructor, or a non-trivial copy assignment operator 17476 // cannot be a member of a union, nor can an array of such 17477 // objects. 17478 if (CheckNontrivialField(NewFD)) 17479 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 17480 } 17481 } 17482 17483 // C++ [class.union]p1: If a union contains a member of reference type, 17484 // the program is ill-formed, except when compiling with MSVC extensions 17485 // enabled. 17486 if (EltTy->isReferenceType()) { 17487 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt ? 17488 diag::ext_union_member_of_reference_type : 17489 diag::err_union_member_of_reference_type) 17490 << NewFD->getDeclName() << EltTy; 17491 if (!getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt) 17492 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 17493 } 17494 } 17495 } 17496 17497 // FIXME: We need to pass in the attributes given an AST 17498 // representation, not a parser representation. 17499 if (D) { 17500 // FIXME: The current scope is almost... but not entirely... correct here. 17501 ProcessDeclAttributes(getCurScope(), NewFD, *D); 17502 17503 if (NewFD->hasAttrs()) 17504 CheckAlignasUnderalignment(NewFD); 17505 } 17506 17507 // In auto-retain/release, infer strong retension for fields of 17508 // retainable type. 17509 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && inferObjCARCLifetime(NewFD)) 17510 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 17511 17512 if (T.isObjCGCWeak()) 17513 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_attribute_weak_on_field); 17514 17515 // PPC MMA non-pointer types are not allowed as field types. 17516 if (Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isPPC64() && 17517 CheckPPCMMAType(T, NewFD->getLocation())) 17518 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 17519 17520 NewFD->setAccess(AS); 17521 return NewFD; 17522 } 17523 17524 bool Sema::CheckNontrivialField(FieldDecl *FD) { 17525 assert(FD); 17526 assert(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "valid check only for C++"); 17527 17528 if (FD->isInvalidDecl() || FD->getType()->isDependentType()) 17529 return false; 17530 17531 QualType EltTy = Context.getBaseElementType(FD->getType()); 17532 if (const RecordType *RT = EltTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { 17533 CXXRecordDecl *RDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RT->getDecl()); 17534 if (RDecl->getDefinition()) { 17535 // We check for copy constructors before constructors 17536 // because otherwise we'll never get complaints about 17537 // copy constructors. 17538 17539 CXXSpecialMember member = CXXInvalid; 17540 // We're required to check for any non-trivial constructors. Since the 17541 // implicit default constructor is suppressed if there are any 17542 // user-declared constructors, we just need to check that there is a 17543 // trivial default constructor and a trivial copy constructor. (We don't 17544 // worry about move constructors here, since this is a C++98 check.) 17545 if (RDecl->hasNonTrivialCopyConstructor()) 17546 member = CXXCopyConstructor; 17547 else if (!RDecl->hasTrivialDefaultConstructor()) 17548 member = CXXDefaultConstructor; 17549 else if (RDecl->hasNonTrivialCopyAssignment()) 17550 member = CXXCopyAssignment; 17551 else if (RDecl->hasNonTrivialDestructor()) 17552 member = CXXDestructor; 17553 17554 if (member != CXXInvalid) { 17555 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && 17556 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && RDecl->hasObjectMember()) { 17557 // Objective-C++ ARC: it is an error to have a non-trivial field of 17558 // a union. However, system headers in Objective-C programs 17559 // occasionally have Objective-C lifetime objects within unions, 17560 // and rather than cause the program to fail, we make those 17561 // members unavailable. 17562 SourceLocation Loc = FD->getLocation(); 17563 if (getSourceManager().isInSystemHeader(Loc)) { 17564 if (!FD->hasAttr<UnavailableAttr>()) 17565 FD->addAttr(UnavailableAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, "", 17566 UnavailableAttr::IR_ARCFieldWithOwnership, Loc)); 17567 return false; 17568 } 17569 } 17570 17571 Diag(FD->getLocation(), getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 ? 17572 diag::warn_cxx98_compat_nontrivial_union_or_anon_struct_member : 17573 diag::err_illegal_union_or_anon_struct_member) 17574 << FD->getParent()->isUnion() << FD->getDeclName() << member; 17575 DiagnoseNontrivial(RDecl, member); 17576 return !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11; 17577 } 17578 } 17579 } 17580 17581 return false; 17582 } 17583 17584 /// TranslateIvarVisibility - Translate visibility from a token ID to an 17585 /// AST enum value. 17586 static ObjCIvarDecl::AccessControl 17587 TranslateIvarVisibility(tok::ObjCKeywordKind ivarVisibility) { 17588 switch (ivarVisibility) { 17589 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown visitibility kind"); 17590 case tok::objc_private: return ObjCIvarDecl::Private; 17591 case tok::objc_public: return ObjCIvarDecl::Public; 17592 case tok::objc_protected: return ObjCIvarDecl::Protected; 17593 case tok::objc_package: return ObjCIvarDecl::Package; 17594 } 17595 } 17596 17597 /// ActOnIvar - Each ivar field of an objective-c class is passed into this 17598 /// in order to create an IvarDecl object for it. 17599 Decl *Sema::ActOnIvar(Scope *S, 17600 SourceLocation DeclStart, 17601 Declarator &D, Expr *BitfieldWidth, 17602 tok::ObjCKeywordKind Visibility) { 17603 17604 IdentifierInfo *II = D.getIdentifier(); 17605 Expr *BitWidth = (Expr*)BitfieldWidth; 17606 SourceLocation Loc = DeclStart; 17607 if (II) Loc = D.getIdentifierLoc(); 17608 17609 // FIXME: Unnamed fields can be handled in various different ways, for 17610 // example, unnamed unions inject all members into the struct namespace! 17611 17612 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = GetTypeForDeclarator(D, S); 17613 QualType T = TInfo->getType(); 17614 17615 if (BitWidth) { 17616 // 6.7.2.1p3, 6.7.2.1p4 17617 BitWidth = VerifyBitField(Loc, II, T, /*IsMsStruct*/false, BitWidth).get(); 17618 if (!BitWidth) 17619 D.setInvalidType(); 17620 } else { 17621 // Not a bitfield. 17622 17623 // validate II. 17624 17625 } 17626 if (T->isReferenceType()) { 17627 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ivar_reference_type); 17628 D.setInvalidType(); 17629 } 17630 // C99 6.7.2.1p8: A member of a structure or union may have any type other 17631 // than a variably modified type. 17632 else if (T->isVariablyModifiedType()) { 17633 if (!tryToFixVariablyModifiedVarType( 17634 TInfo, T, Loc, diag::err_typecheck_ivar_variable_size)) 17635 D.setInvalidType(); 17636 } 17637 17638 // Get the visibility (access control) for this ivar. 17639 ObjCIvarDecl::AccessControl ac = 17640 Visibility != tok::objc_not_keyword ? TranslateIvarVisibility(Visibility) 17641 : ObjCIvarDecl::None; 17642 // Must set ivar's DeclContext to its enclosing interface. 17643 ObjCContainerDecl *EnclosingDecl = cast<ObjCContainerDecl>(CurContext); 17644 if (!EnclosingDecl || EnclosingDecl->isInvalidDecl()) 17645 return nullptr; 17646 ObjCContainerDecl *EnclosingContext; 17647 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *IMPDecl = 17648 dyn_cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(EnclosingDecl)) { 17649 if (LangOpts.ObjCRuntime.isFragile()) { 17650 // Case of ivar declared in an implementation. Context is that of its class. 17651 EnclosingContext = IMPDecl->getClassInterface(); 17652 assert(EnclosingContext && "Implementation has no class interface!"); 17653 } 17654 else 17655 EnclosingContext = EnclosingDecl; 17656 } else { 17657 if (ObjCCategoryDecl *CDecl = 17658 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(EnclosingDecl)) { 17659 if (LangOpts.ObjCRuntime.isFragile() || !CDecl->IsClassExtension()) { 17660 Diag(Loc, diag::err_misplaced_ivar) << CDecl->IsClassExtension(); 17661 return nullptr; 17662 } 17663 } 17664 EnclosingContext = EnclosingDecl; 17665 } 17666 17667 // Construct the decl. 17668 ObjCIvarDecl *NewID = ObjCIvarDecl::Create(Context, EnclosingContext, 17669 DeclStart, Loc, II, T, 17670 TInfo, ac, (Expr *)BitfieldWidth); 17671 17672 if (II) { 17673 NamedDecl *PrevDecl = LookupSingleName(S, II, Loc, LookupMemberName, 17674 ForVisibleRedeclaration); 17675 if (PrevDecl && isDeclInScope(PrevDecl, EnclosingContext, S) 17676 && !isa<TagDecl>(PrevDecl)) { 17677 Diag(Loc, diag::err_duplicate_member) << II; 17678 Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 17679 NewID->setInvalidDecl(); 17680 } 17681 } 17682 17683 // Process attributes attached to the ivar. 17684 ProcessDeclAttributes(S, NewID, D); 17685 17686 if (D.isInvalidType()) 17687 NewID->setInvalidDecl(); 17688 17689 // In ARC, infer 'retaining' for ivars of retainable type. 17690 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && inferObjCARCLifetime(NewID)) 17691 NewID->setInvalidDecl(); 17692 17693 if (D.getDeclSpec().isModulePrivateSpecified()) 17694 NewID->setModulePrivate(); 17695 17696 if (II) { 17697 // FIXME: When interfaces are DeclContexts, we'll need to add 17698 // these to the interface. 17699 S->AddDecl(NewID); 17700 IdResolver.AddDecl(NewID); 17701 } 17702 17703 if (LangOpts.ObjCRuntime.isNonFragile() && 17704 !NewID->isInvalidDecl() && isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(EnclosingDecl)) 17705 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_ivars_in_interface); 17706 17707 return NewID; 17708 } 17709 17710 /// ActOnLastBitfield - This routine handles synthesized bitfields rules for 17711 /// class and class extensions. For every class \@interface and class 17712 /// extension \@interface, if the last ivar is a bitfield of any type, 17713 /// then add an implicit `char :0` ivar to the end of that interface. 17714 void Sema::ActOnLastBitfield(SourceLocation DeclLoc, 17715 SmallVectorImpl<Decl *> &AllIvarDecls) { 17716 if (LangOpts.ObjCRuntime.isFragile() || AllIvarDecls.empty()) 17717 return; 17718 17719 Decl *ivarDecl = AllIvarDecls[AllIvarDecls.size()-1]; 17720 ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = cast<ObjCIvarDecl>(ivarDecl); 17721 17722 if (!Ivar->isBitField() || Ivar->isZeroLengthBitField(Context)) 17723 return; 17724 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(CurContext); 17725 if (!ID) { 17726 if (ObjCCategoryDecl *CD = dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(CurContext)) { 17727 if (!CD->IsClassExtension()) 17728 return; 17729 } 17730 // No need to add this to end of @implementation. 17731 else 17732 return; 17733 } 17734 // All conditions are met. Add a new bitfield to the tail end of ivars. 17735 llvm::APInt Zero(Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy), 0); 17736 Expr * BW = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, Zero, Context.IntTy, DeclLoc); 17737 17738 Ivar = ObjCIvarDecl::Create(Context, cast<ObjCContainerDecl>(CurContext), 17739 DeclLoc, DeclLoc, nullptr, 17740 Context.CharTy, 17741 Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(Context.CharTy, 17742 DeclLoc), 17743 ObjCIvarDecl::Private, BW, 17744 true); 17745 AllIvarDecls.push_back(Ivar); 17746 } 17747 17748 void Sema::ActOnFields(Scope *S, SourceLocation RecLoc, Decl *EnclosingDecl, 17749 ArrayRef<Decl *> Fields, SourceLocation LBrac, 17750 SourceLocation RBrac, 17751 const ParsedAttributesView &Attrs) { 17752 assert(EnclosingDecl && "missing record or interface decl"); 17753 17754 // If this is an Objective-C @implementation or category and we have 17755 // new fields here we should reset the layout of the interface since 17756 // it will now change. 17757 if (!Fields.empty() && isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(EnclosingDecl)) { 17758 ObjCContainerDecl *DC = cast<ObjCContainerDecl>(EnclosingDecl); 17759 switch (DC->getKind()) { 17760 default: break; 17761 case Decl::ObjCCategory: 17762 Context.ResetObjCLayout(cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(DC)->getClassInterface()); 17763 break; 17764 case Decl::ObjCImplementation: 17765 Context. 17766 ResetObjCLayout(cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(DC)->getClassInterface()); 17767 break; 17768 } 17769 } 17770 17771 RecordDecl *Record = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(EnclosingDecl); 17772 CXXRecordDecl *CXXRecord = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(EnclosingDecl); 17773 17774 // Start counting up the number of named members; make sure to include 17775 // members of anonymous structs and unions in the total. 17776 unsigned NumNamedMembers = 0; 17777 if (Record) { 17778 for (const auto *I : Record->decls()) { 17779 if (const auto *IFD = dyn_cast<IndirectFieldDecl>(I)) 17780 if (IFD->getDeclName()) 17781 ++NumNamedMembers; 17782 } 17783 } 17784 17785 // Verify that all the fields are okay. 17786 SmallVector<FieldDecl*, 32> RecFields; 17787 17788 for (ArrayRef<Decl *>::iterator i = Fields.begin(), end = Fields.end(); 17789 i != end; ++i) { 17790 FieldDecl *FD = cast<FieldDecl>(*i); 17791 17792 // Get the type for the field. 17793 const Type *FDTy = FD->getType().getTypePtr(); 17794 17795 if (!FD->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) { 17796 // Remember all fields written by the user. 17797 RecFields.push_back(FD); 17798 } 17799 17800 // If the field is already invalid for some reason, don't emit more 17801 // diagnostics about it. 17802 if (FD->isInvalidDecl()) { 17803 EnclosingDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 17804 continue; 17805 } 17806 17807 // C99 6.7.2.1p2: 17808 // A structure or union shall not contain a member with 17809 // incomplete or function type (hence, a structure shall not 17810 // contain an instance of itself, but may contain a pointer to 17811 // an instance of itself), except that the last member of a 17812 // structure with more than one named member may have incomplete 17813 // array type; such a structure (and any union containing, 17814 // possibly recursively, a member that is such a structure) 17815 // shall not be a member of a structure or an element of an 17816 // array. 17817 bool IsLastField = (i + 1 == Fields.end()); 17818 if (FDTy->isFunctionType()) { 17819 // Field declared as a function. 17820 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_field_declared_as_function) 17821 << FD->getDeclName(); 17822 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 17823 EnclosingDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 17824 continue; 17825 } else if (FDTy->isIncompleteArrayType() && 17826 (Record || isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(EnclosingDecl))) { 17827 if (Record) { 17828 // Flexible array member. 17829 // Microsoft and g++ is more permissive regarding flexible array. 17830 // It will accept flexible array in union and also 17831 // as the sole element of a struct/class. 17832 unsigned DiagID = 0; 17833 if (!Record->isUnion() && !IsLastField) { 17834 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_flexible_array_not_at_end) 17835 << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType() << Record->getTagKind(); 17836 Diag((*(i + 1))->getLocation(), diag::note_next_field_declaration); 17837 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 17838 EnclosingDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 17839 continue; 17840 } else if (Record->isUnion()) 17841 DiagID = getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt 17842 ? diag::ext_flexible_array_union_ms 17843 : getLangOpts().CPlusPlus 17844 ? diag::ext_flexible_array_union_gnu 17845 : diag::err_flexible_array_union; 17846 else if (NumNamedMembers < 1) 17847 DiagID = getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt 17848 ? diag::ext_flexible_array_empty_aggregate_ms 17849 : getLangOpts().CPlusPlus 17850 ? diag::ext_flexible_array_empty_aggregate_gnu 17851 : diag::err_flexible_array_empty_aggregate; 17852 17853 if (DiagID) 17854 Diag(FD->getLocation(), DiagID) << FD->getDeclName() 17855 << Record->getTagKind(); 17856 // While the layout of types that contain virtual bases is not specified 17857 // by the C++ standard, both the Itanium and Microsoft C++ ABIs place 17858 // virtual bases after the derived members. This would make a flexible 17859 // array member declared at the end of an object not adjacent to the end 17860 // of the type. 17861 if (CXXRecord && CXXRecord->getNumVBases() != 0) 17862 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_flexible_array_virtual_base) 17863 << FD->getDeclName() << Record->getTagKind(); 17864 if (!getLangOpts().C99) 17865 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::ext_c99_flexible_array_member) 17866 << FD->getDeclName() << Record->getTagKind(); 17867 17868 // If the element type has a non-trivial destructor, we would not 17869 // implicitly destroy the elements, so disallow it for now. 17870 // 17871 // FIXME: GCC allows this. We should probably either implicitly delete 17872 // the destructor of the containing class, or just allow this. 17873 QualType BaseElem = Context.getBaseElementType(FD->getType()); 17874 if (!BaseElem->isDependentType() && BaseElem.isDestructedType()) { 17875 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_flexible_array_has_nontrivial_dtor) 17876 << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType(); 17877 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 17878 EnclosingDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 17879 continue; 17880 } 17881 // Okay, we have a legal flexible array member at the end of the struct. 17882 Record->setHasFlexibleArrayMember(true); 17883 } else { 17884 // In ObjCContainerDecl ivars with incomplete array type are accepted, 17885 // unless they are followed by another ivar. That check is done 17886 // elsewhere, after synthesized ivars are known. 17887 } 17888 } else if (!FDTy->isDependentType() && 17889 RequireCompleteSizedType( 17890 FD->getLocation(), FD->getType(), 17891 diag::err_field_incomplete_or_sizeless)) { 17892 // Incomplete type 17893 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 17894 EnclosingDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 17895 continue; 17896 } else if (const RecordType *FDTTy = FDTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { 17897 if (Record && FDTTy->getDecl()->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) { 17898 // A type which contains a flexible array member is considered to be a 17899 // flexible array member. 17900 Record->setHasFlexibleArrayMember(true); 17901 if (!Record->isUnion()) { 17902 // If this is a struct/class and this is not the last element, reject 17903 // it. Note that GCC supports variable sized arrays in the middle of 17904 // structures. 17905 if (!IsLastField) 17906 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::ext_variable_sized_type_in_struct) 17907 << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType(); 17908 else { 17909 // We support flexible arrays at the end of structs in 17910 // other structs as an extension. 17911 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::ext_flexible_array_in_struct) 17912 << FD->getDeclName(); 17913 } 17914 } 17915 } 17916 if (isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(EnclosingDecl) && 17917 RequireNonAbstractType(FD->getLocation(), FD->getType(), 17918 diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl, 17919 AbstractIvarType)) { 17920 // Ivars can not have abstract class types 17921 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 17922 } 17923 if (Record && FDTTy->getDecl()->hasObjectMember()) 17924 Record->setHasObjectMember(true); 17925 if (Record && FDTTy->getDecl()->hasVolatileMember()) 17926 Record->setHasVolatileMember(true); 17927 } else if (FDTy->isObjCObjectType()) { 17928 /// A field cannot be an Objective-c object 17929 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_statically_allocated_object) 17930 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FD->getLocation(), "*"); 17931 QualType T = Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(FD->getType()); 17932 FD->setType(T); 17933 } else if (Record && Record->isUnion() && 17934 FD->getType().hasNonTrivialObjCLifetime() && 17935 getSourceManager().isInSystemHeader(FD->getLocation()) && 17936 !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !FD->hasAttr<UnavailableAttr>() && 17937 (FD->getType().getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Strong || 17938 !Context.hasDirectOwnershipQualifier(FD->getType()))) { 17939 // For backward compatibility, fields of C unions declared in system 17940 // headers that have non-trivial ObjC ownership qualifications are marked 17941 // as unavailable unless the qualifier is explicit and __strong. This can 17942 // break ABI compatibility between programs compiled with ARC and MRR, but 17943 // is a better option than rejecting programs using those unions under 17944 // ARC. 17945 FD->addAttr(UnavailableAttr::CreateImplicit( 17946 Context, "", UnavailableAttr::IR_ARCFieldWithOwnership, 17947 FD->getLocation())); 17948 } else if (getLangOpts().ObjC && 17949 getLangOpts().getGC() != LangOptions::NonGC && Record && 17950 !Record->hasObjectMember()) { 17951 if (FD->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() || 17952 FD->getType().isObjCGCStrong()) 17953 Record->setHasObjectMember(true); 17954 else if (Context.getAsArrayType(FD->getType())) { 17955 QualType BaseType = Context.getBaseElementType(FD->getType()); 17956 if (BaseType->isRecordType() && 17957 BaseType->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()->hasObjectMember()) 17958 Record->setHasObjectMember(true); 17959 else if (BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || 17960 BaseType.isObjCGCStrong()) 17961 Record->setHasObjectMember(true); 17962 } 17963 } 17964 17965 if (Record && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 17966 !shouldIgnoreForRecordTriviality(FD)) { 17967 QualType FT = FD->getType(); 17968 if (FT.isNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitialize()) { 17969 Record->setNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitialize(true); 17970 if (FT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion() || 17971 Record->isUnion()) 17972 Record->setHasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion(true); 17973 } 17974 QualType::PrimitiveCopyKind PCK = FT.isNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopy(); 17975 if (PCK != QualType::PCK_Trivial && PCK != QualType::PCK_VolatileTrivial) { 17976 Record->setNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopy(true); 17977 if (FT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion() || Record->isUnion()) 17978 Record->setHasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion(true); 17979 } 17980 if (FT.isDestructedType()) { 17981 Record->setNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestroy(true); 17982 Record->setParamDestroyedInCallee(true); 17983 if (FT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion() || Record->isUnion()) 17984 Record->setHasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion(true); 17985 } 17986 17987 if (const auto *RT = FT->getAs<RecordType>()) { 17988 if (RT->getDecl()->getArgPassingRestrictions() == 17989 RecordDecl::APK_CanNeverPassInRegs) 17990 Record->setArgPassingRestrictions(RecordDecl::APK_CanNeverPassInRegs); 17991 } else if (FT.getQualifiers().getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Weak) 17992 Record->setArgPassingRestrictions(RecordDecl::APK_CanNeverPassInRegs); 17993 } 17994 17995 if (Record && FD->getType().isVolatileQualified()) 17996 Record->setHasVolatileMember(true); 17997 // Keep track of the number of named members. 17998 if (FD->getIdentifier()) 17999 ++NumNamedMembers; 18000 } 18001 18002 // Okay, we successfully defined 'Record'. 18003 if (Record) { 18004 bool Completed = false; 18005 if (CXXRecord) { 18006 if (!CXXRecord->isInvalidDecl()) { 18007 // Set access bits correctly on the directly-declared conversions. 18008 for (CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator 18009 I = CXXRecord->conversion_begin(), 18010 E = CXXRecord->conversion_end(); I != E; ++I) 18011 I.setAccess((*I)->getAccess()); 18012 } 18013 18014 // Add any implicitly-declared members to this class. 18015 AddImplicitlyDeclaredMembersToClass(CXXRecord); 18016 18017 if (!CXXRecord->isDependentType()) { 18018 if (!CXXRecord->isInvalidDecl()) { 18019 // If we have virtual base classes, we may end up finding multiple 18020 // final overriders for a given virtual function. Check for this 18021 // problem now. 18022 if (CXXRecord->getNumVBases()) { 18023 CXXFinalOverriderMap FinalOverriders; 18024 CXXRecord->getFinalOverriders(FinalOverriders); 18025 18026 for (CXXFinalOverriderMap::iterator M = FinalOverriders.begin(), 18027 MEnd = FinalOverriders.end(); 18028 M != MEnd; ++M) { 18029 for (OverridingMethods::iterator SO = M->second.begin(), 18030 SOEnd = M->second.end(); 18031 SO != SOEnd; ++SO) { 18032 assert(SO->second.size() > 0 && 18033 "Virtual function without overriding functions?"); 18034 if (SO->second.size() == 1) 18035 continue; 18036 18037 // C++ [class.virtual]p2: 18038 // In a derived class, if a virtual member function of a base 18039 // class subobject has more than one final overrider the 18040 // program is ill-formed. 18041 Diag(Record->getLocation(), diag::err_multiple_final_overriders) 18042 << (const NamedDecl *)M->first << Record; 18043 Diag(M->first->getLocation(), 18044 diag::note_overridden_virtual_function); 18045 for (OverridingMethods::overriding_iterator 18046 OM = SO->second.begin(), 18047 OMEnd = SO->second.end(); 18048 OM != OMEnd; ++OM) 18049 Diag(OM->Method->getLocation(), diag::note_final_overrider) 18050 << (const NamedDecl *)M->first << OM->Method->getParent(); 18051 18052 Record->setInvalidDecl(); 18053 } 18054 } 18055 CXXRecord->completeDefinition(&FinalOverriders); 18056 Completed = true; 18057 } 18058 } 18059 } 18060 } 18061 18062 if (!Completed) 18063 Record->completeDefinition(); 18064 18065 // Handle attributes before checking the layout. 18066 ProcessDeclAttributeList(S, Record, Attrs); 18067 18068 // Check to see if a FieldDecl is a pointer to a function. 18069 auto IsFunctionPointer = [&](const Decl *D) { 18070 const FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(D); 18071 if (!FD) 18072 return false; 18073 QualType FieldType = FD->getType().getDesugaredType(Context); 18074 if (isa<PointerType>(FieldType)) { 18075 QualType PointeeType = cast<PointerType>(FieldType)->getPointeeType(); 18076 return PointeeType.getDesugaredType(Context)->isFunctionType(); 18077 } 18078 return false; 18079 }; 18080 18081 // Maybe randomize the record's decls. We automatically randomize a record 18082 // of function pointers, unless it has the "no_randomize_layout" attribute. 18083 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 18084 (Record->hasAttr<RandomizeLayoutAttr>() || 18085 (!Record->hasAttr<NoRandomizeLayoutAttr>() && 18086 llvm::all_of(Record->decls(), IsFunctionPointer))) && 18087 !Record->isUnion() && !getLangOpts().RandstructSeed.empty() && 18088 !Record->isRandomized()) { 18089 SmallVector<Decl *, 32> NewDeclOrdering; 18090 if (randstruct::randomizeStructureLayout(Context, Record, 18091 NewDeclOrdering)) 18092 Record->reorderDecls(NewDeclOrdering); 18093 } 18094 18095 // We may have deferred checking for a deleted destructor. Check now. 18096 if (CXXRecord) { 18097 auto *Dtor = CXXRecord->getDestructor(); 18098 if (Dtor && Dtor->isImplicit() && 18099 ShouldDeleteSpecialMember(Dtor, CXXDestructor)) { 18100 CXXRecord->setImplicitDestructorIsDeleted(); 18101 SetDeclDeleted(Dtor, CXXRecord->getLocation()); 18102 } 18103 } 18104 18105 if (Record->hasAttrs()) { 18106 CheckAlignasUnderalignment(Record); 18107 18108 if (const MSInheritanceAttr *IA = Record->getAttr<MSInheritanceAttr>()) 18109 checkMSInheritanceAttrOnDefinition(cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record), 18110 IA->getRange(), IA->getBestCase(), 18111 IA->getInheritanceModel()); 18112 } 18113 18114 // Check if the structure/union declaration is a type that can have zero 18115 // size in C. For C this is a language extension, for C++ it may cause 18116 // compatibility problems. 18117 bool CheckForZeroSize; 18118 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 18119 CheckForZeroSize = true; 18120 } else { 18121 // For C++ filter out types that cannot be referenced in C code. 18122 CXXRecordDecl *CXXRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record); 18123 CheckForZeroSize = 18124 CXXRecord->getLexicalDeclContext()->isExternCContext() && 18125 !CXXRecord->isDependentType() && !inTemplateInstantiation() && 18126 CXXRecord->isCLike(); 18127 } 18128 if (CheckForZeroSize) { 18129 bool ZeroSize = true; 18130 bool IsEmpty = true; 18131 unsigned NonBitFields = 0; 18132 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator I = Record->field_begin(), 18133 E = Record->field_end(); 18134 (NonBitFields == 0 || ZeroSize) && I != E; ++I) { 18135 IsEmpty = false; 18136 if (I->isUnnamedBitfield()) { 18137 if (!I->isZeroLengthBitField(Context)) 18138 ZeroSize = false; 18139 } else { 18140 ++NonBitFields; 18141 QualType FieldType = I->getType(); 18142 if (FieldType->isIncompleteType() || 18143 !Context.getTypeSizeInChars(FieldType).isZero()) 18144 ZeroSize = false; 18145 } 18146 } 18147 18148 // Empty structs are an extension in C (C99 6.7.2.1p7). They are 18149 // allowed in C++, but warn if its declaration is inside 18150 // extern "C" block. 18151 if (ZeroSize) { 18152 Diag(RecLoc, getLangOpts().CPlusPlus ? 18153 diag::warn_zero_size_struct_union_in_extern_c : 18154 diag::warn_zero_size_struct_union_compat) 18155 << IsEmpty << Record->isUnion() << (NonBitFields > 1); 18156 } 18157 18158 // Structs without named members are extension in C (C99 6.7.2.1p7), 18159 // but are accepted by GCC. 18160 if (NonBitFields == 0 && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 18161 Diag(RecLoc, IsEmpty ? diag::ext_empty_struct_union : 18162 diag::ext_no_named_members_in_struct_union) 18163 << Record->isUnion(); 18164 } 18165 } 18166 } else { 18167 ObjCIvarDecl **ClsFields = 18168 reinterpret_cast<ObjCIvarDecl**>(RecFields.data()); 18169 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(EnclosingDecl)) { 18170 ID->setEndOfDefinitionLoc(RBrac); 18171 // Add ivar's to class's DeclContext. 18172 for (unsigned i = 0, e = RecFields.size(); i != e; ++i) { 18173 ClsFields[i]->setLexicalDeclContext(ID); 18174 ID->addDecl(ClsFields[i]); 18175 } 18176 // Must enforce the rule that ivars in the base classes may not be 18177 // duplicates. 18178 if (ID->getSuperClass()) 18179 DiagnoseDuplicateIvars(ID, ID->getSuperClass()); 18180 } else if (ObjCImplementationDecl *IMPDecl = 18181 dyn_cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(EnclosingDecl)) { 18182 assert(IMPDecl && "ActOnFields - missing ObjCImplementationDecl"); 18183 for (unsigned I = 0, N = RecFields.size(); I != N; ++I) 18184 // Ivar declared in @implementation never belongs to the implementation. 18185 // Only it is in implementation's lexical context. 18186 ClsFields[I]->setLexicalDeclContext(IMPDecl); 18187 CheckImplementationIvars(IMPDecl, ClsFields, RecFields.size(), RBrac); 18188 IMPDecl->setIvarLBraceLoc(LBrac); 18189 IMPDecl->setIvarRBraceLoc(RBrac); 18190 } else if (ObjCCategoryDecl *CDecl = 18191 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(EnclosingDecl)) { 18192 // case of ivars in class extension; all other cases have been 18193 // reported as errors elsewhere. 18194 // FIXME. Class extension does not have a LocEnd field. 18195 // CDecl->setLocEnd(RBrac); 18196 // Add ivar's to class extension's DeclContext. 18197 // Diagnose redeclaration of private ivars. 18198 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CDecl->getClassInterface(); 18199 for (unsigned i = 0, e = RecFields.size(); i != e; ++i) { 18200 if (IDecl) { 18201 if (const ObjCIvarDecl *ClsIvar = 18202 IDecl->getIvarDecl(ClsFields[i]->getIdentifier())) { 18203 Diag(ClsFields[i]->getLocation(), 18204 diag::err_duplicate_ivar_declaration); 18205 Diag(ClsIvar->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition); 18206 continue; 18207 } 18208 for (const auto *Ext : IDecl->known_extensions()) { 18209 if (const ObjCIvarDecl *ClsExtIvar 18210 = Ext->getIvarDecl(ClsFields[i]->getIdentifier())) { 18211 Diag(ClsFields[i]->getLocation(), 18212 diag::err_duplicate_ivar_declaration); 18213 Diag(ClsExtIvar->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition); 18214 continue; 18215 } 18216 } 18217 } 18218 ClsFields[i]->setLexicalDeclContext(CDecl); 18219 CDecl->addDecl(ClsFields[i]); 18220 } 18221 CDecl->setIvarLBraceLoc(LBrac); 18222 CDecl->setIvarRBraceLoc(RBrac); 18223 } 18224 } 18225 } 18226 18227 /// Determine whether the given integral value is representable within 18228 /// the given type T. 18229 static bool isRepresentableIntegerValue(ASTContext &Context, 18230 llvm::APSInt &Value, 18231 QualType T) { 18232 assert((T->isIntegralType(Context) || T->isEnumeralType()) && 18233 "Integral type required!"); 18234 unsigned BitWidth = Context.getIntWidth(T); 18235 18236 if (Value.isUnsigned() || Value.isNonNegative()) { 18237 if (T->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType()) 18238 --BitWidth; 18239 return Value.getActiveBits() <= BitWidth; 18240 } 18241 return Value.getMinSignedBits() <= BitWidth; 18242 } 18243 18244 // Given an integral type, return the next larger integral type 18245 // (or a NULL type of no such type exists). 18246 static QualType getNextLargerIntegralType(ASTContext &Context, QualType T) { 18247 // FIXME: Int128/UInt128 support, which also needs to be introduced into 18248 // enum checking below. 18249 assert((T->isIntegralType(Context) || 18250 T->isEnumeralType()) && "Integral type required!"); 18251 const unsigned NumTypes = 4; 18252 QualType SignedIntegralTypes[NumTypes] = { 18253 Context.ShortTy, Context.IntTy, Context.LongTy, Context.LongLongTy 18254 }; 18255 QualType UnsignedIntegralTypes[NumTypes] = { 18256 Context.UnsignedShortTy, Context.UnsignedIntTy, Context.UnsignedLongTy, 18257 Context.UnsignedLongLongTy 18258 }; 18259 18260 unsigned BitWidth = Context.getTypeSize(T); 18261 QualType *Types = T->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType()? SignedIntegralTypes 18262 : UnsignedIntegralTypes; 18263 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumTypes; ++I) 18264 if (Context.getTypeSize(Types[I]) > BitWidth) 18265 return Types[I]; 18266 18267 return QualType(); 18268 } 18269 18270 EnumConstantDecl *Sema::CheckEnumConstant(EnumDecl *Enum, 18271 EnumConstantDecl *LastEnumConst, 18272 SourceLocation IdLoc, 18273 IdentifierInfo *Id, 18274 Expr *Val) { 18275 unsigned IntWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getIntWidth(); 18276 llvm::APSInt EnumVal(IntWidth); 18277 QualType EltTy; 18278 18279 if (Val && DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(Val, UPPC_EnumeratorValue)) 18280 Val = nullptr; 18281 18282 if (Val) 18283 Val = DefaultLvalueConversion(Val).get(); 18284 18285 if (Val) { 18286 if (Enum->isDependentType() || Val->isTypeDependent() || 18287 Val->containsErrors()) 18288 EltTy = Context.DependentTy; 18289 else { 18290 // FIXME: We don't allow folding in C++11 mode for an enum with a fixed 18291 // underlying type, but do allow it in all other contexts. 18292 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && Enum->isFixed()) { 18293 // C++11 [dcl.enum]p5: If the underlying type is fixed, [...] the 18294 // constant-expression in the enumerator-definition shall be a converted 18295 // constant expression of the underlying type. 18296 EltTy = Enum->getIntegerType(); 18297 ExprResult Converted = 18298 CheckConvertedConstantExpression(Val, EltTy, EnumVal, 18299 CCEK_Enumerator); 18300 if (Converted.isInvalid()) 18301 Val = nullptr; 18302 else 18303 Val = Converted.get(); 18304 } else if (!Val->isValueDependent() && 18305 !(Val = 18306 VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(Val, &EnumVal, AllowFold) 18307 .get())) { 18308 // C99 6.7.2.2p2: Make sure we have an integer constant expression. 18309 } else { 18310 if (Enum->isComplete()) { 18311 EltTy = Enum->getIntegerType(); 18312 18313 // In Obj-C and Microsoft mode, require the enumeration value to be 18314 // representable in the underlying type of the enumeration. In C++11, 18315 // we perform a non-narrowing conversion as part of converted constant 18316 // expression checking. 18317 if (!isRepresentableIntegerValue(Context, EnumVal, EltTy)) { 18318 if (Context.getTargetInfo() 18319 .getTriple() 18320 .isWindowsMSVCEnvironment()) { 18321 Diag(IdLoc, diag::ext_enumerator_too_large) << EltTy; 18322 } else { 18323 Diag(IdLoc, diag::err_enumerator_too_large) << EltTy; 18324 } 18325 } 18326 18327 // Cast to the underlying type. 18328 Val = ImpCastExprToType(Val, EltTy, 18329 EltTy->isBooleanType() ? CK_IntegralToBoolean 18330 : CK_IntegralCast) 18331 .get(); 18332 } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 18333 // C++11 [dcl.enum]p5: 18334 // If the underlying type is not fixed, the type of each enumerator 18335 // is the type of its initializing value: 18336 // - If an initializer is specified for an enumerator, the 18337 // initializing value has the same type as the expression. 18338 EltTy = Val->getType(); 18339 } else { 18340 // C99 6.7.2.2p2: 18341 // The expression that defines the value of an enumeration constant 18342 // shall be an integer constant expression that has a value 18343 // representable as an int. 18344 18345 // Complain if the value is not representable in an int. 18346 if (!isRepresentableIntegerValue(Context, EnumVal, Context.IntTy)) 18347 Diag(IdLoc, diag::ext_enum_value_not_int) 18348 << toString(EnumVal, 10) << Val->getSourceRange() 18349 << (EnumVal.isUnsigned() || EnumVal.isNonNegative()); 18350 else if (!Context.hasSameType(Val->getType(), Context.IntTy)) { 18351 // Force the type of the expression to 'int'. 18352 Val = ImpCastExprToType(Val, Context.IntTy, CK_IntegralCast).get(); 18353 } 18354 EltTy = Val->getType(); 18355 } 18356 } 18357 } 18358 } 18359 18360 if (!Val) { 18361 if (Enum->isDependentType()) 18362 EltTy = Context.DependentTy; 18363 else if (!LastEnumConst) { 18364 // C++0x [dcl.enum]p5: 18365 // If the underlying type is not fixed, the type of each enumerator 18366 // is the type of its initializing value: 18367 // - If no initializer is specified for the first enumerator, the 18368 // initializing value has an unspecified integral type. 18369 // 18370 // GCC uses 'int' for its unspecified integral type, as does 18371 // C99 6.7.2.2p3. 18372 if (Enum->isFixed()) { 18373 EltTy = Enum->getIntegerType(); 18374 } 18375 else { 18376 EltTy = Context.IntTy; 18377 } 18378 } else { 18379 // Assign the last value + 1. 18380 EnumVal = LastEnumConst->getInitVal(); 18381 ++EnumVal; 18382 EltTy = LastEnumConst->getType(); 18383 18384 // Check for overflow on increment. 18385 if (EnumVal < LastEnumConst->getInitVal()) { 18386 // C++0x [dcl.enum]p5: 18387 // If the underlying type is not fixed, the type of each enumerator 18388 // is the type of its initializing value: 18389 // 18390 // - Otherwise the type of the initializing value is the same as 18391 // the type of the initializing value of the preceding enumerator 18392 // unless the incremented value is not representable in that type, 18393 // in which case the type is an unspecified integral type 18394 // sufficient to contain the incremented value. If no such type 18395 // exists, the program is ill-formed. 18396 QualType T = getNextLargerIntegralType(Context, EltTy); 18397 if (T.isNull() || Enum->isFixed()) { 18398 // There is no integral type larger enough to represent this 18399 // value. Complain, then allow the value to wrap around. 18400 EnumVal = LastEnumConst->getInitVal(); 18401 EnumVal = EnumVal.zext(EnumVal.getBitWidth() * 2); 18402 ++EnumVal; 18403 if (Enum->isFixed()) 18404 // When the underlying type is fixed, this is ill-formed. 18405 Diag(IdLoc, diag::err_enumerator_wrapped) 18406 << toString(EnumVal, 10) 18407 << EltTy; 18408 else 18409 Diag(IdLoc, diag::ext_enumerator_increment_too_large) 18410 << toString(EnumVal, 10); 18411 } else { 18412 EltTy = T; 18413 } 18414 18415 // Retrieve the last enumerator's value, extent that type to the 18416 // type that is supposed to be large enough to represent the incremented 18417 // value, then increment. 18418 EnumVal = LastEnumConst->getInitVal(); 18419 EnumVal.setIsSigned(EltTy->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType()); 18420 EnumVal = EnumVal.zextOrTrunc(Context.getIntWidth(EltTy)); 18421 ++EnumVal; 18422 18423 // If we're not in C++, diagnose the overflow of enumerator values, 18424 // which in C99 means that the enumerator value is not representable in 18425 // an int (C99 6.7.2.2p2). However, we support GCC's extension that 18426 // permits enumerator values that are representable in some larger 18427 // integral type. 18428 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !T.isNull()) 18429 Diag(IdLoc, diag::warn_enum_value_overflow); 18430 } else if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 18431 !isRepresentableIntegerValue(Context, EnumVal, EltTy)) { 18432 // Enforce C99 6.7.2.2p2 even when we compute the next value. 18433 Diag(IdLoc, diag::ext_enum_value_not_int) 18434 << toString(EnumVal, 10) << 1; 18435 } 18436 } 18437 } 18438 18439 if (!EltTy->isDependentType()) { 18440 // Make the enumerator value match the signedness and size of the 18441 // enumerator's type. 18442 EnumVal = EnumVal.extOrTrunc(Context.getIntWidth(EltTy)); 18443 EnumVal.setIsSigned(EltTy->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType()); 18444 } 18445 18446 return EnumConstantDecl::Create(Context, Enum, IdLoc, Id, EltTy, 18447 Val, EnumVal); 18448 } 18449 18450 Sema::SkipBodyInfo Sema::shouldSkipAnonEnumBody(Scope *S, IdentifierInfo *II, 18451 SourceLocation IILoc) { 18452 if (!(getLangOpts().Modules || getLangOpts().ModulesLocalVisibility) || 18453 !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 18454 return SkipBodyInfo(); 18455 18456 // We have an anonymous enum definition. Look up the first enumerator to 18457 // determine if we should merge the definition with an existing one and 18458 // skip the body. 18459 NamedDecl *PrevDecl = LookupSingleName(S, II, IILoc, LookupOrdinaryName, 18460 forRedeclarationInCurContext()); 18461 auto *PrevECD = dyn_cast_or_null<EnumConstantDecl>(PrevDecl); 18462 if (!PrevECD) 18463 return SkipBodyInfo(); 18464 18465 EnumDecl *PrevED = cast<EnumDecl>(PrevECD->getDeclContext()); 18466 NamedDecl *Hidden; 18467 if (!PrevED->getDeclName() && !hasVisibleDefinition(PrevED, &Hidden)) { 18468 SkipBodyInfo Skip; 18469 Skip.Previous = Hidden; 18470 return Skip; 18471 } 18472 18473 return SkipBodyInfo(); 18474 } 18475 18476 Decl *Sema::ActOnEnumConstant(Scope *S, Decl *theEnumDecl, Decl *lastEnumConst, 18477 SourceLocation IdLoc, IdentifierInfo *Id, 18478 const ParsedAttributesView &Attrs, 18479 SourceLocation EqualLoc, Expr *Val) { 18480 EnumDecl *TheEnumDecl = cast<EnumDecl>(theEnumDecl); 18481 EnumConstantDecl *LastEnumConst = 18482 cast_or_null<EnumConstantDecl>(lastEnumConst); 18483 18484 // The scope passed in may not be a decl scope. Zip up the scope tree until 18485 // we find one that is. 18486 S = getNonFieldDeclScope(S); 18487 18488 // Verify that there isn't already something declared with this name in this 18489 // scope. 18490 LookupResult R(*this, Id, IdLoc, LookupOrdinaryName, ForVisibleRedeclaration); 18491 LookupName(R, S); 18492 NamedDecl *PrevDecl = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>(); 18493 18494 if (PrevDecl && PrevDecl->isTemplateParameter()) { 18495 // Maybe we will complain about the shadowed template parameter. 18496 DiagnoseTemplateParameterShadow(IdLoc, PrevDecl); 18497 // Just pretend that we didn't see the previous declaration. 18498 PrevDecl = nullptr; 18499 } 18500 18501 // C++ [class.mem]p15: 18502 // If T is the name of a class, then each of the following shall have a name 18503 // different from T: 18504 // - every enumerator of every member of class T that is an unscoped 18505 // enumerated type 18506 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !TheEnumDecl->isScoped()) 18507 DiagnoseClassNameShadow(TheEnumDecl->getDeclContext(), 18508 DeclarationNameInfo(Id, IdLoc)); 18509 18510 EnumConstantDecl *New = 18511 CheckEnumConstant(TheEnumDecl, LastEnumConst, IdLoc, Id, Val); 18512 if (!New) 18513 return nullptr; 18514 18515 if (PrevDecl) { 18516 if (!TheEnumDecl->isScoped() && isa<ValueDecl>(PrevDecl)) { 18517 // Check for other kinds of shadowing not already handled. 18518 CheckShadow(New, PrevDecl, R); 18519 } 18520 18521 // When in C++, we may get a TagDecl with the same name; in this case the 18522 // enum constant will 'hide' the tag. 18523 assert((getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || !isa<TagDecl>(PrevDecl)) && 18524 "Received TagDecl when not in C++!"); 18525 if (!isa<TagDecl>(PrevDecl) && isDeclInScope(PrevDecl, CurContext, S)) { 18526 if (isa<EnumConstantDecl>(PrevDecl)) 18527 Diag(IdLoc, diag::err_redefinition_of_enumerator) << Id; 18528 else 18529 Diag(IdLoc, diag::err_redefinition) << Id; 18530 notePreviousDefinition(PrevDecl, IdLoc); 18531 return nullptr; 18532 } 18533 } 18534 18535 // Process attributes. 18536 ProcessDeclAttributeList(S, New, Attrs); 18537 AddPragmaAttributes(S, New); 18538 18539 // Register this decl in the current scope stack. 18540 New->setAccess(TheEnumDecl->getAccess()); 18541 PushOnScopeChains(New, S); 18542 18543 ActOnDocumentableDecl(New); 18544 18545 return New; 18546 } 18547 18548 // Returns true when the enum initial expression does not trigger the 18549 // duplicate enum warning. A few common cases are exempted as follows: 18550 // Element2 = Element1 18551 // Element2 = Element1 + 1 18552 // Element2 = Element1 - 1 18553 // Where Element2 and Element1 are from the same enum. 18554 static bool ValidDuplicateEnum(EnumConstantDecl *ECD, EnumDecl *Enum) { 18555 Expr *InitExpr = ECD->getInitExpr(); 18556 if (!InitExpr) 18557 return true; 18558 InitExpr = InitExpr->IgnoreImpCasts(); 18559 18560 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(InitExpr)) { 18561 if (!BO->isAdditiveOp()) 18562 return true; 18563 IntegerLiteral *IL = dyn_cast<IntegerLiteral>(BO->getRHS()); 18564 if (!IL) 18565 return true; 18566 if (IL->getValue() != 1) 18567 return true; 18568 18569 InitExpr = BO->getLHS(); 18570 } 18571 18572 // This checks if the elements are from the same enum. 18573 DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(InitExpr); 18574 if (!DRE) 18575 return true; 18576 18577 EnumConstantDecl *EnumConstant = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(DRE->getDecl()); 18578 if (!EnumConstant) 18579 return true; 18580 18581 if (cast<EnumDecl>(TagDecl::castFromDeclContext(ECD->getDeclContext())) != 18582 Enum) 18583 return true; 18584 18585 return false; 18586 } 18587 18588 // Emits a warning when an element is implicitly set a value that 18589 // a previous element has already been set to. 18590 static void CheckForDuplicateEnumValues(Sema &S, ArrayRef<Decl *> Elements, 18591 EnumDecl *Enum, QualType EnumType) { 18592 // Avoid anonymous enums 18593 if (!Enum->getIdentifier()) 18594 return; 18595 18596 // Only check for small enums. 18597 if (Enum->getNumPositiveBits() > 63 || Enum->getNumNegativeBits() > 64) 18598 return; 18599 18600 if (S.Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_duplicate_enum_values, Enum->getLocation())) 18601 return; 18602 18603 typedef SmallVector<EnumConstantDecl *, 3> ECDVector; 18604 typedef SmallVector<std::unique_ptr<ECDVector>, 3> DuplicatesVector; 18605 18606 typedef llvm::PointerUnion<EnumConstantDecl*, ECDVector*> DeclOrVector; 18607 18608 // DenseMaps cannot contain the all ones int64_t value, so use unordered_map. 18609 typedef std::unordered_map<int64_t, DeclOrVector> ValueToVectorMap; 18610 18611 // Use int64_t as a key to avoid needing special handling for map keys. 18612 auto EnumConstantToKey = [](const EnumConstantDecl *D) { 18613 llvm::APSInt Val = D->getInitVal(); 18614 return Val.isSigned() ? Val.getSExtValue() : Val.getZExtValue(); 18615 }; 18616 18617 DuplicatesVector DupVector; 18618 ValueToVectorMap EnumMap; 18619 18620 // Populate the EnumMap with all values represented by enum constants without 18621 // an initializer. 18622 for (auto *Element : Elements) { 18623 EnumConstantDecl *ECD = cast_or_null<EnumConstantDecl>(Element); 18624 18625 // Null EnumConstantDecl means a previous diagnostic has been emitted for 18626 // this constant. Skip this enum since it may be ill-formed. 18627 if (!ECD) { 18628 return; 18629 } 18630 18631 // Constants with initalizers are handled in the next loop. 18632 if (ECD->getInitExpr()) 18633 continue; 18634 18635 // Duplicate values are handled in the next loop. 18636 EnumMap.insert({EnumConstantToKey(ECD), ECD}); 18637 } 18638 18639 if (EnumMap.size() == 0) 18640 return; 18641 18642 // Create vectors for any values that has duplicates. 18643 for (auto *Element : Elements) { 18644 // The last loop returned if any constant was null. 18645 EnumConstantDecl *ECD = cast<EnumConstantDecl>(Element); 18646 if (!ValidDuplicateEnum(ECD, Enum)) 18647 continue; 18648 18649 auto Iter = EnumMap.find(EnumConstantToKey(ECD)); 18650 if (Iter == EnumMap.end()) 18651 continue; 18652 18653 DeclOrVector& Entry = Iter->second; 18654 if (EnumConstantDecl *D = Entry.dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl*>()) { 18655 // Ensure constants are different. 18656 if (D == ECD) 18657 continue; 18658 18659 // Create new vector and push values onto it. 18660 auto Vec = std::make_unique<ECDVector>(); 18661 Vec->push_back(D); 18662 Vec->push_back(ECD); 18663 18664 // Update entry to point to the duplicates vector. 18665 Entry = Vec.get(); 18666 18667 // Store the vector somewhere we can consult later for quick emission of 18668 // diagnostics. 18669 DupVector.emplace_back(std::move(Vec)); 18670 continue; 18671 } 18672 18673 ECDVector *Vec = Entry.get<ECDVector*>(); 18674 // Make sure constants are not added more than once. 18675 if (*Vec->begin() == ECD) 18676 continue; 18677 18678 Vec->push_back(ECD); 18679 } 18680 18681 // Emit diagnostics. 18682 for (const auto &Vec : DupVector) { 18683 assert(Vec->size() > 1 && "ECDVector should have at least 2 elements."); 18684 18685 // Emit warning for one enum constant. 18686 auto *FirstECD = Vec->front(); 18687 S.Diag(FirstECD->getLocation(), diag::warn_duplicate_enum_values) 18688 << FirstECD << toString(FirstECD->getInitVal(), 10) 18689 << FirstECD->getSourceRange(); 18690 18691 // Emit one note for each of the remaining enum constants with 18692 // the same value. 18693 for (auto *ECD : llvm::drop_begin(*Vec)) 18694 S.Diag(ECD->getLocation(), diag::note_duplicate_element) 18695 << ECD << toString(ECD->getInitVal(), 10) 18696 << ECD->getSourceRange(); 18697 } 18698 } 18699 18700 bool Sema::IsValueInFlagEnum(const EnumDecl *ED, const llvm::APInt &Val, 18701 bool AllowMask) const { 18702 assert(ED->isClosedFlag() && "looking for value in non-flag or open enum"); 18703 assert(ED->isCompleteDefinition() && "expected enum definition"); 18704 18705 auto R = FlagBitsCache.insert(std::make_pair(ED, llvm::APInt())); 18706 llvm::APInt &FlagBits = R.first->second; 18707 18708 if (R.second) { 18709 for (auto *E : ED->enumerators()) { 18710 const auto &EVal = E->getInitVal(); 18711 // Only single-bit enumerators introduce new flag values. 18712 if (EVal.isPowerOf2()) 18713 FlagBits = FlagBits.zextOrSelf(EVal.getBitWidth()) | EVal; 18714 } 18715 } 18716 18717 // A value is in a flag enum if either its bits are a subset of the enum's 18718 // flag bits (the first condition) or we are allowing masks and the same is 18719 // true of its complement (the second condition). When masks are allowed, we 18720 // allow the common idiom of ~(enum1 | enum2) to be a valid enum value. 18721 // 18722 // While it's true that any value could be used as a mask, the assumption is 18723 // that a mask will have all of the insignificant bits set. Anything else is 18724 // likely a logic error. 18725 llvm::APInt FlagMask = ~FlagBits.zextOrTrunc(Val.getBitWidth()); 18726 return !(FlagMask & Val) || (AllowMask && !(FlagMask & ~Val)); 18727 } 18728 18729 void Sema::ActOnEnumBody(SourceLocation EnumLoc, SourceRange BraceRange, 18730 Decl *EnumDeclX, ArrayRef<Decl *> Elements, Scope *S, 18731 const ParsedAttributesView &Attrs) { 18732 EnumDecl *Enum = cast<EnumDecl>(EnumDeclX); 18733 QualType EnumType = Context.getTypeDeclType(Enum); 18734 18735 ProcessDeclAttributeList(S, Enum, Attrs); 18736 18737 if (Enum->isDependentType()) { 18738 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Elements.size(); i != e; ++i) { 18739 EnumConstantDecl *ECD = 18740 cast_or_null<EnumConstantDecl>(Elements[i]); 18741 if (!ECD) continue; 18742 18743 ECD->setType(EnumType); 18744 } 18745 18746 Enum->completeDefinition(Context.DependentTy, Context.DependentTy, 0, 0); 18747 return; 18748 } 18749 18750 // TODO: If the result value doesn't fit in an int, it must be a long or long 18751 // long value. ISO C does not support this, but GCC does as an extension, 18752 // emit a warning. 18753 unsigned IntWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getIntWidth(); 18754 unsigned CharWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getCharWidth(); 18755 unsigned ShortWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getShortWidth(); 18756 18757 // Verify that all the values are okay, compute the size of the values, and 18758 // reverse the list. 18759 unsigned NumNegativeBits = 0; 18760 unsigned NumPositiveBits = 0; 18761 18762 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Elements.size(); i != e; ++i) { 18763 EnumConstantDecl *ECD = 18764 cast_or_null<EnumConstantDecl>(Elements[i]); 18765 if (!ECD) continue; // Already issued a diagnostic. 18766 18767 const llvm::APSInt &InitVal = ECD->getInitVal(); 18768 18769 // Keep track of the size of positive and negative values. 18770 if (InitVal.isUnsigned() || InitVal.isNonNegative()) 18771 NumPositiveBits = std::max(NumPositiveBits, 18772 (unsigned)InitVal.getActiveBits()); 18773 else 18774 NumNegativeBits = std::max(NumNegativeBits, 18775 (unsigned)InitVal.getMinSignedBits()); 18776 } 18777 18778 // Figure out the type that should be used for this enum. 18779 QualType BestType; 18780 unsigned BestWidth; 18781 18782 // C++0x N3000 [conv.prom]p3: 18783 // An rvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying 18784 // type is not fixed can be converted to an rvalue of the first 18785 // of the following types that can represent all the values of 18786 // the enumeration: int, unsigned int, long int, unsigned long 18787 // int, long long int, or unsigned long long int. 18788 // C99 6.4.4.3p2: 18789 // An identifier declared as an enumeration constant has type int. 18790 // The C99 rule is modified by a gcc extension 18791 QualType BestPromotionType; 18792 18793 bool Packed = Enum->hasAttr<PackedAttr>(); 18794 // -fshort-enums is the equivalent to specifying the packed attribute on all 18795 // enum definitions. 18796 if (LangOpts.ShortEnums) 18797 Packed = true; 18798 18799 // If the enum already has a type because it is fixed or dictated by the 18800 // target, promote that type instead of analyzing the enumerators. 18801 if (Enum->isComplete()) { 18802 BestType = Enum->getIntegerType(); 18803 if (BestType->isPromotableIntegerType()) 18804 BestPromotionType = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(BestType); 18805 else 18806 BestPromotionType = BestType; 18807 18808 BestWidth = Context.getIntWidth(BestType); 18809 } 18810 else if (NumNegativeBits) { 18811 // If there is a negative value, figure out the smallest integer type (of 18812 // int/long/longlong) that fits. 18813 // If it's packed, check also if it fits a char or a short. 18814 if (Packed && NumNegativeBits <= CharWidth && NumPositiveBits < CharWidth) { 18815 BestType = Context.SignedCharTy; 18816 BestWidth = CharWidth; 18817 } else if (Packed && NumNegativeBits <= ShortWidth && 18818 NumPositiveBits < ShortWidth) { 18819 BestType = Context.ShortTy; 18820 BestWidth = ShortWidth; 18821 } else if (NumNegativeBits <= IntWidth && NumPositiveBits < IntWidth) { 18822 BestType = Context.IntTy; 18823 BestWidth = IntWidth; 18824 } else { 18825 BestWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongWidth(); 18826 18827 if (NumNegativeBits <= BestWidth && NumPositiveBits < BestWidth) { 18828 BestType = Context.LongTy; 18829 } else { 18830 BestWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth(); 18831 18832 if (NumNegativeBits > BestWidth || NumPositiveBits >= BestWidth) 18833 Diag(Enum->getLocation(), diag::ext_enum_too_large); 18834 BestType = Context.LongLongTy; 18835 } 18836 } 18837 BestPromotionType = (BestWidth <= IntWidth ? Context.IntTy : BestType); 18838 } else { 18839 // If there is no negative value, figure out the smallest type that fits 18840 // all of the enumerator values. 18841 // If it's packed, check also if it fits a char or a short. 18842 if (Packed && NumPositiveBits <= CharWidth) { 18843 BestType = Context.UnsignedCharTy; 18844 BestPromotionType = Context.IntTy; 18845 BestWidth = CharWidth; 18846 } else if (Packed && NumPositiveBits <= ShortWidth) { 18847 BestType = Context.UnsignedShortTy; 18848 BestPromotionType = Context.IntTy; 18849 BestWidth = ShortWidth; 18850 } else if (NumPositiveBits <= IntWidth) { 18851 BestType = Context.UnsignedIntTy; 18852 BestWidth = IntWidth; 18853 BestPromotionType 18854 = (NumPositiveBits == BestWidth || !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 18855 ? Context.UnsignedIntTy : Context.IntTy; 18856 } else if (NumPositiveBits <= 18857 (BestWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongWidth())) { 18858 BestType = Context.UnsignedLongTy; 18859 BestPromotionType 18860 = (NumPositiveBits == BestWidth || !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 18861 ? Context.UnsignedLongTy : Context.LongTy; 18862 } else { 18863 BestWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth(); 18864 assert(NumPositiveBits <= BestWidth && 18865 "How could an initializer get larger than ULL?"); 18866 BestType = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy; 18867 BestPromotionType 18868 = (NumPositiveBits == BestWidth || !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 18869 ? Context.UnsignedLongLongTy : Context.LongLongTy; 18870 } 18871 } 18872 18873 // Loop over all of the enumerator constants, changing their types to match 18874 // the type of the enum if needed. 18875 for (auto *D : Elements) { 18876 auto *ECD = cast_or_null<EnumConstantDecl>(D); 18877 if (!ECD) continue; // Already issued a diagnostic. 18878 18879 // Standard C says the enumerators have int type, but we allow, as an 18880 // extension, the enumerators to be larger than int size. If each 18881 // enumerator value fits in an int, type it as an int, otherwise type it the 18882 // same as the enumerator decl itself. This means that in "enum { X = 1U }" 18883 // that X has type 'int', not 'unsigned'. 18884 18885 // Determine whether the value fits into an int. 18886 llvm::APSInt InitVal = ECD->getInitVal(); 18887 18888 // If it fits into an integer type, force it. Otherwise force it to match 18889 // the enum decl type. 18890 QualType NewTy; 18891 unsigned NewWidth; 18892 bool NewSign; 18893 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 18894 !Enum->isFixed() && 18895 isRepresentableIntegerValue(Context, InitVal, Context.IntTy)) { 18896 NewTy = Context.IntTy; 18897 NewWidth = IntWidth; 18898 NewSign = true; 18899 } else if (ECD->getType() == BestType) { 18900 // Already the right type! 18901 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 18902 // C++ [dcl.enum]p4: Following the closing brace of an 18903 // enum-specifier, each enumerator has the type of its 18904 // enumeration. 18905 ECD->setType(EnumType); 18906 continue; 18907 } else { 18908 NewTy = BestType; 18909 NewWidth = BestWidth; 18910 NewSign = BestType->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType(); 18911 } 18912 18913 // Adjust the APSInt value. 18914 InitVal = InitVal.extOrTrunc(NewWidth); 18915 InitVal.setIsSigned(NewSign); 18916 ECD->setInitVal(InitVal); 18917 18918 // Adjust the Expr initializer and type. 18919 if (ECD->getInitExpr() && 18920 !Context.hasSameType(NewTy, ECD->getInitExpr()->getType())) 18921 ECD->setInitExpr(ImplicitCastExpr::Create( 18922 Context, NewTy, CK_IntegralCast, ECD->getInitExpr(), 18923 /*base paths*/ nullptr, VK_PRValue, FPOptionsOverride())); 18924 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 18925 // C++ [dcl.enum]p4: Following the closing brace of an 18926 // enum-specifier, each enumerator has the type of its 18927 // enumeration. 18928 ECD->setType(EnumType); 18929 else 18930 ECD->setType(NewTy); 18931 } 18932 18933 Enum->completeDefinition(BestType, BestPromotionType, 18934 NumPositiveBits, NumNegativeBits); 18935 18936 CheckForDuplicateEnumValues(*this, Elements, Enum, EnumType); 18937 18938 if (Enum->isClosedFlag()) { 18939 for (Decl *D : Elements) { 18940 EnumConstantDecl *ECD = cast_or_null<EnumConstantDecl>(D); 18941 if (!ECD) continue; // Already issued a diagnostic. 18942 18943 llvm::APSInt InitVal = ECD->getInitVal(); 18944 if (InitVal != 0 && !InitVal.isPowerOf2() && 18945 !IsValueInFlagEnum(Enum, InitVal, true)) 18946 Diag(ECD->getLocation(), diag::warn_flag_enum_constant_out_of_range) 18947 << ECD << Enum; 18948 } 18949 } 18950 18951 // Now that the enum type is defined, ensure it's not been underaligned. 18952 if (Enum->hasAttrs()) 18953 CheckAlignasUnderalignment(Enum); 18954 } 18955 18956 Decl *Sema::ActOnFileScopeAsmDecl(Expr *expr, 18957 SourceLocation StartLoc, 18958 SourceLocation EndLoc) { 18959 StringLiteral *AsmString = cast<StringLiteral>(expr); 18960 18961 FileScopeAsmDecl *New = FileScopeAsmDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, 18962 AsmString, StartLoc, 18963 EndLoc); 18964 CurContext->addDecl(New); 18965 return New; 18966 } 18967 18968 void Sema::ActOnPragmaRedefineExtname(IdentifierInfo* Name, 18969 IdentifierInfo* AliasName, 18970 SourceLocation PragmaLoc, 18971 SourceLocation NameLoc, 18972 SourceLocation AliasNameLoc) { 18973 NamedDecl *PrevDecl = LookupSingleName(TUScope, Name, NameLoc, 18974 LookupOrdinaryName); 18975 AttributeCommonInfo Info(AliasName, SourceRange(AliasNameLoc), 18976 AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma); 18977 AsmLabelAttr *Attr = AsmLabelAttr::CreateImplicit( 18978 Context, AliasName->getName(), /*IsLiteralLabel=*/true, Info); 18979 18980 // If a declaration that: 18981 // 1) declares a function or a variable 18982 // 2) has external linkage 18983 // already exists, add a label attribute to it. 18984 if (PrevDecl && (isa<FunctionDecl>(PrevDecl) || isa<VarDecl>(PrevDecl))) { 18985 if (isDeclExternC(PrevDecl)) 18986 PrevDecl->addAttr(Attr); 18987 else 18988 Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::warn_redefine_extname_not_applied) 18989 << /*Variable*/(isa<FunctionDecl>(PrevDecl) ? 0 : 1) << PrevDecl; 18990 // Otherwise, add a label atttibute to ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers. 18991 } else 18992 (void)ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.insert(std::make_pair(Name, Attr)); 18993 } 18994 18995 void Sema::ActOnPragmaWeakID(IdentifierInfo* Name, 18996 SourceLocation PragmaLoc, 18997 SourceLocation NameLoc) { 18998 Decl *PrevDecl = LookupSingleName(TUScope, Name, NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 18999 19000 if (PrevDecl) { 19001 PrevDecl->addAttr(WeakAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, PragmaLoc, AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma)); 19002 } else { 19003 (void)WeakUndeclaredIdentifiers[Name].insert(WeakInfo(nullptr, NameLoc)); 19004 } 19005 } 19006 19007 void Sema::ActOnPragmaWeakAlias(IdentifierInfo* Name, 19008 IdentifierInfo* AliasName, 19009 SourceLocation PragmaLoc, 19010 SourceLocation NameLoc, 19011 SourceLocation AliasNameLoc) { 19012 Decl *PrevDecl = LookupSingleName(TUScope, AliasName, AliasNameLoc, 19013 LookupOrdinaryName); 19014 WeakInfo W = WeakInfo(Name, NameLoc); 19015 19016 if (PrevDecl && (isa<FunctionDecl>(PrevDecl) || isa<VarDecl>(PrevDecl))) { 19017 if (!PrevDecl->hasAttr<AliasAttr>()) 19018 if (NamedDecl *ND = dyn_cast<NamedDecl>(PrevDecl)) 19019 DeclApplyPragmaWeak(TUScope, ND, W); 19020 } else { 19021 (void)WeakUndeclaredIdentifiers[AliasName].insert(W); 19022 } 19023 } 19024 19025 ObjCContainerDecl *Sema::getObjCDeclContext() const { 19026 return (dyn_cast_or_null<ObjCContainerDecl>(CurContext)); 19027 } 19028 19029 Sema::FunctionEmissionStatus Sema::getEmissionStatus(FunctionDecl *FD, 19030 bool Final) { 19031 assert(FD && "Expected non-null FunctionDecl"); 19032 19033 // SYCL functions can be template, so we check if they have appropriate 19034 // attribute prior to checking if it is a template. 19035 if (LangOpts.SYCLIsDevice && FD->hasAttr<SYCLKernelAttr>()) 19036 return FunctionEmissionStatus::Emitted; 19037 19038 // Templates are emitted when they're instantiated. 19039 if (FD->isDependentContext()) 19040 return FunctionEmissionStatus::TemplateDiscarded; 19041 19042 // Check whether this function is an externally visible definition. 19043 auto IsEmittedForExternalSymbol = [this, FD]() { 19044 // We have to check the GVA linkage of the function's *definition* -- if we 19045 // only have a declaration, we don't know whether or not the function will 19046 // be emitted, because (say) the definition could include "inline". 19047 FunctionDecl *Def = FD->getDefinition(); 19048 19049 return Def && !isDiscardableGVALinkage( 19050 getASTContext().GetGVALinkageForFunction(Def)); 19051 }; 19052 19053 if (LangOpts.OpenMPIsDevice) { 19054 // In OpenMP device mode we will not emit host only functions, or functions 19055 // we don't need due to their linkage. 19056 Optional<OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr::DevTypeTy> DevTy = 19057 OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr::getDeviceType(FD->getCanonicalDecl()); 19058 // DevTy may be changed later by 19059 // #pragma omp declare target to(*) device_type(*). 19060 // Therefore DevTy having no value does not imply host. The emission status 19061 // will be checked again at the end of compilation unit with Final = true. 19062 if (DevTy.hasValue()) 19063 if (*DevTy == OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr::DT_Host) 19064 return FunctionEmissionStatus::OMPDiscarded; 19065 // If we have an explicit value for the device type, or we are in a target 19066 // declare context, we need to emit all extern and used symbols. 19067 if (isInOpenMPDeclareTargetContext() || DevTy.hasValue()) 19068 if (IsEmittedForExternalSymbol()) 19069 return FunctionEmissionStatus::Emitted; 19070 // Device mode only emits what it must, if it wasn't tagged yet and needed, 19071 // we'll omit it. 19072 if (Final) 19073 return FunctionEmissionStatus::OMPDiscarded; 19074 } else if (LangOpts.OpenMP > 45) { 19075 // In OpenMP host compilation prior to 5.0 everything was an emitted host 19076 // function. In 5.0, no_host was introduced which might cause a function to 19077 // be ommitted. 19078 Optional<OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr::DevTypeTy> DevTy = 19079 OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr::getDeviceType(FD->getCanonicalDecl()); 19080 if (DevTy.hasValue()) 19081 if (*DevTy == OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr::DT_NoHost) 19082 return FunctionEmissionStatus::OMPDiscarded; 19083 } 19084 19085 if (Final && LangOpts.OpenMP && !LangOpts.CUDA) 19086 return FunctionEmissionStatus::Emitted; 19087 19088 if (LangOpts.CUDA) { 19089 // When compiling for device, host functions are never emitted. Similarly, 19090 // when compiling for host, device and global functions are never emitted. 19091 // (Technically, we do emit a host-side stub for global functions, but this 19092 // doesn't count for our purposes here.) 19093 Sema::CUDAFunctionTarget T = IdentifyCUDATarget(FD); 19094 if (LangOpts.CUDAIsDevice && T == Sema::CFT_Host) 19095 return FunctionEmissionStatus::CUDADiscarded; 19096 if (!LangOpts.CUDAIsDevice && 19097 (T == Sema::CFT_Device || T == Sema::CFT_Global)) 19098 return FunctionEmissionStatus::CUDADiscarded; 19099 19100 if (IsEmittedForExternalSymbol()) 19101 return FunctionEmissionStatus::Emitted; 19102 } 19103 19104 // Otherwise, the function is known-emitted if it's in our set of 19105 // known-emitted functions. 19106 return FunctionEmissionStatus::Unknown; 19107 } 19108 19109 bool Sema::shouldIgnoreInHostDeviceCheck(FunctionDecl *Callee) { 19110 // Host-side references to a __global__ function refer to the stub, so the 19111 // function itself is never emitted and therefore should not be marked. 19112 // If we have host fn calls kernel fn calls host+device, the HD function 19113 // does not get instantiated on the host. We model this by omitting at the 19114 // call to the kernel from the callgraph. This ensures that, when compiling 19115 // for host, only HD functions actually called from the host get marked as 19116 // known-emitted. 19117 return LangOpts.CUDA && !LangOpts.CUDAIsDevice && 19118 IdentifyCUDATarget(Callee) == CFT_Global; 19119 } 19120